Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Ford
Model
Expedition 4wd
Engine and year
V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0005 - P0009,
( P0006 P0007 P0008 0005 0006 0007 0008 0009 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0005 - P0009: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P005x, refer to chart:
P005x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0010 - P0014,
( P0011 P0012 P0013 0010 0011 0012 0013 0014 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0010
P0010 - P0014: Testing and Inspection P0010
For diagnosis of code P0010, refer to chart:
P0010
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0010 - P0014,
( P0011 P0012 P0013 0010 0011 0012 0013 0014 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0010 > Page 12
P0010 - P0014: Testing and Inspection P0011
For diagnosis of code P0011, refer to chart:
P0011
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0010 - P0014,
( P0011 P0012 P0013 0010 0011 0012 0013 0014 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0010 > Page 13
P0010 - P0014: Testing and Inspection P0012
For diagnosis of code P0012, refer to chart:
P0012
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0015 - P0019,
( P0016 P0017 P0018 0015 0016 0017 0018 0019 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0016
P0015 - P0019: Testing and Inspection P0016
For diagnosis of code P, refer to chart:
P0016
P0016
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0015 - P0019,
( P0016 P0017 P0018 0015 0016 0017 0018 0019 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0016 > Page 18
P0015 - P0019: Testing and Inspection P0018
For diagnosis of code P0018, refer to chart:
P0018
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0020 - P0024,
( P0021 P0022 P0023 0020 0021 0022 0023 0024 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0020
P0020 - P0024: Testing and Inspection P0020
For diagnosis of code P0020, refer to chart:
P0020
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0020 - P0024,
( P0021 P0022 P0023 0020 0021 0022 0023 0024 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0020 > Page 23
P0020 - P0024: Testing and Inspection P0021
For diagnosis of code P0021, refer to chart:
P0021
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0020 - P0024,
( P0021 P0022 P0023 0020 0021 0022 0023 0024 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0020 > Page 24
P0020 - P0024: Testing and Inspection P0022
For diagnosis of code P0022, refer to chart:
P0022
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0040 - P0044,
( P0041 P0042 P0043 0040 0041 0042 0043 0044 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0040
P0040 - P0044: Testing and Inspection P0040
For diagnosis of code P0040, refer to chart:
P0040
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0040 - P0044,
( P0041 P0042 P0043 0040 0041 0042 0043 0044 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0040 > Page 29
P0040 - P0044: Testing and Inspection P0041
For diagnosis of code P0041, refer to chart:
P0041
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0050 - P0054,
( P0051 P0052 P0053 0050 0051 0052 0053 0054 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0053
P0050 - P0054: Testing and Inspection P0053
For diagnosis of code P0053, refer to chart:
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0050 - P0054,
( P0051 P0052 P0053 0050 0051 0052 0053 0054 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0053 > Page 34
P0050 - P0054: Testing and Inspection P0054
For diagnosis of code P0054, refer to chart:
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0055 - P0059,
( P0056 P0057 P0058 0055 0056 0057 0058 0059 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0055
P0055 - P0059: Testing and Inspection P0055
For diagnosis of code P0055, refer to chart:
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0055 - P0059,
( P0056 P0057 P0058 0055 0056 0057 0058 0059 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0055 > Page 39
P0055 - P0059: Testing and Inspection P0059
For diagnosis of code P0059, refer to chart:
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0060 - P0064,
( P0061 P0062 P0063 0060 0061 0062 0063 0064 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0060 - P0064: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0060, refer to chart:
P0060
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0000-P00ZZ > P0065 - P0069,
( P0066 P0067 P0068 0065 0066 0067 0068 0069 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0065 - P0069: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0068, refer to chart:
P0068
P0068
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0100 - P0104,
( P0101 P0102 P0103 0100 0101 0102 0103 0104 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0102
P0100 - P0104: Testing and Inspection P0102
For diagnosis of code P0102, refer to chart:
P0102
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0100 - P0104,
( P0101 P0102 P0103 0100 0101 0102 0103 0104 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0102 > Page 51
P0100 - P0104: Testing and Inspection P0103
For diagnosis of code P0103, refer to chart:
P0103
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0100 - P0104,
( P0101 P0102 P0103 0100 0101 0102 0103 0104 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0102 > Page 52
P0100 - P0104: Testing and Inspection P0104
For diagnosis of code P0104, refer to chart:
P0104
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0105 - P0109,
( P0106 P0107 P0108 0105 0106 0107 0108 0109 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0106
P0105 - P0109: Testing and Inspection P0106
For diagnosis of code P0106, refer to chart:
P0106
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0105 - P0109,
( P0106 P0107 P0108 0105 0106 0107 0108 0109 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0106 > Page 57
P0105 - P0109: Testing and Inspection P0107
For diagnosis of code P0107, refer to chart:
P0107
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0105 - P0109,
( P0106 P0107 P0108 0105 0106 0107 0108 0109 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0106 > Page 58
P0105 - P0109: Testing and Inspection P0108
For diagnosis of code P0108, refer to chart:
P0108
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0105 - P0109,
( P0106 P0107 P0108 0105 0106 0107 0108 0109 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0106 > Page 59
P0105 - P0109: Testing and Inspection P0109
For diagnosis of code P0109, refer to chart:
P0109
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0110 - P0114,
( P0111 P0112 P0113 0110 0111 0112 0113 0114 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0112
P0110 - P0114: Testing and Inspection P0112
For diagnosis of code P, refer to chart:
P0112
P0112
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0110 - P0114,
( P0111 P0112 P0113 0110 0111 0112 0113 0114 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0112 > Page 64
P0110 - P0114: Testing and Inspection P0113
For diagnosis of code P0113, refer to chart:
P0113
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0110 - P0114,
( P0111 P0112 P0113 0110 0111 0112 0113 0114 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0112 > Page 65
P0110 - P0114: Testing and Inspection P0114
For diagnosis of code P0114, refer to chart:
P0114
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0115 - P0119,
( P0116 P0117 P0118 0115 0116 0117 0118 0119 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0116
P0115 - P0119: Testing and Inspection P0116
For diagnosis of code P0116, refer to chart:
P0116
P0116
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0115 - P0119,
( P0116 P0117 P0118 0115 0116 0117 0118 0119 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0116 > Page 70
P0115 - P0119: Testing and Inspection P0117
For diagnosis of code P0117, refer to chart:
P0117
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0115 - P0119,
( P0116 P0117 P0118 0115 0116 0117 0118 0119 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0116 > Page 71
P0115 - P0119: Testing and Inspection P0118
For diagnosis of code P0118, refer to chart:
P0118
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0115 - P0119,
( P0116 P0117 P0118 0115 0116 0117 0118 0119 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0116 > Page 72
P0115 - P0119: Testing and Inspection P0119
For diagnosis of code P0119, refer to chart:
P0119
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0120 - P0124,
( P0121 P0122 P0123 0120 0121 0122 0123 0124 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0121
P0120 - P0124: Testing and Inspection P0121
For diagnosis of code P0121, refer to chart:
P0121
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0120 - P0124,
( P0121 P0122 P0123 0120 0121 0122 0123 0124 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0121 > Page 77
P0120 - P0124: Testing and Inspection P0122
For diagnosis of code P0122, refer to chart:
P0122
P0122
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0120 - P0124,
( P0121 P0122 P0123 0120 0121 0122 0123 0124 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0121 > Page 78
P0120 - P0124: Testing and Inspection P0123
For diagnosis of code P0123, refer to chart:
P0123
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0125 - P0129,
( P0126 P0127 P0128 0125 0126 0127 0128 0129 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0125
P0125 - P0129: Testing and Inspection P0125
For diagnosis of code P0125, refer to chart:
P0125
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0125 - P0129,
( P0126 P0127 P0128 0125 0126 0127 0128 0129 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0125 > Page 83
P0125 - P0129: Testing and Inspection P0127
For diagnosis of code P0127, refer to chart:
P0127
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0125 - P0129,
( P0126 P0127 P0128 0125 0126 0127 0128 0129 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0125 > Page 84
P0125 - P0129: Testing and Inspection P0128
For diagnosis of code P0128, refer to chart:
P0128
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0130 - P0134,
( P0131 P0132 P0133 0130 0131 0132 0133 0134 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0132
P0130 - P0134: Testing and Inspection P0132
For diagnosis of code P0132, refer to chart:
P0132
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0130 - P0134,
( P0131 P0132 P0133 0130 0131 0132 0133 0134 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0132 > Page 89
P0130 - P0134: Testing and Inspection P0133
For diagnosis of code P0133, refer to chart:
P0133
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0135 - P0139,
( P0136 P0137 P0138 0135 0136 0137 0138 0139 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0135
P0135 - P0139: Testing and Inspection P0135
For diagnosis of code P0135, refer to chart:
P0135
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0135 - P0139,
( P0136 P0137 P0138 0135 0136 0137 0138 0139 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0135 > Page 94
P0135 - P0139: Testing and Inspection P0138
For diagnosis of code P0138, refer to chart:
P0138
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0140 - P0144,
( P0141 P0142 P0143 0140 0141 0142 0143 0144 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0141
P0140 - P0144: Testing and Inspection P0141
For diagnosis of code P0141, refer to chart:
P0141
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0140 - P0144,
( P0141 P0142 P0143 0140 0141 0142 0143 0144 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0141 > Page 99
P0140 - P0144: Testing and Inspection P0144
For diagnosis of code P0144, refer to chart:
P0144
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0145 - P0149,
( P0146 P0127 P0148 0145 0146 0147 0148 0149 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0147
P0145 - P0149: Testing and Inspection P0147
For diagnosis of code P0147, refer to chart:
P0147
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0145 - P0149,
( P0146 P0127 P0148 0145 0146 0147 0148 0149 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0147 > Page 104
P0145 - P0149: Testing and Inspection P0148
For diagnosis of code P0148, refer to chart:
P0148
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0150 - P0154,
( P0151 P0152 P0153 0150 0151 0152 0153 0154 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0152
P0150 - P0154: Testing and Inspection P0152
For diagnosis of code P0152, refer to chart:
P0152
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0150 - P0154,
( P0151 P0152 P0153 0150 0151 0152 0153 0154 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0152 > Page 109
P0150 - P0154: Testing and Inspection P0153
For diagnosis of code P0153, refer to chart:
P0153
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0155 - P0159,
( P0156 P0157 P0158 0155 0156 0157 0158 0159 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0155
P0155 - P0159: Testing and Inspection P0155
For diagnosis of code P0155, refer to chart:
P0155
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0155 - P0159,
( P0156 P0157 P0158 0155 0156 0157 0158 0159 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0155 > Page 114
P0155 - P0159: Testing and Inspection P0158
For diagnosis of code P0158, refer to chart:
P0158
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0160 - P0164,
( P0161 P0162 P0163 0160 0161 0162 0163 0164 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0160 - P0164: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0161, refer to chart:
P0161
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0170 - P0174,
( P0171 P0172 P0173 0170 0171 0172 0173 0174 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0171
P0170 - P0174: Testing and Inspection P0171
For diagnosis of code P0171, refer to chart:
P0171
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0170 - P0174,
( P0171 P0172 P0173 0170 0171 0172 0173 0174 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0171 > Page 122
P0170 - P0174: Testing and Inspection P0172
For diagnosis of code P0172, refer to chart:
P0172
P0172
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0170 - P0174,
( P0171 P0172 P0173 0170 0171 0172 0173 0174 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0171 > Page 123
P0170 - P0174: Testing and Inspection P0174
For diagnosis of code P0174, refer to chart:
P0174
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0175 - P0179,
( P0176 P0177 P0178 0175 0176 0177 0178 0179 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0175 - P0179: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0175, refer to chart:
P0175
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0180 - P0184,
( P0181 P0182 P0183 0180 0181 0182 0183 0184 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0180
P0180 - P0184: Testing and Inspection P0180
For diagnosis of code P0180, refer to chart:
P0180
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0180 - P0184,
( P0181 P0182 P0183 0180 0181 0182 0183 0184 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0180 > Page 131
P0180 - P0184: Testing and Inspection P0181
For diagnosis of code P0181, refer to chart:
P0181
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0180 - P0184,
( P0181 P0182 P0183 0180 0181 0182 0183 0184 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0180 > Page 132
P0180 - P0184: Testing and Inspection P0182
For diagnosis of code P0182, refer to chart:
P0182
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0180 - P0184,
( P0181 P0182 P0183 0180 0181 0182 0183 0184 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0180 > Page 133
P0180 - P0184: Testing and Inspection P0183
For diagnosis of code P0183, refer to chart:
P0183
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0190 - P0194,
( P0191 P0192 P0193 0190 0191 0192 0193 0194 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0190
P0190 - P0194: Testing and Inspection P0190
For diagnosis of code P0190, refer to chart:
P0190
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0190 - P0194,
( P0191 P0192 P0193 0190 0191 0192 0193 0194 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0190 > Page 138
P0190 - P0194: Testing and Inspection P0191
For diagnosis of code P0191, refer to chart:
P0191
P0191
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0190 - P0194,
( P0191 P0192 P0193 0190 0191 0192 0193 0194 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0190 > Page 139
P0190 - P0194: Testing and Inspection P0192
For diagnosis of code P0192, refer to chart:
P0192
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0190 - P0194,
( P0191 P0192 P0193 0190 0191 0192 0193 0194 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0190 > Page 140
P0190 - P0194: Testing and Inspection P0193
For diagnosis of code P0193, refer to chart:
P0193
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0195 - P0199,
( P0196 P0197 P0198 0195 0196 0197 0198 0199 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0196
P0195 - P0199: Testing and Inspection P0196
For diagnosis of code P0196, refer to chart:
P0196
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0195 - P0199,
( P0196 P0197 P0198 0195 0196 0197 0198 0199 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0196 > Page 145
P0195 - P0199: Testing and Inspection P0197
For diagnosis of code P0197, refer to chart:
P0197
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0100-P01ZZ > P0195 - P0199,
( P0196 P0197 P0198 0195 0196 0197 0198 0199 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0196 > Page 146
P0195 - P0199: Testing and Inspection P0198
For diagnosis of code P0198, refer to chart:
P0198
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0200 - P0204,
( P0201 P0202 P0203 0200 0201 0202 0203 0204 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0200 - P0204: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P020X, refer to chart:
P020x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0210 - P0214,
( P0211 P0212 P0213 0210 0211 0212 0213 0214 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0210 - P0214: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0210, refer to chart:
P0210
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0215 - P0219,
( P0216 P0217 P0218 0215 0216 0217 0218 0219 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0217
P0215 - P0219: Testing and Inspection P0217
For diagnosis of code P0217, refer to chart:
P0217
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0215 - P0219,
( P0216 P0217 P0218 0215 0216 0217 0218 0219 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0217 > Page 158
P0215 - P0219: Testing and Inspection P0218
For diagnosis of code P0218, refer to chart:
P0218
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0215 - P0219,
( P0216 P0217 P0218 0215 0216 0217 0218 0219 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0217 > Page 159
P0215 - P0219: Testing and Inspection P0219
For diagnosis of code P0219, refer to chart:
P0219
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0220 - P0224,
( P0221 P0222 P0223 0220 0221 0222 0223 0224 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0221
P0220 - P0224: Testing and Inspection P0221
For diagnosis of code P0221, refer to chart:
P0221
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0220 - P0224,
( P0221 P0222 P0223 0220 0221 0222 0223 0224 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0221 > Page 164
P0220 - P0224: Testing and Inspection P0222
For diagnosis of code P0222, refer to chart:
P0222
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0220 - P0224,
( P0221 P0222 P0223 0220 0221 0222 0223 0224 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0221 > Page 165
P0220 - P0224: Testing and Inspection P0223
For diagnosis of code P0223, refer to chart:
P0223
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0230 - P0234,
( P0231 P0232 P0233 0230 0231 0232 0233 0234 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0230
P0230 - P0234: Testing and Inspection P0230
For diagnosis of code P0230, refer to chart:
P0230
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0230 - P0234,
( P0231 P0232 P0233 0230 0231 0232 0233 0234 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0230 > Page 170
P0230 - P0234: Testing and Inspection P0231
For diagnosis of code P0231, refer to chart:
P0231
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0230 - P0234,
( P0231 P0232 P0233 0230 0231 0232 0233 0234 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0230 > Page 171
P0230 - P0234: Testing and Inspection P0232
For diagnosis of code P0232, refer to chart:
P0232
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0230 - P0234,
( P0231 P0232 P0233 0230 0231 0232 0233 0234 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0230 > Page 172
P0230 - P0234: Testing and Inspection P0234
For diagnosis of code P0234, refer to chart:
P0234
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0240 - P0244,
( P0241 P0242 P0243 0240 0241 0242 0243 0244 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0240 - P0244: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0243, refer to chart:
P0243
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0260 - P0264,
( P0261 P0262 P0263 0260 0261 0262 0263 0264 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0261
P0260 - P0264: Testing and Inspection P0261
For diagnosis of code P0261, refer to chart:
P0261
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0260 - P0264,
( P0261 P0262 P0263 0260 0261 0262 0263 0264 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0261 > Page 180
P0260 - P0264: Testing and Inspection P0262
For diagnosis of code P0262, refer to chart:
P0262
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0260 - P0264,
( P0261 P0262 P0263 0260 0261 0262 0263 0264 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0261 > Page 181
P0260 - P0264: Testing and Inspection P0264
For diagnosis of code P0264, refer to chart:
P0264
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0265 - P0269,
( P0266 P0267 P0268 0265 0266 0267 0268 0269 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0265
P0265 - P0269: Testing and Inspection P0265
For diagnosis of code P0265, refer to chart:
P0265
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0265 - P0269,
( P0266 P0267 P0268 0265 0266 0267 0268 0269 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0265 > Page 186
P0265 - P0269: Testing and Inspection P0267
For diagnosis of code P0267, refer to chart:
P0267
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0265 - P0269,
( P0266 P0267 P0268 0265 0266 0267 0268 0269 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0265 > Page 187
P0265 - P0269: Testing and Inspection P0268
For diagnosis of code P0268, refer to chart:
P0268
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0270 - P0274,
( P0271 P0272 P0273 0270 0271 0272 0273 0274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0270
P0270 - P0274: Testing and Inspection P0270
For diagnosis of code P0270, refer to chart:
P0270
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0270 - P0274,
( P0271 P0272 P0273 0270 0271 0272 0273 0274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0270 > Page 192
P0270 - P0274: Testing and Inspection P0271
For diagnosis of code P0271, refer to chart:
P0271
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0270 - P0274,
( P0271 P0272 P0273 0270 0271 0272 0273 0274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0270 > Page 193
P0270 - P0274: Testing and Inspection P0273
For diagnosis of code P0273, refer to chart:
P0273
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0270 - P0274,
( P0271 P0272 P0273 0270 0271 0272 0273 0274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0270 > Page 194
P0270 - P0274: Testing and Inspection P0274
For diagnosis of code P0274, refer to chart:
P0274
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0275 - P0279,
( P0276 P0277 P0278 0275 0276 0277 0278 0279 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0276
P0275 - P0279: Testing and Inspection P0276
For diagnosis of code P0276, refer to chart:
P0276
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0275 - P0279,
( P0276 P0277 P0278 0275 0276 0277 0278 0279 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0276 > Page 199
P0275 - P0279: Testing and Inspection P0277
For diagnosis of code P0277, refer to chart:
P0277
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0275 - P0279,
( P0276 P0277 P0278 0275 0276 0277 0278 0279 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0276 > Page 200
P0275 - P0279: Testing and Inspection P0279
For diagnosis of code P0279, refer to chart:
P0279
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0280 - P0284,
( P0281 P0282 P0283 0280 0281 0282 0283 0284 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0280
P0280 - P0284: Testing and Inspection P0280
For diagnosis of code P0280, refer to chart:
P0280
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0280 - P0284,
( P0281 P0282 P0283 0280 0281 0282 0283 0284 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0280 > Page 205
P0280 - P0284: Testing and Inspection P0282
For diagnosis of code P0282, refer to chart:
P0283
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0280 - P0284,
( P0281 P0282 P0283 0280 0281 0282 0283 0284 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0280 > Page 206
P0280 - P0284: Testing and Inspection P0283
For diagnosis of code P0283, refer to chart:
P0283
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0295 - P0299,
( P0296 P0297 P0298 0295 0296 0297 0298 0299 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0297
P0295 - P0299: Testing and Inspection P0297
For diagnosis of code P0297, refer to chart:
P0297
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0200-P02ZZ > P0295 - P0299,
( P0296 P0297 P0298 0295 0296 0297 0298 0299 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0297 > Page 211
P0295 - P0299: Testing and Inspection P0298
For diagnosis of code P0298, refer to chart:
P0298
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0300 - P0304,
( P0301 P0302 P0303 0300 0301 0302 0303 0304 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P030x
P0300 - P0304: Testing and Inspection P030x
For diagnosis of code P030X, refer to chart:
P030x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0300 - P0304,
( P0301 P0302 P0303 0300 0301 0302 0303 0304 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P030x > Page 217
P0300 - P0304: Testing and Inspection P0300
For diagnosis of code P0300, refer to chart:
P0300
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0310 - P0314,
( P0311 P0312 P0313 0310 0311 0312 0313 0314 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0310 - P0314: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0310, refer to chart:
P0310
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0315 - P0319,
( P0316 P0317 P0318 0315 0316 0317 0318 0319 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0315
P0315 - P0319: Testing and Inspection P0315
For diagnosis of code P0315, refer to chart:
P0315
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0315 - P0319,
( P0316 P0317 P0318 0315 0316 0317 0318 0319 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0315 > Page 225
P0315 - P0319: Testing and Inspection P0316
For diagnosis of code P0316, refer to chart:
P0316
P0316
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0320 - P0324,
( P0321 P0322 P0323 0320 0321 0322 0323 0324 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0320 - P0324: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0320, refer to chart:
P0320
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0325 - P0329,
( P0326 P0327 P0328 0325 0326 0327 0328 0329 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0325
P0325 - P0329: Testing and Inspection P0325
For diagnosis of code P0325, refer to chart:
P0325
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0325 - P0329,
( P0326 P0327 P0328 0325 0326 0327 0328 0329 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0325 > Page 233
P0325 - P0329: Testing and Inspection P0326
For diagnosis of code P0326, refer to chart:
P0326
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0330 - P0334,
( P0331 P0332 P0333 0330 0331 0332 0333 0334 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0330
P0330 - P0334: Testing and Inspection P0330
For diagnosis of code P0330, refer to chart:
P0330
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0330 - P0334,
( P0331 P0332 P0333 0330 0331 0332 0333 0334 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0330 > Page 238
P0330 - P0334: Testing and Inspection P0331
For diagnosis of code P0331, refer to chart:
P0331
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0340 - P0344,
( P0341 P0342 P0343 0340 0341 0342 0343 0344 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0340
P0340 - P0344: Testing and Inspection P0340
For diagnosis of code P0340, refer to chart:
P0340
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0340 - P0344,
( P0341 P0342 P0343 0340 0341 0342 0343 0344 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0340 > Page 243
P0340 - P0344: Testing and Inspection P0344
For diagnosis of code P0344, refer to chart:
P0344
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0345 - P0349,
( P0346 P0347 P0348 0345 0346 0347 0348 0349 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0345
P0345 - P0349: Testing and Inspection P0345
For diagnosis of code P0345, refer to chart:
P0345
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0345 - P0349,
( P0346 P0347 P0348 0345 0346 0347 0348 0349 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0345 > Page 248
P0345 - P0349: Testing and Inspection P0349
For diagnosis of code P0349, refer to chart:
P0349
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0350 - P0354,
( P0351 P0352 P0353 0350 0351 0352 0353 0354 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0350
P0350 - P0354: Testing and Inspection P0350
For diagnosis of code P0350, refer to chart:
P0350
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0350 - P0354,
( P0351 P0352 P0353 0350 0351 0352 0353 0354 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0350 > Page 253
P0350 - P0354: Testing and Inspection P0351
For diagnosis of code P0351, refer to chart:
P0351
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0350 - P0354,
( P0351 P0352 P0353 0350 0351 0352 0353 0354 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0350 > Page 254
P0350 - P0354: Testing and Inspection P0352
For diagnosis of code P0352, refer to chart:
P0352
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0350 - P0354,
( P0351 P0352 P0353 0350 0351 0352 0353 0354 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0350 > Page 255
P0350 - P0354: Testing and Inspection P0353
For diagnosis of code P0353, refer to chart:
P0353 (Part 1)
P0353 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0350 - P0354,
( P0351 P0352 P0353 0350 0351 0352 0353 0354 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0350 > Page 256
P0350 - P0354: Testing and Inspection P0354
For diagnosis of code P0354, refer to chart:
P0354
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0355 - P0359,
( P0356 P0357 P0358 0355 0356 0357 0358 0359 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0355
P0355 - P0359: Testing and Inspection P0355
For diagnosis of code P0355, refer to chart:
P0355
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0355 - P0359,
( P0356 P0357 P0358 0355 0356 0357 0358 0359 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0355 > Page 261
P0355 - P0359: Testing and Inspection P0356
For diagnosis of code P0356, refer to chart:
P0356
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0355 - P0359,
( P0356 P0357 P0358 0355 0356 0357 0358 0359 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0355 > Page 262
P0355 - P0359: Testing and Inspection P0357
For diagnosis of code P0357, refer to chart:
P0357
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0355 - P0359,
( P0356 P0357 P0358 0355 0356 0357 0358 0359 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0355 > Page 263
P0355 - P0359: Testing and Inspection P0358
For diagnosis of code P0358, refer to chart:
P0358 (Part 1)
P0358 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0355 - P0359,
( P0356 P0357 P0358 0355 0356 0357 0358 0359 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0355 > Page 264
P0355 - P0359: Testing and Inspection P0359
For diagnosis of code P0359, refer to chart:
P0359
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0300-P03ZZ > P0360 - P0364,
( P0361 P0362 P0363 0360 0361 0362 0363 0364 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0360 - P0364: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0360, refer to chart:
P0360
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0400 - P0404,
( P0401 P0402 P0403 0400 0401 0402 0403 0404 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0400
P0400 - P0404: Testing and Inspection P0400
For diagnosis of code P0400, refer to chart:
P0400
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0400 - P0404,
( P0401 P0402 P0403 0400 0401 0402 0403 0404 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0400 > Page 273
P0400 - P0404: Testing and Inspection P0401
For diagnosis of code P0401, refer to chart:
P0401
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0400 - P0404,
( P0401 P0402 P0403 0400 0401 0402 0403 0404 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0400 > Page 274
P0400 - P0404: Testing and Inspection P0402
For diagnosis of code P0402, refer to chart:
P0402
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0400 - P0404,
( P0401 P0402 P0403 0400 0401 0402 0403 0404 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0400 > Page 275
P0400 - P0404: Testing and Inspection P0403
For diagnosis of code P0403, refer to chart:
P0403
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0405 - P0409,
( P0406 P0407 P0408 0405 0406 0407 0408 0409 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0405
P0405 - P0409: Testing and Inspection P0405
For diagnosis of code P0405, refer to chart:
P0405
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0405 - P0409,
( P0406 P0407 P0408 0405 0406 0407 0408 0409 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0405 > Page 280
P0405 - P0409: Testing and Inspection P0406
For diagnosis of code P0406, refer to chart:
P0406
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0410 - P0414,
( P0411 P0412 P0413 0410 0411 0412 0413 0414 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0410
P0410 - P0414: Testing and Inspection P0410
For diagnosis of code P0410, refer to chart:
P0410
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0410 - P0414,
( P0411 P0412 P0413 0410 0411 0412 0413 0414 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0410 > Page 285
P0410 - P0414: Testing and Inspection P0412
For diagnosis of code P0412, refer to chart:
P0412
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0420 - P0424,
( P0421 P0422 P0423 0420 0421 0422 0423 0424 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0420 - P0424: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0420, refer to chart:
P0420
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0430 - P0434,
( P0431 P0432 P0433 0430 0431 0432 0433 0434 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0430 - P0434: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0430, refer to chart:
P0430
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0440 - P0444,
( P0441 P0442 P0443 0440 0441 0442 0443 0444 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0442
P0440 - P0444: Testing and Inspection P0442
For diagnosis of code P0442, refer to chart:
P0442
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0440 - P0444,
( P0441 P0442 P0443 0440 0441 0442 0443 0444 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0442 > Page 296
P0440 - P0444: Testing and Inspection P0443
For diagnosis of code P0443, refer to chart:
P0443
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0445 - P0449,
( P0446 P0447 P0448 0445 0446 0447 0448 0449 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0445 - P0449: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0446, refer to chart:
P0446
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0450 - P0454,
( P0451 P0452 P0453 0450 0451 0452 0453 0454 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0451
P0450 - P0454: Testing and Inspection P0451
For diagnosis of code P0451, refer to chart:
P0451 (Part 1)
P0451 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0450 - P0454,
( P0451 P0452 P0453 0450 0451 0452 0453 0454 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0451 > Page 304
P0450 - P0454: Testing and Inspection P0452
For diagnosis of code P0452, refer to chart:
P0452
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection See: Powertrain Management/Transmission Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0450 - P0454,
( P0451 P0452 P0453 0450 0451 0452 0453 0454 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0451 > Page 305
P0450 - P0454: Testing and Inspection P0453
For diagnosis of code P0453, refer to chart:
P0453
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0450 - P0454,
( P0451 P0452 P0453 0450 0451 0452 0453 0454 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0451 > Page 306
P0450 - P0454: Testing and Inspection P0454
For diagnosis of code P0454, refer to chart:
P0454
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0455 - P0459,
( P0456 P0457 P0458 0455 0456 0457 0458 0459 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0455
P0455 - P0459: Testing and Inspection P0455
For diagnosis of code P0455, refer to chart:
P0455
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0455 - P0459,
( P0456 P0457 P0458 0455 0456 0457 0458 0459 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0455 > Page 311
P0455 - P0459: Testing and Inspection P0456
For diagnosis of code P0456, refer to chart:
P0456
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0455 - P0459,
( P0456 P0457 P0458 0455 0456 0457 0458 0459 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0455 > Page 312
P0455 - P0459: Testing and Inspection P0457
For diagnosis of code P0457, refer to chart:
P0457
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0460 - P0464,
( P0461 P0462 P0463 0460 0461 0462 0463 0464 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0460
P0460 - P0464: Testing and Inspection P0460
For diagnosis of code P0460, refer to chart:
P0460
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0460 - P0464,
( P0461 P0462 P0463 0460 0461 0462 0463 0464 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0460 > Page 317
P0460 - P0464: Testing and Inspection P0461
For diagnosis of code P0461, refer to chart:
P0461
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0460 - P0464,
( P0461 P0462 P0463 0460 0461 0462 0463 0464 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0460 > Page 318
P0460 - P0464: Testing and Inspection P0462
For diagnosis of code P0462, refer to chart:
P0462
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0460 - P0464,
( P0461 P0462 P0463 0460 0461 0462 0463 0464 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0460 > Page 319
P0460 - P0464: Testing and Inspection P0463
For diagnosis of code P0463, refer to chart:
P0463
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0480 - P0484,
( P0481 P0482 P0483 0480 0481 0482 0483 0484 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0480
P0480 - P0484: Testing and Inspection P0480
For diagnosis of code P0480, refer to chart:
P0480 (Part 1)
P0480 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0480 - P0484,
( P0481 P0482 P0483 0480 0481 0482 0483 0484 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0480 > Page 324
P0480 - P0484: Testing and Inspection P0481
For diagnosis of code P0481, refer to chart:
P0481
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0480 - P0484,
( P0481 P0482 P0483 0480 0481 0482 0483 0484 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0480 > Page 325
P0480 - P0484: Testing and Inspection P0482
For diagnosis of code P0482, refer to chart:
P0482
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0480 - P0484,
( P0481 P0482 P0483 0480 0481 0482 0483 0484 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0480 > Page 326
P0480 - P0484: Testing and Inspection P0483
For diagnosis of code P0483, refer to chart:
P0483
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0400-P04ZZ > P0490 - P0494,
( P0491 P0492 P0493 0490 0491 0492 0493 0494 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0490 - P0494: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0491, refer to chart:
P0491
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0500 - P0504,
( P0501 P0502 P0503 0500 0501 0502 0503 0504 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0500
P0500 - P0504: Testing and Inspection P0500
For diagnosis of code P0500, refer to chart:
P0500 (Part 1)
P0500 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0500 - P0504,
( P0501 P0502 P0503 0500 0501 0502 0503 0504 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0500 > Page 335
P0500 - P0504: Testing and Inspection P0503
For diagnosis of code P0503, refer to chart:
P0503
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0505 - P0509,
( P0506 P0507 P0508 0505 0506 0507 0508 0509 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0505
P0505 - P0509: Testing and Inspection P0505
For diagnosis of code P0505, refer to chart:
P0505
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0505 - P0509,
( P0506 P0507 P0508 0505 0506 0507 0508 0509 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0505 > Page 340
P0505 - P0509: Testing and Inspection P0506
For diagnosis of code P0506, refer to chart:
P0506 (Part 1)
P0506 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0505 - P0509,
( P0506 P0507 P0508 0505 0506 0507 0508 0509 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0505 > Page 341
P0505 - P0509: Testing and Inspection P0507
For diagnosis of code P0507, refer to chart:
P0507
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P050A - P050E,
( P050B P050C P050D 050A 050B 050C 050D 050E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P050A
P050A - P050E: Testing and Inspection P050A
For diagnosis of code P050A, refer to chart:
P050A
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P050A - P050E,
( P050B P050C P050D 050A 050B 050C 050D 050E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P050A > Page 346
P050A - P050E: Testing and Inspection P050B
For diagnosis of code P050B, refer to chart:
P050B
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0510 - P0514,
( P0511 P0512 P0513 0510 0511 0512 0513 0514 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0510 - P0514: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0511, refer to chart:
P0511
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0525 - P0529,
( P0526 P0527 P0528 0525 0526 0527 0528 0529 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0525 - P0529: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0528, refer to chart:
P0528
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0530 - P0534,
( P0531 P0532 P0533 0530 0531 0532 0533 0534 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0532
P0530 - P0534: Testing and Inspection P0532
For diagnosis of code P0532, refer to chart:
P0532
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0530 - P0534,
( P0531 P0532 P0533 0530 0531 0532 0533 0534 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0532 > Page 357
P0530 - P0534: Testing and Inspection P0533
For diagnosis of code P0533, refer to chart:
P0533
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0530 - P0534,
( P0531 P0532 P0533 0530 0531 0532 0533 0534 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0532 > Page 358
P0530 - P0534: Testing and Inspection P0534
For diagnosis of code P0534, refer to chart:
P0534 (Part 1)
P0534 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0535 - P0539,
( P0536 P0537 P0538 0535 0536 0537 0538 0539 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0537
P0535 - P0539: Testing and Inspection P0537
For diagnosis of code P0537, refer to chart:
P0537
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0535 - P0539,
( P0536 P0537 P0538 0535 0536 0537 0538 0539 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0537 > Page 363
P0535 - P0539: Testing and Inspection P0538
For diagnosis of code P0538, refer to chart:
P0538
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0550 - P0554,
( P0551 P0552 P0553 0550 0551 0552 0553 0554 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0552
P0550 - P0554: Testing and Inspection P0552
For diagnosis of code P0552, refer to chart:
P0552
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0550 - P0554,
( P0551 P0552 P0553 0550 0551 0552 0553 0554 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0552 > Page 368
P0550 - P0554: Testing and Inspection P0553
For diagnosis of code P0553, refer to chart:
P0553
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0575 - P0579,
( P0576 P0577 P0578 0575 0576 0577 0578 0579 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0575 - P0579: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0579, refer to chart:
P0579
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0500-P05ZZ > P0580 - P0584,
( P0581 P0582 P0583 0580 0581 0582 0583 0584 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0580 - P0584: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0581, refer to chart:
P0581
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0600 - P0604,
( P0601 P0602 P0603 0600 0601 0602 0603 0604 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0600
P0600 - P0604: Testing and Inspection P0600
For diagnosis of code P0600, refer to chart:
P0600
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0600 - P0604,
( P0601 P0602 P0603 0600 0601 0602 0603 0604 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0600 > Page 380
P0600 - P0604: Testing and Inspection P0602
For diagnosis of code P0602, refer to chart:
P0602
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0600 - P0604,
( P0601 P0602 P0603 0600 0601 0602 0603 0604 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0600 > Page 381
P0600 - P0604: Testing and Inspection P0603
For diagnosis of code P0603, refer to chart:
P0603
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0600 - P0604,
( P0601 P0602 P0603 0600 0601 0602 0603 0604 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0600 > Page 382
P0600 - P0604: Testing and Inspection P0604
For diagnosis of code P0604, refer to chart:
P0604
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0605 - P0609,
( P0606 P0607 P0608 0605 0606 0607 0608 0609 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0605
P0605 - P0609: Testing and Inspection P0605
For diagnosis of code P0605, refer to chart:
P0605
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0605 - P0609,
( P0606 P0607 P0608 0605 0606 0607 0608 0609 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0605 > Page 387
P0605 - P0609: Testing and Inspection P0606
For diagnosis of code P0606, refer to chart:
P0606 (Part 1)
P0606 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0605 - P0609,
( P0606 P0607 P0608 0605 0606 0607 0608 0609 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0605 > Page 388
P0605 - P0609: Testing and Inspection P0607
For diagnosis of code P0607, refer to chart:
P0607
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P060A - P060E,
( P060B P060C P060D 060A 060B 060C 060D 060E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P060A
P060A - P060E: Testing and Inspection P060A
For diagnosis of code P060A, refer to chart:
P060A
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P060A - P060E,
( P060B P060C P060D 060A 060B 060C 060D 060E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P060A > Page 393
P060A - P060E: Testing and Inspection P060B
For diagnosis of code P060B, refer to chart:
P060B
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P060A - P060E,
( P060B P060C P060D 060A 060B 060C 060D 060E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P060A > Page 394
P060A - P060E: Testing and Inspection P060C
For diagnosis of code P060C, refer to chart:
P060C (Part 1)
P060C (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0610 - P0614,
( P0611 P0612 P0613 0610 0611 0612 0613 0614 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0610 - P0614: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0611, refer to chart:
P0611
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P061A - P061E,
( P061B P061C P061D 061A 061B 061C 061D 061E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P061B
P061A - P061E: Testing and Inspection P061B
For diagnosis of code P061B, refer to chart:
P061B
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P061A - P061E,
( P061B P061C P061D 061A 061B 061C 061D 061E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P061B > Page 402
P061A - P061E: Testing and Inspection P061C
For diagnosis of code P061C, refer to chart:
P061C
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P061A - P061E,
( P061B P061C P061D 061A 061B 061C 061D 061E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P061B > Page 403
P061A - P061E: Testing and Inspection P061D
For diagnosis of code P061D, refer to chart:
P061D
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P061F - P061J,
( P061G P061H P061I 061F 061G 061H 061I 061J ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P061F - P061J: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P061F, refer to chart:
P061F
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0620 - P0624,
( P0621 P0622 P0623 0620 0621 0622 0623 0624 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0620
P0620 - P0624: Testing and Inspection P0620
For diagnosis of code P0620, refer to chart:
P0620
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0620 - P0624,
( P0621 P0622 P0623 0620 0621 0622 0623 0624 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0620 > Page 411
P0620 - P0624: Testing and Inspection P0622
For diagnosis of code P0622, refer to chart:
P0622
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0625 - P0629,
( P0626 P0627 P0628 0625 0626 0627 0628 0629 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0625
P0625 - P0629: Testing and Inspection P0625
For diagnosis of code P0625, refer to chart:
P0625
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0625 - P0629,
( P0626 P0627 P0628 0625 0626 0627 0628 0629 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0625 > Page 416
P0625 - P0629: Testing and Inspection P0626
For diagnosis of code P0626, refer to chart:
P0626
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P062A - P062E,
( P062B P062C P062D 062A 062B 062C 062D 062E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P062A - P062E: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P062C, refer to chart:
P062C
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0645 - P0649,
( P0646 P0647 P0648 0645 0646 0647 0648 0649 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0645 - P0649: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0645, refer to chart:
P0645
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0655 - P0659,
( P0656 P0657 P0658 0655 0656 0657 0658 0659 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0655 - P0659: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0657, refer to chart:
P0657
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0660 - P0664,
( P0661 P0662 P0663 0660 0661 0662 0663 0664 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0660 - P0664: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0660, refer to chart:
P0660
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0685 - P0689,
( P0686 P0687 P0688 0685 0686 0687 0688 0689 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0685
P0685 - P0689: Testing and Inspection P0685
For diagnosis of code P0685, refer to chart:
P0685 (Part 1)
P0685 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0685 - P0689,
( P0686 P0687 P0688 0685 0686 0687 0688 0689 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0685 > Page 433
P0685 - P0689: Testing and Inspection P0689
For diagnosis of code P0689, refer to chart:
P0689
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0600-P06ZZ > P0690 - P0694,
( P0691 P0692 P0693 0690 0691 0692 0693 0694 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0690 - P0694: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0690, refer to chart:
P0690
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0700 - P0704,
( P0701 P0702 P0703 0700 0701 0702 0703 0704 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0703
P0700 - P0704: Testing and Inspection P0703
For diagnosis of code P0703, refer to chart:
P0703 (Part 1)
P0703 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0700 - P0704,
( P0701 P0702 P0703 0700 0701 0702 0703 0704 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0703 > Page 442
P0700 - P0704: Testing and Inspection P0704
For diagnosis of code P0704, refer to chart:
P0704
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0705 - P0709,
( P0706 P0707 P0708 0705 0706 0707 0708 0709 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0705
P0705 - P0709: Testing and Inspection P0705
For diagnosis of code P0705, refer to chart:
P0705
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0705 - P0709,
( P0706 P0707 P0708 0705 0706 0707 0708 0709 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0705 > Page 447
P0705 - P0709: Testing and Inspection P0707
For diagnosis of code P0707, refer to chart:
P0707
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0705 - P0709,
( P0706 P0707 P0708 0705 0706 0707 0708 0709 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0705 > Page 448
P0705 - P0709: Testing and Inspection P0708
For diagnosis of code P0708, refer to chart:
P0708
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0710 - P0714,
( P0711 P0712 P0713 0710 0711 0712 0713 0714 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0710 - P0714: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P071X, refer to chart:
P071x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0720 - P0724,
( P0721 P0722 P0723 0720 0721 0722 0723 0724 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0720
P0720 - P0724: Testing and Inspection P0720
For diagnosis of code P0720, refer to chart:
P0720
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0720 - P0724,
( P0721 P0722 P0723 0720 0721 0722 0723 0724 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0720 > Page 456
P0720 - P0724: Testing and Inspection P0721
For diagnosis of code P0721, refer to chart:
P0721
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0720 - P0724,
( P0721 P0722 P0723 0720 0721 0722 0723 0724 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0720 > Page 457
P0720 - P0724: Testing and Inspection P0722
For diagnosis of code P0722, refer to chart:
P0722
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0720 - P0724,
( P0721 P0722 P0723 0720 0721 0722 0723 0724 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0720 > Page 458
P0720 - P0724: Testing and Inspection P0723
For diagnosis of code P0723, refer to chart:
P0723
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0730 - P0734,
( P0731 P0732 P0733 0730 0731 0732 0733 0734 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0730 - P0734: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P073X, refer to chart:
P073x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0740 - P0744,
( P0741 P0742 P0743 0740 0741 0742 0743 0744 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0740 - P0744: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P074X, refer to chart:
P074x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0750 - P0754,
( P0751 P0752 P0753 0750 0751 0752 0753 0754 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0750 - P0754: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P075X, refer to chart:
P075x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0760 - P0764,
( P0761 P0762 P0763 0760 0761 0762 0763 0764 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0760 - P0764: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P076X, refer to chart:
P076x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0770 - P0774,
( P0771 P0772 P0773 0770 0771 0772 0773 0774 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0770 - P0774: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P077X, refer to chart:
P077x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0780 - P0784,
( P0781 P0782 P0783 0780 0781 0782 0783 0784 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0780 - P0784: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P078X, refer to chart:
P078x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0700-P07ZZ > P0790 - P0794,
( P0791 P0792 P0793 0790 0791 0792 0793 0794 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0790 - P0794: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P079X, refer to chart:
P079x
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0800-P08ZZ > P0815 - P0819,
( P0816 P0817 P0818 0815 0816 0817 0818 0819 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0815 - P0819: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0815, refer to chart:
P0815
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0800-P08ZZ > P0830 - P0834,
( P0831 P0832 P0833 0830 0831 0832 0833 0834 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0830
P0830 - P0834: Testing and Inspection P0830
For diagnosis of code P0830, refer to chart:
P0830
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0800-P08ZZ > P0830 - P0834,
( P0831 P0832 P0833 0830 0831 0832 0833 0834 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P0830 > Page 488
P0830 - P0834: Testing and Inspection P0833
For diagnosis of code P0833, refer to chart:
P0833
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0800-P08ZZ > P0840 - P0844,
( P0841 P0842 P0843 0840 0841 0842 0843 0844 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0840 - P0844: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P0840, refer to chart:
P0840
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P0900-P09ZZ > P0900 - P0904,
( P0901 P0902 P0903 0900 0901 0902 0903 0904 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P0900 - P0904: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P09XX, refer to chart:
P09xx
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1000-P10ZZ > P1000 - P1004,
( P1001 P1002 P1003 1000 1001 1002 1003 1004 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1000
P1000 - P1004: Testing and Inspection P1000
For diagnosis of code P1000, refer to chart:
P1000
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1000-P10ZZ > P1000 - P1004,
( P1001 P1002 P1003 1000 1001 1002 1003 1004 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1000 > Page 501
P1000 - P1004: Testing and Inspection P1001
For diagnosis of code P1001, refer to chart:
P1001
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1100 - P1104,
( P1101 P1102 P1103 1100 1101 1102 1103 1104 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1100
P1100 - P1104: Testing and Inspection P1100
For diagnosis of code P1100, refer to chart:
P1100
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1100 - P1104,
( P1101 P1102 P1103 1100 1101 1102 1103 1104 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1100 > Page 507
P1100 - P1104: Testing and Inspection P1101
For diagnosis of code P1101, refer to chart:
P1101
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1110 - P1114,
( P1111 P1112 P1113 1110 1111 1112 1113 1114 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1112
P1110 - P1114: Testing and Inspection P1112
For diagnosis of code P1112, refer to chart:
P1112
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1110 - P1114,
( P1111 P1112 P1113 1110 1111 1112 1113 1114 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1112 > Page 512
P1110 - P1114: Testing and Inspection P1114
For diagnosis of code P1114, refer to chart:
P1114 (Part 1)
P1114 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1115 - P1119,
( P1116 P1117 P1118 1115 1116 1117 1118 1119 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1115
P1115 - P1119: Testing and Inspection P1115
For diagnosis of code P1115, refer to chart:
P1115
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1115 - P1119,
( P1116 P1117 P1118 1115 1116 1117 1118 1119 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1115 > Page 517
P1115 - P1119: Testing and Inspection P1116
For diagnosis of code P1116, refer to chart:
P1116
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1115 - P1119,
( P1116 P1117 P1118 1115 1116 1117 1118 1119 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1115 > Page 518
P1115 - P1119: Testing and Inspection P1117
For diagnosis of code P1117, refer to chart:
P1117
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1120 - P1124,
( P1121 P1122 P1123 1120 1121 1122 1123 1124 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1120
P1120 - P1124: Testing and Inspection P1120
For diagnosis of code P1120, refer to chart:
P1120
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1120 - P1124,
( P1121 P1122 P1123 1120 1121 1122 1123 1124 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1120 > Page 523
P1120 - P1124: Testing and Inspection P1124
For diagnosis of code P1124, refer to chart:
P1124
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1125 - P1129,
( P1126 P1127 P1128 1125 1126 1127 1128 1129 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1125
P1125 - P1129: Testing and Inspection P1125
For diagnosis of code P1125, refer to chart:
P1125
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1125 - P1129,
( P1126 P1127 P1128 1125 1126 1127 1128 1129 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1125 > Page 528
P1125 - P1129: Testing and Inspection P1127
For diagnosis of code P1127, refer to chart:
P1127
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1155 - P1159,
( P1156 P1157 P1158 1155 1156 1157 1158 1159 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1155 - P1159: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1156, refer to chart:
P1156
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P117A - P117E,
( P117B P117C P117D 117A 117B 117C 117D 117E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P117A - P117E: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P117A, refer to chart:
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1100-P11ZZ > P1180 - P1184,
( P1181 P1182 P1183 1180 1181 1182 1183 1184 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1180 - P1184: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1184, refer to chart:
P1184
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1225 - P1229,
( P1226 P1227 P1228 1225 1226 1227 1228 1229 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1225 - P1229: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1229, refer to chart:
P1229
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1230 - P1234,
( P1231 P1232 P1233 1230 1231 1232 1233 1234 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1233
P1230 - P1234: Testing and Inspection P1233
For diagnosis of code P1233, refer to chart:
P1233
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1230 - P1234,
( P1231 P1232 P1233 1230 1231 1232 1233 1234 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1233 > Page 546
P1230 - P1234: Testing and Inspection P1234
For diagnosis of code P1234, refer to chart:
P1234
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1235 - P1239,
( P1236 P1237 P1238 1235 1236 1237 1238 1239 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1235
P1235 - P1239: Testing and Inspection P1235
For diagnosis of code P1235, refer to chart:
P1235
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1235 - P1239,
( P1236 P1237 P1238 1235 1236 1237 1238 1239 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1235 > Page 551
P1235 - P1239: Testing and Inspection P1236
For diagnosis of code P1236, refer to chart:
P1236
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1235 - P1239,
( P1236 P1237 P1238 1235 1236 1237 1238 1239 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1235 > Page 552
P1235 - P1239: Testing and Inspection P1237
For diagnosis of code P1237, refer to chart:
P1237 (Part 1)
P1237 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1235 - P1239,
( P1236 P1237 P1238 1235 1236 1237 1238 1239 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1235 > Page 553
P1235 - P1239: Testing and Inspection P1238
For diagnosis of code P1238, refer to chart:
P1238
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1240 - P1244,
( P1241 P1242 P1243 1240 1241 1242 1243 1244 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1240 - P1244: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1244, refer to chart:
P1244
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1245 - P1249,
( P1246 P1247 P1248 1245 1246 1247 1248 1249 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1245
P1245 - P1249: Testing and Inspection P1245
For diagnosis of code P1245, refer to chart:
P1245
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1245 - P1249,
( P1246 P1247 P1248 1245 1246 1247 1248 1249 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1245 > Page 561
P1245 - P1249: Testing and Inspection P1246
For diagnosis of code P1246, refer to chart:
P1246
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1260 - P1264,
( P1261 P1262 P1263 1260 1261 1262 1263 1264 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1260
P1260 - P1264: Testing and Inspection P1260
For diagnosis of code P1260, refer to chart:
P1260
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1260 - P1264,
( P1261 P1262 P1263 1260 1261 1262 1263 1264 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1260 > Page 566
P1260 - P1264: Testing and Inspection P1261
For diagnosis of code P1261, refer to chart:
P1261
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1260 - P1264,
( P1261 P1262 P1263 1260 1261 1262 1263 1264 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1260 > Page 567
P1260 - P1264: Testing and Inspection P1262
For diagnosis of code P1262, refer to chart:
P1262
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1260 - P1264,
( P1261 P1262 P1263 1260 1261 1262 1263 1264 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1260 > Page 568
P1260 - P1264: Testing and Inspection P1263
For diagnosis of code P1263, refer to chart:
P1263
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1260 - P1264,
( P1261 P1262 P1263 1260 1261 1262 1263 1264 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1260 > Page 569
P1260 - P1264: Testing and Inspection P1264
For diagnosis of code P1264, refer to chart:
P1264
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1265 - P1269,
( P1266 P1267 P1268 1265 1266 1267 1268 1269 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1265
P1265 - P1269: Testing and Inspection P1265
For diagnosis of code P1265, refer to chart:
P1265
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1265 - P1269,
( P1266 P1267 P1268 1265 1266 1267 1268 1269 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1265 > Page 574
P1265 - P1269: Testing and Inspection P1266
For diagnosis of code P1266, refer to chart:
P1266 (Part 1)
P1266 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1265 - P1269,
( P1266 P1267 P1268 1265 1266 1267 1268 1269 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1265 > Page 575
P1265 - P1269: Testing and Inspection P1267
For diagnosis of code P1267, refer to chart:
P1267
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1265 - P1269,
( P1266 P1267 P1268 1265 1266 1267 1268 1269 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1265 > Page 576
P1265 - P1269: Testing and Inspection P1268
For diagnosis of code P1268, refer to chart:
P1268
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1270 - P1274,
( P1271 P1272 P1273 1270 1271 1272 1273 1274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1270
P1270 - P1274: Testing and Inspection P1270
For diagnosis of code P1270, refer to chart:
P1270
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1270 - P1274,
( P1271 P1272 P1273 1270 1271 1272 1273 1274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1270 > Page 581
P1270 - P1274: Testing and Inspection P1271
For diagnosis of code P1271, refer to chart:
P1271
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1270 - P1274,
( P1271 P1272 P1273 1270 1271 1272 1273 1274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1270 > Page 582
P1270 - P1274: Testing and Inspection P1272
For diagnosis of code P1272, refer to chart:
P1272
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1270 - P1274,
( P1271 P1272 P1273 1270 1271 1272 1273 1274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1270 > Page 583
P1270 - P1274: Testing and Inspection P1273
For diagnosis of code P1273, refer to chart:
P1273
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1270 - P1274,
( P1271 P1272 P1273 1270 1271 1272 1273 1274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1270 > Page 584
P1270 - P1274: Testing and Inspection P1274
For diagnosis of code P1274, refer to chart:
P1274
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1275 - P1279,
( P1276 P1277 P1278 1275 1276 1277 1278 1279 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1275
P1275 - P1279: Testing and Inspection P1275
For diagnosis of code P1275, refer to chart:
P1275
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1275 - P1279,
( P1276 P1277 P1278 1275 1276 1277 1278 1279 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1275 > Page 589
P1275 - P1279: Testing and Inspection P1276
For diagnosis of code P1276, refer to chart:
P1276
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1275 - P1279,
( P1276 P1277 P1278 1275 1276 1277 1278 1279 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1275 > Page 590
P1275 - P1279: Testing and Inspection P1277
For diagnosis of code P1277, refer to chart:
P1277
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1275 - P1279,
( P1276 P1277 P1278 1275 1276 1277 1278 1279 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1275 > Page 591
P1275 - P1279: Testing and Inspection P1278
For diagnosis of code P1278, refer to chart:
P1278
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1285 - P1289,
( P1286 P1287 P1288 1285 1286 1287 1288 1289 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1285
P1285 - P1289: Testing and Inspection P1285
For diagnosis of code P1285, refer to chart:
P1285
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link:See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1285 - P1289,
( P1286 P1287 P1288 1285 1286 1287 1288 1289 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1285 > Page 596
P1285 - P1289: Testing and Inspection P1288
For diagnosis of code P1288, refer to chart:
P1288
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1285 - P1289,
( P1286 P1287 P1288 1285 1286 1287 1288 1289 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1285 > Page 597
P1285 - P1289: Testing and Inspection P1289
For diagnosis of code P1289, refer to chart:
P1289
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P128A - P128E,
( P128B P128C P128D 128A 128B 128C 128D 128E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P128A - P128E: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P128A, refer to chart:
P128A
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1290 - P1294,
( P1291 P1292 P1293 1290 1291 1292 1293 1294 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1290 - P1294: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1290, refer to chart:
P1290
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1200-P12ZZ > P1295 - P1299,
( P1296 P1297 P1298 1295 1296 1297 1298 1299 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1295 - P1299: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1299, refer to chart:
P1299
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1300-P13ZZ > P1305 - P1309,
( P1306 P1307 P1308 1305 1306 1307 1308 1309 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1305 - P1309: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1309, refer to chart:
P1309
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1300-P13ZZ > P1335 - P1339,
( P1336 P1337 P1338 1335 1336 1337 1338 1339 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1335 - P1339: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1336, refer to chart:
P1336
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1300-P13ZZ > P1395 - P1399,
( P1396 P1397 P1398 1395 1396 1397 1398 1399 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1395 - P1399: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1397, refer to chart:
P1397
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1405 - P1409,
( P1406 P1407 P1408 1405 1406 1407 1408 1409 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1405
P1405 - P1409: Testing and Inspection P1405
For diagnosis of code P1405, refer to chart:
P1405
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1405 - P1409,
( P1406 P1407 P1408 1405 1406 1407 1408 1409 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1405 > Page 622
P1405 - P1409: Testing and Inspection P1406
For diagnosis of code P1406, refer to chart:
P1406 (Part 1)
P1406 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link:See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1405 - P1409,
( P1406 P1407 P1408 1405 1406 1407 1408 1409 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1405 > Page 623
P1405 - P1409: Testing and Inspection P1408
For diagnosis of code P1408, refer to chart:
P1408
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1405 - P1409,
( P1406 P1407 P1408 1405 1406 1407 1408 1409 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1405 > Page 624
P1405 - P1409: Testing and Inspection P1409
For diagnosis of code P1409, refer to chart:
P1409
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1435 - P1439,
( P1436 P1437 P1438 1435 1436 1437 1438 1439 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1436
P1435 - P1439: Testing and Inspection P1436
For diagnosis of code P1436, refer to chart:
P1436 (Part 1)
P1436 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1435 - P1439,
( P1436 P1437 P1438 1435 1436 1437 1438 1439 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1436 > Page 629
P1435 - P1439: Testing and Inspection P1437
For diagnosis of code P1437, refer to chart:
P1437
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1440 - P1444,
( P1441 P1442 P1443 1440 1441 1442 1443 1444 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1440 - P1444: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1443, refer to chart:
P1443
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1450 - P1454,
( P1451 P1452 P1453 1450 1451 1452 1453 1454 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1450
P1450 - P1454: Testing and Inspection P1450
For diagnosis of code P1450, refer to chart:
P1450
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1450 - P1454,
( P1451 P1452 P1453 1450 1451 1452 1453 1454 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1450 > Page 637
P1450 - P1454: Testing and Inspection P1451
For diagnosis of code P1451, refer to chart:
P1451
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1460 - P1464,
( P1461 P1462 P1463 1460 1461 1462 1463 1464 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1460
P1460 - P1464: Testing and Inspection P1460
For diagnosis of code P1460, refer to chart:
P1460 (Part 1)
P1460 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1460 - P1464,
( P1461 P1462 P1463 1460 1461 1462 1463 1464 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1460 > Page 642
P1460 - P1464: Testing and Inspection P1461
For diagnosis of code P1461, refer to chart:
P1461
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1460 - P1464,
( P1461 P1462 P1463 1460 1461 1462 1463 1464 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1460 > Page 643
P1460 - P1464: Testing and Inspection P1462
For diagnosis of code P1462, refer to chart:
P1462
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1460 - P1464,
( P1461 P1462 P1463 1460 1461 1462 1463 1464 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1460 > Page 644
P1460 - P1464: Testing and Inspection P1463
For diagnosis of code P1463, refer to chart:
P1463
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1460 - P1464,
( P1461 P1462 P1463 1460 1461 1462 1463 1464 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1460 > Page 645
P1460 - P1464: Testing and Inspection P1464
For diagnosis of code P1464, refer to chart:
P1464
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1465 - P1469,
( P1466 P1467 P1468 1465 1466 1467 1468 1469 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1465 - P1469: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1469, refer to chart:
P1469
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1470 - P1474,
( P1471 P1472 P1473 1470 1471 1472 1473 1474 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1470 - P1474: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1474, refer to chart:
P1474
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1475 - P1479,
( P1476 P1477 P1478 1475 1476 1477 1478 1479 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1477
P1475 - P1479: Testing and Inspection P1477
For diagnosis of code P1477, refer to chart:
P1477
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1475 - P1479,
( P1476 P1477 P1478 1475 1476 1477 1478 1479 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1477 > Page 656
P1475 - P1479: Testing and Inspection P1479
For diagnosis of code P1479, refer to chart:
P1479
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1400-P14ZZ > P1485 - P1489,
( P1486 P1487 P1488 1485 1486 1487 1488 1489 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1485 - P1489: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1489, refer to chart:
P1489
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1500 - P1504,
( P1501 P1502 P1503 1500 1501 1502 1503 1504 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1500
P1500 - P1504: Testing and Inspection P1500
For diagnosis of code P1500, refer to chart:
P1500
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1500 - P1504,
( P1501 P1502 P1503 1500 1501 1502 1503 1504 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1500 > Page 665
P1500 - P1504: Testing and Inspection P1501
For diagnosis of code P1501, refer to chart:
P1501
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1500 - P1504,
( P1501 P1502 P1503 1500 1501 1502 1503 1504 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1500 > Page 666
P1500 - P1504: Testing and Inspection P1502
For diagnosis of code P1502, refer to chart:
P1502
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1500 - P1504,
( P1501 P1502 P1503 1500 1501 1502 1503 1504 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1500 > Page 667
P1500 - P1504: Testing and Inspection P1504
For diagnosis of code P1504, refer to chart:
P1504
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1505 - P1509,
( P1506 P1507 P1508 1505 1506 1507 1508 1509 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1506
P1505 - P1509: Testing and Inspection P1506
For diagnosis of code P1506, refer to chart:
P1506
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1505 - P1509,
( P1506 P1507 P1508 1505 1506 1507 1508 1509 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1506 > Page 672
P1505 - P1509: Testing and Inspection P1507
For diagnosis of code P1507, refer to chart:
P1507
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1510 - P1514,
( P1511 P1512 P1513 1510 1511 1512 1513 1514 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1512
P1510 - P1514: Testing and Inspection P1512
For diagnosis of code P1512, refer to chart:
P1512
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1510 - P1514,
( P1511 P1512 P1513 1510 1511 1512 1513 1514 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1512 > Page 677
P1510 - P1514: Testing and Inspection P1513
For diagnosis of code P1513, refer to chart:
P1513
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1515 - P1519,
( P1516 P1517 P1518 1515 1516 1517 1518 1519 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1516
P1515 - P1519: Testing and Inspection P1516
For diagnosis of code P1516, refer to chart:
P1516
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1515 - P1519,
( P1516 P1517 P1518 1515 1516 1517 1518 1519 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1516 > Page 682
P1515 - P1519: Testing and Inspection P1517
For diagnosis of code P1517, refer to chart:
P1517
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1515 - P1519,
( P1516 P1517 P1518 1515 1516 1517 1518 1519 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1516 > Page 683
P1515 - P1519: Testing and Inspection P1518
For diagnosis of code P1518, refer to chart:
P1518
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1515 - P1519,
( P1516 P1517 P1518 1515 1516 1517 1518 1519 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1516 > Page 684
P1515 - P1519: Testing and Inspection P1519
For diagnosis of code P1519, refer to chart:
P1519
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P151A - P151E,
( P151B P151C P151D 151A 151B 151C 151D 151E ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P151A - P151E: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P151A, refer to chart:
P151A
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1520 - P1524,
( P1521 P1522 P1523 1520 1521 1522 1523 1524 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1520 - P1524: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1520, refer to chart:
P1520
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1535 - P1539,
( P1536 P1537 P1538 1535 1536 1537 1538 1539 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1537
P1535 - P1539: Testing and Inspection P1537
For diagnosis of code P1537, refer to chart:
P1537
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1535 - P1539,
( P1536 P1537 P1538 1535 1536 1537 1538 1539 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1537 > Page 695
P1535 - P1539: Testing and Inspection P1538
For diagnosis of code P1538, refer to chart:
P1538
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1545 - P1549,
( P1546 P1547 P1548 1545 1546 1547 1548 1549 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1545 - P1549: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1549, refer to chart:
P1549
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1550 - P1554,
( P1551 P1552 P1553 1550 1551 1552 1553 1554 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1550 - P1554: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1550, refer to chart:
P1550
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1565 - P1569,
( P1566 P1567 P1568 1565 1566 1567 1568 1569 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1565
P1565 - P1569: Testing and Inspection P1565
For diagnosis of code P1565, refer to chart:
P1565
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1565 - P1569,
( P1566 P1567 P1568 1565 1566 1567 1568 1569 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1565 > Page 706
P1565 - P1569: Testing and Inspection P1566
For diagnosis of code P1566, refer to chart:
P1566
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1565 - P1569,
( P1566 P1567 P1568 1565 1566 1567 1568 1569 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1565 > Page 707
P1565 - P1569: Testing and Inspection P1567
For diagnosis of code P1567, refer to chart:
P1567
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1565 - P1569,
( P1566 P1567 P1568 1565 1566 1567 1568 1569 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1565 > Page 708
P1565 - P1569: Testing and Inspection P1568
For diagnosis of code P1568, refer to chart:
P1568
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1570 - P1574,
( P1571 P1572 P1573 1570 1571 1572 1573 1574 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1570 - P1574: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1572, refer to chart:
P1572
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1500-P15ZZ > P1580 - P1584,
( P1581 P1582 P1583 1580 1581 1582 1583 1584 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1580 - P1584: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1582, refer to chart:
P1582
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1600-P16ZZ > P1630 - P1634,
( P1631 P1632 P1633 1630 1631 1632 1633 1634 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1630 - P1634: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1633, refer to chart:
P1633
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1600-P16ZZ > P1635 - P1639,
( P1636 P1637 P1638 1635 1636 1637 1638 1639 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1635
P1635 - P1639: Testing and Inspection P1635
For diagnosis of code P1635, refer to chart:
P1635
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1600-P16ZZ > P1635 - P1639,
( P1636 P1637 P1638 1635 1636 1637 1638 1639 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1635 > Page 723
P1635 - P1639: Testing and Inspection P1636
For diagnosis of code P1636, refer to chart:
P1636
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1600-P16ZZ > P1635 - P1639,
( P1636 P1637 P1638 1635 1636 1637 1638 1639 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1635 > Page 724
P1635 - P1639: Testing and Inspection P1639
For diagnosis of code P1639, refer to chart:
P1639
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1600-P16ZZ > P1640 - P1644,
( P1641 P1642 P1643 1640 1641 1642 1643 1644 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1640
P1640 - P1644: Testing and Inspection P1640
For diagnosis of code P1640, refer to chart:
P1640
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1600-P16ZZ > P1640 - P1644,
( P1641 P1642 P1643 1640 1641 1642 1643 1644 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1640 > Page 729
P1640 - P1644: Testing and Inspection P1641
For diagnosis of code P1641, refer to chart:
P1641
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1600-P16ZZ > P1650 - P1654,
( P1651 P1652 P1653 1650 1651 1652 1653 1654 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1650
P1650 - P1654: Testing and Inspection P1650
For diagnosis of code P1650, refer to chart:
P1650
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1600-P16ZZ > P1650 - P1654,
( P1651 P1652 P1653 1650 1651 1652 1653 1654 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1650 > Page 734
P1650 - P1654: Testing and Inspection P1651
For diagnosis of code P1651, refer to chart:
P1651
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1600-P16ZZ > P1670 - P1674,
( P1671 P1672 P1673 1670 1671 1672 1673 1674 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1670 - P1674: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1674, refer to chart:
P1674
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1700-P17ZZ > P1700 - P1704,
( P1701 P1702 P1703 1700 1701 1702 1703 1704 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P17xx
P1700 - P1704: Testing and Inspection P17xx
For diagnosis of code P17XX, refer to chart:
P17xx
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1700-P17ZZ > P1700 - P1704,
( P1701 P1702 P1703 1700 1701 1702 1703 1704 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P17xx > Page 743
P1700 - P1704: Testing and Inspection P1703
For diagnosis of code P1703, refer to chart:
P1703 (Part 1)
P1703 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1700-P17ZZ > P1705 - P1709,
( P1706 P1707 P1708 1705 1706 1707 1708 1709 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1705
P1705 - P1709: Testing and Inspection P1705
For diagnosis of code P1705, refer to chart:
P1705
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1700-P17ZZ > P1705 - P1709,
( P1706 P1707 P1708 1705 1706 1707 1708 1709 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1705 > Page 748
P1705 - P1709: Testing and Inspection P1709
For diagnosis of code P1709, refer to chart:
P1709
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1700-P17ZZ > P1725 - P1729,
( P1726 P1727 P1728 1725 1726 1727 1728 1729 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1725 - P1729: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1729, refer to chart:
P1729
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1700-P17ZZ > P1780 - P1784,
( P1781 P1782 P1783 1780 1781 1782 1783 1784 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1780
P1780 - P1784: Testing and Inspection P1780
For diagnosis of code P1780, refer to chart:
P1780
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1700-P17ZZ > P1780 - P1784,
( P1781 P1782 P1783 1780 1781 1782 1783 1784 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1780 > Page 756
P1780 - P1784: Testing and Inspection P1781
For diagnosis of code P1781, refer to chart:
P1781
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1800 - P1804,
( P1801 P1802 P1803 1800 1801 1802 1803 1804 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1800 - P1804: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P18XX, refer to chart:
P18xx
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1810 - P1814,
( P1811 P1812 P1813 1810 1811 1812 1813 1814 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1810 - P1814: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1812, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 1)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1815 - P1819,
( P1816 P1817 P1818 1815 1816 1817 1818 1819 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1815 - P1819: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1815, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 1)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1820 - P1824,
( P1821 P1822 P1823 1820 1821 1822 1823 1824 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1820
P1820 - P1824: Testing and Inspection P1820
For diagnosis of code P1820, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 1)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1820 - P1824,
( P1821 P1822 P1823 1820 1821 1822 1823 1824 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1820 > Page 771
P1820 - P1824: Testing and Inspection P1822
For diagnosis of code P1822, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 1)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1820 - P1824,
( P1821 P1822 P1823 1820 1821 1822 1823 1824 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1820 > Page 772
P1820 - P1824: Testing and Inspection P1824
For diagnosis of code P1824, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 1)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1825 - P1829,
( P1826 P1827 P1828 1825 1826 1827 1828 1829 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1826
P1825 - P1829: Testing and Inspection P1826
For diagnosis of code P1826, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1825 - P1829,
( P1826 P1827 P1828 1825 1826 1827 1828 1829 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1826 > Page 777
P1825 - P1829: Testing and Inspection P1827
For diagnosis of code P1827, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1825 - P1829,
( P1826 P1827 P1828 1825 1826 1827 1828 1829 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1826 > Page 778
P1825 - P1829: Testing and Inspection P1828
For diagnosis of code P1828, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1830 - P1834,
( P1831 P1832 P1833 1830 1831 1832 1833 1834 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1830 - P1834: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1830, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1845 - P1849,
( P1846 P1847 P1848 1845 1846 1847 1848 1849 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1845 - P1849: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1849, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1850 - P1854,
( P1851 P1852 P1853 1850 1851 1852 1853 1854 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1850 - P1854: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1853, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1855 - P1859,
( P1856 P1857 P1858 1855 1856 1857 1858 1859 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1855 - P1859: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1857, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1860 - P1864,
( P1861 P1862 P1863 1860 1861 1862 1863 1864 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1860 - P1864: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1861, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1865 - P1869,
( P1866 P1867 P1868 1865 1866 1867 1868 1869 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1865 - P1869: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1867, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1800-P18ZZ > P1890 - P1894,
( P1891 P1892 P1893 1890 1891 1892 1893 1894 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1890 - P1894: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1891, refer to chart:
4X4 Module (PCM) Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Index (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the Transfer Case system, follow this link: See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Transfer Case/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1900-P19ZZ > P1900 - P1904,
( P1901 P1902 P1903 1900 1901 1902 1903 1904 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1900
P1900 - P1904: Testing and Inspection P1900
For diagnosis of code P1900, refer to chart:
P1900
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1900-P19ZZ > P1900 - P1904,
( P1901 P1902 P1903 1900 1901 1902 1903 1904 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P1900 > Page 805
P1900 - P1904: Testing and Inspection P1901
For diagnosis of code P1901, refer to chart:
P1901
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P1900-P19ZZ > P1910 - P1914,
( P1911 P1912 P1913 1910 1911 1912 1913 1914 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P1910 - P1914: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P1910, refer to chart:
P1910
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2000 - P2004,
( P2001 P2002 P2003 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P2000 - P2004: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P2004, refer to chart:
P2004
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2005 - P2009,
( P2006 P2007 P2008 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2005
P2005 - P2009: Testing and Inspection P2005
For diagnosis of code P2005, refer to chart:
P2005
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2005 - P2009,
( P2006 P2007 P2008 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2005 > Page 817
P2005 - P2009: Testing and Inspection P2006
For diagnosis of code P2006, refer to chart:
P2006
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2005 - P2009,
( P2006 P2007 P2008 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2005 > Page 818
P2005 - P2009: Testing and Inspection P2007
For diagnosis of code P2007, refer to chart:
P2007
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2005 - P2009,
( P2006 P2007 P2008 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2005 > Page 819
P2005 - P2009: Testing and Inspection P2008
For diagnosis of code P2008, refer to chart:
P2008
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2010 - P2014,
( P2011 P2012 P2013 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P2010 - P2014: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P2014, refer to chart:
P2014
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2015 - P2019,
( P2016 P2017 P2018 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2015
P2015 - P2019: Testing and Inspection P2015
For diagnosis of code P2015, refer to chart:
P2015
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2015 - P2019,
( P2016 P2017 P2018 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2015 > Page 827
P2015 - P2019: Testing and Inspection P2019
For diagnosis of code P2019, refer to chart:
P2019
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2020 - P2024,
( P2021 P2022 P2023 2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P2020 - P2024: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P2020, refer to chart:
P2020
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2065 - P2069,
( P2066 P2067 P2068 2065 2066 2067 2068 2069 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2065
P2065 - P2069: Testing and Inspection P2065
For diagnosis of code P2065, refer to chart:
P2065
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2065 - P2069,
( P2066 P2067 P2068 2065 2066 2067 2068 2069 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2065 > Page 835
P2065 - P2069: Testing and Inspection P2066
For diagnosis of code P2066, refer to chart:
P2066
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2065 - P2069,
( P2066 P2067 P2068 2065 2066 2067 2068 2069 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2065 > Page 836
P2065 - P2069: Testing and Inspection P2067
For diagnosis of code P2067, refer to chart:
P2067 (Part 1)
P2067 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2065 - P2069,
( P2066 P2067 P2068 2065 2066 2067 2068 2069 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2065 > Page 837
P2065 - P2069: Testing and Inspection P2068
For diagnosis of code P2068, refer to chart:
P2068
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2070 - P2074,
( P2071 P2072 P2073 2070 2071 2072 2073 2074 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2070
P2070 - P2074: Testing and Inspection P2070
For diagnosis of code P2070, refer to chart:
P2070
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2070 - P2074,
( P2071 P2072 P2073 2070 2071 2072 2073 2074 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2070 > Page 842
P2070 - P2074: Testing and Inspection P2071
For diagnosis of code P2071, refer to chart:
P2071
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2000-P20ZZ > P2070 - P2074,
( P2071 P2072 P2073 2070 2071 2072 2073 2074 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2070 > Page 843
P2070 - P2074: Testing and Inspection P2072
For diagnosis of code P2072, refer to chart:
P2072 (Part 1)
P2072 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2100 - P2104,
( P2101 P2102 P2103 2100 2101 2102 2103 2104 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2100
P2100 - P2104: Testing and Inspection P2100
For diagnosis of code P2100, refer to chart:
P2100
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2100 - P2104,
( P2101 P2102 P2103 2100 2101 2102 2103 2104 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2100 > Page 849
P2100 - P2104: Testing and Inspection P2101
For diagnosis of code P2101, refer to chart:
P2101
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2100 - P2104,
( P2101 P2102 P2103 2100 2101 2102 2103 2104 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2100 > Page 850
P2100 - P2104: Testing and Inspection P2104
For diagnosis of code P2104, refer to chart:
P2104
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2105 - P2109,
( P2106 P2107 P2108 2105 2106 2107 2108 2109 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2105
P2105 - P2109: Testing and Inspection P2105
For diagnosis of code P2105, refer to chart:
P2105
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2105 - P2109,
( P2106 P2107 P2108 2105 2106 2107 2108 2109 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2105 > Page 855
P2105 - P2109: Testing and Inspection P2106
For diagnosis of code P2106, refer to chart:
P2106
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2105 - P2109,
( P2106 P2107 P2108 2105 2106 2107 2108 2109 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2105 > Page 856
P2105 - P2109: Testing and Inspection P2107
For diagnosis of code P2107, refer to chart:
P2107
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2110 - P2114,
( P2111 P2112 P2113 2110 2111 2112 2113 2114 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2110
P2110 - P2114: Testing and Inspection P2110
For diagnosis of code P2110, refer to chart:
P2110
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2110 - P2114,
( P2111 P2112 P2113 2110 2111 2112 2113 2114 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2110 > Page 861
P2110 - P2114: Testing and Inspection P2111
For diagnosis of code P2111, refer to chart:
P2111
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2110 - P2114,
( P2111 P2112 P2113 2110 2111 2112 2113 2114 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2110 > Page 862
P2110 - P2114: Testing and Inspection P2112
For diagnosis of code P2112, refer to chart:
P2112
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link:See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2120 - P2124,
( P2121 P2122 P2123 2120 2121 2122 2123 2124 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2121
P2120 - P2124: Testing and Inspection P2121
For diagnosis of code P2121, refer to chart:
P2121
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2120 - P2124,
( P2121 P2122 P2123 2120 2121 2122 2123 2124 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2121 > Page 867
P2120 - P2124: Testing and Inspection P2122
For diagnosis of code P2122, refer to chart:
P2122
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2120 - P2124,
( P2121 P2122 P2123 2120 2121 2122 2123 2124 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2121 > Page 868
P2120 - P2124: Testing and Inspection P2123
For diagnosis of code P2123, refer to chart:
P2123 (Part 1)
P2123 (Part 2)
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2125 - P2129,
( P2126 P2127 P2128 2125 2126 2127 2128 2129 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2126
P2125 - P2129: Testing and Inspection P2126
For diagnosis of code P2126, refer to chart:
P2126
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2125 - P2129,
( P2126 P2127 P2128 2125 2126 2127 2128 2129 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2126 > Page 873
P2125 - P2129: Testing and Inspection P2127
For diagnosis of code P2127, refer to chart:
P2127
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2125 - P2129,
( P2126 P2127 P2128 2125 2126 2127 2128 2129 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2126 > Page 874
P2125 - P2129: Testing and Inspection P2128
For diagnosis of code P2128, refer to chart:
P2128
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2130 - P2134,
( P2131 P2132 P2133 2130 2131 2132 2133 2134 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2131
P2130 - P2134: Testing and Inspection P2131
For diagnosis of code P2131, refer to chart:
P2131
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2130 - P2134,
( P2131 P2132 P2133 2130 2131 2132 2133 2134 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2131 > Page 879
P2130 - P2134: Testing and Inspection P2132
For diagnosis of code P2132, refer to chart:
P2132
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2130 - P2134,
( P2131 P2132 P2133 2130 2131 2132 2133 2134 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2131 > Page 880
P2130 - P2134: Testing and Inspection P2133
For diagnosis of code P2133, refer to chart:
P2133
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2135 - P2139,
( P2136 P2137 P2138 2135 2136 2137 2138 2139 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P2135 - P2139: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P2135, refer to chart:
P2135
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link:See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2195 - P2199,
( P2196 P2197 P2198 2195 2196 2197 2198 2199 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2195
P2195 - P2199: Testing and Inspection P2195
For diagnosis of code P2195, refer to chart:
P2195
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2195 - P2199,
( P2196 P2197 P2198 2195 2196 2197 2198 2199 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2195 > Page 888
P2195 - P2199: Testing and Inspection P2196
For diagnosis of code P2196, refer to chart:
P2196
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2195 - P2199,
( P2196 P2197 P2198 2195 2196 2197 2198 2199 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2195 > Page 889
P2195 - P2199: Testing and Inspection P2197
For diagnosis of code P2197, refer to chart:
P2197
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2100-P21ZZ > P2195 - P2199,
( P2196 P2197 P2198 2195 2196 2197 2198 2199 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2195 > Page 890
P2195 - P2199: Testing and Inspection P2198
For diagnosis of code P2198, refer to chart:
P2198
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2200-P22ZZ > P2255 - P2259,
( P2256 P2257 P2258 2255 2256 2257 2258 2259 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2257
P2255 - P2259: Testing and Inspection P2257
For diagnosis of code P2257, refer to chart:
P2257
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2200-P22ZZ > P2255 - P2259,
( P2256 P2257 P2258 2255 2256 2257 2258 2259 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2257 > Page 896
P2255 - P2259: Testing and Inspection P2258
For diagnosis of code P2258, refer to chart:
P2258
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2200-P22ZZ > P2270 - P2274,
( P2271 P2272 P2273 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2270
P2270 - P2274: Testing and Inspection P2270
For diagnosis of code P2270, refer to chart:
P2270
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2200-P22ZZ > P2270 - P2274,
( P2271 P2272 P2273 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2270 > Page 901
P2270 - P2274: Testing and Inspection P2271
For diagnosis of code P2271, refer to chart:
P2271
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2200-P22ZZ > P2270 - P2274,
( P2271 P2272 P2273 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2270 > Page 902
P2270 - P2274: Testing and Inspection P2272
For diagnosis of code P2272, refer to chart:
P2272
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2200-P22ZZ > P2270 - P2274,
( P2271 P2272 P2273 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2270 > Page 903
P2270 - P2274: Testing and Inspection P2273
For diagnosis of code P2273, refer to chart:
P2273
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2200-P22ZZ > P2270 - P2274,
( P2271 P2272 P2273 2270 2271 2272 2273 2274 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis > P2270 > Page 904
P2270 - P2274: Testing and Inspection P2274
For diagnosis of code P2274, refer to chart:
P2274
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2200-P22ZZ > P2275 - P2279,
( P2276 P2277 P2278 2275 2276 2277 2278 2279 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P2275 - P2279: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P2275, refer to chart:
P2275
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2400-P24ZZ > P2445 - P2449,
( P2446 P2447 P2448 2445 2446 2447 2448 2449 ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P2445 - P2449: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P2448, refer to chart:
P2448
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > A L L Diagnostic Trouble Codes ( DTC ) > Codes by Number > P2600-P26ZZ > P260F - P260J,
( P260G P260H P260I 260F 260G 260H 260I 260J ) > System Information > System Diagnosis
P260F - P260J: Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of code P260F, refer to chart:
P260F
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 922
C2075
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 923
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 924
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit
Navigation Module: Diagrams Audio/Navigation Control Unit
C2123a
C2123b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 930
C2123c
C2123d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 931
C2123e
C2123f
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 932
C2123g
C2253a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 933
C2253b
C2253c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 934
C2253d
C2253e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 935
Navigation Module: Diagrams Navigation Module
C2279a
C2279b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 936
Navigation Module: Service and Repair
NAVIGATION MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Remove the lower LH and RH front floor console panels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 937
3. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the navigation module.
1 Remove the 2 navigation module rear screws.
2 Remove the 2 navigation module lateral screws.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 >
Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Control Module: Customer Interest Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC
C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 >
Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 > Page 946
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-20-5 >
Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Parking Assist System - Speaker
Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-20-5 >
Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 > Page 952
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Parking
Assist Control Module: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Parking
Assist Control Module: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 958
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Parking
Assist Control Module: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 959
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Parking
Assist Control Module: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 965
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Parking
Assist Control Module: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 966
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 967
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 968
Parking Assist Control Module: Diagrams
C4014a
C4014b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 969
C4226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 970
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
PARKING AID MODULE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 971
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the parking aid module.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
2 Remove the parking aid module screw.
3 Remove the parking aid module.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 976
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C341a
C341b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 977
C341c
C341d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
C4183
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 983
C4184
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 986
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 987
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 988
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 992
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
C4174a
C4174b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 993
C4174c
C4174d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 994
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair
POWER LIFTGATE MODULE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Prior to removal of the power liftgate module, it is necessary to upload module configuration
information to a diagnostic tool. This information needs to be downloaded into the new power
liftgate module once installed.
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the power liftgate module.
1 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2 Remove the nut. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: Once the new power liftgate module is installed, it is necessary to download the module
configuration information from the diagnostic
tool into the new power liftgate module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1003
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1004
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1005
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1006
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1007
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1008
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1009
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1010
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1011
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1012
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1013
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1019
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1020
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1021
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1022
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1023
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1024
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1025
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1026
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1027
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1028
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1029
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1030
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1031
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams
C3265a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1032
C3265b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1033
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair
CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), it is necessary to carry out
programmable module installation (PMI).
1. Before removing the dual CCSM, carry out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure. 2.
Position the front passenger seat all the way back and up. 3. Depower the SRS. 4. Pull out and
remove the seat track front cover.
5. NOTE: The inset shows the dual climate control seat module (CCSM) retaining bracket.
Remove the dual CCSM. 1
Pull the back of the dual CCSM away from the seat and slide it off the mounting bracket.
2 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3 Remove the dual CCSM.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the SRS. 8. Install the CCSM software
data. Carry out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1042
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1043
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1044
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1045
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1046
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1047
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1048
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1049
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1050
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1051
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled
Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1052
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1062
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1063
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1064
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1065
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1066
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1067
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1068
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1069
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1070
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1071
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-5-1 > Mar >
06 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
> Page 1072
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > Page 1073
P1275 - P1279: Testing and Inspection P1276
For diagnosis of code P1276, refer to chart:
P1276
If there is no link in the chart then:
- This code is not a valid code for this vehicle
- Or information published by the manufacturer for this vehicle did not include this code
For complete diagnosis of the system, follow this link: See: Powertrain Management/Computers
and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1077
C921
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1081
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1082
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1083
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 1088
C135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 1089
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new module, it must be calibrated and configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical connector. 3. Remove the 3 bolts
and the ABS module.
^ To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 1090
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Locations Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 1096
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 1097
Blower Motor Relay: Locations Rear Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 1098
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Blower Motor Relay
C2216
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 1101
C4075
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 1104
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 1105
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 1106
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1110
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1111
C1008
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1112
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH RELAY (A/CCR)
NOTE: The PCM PIDs WAC and wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WACF) are used to
monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR (may be referred to as the wide open throttle A/C cutoff [WAC] relay) is wired normally
open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch or EATC module and the A/C
clutch. The PCM receives a signal indicating that A/C is requested (for some applications, this
message is sent through the communications network). When A/C is requested, the PCM will
check other A/C related inputs that are available (such as ACPSW, ACCS). If these inputs indicate
A/C operation is OK, and the engine conditions are OK (such as coolant temperature, engine RPM,
throttle position), the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending
voltage to the A/CC.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1113
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1114
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1118
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams
C228a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1119
C228b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1124
C1474
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1125
Backup Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1126
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Battery Discharge Protection
Relay, Lighting > Component Information > Locations
Battery Discharge Protection Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Battery Discharge Protection
Relay, Lighting > Component Information > Locations > Page 1130
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The battery savar relay is part of the central junction box (CJB) and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Courtesy Lamp Relay: Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
The interior lamp relay is located in the instrument cluster and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Locations Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 1138
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 1139
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Locations Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Ignition Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 1140
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
C1359
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 1143
C1171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp
Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 1146
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 1147
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Ignition
Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 1148
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1152
C2241
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1153
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1154
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1158
C2047
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1159
Hazard Flasher Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1164
C2242
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1165
High Beam Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1166
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Horn Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1170
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The horn relay is part of the central junction box (CJB) and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Interior Lighting Relay: Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
The interior lamp relay is located in the instrument cluster and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 1178
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
C2244
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 1181
C2245
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 1184
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 1185
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Reset Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 1186
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 1191
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
C2240
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 1194
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 1197
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 1198
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 1199
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1203
C2047
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1204
Turn Signal Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1205
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1210
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1214
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1218
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1219
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1220
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1225
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1227
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1228
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1229
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1230
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1231
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1232
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1233
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1234
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1235
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1236
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 1237
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1238
Relay Box: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1239
C270a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1240
C270b
C270c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1241
C270d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1242
C270e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1243
C270f
C270g
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1244
C270h
C270j
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1245
C270k
C270m
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1246
C270n
C270p
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1249
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1251
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1252
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1253
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1254
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1255
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1256
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1257
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1258
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1259
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1260
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 1261
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Body Control Module: Locations
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE (VSM)
View 151-17 (RH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 1267
Body Control Module: Diagrams
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE (VSM)
C2113a
C2113b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 1268
C2113c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat
Module (DSM)
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
may result.
- Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload module configuration information to
the appropriate diagnostic equipment. This information needs to be downloaded into the new
module once installed.
1. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the driver seat module forward to remove it from the bracket.
2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
4. CAUTION: Once the module is installed it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the diagnostic tool into
the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat
Module (DSM) > Page 1271
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Vehicle Security Module
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE
Removal
CAUTION: The steps included in the vehicle security module removal and installation procedure
are critical to restoring the vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring systems to normal
operation. A new vehicle security module is delivered in manufacturing mode with 6 pre-set
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) related to the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). The
presence of these DTCs requires the installation procedures be followed in order to clear the DTCs
and enable normal vehicle security module operations.
1. NOTE: Prior to the removal of the vehicle security module, it is necessary to upload the module
configuration information to the diagnostic tool.
This information must be downloaded to the new vehicle security module after installation.
Disconnect the battery.
2. Remove the pin-type retainer and the RH A-pillar lower trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat
Module (DSM) > Page 1272
3. Remove the glove compartment. 4. Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors. 5. Remove the 2
screws and the vehicle security module.
Installation
1. Position the vehicle security module and install the 2 screws.
- Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
2. Connect the 3 electrical connectors. 3. Position the RH A-pillar lower trim panel and install the
pin-type retainer. 4. Install the glove compartment 5. Connect the battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for vehicle security module
operation and clears DTC B2477. The clearing
of the DTC indicates the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the vehicle security
module.
Download the vehicle security module configuration information from the diagnostic tool to the
vehicle security module.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the vehicle security
module has recognized the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. Clear the DTCs.
9. NOTE:
- DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the vehicle security module.
- This step is required to clear DTC C2780, allow the vehicle security module to exit the
manufacturing mode, and to be sure there are no other concerns with the newly programmed
vehicle security module.
Carry out the vehicle security module on-demand self-test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position sensor (TPS), and mechanical throttle
body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph) Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The throttle position (TP) sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The
redundant throttle position signals are required for
increased monitoring reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle,
decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing
voltage). During normal operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control
strategy as the indication of throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1276
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1277
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1278
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. Therefore, the E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly
monitor selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of
the IPC and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it
takes appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1279
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1280
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 5% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 5% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key-on,
engine off.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard-stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard-stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide Open Throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of Range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard-stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard-stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H-driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1286
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1287
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1288
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1289
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1290
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1291
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1292
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1293
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1294
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1295
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1296
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1297
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1298
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1299
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1300
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1301
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1302
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1303
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175b (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1304
C175b (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1305
C175e (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1306
C175e (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1307
C175t (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1308
C175t (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flash
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The flash electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM) is contained in an
integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module (PCM). The EEPROM contains the
vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the vehicle, and is capable of being
programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate fault code P1635
or P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various
hardware or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this
procedure properly may generate fault code P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An
incorrect tire/axle ratio is one of the main causes for fault code P1639. This is described under
Making Changes to the VID Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The
VID block contains many items used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items
include the vehicle identification number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed
limit, tire size, axle ratio, the presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly
(ESOF) versus manual shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and
supported by the VID block is displayed on the diagnostic tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the diagnostic tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again
to reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the
diagnostic tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and will need programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
the use of a diagnostic tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle.
The stored data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Manual data entry must be carried out if the old module is damaged or incapable of
communicating. Remove and install a new PCM. Using a compatible diagnostic tool, select and
carry out the module/parameter programming, referring to the diagnostic tool manufacturer's
instruction manual. Make certain that all parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire
size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches),
axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF may result in codes P1635 and P1639. You may be
instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center for the information needed to manually update the
VID block with the diagnostic tool. Contact the center only if the old PCM cannot be used or the
data is corrupt. For Ford and L-M technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional
Technician Society (PTS) website for As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index.
Non-Ford technicians use the Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the
Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and L-M technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the PTS
website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle when using the worldwide
diagnostic system (WDS) or New Generation STAR (NGS).
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to PCM/Module Reprogramming on the diagnostic tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to PCM/Module Reprogramming on the diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flash
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) > Page 1311
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Refer to Computers and Control Systems for correct worldwide diagnostic system (WDS)
hook-up procedure.
If servicing the powertrain control module (PCM), connect the diagnostic tool to the vehicle. Allow
the diagnostic tool to identify the vehicle and obtain configuration data. All programmable module information will automatically be retrieved by the WDS.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flash
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) > Page 1312
3. Disconnect the PCM electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 4 bolts and the PCM.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. If servicing the PCM bracket, remove the 3 bolts and the PCM bracket.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 1316
C2160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 1317
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 1318
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 1323
C4033
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 1324
Fuel Pump Control Unit: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Driver Module (FPDM)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. NOTE: The fuel pump driver module (FPDM) is located on the top of the LH frame rail near the
fuel tank filler pipe.
Disconnect the FPDM electrical connector.
4. Remove the bolts and the FPDM.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1328
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Central Junction Box (CJB) and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 1332
C2160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 1333
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 1334
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1339
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployable
Components (Part 1)
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployable
Components (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1340
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Sensor Components
(Part 1)
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Sensor Components
(Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1341
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1342
C310b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1343
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
WARNING:
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, the RCM must be replaced whether or not the air bags have deployed. In
addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
NOTE: When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM
is being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
The restraints control module (RCM) carries out the following functions:
- deploys the air bag(s) in the event of a deployable crash.
- activates the safety belt buckle pretensioners to remove slack from the safety belt.
- monitors the SRS for faults.
- illuminates the air bag indicator if a fault is detected.
- flashes the air bag indicator to indicate the lamp fault code (LFC) detected.
- communicates through the data link connector (DLC) the current or historical Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTCs).
- signals the instrument cluster module to activate a chime if the air bag indicator is not available
and another SRS fault exists.
The RCM monitors the SRS for possible faults. If a fault is detected while the ignition switch is in
the ON position, the RCM will illuminate the air bag indicator located in the instrument cluster.
When the ignition is cycled (turned OFF and then ON), the air bag indicator will prove out by
lighting for 6 seconds and then off for 2 seconds. After the prove out, the air bag indicator will then
flash the 2-digit LFC. If an SRS fault exists, the air bag indicator will flash the LFC 5 times, then it
will remain illuminated for the rest of the key cycle. The RCM will also communicate the current and
historical DTCs through the DLC, to the diagnostic tool. If the air bag indicator does not function,
and the system detects a fault condition, the RCM will signal the instrument cluster module to
activate an audible chime. The chime is a series of 5 sets of 5 tone bursts. If the chime is heard,
the SRS and the air bag indicator require repair.
LFCs are prioritized. If 2 or more faults occur at the same time, the fault having the highest priority
will be displayed. After that fault has been corrected, the next highest priority fault will be displayed.
The RCM includes a backup power supply. This feature provides sufficient backup power to deploy
the front air bags and safety belt pretensioners in the event that the ignition circuit is lost or
damaged during impact. The backup power supply will deplete its stored energy approximately one
minute after the battery ground cable is disconnected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1344
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
Vehicles With A Center Console
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1345
Vehicles With 60/40 Front Bench Seat
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for proper air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) operation. If a vehicle equipped with an SRS system has been involved in a collision
in which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, the RCM must be replaced whether or not the air bags have deployed. In
addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage can result.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM is
being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1346
1. Depower the system.
Vehicles with a center console 2. Remove the center console.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat 3. Remove the 60 percent portion of the front bench seat. 4.
Remove the 3 nuts and the restraints control module (RCM) top bracket.
5. WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the
RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal injury.
Remove the 3 nuts and separate the RCM from the bracket.
All vehicles
6. Disconnect the small restraints control module (RCM) electrical connector.
1 Push down to release the retaining tab.
2 While releasing the retaining tab, pull out and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
7. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1 Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever away from the RCM,
disengaging the lever.
2 Pull out and disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat 8. Remove the RCM.
Vehicles with a center console 9. Remove the 4 RCM bracket bolts and RCM with the bracket.
Installation
Vehicles with a center console
1. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag restraints control module (RCM) bracket
retaining bolts is critical for correct system
operation.
Position the RCM with bracket and install the 4 bolts. Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1347
All vehicles
2. Make sure the connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before attempting
to connect the connector.
3. CAUTION: Putting the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM on an angle can cause bad
electrical connections and damage
components.
Position the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM.
- CAUTION: Do not push the connector on to where the lever pivots and seats itself. Light pressure
is needed to get the connector into position on the RCM before using the lever to fully seat the
connector.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1348
4. Connect the RCM electrical connector.
- Pivot the connector position assurance lever toward the RCM, drawing the connector in to the
RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat
6. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag restraints control module (RCM) to bracket
retaining nuts is critical for correct system
operation.
Position the RCM to the bracket and install the 3 nuts. Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
7. Position the RCM top bracket and install the nuts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Vehicles with a center console 8. Install the center console.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat 9. Install the 60 percent portion of the front bench seat.
All vehicles 10. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Control Module: > 05-22-17 > Nov >
05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
Seat Belt Control Module: Customer Interest Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Control Module: > 05-22-17 > Nov >
05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 1357
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: >
05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
Seat Belt Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder'
Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: >
05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 1363
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Starter Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1368
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Central Junction Box (CJB), in the engine compartment, RH
side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1369
C2163
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1370
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1371
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 1377
C1300
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 1378
Compressor/Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 1379
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Suspension Control Module: Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 1383
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 1384
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
C2131a
C2131b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 1385
C2324a
C2324b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 1386
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. NOTE: The air suspension control module is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 air suspension control module electrical connectors.
3. Pull back the dash padding to expose the 2 module bracket nuts. 4. Remove the air suspension
control module nuts and the air suspension control module.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 1387
5. NOTE: The air suspension control module is calibrated with information from the ride height
sensors. A new or exchanged air suspension control
module requires that the ride height adjustment calibration and pneumatic test be carried out.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Module: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Module Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage can result.
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) is integral to the vehicle security module
(VSM) and is not serviced separately.
NOTE: A new VSM module is delivered in manufacturing mode with pre-set diagnostic trouble
codes (DTC's). These DTC's require that a particular set of operations to be carried out in order to
clear them and enable the module for normal operations. The pre-set DTC's are as follows: ^
B2477 - Module Configuration Failure/Mismatch
^ B2868 - Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2869 - Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2870 - Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2871 - Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ C2780 - ECU in Manufacturing Mode
NOTE: A re-configured VSM may also set the above codes and will need to go through the same
set of procedures as a new module to enable normal operation.
1. NOTE: The steps included in the VSM removal and installation process are critical to restoring
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring
system operations and will permit a new or reconfigured module to operate as intended. Each step
is designed to carry out a particular operation and clear the manufacturing mode DTC's. Once
these DTC's are cleared, the new or reconfigured module will enter into normal operating mode.
Remove the VSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Four Wheel Drive (4WD) control module is integral to the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) and is not serviced separately.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1400
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The transfercase Low to High and High to Low relays are located in the Auxiliary relay box 1
located in the engine compartment. LH side, front.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to High
Relay
C1129
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to High
Relay > Page 1403
C1173
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case
Low to High Relay
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case Low to High Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case
Low to High Relay > Page 1406
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case
Low to High Relay > Page 1407
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case High to Low Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case
Low to High Relay > Page 1408
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1413
C2021
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1414
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1415
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay
Power Window Relay: Locations Accessory Delay Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay > Page 1420
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The accessory delay relay is located in the central junction box, in the engine compartment, RH
side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay > Page 1421
Power Window Relay: Locations Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay > Page 1422
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
The quarter window open relay is located in the auxiliary relay box 2, behind trim panel, in loading
space, RH side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay > Page 1423
Power Window Relay: Locations Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay > Page 1424
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
The quarter window close relay is located in the auxiliary relay box 2, behind trim panel, in loading
space, RH side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Quarter Window Open Relay
C4175
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 1427
C4176
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 1430
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 1431
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 1432
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Inner/Outer Left
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Inner/Outer Left > Page 1439
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Inner/Outer Left > Page 1440
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor
C4191
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 1443
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Diagrams Parking Aid Ultrasonic Sensor
C4192
C4193
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 1444
C4009
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 1445
C4011
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 1446
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Diagrams
C4191
C4192
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 1447
C4193
C4009
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 1448
C4011
C4010
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 1449
C4012
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1450
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair
PARKING AID SENSOR
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1451
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the rear bumper cover.
2. Remove the nuts and the foam absorber from the bumper cover. 3. Remove the ultrasonic
sensor(s).
1 Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
2 Release the locking tabs.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1452
3 Remove the ultrasonic sensor(s).
Navigator
4. Remove the radar sensor.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the two parking aid radar sensor nuts.
3 Remove the radar sensor.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
C2090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1459
Pedal Positioning Switch: Diagrams
C2089
C2235
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1460
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1461
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1462
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams
C2090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1470
Pedal Positioning Switch: Diagrams
C2089
C2235
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1471
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1472
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1473
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 1478
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
C505
C541
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side > Page 1481
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
C605
C632
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1482
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1483
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1487
Power Mirror Switch: Diagrams
C527
C577
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1488
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1489
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1490
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the driver front door trim panel.
Navigator
2. Depress the locking tabs and remove the exterior mirror control switch.
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1491
3. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
1 Depress the locking tabs.
2 Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 1496
View 151-35 (Chassis, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 1497
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 1498
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 1499
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor
C372
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 1502
C383
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 1503
C373
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 1504
C1151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 1505
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Diagrams
C372
C383
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 1506
C373
C1151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 1507
C1153
C4084
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 1508
C3244
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Folding Seat Switch, Left/Right
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Folding Seat Switch, Left/Right > Page 1513
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Folding Seat Switch, Left/Right > Page 1514
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Left
C352
C3016
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left > Page 1517
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Right
C355
C3026
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left > Page 1518
C4179
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left > Page 1519
C4180
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1522
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1523
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1524
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Left-8-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1525
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1527
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1528
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Right-6-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1529
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1530
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1531
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Right-8-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1532
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1533
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1534
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1535
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1536
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1537
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1538
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1540
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1541
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1542
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1543
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1544
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1545
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1546
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1547
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1548
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1549
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1550
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1551
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 1552
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - 8-Way
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - 8-Way
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - 8-WAY
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Pry and remove the seat control switch and power recline knobs.
5. Access and remove the cushion side shield front screw.
6. Pull out from the bottom and rear side of the cushion side shield to release the 3 retainer clips. 7.
Disconnect the power lumbar and seat control switch electrical connectors and remove the cushion
side shield. 8. Remove the 3 screws and remove the 8-way seat control switch. 9. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
10. Install the 40 percent seat. 11. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - 8-Way > Page 1555
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - 6-Way
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - 6-WAY
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat is shown, passenger is similar.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. From under the seat, disconnect the 6-way power seat switch
electrical connector. 5. Remove the recliner handle screw cover, screw and recliner handle.
6. CAUTION: Use care when removing the lumbar knob. Using both hands, pull with even pressure
on both sides of the knob to remove.
Pull out to remove the manual lumbar knob.
7. Remove the cushion side shield screw from under the manual lumbar knob.
8. CAUTION: Use care not to scratch the side shield when removing the power seat knob.
Pry the seat control switch knob off.
9. Access and remove the front cushion side shield screw.
10. Pull to release the center and rear retainers and remove the cushion side shield.
11. Remove the 2 seat control switch screws and remove the 6-way seat control switch from the
cushion side shield. 12. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 13. Install the 40 percent seat.
14. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - 8-Way > Page 1556
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Third Row
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - THIRD ROW
Removal and Installation
1. Partially remove the RH quarter trim panel for access to the third row power seat switch(es.). 2.
Remove the one-way push nuts on the back side of the power seat switch bezel. 3. Disconnect the
RH and LH third row seat control switch electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - 8-Way > Page 1557
4. Release the 4 locking tabs (2 shown) on the affected switch, and remove the switch. 5. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1561
C4039
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1570
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1571
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1572
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1573
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1574
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1575
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1576
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1577
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1578
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1579
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1580
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1586
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1587
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1588
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1589
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1590
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1591
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1592
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1593
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1594
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1595
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1596
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1605
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1606
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1607
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1608
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1609
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1610
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1611
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1612
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1613
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1614
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1615
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1621
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1622
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1623
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1624
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1625
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1626
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1627
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1628
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1629
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1630
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 1631
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1635
C503
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1636
Seat Memory Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH - MEMORY SET
Memory Set Switch
Remove the memory set switch.
Measure the resistance between the indicated terminals while pressing the requested switches.
The resistance should be less than 5 ohms for each switch position.
If the resistance is not less than 5 ohms for each switch, install a new switch; otherwise, return to
the calling pinpoint test.
NOTE: Refer to multimeter user's manual for testing diodes.
To check the memory set switch LED, connect the positive meter lead to terminal 7 and the
negative lead to terminal 1. The meter should indicate greater than 0.3 volts. Reversing the leads,
the meter should read OL.
If the meter readings are not as indicated above, install a new switch; otherwise, return to the
calling pinpoint test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1640
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Diagrams
C912
C9001
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1641
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1642
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 1647
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 1648
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch
C4190
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 1651
C4187
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 1652
C9000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump
Switch, Seats > Component Information > Locations > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Left Front
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump
Switch, Seats > Component Information > Locations > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Left Front > Page 1657
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump
Switch, Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Right Front
C331
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump
Switch, Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Right Front > Page 1660
C361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump
Switch, Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1661
Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump
Switch, Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1662
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump
Switch, Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1663
Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch: Service and Repair
LUMBAR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Access and remove the cushion side shield front screw.
5. Pull out from the bottom and rear side of cushion side shield to release the 3 retainer clips. 6.
Disconnect the power lumbar switch and 8-way power seat switch electrical connectors.
7. Pinch retainer in and push from the rear of power lumbar switch to remove the switch from the
side shield. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Install the 40 percent seat.
10. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Service and Repair
ABS Sensor Block: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control
sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Booster
Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Booster
Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1671
C149
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1675
C124
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1676
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Hydraulic Brake Actuation
The brake pedal is connected to the power brake booster, which is connected to the brake master
cylinder. The brake pedal is either fixed or adjustable; non-memory or memory is available. When
the brake pedal is depressed, brake fluid is pushed from the master cylinder through the metal
tubing and flexible hoses to the front disc brake calipers and the rear disc brake calipers. The front
disc brake caliper pistons are forced outward against the brake pads and contact the braking
surface of the brake discs. The brake fluid enters the rear disc brake calipers, forcing the rear disc
brake caliper pistons outward against the brake pads. The brake pads press against the braking
surface on the brake discs. When the brake pedal is released, the pressure is relieved, returning
the brake caliper pistons and the brake pads to the released position.
The dual brake system is split front and rear with the front wheel brakes comprising one circuit and
the rear wheel brakes, the other circuit.
The ability of a brake system to stop the vehicle is dependent on the available traction.
Brake Master Cylinder
The brake master cylinder is a dual-piston type.
The brake master cylinder is assisted by a power brake booster.
These conditions are considered normal and are not indications that the brake master cylinder is in
need of repair or replacement. ^
Low brake fluid level detected without signs of leakage. This condition is caused by displacement
of brake fluid from the brake master cylinder reservoir into the disc brake calipers to compensate
for normal brake wear. Add brake fluid as needed.
^ A momentary or slight ripple of brake fluid inside the brake master cylinder reservoir upon
application or release of the brake pedal.
A trace of brake fluid found on the outside of the power brake booster below the brake master
cylinder mounting flange. This condition results from the lubricating action of the brake master
cylinder wiping seal.
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
The brake fluid level warning switch is an integral part of the brake master cylinder reservoir. It
consists of a float containing a magnet and a reed switch mounted in the bottom of the brake
master cylinder reservoir.
When the brake fluid in the brake master cylinder reservoir gets to a predetermined level, the
floating magnet actuates the reed switch, causing the red brake warning indicator to illuminate.
Loss of brake fluid from either the primary (front) or secondary (rear) system will cause this system
to activate. If the brake fluid level warning switch is inoperative, a new brake master cylinder
reservoir must be installed.
Tubes and Hoses
CAUTION: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of a
specific design and new authorized parts only should be installed.
Steel tubing with flex hoses are used in the hydraulic tubes between the brake master cylinder and
the hydraulic control unit (HCU). Steel tubing is used between the HCU and the front and rear
hoses.
Double flared brake tubing provides good leakproof connections.
When replacing hydraulic brake tubing, hoses or connectors, tighten all connections securely. After
replacement, bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor > Page 1681
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor
C147
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor > Page 1684
C148
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control
sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Release Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Release Switch: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Release Switch
NOTE: Floor shift shown, column shift similar.
Removal and Installation
Column shift (Expedition only)
1. NOTE: The parking brake release switch is located on the steering column. It is serviced as an
assembly with the brake shift interlock.
Remove the brake shift interlock/park brake release switch assembly.
Floor shift
2. Remove the floor shift selector lever. 3. Disconnect the parking brake release switch electrical
connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Release Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1691
4. Remove the 2 parking brake release switch screws and remove the switch.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Make sure the switch is correctly aligned with the extension on the shifter before installing the
screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1695
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Disconnect
the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the steering
wheel rotation sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-24 (Center Console)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1702
C280
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Right Front
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Right Front > Page 1707
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Right Front > Page 1708
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 1711
C440
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 1712
C160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 1713
C426
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the wheel speed sensor
harness retainer bolt and detach the retainers.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the 2 caliper anchor bolts and position the caliper, pads and anchor plate aside. ^
Support the caliper with mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 1716
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake shoes. 2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the
retaining clips. 3. Remove the rear wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1720
C245
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1721
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control
sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
FAN SPEED SENSOR (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch With Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The powertrain control
module (PCM) uses the frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop
control of the cooling fan clutch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1730
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > CHT
Sensor
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor:
^ is mounted into the wall of the cylinder head and is not connected to any coolant passages.
^ sends the PCM a signal indicating cylinder head temperature.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 121 °C (250°F), the PCM disables half of the fuel
injectors at a time. The PCM will alternate which fuel injectors are disabled every 32 engine cycles.
The cylinders that are not being fuel injected act as air pumps to aid in engine cooling.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 166°C (330°F), the PCM disables all of the fuel
injectors until the engine temperature drops below approximately 1 54°C (31 0°F).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > CHT
Sensor > Page 1733
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Cylinder Head Temperature Sensor
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the aluminum cylinder head and measures the metal temperature.
The CHT sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer
coolant temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM
initiates a fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system
concern such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result
damage to major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling
strategy, the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
1734
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Locations > Deactivator Switch
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Locations > Deactivator Switch > Page 1740
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Diagrams > Deactivator Switch
C277
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Diagrams > Deactivator Switch > Page 1743
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 1746
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake
Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS)/BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code is set by the PCM strategy.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1747
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
Removal
1. NOTE: The speed control deactivator switch can only be adjusted once. If further adjusting is
necessary, install a new switch.
Remove the speed control deactivator switch. 1
Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Rotate the deactivator switch counterclockwise 45 degrees and remove the switch.
Installation
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1748
1. Release the plunger lock (if equipped).
- Turn the lock knob counterclockwise until the first click is felt.
2. Fully apply the brake pedal
3. Install the speed control deactivator switch.
1 Position the deactivator switch in the bracket and rotate it clockwise 45 degrees.
2 Connect the electrical connector.
Vehicles equipped with a locking tab
4. NOTE: There should be an extra click heard when tugging on the brake pedal.
Slowly release the brake pedal and tug it moderately once the pedal reaches the rest position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the driver air bag module.
Expedition
2. Remove the 2 screws and the speed control switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
3. Remove the horn switch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1755
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the 4 bolts.
4. Remove the speed control switch.
1 Disconnect the wiring harness locators.
2 Remove the 4 screws. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1760
C103
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE (EOP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch,
Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1771
C132
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1772
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1773
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Remove the upper radiator sight shield.
All vehicles
2. Detach and disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the
ambient air temperature sensor. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the climate control assembly. 2. Pull and remove the blower motor switch knob. 3.
Release the 3 clips and remove the blower motor switch. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch > Page 1778
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Speed Control
BLOWER MOTOR SPEED CONTROL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator. 2. Disconnect the blower motor speed control
electrical connector. 3. Remove the blower motor speed control screw. 4. Remove the blower
motor speed control. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
C233
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor > Page 1784
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1785
In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Disconnect the aspirator hose and the in-vehicle
temperature sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor screws. 4.
Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor > Page 1788
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity
Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor trim cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector and aspirator tube.
2. Remove the 2 in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor screws. 3. Remove the in-vehicle
temperature and humidity sensor. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE (ACET) SENSOR
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling, improve defrost/demist
performance, and reduce A/C clutch cycling.
NOTE: These values can vary 15 percent due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1792
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) EVAPORATOR DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Lower the glove compartment. 2. Remove the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor
screw. 3. Disconnect the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor electrical connector.
4. Carefully pry the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor probe out of the heater core and
evaporator core housing. 5. Remove the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor. 6. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Humidity Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Humidity Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 1796
Humidity Sensor: Service and Repair
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor trim cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector and aspirator tube.
2. Remove the 2 in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor screws. 3. Remove the in-vehicle
temperature and humidity sensor. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1801
C1078
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1805
C130
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1809
C286
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch. 3. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
View 151-30 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1818
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1819
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1820
View 151-31 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1821
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch
C479
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 1824
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 1825
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 1826
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 1827
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 1828
Door Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door lock actuator. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump Module (FPM)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 1833
Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump Module (FPM)
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 1834
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module and Reservoir
FUEL PUMP MODULE AND RESERVOIR
Fuel Pump Module And Reservoir
The fuel pump module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge
check valve that maintains the system pressure after the ignition key has been turned off to
minimize starting concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle
maneuvers with low tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1835
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1836
Part 2
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1837
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel and vapor tubes from the fuel pump module.
3. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
4. CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1838
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1842
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
LIGHT SENSOR
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1847
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Remove the light sensor and bezel as an assembly from the defroster grille.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 screws and the light sensor.
Navigator
3. Remove the defroster grille. 4. Remove the 2 screws and the light sensor.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1851
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1852
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1856
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1857
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1858
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
STOPLAMP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the self-locking pin. 3. Remove
the stoplamp switch from the brake booster push rod and the brake pedal assembly. 4. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
View 151-30 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1863
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1864
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1865
View 151-31 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1866
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch
C479
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 1869
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 1870
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 1871
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 1872
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1873
Door Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door lock actuator. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1877
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1878
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1882
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1883
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1884
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1885
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1889
Headlamp Switch: Diagrams
C205a
C205b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1890
C205c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps > Page 1893
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps > Page 1894
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Main Light Switch, Interior Lamps
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps > Page 1895
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1896
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP SWITCH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1897
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. CAUTION: Cover the end of the tool with tape to prevent damage to the trim panel.
NOTE: Use a thin-bladed tool to remove the headlamp switch bezel assembly.
Remove the headlamp switch and bezel assembly. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
Navigator
2. Remove the instrument panel finish panel.
3. NOTE: Release the tabs to remove the headlamp switch.
Remove the 2 screws and the headlamp switch.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Interior Light Switch: Service and Repair
INTERIOR LAMP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. Remove the interior lamp switch.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Rotate the interior lamp switch one-quarter turn counterclockwise and remove.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1904
Turn Signal Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1905
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 1908
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 1909
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Turn Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 1910
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 1911
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1912
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch Removal and Installation
Steering Column
Steering Column
1. Remove the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Lower tilt release handle to access the second screw.
Remove the lower steering column shroud. ^
Remove the screws.
3. NOTE: The screw is located behind the multi-function switch.
Remove the screw and the upper steering column shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1913
4. Remove the bolt, push the release and raise the switch.
5. NOTE: A small screwdriver will be required to depress the connector release tab on connector
number 2.
Remove the multi-function switch. ^
Disconnect the 3 multi-function switch electrical connectors.
^ Remove the switch.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1919
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1920
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1924
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1925
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1926
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. If the hot wire electronic
sensing element must be replaced, then the entire assembly must be replaced. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
The current required to maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow.
The MAF sensor then outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air
mass. The PCM calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired
air/fuel ratio. This input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC),
shift and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology (IBT) with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1927
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1 > Page 1933
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
1934
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston No.
1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing the
sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP signal to
select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
1935
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1942
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1943
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1944
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the accessory drive belt. 4. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 7. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1948
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > CHT Sensor
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor:
^ is mounted into the wall of the cylinder head and is not connected to any coolant passages.
^ sends the PCM a signal indicating cylinder head temperature.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 121 °C (250°F), the PCM disables half of the fuel
injectors at a time. The PCM will alternate which fuel injectors are disabled every 32 engine cycles.
The cylinders that are not being fuel injected act as air pumps to aid in engine cooling.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 166°C (330°F), the PCM disables all of the fuel
injectors until the engine temperature drops below approximately 1 54°C (31 0°F).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > CHT Sensor > Page 1951
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Cylinder Head Temperature Sensor
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the aluminum cylinder head and measures the metal temperature.
The CHT sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer
coolant temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM
initiates a fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system
concern such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result
damage to major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling
strategy, the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1952
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
NOTE: The Ford GT uses a piezoelectric sonar type fuel level sensor. The sensor is located in the
tank and the sensor signal is provided as a communications network message by the instrument
cluster to the PCM.
The FLI is either a hard wire signal input to the PCM from the fuel pump (FP) module or a
communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type FLI sensor
connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 1956
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 1957
Part 2
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 1958
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel and vapor tubes from the fuel pump module.
3. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
4. CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 1959
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1963
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube quick connect couplings from the fuel
vapor/grade vent valves. 3. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube quick connect couplings from the fuel
pump module. 4. Remove the fuel pressure sensor tube assembly. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
- Leak test the system. See: Powertrain Management/Emission Control Systems/Evaporative
Emissions System/Testing and Inspection/Evaporative Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle. See: Powertrain
Management/Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1967
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1968
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1969
fuel, spark, and air flow.
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. However, one is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard
OBD/cold weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the
intake manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature
information to the PCM to control border-line spark and to help determine intercooler efficiency.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 >
Page 1975
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1976
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1977
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE (EOP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1984
C104
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1985
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1986
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Service and Repair
OIL TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Drain the engine oil. 4. Disconnect the engine oil temperature (EOT) sensor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the EOT sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
- Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 1991
Oxygen Sensor: Harness Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 1992
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 1993
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 1994
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission Without Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 1995
View 151-9 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission With Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 1996
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 1997
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 1998
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 1999
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission Without Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2000
View 151-9 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission With Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22
C141
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2003
C142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2004
C171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2005
C172
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2006
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2009
3. Using the special tool, remove the HO2S.
- To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2010
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2011
3. Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor.
- To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 2016
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR
DPFE Sensor
The DPFE sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer that monitors the differential
pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly. The differential pressure
feedback sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as the downstream pressure hose
(REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI and REF hose connections are
marked on the DPFE sensor housing for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger
diameter hose). The DPFE sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the
metering orifice and supplies it to the powertrain control module (PCM) as EGR flow rate feedback.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor > Page 2021
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor - Tube Mounted
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR - TUBE MOUNTED
DPFE Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted DPFE sensor is identical in operation as the larger plastic DPFE sensors and
uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2025
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 2028
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases corrosion resistance on terminals
and increases connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body. As the TP
sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM from the
TP. Those conditions are closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration), part throttle (includes cruise
or moderate acceleration), wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on
crank), and throttle angle rate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2029
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and the air cleaner
assembly. 3. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the air cleaner and air cleaner inlet pipe. 4.
Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2033
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2036
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2037
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2038
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2039
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2040
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2041
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2042
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2043
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2044
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2045
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2046
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2047
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2048
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2049
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2050
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2051
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2052
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2053
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2054
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
4R70E/4R75E Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Adjustment
Special Tools
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual lever shift control cable.
3. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2055
4. Loosen the digital transmission range (TR) sensor bolts.
5. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
6. CAUTION: Tightening one bolt before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor and tighten the bolts in an alternating sequence.
^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Install the manual control lever.
^ Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual lever shaft outer nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2056
8. With the manual lever in overdrive connect the shift lever control cable. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2057
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tools
Removal
NOTE: Manual shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2058
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual control lever shift control cable.
3. Disconnect the digital TR electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
5. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the digital TR sensor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2059
1. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
2. Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
3. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2060
5. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
6. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information generated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 2065
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or HALL-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a
frequency that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low
velocity, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the
sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated
by the VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR
DPFE Sensor
The DPFE sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer that monitors the differential
pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly. The differential pressure
feedback sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as the downstream pressure hose
(REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI and REF hose connections are
marked on the DPFE sensor housing for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger
diameter hose). The DPFE sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the
metering orifice and supplies it to the powertrain control module (PCM) as EGR flow rate feedback.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor > Page 2071
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor - Tube Mounted
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR - TUBE MOUNTED
DPFE Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted DPFE sensor is identical in operation as the larger plastic DPFE sensors and
uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2076
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2077
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2081
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2082
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2083
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. If the hot wire electronic
sensing element must be replaced, then the entire assembly must be replaced. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
The current required to maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow.
The MAF sensor then outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air
mass. The PCM calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired
air/fuel ratio. This input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC),
shift and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology (IBT) with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2084
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Rail
Pressure Sensor
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Rail
Pressure Sensor > Page 2089
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Rail
Pressure/Temperature Sensor
C1475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Rail
Pressure/Temperature Sensor > Page 2092
C435
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 2095
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail. Both pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the
fuel pump. The speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid
state. The dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which
allows the injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2096
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Disconnect the fuel
rail pressure and temperature (FRPT) sensor electrical and vacuum connectors. 4. Remove the 2
bolts and the FRPT sensor and discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal.
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2100
C1475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail. Both pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the
fuel pump. The speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid
state. The dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which
allows the injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor > Page 2103
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Temperature (FRT) Sensor
FUEL RAIL TEMPERATURE (FRT) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Temperature (FRT) Sensor
The FRT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRT sensor measures the temperature of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2104
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Disconnect the fuel
rail pressure and temperature (FRPT) sensor electrical and vacuum connectors. 4. Remove the 2
bolts and the FRPT sensor and discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal.
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2108
C4168
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2109
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2110
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the LH rear interior quarter trim panel. 3.
Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the
IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2114
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 2117
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases corrosion resistance on terminals
and increases connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body. As the TP
sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM from the
TP. Those conditions are closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration), part throttle (includes cruise
or moderate acceleration), wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on
crank), and throttle angle rate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 2118
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and the air cleaner
assembly. 3. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the air cleaner and air cleaner inlet pipe. 4.
Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
1 > Page 2125
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2126
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston No.
1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing the
sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP signal to
select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2127
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2131
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2132
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2133
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the accessory drive belt. 4. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 7. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2139
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2140
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2141
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2142
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2143
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2144
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2145
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2146
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2147
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2148
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2149
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2150
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2151
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2152
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2153
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2154
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2155
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2156
C250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2157
Ignition Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2158
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2159
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Lower tilt release handle to access second screw.
Remove the lower steering column shroud. ^
Remove the screws.
3. NOTE: The screw is located behind the multi-function switch.
Remove the screw and the upper steering column shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2160
4. Remove the bolt, push the release and position the multi-function switch aside.
5. Disconnect the ignition switch electrical connector.
6. Remove the ignition switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Make sure that the spring located under the ignition switch is positioned on the steering column
lock rod.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 2166
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2167
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2168
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Forward Crash Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 2174
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 2175
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 2176
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 2177
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Forward Crash Sensor
C177
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 2180
C539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 2181
C631
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 2182
C9004
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 2183
C9005
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2184
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation
SENSORS
WARNING:
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, the RCM must be replaced whether or not the air bags have deployed. In
addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
For these vehicles, the SRS uses up to 8 sensors. Within the RCM there can be up to 3 safing
sensors which are not separately serviced. The RCM will always have at least 1 safing sensor for
front impact. Two more safing sensors are used if the vehicle is equipped with safety canopy
modules. The RCM is mounted to the center tunnel beneath the console or bench seat. All vehicles
will have a front impact severity sensor that is located in the front-center of the vehicle, mounted
near the bottom of the hood latch support bracket. If the vehicle is equipped with safety canopy
modules, there are 4 additional side impact sensors external to the RCM. One front row side
impact sensor is located behind each of the front door interior trim panels. One second row side
impact sensor is located at the base of each C-pillar. Mounting orientation is critical for correct
operation of all impact and rollover sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
FRONT IMPACT SEVERITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for proper system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and properly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Front bumper removed for clarity.
1. Depower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 2187
2. NOTE: The front impact severity sensor is mounted on the bottom of the hood latch support
bracket.
Remove the pin-type retainers and lower the front lower splash shield to access the front impact
severity sensor.
3. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag front impact severity sensor retaining nut is
critical for correct system operation.
CAUTION: If the hood latch support bracket or weld stud are damaged in any way that would affect
the way the front impact severity sensor mounts to its original manufactured position, a new hood
latch support bracket must be installed.
NOTE: Note the position of the front impact severity sensor locator tabs to the hood latch support bracket
alignment holes for installation.
- Make sure the hood latch support bracket and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are
clean and debris free.
Remove the front impact severity sensor nut. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft)
4. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the front impact severity sensor. 5. To install,
reverse the removal procedure. 6. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 2188
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - C-PILLAR
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 2189
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and perform the diagnostic procedure again.
- Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Lift to release and remove the rear door scuff plate. 3. Remove the
safety belt retractor anchor bolt. 4. Pull out at the front of the rear quarter trim panel, releasing the
retaining clips, allowing access to the side impact sensor. 5. Remove the side impact sensor bolt.
6. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector and remove the sensor and bracket.
Installation
1. Make sure the second row side impact sensor tabs are aligned to the bracket. 2. Position the
side impact sensor and bracket locator pin to the opening in the quarter panel sheet metal and
install the bolt.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
3. Connect the side impact sensor electrical connector. 4. Align the rear quarter trim panel and
push in, seating the retaining clips.
5. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the safety belt retractor anchor bolt. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
6. Install the rear door scuff plate. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 2190
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for proper system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and properly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the front interior door trim panel on the side with the affected
side impact sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 2191
3. Separate the weathershield enough to access the side impact sensor. 4. Disconnect the side
impact sensor electrical connector.
5. WARNING: The tightening torque of the side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for correct
system operation.
CAUTION: The ground wire must be placed between the bolt head and the sensor. Never position the ground
wire between the J-clip retaining nut and the sensor.
- Always replace the J-clip retaining nut whenever installing a side impact sensor.
NOTE: Make sure the side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign material.
- Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tabs for installation.
Remove the bolt and the side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger
View 151-17 (RH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger > Page 2196
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver
C3065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver > Page 2199
C3066
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2200
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE SWITCHES
As part of the supplemental restraint system (SRS), the driver and front outboard passenger safety
belt buckles are equipped with safety belt buckle switches. The safety belt buckle switches indicate
to the restraints control module (RCM) whether the safety belts are connected or disconnected.
The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage driver and
passenger air bag modules.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2204
C356
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2205
Seat Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the inboard side of the seat
track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver seat
position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage driver
air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2212
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2213
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2214
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2215
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2216
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2217
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2218
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2219
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2220
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2221
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2222
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2223
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2224
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2225
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2226
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2227
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2228
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2229
C250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2230
Ignition Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2231
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2232
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Lower tilt release handle to access second screw.
Remove the lower steering column shroud. ^
Remove the screws.
3. NOTE: The screw is located behind the multi-function switch.
Remove the screw and the upper steering column shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2233
4. Remove the bolt, push the release and position the multi-function switch aside.
5. Disconnect the ignition switch electrical connector.
6. Remove the ignition switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Make sure that the spring located under the ignition switch is positioned on the steering column
lock rod.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Neutral Safety Switch: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2237
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2238
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 2245
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2249
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Ride Height Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage
Loose
Ride Height Sensor: Customer Interest Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose
TSB 06-15-10
08/07/06
AIR SUSPENSION PERFORMANCE - HEIGHT SENSOR LINKAGE ARM DISENGAGING
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with an air suspension may
exhibit an air suspension height sensor linkage arm disengaging from the suspension ball stud or
height sensor rotating arm. This concern typically occurs with the rear sensor (Figure 1) but may
occur with the front sensors as well. If this occurs, the symptom will typically be the vehicle leaning
to one side, the vehicle sitting too low/high, a harsh ride, and/or an inoperative air suspension. In
addition, this concern may result in diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1725 (air suspension front
pneumatic failure) or C1726 (air suspension rear pneumatic failure).
ACTION When a linkage arm becomes disengaged, do not re-attach the arm and do not replace
the sensor unless broken. Instead, install a revised linkage arm on all three (3) sensor assemblies,
even if they have not detached from the ball stud. Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Ride Height Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage
Loose > Page 2259
NOTE
LINKAGE ARMS USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT ARE SHOWN IN FIGURE 2. REVISED
LINKAGE ARMS (FIGURE 3) HAVE A NEW DESIGN THAT MAKES IT MORE DIFFICULT TO
DISENGAGE FROM THE BALL STUDS.
NOTE
IF THE SENSOR ASSEMBLY NEEDS TO BE REPLACED FOR ANY DAMAGE/FAILURE OTHER
THAN THE ONE DESCRIBED IN THIS TSB, THE REPLACEMENT ASSEMBLY IS SUPPLIED
WITH A NEW STYLE LINKAGE ARM, SO THERE IS NO NEED TO ORDER ADDITIONAL
LINKAGES FOR THE SERVICE REPAIR.
1. Replace linkage arms on all three (3) sensor assemblies following Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 204-05.
2. Discard the old linkage arms.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061510A 2003-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Three Linkage Arms, Includes Time To Check Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (Do Not Use With 5300A, 5300A7, 5300A8)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
5A967 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Ride Height Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height
Sensor Linkage Loose
Ride Height Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor
Linkage Loose
TSB 06-15-10
08/07/06
AIR SUSPENSION PERFORMANCE - HEIGHT SENSOR LINKAGE ARM DISENGAGING
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with an air suspension may
exhibit an air suspension height sensor linkage arm disengaging from the suspension ball stud or
height sensor rotating arm. This concern typically occurs with the rear sensor (Figure 1) but may
occur with the front sensors as well. If this occurs, the symptom will typically be the vehicle leaning
to one side, the vehicle sitting too low/high, a harsh ride, and/or an inoperative air suspension. In
addition, this concern may result in diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1725 (air suspension front
pneumatic failure) or C1726 (air suspension rear pneumatic failure).
ACTION When a linkage arm becomes disengaged, do not re-attach the arm and do not replace
the sensor unless broken. Instead, install a revised linkage arm on all three (3) sensor assemblies,
even if they have not detached from the ball stud. Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Ride Height Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height
Sensor Linkage Loose > Page 2265
NOTE
LINKAGE ARMS USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT ARE SHOWN IN FIGURE 2. REVISED
LINKAGE ARMS (FIGURE 3) HAVE A NEW DESIGN THAT MAKES IT MORE DIFFICULT TO
DISENGAGE FROM THE BALL STUDS.
NOTE
IF THE SENSOR ASSEMBLY NEEDS TO BE REPLACED FOR ANY DAMAGE/FAILURE OTHER
THAN THE ONE DESCRIBED IN THIS TSB, THE REPLACEMENT ASSEMBLY IS SUPPLIED
WITH A NEW STYLE LINKAGE ARM, SO THERE IS NO NEED TO ORDER ADDITIONAL
LINKAGES FOR THE SERVICE REPAIR.
1. Replace linkage arms on all three (3) sensor assemblies following Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 204-05.
2. Discard the old linkage arms.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061510A 2003-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Three Linkage Arms, Includes Time To Check Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (Do Not Use With 5300A, 5300A7, 5300A8)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
5A967 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2266
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
Front Height Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2267
Rear Height Sensor
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH quarter trim panel. Failure to do so may result in unexpected
inflation or deflation of the air springs, which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these
operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All sensors
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the sensor arm from the
vehicle.
Front sensor
3. Remove and discard the 2 sensor nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
Rear sensor
4. Remove and discard the sensor nuts and bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
All sensors
5. Disconnect the sensor electrical connector.
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensors cannot be used on opposite sides of the vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the height sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2271
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Suspension Mode Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Suspension Mode Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2275
C4169
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Sensor Training (Reset Procedure)
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system is not affected by wheel and tire rotation.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency (RF) noise.
RF noise is generated by electrical motor and appliance operation, cellular telephones and remote
transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 2. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to
the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
3. Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
6. The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if train mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center displays
"TRAIN LF TIRE", place the special tool on the valve stem of the LF tire pressure sensor. The horn
will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the TPMS
module.
7. Within 2 minutes after the horn sounds, place the special tool on the valve stem of the RF tire
pressure sensor.
NOTE: If the VSM (TPMS module integral to VSM) does not recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure
sensors during the tire training procedure, the horn will sound twice and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT" and the procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
When the tire training procedure is complete, the horn will sound once and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPLETE".
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2280
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Sensor
Special Tools
CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2281
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
Removal
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) will
not operate correctly if black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not remove the valve stem core to relieve the tire pressure.
CAUTION: If the valve stem core has been removed from the valve stem, reinstall the original valve
stem core. If the original valve stem core is damaged, a nickel-plated core must be installed.
Failure to use a nickel-plated core will result in corrosion and the possible loss of tire pressure.
NOTE: Release the tire pressure by removing the sensor valve stem nut.
With the valve stem at the 6 o'clock position, remove the sensor valve stem nut and push the
sensor by hand into the tire (with the cap on).
3. Using a suitable tire machine, separate both beads of the tire from the wheel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2282
4. CAUTION: Care should be taken not to damage the tire pressure sensor while separating the
outside bead of tire from the wheel.
Place the wheel and tire on the turntable of the tire machine, index-mark the valve stem and wheel
weight positions, lubricate the bead of the tire and dismount the outside bead of the tire from the
wheel.
5. Remove the tire pressure sensor from the tire. 6. Remove and discard the grommet from the tire
pressure sensor.
Installation
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The TPM's will not operate correctly if
black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. NOTE: Install a new sensor grommet or an air leak can occur.
Install a new grommet on the tire pressure sensor.
2. NOTE: Do not allow the tire to rotate relative to the rim while mounting the tire.
Lubricate and mount the outside and inside bead of the tire to the rim.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2283
3. CAUTION: Overtightening the tire pressure sensor valve stem nut can damage the tire pressure
sensor, undertightening can cause air leaks.
NOTE: Sensor position is critical for correct sensor operation. The "flat" side of the sensor must be
facing the wheel and the "slanted" side of the sensor must be facing away from the wheel. When
properly installed, there will be a very small gap between the sensor and the wheel.
NOTE: Tightening the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs.) equals approximately 2 clockwise turns after the
nut has been tightened by hand.
Push the side wall of the tire and install the tire pressure sensor. Tighten the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch
lbs.).
4. CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2284
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
CAUTION: Use only OEM valve caps (aluminum or plastic valve caps) with the tire pressure
sensors. Do not use brass-threaded valve caps with the tire pressure sensors.
Inflate the tire to the pressure specified on the safety certification sticker located on the driver or
door pillar.
5. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 6. Train the tire pressure sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2291
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2292
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2293
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2294
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2295
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2296
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2297
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2298
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2299
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2300
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2301
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2302
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2303
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2304
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2305
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2306
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
2307
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2308
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2314
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2315
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2316
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2317
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2318
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2319
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2320
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2321
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2322
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2323
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2324
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2325
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2326
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2327
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2328
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2329
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2330
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 2331
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2336
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2337
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2338
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2339
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2340
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2341
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2342
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2343
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2344
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2345
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2346
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2347
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2348
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2349
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2350
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2351
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2352
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2357
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2358
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2359
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2360
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2361
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2362
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2363
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2364
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2365
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2366
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2367
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2368
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2369
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2370
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2371
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2372
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2373
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2374
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2378
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2381
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2382
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2383
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2384
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2385
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2386
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2387
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2388
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2389
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2390
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2391
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2392
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2393
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2394
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2395
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2396
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2397
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2398
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2399
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
4R70E/4R75E Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Adjustment
Special Tools
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual lever shift control cable.
3. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2400
4. Loosen the digital transmission range (TR) sensor bolts.
5. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
6. CAUTION: Tightening one bolt before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor and tighten the bolts in an alternating sequence.
^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Install the manual control lever.
^ Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual lever shaft outer nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2401
8. With the manual lever in overdrive connect the shift lever control cable. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2402
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tools
Removal
NOTE: Manual shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2403
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual control lever shift control cable.
3. Disconnect the digital TR electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
5. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the digital TR sensor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2404
1. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
2. Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
3. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2405
5. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
6. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS)
Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS)
Sensor > Page 2410
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS)
Sensor > Page 2411
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS)
Sensor > Page 2412
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2415
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2416
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2417
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2418
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2419
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2420
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2421
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2422
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2423
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2424
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2425
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2426
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2427
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2428
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2429
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2430
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2431
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2432
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Views
C193
C143
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2433
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Speed Sensors
Speed Sensors
NOTE: Only remove the affected sensor.
Removal All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist,
OSS sensor
2. Disconnect the output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the OSS
sensor bolt. 4. Remove the OSS sensor.
TSS sensor
5. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the TSS
sensor bolt. 7. Remove the TSS sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2434
Installation TSS sensor
1. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the TSS sensor. 2. Install the TSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
OSS sensor
4. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the OSS sensor. 5. Install the OSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
6. Connect the OSS sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2439
C284
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2445
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2446
View 151-30 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2447
View 151-31 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2448
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
C504a
C504b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2451
C3193a
C3193b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2452
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Window Adjust Switch, Left Rear
C701
C717
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2453
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Window Adjust Switch, Right Rear
C801
C819
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2454
C624
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2455
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Quarter Window Switch
C998
C999
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2458
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2459
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2460
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Quarter Window Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2461
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2462
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2463
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2464
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 2465
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2466
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
WINDOW CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
Navigator front
1. Lift up on the center console armrest.
2. Remove the center console window control switch panel.
- Remove the pin-type retainer.
3. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the window control switch.
- Release the locking tabs.
Expedition front and Expedition passenger rear
NOTE: Driver side Expedition shown, all others similar.
4. Remove the window control switch panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2467
5. Disconnect the electrical connector(s) and remove the window control switch.
- Release the locking tabs.
Navigator passenger rear
6. Remove the rear door trim panel. 7. Remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
All vehicles
8. To install, reverse removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2472
C138
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2476
Windshield Washer Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2477
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2478
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2479
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2480
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade
Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Climate Control System)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade
Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2484
C2323
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2488
Wiper Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2489
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2490
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2491
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2492
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications
Total
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications Total
ALIGNMENT SPECIFICATIONS
FRONT COIL SPRING SUSPENSION
CAMBER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... -0.3° ± 0.75° RH ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. -0.3° ± 0.75°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
CASTER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 5.3° ± 1.0° RH ...........................................................................
...................................................................................................................................... 5.3° ± 1.0°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
TOE @ CURB RIDE HEIGHT
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... --- RH ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. --Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0.14° ± 0.20°
NOTE: Positive value is toe-in, negative value is toe-out.
FRONT AIR SUSPENSION
CAMBER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
............................................ -0.6°/ -0.3° ± 0.75° RH ............................................................................
....................................................................................................................... -0.6°/ -0.3° ± 0.75°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
CASTER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 5.5°/5.4° ± 1.0° RH ............................................................................
............................................................................................................................. 5.5°/5.4° ± 1.0°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
TOE @ TRIM RIDE HEIGHT
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... --- RH ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. --Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0.14° ± 0.20°
NOTE: Positive value is toe-in, negative value is toe-out.
REAR COIL SPRING SUSPENSION
CAMBER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... -0.9° ± 0.75° RH ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. -0.9° ± 0.75°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
TOE @ CURB RIDE HEIGHT
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... --- RH ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. --Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0.20° ± 0.20°
NOTE: Positive value is toe-in, negative value is toe-out.
REAR AIR SUSPENSION
CAMBER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... -1.0° ± 0.75° RH ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. -1.0° ± 0.75°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
TOE @ TRIM RIDE HEIGHT
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... --- RH ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. --Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0.20° ± 0.20°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications
Total > Page 2498
NOTE: Positive value is toe-in, negative value is toe-out.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications
Total > Page 2499
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 2500
Alignment: Description and Operation
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie-rods. The rear camber is adjusted by positioning the upper
arm-to-knuckle bolt in the upper arm-to-knuckle slot. The rear toe is adjusted by the use of the rear
toe links.
Camber
Negative and Positive Camber
Camber is the vertical tilt of the wheel when viewed from the front. Camber can be positive or
negative and has a direct effect on tire wear.
Caster
Caster
Caster is the deviation from vertical of an imaginary line drawn through the ball joints when viewed
from the side. The caster specifications will give the vehicle the best directional stability
characteristics when loaded and driven. The caster setting does not effect tire wear.
Toe
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 2501
Positive Toe (Toe In)
Negative Toe (Toe Out)
The vehicle toe setting: ^
affects tire wear and directional stability.
^ must be checked after adding aftermarket equipment, such as a snowplow.
Ride Height
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim height prior to measuring the vehicle ride height.
Front Ride Height Measurement
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 2502
Rear Ride Height Measurement
Wheel Track
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 2503
Dogtracking
Dogtracking is the condition in which the rear axle is not square to the chassis. Heavily crowned
roads can give the illusion of dogtracking.
Wander
Wander is the tendency of the vehicle to require frequent, random left and right steering wheel
corrections to maintain a straight path down a level road.
Shimmy
Shimmy, as observed by the driver, is large, consistent, rotational oscillations of the steering wheel
resulting from large, side-to-side (lateral) tire/wheel movements. Shimmy is usually experienced
near 64 km/h (40 mph), and can begin or be amplified when the tire contacts pot holes or
irregularities in the road surface.
Nibble
Sometimes confused with shimmy, nibble is a condition resulting from tire interaction with various
road surfaces or tire imbalance. This condition is observed by the driver as small rotational
oscillations of the steering wheel.
Poor Returnability/Sticky Steering
Poor returnability and sticky steering is used to describe the poor return of the steering wheel to
center after a turn or when the steering correction is completed.
Drift/Pull
Pull is a tugging sensation, felt by the hands on the steering wheel, that must be overcome to keep
the vehicle going straight. Drift describes what a vehicle with this condition does with hands off the
steering wheel. ^
A vehicle-related drift/pull, on a flat road, will cause a consistent deviation from the straight-ahead
path and require constant steering input in the opposite direction to counteract the effect
^ Drift/Pull may be induced by conditions external to the vehicle (such as wind or road camber).
Poor Groove Feel
Poor groove feel is, characterized by little or no buildup of turning effort felt in the steering wheel as
the wheel is rocked slowly left and right within very small turns around center or straight-ahead
(under 20 degrees of steering wheel turn). Efforts may be said to be "flat on center." ^
Under 20 degrees of turn, most of the turning effort that builds up comes from the mesh of gear
teeth in the steering gear. In this range, the steering wheel is not yet turned enough to feel the
effort from the self-aligning forces at the road wheel or tire patch.
^ In the diagnosis of a steering or alignment concern, it is important to understand the difference
between wander and poor groove feel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment Front
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber and Caster Adjustment Front
Camber and Caster Adjustment Front
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the front caster and
camber.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the caster and camber values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Remove and discard the lower arm front and rear nuts and bolts.
3. NOTE: New lower arm front and rear bolts must be installed with cam bolt kits (2L1Z-3B236-AC
for front bushing; and 2L1Z-3B236-AD for
rear bushing), to allow for adjustment of the arm in the frame slot. The vehicle should be supported
by the frame to ease movement of the lower arm in the slot.
Install the cam bolt kit and loosely install the nut.
4. To adjust the caster and camber, refer to the following chart.
^ Adjustments that require moving the front and the rear of the lower arm should be made equally.
5. While holding the cam bolt, tighten the nut to 270 Nm (199 ft. lbs.). 6. Cheek and, if necessary,
adjust the front toe.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment Front > Page 2506
Alignment: Service and Repair Front Toe Adjustment
Front Toe Adjustment
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the front toe.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the front toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Start the engine and center the steering wheel. 3. Turn the engine off and, using a suitable
steering wheel holding device, lock the steering wheel in the straight-ahead position.
4. Remove the steering gear bellows clamp(s).
5. Loosen the tie-rod end jam nut(s).
6. NOTE: Do not allow the steering gear bellows to twist while rotating the tie-rod.
Rotate the tie-rod(s) to achieve the desired toe setting.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment Front > Page 2507
7. CAUTION: Make sure to hold the tie-rod end stationary while tightening the jam nut or damage
to the boot can occur.
NOTE: Make sure that the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the jam nuts.
Tighten the tie-rod end jam nut(s) to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the steering gear bellows clamp(s). 9. Start the engine and center the steering wheel.
^ Recheck the toe settings and adjust as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment Front > Page 2508
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment - Rear
Camber Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the rear caster.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the rear caster value is not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Determine desired camber adjustment (subtract the specified camber angle from the measured
camber angle).
3. Mark a scribe line on the upper arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt head and upper arm.
Desired Camber Adjustment (In Degrees) (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment Front > Page 2509
Desired Camber Adjustment (In Degrees) (Part 2)
4. Use the following table to determine the camber adjustment required. Obtained by subtracting
the specified camber angle from the measure
camber angle.
5. Remove the upper arm-to-knuckle nut and install a new one until snug.
6. NOTE: Support the vehicle at the lower arm to ease the wheel knuckle movement in the upper
arm slot.
Position the upper arm-to-knuckle bolt in the upper arm slot as required to adjust the camber angle
to the value obtained in Step 4.
7. Tighten the upper arm-to-knuckle nut to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.). 8. Recheck the camber setting,
adjust as necessary. 9. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear toe.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment Front > Page 2510
Alignment: Service and Repair Rear Toe Adjustment
Rear Toe Adjustment
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the rear toe.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the rear toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Loosen the toe link jam nut(s).
3. Rotate the toe link tie-rod to achieve the desired toe setting.
4. NOTE: Make sure the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the jam nuts.
Tighten the toe link jam nut(s) to 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs.).
5. Recheck the rear toe setting, adjust as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment Front > Page 2511
Alignment: Service and Repair Ride Height Adjustments
Ride Height Adjustments
Special Tools
Inflation and Deflation of the Air Suspension System
1. NOTE: Make sure that the air suspension switch is in the ON position.
NOTE: Make sure that a battery voltage of at least 11 volts is maintained while carrying out this
procedure.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2. Connect the diagnostic tool to the data link connector (DLC). 3. Select Air Suspension Control
Module under Active Command Mode. 4. Follow the diagnostic tool directions to lift or vent the front
or rear suspension.
Calibration Ride Height Resetting
1. NOTE: Make sure that the air suspension switch is in the ON position.
NOTE: Make sure that a battery voltage of at least 11 volts is maintained while carrying out this
procedure.
Turn the ignition to the OFF position. Exit the vehicle, close all doors and allow the system to vent
the vehicle down to kneel height (approximately 45 seconds).
2. With the ignition in the ON position, shift the vehicle into DRIVE and then back to PARK. Exit the
vehicle, close all doors and allow the vehicle
to pump to trim (approximately 45 seconds).
3. Measure the ride height. 4. Open the LF door. 5. Connect the diagnostic tool to the data link
connector (DLC). 6. While outside of the vehicle, select the correct vehicle year, model and engine
type. 7. Select vehicle dynamic module (VDM). 8. Using the active command mode, vent or lift the
vehicle to achieve the correct ride height. 9. Select the "Save Calibration Values (Store Ride
Height)" diagnostic tool command to calibrate the VDM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
Key on, engine off.................................................................................................................................
.............................................240-310 kPa (35-45 psi) Engine running.................................................
..................................................................................................................................193-310 kPa
(28-45 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information >
Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Measured/PID Values
Hot Idle Speed .....................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 600-650 RPM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner
Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER INTAKE PIPE
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air cleaner element.
2. Reach into the opening of the air cleaner assembly and depress the locking tab on the air
cleaner intake pipe to release the air cleaner intake pipe
from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner
Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2523
3. Remove the air cleaner intake tube assembly.
4. CAUTION: The air cleaner intake pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unusual engine
noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Release the retaining clips and remove the air cleaner element tray. 2. Remove the air cleaner
element from the air cleaner element tray.
3. CAUTION: The air cleaner element tray must be fully seated to the air cleaner housing. Failure
to do so will result in unusual engine
noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: The electrical connector is located on the LH frame rail under the driver side door.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Start the engine and allow it to idle until it stalls. 4. After the engine stalls, crank the engine for
approximately 5 seconds to make sure the fuel rail pressure has been released. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the OFF position.
6. When fuel system service is complete, connect the electrical connector.
7. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
8. Install the diagnostic tool. Turn the key ON with the engine OFF. Cycle the key OFF, then ON.
Select the appropriate vehicle and engine qualifier.
Clear all diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and carry out a PCM reset.
9. Start the vehicle and check the fuel system for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Eight separate ignition coils:
- are mounted directly above each spark plug.
- are controlled by the powertrain control module (PCM) for correct firing sequence.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Number One
Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Item ......................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Specification
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Eight separate ignition coils:
- are mounted directly above each spark plug.
- are controlled by the powertrain control module (PCM) for correct firing sequence.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2542
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2543
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2544
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2545
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2546
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2547
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2548
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2549
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2550
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2551
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2552
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Spark Plug Gap
Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Gap
Spark Plug Gap
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.040 - 0.050 inch (1.02 - 1.27 mm)
NOTE: Spark plug gap not adjustable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Spark Plug Gap > Page 2555
Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Torque
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
................................................... 34 Nm (25.0 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2556
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark Plug ...........................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... PZT-2F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2557
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Engine Ignition - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2558
Engine Ignition - LH
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug.
2. NOTE:
- Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before removing the
spark plugs.
- If an original spark plug is used, make sure it is installed in the same cylinder from which it was
taken. New spark plugs can be used in any cylinder.
Remove the spark plugs. To install, tighten to 34 Nm (25 lb-ft).
3. Inspect the spark plugs. Install new spark plugs as necessary. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 1)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 2)
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75 percent of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit
Chart.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 2562
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test-Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of five compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test-Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75 percent of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit
Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 1)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 2)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 2563
Compression Test-Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty. 2. If compression does not
improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly. 3. If two adjacent cylinders indicate low
compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does not increase compression, the head
gasket may
be leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75 percent of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
This engine is equipped with hydraulic valve lifters. No adjustment is required.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Locations
Drive Belt: Locations
Accessory Drive
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Locations > Page 2570
Drive Belt: Diagrams
Accessory Drive
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Locations > Page 2571
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
Accessory Drive
The accessory drive system:
- has a single serpentine drive belt (6 ribs). - has 3 idler pulleys. - has an automatic belt tensioner. is not adjustable.
The accessory drive system provides power to operate components which power other systems.
These could include components such as the generator, power steering pump, and A/C
compressor. Each of these components is equipped with a pulley which is driven by the accessory
drive belt. The accessory drive belt is driven by the engine crankshaft pulley. One or more idler
pulleys may be provided to facilitate belt routing and alignment. The automatic belt tensioner
maintains correct belt tension and compensates for component wear and changes in system load.
System load changes can be caused by the A/C compressor clutch engaging and disengaging, or
demand changes on other systems powered by the accessory drive belt. To maintain correct
operation of this stem, it is critical that the correct length drive belt be installed. The pulleys must
also be correctly aligned and kept clean.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview
Drive Belt: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Accessory Drive
Inspection and Verification
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys be
lubricated as potential damage to the belt material and tensioner damping mechanism will occur.
Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
1. Verify the customer concern by operating the system. 2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of
mechanical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
3. Eliminate all other non-belt related noises that could cause belt misdiagnosis, such as A/C
compressor engagement chirp, power steering
cavitations at low temperatures, variable camshaft timing (VCT) tick or generator whine.
4. If a concern is found, correct the condition before proceeding to the next step.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Drive Belt With Cracks Across Ribs
5. NOTE: Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be considered
acceptable. If damage exceeds the acceptable limit or
any chunks are found to be missing from the ribs, a new belt must be installed.
Check the belt for cracks. Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be
considered acceptable. If cracks exceed this standard, install a new belt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2574
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Piling
6. The condition of the V-ribbed drive belt should be compared against the illustration and
appropriate action taken.
1 Small scattered deposits of rubber material. This is not a concern, therefore, installation of a new
belt is not required.
2 Longer deposit areas building up to 50 percent of the rib height. This is not considered a concern
but it can result in excessive noise. If noise is apparent, install a new belt.
3 Heavy deposits building up along the grooves resulting in a possible noise and belt stability
concern. If heavy deposits are apparent, install a new belt.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Chunks of Rib Missing
7. There should be no chunks missing from the belt ribs. If the belt shows any evidence of this,
install a new accessory drive belt. 8. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom and
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2575
Drive Belt: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2576
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2577
Drive Belt: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Component Tests
Drive Belt Noise/Flutter
Drive belt chirp occurs due to pulley misalignment or excessive pulley runout. It can be the result of
a damaged or an incorrectly aligned grooved pulley.
To correct, determine the area where the noise comes from. Check each of the pulleys in that area
with a straightedge to the crankshaft pulley. Look for accessory pulleys out of position in the fore/aft
direction or at an angle to the straightedge.
CAUTION: Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
Drive belt squeal may be an intermittent or constant noise that occurs when the drive belt slips on
an accessory pulley under certain conditions.
A short intermittent squeal may occur during engine start-up and shut down or during very rapid
engine acceleration and decelerations, such as: ^
wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts or 2-3 and 3-4 back out shifts on automatic transmissions.
^ wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts and any combination of rapid downshifting on manual
transmissions.
These special short-term transient events are expected, and are due to the higher system inertias
required to meet the electrical and cooling demands on today's vehicle systems. Constant or
re-occurring drive belt squeal can occur under these conditions: ^
if the A/C discharge pressure goes above specifications:
^ the A/C system is overcharged.
^ the A/C condenser core airflow is blocked.
^ if the A/C OFF equalized pressure (the common discharged and suction pressure that occurs
after several minutes) exceeds specifications.
^ if any of the accessories are damaged or have a worn or damaged bearing. All accessories
should be rotatable by hand in the unloaded condition, if not, inspect the accessory.
^ if there is evidence of fluid contamination on the accessory drive belt. When the drive belt has
been exposed to fluid contamination during vehicle operation, such as leaks from the power
steering system, A/C system or cooling system, clean all pulleys with soap and water, rinse with
clean water and install a new accessory drive belt. If the drive belt has been exposed to fluids in a
localized area during routine vehicle service, such as replacement of hoses or fluids, the drive belt
and pulleys should be washed with soap and water immediately (prior to starting the engine), and
rinsed with clean water.
^ if the accessory drive belt is too long. A drive belt that is too long will allow the accessory drive
belt tensioner arm to go all the way to the arm travel stop under certain load conditions, which will
release tension to the drive belt. If the accessory drive belt tensioner indicator is outside the normal
installation wear range window, install a new accessory drive belt.
^ NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner arm should rotate freely without binding.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if the drive belt tensioner is worn or damaged.
Incorrect Drive Belt Installation
CAUTION: Incorrect accessory drive belt installation will cause excessive drive belt wear and can
cause the drive belt to come off the pulleys.
Non-standard accessory drive belts can track differently or incorrectly. If an accessory drive belt
tracks incorrectly, install a new accessory drive belt to avoid performance failure or loss of the drive
belt.
Incorrect Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2578
Correct Installation
With the engine running, check accessory drive belt tracking on all pulleys. If the edge of the
accessory drive belt rides beyond the edge of the pulleys, noise and premature wear will occur.
Make sure the accessory drive belt rides correctly on the pulley. If an accessory drive belt tracking
condition exists, proceed with these steps: ^
Visually check the accessory drive belt tensioner for damage, especially the mounting pad surface.
If the accessory drive belt tensioner is not installed correctly, the mounting surface pad will be out
of position. This will result in chirp and squeal noises.
^ With the engine running, visually observe the grooves in the pulleys (not the pulley flanges or the
pulley forward faces) for excessive wobble. Install new components as necessary.
^ Check all accessories, mounting brackets and the accessory drive belt tensioner for any
interference that would prevent the component from mounting correctly. Correct any interference
condition and recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
Tighten all accessories, mounting brackets and accessory drive belt tensioner retaining hardware
to specification. Recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
The only mechanical check that needs to be made is a check for tensioner stick grab or bind. 1.
With the engine OFF, check routing of the accessory drive belt.
2. NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner spring is very strong and requires substantial force to
release.
Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, release the tension
on the belt and detach the accessory drive belt in the area of the tensioner.
3. Using the suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, move the
tensioner from its relaxed position, through its full
stroke and back to the relaxed position to make sure there is no stick, grab or bind, and to make
sure that there is tension on the tensioner spring.
4. Rotate the tensioner pulley by hand and check for a binding, contaminated or seized condition.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if
necessary.
5. Inspect the area surrounding the accessory drive belt tensioner for oil leaks or contamination
and repair any leaks. Install a new accessory drive
belt tensioner as necessary.
6. If the accessory drive belt tensioner meets the above criteria, proceed to testing the tensioner
dynamically. If the accessory drive belt tensioner
does not meet the above criteria, install a new tensioner.
Belt Tensioner - Dynamics
The accessory drive belt tensioner can be checked dynamically as follows: 1. With the engine
running, observe the accessory drive belt tensioner movement. The accessory drive tensioner
should move (respond) when the air
conditioning clutch cycles (if equipped), or when the engine is accelerated rapidly. If the accessory
drive belt tensioner movement is excessive without air conditioning clutch cycling or engine
acceleration, check belt rideout. Excessive belt rideout (uneven depth of grooves in the belt) can
cause excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement. Check rideout condition by installing a
new belt. If excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement still exists, install a new accessory
drive belt tensioner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2579
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
Accessory Drive
Removal
1. Rotate the drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the drive belt.
Installation
1. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER INTAKE PIPE
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air cleaner element.
2. Reach into the opening of the air cleaner assembly and depress the locking tab on the air
cleaner intake pipe to release the air cleaner intake pipe
from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2585
3. Remove the air cleaner intake tube assembly.
4. CAUTION: The air cleaner intake pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unusual engine
noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Release the retaining clips and remove the air cleaner element tray. 2. Remove the air cleaner
element from the air cleaner element tray.
3. CAUTION: The air cleaner element tray must be fully seated to the air cleaner housing. Failure
to do so will result in unusual engine
noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cabin Air Filter: Service and Repair
NOTE: The air distribution system of this vehicle cannot be equipped with a cabin air filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter
Special Tools
Transmission Fluid In-line Filter with an OTA cooler
NOTE: Use the following guidelines for installing the transmission fluid in-line filter: ^
If the transmission was overhauled and the vehicle was equipped with an in-line fluid filter, install a
new in-line fluid filter.
^ If the transmission was overhauled and the vehicle was not equipped with an in-line fluid filter,
install a new in-line fluid filter kit.
^ If the transmission is being installed for a non-internal repair, do not install an in-line filter or filter
kit.
^ If installing a new or a Ford-authorized remanufactured transmission, install the in-line
transmission fluid filter that is supplied.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. If equipped, remove the bolts and the skid plate.
3. Remove the section of the rubber hose and steel line as illustrated.
^ Clean and de-burr the end of the steel line.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 2596
4. NOTE: Be sure the cooler tube is fully seated in the body of the fitting before final tightening of
the ferrule nut.
Install the tubing ferrule hose assembly connector onto the end of the steel fluid cooler tube.
Finger-tighten the ferrule nut, then tighten the nut an additional 1-1/2 turns to seat the ferrule in the
connector.
5. CAUTION: The filter has a bypass valve in it. The red arrow on the filter indicates the direction of
fluid flow through the filter. The filter must
be installed in the fluid cooler return line with the red arrow on the filter pointing away from the
transmission fluid cooler and toward the transmission (the return line has fluid coming out of the
cooler going to the transmission). If the fluid filter is not installed correctly, it will cause internal
transmission damage.
CAUTION: Do not install any rubber hoses or steel tubing with a bend entering the filter greater
than 60 degrees.
Using a suitable length of hose install the filter. Tighten the hose clamps.
6. Clean a section of the transmission fluid pan and install the sticker.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 2597
7. If equipped, install the skid plate and the bolts. 8. Fill the transmission with clean automatic
transmission fluid.
^ Verify for correct operation.
^ Check the filter for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 2598
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter - Without an OTA Cooler
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Transmission Fluid In-line Filter - without an OTA cooler
NOTE: Use the following guidelines for installing the transmission fluid in-line filter: ^
If the transmission was overhauled and the vehicle was equipped with an in-line fluid filter, install a
new in-line fluid filter.
^ If the transmission was overhauled and the vehicle was not equipped with an in-line fluid filter,
install a new in-line fluid filter kit.
^ If the transmission is being installed for a non-internal repair, do not install an in-line filter or filter
kit.
^ If installing a new or a Ford-authorized remanufactured transmission, install the in-line
transmission fluid filter that is supplied.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the cooler tubes retainers.
3. Remove the section of the steel tube as illustrated.
^ Clean and de-burr the end of the steel tubes.
4. NOTE: Be sure the cooler tube is fully seated in the body of the fitting before final tightening of
the ferrule nut.
Install the tubing ferrule hose assembly connector onto the end of the steel fluid cooler tubes.
Finger-tighten the ferrule nut, then tighten the nut an additional 1-1/2 turns to seat the ferrule in the
connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 2599
5. CAUTION: The filter has a bypass valve in it. The red arrow on the filter indicates the direction of
fluid flow through the filter. The filter must
be installed in the fluid cooler return line with the red arrow on the filter pointing away from the
transmission fluid cooler and toward the transmission (the return line has fluid coming out of the
cooler going to the transmission). If the fluid filter is not installed correctly, it will cause internal
transmission damage.
CAUTION: Do not install any rubber hoses or steel tubing with a bend entering the filter greater
than 60 degrees.
Using a suitable length of hose install the filter. Tighten the hose clamps.
6. Install one cooler tube retainer as Illustrated.
7. Secure the cooler tubes together with a tie strap.
8. Clean a section of the transmission fluid pan and install the sticker. 9. Fill the transmission with
clean automatic transmission fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 2600
^ Verify for correct operation.
^ Check the filter for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 2601
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
Material
Removal
CAUTION: Do not use any supplemental transmission fluid additives or cleaning agents. The use
of these products could cause internal transmission components to fail; this will effect the operation
of the transmission. Use of a fluid other than specified could result in transmission failure.
NOTE: Normal maintenance requires periodic automatic transmission fluid changes. If a major
repair, such as a clutch, band, bearing, etc., is required, the automatic transmission will need to be
removed for repair. The transmission fluid needs to be changed if evidence of fluid contamination is
found.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Drain transmission fluid.
^ Loosen the transmission fluid pan bolts and allow fluid to drain. After fluid is drained remove the
bolts.
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and transmission fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 2602
4. Pull down evenly and remove the transmission fluid filter and seal.
5. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan, gasket and magnet.
Installation
1. CAUTION: If installing a new filter and the seal remains in the main control bore, carefully use a
small screwdriver to remove the seal. Use care
not to damage the main control bore.
NOTE: If transmission is being repaired for a contamination related failure, use a new filter and
seal. The filter may be reused if no excessive contamination is present.
Install a new fluid filter and seal as required.
2. Position the pan magnet into the transmission fluid pan.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 2603
3. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket is reusable.
Clean and inspect for damage; if not damaged, the gasket should be reused. ^
Install the transmission fluid pan and gasket.
1 Position the transmission fluid pan and gasket.
2 Install the transmission fluid pan bolts.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.).
4. NOTE: When filling a dry transmission and converter, start with a minimum of 4.7 liters (5
quarts).
Fill the transmission to the correct level with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and
Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: The electrical connector is located on the LH frame rail under the driver side door.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Start the engine and allow it to idle until it stalls. 4. After the engine stalls, crank the engine for
approximately 5 seconds to make sure the fuel rail pressure has been released. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the OFF position.
6. When fuel system service is complete, connect the electrical connector.
7. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
8. Install the diagnostic tool. Turn the key ON with the engine OFF. Cycle the key OFF, then ON.
Select the appropriate vehicle and engine qualifier.
Clear all diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and carry out a PCM reset.
9. Start the vehicle and check the fuel system for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: Customer Interest A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 2617
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 2618
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
2624
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
2625
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Hose Coupling
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Hose Coupling
HEATER HOSE COUPLING
Remover, Heater Hose Inlet Tube
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect
1. WARNING: The engine must be off, fully cool and the cooling system fully depressurized before
attempting to disconnect any heater
water hoses. Failure to comply with this warning can result in serious injury or burns from hot liquid
escaping out of the engine cooling system.
Depressurize the engine cooling system.
2. Push the heater water hose toward the tube to fully expose the locking tabs.
3. NOTE: When compressing the white coupling retainer, the Heater Hose Disconnect Tool must
be perpendicular to and on the highest point of the
coupling.
Push the special tool over the coupling retainer windows to compress the retainer locking tabs.
4. NOTE: A slight twisting motion while pulling on the heater water hose may be necessary to
assist in the removal.
Pull the heater water hose away from the heater core tube.
5. Plug the heater water hose. 6. Remove the white coupling retainer from the tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Hose Coupling > Page 2628
7. Spread the retainer tabs apart and slide the retainer off the tube. 8. Discard the retainer.
Connect
1. Clean the tubes and lubricate with MERPOL(R) meeting Ford specification ESE-M99B144-B or
plain water.
2. Install a new coupling retainer, spacer, and lubricated O-ring seals into the quick disconnect
coupling housing.
3. Push the heater water hose with a quick disconnect coupling onto the tube. 4. Make sure the
coupling is fully engaged by lightly pulling on the heater water hose.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Hose Coupling > Page 2629
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Outlet and Inlet Line
AUXILIARY HEATER OUTLET AND INLET LINE
Removal
CAUTION: To avoid refrigerant loss, clearly differentiate the auxiliary heater lines from the auxiliary
refrigerant lines before beginning this procedure.
NOTE:
- The auxiliary heater inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly. The auxiliary
heater inlet line and outlet line are each installed from the factory as 1-piece assemblies. The
replacement parts are supplied as separate kits containing multiple piece lines for ease of
installation.
- The following procedure can be used to remove and install 1 or both the auxiliary heater inlet and
auxiliary heater outlet lines. If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed and installed, cut or
disconnect only the desired line at the specified points within the procedure.
1. Drain the engine coolant. 2. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
3. Detach the auxiliary heater lines.
1 Disconnect the heater hose(s).
2 Remove the 2 line bracket bolts.
3 Remove the line bracket.
4. Remove the spare tire. 5. Raise the vehicle. 6. Remove the RH front wheel. 7. Remove the RH
fender splash shield.
8. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the heater hose(s).
9. Remove the muffler.
10. Remove the RH catalytic converter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Hose Coupling > Page 2630
11. Remove the 3 bolts and the heat shield.
12. Remove the bolts.
13. Remove the nut and the line bracket.
14. Remove the bolt and the heat shield.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Hose Coupling > Page 2631
15. Remove the nuts and the remaining line brackets.
16. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary heater line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new line(s).
17. Remove the auxiliary heater line(s) in 3 separate pieces.
Installation
1. Partially lower the vehicle.
2. Attach the rear portion of the auxiliary heater lines.
1 Connect the heater hoses.
2 Install the line bracket.
3 Install the bolts.
3. Install the front auxiliary heater line(s) and connect the heater hose(s).
- Clean and lubricate the heater hoses with plain water only if needed.
4. Raise the vehicle.
5. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the middle auxiliary heater line(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Hose Coupling > Page 2632
6. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 line brackets.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
7. Tighten the middle auxiliary heater line fittings. 8. Inspect the auxiliary heater lines for correct
installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as needed.
9. Install the heat shield and the bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
10. Install the heat shield and the bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
11. Install the RH catalytic converter. 12. Install the muffler. 13. Partially lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Hose Coupling > Page 2633
14. Install the heat shield bolt.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
15. Install the line bracket.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Install the spare tire. 18. Install the RH quarter trim panel. 19. Fill the
engine coolant level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly
COMPRESSOR MANIFOLD AND TUBE ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
All vehicles
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Disconnect the negative and positive battery cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 2638
3. Disconnect the electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the pressure cutoff switch electrical
connector. 5. Remove the compressor manifold and tube suction fitting nut and disconnect the
fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Vehicles with auxiliary A/C
6. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles
7. Remove the compressor manifold and tube assembly discharge fitting nut and disconnect the
fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
8. Loosen the compressor manifold bolt and remove the compressor manifold and tube assembly.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
10. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 2639
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
AUXILIARY EVAPORATOR OUTLET AND INLET LINE
Removal
NOTE:
- The auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly. The
auxiliary evaporator inlet line and outlet line are each installed from the factory as 1-piece
assemblies. The replacement parts are supplied as separate kits containing multiple piece lines for
ease of installation.
- The following procedure can be used to remove and install 1 or both the auxiliary evaporator inlet
and auxiliary evaporator outlet lines. If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed and
installed, cut or disconnect only the desired line at the specified points within the procedure.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. NOTE: If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Remove the nut(s) and disconnect the A/C fitting(s).
3. Remove the RH quarter trim panel. 4. Remove the spare tire.
5. NOTE: Both A/C fittings must be disconnected even if only one line is to be removed.
Disconnect the A/C fittings. Install new O-rings seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 2640
6. Remove the bolts and the line bracket. 7. Raise the vehicle. 8. Remove the spare tire carrier
splash shield. 9. Remove the RH front wheel.
10. Remove the RH fender splash shield. 11. Remove the muffler. 12. Remove the RH catalytic
converter.
13. Remove the 3 bolts and the heat shield.
14. Remove the bolts.
15. Remove the nut and the line bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 2641
16. Remove the bolt and the heat shield.
17. Remove the nuts and the remaining line brackets.
18. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary evaporator line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary evaporator line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new
line(s).
19. Remove the auxiliary evaporator line(s) in 3 separate pieces.
Installation
1. Partially lower the vehicle to allow access to both the rear auxiliary line fittings and the underside
of the vehicle.
2. Position the rear portion of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) and install the line bracket and bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 2642
3. Connect the A/C fittings.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. Install the front auxiliary evaporator line(s) and connect the A/C fittings.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
5. Raise the vehicle.
6. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the middle auxiliary evaporator line(s).
7. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 line brackets.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 2643
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
8. Tighten the middle auxiliary evaporator line fittings. 9. Inspect the auxiliary evaporator lines for
correct installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as needed.
10. Install the heat shield and the bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
11. Install the heat shield and the bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
12. Install the RH catalytic converter. 13. Install the muffler. 14. Partially lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 2644
15. Install the heat shield bolt.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
16. Install the line bracket.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
17. Install the spare tire carrier splash shield. 18. Install the RH front fender splash shield. 19.
Install the RH front wheel. 20. Lower the vehicle. 21. Install the RH quarter trim panel. 22. Install
the spare tire. 23. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. 24.
Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure
Line
Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line - 4x4
Materials
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 2649
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 2650
Part 2
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
All vehicles
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH
quarter trim panel rear. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air
springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position, if equipped.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the engine cooling fan. 4.
Remove the power steering pump pulley. 5. Disconnect the power steering pressure line-to-pump
fitting. Discard the Teflon seal. ^
To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
7. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-crossmember bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
8. Disconnect the power steering pressure line from the frame rail retainers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 2651
9. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-engine nut.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
Expedition vehicles
10. If equipped disconnect the power steering pressure sensor electrical connector and detach the
harness retainer.
All vehicles
CAUTION: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the
steering gear.
11. Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt and the power steering pressure line. Discard
the O-ring seal.
1 To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Using the special tool, install a new Teflon O-ring seal on the power steering pressure
line-to-pump fitting.
^ Install a new O-ring seal on the clamp plate end of the power steering pressure line.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 2652
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Fluid Cooler to Power Steering
Fluid Reservoir Return Hose
Power Steering Fluid Cooler to Power Steering Fluid Reservoir Return Hose
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
All vehicles
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located near in the LH
rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air
springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position, if equipped.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Using a suitable suction device, remove
the power steering fluid from the reservoir. 4. Remove the 3 power steering reservoir bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
5. Release the clamp, and disconnect power steering return line from the reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 2653
Navigator vehicles
6. Remove the pushpins and the deflector shield.
All vehicles
7. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering return line from the power steering cooler.
8. Disconnect the power steering return line from the frame rail retainer and remove the line. 9. To
install, reverse the removal procedure. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 2654
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Materials
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 2655
Part 2
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
All vehicles
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH rear
quarter trim panel. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs,
which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position, if equipped.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Navigator vehicles
3. Remove the pushpins and the deflector shield.
All vehicles
4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering return line from the power steering cooler.
5. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 2656
CAUTION: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the
steering gear.
6. Remove the steering line clamp plate bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 28 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
^ Discard the steering line O-ring seals.
7. Disconnect the line from frame rail retainers and remove the return line. 8. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
^ Install a new O-ring seals.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Motorcraft High Performance DOT 3 Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... PM-1 Ford Specification ................................................
..................................................................................................................................... ESA-M6C25-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
COOLING SYSTEM
BASE RADIATOR
With aux rear heat ...............................................................................................................................
........................................ 20.7 quarts (19.6 liters) Without aux rear heat ...........................................
....................................................................................................................... 19.4 quarts (18.4 liters)
HEAVY DUTY TRAILER TOW RADIATOR
With aux rear heat ...............................................................................................................................
........................................ 20.9 quarts (19.8 liters) Without aux rear heat ...........................................
....................................................................................................................... 19.7 quarts (18.6 liters)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 2665
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE COOLANT
Motorcraft Premium Gold Engine Coolant (yellow-colored)
Ford P/N
............................................................................................................................................................
VC-7-A (U.S., except CA, OR and NM) Ford P/N ...............................................................................
.................................................................................................. VC-7-B (CA, OR and NM)
Ford Specification ................................................................................................................................
................................................ WSS-M97B51-A1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid ..............................................................................................................................
.............................................. 13.9 quarts (13.1 liters)
NOTE: Indicates only approximate dry-fill capacity. Some applications may vary based on cooler
size and if equipped with an in-tank cooler. The amount of transmission fluid and fluid level should
be set by the indication on the dipsticks normal operating range.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 2670
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid Type
Fluid Type ............................................................................................................................................
............................................. MERCON V XT-5-QM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
6HP26 Automatic Transmission Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
CAUTION: When internal damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch plate
material can travel into the torque converter and the transmission fluid cooler. These contaminates
are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent further concerns, remove these
contaminates from the cooler lines and install a new cooler before placing the transmission in use.
1. Install a new transmission fluid cooler if any fluid leak are indicated or a major metallic failure is
indicated. 2. Using a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner, flush the fluid cooler and lines.
3. NOTE: Rubber hoses must be attached to the ends of the fluid cooler tubes, to aid in connecting
them to the cleaner.
Connect the cleaner pressure and return lines appropriately. 1
Connect the pressure line to the fluid cooler inlet tube.
2 Connect the return line to the fluid cooler outlet tube.
3 Place the outlet end of the return line in the fluid tank reservoir.
4. NOTE: Cycling the fluid pump on and off will help dislodge contaminants in the cooler system.
Switch the fluid pumps on. Allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes.
5. Switch the fluid pump off. 6. Disconnect the cleaner pressure line at the fluid cooler tube. 7.
Using compressed air, blow through the fluid cooler inlet tube until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove
the rubber hoses from the fluid cooler tubes.
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Special Tools
Material
Drain
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission > Page 2673
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove and discard the fluid pan drain plug and allow the fluid to drain.
Refill
1. Install a new fluid pan drain plug.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
2. Remove the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case, near the transmission
electrical connector.
3. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission > Page 2674
transmission failure.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add 4.7 liters (5 quarts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid
fill hole. Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
4. Install the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case, near the transmission electrical
connector.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
5. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 6. With the special tool connected, the engine idling (600 - 750 rpm) in
PARK and the transmission temperature at 30°C - 50°C (86°F - 122°F),
check and adjust the transmission fluid level.
7. If more fluid is needed, remove the fluid fill plug on the side of the case and fill with clean
automatic transmission fluid until the fluid runs out of
the bottom of the hole.
Check Fluid Level and Condition
Check Fluid Level and Condition Fluid Level Check
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period at high highway speeds, in city
traffic, during hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the fluid must cool down to obtain an accurate
reading.
NOTE: The transmission fluid temperature must not be allowed to exceed 50°C (122°F) when
checking the fluid level.
The fluid temperature should be between 30°C - 50°C (86°F - 122°F) closer to 50°C (122°F) when
checking the fluid level. This vehicle is not equipped with a fluid level indicator. An incorrect level
may affect the transmission operation and can result in transmission failure. Under normal
circumstances, the fluid level should not be checked during normal maintenance. If the
transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level should be
checked. 1. With the transmission in P (PARK), the engine at idle (600 - 750 rpm) and foot pressed
on the brake, move the range selector lever through each
gear and allow engagement of each gear. Place the transmission range selector lever in the P
position.
2. With the engine idling (600 - 750 rpm) in PARK, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the fluid fill plug
located on the side of the transmission case. 4. Partially add fluid until fluid starts to come out. Wait
until the fluid stops or just drips from the hole. 5. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
High Fluid Level
CAUTION: A fluid level that is too high can cause the fluid to become aerated due to the churning
action of the rotating internal parts. This will
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission > Page 2675
cause erratic control pressure, foaming, loss of fluid from the vent tube and possible transmission
failure.
If an overfill reading is indicated, drain and refill the transmission.
Low Fluid Level
A low fluid level can result in poor transmission engagement, slipping or failure. This may also
indicate a leak in one of the transmission seals or gaskets.
Adding Fluid
CAUTION: The use of any other type of transmission fluid than specified can result in transmission
failure.
If fluid must be added, add fluid in 0.5 liter (1/2 quart)increments through the fluid fill plug. Do not
overfill the fluid. For fluid type, refer to the specification chart.
Fluid Condition Check
1. Check the fluid level. 2. Remove the fluid fill plug and allow the fluid to drip onto a facial tissue
and examine the stain.
3. NOTE: The transmission fluid could be 2 different colors. The factory fill fluid is clear. The
replacement fluid is red.
Observe the color and the odor. The color under normal circumstances should be dark reddish or
clear, not black or have a burnt odor.
4. If evidence of solid material is found, the transmission fluid pan should be removed for further
inspection. 5. If the stain is a foamy pink color, this may indicate coolant in the transmission. The
engine cooling system should also be inspected at this time. 6. If fluid contamination or
transmission failure is confirmed by the sediment in the bottom of the fluid pan, the transmission
must be disassembled
and completely cleaned. This includes the torque converter and fluid cooler tubes. A new oil-to-air
cooler must be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission > Page 2676
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
1. CAUTION: Do not use any supplemental transmission fluid additives or cleaning agents. The
use of these products could cause internal
transmission components to fail; this will effect the operation of the transmission.
Conduct backflushing with a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner. Test your equipment to
make sure that a vigorous fluid flow is present before proceeding. Install a new filter in the flush
equipment if flow is weak or contaminated.
2. If equipped, remove and discard the transmission fluid in-line filter. 3. Remove the transmission
fluid cooler bypass valve and install rubber hoses in its place. 4. To aid in attaching the cleaner to
the transmission steel cooler lines, connect 2 additional rubber hoses to the transmission end of
the steel
transmission cooler lines as described below. ^
Connect the cleaner tank pressure line to the steel transmission cooler return line (longest line).
^ Connect a tank return hose to the steel transmission cooler pressure line (shorter line). Place the
outlet end of this hose in the tank reservoir.
5. Turn on the pump and allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes (cycling switch on and
off will help dislodge contaminants in cooler
system).
6. Switch off the pump and disconnect the pressure hose from the transmission cooler return line.
7. Use compressed air to blow out the cooler(s) and lines (blow air into the transmission cooler
return line) until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove the rubber return hose from the remaining steel
cooler line. 9. Remove the rubber hoses and reinstall the transmission fluid cooler bypass valve.
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Special Tools
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission > Page 2677
special Tools
Draining, all vehicles using a suitable flush and fill machine
CAUTION: Always refer to the instructions supplied with the flush and fill machine.
NOTE: Draining fluid from the transmission by removing only the fluid pan is acceptable for normal
or severe duty fluid maintenance.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Use a suitable flush and fill machine to
change the fluid. 3. When connecting the flush and fill machine, connect the machine to the fluid
cooler tube after the fluid cooler on the cooler return line. This will
help remove any foreign material trapped in the fluid coolers.
Refill
1. Use only clean automatic transmission fluid. 2. Once the fluid exchange has been completed,
disconnect the flush and fill machine. Reconnect any disconnected fluid cooler tubes. 3. With the
engine running and the transmission at normal operating temperature 66 - 77°C (150 - 170°F),
check and adjust the transmission fluid
level and check for any leaks. If fluid is needed, add fluid in increments of 0.24 liter (0.5 pint) until
the correct level is achieved (fluid should be in the cross-hatched area of the fluid level indicator).
Draining, all vehicles not using a suitable flush and fill machine
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Loosen the transmission fluid pan bolts and allow the fluid to drain.
3. After the fluid has drained, remove the transmission fluid pan. 4. Do not remove the fluid filter. It
is not necessary to change the fluid filter during a normal maintenance fluid change.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission > Page 2678
5. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan, transmission fluid pan gasket and magnet. 6.
Thoroughly flush the cooler tubes.
Refill
1. Position the magnet into the transmission fluid pan.
2. NOTE: The fluid pan gasket is reusable, clean and inspect for damage. If not damaged, the
gasket should be reused.
Install the fluid pan and gasket. 1
Position the fluid pan with the gasket in place.
2 Install the bolts.
1 Tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.).
3. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid can result in the transmission failing to
operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
Fill the transmission. Add 4.7 liters (5 qts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission
through the fluid filler tube.
4. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 5. With the engine running and the transmission at normal operating
temperature 66 - 77°C (150 - 170°F), check and adjust the transmission fluid
level and check for any leaks. If fluid is needed, add fluid in increments of 0.24 liter (0.5 pint) until
the correct level is achieved (fluid should be in the cross-hatched area of the fluid level indicator).
Check Fluid Level and Condition
Check Fluid Level and Condition Fluid Level Check
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level indicator shows the fluid below the DO
NOT DRIVE mark or internal failure could result.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission > Page 2679
NOTE: If vehicle has been operated for an extended period of time at highway speeds, in city
traffic, in hot weather or when pulling a trailer, the fluid needs to cool down to obtain an accurate
reading.
NOTE: The fluid level reading on the indicator will differ from operating and ambient temperatures.
The correct reading should be within the normal operating temperature range.
Under normal circumstances, the fluid level should be checked during normal maintenance. If the
transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or has signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level should be
checked.
1. With the transmission in (P) PARK, the engine at idle, foot pressed on the brake, move the range
selector lever through each gear and allow
engagement of each gear. Place the range selector lever in the PARK position.
2. Wipe the fluid level indicator cap and remove the indicator. 3. Wipe the indicator with a clean
cloth.
4. Install the indicator back in the filler tube until it is fully seated, then remove the indicator. The
fluid level should be within the normal operating
temperature range.
High Fluid Level
A fluid level that is too high may cause the fluid to become aerated due to the churning action of
the rotating internal parts. This will cause erratic control pressure, foaming, loss of fluid from the
vent tube and possible transmission malfunction and/or damage. If an overfill reading is indicated
drain and refill the transmission.
Low Fluid Level
A low fluid level could result in poor transmission engagement, slipping, malfunction and/or
damage. This could also indicate a leak in one of the transmission seals or gaskets.
Adding Fluid
CAUTION: The use of any type of transmission fluid other than specified could result in
transmission malfunction and/or damage.
If fluid needs to be added, add fluid in 0.25L (1/2 pint) increments through the filler tube. Do not
overfill the fluid. For fluid type, refer to the General Specifications chart.
Fluid Condition Check
1. Check the fluid level. 2. Observe the color and the odor. The color under normal circumstances
should be dark reddish, not brown or black or have a burnt odor. 3. Hold the fluid level indicator
over a white facial tissue and allow the fluid to drip onto the facial tissue and examine the stain. 4. If
evidence of solid material is found, the transmission fluid pan should be removed for further
inspection. 5. If the stain is a foamy pink color, this may indicate coolant in the transmission. The
engine cooling system should also be inspected at this time. 6. If fluid contamination or
transmission failure is confirmed by the sediment in the bottom of the fluid pan, the transmission
must be disassembled
and completely cleaned. This includes the torque converter, coolers and cooler lines.
7. Carry out diagnostic checks and adjustments; refer to Diagnosis By Symptom See: Powertrain
Management/Transmission Control Systems/Testing
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission > Page 2680
and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/4R70E/4R75E/Diagnosis By Symptom.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Differential Oil Capacity
FRONT AXLE ......................................................................................................................................
................................. 3.5 - 3.7 pints (1.8 - 2.0 liters)
REAR AXLE Conventional differential .................................................................................................
..................................................................... 4.5 pints (2.13 liters) Limited-slip differential .................
..................................................................................................................................................... 4.25
pints (2.01 liters)
NOTE: Your vehicles rear axle is filled with a synthetic rear axle lubricant and is considered
lubricated for life. These lubricants are not to be checked or changed unless a leak is suspected,
service is required or the axle has been submerged in water. The axle lubricant should be changed
any time the axle has been submerged in water.
NOTE: Add 4 oz. (118 ml) of Additive Friction Modifier XL-3 (or equivalent) for complete refill of
Ford Limited Slip axles.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 2685
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Differential Fluid Type
REAR AXLE Motorcraft SAE 75W-140 Synthetic Rear Axle Lube Ford P/N ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
. XY-75W140-QL Ford Specification ...................................................................................................
................................................................................... WSL-M2C192-A
FRONT AXLE Motorcraft SAE 80W-90 Premium Rear Axle Lube Ford P/N ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... XY-80W90-QL Ford Specification ...................................................................................................
................................................................................... WSP-M2C197-A
NOTE: Add 4.0 oz. (118 ml) of Additive Friction Modifier XL-3 or equivalent for complete refill of
Ford Limited Slip rear axles.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Transfer Case: Capacity Specifications
Transfer Case Capacity .......................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 2.0 Quarts
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 2690
Fluid - Transfer Case: Fluid Type Specifications
Transfer Case Fluid
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................. Mercon ATF
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2691
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair
Transfer Case Draining and Filling
Special Tools
Materials
1. Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid. Clean the drain plug and the drain plug area. Apply
thread sealant to the drain plug threads. Reinstall
the drain plug.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
2. Clean the area around the fill plug. Remove the fill plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2692
3. CAUTION: Incorrect fluid fill can result in transfer case failure.
Using the special tool, fill the transfer case to specification. ^
The fluid must be just below the fill plug hole. Fill the case until the fluid slowly flows over the fill
plug threads. Clean the fluid from the fill plug area.
4. Apply thread sealant to the fill plug threads, then install the fill plug.
^ Tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
With Filter ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 6.6L (7.0 Qt)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 2697
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
U.S.A. ...................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Premium Synthetic Blend Motor Oil Canada
..................................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Super Premium Motor Oil
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................... XO-5W20-QSP (U.S.A) Ford P/N ............................................................
...................................................................................................................... CXO-5W20-LSP12
(Canada) Ford Specification
.........................................................................................................................................
WSS-M2C930-A with API Certification Mark
NOTE: Use of synthetic or synthetic blend motor oil is not mandatory. Engine oil need only meet
the requirements of Ford specification WSS-M2C930-A and the API Certification mark.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage
Power Steering Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage
TSB 07-1-7
01/22/07
MERCON(R) ATF REPLACED BY MERCON(R) V AS A SERVICE FLUID FOR SOME POWER
STEERING SYSTEMS
FORD: 1996-1997 Thunderbird 1996-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 1998-2003 Escort
2000-2007 Focus 2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2006 Ford GT 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle
2006-2007 Fusion 1996-1997 Aerostar 1996-2007 E-Series, Explorer, Ranger 1997-2004 F-53
Motorhome Chassis 1997-2007 Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty 1998-2003 Windstar 2000-2005
Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2005 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2007 Escape 2004-2007
Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1996-1997 Cargo 1996-1998 L-Series 1996-1999 F- B-Series
2000-2007 F-650, F-750 2006-2007 Low Cab Forward
LINCOLN: 1996-1998 Mark VIII 1996-1999 Continental 1996-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln
LS 2006 Zephyr 2007 MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator
2006-2007 Mark LT 2007 MKX
MERCURY: 1996-1997 Cougar 1996-2005 Sable 1996-2007 Grand Marquis 1999-2002 Cougar
2003-2004 Marauder 2005-2007 Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2007 Mountaineer 1998-2002
Villager 2004-2007 Monterey 2005-2007 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission Fluid is being replaced by MERCON(R) V as a
service fluid for power steering systems originally requiring MERCON(R).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage > Page 2702
ACTION Beginning immediately all power steering applications requiring MERCON(R) can now be
serviced using MERCON(R) V or MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission Fluid or dual usage fluids
labeled MERCON(R) / MERCON(R) V. After July 1, 2007, MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission
Fluid will no longer be manufactured, therefore, availability of this fluid will continue until remaining
inventory has been depleted.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Service power steering Systems requiring MERCON(R) with MERCON(R) V or MERCON(R)
Automatic Transmission Fluid or dual usage fluids labeled MERCON(R) / MERCON(R) V.
CAUTION
APPLICATIONS RECOMMENDING TYPE F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION AND POWER
STEERING FLUID MUST CONTINUE TO USE THAT PARTICULAR FLUID. USE OF ANY
OTHER FLUID MAY CAUSE REDUCED FUNCTIONALITY OR DAMAGE
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2703
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
POWER STEERING FLUID
Motorcraft MERCON ATF
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................................ XT-2-QDX Ford Specification .................................................
............................................................................................................................................ MERCON
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Refrigerant and Capacity
Capacity without auxiliary climate control.............................................................................................
..........................................................1.13 kg (40 oz) Capacity with auxiliary climate control...............
.............................................................................................................................................1.64 kg
(58 oz)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 2708
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
REFRIGERANT TYPE
R134a Refrigerant
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... YN-19 Ford Specification ...............................................
....................................................................................................................................
WSH-M17B19-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2709
Refrigerant: Description and Operation
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM DYE
Fluorescent refrigerant system dye is added to the refrigerant system at the factory to assist in
refrigerant system leak diagnosis using a Rotunda-approved ultraviolet blacklight. It is not
necessary to add additional dye to the refrigerant system before diagnosing leaks, even if a
significant amount of refrigerant has been removed from the system. New suction accumulators are
shipped with a fluorescent dye "wafer" included in the desiccant bag which will dissolve after
approximately 30 minutes of continued A/C operation. It is not necessary to add dye after flushing
or filtering the refrigerant system because a new suction accumulator is installed as part of the
flushing or filtering procedure. Additional refrigerant system dye should only be added if more than
50% of the refrigerant system lubricant capacity has been lost due to a fitting separation, hose
rupture or other damage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection
Refrigerant: Testing and Inspection Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection
FLUORESCENT DYE LEAK DETECTION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Fluorescent Dye Detection
NOTE: Ford Motor Company vehicles are produced with R-134a fluorescent dye installed in the
refrigerant system from the factory. The location of leaks can be pinpointed by the bright
yellow-green glow of the fluorescent dye under a UV lamp. Since more than one leak can exist,
make sure to inspect each component, line and fitting in the refrigerant system for a leak.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection > Page 2712
1. Check for leaks using a Rotunda-approved UV lamp.
- Inspect all components, lines and fittings of the refrigerant system.
2. If a leak is found, recover the refrigerant. 3. Repair the refrigerant system leak(s). 4. Evacuate
and charge the refrigerant system. 5. After the leak(s) is/are repaired, remove any traces of
fluorescent dye with a general purpose oil solvent.
6. Verify the repair by running the vehicle for a short period of time and rechecking the area of the
leak with a Rotunda-approved UV lamp.
Fluorescent Dye Injection - Using an A/C Refrigerant Center and Dye Injector
NOTE:
- Fluorescent refrigerant system dye is added to the refrigerant system at the factory to assist in
refrigerant system leak diagnosis using a Rotunda-approved ultraviolet blacklight. It is not
necessary to add additional dye to the refrigerant system before diagnosing leaks, even if a
significant amount of refrigerant has been removed from the system. Replacement suction
accumulators and receiver/driers are shipped with a fluorescent dye "wafer" included in the
desiccant bag which will dissolve after approximately 30 minutes of continued A/C operation. It is
not necessary to add dye after flushing or filtering the refrigerant system because a new suction
accumulator or receiver/drier is installed as part of the flushing or filtering procedure. Additional
refrigerant system dye should only be added if more than 50% of the refrigerant system lubricant
capacity has been lost due to a fitting separation, hose rupture or other damage.
- Before using the R-134a fluorescent dye injector for the first time, refer to the manufacturers
instructions on evacuation of any non-condensable gasses from the hoses.
- Only connect the R-134a fluorescent dye injector to a manifold and gauge set or R-134a service
center when fluorescent dye is to be injected. The R-134a fluorescent dye injector has a one way
check valve that will prevent refrigerant system recovery and evacuation.
- Refrigerant system pressure should be between 413-551 kPa (60-80 psi) at 24°C (75°F) with the
engine off.
1. Connect an R-134a A/C refrigerant service center or a manifold and gauge set to the refrigerant
system service port valves.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection > Page 2713
2. Verify that the valves on the fluorescent dye injector are closed.
3. Fill the fluorescent dye injector reservoir with 7 ml (0.25 oz) of fluorescent dye. 4. Install the
fluorescent dye injector between the low-pressure service gauge port valve and the R-134a
refrigerant service center or manifold gauge
set.
5. Open all valves and inject the fluorescent dye into the refrigerant system. 6. When fluorescent
dye injection is complete, close all valves. 7. Recover the refrigerant from the R-134a fluorescent
dye injector. 8. Remove the fluorescent dye injector from the low-pressure service gauge port valve
and the R-134a A/C refrigerant service center or manifold
gauge set.
Fluorescent Dye Injection - Using a Dye Injector Loop Kit
NOTE:
- Fluorescent refrigerant system dye is added to the refrigerant system at the factory to assist in
refrigerant system leak diagnosis using a Rotunda-approved ultraviolet blacklight. It is not
necessary to add additional dye to the refrigerant system before diagnosing leaks, even if a
significant amount of refrigerant has been removed from the system. Replacement suction
accumulators and receiver/driers are shipped with a fluorescent dye "wafer" included in the
desiccant bag which will dissolve after approximately 30 minutes of continued A/C operation. It is
not necessary to add dye after flushing or filtering the refrigerant system because a new suction
accumulator or receiver/drier is installed as part of the flushing or filtering procedure. Additional
refrigerant system dye should only be added if more than 50% of the refrigerant system lubricant
capacity has been lost due to a fitting separation, hose rupture or other damage.
- Before using the R-134a fluorescent dye injector for the first time, refer to the equipment
manufacturers instructions on evacuation of non-condensable gasses from the hoses.
- Refrigerant system pressure should be between 413-551 kPa (60-80 psi) at 24°C.
1. Verify that the valves on the deluxe injector loop kit are closed.
2. Fill the deluxe injector loop kit reservoir with 7 ml (0.25 oz) of fluorescent dye.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection > Page 2714
3. Install the deluxe injector loop kit between the high-pressure and low-pressure service gauge
port valves.
4. CAUTION: Make sure all tools and hoses are clear of the engine cooling fan and drive belt
before starting the engine.
Start the engine.
5. Open the high-pressure service valve.
6. Open the deluxe injector loop kit valves and inject the fluorescent dye into the refrigerant system.
7. Close the high-pressure service valve to allow the pressure inside the deluxe injector loop kit to
equalize with the suction side of the refrigerant
system.
8. NOTE: Close the valves on the deluxe injector loop kit while the A/C compressor is operating.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection > Page 2715
Close the valves on the deluxe injector loop kit.
9. NOTE: Leave all valves on the special tool closed when not in use.
Disconnect the high-pressure and low-pressure service valves and remove the deluxe injector loop
kit from the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection > Page 2716
Refrigerant: Testing and Inspection Electronic Leak Detection
ELECTRONIC LEAK DETECTION
H10PM Refrigerant Leak Detector With Battery
Special Tool(s)
CAUTION: Good ventilation is necessary in the area where electronic A/C leak testing is to be
carried out. If the surrounding air is contaminated with refrigerant gas, the leak detector will indicate
this gas all the time. Odors from other chemicals such as antifreeze, diesel fuel, disc brake cleaner
or other cleaning solvents can cause the same problem. Using a fan to ventilate the area to be
tested before proceeding with the leak detection procedure is helpful in removing small traces of
contamination from the air, but the fan should be turned off during actual testing.
1. NOTE: The system pressure should be between 413-551 kPa (60-80 psi) at 24°C (75°F) with the
engine off.
Leak test the refrigerant system using the Refrigerant Leak Detector. Follow the instructions
included with the leak detector for handling and operation techniques.
2. If a leak is found, recover the refrigerant.
- Repair the system.
- Test the system for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) SYSTEM RECOVERY, EVACUATION AND CHARGING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Refrigerant System Recovery
NOTE:
- Ford Motor Company recommends use of an A/C service center to carry out recovery, evacuation
and charging of the refrigerant system. If an A/C service center is not available, refrigerant system
recovery, evacuation and charging may be accomplished using a separate recovery station,
vacuum pump, charging meter and manifold gauge set.
- Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in vacuum that
may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to
leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify
that no leaks are present.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure > Page 2719
1. Prior to recovering, you must verify the purity of the refrigerant. 2. Connect an R-134a refrigerant
service center to the low- and high-pressure service gauge port valves following the operating
instructions provided
by the equipment manufacturer.
3. Recover the refrigerant from the system following the operating instructions provided by the
equipment manufacturer. 4. Once the refrigerant service center has recovered the refrigerant,
switch OFF the power supply. 5. Allow the system to set for about 2 minutes, and observe the
system vacuum reading. If the vacuum is not lost, disconnect the recovery equipment. 6. If the
system does lose vacuum, repeat Steps 3 through 5 until the vacuum level remains stable for 2
minutes. 7. Carry out the required repairs.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure > Page 2720
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Evacuation and Charging
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) SYSTEM RECOVERY, EVACUATION AND CHARGING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Refrigerant System Evacuation Using an R-134a Service Center
NOTE:
- Ford Motor Company recommends use of an A/C service center to carry out recovery, evacuation
and charging of the refrigerant system. If an A/C service center is not available, refrigerant system
recovery, evacuation and charging may be accomplished using a separate recovery station,
vacuum pump, charging meter and manifold gauge set.
- Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in vacuum that
may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to
leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify
that no leaks are present.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure > Page 2721
1. Connect an R-134a service center to the low- and high-pressure service gauge port valves
following the operating instructions provided by the
equipment manufacturer.
2. Evacuate the system until the low-pressure gauge reads at least 99.4 kPa (29.5 in-Hg) of
vacuum and as close to 101.1 kPa (30 in-Hg) as
possible. Continue to operate the vacuum pump for a minimum of 45 minutes.
3. Turn off the vacuum pump. Observe the low-pressure gauge for 5 minutes to make sure that the
system vacuum is held. If vacuum is not held for 5
minutes, leak test the system, repair the leak and evacuate the system again.
Refrigerant System Evacuation Using an R-134a Manifold Gauge Set
NOTE:
- Ford Motor Company recommends use of an A/C service center to carry out recovery, evacuation
and charging of the refrigerant system. If an A/C service center is not available, refrigerant system
recovery, evacuation and charging may be accomplished using a separate recovery station,
vacuum pump, charging meter and manifold gauge set.
- Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in vacuum that
may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to
leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify
that no leaks are present.
1. Connect the R-134a manifold gauge set to the low-side and high-side service gauge port valves.
2. Connect the center (yellow) hose from the manifold gauge set to the suction port on the vacuum
pump. 3. Open all valves on the R-134a manifold gauge set and both service gauge port valves. 4.
Turn on the vacuum pump and evacuate the system until the low-pressure gauge reads at least
99.4 kPa (29.5 in-Hg) of vacuum and as close to
101.1 kPa (30 in-Hg) as possible. Continue to operate the vacuum pump for a minimum of 45
minutes.
5. Close the high-side and low-side valves on the manifold gauge set (not the service gauge port
valves) and turn off the vacuum pump. 6. Observe the low-pressure gauge for 5 minutes to make
sure that the system vacuum is held. If vacuum is not held for 5 minutes, leak test the
system, repair the leak and evacuate the system again.
Refrigerant System Charging Using an R-134a Service Center
NOTE:
- Ford Motor Company recommends use of an A/C service center to carry out recovery, evacuation
and charging of the refrigerant system. If an A/C service center is not available, refrigerant system
recovery, evacuation and charging may be accomplished using a separate recovery station,
vacuum pump, charging meter and manifold gauge set.
- Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak that may be
misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to leak-test all
refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify that no leaks
are present.
1. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. 2. Connect an R-134a
A/C service center to the low-side and high-side service gauge port valves following the operating
instructions provided by the
equipment manufacturer.
3. Set the refrigerant charge amount, and charge the refrigerant system following the instructions
provided by the equipment manufacturer.
Refrigerant System Charging
NOTE:
- Ford Motor Company recommends use of an A/C service center to carry out recovery, evacuation
and charging of the refrigerant system. If an A/C service center is not available, refrigerant system
recovery, evacuation and charging may be accomplished using a separate recovery station,
vacuum pump, charging meter and manifold gauge set.
- Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak that may be
misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to leak-test all
refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify that no leaks
are present.
1. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. 2. Assemble the
R-134a manifold gauge set, automatic refrigerant charging meter and R-134a supply tank following
the automatic refrigerant
charging meter operating instructions.
3. Charge the refrigerant system following the automatic refrigerant charging meter operating
instructions. 4. If the refrigerant flow stops before the refrigerant charge is complete, start the
engine, select A/C operation and allow the refrigerant charge to
complete.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure > Page 2722
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant Identification Testing
REFRIGERANT IDENTIFICATION TESTING
Refrigerant Identifier With Air-Radicator
Special Tool(s)
Refrigerant Identification
1. NOTE: An A/C refrigerant analyzer must be used to identify gas samples taken directly from the
refrigeration system or storage containers prior
to recovering or charging the refrigerant system.
Follow the instructions included with the refrigerant identifier to obtain the sample for testing.
2. The diagnostic tool will display one of the following:
- If the purity level of R-134a is 98% or greater by weight, the green "PASS" light emitting diode
(LED) will light. The weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12, R-22, hydrocarbons, and air will be
displayed on the digital display.
- If refrigerant R-134a does not meet the 98% purity level, the red "FAIL" LED will light and an
alarm will sound alerting the user of potential hazards. The weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12,
R-22, and hydrocarbons will be displayed on the digital display.
- If hydrocarbon concentrations are 2% or greater by weight, the red "FAIL" LED will light,
"Hydrocarbon High" will be displayed on the digital display, and an alarm will sound alerting the
user of potential hazards. The weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12, R-22, and hydrocarbons will
also be displayed on the digital display.
3. The percentage of air contained in the sample will be displayed if the R-134a content is 98% or
greater. The diagnostic tool eliminates the effect of
air when determining the refrigerant sample content because air is not considered a contaminant,
although air can affect A/C system performance. When the diagnostic tool has determined that a
refrigerant source is pure (R-134a is 98% or greater by weight) and air concentration levels are 2%
or greater by weight, the diagnostic tool will prompt the user if an air purge is desired.
4. If contaminated refrigerant is detected, repeat the refrigerant identification test to verify that the
refrigerant is indeed contaminated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure > Page 2723
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Contaminated Refrigerant Handling
CONTAMINATED REFRIGERANT HANDLING
CAUTION: If contaminated refrigerant is detected, DO NOT recover the refrigerant into R-134a
recovery/recycling equipment.
NOTE: A new suction accumulator or receiver/drier must be installed as directed by the air
conditioning system flushing procedure.
1. Recover the contaminated refrigerant using suitable recovery-only equipment designed for
capturing and storing contaminated refrigerant only.
- If this equipment is not available, contact an A/C service facility in your area with the correct
equipment to carry out this service.
2. Determine and correct the cause of the customers initial concern. 3. Flush the air conditioning
system. 4. Dispose of the contaminated refrigerant in accordance with all federal, state and local
regulations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL
TOTAL SYSTEM CAPACITY
Without auxiliary climate control
............................................................................................................................................................
266 ml (9.0 oz) With auxiliary climate control ......................................................................................
......................................................................... 414 ml (14.0 oz)
A/C COMPRESSOR
Add the same amount drained plus the amount collected during refrigerant recovery. NOTE: Rotate
the old A/C compressor shaft 8 to 10 full rotations (clockwise) while collecting the refrigerant oil in a
clean measuring cup. Service A/C compressors are shipped without refrigerant oil.
SUCTION ACCUMULATOR OR RECEIVER/DRIER
Add the quantity of oil drained, plus the amount collected during refrigerant recovery and 60 ml (2.0
fl oz). NOTE: Drill one 12.7 mm (1/2 inch) hole in the old suction accumulator or receiver/drier
cylinder and drain the oil into a clean measuring cup.
EVAPORATOR CORE ........................................................................................................................
................................................ 45 ml (1.5 fl oz.)
NOTE: Added to the amount collected during refrigerant recovery.
CONDENSER CORE ..........................................................................................................................
................................................. 60 ml (2.0 fl oz.)
NOTE: Added to the amount collected during refrigerant recovery.
EVAPORATOR CORE ORIFICE OR THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE
The amount collected during refrigerant recovery.
A/C PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
...................................................................................................................................................... 60
ml (2.0 fl oz.)
REFRIGERANT HOSE/LINE
.............................................................................................................................................................
60 ml (2.0 fl oz.)
NOTE: If an excessive amount of refrigerant oil is lost due to a hose rupture/separation or other
damage, the total system refrigerant oil capacity must be added.
O-RING LEAK REPAIR .......................................................................................................................
.............................................. 60 ml (2.0 fl oz.)
NOTE: The amount specified may be used for one or multiple O-ring leak repairs. Do not multiply
the refrigerant oil amount by the number of O-ring leaks being repaired.
SERVICE PORT LEAK REPAIR
....................................................................................................................................................... 60
ml (2.0 fl oz.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 2728
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL
PAG Refrigerant Compressor Oil (R-134a Systems)
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. F7AZ-19589-DA Motorcraft P/N .......................................................
............................................................................................................................................. YN-12-C
Ford Specification ................................................................................................................................
.................................................. WSH-M1C231-B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2729
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
REFRIGERANT OIL ADDING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
CAUTION: During normal A/C operation, oil is circulated through the system with the refrigerant,
and a small amount is retained in each component. If certain components of the system are
removed, some of the refrigerant oil will go with the component. To maintain the original total oil
charge, it is necessary to compensate for the oil lost by adding oil to the system with the new part.
Part 1
Part 2
1. Refer to the chart for refrigerant oil adding amounts and methods of installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2730
Refrigerant Oil Adding for New A/C Compressor Installation
NOTE: Service A/C compressors are shipped without refrigerant oil.
1. Rotate the old A/C compressor shaft 8 to 10 full rotations (clockwise) while collecting the
refrigerant oil in a clean measuring cup.
- Add the same amount plus the amount collected during refrigerant recovery.
Refrigerant Oil Adding for New Suction Accumulator or Receiver/Drier Installation
1. Drill one half-inch hole in the old suction accumulator or receiver/drier cylinder and drain the oil
into a clean measuring cup. 2. Add the quantity of oil drained, plus the amount collected during
refrigerant recovery and 60 ml (2 oz.).
Oil Injection Using a Dye/Lubricant Injector
NOTE: If fluorescent leak detection dye is also to be added during A/C charging, the dye may be
added to the dye/lubricant injector along with the refrigerant oil.
1. Evacuate the refrigerant system. 2. Assemble the dye/lubricant injector using the correct
adapters to match the amount of PAG oil to be injected.
3. Verify that all the valves on the dye/lubricant injector are closed.
4. Fill the dye/lubricant injector with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. 5. Install the dye/lubricant
injector between the low-side service gauge port valve and the refrigerant service station or
manifold gauge set. 6. Open all valves and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Brake Bleeding: > 05-26-21 > Dec > 05 > Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
Brake Bleeding: Customer Interest Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > 05-26-21 > Dec > 05 > Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
Brake Bleeding: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > Page 2744
Brake Bleeding: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-26-21 Date: 051231
Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > Page 2745
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-26-21 Date: 051231
Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > Page 2746
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the 4 wheel anti-lock brake (4WABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the 4WABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add recommended brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear waste line to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in
a container partially filled with recommended brake
fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the diagnostic tool.
Connect the diagnostic tool DCL cable adapter into the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the
dash and follow the diagnostic tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the diagnostic tool service bleed procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2749
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Gravity
Gravity
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with brake fluid.
2. Bleed the rear disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free
end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
rear disc brake caliper.
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2750
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Manual
Manual
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper.
6. Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2751
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2752
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Pressure
Pressure
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
^ WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Bleed the longest line first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough specified brake fluid
to complete the bleeding operation.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with the specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 5. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then tighten rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
7. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2753
8. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir and install the brake master cylinder filler cap.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2754
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the 4 wheel anti-lock brake (4WABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the 4WABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add recommended brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear waste line to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in
a container partially filled with recommended brake
fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the diagnostic tool.
Connect the diagnostic tool DCL cable adapter into the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the
dash and follow the diagnostic tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the diagnostic tool service bleed procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2755
Gravity
Gravity
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with brake fluid.
2. Bleed the rear disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free
end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
rear disc brake caliper.
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
Manual
Manual
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2756
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper.
6. Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Pressure
Pressure
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
^ WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2757
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Bleed the longest line first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough specified brake fluid
to complete the bleeding operation.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with the specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 5. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then tighten rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
7. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2758
8. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir and install the brake master cylinder filler cap.
Brake System Bleeding
Brake System Bleeding
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2759
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with brake fluid. 3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until
clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and
install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fittings until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tubes.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
Master Cylinder, Bench
Master Cylinder, Bench
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Four Wheel
Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 2760
1. Support the brake master cylinder body in a vise and fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with
specified brake fluid.
^ Use clean brake fluid.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir. 3.
Slowly depress the primary piston until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air bubbles.
4. Remove the short brake tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety
canopy deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a seat mounted side air bag and/or a safety belt pretensioner (if equipped)
system is being serviced, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central junction
box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover and
remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and close
the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2765
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety canopy
module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2766
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central
junction box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover
and remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Remove the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
8. Remove the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2767
9. Remove the driver air bag module.
1 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
2 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
3 Disconnect the horn switch electrical connector.
4 Remove the driver air bag module.
Navigator
10. Disconnect the driver air bag module.
- Release the 2 tabs on each driver air bag module electrical connector and disconnect them. Label each driver air bag module electrical connector before disconnecting.
11. Release the tab and disconnect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector at
the top of the clockspring and remove the driver air
bag module.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2768
12. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tools to the clockspring electrical connectors at the top of
the steering column.
13. While pushing in on the 2 glove compartment door tabs, position the glove compartment
downward.
14. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the tab and disconnect the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
15. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
Vehicles with safety canopies
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2769
16. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
17. Remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
18. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2770
19. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
20. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide.
21. Remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
22. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2771
23. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the driver side safety
canopy electrical connector.
All vehicles 24. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB. 25. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
Vehicles with safety canopies
3. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the driver side
safety canopy electrical connector.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2772
5. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the driver side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
6. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row driver side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
7. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2773
8. Connect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
9. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
10. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2774
11. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger air
bag module electrical connector.
12. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
13. Close the glove compartment.
14. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tools from the clockspring electrical connector at the
top of the steering column.
Navigator
15. Connect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector to the connector end at the
top of the clockspring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2775
16. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module.
Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the
electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
Expedition
17. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
1 Connect the horn switch electrical connector.
2 CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the
driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal.
3 Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
All vehicles
18. Install the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2776
19. Install the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
20. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
21. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 22. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and
close the cover.
23. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
24. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 2777
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Prove Out Procedure
PROVE OUT PROCEDURE
Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the ON position and visually monitor the air bag indicator
with all SRS components connected or restraint system diagnostic tools installed. The air bag
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is
present, the air bag indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator will
need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box
Fuse: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2783
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2784
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2785
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2786
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2787
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2788
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2789
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2790
Fuse: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2791
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2792
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2793
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2794
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2795
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2798
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2799
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2800
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2801
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2802
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2803
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2804
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2805
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2806
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2807
Fuse: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2808
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2809
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2810
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2811
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2812
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2813
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2814
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box
Fuse: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2817
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2818
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2819
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2821
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2822
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2823
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2824
Fuse: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2825
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2826
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2827
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2828
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2829
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box
Fuse Block: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2834
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2835
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2836
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2837
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2838
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2839
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2840
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2841
Fuse Block: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2842
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2843
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2844
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2845
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Central Junction Box > Page 2846
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2849
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2850
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2851
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2852
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2853
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2854
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2855
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2856
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2857
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2858
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2859
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2860
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2861
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2862
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2863
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2864
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2865
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2866
Fuse Block: Connector Views
C270a
C270b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2867
C270c
C270d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2868
C270e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2869
C270f
C270g
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2870
C270h
C270j
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2871
C270k
C270m
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2872
C270n
C270p
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box
Fuse Block: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2875
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2876
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2877
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2878
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2879
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2880
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2881
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2882
Fuse Block: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2883
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2884
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2885
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2886
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2887
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2892
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2893
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2894
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2895
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2896
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2897
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2898
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2899
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2900
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2901
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2902
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2903
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Central Junction Box > Page 2904
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2905
Relay Box: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2906
C270a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2907
C270b
C270c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2908
C270d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2909
C270e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2910
C270f
C270g
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2911
C270h
C270j
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2912
C270k
C270m
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2913
C270n
C270p
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2916
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2917
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2918
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2919
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2920
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2921
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2922
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2923
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2924
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2925
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2926
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2927
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 2928
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Low Tire Pressure Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Description and Operation
UNDERSTANDING YOUR TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System measures pressure in your four road tires and sends the tire
pressure readings to your vehicle every minute while you are driving and once every 6 hours when
your vehicle is parked. The Low Tire Warning Lamp will turn ON if the tire pressure is 25% below
the pressure listed on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (approximately 6 to 9 psi below the
manufacturers recommend tire pressure). If the tire pressure increases 2 psi above the Light ON
threshold, then the TPMS light will turn OFF. Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under
inflated and need to be inflated to the manufacturers recommended tire pressure. Even if the light
turns ON and a short time later turns OFF, your tire pressure still needs to be checked. In short,
once the light has turned ON, at least one tire may be under inflated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Low Tire Pressure Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 2933
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPM's Indicator and Vehicle Message Center Messages
The TPM's indicator and vehicle message center (if equipped) sometimes displays faults that
cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these messages as TPM's faults that must be serviced.
GO to Symptom Chart for the TPM's indicator operation and message center messages. See:
Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
TPM's Indicator Illuminates Continuously
The TPM's indicator remains on continuously for the following condition:
1. NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPM's functionality
before carrying out any diagnosis.
Low Tire Pressure - The TPM's indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays LOW
TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low. Tire
pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold placard pressure. Adjust the air pressure in
tires. Refer to Information BUS for diagnosis of the CAN bus. The TPM's indicator flashes for 20
seconds after prove-out and for the following 3 reasons:
1 No communication with the TPM's Module (integral to VSM) - The TPM's indicator is illuminated
when the instrument cluster (IC) has received no signals from the VSM for more than 5 seconds. If
equipped, the message center displays TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom
Chart. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
2 Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
SENSOR FAULT when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
3 Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT when the tire pressure
monitoring system is malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring
System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Service and Repair
This vehicle is not equipped with a maintenance required lamp/indicator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (MIL)
MIL (applications With A Dedicated Hard Wire MIL Circuit)
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, Or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately 4 seconds.
- For applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit, the PCM illuminates the MIL until a profile
ignition pickup (PIP) signal is detected. The Ranger uses a hard wire circuit.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if: an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- no PIP signal is detected (applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit). The PIP signal is
generated in the PCM using the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor. For these applications, the MIL
can be helpful in diagnosing a no start.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the Hardware Limited Operation Strategy (HLOS).
- the MIL circuit is shorted to ground (applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if: an indicator or instrument cluster concern is present.
- the MIL circuit is open (applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit).
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the diagnostic tool must be sent, or 3
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
This vehicle is not equipped with an oil change reminder lamp.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
JACKING
WARNING:
- The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut down prior to hoisting, jacking or
towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension
switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected
inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these
operations.
- Do not run the engine when jacking the vehicle. The wheels contacting the ground could cause
the vehicle to move.
- Support the vehicle prior to carrying out any procedure requiring the vehicle to be jacked off the
ground.
- Make sure the jack and jack stands are correctly located to prevent the vehicle from falling.
- Wheel chocks should be used to prevent the vehicle from rolling and falling off the jack.
CAUTION:
- Never use a halfshaft as a lifting point.
- If equipped with retractable running board, disable the system through the instrument cluster
controls.
Jacking Points - Front
Jacking Points - Front
The front jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located behind the front tire and
wheel assembly.
Jacking Points - Rear
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2947
Jacking Points - Rear
CAUTION: Do not use the differential housing as a lift point. Leaks or damage to the rear axle cover and
adjoining differential housing surface can occur if a floor jack or any lifting device is allowed to
contact the cover at any point where the cover joins the housing.
- Do not use the rear control arms as a lifting point.
The rear jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located in front of the rear tire
and wheel assembly.
LIFTING
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut down prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel area. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations.
CAUTION: Damage to suspension, exhaust and steering linkage components can occur if care is
not exercised when positioning the hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
Lifting Points - Twin Post Hoist
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2948
Lifting Points - Twin Post Hoist
Locate the front hoist adapters and rear hoist adapters (top of frame arc) as indicated.
Lifting Points - Drive On Hoist
Lifting Points - Drive On Hoist
The vehicle is supported by tires and suspension components.
Lifting Points - Floor Jack, Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2949
Lifting Points - Floor Jack, Front
The front can be lifted using a floor jack under the front control arm directly below the shock.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Relays and Modules - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Module: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Module Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage can result.
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) is integral to the vehicle security module
(VSM) and is not serviced separately.
NOTE: A new VSM module is delivered in manufacturing mode with pre-set diagnostic trouble
codes (DTC's). These DTC's require that a particular set of operations to be carried out in order to
clear them and enable the module for normal operations. The pre-set DTC's are as follows: ^
B2477 - Module Configuration Failure/Mismatch
^ B2868 - Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2869 - Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2870 - Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2871 - Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ C2780 - ECU in Manufacturing Mode
NOTE: A re-configured VSM may also set the above codes and will need to go through the same
set of procedures as a new module to enable normal operation.
1. NOTE: The steps included in the VSM removal and installation process are critical to restoring
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring
system operations and will permit a new or reconfigured module to operate as intended. Each step
is designed to carry out a particular operation and clear the manufacturing mode DTC's. Once
these DTC's are cleared, the new or reconfigured module will enter into normal operating mode.
Remove the VSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Sensor Training (Reset Procedure)
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system is not affected by wheel and tire rotation.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency (RF) noise.
RF noise is generated by electrical motor and appliance operation, cellular telephones and remote
transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 2. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to
the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
3. Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
6. The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if train mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center displays
"TRAIN LF TIRE", place the special tool on the valve stem of the LF tire pressure sensor. The horn
will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the TPMS
module.
7. Within 2 minutes after the horn sounds, place the special tool on the valve stem of the RF tire
pressure sensor.
NOTE: If the VSM (TPMS module integral to VSM) does not recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure
sensors during the tire training procedure, the horn will sound twice and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT" and the procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
When the tire training procedure is complete, the horn will sound once and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPLETE".
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2958
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Sensor
Special Tools
CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2959
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
Removal
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) will
not operate correctly if black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not remove the valve stem core to relieve the tire pressure.
CAUTION: If the valve stem core has been removed from the valve stem, reinstall the original valve
stem core. If the original valve stem core is damaged, a nickel-plated core must be installed.
Failure to use a nickel-plated core will result in corrosion and the possible loss of tire pressure.
NOTE: Release the tire pressure by removing the sensor valve stem nut.
With the valve stem at the 6 o'clock position, remove the sensor valve stem nut and push the
sensor by hand into the tire (with the cap on).
3. Using a suitable tire machine, separate both beads of the tire from the wheel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2960
4. CAUTION: Care should be taken not to damage the tire pressure sensor while separating the
outside bead of tire from the wheel.
Place the wheel and tire on the turntable of the tire machine, index-mark the valve stem and wheel
weight positions, lubricate the bead of the tire and dismount the outside bead of the tire from the
wheel.
5. Remove the tire pressure sensor from the tire. 6. Remove and discard the grommet from the tire
pressure sensor.
Installation
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The TPM's will not operate correctly if
black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. NOTE: Install a new sensor grommet or an air leak can occur.
Install a new grommet on the tire pressure sensor.
2. NOTE: Do not allow the tire to rotate relative to the rim while mounting the tire.
Lubricate and mount the outside and inside bead of the tire to the rim.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2961
3. CAUTION: Overtightening the tire pressure sensor valve stem nut can damage the tire pressure
sensor, undertightening can cause air leaks.
NOTE: Sensor position is critical for correct sensor operation. The "flat" side of the sensor must be
facing the wheel and the "slanted" side of the sensor must be facing away from the wheel. When
properly installed, there will be a very small gap between the sensor and the wheel.
NOTE: Tightening the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs.) equals approximately 2 clockwise turns after the
nut has been tightened by hand.
Push the side wall of the tire and install the tire pressure sensor. Tighten the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch
lbs.).
4. CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2962
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
CAUTION: Use only OEM valve caps (aluminum or plastic valve caps) with the tire pressure
sensors. Do not use brass-threaded valve caps with the tire pressure sensors.
Inflate the tire to the pressure specified on the safety certification sticker located on the driver or
door pillar.
5. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 6. Train the tire pressure sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Description and Operation
UNDERSTANDING YOUR TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System measures pressure in your four road tires and sends the tire
pressure readings to your vehicle every minute while you are driving and once every 6 hours when
your vehicle is parked. The Low Tire Warning Lamp will turn ON if the tire pressure is 25% below
the pressure listed on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (approximately 6 to 9 psi below the
manufacturers recommend tire pressure). If the tire pressure increases 2 psi above the Light ON
threshold, then the TPMS light will turn OFF. Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under
inflated and need to be inflated to the manufacturers recommended tire pressure. Even if the light
turns ON and a short time later turns OFF, your tire pressure still needs to be checked. In short,
once the light has turned ON, at least one tire may be under inflated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2967
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPM's Indicator and Vehicle Message Center Messages
The TPM's indicator and vehicle message center (if equipped) sometimes displays faults that
cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these messages as TPM's faults that must be serviced.
GO to Symptom Chart for the TPM's indicator operation and message center messages. See:
Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
TPM's Indicator Illuminates Continuously
The TPM's indicator remains on continuously for the following condition:
1. NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPM's functionality
before carrying out any diagnosis.
Low Tire Pressure - The TPM's indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays LOW
TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low. Tire
pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold placard pressure. Adjust the air pressure in
tires. Refer to Information BUS for diagnosis of the CAN bus. The TPM's indicator flashes for 20
seconds after prove-out and for the following 3 reasons:
1 No communication with the TPM's Module (integral to VSM) - The TPM's indicator is illuminated
when the instrument cluster (IC) has received no signals from the VSM for more than 5 seconds. If
equipped, the message center displays TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom
Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
2 Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
SENSOR FAULT when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
3 Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT when the tire pressure
monitoring system is malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Module: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Module Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage can result.
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) is integral to the vehicle security module
(VSM) and is not serviced separately.
NOTE: A new VSM module is delivered in manufacturing mode with pre-set diagnostic trouble
codes (DTC's). These DTC's require that a particular set of operations to be carried out in order to
clear them and enable the module for normal operations. The pre-set DTC's are as follows: ^
B2477 - Module Configuration Failure/Mismatch
^ B2868 - Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2869 - Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2870 - Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2871 - Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ C2780 - ECU in Manufacturing Mode
NOTE: A re-configured VSM may also set the above codes and will need to go through the same
set of procedures as a new module to enable normal operation.
1. NOTE: The steps included in the VSM removal and installation process are critical to restoring
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring
system operations and will permit a new or reconfigured module to operate as intended. Each step
is designed to carry out a particular operation and clear the manufacturing mode DTC's. Once
these DTC's are cleared, the new or reconfigured module will enter into normal operating mode.
Remove the VSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Sensor Training (Reset Procedure)
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system is not affected by wheel and tire rotation.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency (RF) noise.
RF noise is generated by electrical motor and appliance operation, cellular telephones and remote
transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 2. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to
the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
3. Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
6. The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if train mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center displays
"TRAIN LF TIRE", place the special tool on the valve stem of the LF tire pressure sensor. The horn
will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the TPMS
module.
7. Within 2 minutes after the horn sounds, place the special tool on the valve stem of the RF tire
pressure sensor.
NOTE: If the VSM (TPMS module integral to VSM) does not recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure
sensors during the tire training procedure, the horn will sound twice and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT" and the procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
When the tire training procedure is complete, the horn will sound once and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPLETE".
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2974
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Sensor
Special Tools
CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2975
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
Removal
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) will
not operate correctly if black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not remove the valve stem core to relieve the tire pressure.
CAUTION: If the valve stem core has been removed from the valve stem, reinstall the original valve
stem core. If the original valve stem core is damaged, a nickel-plated core must be installed.
Failure to use a nickel-plated core will result in corrosion and the possible loss of tire pressure.
NOTE: Release the tire pressure by removing the sensor valve stem nut.
With the valve stem at the 6 o'clock position, remove the sensor valve stem nut and push the
sensor by hand into the tire (with the cap on).
3. Using a suitable tire machine, separate both beads of the tire from the wheel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2976
4. CAUTION: Care should be taken not to damage the tire pressure sensor while separating the
outside bead of tire from the wheel.
Place the wheel and tire on the turntable of the tire machine, index-mark the valve stem and wheel
weight positions, lubricate the bead of the tire and dismount the outside bead of the tire from the
wheel.
5. Remove the tire pressure sensor from the tire. 6. Remove and discard the grommet from the tire
pressure sensor.
Installation
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The TPM's will not operate correctly if
black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. NOTE: Install a new sensor grommet or an air leak can occur.
Install a new grommet on the tire pressure sensor.
2. NOTE: Do not allow the tire to rotate relative to the rim while mounting the tire.
Lubricate and mount the outside and inside bead of the tire to the rim.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2977
3. CAUTION: Overtightening the tire pressure sensor valve stem nut can damage the tire pressure
sensor, undertightening can cause air leaks.
NOTE: Sensor position is critical for correct sensor operation. The "flat" side of the sensor must be
facing the wheel and the "slanted" side of the sensor must be facing away from the wheel. When
properly installed, there will be a very small gap between the sensor and the wheel.
NOTE: Tightening the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs.) equals approximately 2 clockwise turns after the
nut has been tightened by hand.
Push the side wall of the tire and install the tire pressure sensor. Tighten the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch
lbs.).
4. CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2978
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
CAUTION: Use only OEM valve caps (aluminum or plastic valve caps) with the tire pressure
sensors. Do not use brass-threaded valve caps with the tire pressure sensors.
Inflate the tire to the pressure specified on the safety certification sticker located on the driver or
door pillar.
5. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 6. Train the tire pressure sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection
Technical Service Bulletin # 05S35 Date: 050705
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 2987
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED? Yes. OASIS will be activated by July 5, 2005
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? Yes
Available through by July 5, 2005.
Owner names and addresses will be available by July 18, 2005.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states provinces and countries.
Accordingly you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Inspect and if necessary correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TIRE REPLACEMENT GUIDELINES
^ Tires that fail the inspection must be replaced regardless of the mileage or the remaining tread on
the tire.
^ Ford Motor Company will only pay claims for the replacement tires ordered through the Ford Tire
Hotline that are listed in Attachment II under Ford Approved Replacement Tire List. Upgrades to
other brand and size tires are NOT allowed.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 2988
^ Some vehicles may be equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Damaged
TPMS sensors are not covered under this program. Follow the instructions in Attachment III to
avoid damaging the TPMS sensor while dismounting the tire from the rim.
^ If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition call
the Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted (excluding the post-repair
wheel nut re-torque procedure - see below).
^ The owner letter will direct customers to the dealer to have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 500
miles (800km) after tire replacement. Dealers are to use the related damage flag to submit claims
for labor operation 05S35Z (post-repair wheel nut re-torque). Approval is not required for this labor
operation. This labor operation may only be claimed once after the original repair has been
completed.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company is offering a refund for owner-paid repairs covered by this recall if the repair
was performed prior to the date indicated in the reimbursement plan which is posted with this
bulletin. This plan is also available to owners through the Customer Relationship Center (CRC).
The CRC will direct owners to seek reimbursement through authorized dealers or at their option
directly through Ford Motor Company at P.O. Box 6251 Dearborn, MI 48121-6251.
^ Dealers are also authorized to refund owner-paid emergency repairs that were performed away
from an authorized servicing dealer after the end date specified in the reimbursement plan. Refund
claims that include other non-covered repairs or those judged by Ford to be excessive will not be
accepted for reimbursement.
^ This safety recall (tire tread inspection) must still be performed, even if the customer has paid for
a previous tire replacement Claiming a refund will not close the recall on this vehicle.
^ Refund Claiming Information (Submit on separate repair line.)
- Program Code: 05S35 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN
- Misc. Expense: REFUND - Misc. Expense: 0.2 Hrs.
RENTAL VEHICLES
Ford Motor Company will pay for a rental vehicle while a replacement tire is on order except for fuel
and insurance which will be at the owner's expense. Follow Extended Service Plan (ESP)
guidelines for rental dollar amounts. Enter the word "RENTAL" plus the number of days the vehicle
was used in the Miscellaneous Expense area of the recall claim form.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Enter each unique DOT code of the "new" replacement tires on the diagnostic code entry screen
in the Powertrain DTC fields. The "old" replaced tire DOT codes should be entered in the Body
DTC fields.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Enter the full part number of the replacement tire with the quantity of tires replaced. Tires will be
reimbursed at AtW Dealer cost +25% (mounting balancing valve stems and wheel weights
included).
- Virginia Dealers: Claim the additional 15% mark-up amount as miscellaneous expense code
"TIREMU".
^ Freight is not reimbursable. (Freight charges will be credited on the dealer's Ford Parts
statement.)
^ Tire disposal will be reimbursed see the Tire Disposal Allowance Attachment II.
^ Dealers may claim any applicable local waste tax - enter OTHER in the miscellaneous expense
area of the claim with the actual cost.
^ Refunds or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 2989
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS ORDERING INFORMATION
The following part is necessary when changing a tire on a vehicle that is equipped with the optional
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
FORD APPROVED REPLACEMENT TIRE LIST
TIRE ORDERING INFORMATION
^ Tires must be ordered through the Ford Tire Hot Line. Identify the number of tires needed and
use the "05535 Replacement Tire Order Form" to order your tires. (See Attachment IV for the tire
order form.)
^ Tires will begin shipping the week of July 11, 2005
^ Orders will be fulfilled in the order they are received.
^ Ford Tire Hot Line hours are 8AM to 8PM Monday through Friday EST.
TIRE DESTRUCTION / MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
TIRE PRICE
For latest tire prices refer to the Tire Sales Tool on the website.
TIRE DISPOSAL ALLOWANCE
An allowance of $4.00 per tire is being provided for tire disposal. To claim the allowance enter the
dollar amount as "HANDLG" in the "MISC EXPENSE" area of the claim form.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST-REPAIR TORQUE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 2990
The vehicle Owner's Guide states that each wheel that is removed and reinstalled must have the
wheel nuts re-tightened at 500 miles (800km) after service. This is required to permit the wheel
clamping system to seat correctly so that the wheel nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain
fully tightened. To claim this operation you must file a related damage claim using labor operation
05S35Z. This labor operation includes time to check the torque on all the wheel nuts.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves inspecting all four (4) tires of the vehicle for tread damaged caused by a
piece of metal on the conveyor line during vehicle assembly.
INSPECTION
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
2. Raise the vehicle on a hoist and inspect all four (4) tires for tread damage. See Figure 1.
^ If no tread damage is found, lower the vehicle, turn on the air suspension if equipped, and
release the vehicle.
^ Any tire found to have damaged tread must be replaced. Proceed to Tire Replacement.
TIRE REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 2991
If the vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS), specific procedures
must be followed to remove and install the tire or damage to the TPMS sensors will occur. Related
damage claims for TPMS sensors will be rejected.
NOTE:
Vehicles equipped with TPMS can be identified by the presence of a metallic valve stem at each
wheel. Vehicles without TPMS will have rubber valve stems.
NOTE:
While the Workshop Repair Manual does not provide actual tire replacement procedures, it does
provide procedures for TPMS sensor removal and installation. To prevent damage to the sensor, it
must be removed and installed during tire removal and installation. Refer to Section 204-04 of the
ONLINE version of the 2006 Model Year Expedition/Navigator Workshop Repair Manual for the
most up-to-date service information available. Again, related damage claims for TPMS sensors will
be rejected.
1.
CAUTION: Do not remove the valve core from TPMS valve stem.
Remove the tire from the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor removal.
2. For vehicles without TPMS, install a new rubber valve stem.
3. Mount the new tire onto the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor installation.
4. Balance the wheel/tire assembly, then install it on the vehicle.
5. Tighten the wheel nuts to 204 Nm (150 lb-ft).
6. Lower the hoist and if equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the ON position.
7. Proceed to Tire Destruction/Mutilation.
TIRE DESTRUCTION/MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST REPAIR RETIGHTEN PROCEDURE
WARNING:
Re-tighten the wheel nuts at 800 km (500 miles) after any wheel change or any time the wheel nuts
are loosened. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
The Owner Guide and workshop repair manual recommend that each wheel removed and
reinstalled must have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 800 km (500 miles) after service. Wheel nut
torque specification is 204 Nm (150 lb-ft). This is required to permit the wheel clamping system to
seat correctly so that the wheel lug nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain fully tightened.
To claim this operation, refer to Attachment II.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 2992
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 2993
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 2994
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 2995
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls: > NHTSA05V310000 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for Damage
Tires: Recalls Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for Damage
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2006 Lincoln/Navigator 2006
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V310000 MFG'S
REPORT DATE: July 05, 2005
COMPONENT: Tires: Tread/Belt
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 10061
SUMMARY: On certain sport utility vehicles, the front and rear tires on the driver's side of affected
vehicles may have been damaged at the center tread during production.
CONSEQUENCE: Over time, the damage may be sufficient to allow belt corrosion ultimately
leading to a tread separation, which could result in a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect all four tires (to ensure inspection of the left hand side tires that may
have been rotated to the other side of the vehicle) for tire tread damage and, if necessary, replace
the damaged tire. The recall began on July 13, 2005. Owners should contact Ford at
1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 05S35. Please note that this program will expire on December 31, 2005.
Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety
Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns
Tires: Customer Interest 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns
TSB 08-21-11
10/27/08
4 WHEEL DRIVE/ALL WHEEL DRIVE - WITH CONTROL TRAC - SHUDDER ON
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION OR BINDING ON SLOW TURNS
FORD: 1997-2008 Expedition, Explorer 2006-2008 F-150 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac 2008
F-150
LINCOLN: 1998-2008 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2005 Mountaineer 2006-2008 Mountaineer
ISSUE Various 1997-2008 vehicles equipped with either 4 wheel drive or all wheel drive and
equipped with control trac may exhibit a shudder on acceleration/deceleration, binding in slow
speed turns or noise from the front driveline and/or transfer case. The shudder/binding will occur
with the vehicle being operated in the awd/auto 4x4 mode. The shudder/binding may be due to
incorrect tire circumference or improper tire inflation pressures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS DOES NOT APPLY TO 2006-2008 MOUNTAINEER WITH A 4.0L ENGINE OR 2007-2008
EXPLORER AND SPORT TRAC WITH 20 INCH WHEELS.
NOTE
VEHICLES ON THE LIST MAY REQUIRE REPLACEMENT OF TIRE/S IF THE TIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AVERAGE BETWEEN THE FRONT AND REAR AXLES ARE OUTSIDE OF
THE 1/2 INCH SPECIFICATION OR IF THE TIRE CIRCUMFERENCE FROM SIDE TO SIDE ON
EITHER AXLE EXCEEDS 1/2 INCH DIFFERENCE, THE SMALLER TIRE(S) MUST BE
REPLACED.
NOTE
REVIEW THE WARRANTY AND POLICY MANUAL FOR FORD MOTOR COMPANY TIRE
REPLACEMENT WARRANTY BEFORE PERFORMING THE SERVICE PROCEDURE.
NOTE
ONLY USE REPLACEMENT TIRE AND WHEEL THAT ARE THE SAME SIZE, LOAD INDEX,
SPEED RATING AND TYPE (SUCH AS P-METRIC VERSUS LT-METRIC OR ALL-SEASON
VERSUS ALL-TERRAIN) AS THOSE ORIGINALLY PROVIDED BY FORD. THE
RECOMMENDED TIRE AND WHEEL SIZE MAY BE FOUND ON EITHER THE SAFETY
COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION LABEL OR THE TIRE LABEL WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE
B-PILLAR OR EDGE OF THE DRIVER'S DOOR.
NOTE
ON SOME 4WD MODELS, THE INITIAL SHIFT FROM 2WD TO 4WD WHILE THE VEHICLE IS
MOVING CAN CAUSE A MOMENTARY CLUNK AND/OR BRIEF RATCHETING SOUND. THESE
SOUNDS ARE NORMAL AS THE FRONT DRIVETRAIN COMES UP TO SPEED AND IS NOT
CAUSE FOR CONCERN.
1. Review the tire label for correct tire size and tire inflation pressures located at the B-Pillar of the
driver's door.
2. If the tire size does not match the label, this procedure does not apply, follow normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
3. If the tire size is correct, ensure tire pressures are within specifications.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 3005
4. Raise the vehicle on the hoist, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 100-02.
5. Disconnect all wiring going to the transfer case and road test.
6. Is the shudder/binding present?
a. If the shudder/binding is still present, do not continue with this procedure, continue with WSM
normal diagnostic for 4X4.
b. If the shudder/binding is gone, proceed to Step 7.
7. Raise the vehicle on the hoist and reconnect all the wiring previously disconnected.
8. Using a tailor's tape or flexible measuring tape and measure the circumference of all four (4)
tires and record the measurements. (Figure 1)
9. Calculate the average of the circumference of the two (2) front tires and calculate the average of
the circumference of the two (2) rear tires. (Figure 2)
10. If the difference between these two averages is greater than 1/2" (12.7 mm), front to back or
side to side, replace the smallest circumference tire(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 3006
and remeasure the tire averages. Refer to WSM, Section 204-04 for tire replacement.
NOTE
WARRANTY COVERAGE ELIGIBILITY STARTS WITH 2007 NEW VEHICLE LIMITED
WARRANTY COVERAGE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082111A 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111A 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace TWO Tires. (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace Two (2) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 3007
Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150
Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do
Not Use With 1007A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A195 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns
TSB 08-21-11
10/27/08
4 WHEEL DRIVE/ALL WHEEL DRIVE - WITH CONTROL TRAC - SHUDDER ON
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION OR BINDING ON SLOW TURNS
FORD: 1997-2008 Expedition, Explorer 2006-2008 F-150 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac 2008
F-150
LINCOLN: 1998-2008 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2005 Mountaineer 2006-2008 Mountaineer
ISSUE Various 1997-2008 vehicles equipped with either 4 wheel drive or all wheel drive and
equipped with control trac may exhibit a shudder on acceleration/deceleration, binding in slow
speed turns or noise from the front driveline and/or transfer case. The shudder/binding will occur
with the vehicle being operated in the awd/auto 4x4 mode. The shudder/binding may be due to
incorrect tire circumference or improper tire inflation pressures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS DOES NOT APPLY TO 2006-2008 MOUNTAINEER WITH A 4.0L ENGINE OR 2007-2008
EXPLORER AND SPORT TRAC WITH 20 INCH WHEELS.
NOTE
VEHICLES ON THE LIST MAY REQUIRE REPLACEMENT OF TIRE/S IF THE TIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AVERAGE BETWEEN THE FRONT AND REAR AXLES ARE OUTSIDE OF
THE 1/2 INCH SPECIFICATION OR IF THE TIRE CIRCUMFERENCE FROM SIDE TO SIDE ON
EITHER AXLE EXCEEDS 1/2 INCH DIFFERENCE, THE SMALLER TIRE(S) MUST BE
REPLACED.
NOTE
REVIEW THE WARRANTY AND POLICY MANUAL FOR FORD MOTOR COMPANY TIRE
REPLACEMENT WARRANTY BEFORE PERFORMING THE SERVICE PROCEDURE.
NOTE
ONLY USE REPLACEMENT TIRE AND WHEEL THAT ARE THE SAME SIZE, LOAD INDEX,
SPEED RATING AND TYPE (SUCH AS P-METRIC VERSUS LT-METRIC OR ALL-SEASON
VERSUS ALL-TERRAIN) AS THOSE ORIGINALLY PROVIDED BY FORD. THE
RECOMMENDED TIRE AND WHEEL SIZE MAY BE FOUND ON EITHER THE SAFETY
COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION LABEL OR THE TIRE LABEL WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE
B-PILLAR OR EDGE OF THE DRIVER'S DOOR.
NOTE
ON SOME 4WD MODELS, THE INITIAL SHIFT FROM 2WD TO 4WD WHILE THE VEHICLE IS
MOVING CAN CAUSE A MOMENTARY CLUNK AND/OR BRIEF RATCHETING SOUND. THESE
SOUNDS ARE NORMAL AS THE FRONT DRIVETRAIN COMES UP TO SPEED AND IS NOT
CAUSE FOR CONCERN.
1. Review the tire label for correct tire size and tire inflation pressures located at the B-Pillar of the
driver's door.
2. If the tire size does not match the label, this procedure does not apply, follow normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
3. If the tire size is correct, ensure tire pressures are within specifications.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 3013
4. Raise the vehicle on the hoist, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 100-02.
5. Disconnect all wiring going to the transfer case and road test.
6. Is the shudder/binding present?
a. If the shudder/binding is still present, do not continue with this procedure, continue with WSM
normal diagnostic for 4X4.
b. If the shudder/binding is gone, proceed to Step 7.
7. Raise the vehicle on the hoist and reconnect all the wiring previously disconnected.
8. Using a tailor's tape or flexible measuring tape and measure the circumference of all four (4)
tires and record the measurements. (Figure 1)
9. Calculate the average of the circumference of the two (2) front tires and calculate the average of
the circumference of the two (2) rear tires. (Figure 2)
10. If the difference between these two averages is greater than 1/2" (12.7 mm), front to back or
side to side, replace the smallest circumference tire(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 3014
and remeasure the tire averages. Refer to WSM, Section 204-04 for tire replacement.
NOTE
WARRANTY COVERAGE ELIGIBILITY STARTS WITH 2007 NEW VEHICLE LIMITED
WARRANTY COVERAGE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082111A 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111A 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace TWO Tires. (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace Two (2) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 3015
Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150
Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do
Not Use With 1007A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A195 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection
Technical Service Bulletin # 05S35 Date: 050705
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3020
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED? Yes. OASIS will be activated by July 5, 2005
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? Yes
Available through by July 5, 2005.
Owner names and addresses will be available by July 18, 2005.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states provinces and countries.
Accordingly you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Inspect and if necessary correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TIRE REPLACEMENT GUIDELINES
^ Tires that fail the inspection must be replaced regardless of the mileage or the remaining tread on
the tire.
^ Ford Motor Company will only pay claims for the replacement tires ordered through the Ford Tire
Hotline that are listed in Attachment II under Ford Approved Replacement Tire List. Upgrades to
other brand and size tires are NOT allowed.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3021
^ Some vehicles may be equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Damaged
TPMS sensors are not covered under this program. Follow the instructions in Attachment III to
avoid damaging the TPMS sensor while dismounting the tire from the rim.
^ If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition call
the Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted (excluding the post-repair
wheel nut re-torque procedure - see below).
^ The owner letter will direct customers to the dealer to have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 500
miles (800km) after tire replacement. Dealers are to use the related damage flag to submit claims
for labor operation 05S35Z (post-repair wheel nut re-torque). Approval is not required for this labor
operation. This labor operation may only be claimed once after the original repair has been
completed.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company is offering a refund for owner-paid repairs covered by this recall if the repair
was performed prior to the date indicated in the reimbursement plan which is posted with this
bulletin. This plan is also available to owners through the Customer Relationship Center (CRC).
The CRC will direct owners to seek reimbursement through authorized dealers or at their option
directly through Ford Motor Company at P.O. Box 6251 Dearborn, MI 48121-6251.
^ Dealers are also authorized to refund owner-paid emergency repairs that were performed away
from an authorized servicing dealer after the end date specified in the reimbursement plan. Refund
claims that include other non-covered repairs or those judged by Ford to be excessive will not be
accepted for reimbursement.
^ This safety recall (tire tread inspection) must still be performed, even if the customer has paid for
a previous tire replacement Claiming a refund will not close the recall on this vehicle.
^ Refund Claiming Information (Submit on separate repair line.)
- Program Code: 05S35 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN
- Misc. Expense: REFUND - Misc. Expense: 0.2 Hrs.
RENTAL VEHICLES
Ford Motor Company will pay for a rental vehicle while a replacement tire is on order except for fuel
and insurance which will be at the owner's expense. Follow Extended Service Plan (ESP)
guidelines for rental dollar amounts. Enter the word "RENTAL" plus the number of days the vehicle
was used in the Miscellaneous Expense area of the recall claim form.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Enter each unique DOT code of the "new" replacement tires on the diagnostic code entry screen
in the Powertrain DTC fields. The "old" replaced tire DOT codes should be entered in the Body
DTC fields.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Enter the full part number of the replacement tire with the quantity of tires replaced. Tires will be
reimbursed at AtW Dealer cost +25% (mounting balancing valve stems and wheel weights
included).
- Virginia Dealers: Claim the additional 15% mark-up amount as miscellaneous expense code
"TIREMU".
^ Freight is not reimbursable. (Freight charges will be credited on the dealer's Ford Parts
statement.)
^ Tire disposal will be reimbursed see the Tire Disposal Allowance Attachment II.
^ Dealers may claim any applicable local waste tax - enter OTHER in the miscellaneous expense
area of the claim with the actual cost.
^ Refunds or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3022
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS ORDERING INFORMATION
The following part is necessary when changing a tire on a vehicle that is equipped with the optional
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
FORD APPROVED REPLACEMENT TIRE LIST
TIRE ORDERING INFORMATION
^ Tires must be ordered through the Ford Tire Hot Line. Identify the number of tires needed and
use the "05535 Replacement Tire Order Form" to order your tires. (See Attachment IV for the tire
order form.)
^ Tires will begin shipping the week of July 11, 2005
^ Orders will be fulfilled in the order they are received.
^ Ford Tire Hot Line hours are 8AM to 8PM Monday through Friday EST.
TIRE DESTRUCTION / MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
TIRE PRICE
For latest tire prices refer to the Tire Sales Tool on the website.
TIRE DISPOSAL ALLOWANCE
An allowance of $4.00 per tire is being provided for tire disposal. To claim the allowance enter the
dollar amount as "HANDLG" in the "MISC EXPENSE" area of the claim form.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST-REPAIR TORQUE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3023
The vehicle Owner's Guide states that each wheel that is removed and reinstalled must have the
wheel nuts re-tightened at 500 miles (800km) after service. This is required to permit the wheel
clamping system to seat correctly so that the wheel nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain
fully tightened. To claim this operation you must file a related damage claim using labor operation
05S35Z. This labor operation includes time to check the torque on all the wheel nuts.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves inspecting all four (4) tires of the vehicle for tread damaged caused by a
piece of metal on the conveyor line during vehicle assembly.
INSPECTION
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
2. Raise the vehicle on a hoist and inspect all four (4) tires for tread damage. See Figure 1.
^ If no tread damage is found, lower the vehicle, turn on the air suspension if equipped, and
release the vehicle.
^ Any tire found to have damaged tread must be replaced. Proceed to Tire Replacement.
TIRE REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3024
If the vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS), specific procedures
must be followed to remove and install the tire or damage to the TPMS sensors will occur. Related
damage claims for TPMS sensors will be rejected.
NOTE:
Vehicles equipped with TPMS can be identified by the presence of a metallic valve stem at each
wheel. Vehicles without TPMS will have rubber valve stems.
NOTE:
While the Workshop Repair Manual does not provide actual tire replacement procedures, it does
provide procedures for TPMS sensor removal and installation. To prevent damage to the sensor, it
must be removed and installed during tire removal and installation. Refer to Section 204-04 of the
ONLINE version of the 2006 Model Year Expedition/Navigator Workshop Repair Manual for the
most up-to-date service information available. Again, related damage claims for TPMS sensors will
be rejected.
1.
CAUTION: Do not remove the valve core from TPMS valve stem.
Remove the tire from the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor removal.
2. For vehicles without TPMS, install a new rubber valve stem.
3. Mount the new tire onto the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor installation.
4. Balance the wheel/tire assembly, then install it on the vehicle.
5. Tighten the wheel nuts to 204 Nm (150 lb-ft).
6. Lower the hoist and if equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the ON position.
7. Proceed to Tire Destruction/Mutilation.
TIRE DESTRUCTION/MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST REPAIR RETIGHTEN PROCEDURE
WARNING:
Re-tighten the wheel nuts at 800 km (500 miles) after any wheel change or any time the wheel nuts
are loosened. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
The Owner Guide and workshop repair manual recommend that each wheel removed and
reinstalled must have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 800 km (500 miles) after service. Wheel nut
torque specification is 204 Nm (150 lb-ft). This is required to permit the wheel clamping system to
seat correctly so that the wheel lug nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain fully tightened.
To claim this operation, refer to Attachment II.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3025
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3026
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3027
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3028
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > NHTSA05V310000 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for Damage
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for Damage
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2006 Lincoln/Navigator 2006
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V310000 MFG'S
REPORT DATE: July 05, 2005
COMPONENT: Tires: Tread/Belt
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 10061
SUMMARY: On certain sport utility vehicles, the front and rear tires on the driver's side of affected
vehicles may have been damaged at the center tread during production.
CONSEQUENCE: Over time, the damage may be sufficient to allow belt corrosion ultimately
leading to a tread separation, which could result in a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect all four tires (to ensure inspection of the left hand side tires that may
have been rotated to the other side of the vehicle) for tire tread damage and, if necessary, replace
the damaged tire. The recall began on July 13, 2005. Owners should contact Ford at
1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 05S35. Please note that this program will expire on December 31, 2005.
Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety
Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns
TSB 08-21-11
10/27/08
4 WHEEL DRIVE/ALL WHEEL DRIVE - WITH CONTROL TRAC - SHUDDER ON
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION OR BINDING ON SLOW TURNS
FORD: 1997-2008 Expedition, Explorer 2006-2008 F-150 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac 2008
F-150
LINCOLN: 1998-2008 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2005 Mountaineer 2006-2008 Mountaineer
ISSUE Various 1997-2008 vehicles equipped with either 4 wheel drive or all wheel drive and
equipped with control trac may exhibit a shudder on acceleration/deceleration, binding in slow
speed turns or noise from the front driveline and/or transfer case. The shudder/binding will occur
with the vehicle being operated in the awd/auto 4x4 mode. The shudder/binding may be due to
incorrect tire circumference or improper tire inflation pressures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS DOES NOT APPLY TO 2006-2008 MOUNTAINEER WITH A 4.0L ENGINE OR 2007-2008
EXPLORER AND SPORT TRAC WITH 20 INCH WHEELS.
NOTE
VEHICLES ON THE LIST MAY REQUIRE REPLACEMENT OF TIRE/S IF THE TIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AVERAGE BETWEEN THE FRONT AND REAR AXLES ARE OUTSIDE OF
THE 1/2 INCH SPECIFICATION OR IF THE TIRE CIRCUMFERENCE FROM SIDE TO SIDE ON
EITHER AXLE EXCEEDS 1/2 INCH DIFFERENCE, THE SMALLER TIRE(S) MUST BE
REPLACED.
NOTE
REVIEW THE WARRANTY AND POLICY MANUAL FOR FORD MOTOR COMPANY TIRE
REPLACEMENT WARRANTY BEFORE PERFORMING THE SERVICE PROCEDURE.
NOTE
ONLY USE REPLACEMENT TIRE AND WHEEL THAT ARE THE SAME SIZE, LOAD INDEX,
SPEED RATING AND TYPE (SUCH AS P-METRIC VERSUS LT-METRIC OR ALL-SEASON
VERSUS ALL-TERRAIN) AS THOSE ORIGINALLY PROVIDED BY FORD. THE
RECOMMENDED TIRE AND WHEEL SIZE MAY BE FOUND ON EITHER THE SAFETY
COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION LABEL OR THE TIRE LABEL WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE
B-PILLAR OR EDGE OF THE DRIVER'S DOOR.
NOTE
ON SOME 4WD MODELS, THE INITIAL SHIFT FROM 2WD TO 4WD WHILE THE VEHICLE IS
MOVING CAN CAUSE A MOMENTARY CLUNK AND/OR BRIEF RATCHETING SOUND. THESE
SOUNDS ARE NORMAL AS THE FRONT DRIVETRAIN COMES UP TO SPEED AND IS NOT
CAUSE FOR CONCERN.
1. Review the tire label for correct tire size and tire inflation pressures located at the B-Pillar of the
driver's door.
2. If the tire size does not match the label, this procedure does not apply, follow normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
3. If the tire size is correct, ensure tire pressures are within specifications.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 3038
4. Raise the vehicle on the hoist, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 100-02.
5. Disconnect all wiring going to the transfer case and road test.
6. Is the shudder/binding present?
a. If the shudder/binding is still present, do not continue with this procedure, continue with WSM
normal diagnostic for 4X4.
b. If the shudder/binding is gone, proceed to Step 7.
7. Raise the vehicle on the hoist and reconnect all the wiring previously disconnected.
8. Using a tailor's tape or flexible measuring tape and measure the circumference of all four (4)
tires and record the measurements. (Figure 1)
9. Calculate the average of the circumference of the two (2) front tires and calculate the average of
the circumference of the two (2) rear tires. (Figure 2)
10. If the difference between these two averages is greater than 1/2" (12.7 mm), front to back or
side to side, replace the smallest circumference tire(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 3039
and remeasure the tire averages. Refer to WSM, Section 204-04 for tire replacement.
NOTE
WARRANTY COVERAGE ELIGIBILITY STARTS WITH 2007 NEW VEHICLE LIMITED
WARRANTY COVERAGE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082111A 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111A 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace TWO Tires. (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace Two (2) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 3040
Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150
Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do
Not Use With 1007A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A195 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection
Technical Service Bulletin # 05S35 Date: 050705
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3046
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED? Yes. OASIS will be activated by July 5, 2005
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? Yes
Available through by July 5, 2005.
Owner names and addresses will be available by July 18, 2005.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states provinces and countries.
Accordingly you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Inspect and if necessary correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TIRE REPLACEMENT GUIDELINES
^ Tires that fail the inspection must be replaced regardless of the mileage or the remaining tread on
the tire.
^ Ford Motor Company will only pay claims for the replacement tires ordered through the Ford Tire
Hotline that are listed in Attachment II under Ford Approved Replacement Tire List. Upgrades to
other brand and size tires are NOT allowed.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3047
^ Some vehicles may be equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Damaged
TPMS sensors are not covered under this program. Follow the instructions in Attachment III to
avoid damaging the TPMS sensor while dismounting the tire from the rim.
^ If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition call
the Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted (excluding the post-repair
wheel nut re-torque procedure - see below).
^ The owner letter will direct customers to the dealer to have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 500
miles (800km) after tire replacement. Dealers are to use the related damage flag to submit claims
for labor operation 05S35Z (post-repair wheel nut re-torque). Approval is not required for this labor
operation. This labor operation may only be claimed once after the original repair has been
completed.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company is offering a refund for owner-paid repairs covered by this recall if the repair
was performed prior to the date indicated in the reimbursement plan which is posted with this
bulletin. This plan is also available to owners through the Customer Relationship Center (CRC).
The CRC will direct owners to seek reimbursement through authorized dealers or at their option
directly through Ford Motor Company at P.O. Box 6251 Dearborn, MI 48121-6251.
^ Dealers are also authorized to refund owner-paid emergency repairs that were performed away
from an authorized servicing dealer after the end date specified in the reimbursement plan. Refund
claims that include other non-covered repairs or those judged by Ford to be excessive will not be
accepted for reimbursement.
^ This safety recall (tire tread inspection) must still be performed, even if the customer has paid for
a previous tire replacement Claiming a refund will not close the recall on this vehicle.
^ Refund Claiming Information (Submit on separate repair line.)
- Program Code: 05S35 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN
- Misc. Expense: REFUND - Misc. Expense: 0.2 Hrs.
RENTAL VEHICLES
Ford Motor Company will pay for a rental vehicle while a replacement tire is on order except for fuel
and insurance which will be at the owner's expense. Follow Extended Service Plan (ESP)
guidelines for rental dollar amounts. Enter the word "RENTAL" plus the number of days the vehicle
was used in the Miscellaneous Expense area of the recall claim form.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Enter each unique DOT code of the "new" replacement tires on the diagnostic code entry screen
in the Powertrain DTC fields. The "old" replaced tire DOT codes should be entered in the Body
DTC fields.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Enter the full part number of the replacement tire with the quantity of tires replaced. Tires will be
reimbursed at AtW Dealer cost +25% (mounting balancing valve stems and wheel weights
included).
- Virginia Dealers: Claim the additional 15% mark-up amount as miscellaneous expense code
"TIREMU".
^ Freight is not reimbursable. (Freight charges will be credited on the dealer's Ford Parts
statement.)
^ Tire disposal will be reimbursed see the Tire Disposal Allowance Attachment II.
^ Dealers may claim any applicable local waste tax - enter OTHER in the miscellaneous expense
area of the claim with the actual cost.
^ Refunds or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3048
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS ORDERING INFORMATION
The following part is necessary when changing a tire on a vehicle that is equipped with the optional
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
FORD APPROVED REPLACEMENT TIRE LIST
TIRE ORDERING INFORMATION
^ Tires must be ordered through the Ford Tire Hot Line. Identify the number of tires needed and
use the "05535 Replacement Tire Order Form" to order your tires. (See Attachment IV for the tire
order form.)
^ Tires will begin shipping the week of July 11, 2005
^ Orders will be fulfilled in the order they are received.
^ Ford Tire Hot Line hours are 8AM to 8PM Monday through Friday EST.
TIRE DESTRUCTION / MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
TIRE PRICE
For latest tire prices refer to the Tire Sales Tool on the website.
TIRE DISPOSAL ALLOWANCE
An allowance of $4.00 per tire is being provided for tire disposal. To claim the allowance enter the
dollar amount as "HANDLG" in the "MISC EXPENSE" area of the claim form.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST-REPAIR TORQUE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3049
The vehicle Owner's Guide states that each wheel that is removed and reinstalled must have the
wheel nuts re-tightened at 500 miles (800km) after service. This is required to permit the wheel
clamping system to seat correctly so that the wheel nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain
fully tightened. To claim this operation you must file a related damage claim using labor operation
05S35Z. This labor operation includes time to check the torque on all the wheel nuts.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves inspecting all four (4) tires of the vehicle for tread damaged caused by a
piece of metal on the conveyor line during vehicle assembly.
INSPECTION
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
2. Raise the vehicle on a hoist and inspect all four (4) tires for tread damage. See Figure 1.
^ If no tread damage is found, lower the vehicle, turn on the air suspension if equipped, and
release the vehicle.
^ Any tire found to have damaged tread must be replaced. Proceed to Tire Replacement.
TIRE REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3050
If the vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS), specific procedures
must be followed to remove and install the tire or damage to the TPMS sensors will occur. Related
damage claims for TPMS sensors will be rejected.
NOTE:
Vehicles equipped with TPMS can be identified by the presence of a metallic valve stem at each
wheel. Vehicles without TPMS will have rubber valve stems.
NOTE:
While the Workshop Repair Manual does not provide actual tire replacement procedures, it does
provide procedures for TPMS sensor removal and installation. To prevent damage to the sensor, it
must be removed and installed during tire removal and installation. Refer to Section 204-04 of the
ONLINE version of the 2006 Model Year Expedition/Navigator Workshop Repair Manual for the
most up-to-date service information available. Again, related damage claims for TPMS sensors will
be rejected.
1.
CAUTION: Do not remove the valve core from TPMS valve stem.
Remove the tire from the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor removal.
2. For vehicles without TPMS, install a new rubber valve stem.
3. Mount the new tire onto the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor installation.
4. Balance the wheel/tire assembly, then install it on the vehicle.
5. Tighten the wheel nuts to 204 Nm (150 lb-ft).
6. Lower the hoist and if equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the ON position.
7. Proceed to Tire Destruction/Mutilation.
TIRE DESTRUCTION/MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST REPAIR RETIGHTEN PROCEDURE
WARNING:
Re-tighten the wheel nuts at 800 km (500 miles) after any wheel change or any time the wheel nuts
are loosened. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
The Owner Guide and workshop repair manual recommend that each wheel removed and
reinstalled must have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 800 km (500 miles) after service. Wheel nut
torque specification is 204 Nm (150 lb-ft). This is required to permit the wheel clamping system to
seat correctly so that the wheel lug nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain fully tightened.
To claim this operation, refer to Attachment II.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3051
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3052
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3053
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 3054
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > NHTSA05V310000 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for Damage
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for Damage
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2006 Lincoln/Navigator 2006
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V310000 MFG'S
REPORT DATE: July 05, 2005
COMPONENT: Tires: Tread/Belt
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 10061
SUMMARY: On certain sport utility vehicles, the front and rear tires on the driver's side of affected
vehicles may have been damaged at the center tread during production.
CONSEQUENCE: Over time, the damage may be sufficient to allow belt corrosion ultimately
leading to a tread separation, which could result in a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect all four tires (to ensure inspection of the left hand side tires that may
have been rotated to the other side of the vehicle) for tire tread damage and, if necessary, replace
the damaged tire. The recall began on July 13, 2005. Owners should contact Ford at
1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 05S35. Please note that this program will expire on December 31, 2005.
Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety
Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS
High Temperature 4x4 Front Axle & Wheel Bearing Grease
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
...................................................... E8TZ-19590-A Ford Specification ................................................
................................................................................................................................... ESA-M1C198-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 3062
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist.
3. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the rear halfshaft nut and washer. ^
To install, tighten to 300 Nm (221 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 3063
4. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV Joint from the wheel hub.
5. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the brake disc.
7. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector and detach the wheel speed sensor
harness from the retainer.
8. Remove the bolt and detach the harness from the retainers. To install, tighten the bolt to 15 Nm
(11 ft. lbs.). 9. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and hub assembly bolts, the wheel bearing assembly
and the wheel speed sensor as an assembly.
^ Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake shield.
^ Discard the bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 ft. lbs.).
10. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and hub assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front axle nut .......................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 27 Nm (20 ft.lbs.) Rear axle wheel hub retainer ...........................
...................................................................................................................................... 345 Nm (254
ft.lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3071
C1157
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Tighten the wheel nuts, using the pattern indicated, to
............................................................................................................. 204 Nm (150 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 3075
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair
Wheel Studs
Special Tools
Removal
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub assembly.
2. CAUTION: Never use a hammer to remove a wheel stud.
Damage to the wheel hub can result. ^
Place the wheel hub in a soft jawed vice and, using the special tool, remove the wheel stud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 3076
Installation
1. Position the new wheel stud in the wheel bearing and hub assembly, aligning the serrations in
the wheel hub flange made by the original wheel
stud.
2. CAUTION: Do not use power tools to install the wheel stud. The serrations on the flange can be
stripped.
NOTE: Do not use the wheel nut that came with the vehicle.
Install 4 washers and a wheel nut on the wheel stud and tighten the wheel nut until the stud seats
against the flange.
3. Remove the wheel nut and washers.
^ Discard the wheel nut.
4. Install the wheel bearing and wheel hub assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
JACKING
WARNING:
- The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut down prior to hoisting, jacking or
towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension
switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected
inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these
operations.
- Do not run the engine when jacking the vehicle. The wheels contacting the ground could cause
the vehicle to move.
- Support the vehicle prior to carrying out any procedure requiring the vehicle to be jacked off the
ground.
- Make sure the jack and jack stands are correctly located to prevent the vehicle from falling.
- Wheel chocks should be used to prevent the vehicle from rolling and falling off the jack.
CAUTION:
- Never use a halfshaft as a lifting point.
- If equipped with retractable running board, disable the system through the instrument cluster
controls.
Jacking Points - Front
Jacking Points - Front
The front jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located behind the front tire and
wheel assembly.
Jacking Points - Rear
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3080
Jacking Points - Rear
CAUTION: Do not use the differential housing as a lift point. Leaks or damage to the rear axle cover and
adjoining differential housing surface can occur if a floor jack or any lifting device is allowed to
contact the cover at any point where the cover joins the housing.
- Do not use the rear control arms as a lifting point.
The rear jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located in front of the rear tire
and wheel assembly.
LIFTING
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut down prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel area. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations.
CAUTION: Damage to suspension, exhaust and steering linkage components can occur if care is
not exercised when positioning the hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
Lifting Points - Twin Post Hoist
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3081
Lifting Points - Twin Post Hoist
Locate the front hoist adapters and rear hoist adapters (top of frame arc) as indicated.
Lifting Points - Drive On Hoist
Lifting Points - Drive On Hoist
The vehicle is supported by tires and suspension components.
Lifting Points - Floor Jack, Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3082
Lifting Points - Floor Jack, Front
The front can be lifted using a floor jack under the front control arm directly below the shock.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page 3090
C1452
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3091
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS Systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
Variable Camshaft Timing System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3092
achieved. A difference between the desired and actual camshaft position represents a position
error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a
default position if a concern is detected. A related DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL SOLENOID
LH Shown, RH Similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the variable camshaft timing (VCT) oil
control solenoid electrical connector. 3. Remove the VCT oil control solenoid grommet. 4. Remove
the bolt and the VCT oil control solenoid. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 1)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 2)
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75 percent of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit
Chart.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 3099
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test-Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of five compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test-Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75 percent of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit
Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 1)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 2)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 3100
Compression Test-Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty. 2. If compression does not
improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly. 3. If two adjacent cylinders indicate low
compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does not increase compression, the head
gasket may
be leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75 percent of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Bearing: Specifications
Camshaft bearing cap bolts .................................................................................................................
.............................................. 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See:
Camshaft/Service and Repair
2. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See:
Camshaft/Service and Repair
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the special
tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must
be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing
Components
Remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket from the timing chain.
4. Inspect the front of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for missing or damaged roll pins.
- If the roll pins are missing or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be installed.
5. Inspect the rear of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for a deformed or damaged location pin.
- If the location pin is deformed or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be
installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3108
6. Visually inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for squareness (A). If the trigger wheel or
spring is deformed or damaged (B), install a new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
If installing a new camshaft phaser and sprocket, transfer the original scribe mark to the new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
2. NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to
valves and pistons will result.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Align the scribe marks and position the camshaft phaser and sprocket into the timing chain.
3. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See:
Camshaft/Service and Repair
4. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See:
Camshaft/Service and Repair
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures
Camshaft: Service and Repair General Procedures
Camshaft Journal-Diameter
1. Measure each camshaft journal diameter in two directions.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Camshaft Journal-Clearance, Plastigage Method
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: The camshaft journals must meet specifications before checking camshaft journal
clearance.
1. Remove the camshaft bearing cap and lay Plastigage across the surface.
2. NOTE: Do not turn the camshaft while carrying out this procedure.
Position the camshaft bearing cap and install the bolts.
3. Use Plastigage to verify the camshaft journal clearance.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Camshaft End Play
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3113
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
1. Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure camshaft end play. 2. Position the
camshaft to the rear of the cylinder head. 3. Zero the indicator.
4. Move the camshaft to the front of the cylinder head. Note and record the camshaft end play.
^ If camshaft end play exceeds specifications, install new camshaft and recheck end play.
^ If camshaft end play exceeds specification after camshaft installation, install a new cylinder head.
Camshaft-Lobe Surface
1. Inspect camshaft lobes for pitting or damage in the contact area. Minor pitting is acceptable
outside the contact area.
^ If excessive pitting or damage is present, install new components as necessary.
Camshaft Lobe Lift
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3114
1. Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure camshaft intake exhaust lobe lift.
^ Rotate the camshaft and subtract the lowest indicator reading from the highest indicator reading
to figure the camshaft lobe lift.
^
Camshaft Runout
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
1. NOTE: Camshaft journals must be within specifications before checking runout.
Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure the camshaft runout. ^
Rotate the camshaft and subtract the lowest indicator reading from the highest indicator reading.
^ For additional information, refer to the specification chart in the appropriate engine section.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3115
Camshaft: Service and Repair Camshaft - LH
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
NOTICE: The camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the valves and pistons
will result.
1. Position the crankshaft damper spoke at the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation
at the 1 o'clock position.
2. Remove the LH valve cover.
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
Loosen and back off the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt one full turn.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3116
4. Disconnect the LH camshaft position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the LH CMP sensor and the bolt.
6. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft keyway will
require one full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
The No.5 cylinder camshaft lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by noting the
position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the No.5 cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3117
7. Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration.
8. NOTICE: The camshaft roller followers must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft roller follower locations. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder. If
a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the special tool, remove only the 3 designated camshaft roller followers from the previous
step.
9. NOTICE: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set or engine
damage may occur.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3118
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise, as viewed from the front, positioning the crankshaft damper spoke
at the 6 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation at the 7 o'clock position.
10. NOTICE: Engine is not freewheeling. Camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage
to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: The Timing Chain Wedge tool must be installed square to the timing chain and the engine
block.
NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Install the special tool in the LH timing chain as shown.
11. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement, the
engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For additional information,
refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing Components
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3119
Scribe a location mark on the timing chain and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly.
12. NOTICE: Remove the front thrust camshaft bearing cap straight upward from the bearing
towers or the bearing cap may be damaged from side
loading.
Remove the 2 bolts and the LH cylinder head camshaft front bearing cap.
13. NOTICE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft bearing cap locations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove the remaining bolts in the sequence shown and remove the LH cylinder head camshaft
bearing caps.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3120
14. Clean and inspect the LH camshaft bearing caps.
- The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
15. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the special
tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must
be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing
Components
Remove the bolt and withdraw the camshaft from the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly,
leaving the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly in place.
Discard the bolt and washer.
16. Inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for damage. For additional information, refer to
Camshaft Phaser and Sprocket. See: In-Vehicle Repair
Installation
1. Lubricate the camshaft and camshaft journals with clean engine oil.
2. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement, the
engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For additional information,
refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing Components
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3121
Install the camshaft into the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly and onto the head. Install a
new camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt finger-tight.
3. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement, the
engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For additional information,
refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing Components
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Verify the camshaft phaser and sprocket and timing chain scribe marks are still in alignment.
4. NOTE: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Install the camshaft bearing caps in their original locations.
- Lubricate the camshaft bearing caps with clean engine oil.
- Position the front camshaft bearing cap.
- Position the remaining camshaft bearing caps.
- Install the bolts loosely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3122
5. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Remove the special tools.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3123
7. Rotate the crankshaft a half turn counterclockwise and position the crankshaft damper spoke at
the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark
indentation at the 1 o'clock position.
8. Verify correct camshaft position by noting the position of the No.5 cylinder intake and exhaust
camshaft lobes.
9. NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder. If a valve drops into the cylinder, the
cylinder head must be removed. For additional information, refer to Cylinder Head. See: Cylinder
Head Assembly
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the special tool, install the 3 originally removed camshaft roller followers.
10. Install the CMP sensor and the bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3124
11. Connect the CMP electrical connector.
12. NOTICE: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and
sprocket.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Tighten the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt in 2 stages:
- Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90°.
13. In stall the LH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3125
Camshaft: Service and Repair Camshaft - RH
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
NOTICE: The camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the valves and pistons
will result.
1. Position the crankshaft damper spoke at the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation
at the 1 o'clock position.
2. Remove the RH valve cover.
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
Loosen and back off the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt one full turn.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3126
4. Disconnect the RH camshaft position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the bolt and the RH CMP sensor.
6. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft will require one
full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
The No.1 cylinder camshaft exhaust lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by
noting the position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the No.1 cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3127
7. Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration.
8. NOTICE: The camshaft roller followers must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft roller follower locations. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder. If
a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the special tool, remove only the 3 designated camshaft roller followers from the previous
step.
9. NOTICE: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set or engine
damage may occur.
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise, as viewed from the front, positioning the crankshaft damper spoke
at the 6 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation at the 7 o'clock position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3128
10. NOTICE: Engine is not freewheeling. Camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage
to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: The Timing Chain Wedge tool must be installed square to the timing chain and the engine
block.
NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Install the special tool in the RH timing chain as shown.
11. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement, the
engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For additional information,
refer to Timing Drive Components.
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
Scribe a location mark on the timing chain and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly.
12. NOTICE: Remove the front thrust camshaft bearing cap straight upward from the bearing
towers or the bearing cap may be damaged from side
loading.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3129
Remove the 2 bolts and the RH cylinder head camshaft front bearing cap.
13. NOTICE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft bearing cap locations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove the remaining bolts in the sequence shown and remove the RH cylinder head camshaft
bearing caps.
14. Clean and inspect the RH camshaft bearing caps.
- The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
15. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the special
tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must
be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing
Components
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3130
Remove the bolt and withdraw the camshaft from the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly,
leaving the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly in place. Discard the bolt and washer.
16. Inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for damage. For additional information, refer to
Camshaft Phaser and Sprocket. See: Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket
Installation
1. Lubricate the camshaft and camshaft journals with clean engine oil.
2. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement, the
engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For additional information,
refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing Components
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Install the camshaft into the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly and onto the head. Install a
new camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt finger-tight.
3. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement, the
engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For additional information,
refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing Components
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3131
Verify the camshaft phaser and sprocket and timing chain scribe marks are still in alignment.
4. NOTE: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Install the camshaft bearing caps in their original locations.
- Lubricate the camshaft bearing caps with clean engine oil.
- Position the front camshaft bearing cap.
- Position the remaining camshaft bearing caps.
- Install the bolts loosely.
5. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3132
Remove the special tool.
7. Rotate the crankshaft a half turn counterclockwise and position the crankshaft damper spoke at
the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark
indentation at the 1 o'clock position.
8. Verify correct camshaft position by noting the position of the No.1 cylinder intake and exhaust
camshaft lobes.
9. NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder. If a valve drops into the cylinder, the
cylinder head must be removed.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3133
Using the special tool, install the 3 originally removed camshaft roller followers.
10. Install the CMP sensor and the bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
11. Connect the CMP electrical connector.
12. NOTICE: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and
sprocket.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Tighten the new camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt in 2 stages:
- Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3134
- stage 2: Tighten an additional 90°.
13. Install the RH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3135
Camshaft: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Repair
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See:
2. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See:
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the special
tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must
be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing
Components
Remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket from the timing chain.
4. Inspect the front of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for missing or damaged roll pins.
- If the roll pins are missing or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be installed.
5. Inspect the rear of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for a deformed or damaged location pin.
- If the location pin is deformed or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be
installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3136
6. Visually inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for squareness (A). If the trigger wheel or
spring is deformed or damaged (B), install a new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
If installing a new camshaft phaser and sprocket, transfer the original scribe mark to the new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
2. NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to
valves and pistons will result.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Align the scribe marks and position the camshaft phaser and sprocket into the timing chain.
3. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See:
4. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-9-11 > May > 06 > Engine
- Loud Valve Train Ticking Noise
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Customer Interest Engine - Loud Valve Train Ticking Noise
TSB 06-9-11
05/15/06
LOUD TICKING NOISE - 3-VALVE ENGINES - STUCK LASH ADJUSTER
FORD: 2006 Mustang, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-250, F-350
LINCOLN: 2006 Mark LT, Navigator
MERCURY: 2006 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some vehicles equipped with 4.6L, 5.4L, and 6.8L 3-valve engines built between 1/11/2006
and 2/14/2006 may exhibit a loud ticking noise in the valve train area. This may be caused by a
stuck/collapsed lash adjuster.
ACTION Verify engine build date, isolate, and replace any stuck/collapsed lash adjuster by
following the Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check date code on the engine, located on the engine timing cover.
a. Date code between 1/11/2006 and 2/14/2006, proceed to Step 2.
b. Date code NOT between 1/11/2006 and 2/14/2006, this TSB does not apply, perform normal
diagnostics.
2. Isolate the source of the noise to the cam cover on either Bank 1 or Bank 2. If the noise is not
isolated to either cam cover, this TSB does not apply. Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM)
procedures for additional diagnostics.
3. Remove the appropriate cam cover.
4. Check for stuck/collapsed lash adjuster(s) by placing the cam lobe on the base circle and
inspecting for loose cam followers as a result of the lash adjuster plunger being bottomed out.
NOTE
A COLLAPSED LASH ADJUSTER WILL RESULT IN EXCESSIVE CLEARANCE BETWEEN THE
LASH ADJUSTER AND THE CAM FOLLOWER.
NOTE
WHEN CHECKING "3V" LASH ADJUSTERS - A "SPONGY" LASH ADJUSTER IS NORMAL
WHEN OIL PRESSURE IS "NOT" APPLIED.
5. Replace only the affected lash adjuster(s) on the affected bank(s) following the procedures
outlined in the appropriate WSM, Section 303.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
060911A 2006 Expedition/Navigator 4.6 Hrs.
5.4L 3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Right Side Of Engine (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-9-11 > May > 06 > Engine
- Loud Valve Train Ticking Noise > Page 3145
Not Use With 6051A, 6306A, 9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911A 2006 F-150/Mark LT 5.4L 3.8 Hrs.
3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Right Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer 2.6 Hrs.
4.6L 3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Right Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A,
6306A, 9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911A 2006 Super Duty 5.4L 3V: 3.2 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Right Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911A 2006 Super Duty 6.8L 3V: 4.9 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Right Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911A 2006 Mustang 4.6L 3V: 2.3 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Right Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 Expedition/Navigator 2.6 Hrs.
5.4L 3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A,
6306A, 9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 F-150/Mark LT 5.4L 2.6 Hrs.
3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer 2.4 Hrs.
4.6L 3V:: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A,
6306A, 9424A, 6584A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-9-11 > May > 06 > Engine
- Loud Valve Train Ticking Noise > Page 3146
6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 Super Duty 5.4L 3V: 2.7 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A, 9424A,
6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 Super Duty 6.8L 3V: 3.1 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A, 9424A,
6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 Mustang 4.6L 3V: 2.4 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911C 2006 Expedition/Navigator 6.6 Hrs.
5.4L 3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A,
6306A, 9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911C 2006 F-150/Mark LT 5.4L 5.6 Hrs.
3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911C 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer 4.4 Hrs.
4.6L 3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A,
6306A, 9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911C 2006 Super Duty 5.4L 3V: 5.3 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911C 2006 Super Duty 6.8L 3V: 7.4 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-9-11 > May > 06 > Engine
- Loud Valve Train Ticking Noise > Page 3147
060911C 2006 Mustang 4.6L 3V: 4.2 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6500 69
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-9-11 > May >
06 > Engine - Loud Valve Train Ticking Noise
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Loud Valve Train Ticking Noise
TSB 06-9-11
05/15/06
LOUD TICKING NOISE - 3-VALVE ENGINES - STUCK LASH ADJUSTER
FORD: 2006 Mustang, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-250, F-350
LINCOLN: 2006 Mark LT, Navigator
MERCURY: 2006 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some vehicles equipped with 4.6L, 5.4L, and 6.8L 3-valve engines built between 1/11/2006
and 2/14/2006 may exhibit a loud ticking noise in the valve train area. This may be caused by a
stuck/collapsed lash adjuster.
ACTION Verify engine build date, isolate, and replace any stuck/collapsed lash adjuster by
following the Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check date code on the engine, located on the engine timing cover.
a. Date code between 1/11/2006 and 2/14/2006, proceed to Step 2.
b. Date code NOT between 1/11/2006 and 2/14/2006, this TSB does not apply, perform normal
diagnostics.
2. Isolate the source of the noise to the cam cover on either Bank 1 or Bank 2. If the noise is not
isolated to either cam cover, this TSB does not apply. Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM)
procedures for additional diagnostics.
3. Remove the appropriate cam cover.
4. Check for stuck/collapsed lash adjuster(s) by placing the cam lobe on the base circle and
inspecting for loose cam followers as a result of the lash adjuster plunger being bottomed out.
NOTE
A COLLAPSED LASH ADJUSTER WILL RESULT IN EXCESSIVE CLEARANCE BETWEEN THE
LASH ADJUSTER AND THE CAM FOLLOWER.
NOTE
WHEN CHECKING "3V" LASH ADJUSTERS - A "SPONGY" LASH ADJUSTER IS NORMAL
WHEN OIL PRESSURE IS "NOT" APPLIED.
5. Replace only the affected lash adjuster(s) on the affected bank(s) following the procedures
outlined in the appropriate WSM, Section 303.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
060911A 2006 Expedition/Navigator 4.6 Hrs.
5.4L 3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Right Side Of Engine (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-9-11 > May >
06 > Engine - Loud Valve Train Ticking Noise > Page 3153
Not Use With 6051A, 6306A, 9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911A 2006 F-150/Mark LT 5.4L 3.8 Hrs.
3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Right Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer 2.6 Hrs.
4.6L 3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Right Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A,
6306A, 9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911A 2006 Super Duty 5.4L 3V: 3.2 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Right Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911A 2006 Super Duty 6.8L 3V: 4.9 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Right Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911A 2006 Mustang 4.6L 3V: 2.3 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Right Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 Expedition/Navigator 2.6 Hrs.
5.4L 3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A,
6306A, 9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 F-150/Mark LT 5.4L 2.6 Hrs.
3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer 2.4 Hrs.
4.6L 3V:: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A,
6306A, 9424A, 6584A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-9-11 > May >
06 > Engine - Loud Valve Train Ticking Noise > Page 3154
6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 Super Duty 5.4L 3V: 2.7 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A, 9424A,
6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 Super Duty 6.8L 3V: 3.1 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A, 9424A,
6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911B 2006 Mustang 4.6L 3V: 2.4 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Left Side Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911C 2006 Expedition/Navigator 6.6 Hrs.
5.4L 3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A,
6306A, 9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911C 2006 F-150/Mark LT 5.4L 5.6 Hrs.
3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911C 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer 4.4 Hrs.
4.6L 3V: Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A,
6306A, 9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911C 2006 Super Duty 5.4L 3V: 5.3 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
060911C 2006 Super Duty 6.8L 3V: 7.4 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster(s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-9-11 > May >
06 > Engine - Loud Valve Train Ticking Noise > Page 3155
060911C 2006 Mustang 4.6L 3V: 4.2 Hrs.
Isolate And Replace Lash Adjuster (s) Both Sides Of Engine (Do Not Use With 6051A, 6306A,
9424A, 6584A, 6256A, 6250A, 6500A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6500 69
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Lifter / Lash
Adjuster: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Parking Assist System - Speaker
Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Lifter / Lash
Adjuster: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 > Page 3161
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Lifter / Lash
Adjuster: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 > Page 3167
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair General Procedures
Hydraulic Lash Adjuster-Inspection
1. Inspect the hydraulic lash adjuster and roller follower for damage. If any damage is found,
inspect the camshaft lobes and valves for damage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3170
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair Hydraulic Lash Adjuster
Hydraulic Lash Adjuster
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the camshafts. 2. Remove the remaining camshaft roller followers from the cylinder
head being serviced.
3. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into the
original locations.
Remove the hydraulic lash adjusters that are being serviced.
4. Inspect the hydraulic lash adjusters.
5. NOTE: Lubricate each of the hydraulic lash adjusters with clean engine oil prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Roller Follower
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Camshaft Roller Follower
Camshaft Roller Follower
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. Depending on the camshaft roller follower being serviced, remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2.
Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with the
intake valve and the exhaust valves closed.
3. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same position.
Mark the components for installation into the
original location.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller follower.
4. Repeat the previous 2 steps for each camshaft roller follower being serviced. 5. Inspect the
camshaft roller follower.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Roller Follower > Page 3175
1. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same position.
Mark the components for installation into the
original locations.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller follower.
2. Repeat the previous step for each camshaft roller follower being serviced. 3. Depending on the
camshaft roller follower being serviced, install the LH or RH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Roller Follower > Page 3176
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair General Procedures
Roller Follower-Inspection
1. Inspect the roller follower for flat spots or scoring. If any damage is found, inspect the camshaft
lobes and hydraulic lash adjuster for damage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page 3181
C1452
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3182
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS Systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
Variable Camshaft Timing System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3183
achieved. A difference between the desired and actual camshaft position represents a position
error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a
default position if a concern is detected. A related DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
Rod bearing bore diameter (with assembled liners)
............................................................................................... 53.049-53.027 mm (2.0885-2.0877
inch) Rod bearing-to-crankshaft clearance
.......................................................................................................................... 0.064-0.026 mm
(0.0025-0.0010 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod: Specifications
Connecting rod journal
Diameter
.............................................................................................................................................................
53.003-52.983 mm (2.0867-2.0859 inch) Maximum taper ..................................................................
........................................................................................................... 0.004 mm (0.0002 inch)
Maximum out-of-round between cross sections
.......................................................................................................................... 0.0075 mm (0.0003
inch)
Rod-to-pin clearance
................................................................................................................................................
0.009-0.0235 mm (0.0004-0.0093 inch) Rod pin bore diameter
............................................................................................................................................
22.012-22.024 mm (0.8666-0.8671 inch) Rod length (center-to-center)
............................................................................................................................................................
169.1 mm (6.6575 inch) Rod maximum allowed bend
............................................................................................................................................................
0.038 mm (0.0015 inch) Rod maximum allowed twist
...........................................................................................................................................................
0.05 mm (0.0020 inch) b
Rod bearing bore diameter (with assembled liners)
............................................................................................... 53.049-53.027 mm (2.0885-2.0877
inch) Rod bearing-to-crankshaft clearance
.......................................................................................................................... 0.064-0.026 mm
(0.0025-0.0010 inch) Rod side clearance
.....................................................................................................................................................
0.475-0.125 mm (0.0187-0.0049 inch)
b The pin bore and crank bearing bore must be parallel and in the same vertical plane within the
specified total difference when measured at the ends of a 203 mm bar, 105.5 mm on each side of
rod centerline.
Connecting rod cap bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.) Final pass ............................................................
............................................................................................................................................ tighten
105°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3191
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair
Connecting Rod-Cleaning
CAUTION: Do not use a caustic cleaning solution or damage to connecting rods can occur.
1. NOTE: The connecting rod large end is a matched set. The connecting rod cap must be installed
on the original connecting rod in the original
position. Do not reverse the cap. Parts are not interchangeable.
Mark and separate the parts and clean with solvent. Clean the oil passages.
Connecting Rod-Large End Bore
1. Tighten the bolts to specification, then measure the bore in two directions. The difference is the
connecting rod bore out-of-round. Verify the
out-of-round is within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Connecting Rod-Bushing Diameter
1. Measure the inner diameter of the connecting rod bushing, if equipped. Verify the diameter is
within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Connecting Rod-Bend
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3192
1. Measure the connecting rod bend on a suitable alignment fixture. Follow the instructions of the
fixture manufacturer. Verify the bend measurement
is within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Connecting Rod-Twist
1. Measure the connecting rod twist on a suitable alignment fixture. Follow the instructions of the
fixture manufacturer. Verify the measurement is
within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Connecting Rod-Piston Pin Side Clearance
1. Measure the clearance between the connecting rod and the piston. Verify the measurement is
within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Connecting Rod-Bearing Journal Clearance
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3193
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: The crankshaft connecting rod journals must be within specifications to check the
connecting rod bearing journal clearance.
1. Remove the connecting rod bearing cap.
2. Position a piece of Plastigage across the bearing surface.
3. NOTE: Do not turn the crankshaft during this step.
Install and tighten to specifications, then remove the connecting rod bearing cap.
4. Measure the Plastigage to get the connecting rod bearing journal clearance. The Plastigage
should be smooth and flat. A changing width indicates
a tapered or damaged connecting rod or connecting rod bearing.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications
Cylinder block
Main bearing bore inside diameter
......................................................................................................................... 72.400-72.424 mm
(2.850-2.851 inch) Crankshaft
Main bearing journal
Diameter
.................................................................................................................................................
67.481-67.505 mm (2.6567-2.6576 inch) Maximum taper ..................................................................
.............................................................................................. 0.004 mm (0.0002 inch) Maximum
out-of-round between cross sections
............................................................................................................. 0.0075 mm (0.0003 inch)
Journal-to-cylinder block clearance
.......................................................................................................... 0.048-0.024 mm
(0.0019-0.0009 inch)
Crankshaft maximum end play
......................................................................................................................... 0.075-0.377 mm
(0.0030-0.0148 inch)
Main bearing size chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3197
Vertical main bearing cap bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
............................................ 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) Final pass ..................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. tighten 90°
Side main bearing bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
............................................ 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) Final pass ..................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. tighten 90°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3198
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Service and Repair
Bearing-Inspection
1. Inspect bearings for the following defects.
Possible causes are shown: 1. Cratering-fatigue failure. 2. Spot polishing-incorrect seating. 3.
Imbedded dirt engine oil. 4. Scratching-dirty engine oil. 5. Base exposed-poor lubrication. 6. Both
edges worn-journal damaged. 7. One edge worn-journal tapered or bearing not seated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications
Crankshaft
Main bearing journal
Diameter
.................................................................................................................................................
67.481-67.505 mm (2.6567-2.6576 inch) Maximum taper ..................................................................
.............................................................................................. 0.004 mm (0.0002 inch) Maximum
out-of-round between cross sections
............................................................................................................. 0.0075 mm (0.0003 inch)
Journal-to-cylinder block clearance
........................................................................................................... 0.048-0.024 mm
(0.0019-0.0009 inch)
Connecting rod journal
Diameter
.......................................................................................................................................................
53.003-52.983 mm (2.0867-2.0859 inch)
Maximum taper ....................................................................................................................................
............................ 0.004 mm (0.0002 inch) Maximum out-of-round between cross sections
............................................................................................................. 0.0075 mm (0.0003 inch)
Crankshaft maximum end play
......................................................................................................................... 0.075-0.377 mm
(0.0030-0.0148 inch) Rod bearing-to-crankshaft clearance
............................................................................................................... 0.064-0.026 mm
(0.0025-0.0010 inch) Rod side clearance
...........................................................................................................................................
0.475-0.125 mm (0.0187-0.0049 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3202
Main bearing size chart
Vertical main bearing cap bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
............................................ 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) Final pass ..................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. tighten 90°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3203
Side main bearing bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
............................................ 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) Final pass ..................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. tighten 90°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3204
Crankshaft: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal- Diameter
1. Measure each of the crankshaft main bearing journal diameters in at least two directions.
^^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal- Taper
1. Measure each of the crankshaft main bearing journal diameters in at least two directions at each
end of the main bearing journal.
^^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal- Clearance
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: Crankshaft main bearing journals must be within specifications before checking journal
clearance.
1. Remove the crankshaft main bearing caps and crankshaft main bearing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3205
2. Lay a piece of Plastigage across the face of each crankshaft main bearing surface.
3. NOTE: Do not turn the crankshaft while carrying out this procedure.
Install and remove the crankshaft main bearing cap.
4. Verify the crankshaft journal clearance.
^^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Crankshaft End Play
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
1. Measure the crankshaft end play. Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure
crankshaft end play. 2. Position the crankshaft to the rear of the cylinder block. 3. Zero the
indicator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3206
4. Move the crankshaft to the front of the cylinder block. Note and record the crankshaft end play.
^ If crankshaft end play exceeds specifications, install a new crankshaft thrust washer or crankshaft
thrust main bearing.
Crankshaft Runout
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
1. NOTE: Crankshaft main bearing journals must be within specifications before checking runout.
Use the Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure the crankshaft runout. ^ ^
Rotate the crankshaft and subtract the lowest dial indicator reading from the highest dial indicator
reading to figure the crankshaft runout. If it is out of specification, install new components as
necessary.
Crankshaft-Connecting Rod Journal Taper, Out of Round
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3207
1. Measure the crankshaft connecting rod journal diameters in two directions perpendicular to one
another at each end of the connecting rod journal.
The difference in the measurements from one end to the other is the taper. Verify measurement is
within the wear limit. ^ ^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair
Block Heater
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system.
2. CAUTION: Do not loosen the block heater retaining screw more than necessary for removal.
Loosen the block heater retaining screw and remove the block heater. ^
To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.).
3. NOTE: Route the block heater power cable away from hot or rotating components, or damage to
the cable can occur.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3211
NOTE: Lubricate the block heater O-ring seal with clean engine coolant prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Expansion/Freeze Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Expansion/Freeze Plug: Service and Repair
Cylinder Block Core Plug Replacement
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
1. Use a slide hammer or tools suitable to remove the cylinder block core plug. 2. Inspect the
cylinder block plug bore for any damage that would interfere with the correct sealing of the plug. If
the cylinder block plug bore is
damaged, bore for the next oversize plug.
3. NOTE: Oversize plugs are identified by the OS stamped in the flat located on the cup side of the
plug.
Coat the cylinder block core plug and bore lightly with High Strength Thread-locker and install the
cylinder block core plug.
Cup-Type
1. CAUTION: Use care during this procedure so as not to disturb or distort the cup sealing surface.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Expansion/Freeze Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3215
CAUTION: When installed, the flanged edge must be below the chamfered edge of the bore to
effectively seal the bore.
Use a tool suitable to seat the cup-type cylinder block core plug.
Expansion-Type
1. CAUTION: Do not contact the crown when installing an expansion-type cylinder block core plug.
This could expand the plug before seating and
result in leakage.
Use tool suitable to seat the expansion-type cylinder block core plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications
Using a new crankshaft pulley bolt, install the bolt and washer and tighten the bolt in 4 stages.
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.) Second pass .......................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. loosen
360° Third pass ...................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.) Final pass ....................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
tighten 90°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3219
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Diagrams
Engine - Front End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3220
Engine - Front End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3221
Engine - Lower End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3222
Engine - Lower End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3223
Engine - Lower End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3224
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Pulley
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3225
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the engine cooling fan lower shroud. For additional
information, refer to Cooling System.
3. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from the crankshaft pulley.
4. Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt and washer.
^ Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
5. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft pulley.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3226
1. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with metal surface prep and silicone gasket
remover. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4
minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant to the Woodruff key slot in the crankshaft pulley.
2. Lubricate the crankshaft pulley sealing area with clean engine oil prior to installation.
3. Using the special tool, install the crankshaft pulley.
4. Using a new crankshaft pulley bolt, install the bolt and washer and tighten the bolt in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 2: Loosen 360°.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90°.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3227
5. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt onto the crankshaft pulley. 6.
Install the engine cooling fan lower shroud. For additional information, refer to Cooling System.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
Piston diameter (at right angle to pin bore)
Grade 1
..................................................................................................................................................
90.175-90.165 mm (3.5502-3.5498 inch) Grade 2
..................................................................................................................................................
90.185-90.175 mm (3.5506-3.5502 inch) Grade 3
..................................................................................................................................................
90.195-90.185 mm (3.5510-3.5506 inch)
Piston-to-cylinder bore clearance (at grade size)
............................................................................................. 0.025-0.045 mm (0.0010-0.0018 inch)
Ring end gap
Top ......................................................................................................................................................
............... 0.15-0.30 mm (0.006-0.012 inch) Intermediate
...................................................................................................................................................
0.25-0.50 mm (0.0098-0.0197 inch) Oil control
......................................................................................................................................................
0.15-0.65 mm (0.0059-0.0256 inch)
Ring groove width
Top ......................................................................................................................................................
........... 1.52-1.55 mm (0.0598-0.0610 inch) Intermediate
...................................................................................................................................................
1.52-1.54 mm (0.0598-0.0606 inch) Oil control
..................................................................................................................................................
3.030-3.050 mm (0.1193-0.1201 inch)
Ring width
Top and intermediate
..................................................................................................................................... 1.50-1.47 mm
(0.0590-0.0578 inch)
Ring-to-groove clearance
Top
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.020-0.080 mm (0.0008-0.0031 inch) Intermediate
...............................................................................................................................................
0.030-0.070 mm (0.0012-0.0028 inch)
Pin bore diameter
.........................................................................................................................................
22.008-22.014 mm (0.8665-0.8667 inch) Pin diameter
.............................................................................................................................................
22.0010-22.0030 mm (0.8662-0.8663 inch) Pin length .......................................................................
............................................................................................................ 61.8 mm (2.43 3 inch)
Pin-to-piston fit
................................................................................................................................................
0.005-0.013 mm (0.0002-0.0005 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures
Piston: Service and Repair General Procedures
Piston Inspection
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
CAUTION: Do not use a caustic cleaning solution or a wire brush to clean the pistons or damage
can occur.
1. Clean and inspect the (1) ring lands, (2) skirts, (3) pin bosses and the (4) tops of the pistons. If
wear marks, scores or glazing is found on the piston
skirt, check for a bent or twisted connecting rod.
2. Use the Piston Ring Groove Scraper to clean the piston ring grooves.
^ Make sure the oil ring holes are clean.
Piston-Pin to Bore Diameter
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3233
1. WARNING: Cover the end of the pin bore with a hand or shop rag when removing the retainer
ring, since it has a tendency to spring
out. Wear eye protection.
NOTE: Piston and piston pins are a matched set and should not be interchanged.
Measure the piston pin bore diameter in two directions on each side. Verify the diameter is within
specification. ^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Piston-Diameter
1. Measure the piston diameter 90 degrees from the piston pin and 42 mm down from the top of the
piston at the point indicated.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Piston-to Cylinder Bore Clearance
Subtract the piston diameter from the cylinder bore diameter to find the piston-to-cylinder bore
clearance.
Piston-Selection
NOTE: The cylinder bore must be within the specifications for taper and out-of-round before fitting
a piston.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3234
1. Select a piston size based on the cylinder bore.
2. NOTE: For precision fit, new pistons are divided into three categories within each size range
based on their relative position within the range. A
paint spot on the new pistons indicates the position within the size range.
Choose the piston with the correct paint color. ^
Piston-Ring End Gap
CAUTION: Use care when fitting piston rings to avoid possible damage to the piston ring or the
cylinder bore.
CAUTION: Piston rings should not be transferred from one piston to another.
NOTE: Cylinder bore must be within specification for taper and out-of-round.
1. Use a piston without rings to push a piston ring in a cylinder to the bottom of ring travel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3235
2. Use a feeler gauge to measure the top piston ring end gap and the second piston ring end gap.
^
Piston-Ring-to-Groove Clearance
1. Inspect the piston for ring land damage or accelerated wear.
2. Measure the piston ring-to-groove clearance.
^^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Piston-Pin Diameter
1. Measure the piston pin diameter in two directions at the points shown. Verify the diameter is
within specification.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3236
^^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3237
Piston: Service and Repair Disassembly and Assembly
Piston
Material
Disassembly
1. Remove the piston rings from the piston.
^ Discard the piston rings.
2. Remove the piston pin retainers and the piston pin. 3. Separate the piston from the connecting
rod. 4. Clean and inspect the piston and connecting rod.
Assembly
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3238
1. NOTE: The connecting rod must be installed into the piston with identification markings toward
the front.
Position the connecting rod in the piston.
2. Lubricate the piston pin and pin bore with clean engine oil. 3. Install the piston pin in the piston
and connecting rod assembly. 4. Install the piston pin retaining clips in the piston. 5. Lubricate the
piston and the new piston rings with clean engine oil. 6. Install the piston rings onto the piston.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
Piston
Ring end gap
Top ......................................................................................................................................................
............... 0.15-0.30 mm (0.006-0.012 inch) Intermediate
...................................................................................................................................................
0.25-0.50 mm (0.0098-0.0197 inch) Oil control
......................................................................................................................................................
0.15-0.65 mm (0.0059-0.0256 inch)
Ring groove width
Top ......................................................................................................................................................
........... 1.52-1.55 mm (0.0598-0.0610 inch) Intermediate
...................................................................................................................................................
1.52-1.54 mm (0.0598-0.0606 inch) Oil control
..................................................................................................................................................
3.030-3.050 mm (0.1193-0.1201 inch)
Ring width
Top and intermediate
..................................................................................................................................... 1.50-1.47 mm
(0.0590-0.0578 inch)
Ring-to-groove clearance
Top
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.020-0.080 mm (0.0008-0.0031 inch) Intermediate
...............................................................................................................................................
0.030-0.070 mm (0.0012-0.0028 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
This engine is equipped with hydraulic valve lifters. No adjustment is required.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: The electrical connector is located on the LH frame rail under the driver side door.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Start the engine and allow it to idle until it stalls. 4. After the engine stalls, crank the engine for
approximately 5 seconds to make sure the fuel rail pressure has been released. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the OFF position.
6. When fuel system service is complete, connect the electrical connector.
7. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
8. Install the diagnostic tool. Turn the key ON with the engine OFF. Cycle the key OFF, then ON.
Select the appropriate vehicle and engine qualifier.
Clear all diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and carry out a PCM reset.
9. Start the vehicle and check the fuel system for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Roller Follower
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Camshaft Roller Follower
Camshaft Roller Follower
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. Depending on the camshaft roller follower being serviced, remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2.
Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with the
intake valve and the exhaust valves closed.
3. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same position.
Mark the components for installation into the
original location.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller follower.
4. Repeat the previous 2 steps for each camshaft roller follower being serviced. 5. Inspect the
camshaft roller follower.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Roller Follower > Page 3253
1. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same position.
Mark the components for installation into the
original locations.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller follower.
2. Repeat the previous step for each camshaft roller follower being serviced. 3. Depending on the
camshaft roller follower being serviced, install the LH or RH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Roller Follower > Page 3254
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair General Procedures
Roller Follower-Inspection
1. Inspect the roller follower for flat spots or scoring. If any damage is found, inspect the camshaft
lobes and hydraulic lash adjuster for damage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Cover - LH
Valve Cover - LH
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 3259
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 3260
Removal
1. Remove the air cleaner intake pipe. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction. 2. Remove the LH ignition coils. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 3.
Remove the nut, the bolt and position the power steering reservoir and support bracket aside. 4.
Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) tube.
For additional information, refer to Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction.
5. Remove the bolt and position the oil level indicator tube aside. 6. Disconnect the radio ignition
interference capacitor electrical connector. 7. Disconnect the variable camshaft timing (VCT)
solenoid electrical connector and the wiring harness retainers. 8. Disconnect the intake manifold
vacuum tube hose from the brake booster. 9. Remove the intake manifold vacuum tube assembly
from the support bracket and the valve cover stud.
10. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Loosen the 15 fasteners and remove the LH valve cover and gasket. ^
Clean the valve cover mating surface of the cylinder head with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 3261
^ Discard the valve cover gasket. Clean the valve cover gasket groove with soap and water or a
suitable solvent.
Installation
1. NOTE: If the valve cover is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the
sealing area cleaned with metal surface prep and
silicone gasket remover. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign
of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil
leakage.
Apply a bead of silicone gasket and sealant in 2 places where the engine front cover meets the
cylinder head.
2. Position the LH valve cover and new gasket on the cylinder head and tighten the bolts in the
sequence shown
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
3. Position the intake manifold vacuum tube assembly onto the support bracket and the valve cover
stud. 4. Connect the intake manifold vacuum tube hose to the brake booster. 5. Connect the VCT
solenoid electrical connector and the wiring harness retainers. 6. Connect the radio ignition
interference capacitor electrical connector. 7. Position the oil level indicator tube and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
8. Position the PCV tube and connect the quick connect couplings. For additional information, refer
to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 9. Position the power steering reservoir and support bracket and
install the nut.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
10. Install the power steering reservoir and support bracket lower bolt.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
11. Install the LH ignition coils. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 12. Install the air
cleaner intake pipe. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 3262
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Cover - RH
Valve Cover - RH
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 3263
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 3264
Removal
1. Recover the refrigerant. For additional information, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning. 2.
Remove the powertrain control module (PCM) and support bracket. For additional information, refer
to Computers and Control Systems. 3. Remove the RH variable camshaft timing (VCT) oil control
solenoid. For additional information, refer to Computers and Control Systems. 4. Remove the RH
ignition coils. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 5. Disconnect the quick connect
couplings and remove the crankcase vent tube. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction. 6. Disconnect the wiring harness retainers from the valve cover.
7. Disconnect the A/C tube spring lock couplings.
^ Discard the O-ring seals.
8. Remove the bolt and position the A/C tube aside.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
9. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Loosen the 15 fasteners and remove the RH valve cover and gasket. ^
Clean the valve cover mating surface of the cylinder head with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
^ Discard the valve cover gasket. Clean the valve cover gasket groove with soap and water or a
suitable solvent.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 3265
1. NOTE: If the valve cover is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the
sealing area cleaned with metal surface prep and
silicone gasket remover. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign
of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil
leakage.
Apply a bead of silicone gasket and sealant in 2 places where the engine front cover meets the
cylinder head.
2. Position the LH valve cover and new gasket on the cylinder head and tighten the bolts in the
sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
3. NOTE: Lubricate the new O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil prior to installation.
Using new O-ring seals, connect the A/C tube spring lock couplings.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 3266
4. NOTE: Lubricate the new O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil prior to installation.
Using a new O-ring seal, position the A/C tube and install the bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
5. Connect the wiring harness retainers to the valve cover. 6. Position the crankcase vent tube and
connect the quick connect couplings. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction. 7. Install the RH ignition coils. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 8.
Install the PCM and support bracket. For additional information, refer to Computers and Control
Systems. 9. Install the RH VCT oil control solenoid. For additional information, refer to Computers
and Control Systems.
10. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system. For additional information, refer to
Heating and Air Conditioning.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Valve Guide: Service and Repair
Valve-Stem to Valve Guide Clearance
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: Valve stem diameter must be within specifications before checking valve stem to valve
guide clearance.
1. NOTE: If necessary, use a magnetic base.
Install a Valve Stem Clearance Tool on the valve stem and install a Dial Indicator with Bracketry.
Lower the valve until the Valve Stem Clearance Tool contacts the upper surface of the valve guide.
2. Move the Valve Stem Clearance Tool toward the indicator and zero the indicator. Move the
Valve Stem Clearance Tool away from the indicator
and note the reading. The reading will be DOUBLE the valve stem-to-valve guide clearance.
Valves with oversize stems will need to be installed if out of specification.
Valve-Guide Inner Diameter
1. Measure the inner diameter of the valve guides in two directions where indicated.
2. If the valve guide is not within specifications, ream the valve guide and install a valve with an
oversize stem or remove the valve guide and install
a new valve guide.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3270
Valve-Guide Reaming
1. Use a hand-reaming kit to ream the valve guide. 2. Reface the valve seat. 3. Clean the sharp
edges left by reaming.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Valve Seat: Service and Repair
Valve-Stem Diameter
1. Measure the diameter of each intake and exhaust valve stem at the points shown. Verify the
diameter is within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Valve-Inspection
1. Inspect the following valve areas:
1. the end of the stem for grooves or scoring 2. the valve face and the edge for pits, grooves or
scores 3. the valve head for signs of burning, erosion, warpage and cracking 4. the valve margin
for wear
Valve-Seat Inspection
Valve and Seat Refacing Measurements
CAUTION: After grinding valves or valve seats, check valve clearance.
1. Check the valve head and seat.
^ Check valve angles.
^ Check margin width.
^ Be sure margin width is within specification.
2. Inspect for abnormalities on the valve face and seat.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3274
Valve-Seat Width
1. Measure the valve seat width. If necessary, grind the valve seat to specification.
^ Measure the intake valve seat width.
^ Measure the exhaust valve seat width.
^ Recheck the valve spring installed length after the seats have been ground, and shim the valve
springs as necessary to achieve the correct installed spring length.
^
Valve-Seat Runout
1. Use the Valve Seat Runout Gauge to check valve seat runout.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures
Valve Spring: Service and Repair General Procedures
Valve-Spring Installed Length
1. Measure the installed length of each valve spring.
^ If out of specification, install new components.
Valve-Spring Free Length
1. Measure the free length of each valve spring.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Valve-Spring Squareness
1. NOTE: This procedure only applies to cylindrical valve springs.
Measure the out-of-square on each valve spring. ^
Turn the valve spring and observe the space between the top of the valve spring and the square.
Install a new valve spring if out of square.
Valve Spring Strength
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3279
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
1. Use a Valve/Clutch Spring Pressure Gauge to check the valve spring for correct strength at the
specified valve spring length.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3280
Valve Spring: Service and Repair Valve Springs
Valve Springs
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. Depending on the valve spring being serviced, remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2. Remove the
spark plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 3. Rotate the crankshaft until the
piston for the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with the intake valve and the exhaust
valves closed.
4. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into the
original locations.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller follower.
5. Use compressed air in the cylinder to hold both valves in position.
^ Apply a minimum of 965 kPa (140 psi) of compressed air into the cylinder.
6. CAUTION: If air pressure has forced the piston to the bottom of the cylinder, any loss of air
pressure will allow the valve to fall into the cylinder.
If air pressure must be removed, support the valve prior to removal.
CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same position.
Mark the components for location.
NOTE: If a valve drops into the cylinder, remove the cylinder head.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the valve spring retainer keys.
7. Remove the valve spring retainer and the valve spring. 8. Inspect the valve spring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3281
Installation
1. Using the special tool, install the valve spring, the valve spring retainer and the valve spring
retainer keys. 2. Relieve the air pressure from the cylinder.
3. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into the
original locations.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller follower with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller follower.
4. Install the spark plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 5. Depending on the
valve spring being serviced, install the LH or RH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Valve: Service and Repair
Valve-Stem Diameter
1. Measure the diameter of each intake and exhaust valve stem at the points shown. Verify the
diameter is within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Valve-Inspection
1. Inspect the following valve areas:
1. the end of the stem for grooves or scoring 2. the valve face and the edge for pits, grooves or
scores 3. the valve head for signs of burning, erosion, warpage and cracking 4. the valve margin
for wear
Valve-Seat Inspection
Valve and Seat Refacing Measurements
CAUTION: After grinding valves or valve seats, check valve clearance.
1. Check the valve head and seat.
^ Check valve angles.
^ Check margin width.
^ Be sure margin width is within specification.
2. Inspect for abnormalities on the valve face and seat.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3285
Valve-Seat Width
1. Measure the valve seat width. If necessary, grind the valve seat to specification.
^ Measure the intake valve seat width.
^ Measure the exhaust valve seat width.
^ Recheck the valve spring installed length after the seats have been ground, and shim the valve
springs as necessary to achieve the correct installed spring length.
^
Valve-Seat Runout
1. Use the Valve Seat Runout Gauge to check valve seat runout.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Locations
Drive Belt: Locations
Accessory Drive
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Locations > Page 3290
Drive Belt: Diagrams
Accessory Drive
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Locations > Page 3291
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
Accessory Drive
The accessory drive system:
- has a single serpentine drive belt (6 ribs). - has 3 idler pulleys. - has an automatic belt tensioner. is not adjustable.
The accessory drive system provides power to operate components which power other systems.
These could include components such as the generator, power steering pump, and A/C
compressor. Each of these components is equipped with a pulley which is driven by the accessory
drive belt. The accessory drive belt is driven by the engine crankshaft pulley. One or more idler
pulleys may be provided to facilitate belt routing and alignment. The automatic belt tensioner
maintains correct belt tension and compensates for component wear and changes in system load.
System load changes can be caused by the A/C compressor clutch engaging and disengaging, or
demand changes on other systems powered by the accessory drive belt. To maintain correct
operation of this stem, it is critical that the correct length drive belt be installed. The pulleys must
also be correctly aligned and kept clean.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Drive Belt: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Accessory Drive
Inspection and Verification
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys be
lubricated as potential damage to the belt material and tensioner damping mechanism will occur.
Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
1. Verify the customer concern by operating the system. 2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of
mechanical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
3. Eliminate all other non-belt related noises that could cause belt misdiagnosis, such as A/C
compressor engagement chirp, power steering
cavitations at low temperatures, variable camshaft timing (VCT) tick or generator whine.
4. If a concern is found, correct the condition before proceeding to the next step.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Drive Belt With Cracks Across Ribs
5. NOTE: Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be considered
acceptable. If damage exceeds the acceptable limit or
any chunks are found to be missing from the ribs, a new belt must be installed.
Check the belt for cracks. Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be
considered acceptable. If cracks exceed this standard, install a new belt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3294
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Piling
6. The condition of the V-ribbed drive belt should be compared against the illustration and
appropriate action taken.
1 Small scattered deposits of rubber material. This is not a concern, therefore, installation of a new
belt is not required.
2 Longer deposit areas building up to 50 percent of the rib height. This is not considered a concern
but it can result in excessive noise. If noise is apparent, install a new belt.
3 Heavy deposits building up along the grooves resulting in a possible noise and belt stability
concern. If heavy deposits are apparent, install a new belt.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Chunks of Rib Missing
7. There should be no chunks missing from the belt ribs. If the belt shows any evidence of this,
install a new accessory drive belt. 8. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom and
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3295
Drive Belt: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3296
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3297
Drive Belt: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Component Tests
Drive Belt Noise/Flutter
Drive belt chirp occurs due to pulley misalignment or excessive pulley runout. It can be the result of
a damaged or an incorrectly aligned grooved pulley.
To correct, determine the area where the noise comes from. Check each of the pulleys in that area
with a straightedge to the crankshaft pulley. Look for accessory pulleys out of position in the fore/aft
direction or at an angle to the straightedge.
CAUTION: Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
Drive belt squeal may be an intermittent or constant noise that occurs when the drive belt slips on
an accessory pulley under certain conditions.
A short intermittent squeal may occur during engine start-up and shut down or during very rapid
engine acceleration and decelerations, such as: ^
wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts or 2-3 and 3-4 back out shifts on automatic transmissions.
^ wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts and any combination of rapid downshifting on manual
transmissions.
These special short-term transient events are expected, and are due to the higher system inertias
required to meet the electrical and cooling demands on today's vehicle systems. Constant or
re-occurring drive belt squeal can occur under these conditions: ^
if the A/C discharge pressure goes above specifications:
^ the A/C system is overcharged.
^ the A/C condenser core airflow is blocked.
^ if the A/C OFF equalized pressure (the common discharged and suction pressure that occurs
after several minutes) exceeds specifications.
^ if any of the accessories are damaged or have a worn or damaged bearing. All accessories
should be rotatable by hand in the unloaded condition, if not, inspect the accessory.
^ if there is evidence of fluid contamination on the accessory drive belt. When the drive belt has
been exposed to fluid contamination during vehicle operation, such as leaks from the power
steering system, A/C system or cooling system, clean all pulleys with soap and water, rinse with
clean water and install a new accessory drive belt. If the drive belt has been exposed to fluids in a
localized area during routine vehicle service, such as replacement of hoses or fluids, the drive belt
and pulleys should be washed with soap and water immediately (prior to starting the engine), and
rinsed with clean water.
^ if the accessory drive belt is too long. A drive belt that is too long will allow the accessory drive
belt tensioner arm to go all the way to the arm travel stop under certain load conditions, which will
release tension to the drive belt. If the accessory drive belt tensioner indicator is outside the normal
installation wear range window, install a new accessory drive belt.
^ NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner arm should rotate freely without binding.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if the drive belt tensioner is worn or damaged.
Incorrect Drive Belt Installation
CAUTION: Incorrect accessory drive belt installation will cause excessive drive belt wear and can
cause the drive belt to come off the pulleys.
Non-standard accessory drive belts can track differently or incorrectly. If an accessory drive belt
tracks incorrectly, install a new accessory drive belt to avoid performance failure or loss of the drive
belt.
Incorrect Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3298
Correct Installation
With the engine running, check accessory drive belt tracking on all pulleys. If the edge of the
accessory drive belt rides beyond the edge of the pulleys, noise and premature wear will occur.
Make sure the accessory drive belt rides correctly on the pulley. If an accessory drive belt tracking
condition exists, proceed with these steps: ^
Visually check the accessory drive belt tensioner for damage, especially the mounting pad surface.
If the accessory drive belt tensioner is not installed correctly, the mounting surface pad will be out
of position. This will result in chirp and squeal noises.
^ With the engine running, visually observe the grooves in the pulleys (not the pulley flanges or the
pulley forward faces) for excessive wobble. Install new components as necessary.
^ Check all accessories, mounting brackets and the accessory drive belt tensioner for any
interference that would prevent the component from mounting correctly. Correct any interference
condition and recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
Tighten all accessories, mounting brackets and accessory drive belt tensioner retaining hardware
to specification. Recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
The only mechanical check that needs to be made is a check for tensioner stick grab or bind. 1.
With the engine OFF, check routing of the accessory drive belt.
2. NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner spring is very strong and requires substantial force to
release.
Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, release the tension
on the belt and detach the accessory drive belt in the area of the tensioner.
3. Using the suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, move the
tensioner from its relaxed position, through its full
stroke and back to the relaxed position to make sure there is no stick, grab or bind, and to make
sure that there is tension on the tensioner spring.
4. Rotate the tensioner pulley by hand and check for a binding, contaminated or seized condition.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if
necessary.
5. Inspect the area surrounding the accessory drive belt tensioner for oil leaks or contamination
and repair any leaks. Install a new accessory drive
belt tensioner as necessary.
6. If the accessory drive belt tensioner meets the above criteria, proceed to testing the tensioner
dynamically. If the accessory drive belt tensioner
does not meet the above criteria, install a new tensioner.
Belt Tensioner - Dynamics
The accessory drive belt tensioner can be checked dynamically as follows: 1. With the engine
running, observe the accessory drive belt tensioner movement. The accessory drive tensioner
should move (respond) when the air
conditioning clutch cycles (if equipped), or when the engine is accelerated rapidly. If the accessory
drive belt tensioner movement is excessive without air conditioning clutch cycling or engine
acceleration, check belt rideout. Excessive belt rideout (uneven depth of grooves in the belt) can
cause excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement. Check rideout condition by installing a
new belt. If excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement still exists, install a new accessory
drive belt tensioner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3299
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
Accessory Drive
Removal
1. Rotate the drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the drive belt.
Installation
1. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Diagrams
Drive Belt Tensioner: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3303
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair
Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the cooling fan shroud. For additional information, refer to Cooling System.
2. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from
the generator pulley. 3. Remove the 3 bolts and the accessory drive belt tensioner.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Mount: > 06-5-1 >
Mar > 06 > Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition
Engine Mount: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition
TSB 06-5-1
03/20/06
COLD START ROUGH IDLE EXPEDITION 4X2 ONLY
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition 4x2 vehicles may exhibit an idle vibration during cold start at
1400 RPM, that lasts for a few seconds. The symptom is perceived as shaking of the entire vehicle
when the engine is first started after being off for an extended period of time in warm weather in
excess of a few hours, such as overnight, with ambient temperatures greater than 60° F (16° C).
The issue is not typically accompanied by unusual engine or fan noise. It is independent of air
conditioning compressor engagement (bumps, bangs, or thumps) and air suspension pump
operation (audible hum or buzz accompanied by an associated vibration).
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to resolve the concern.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using normal Workshop Manual diagnostics:
a. Verify the integrity of the fuel system (fuel injectors, fuel pump, fuel quality) and repair as
necessary.
b. Check ignition system (spark plugs, ignition coils), mechanical engine operation, and repair as
necessary.
2. Check the engine assembly exhaust mounting systems for ground-outs, damage, and repair as
necessary.
3. If no concerns are found or cold start symptoms continue, reprogram the powertrain control
module (PCM) to the latest calibration using WDS release B41.10 and higher or B42.1 and higher.
This new calibration is not included in the B42 CD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
COLD ENGINE IDLE SPEED WILL DROP TO 1250 RPM AND WARM DRIVE IDLE SPEED WILL
INCREASE TO 650 RPM. THIS CALIBRATION IS MATCHED TO THE SERVICE
ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS LISTED IN THIS TSB. DO NOT RE-INSTALL THE
ORIGINAL ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS AFTER PERFORMING THIS RECALIBRATION.
4. Replace the left hand and right hand engine mounts. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section
303-01 - Engine Support Insulators
5. Replace the transmission mount. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 307-01B - Transmission
Insulator & Retainer
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
060501A 2005 Expedition 4X2: 3.7 Hrs. Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount,
Reprogram The Powertrain Control Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84,
050415A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Mount: > 06-5-1 >
Mar > 06 > Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition > Page 3312
052301A)
060501B 2006 Expedition 4X2: 3.6 Hrs.
Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount, Reprogram The Powertrain Control
Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84, 050415A, 052301A)
MT060501 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Mount: >
06-5-1 > Mar > 06 > Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition
Engine Mount: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition
TSB 06-5-1
03/20/06
COLD START ROUGH IDLE EXPEDITION 4X2 ONLY
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition 4x2 vehicles may exhibit an idle vibration during cold start at
1400 RPM, that lasts for a few seconds. The symptom is perceived as shaking of the entire vehicle
when the engine is first started after being off for an extended period of time in warm weather in
excess of a few hours, such as overnight, with ambient temperatures greater than 60° F (16° C).
The issue is not typically accompanied by unusual engine or fan noise. It is independent of air
conditioning compressor engagement (bumps, bangs, or thumps) and air suspension pump
operation (audible hum or buzz accompanied by an associated vibration).
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to resolve the concern.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using normal Workshop Manual diagnostics:
a. Verify the integrity of the fuel system (fuel injectors, fuel pump, fuel quality) and repair as
necessary.
b. Check ignition system (spark plugs, ignition coils), mechanical engine operation, and repair as
necessary.
2. Check the engine assembly exhaust mounting systems for ground-outs, damage, and repair as
necessary.
3. If no concerns are found or cold start symptoms continue, reprogram the powertrain control
module (PCM) to the latest calibration using WDS release B41.10 and higher or B42.1 and higher.
This new calibration is not included in the B42 CD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
COLD ENGINE IDLE SPEED WILL DROP TO 1250 RPM AND WARM DRIVE IDLE SPEED WILL
INCREASE TO 650 RPM. THIS CALIBRATION IS MATCHED TO THE SERVICE
ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS LISTED IN THIS TSB. DO NOT RE-INSTALL THE
ORIGINAL ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS AFTER PERFORMING THIS RECALIBRATION.
4. Replace the left hand and right hand engine mounts. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section
303-01 - Engine Support Insulators
5. Replace the transmission mount. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 307-01B - Transmission
Insulator & Retainer
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
060501A 2005 Expedition 4X2: 3.7 Hrs. Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount,
Reprogram The Powertrain Control Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84,
050415A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Mount: >
06-5-1 > Mar > 06 > Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition > Page 3318
052301A)
060501B 2006 Expedition 4X2: 3.6 Hrs.
Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount, Reprogram The Powertrain Control
Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84, 050415A, 052301A)
MT060501 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3319
Engine Mount: Service and Repair
Engine Support Insulators
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3320
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional
information, refer to Battery. 3. Remove the air cleaner housing. For additional information, refer to
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 4. Remove the generator. For additional information, refer to
Alternator. 5. Remove the upper cooling fan shroud. For additional information, refer to Cooling
System. 6. If removing the RH engine support insulator, remove the starter. For additional
information, refer to Starter. 7. If removing the LH engine support insulator, remove the oil level
indicator and tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3321
8. Install the special tools.
9. Remove the 4 exhaust manifold-to-catalytic converter nuts.
10. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts
or damage to the transmission mount can occur.
Loosen the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts.
11. Remove the 4 bolts and position the sway bar down.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3322
12. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the engine mount nut or damage to the engine
mount can occur.
Remove the RH engine mount nut.
13. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the LH engine mount through bolt or damage to
the cage nut can occur.
NOTE: If the LH engine mount through bolt nut is missing or damaged install a new nut using
service part number W7093 75. If the LH engine mount through bolt nut cage is damaged or
missing, remove the cage and install a new nut using service part number
W520516-S301.
Remove the LH engine mount through bolt.
14. Using the special tools, raise the engine.
RH engine mount
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3323
15. Remove the 3 bolts and the engine mount.
LH engine mount
16. If servicing the LH engine mount on a 4WD vehicle, remove the front driveshaft.
17. Remove the 3 bolts and the engine mount.
Installation
RH engine mount
1. CAUTION: Clean the engine mount-to-cylinder block and engine mount-to-chassis mating
surfaces of any dirt or foreign material prior to
installation.
Position the RH engine mount and install the 3 bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs.).
LH engine mount
2. CAUTION: Clean the engine mount-to-cylinder block and engine mount-to-chassis mating
surfaces of any dirt or foreign material prior to
installation.
Position the LH engine mount and install the 3 bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs.).
3. If servicing the LH engine mount on a 4WD vehicle, install the front driveshaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3324
All vehicles
4. Lower the engine into position.
5. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the LH engine mount through bolt or damage to
the cage nut can occur.
NOTE: If the LH engine mount through bolt nut is missing or damaged install a new nut using
service part number W709375. If the LH engine mount through bolt nut cage is damaged or
missing, remove the cage and install a new nut using service part number W520516-S301.
Install the LH engine support insulator bolt. ^
Tighten to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs.).
6. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when installing the RH engine mount nut or damage to the
engine mount can occur.
Install the RH engine mount nut. ^
Tighten to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs.).
7. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when installing the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts or
damage to the transmission mount can occur.
Install the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts. ^
Tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3325
8. Position the Y-pipe and install the 4 nuts.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
9. Position the sway bar and install the 4 bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
10. Remove the special tools. 11. If installing the LH engine mount, install the oil level indicator and
tube. 12. If installing the RH engine mount, install the starter. For additional information, refer to
Starter. 13. Install the upper cooling fan shroud. For additional information, refer to Cooling System.
14. Install the generator. For additional information, refer to Alternator. 15. Install the air cleaner
housing. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 16. Connect the battery
ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Diagrams
Idler Pulley: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3329
Idler Pulley: Service and Repair
Accessory Drive Belt Idler Pulley
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the cooling fan shroud. For additional information, refer to Cooling System.
2. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from
the generator pulley. 3. Remove the bolt and the accessory drive belt idler pulley.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
4. Repeat the previous step for each accessory drive belt idler pulley being serviced. 5. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Oil pressure minimum at 2,000 rpm (engine at normal operating temperature)
............................................................................................ 517 kPa (75 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair
Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube: Service and Repair
Oil Level Indicator and Tube
Material
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in neutral, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the oil level indicator and tube bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
3. Remove the oil level indicator and tube from the cylinder block.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
4. NOTE: Lubricate the new oil level indicator tube O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to
installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Install a new O-ring seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
With Filter ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 6.6L (7.0 Qt)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 3341
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
U.S.A. ...................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Premium Synthetic Blend Motor Oil Canada
..................................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Super Premium Motor Oil
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................... XO-5W20-QSP (U.S.A) Ford P/N ............................................................
...................................................................................................................... CXO-5W20-LSP12
(Canada) Ford Specification
.........................................................................................................................................
WSS-M2C930-A with API Certification Mark
NOTE: Use of synthetic or synthetic blend motor oil is not mandatory. Engine oil need only meet
the requirements of Ford specification WSS-M2C930-A and the API Certification mark.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Filter Adapter: Service and Repair
Oil Filter Adapter
Material
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the engine cooling system. For additional information,
refer to Cooling System. 3. Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) sensor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the lower radiator hose from the oil filter adapter and position it aside. 5. Disconnect
the degas bottle coolant hose from the oil filter adapter and position it aside. 6. Remove and
discard the engine oil filter. 7. Remove the 4 bolts and the oil filter adapter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3345
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
8. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs, or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These may
cause scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths. Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing
surfaces.
Remove and discard the oil filter adapter gasket. Clean the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket
remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Inspect the mating
surfaces.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Pan: Specifications
Oil pan bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.) Second pass ..............................................................
...................................................................................................................... 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.) Final
pass .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................... tighten 60°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3349
Oil Pan: Service and Repair
Oil Pan
Material
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the engine oil.
3. Remove the 4 bolts and the frame crossmember.
4. Remove the bolt and detach the wire harness bracket.
4WD vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3350
5. Support the front axle housing with a jack stand.
6. NOTE: Mark the bolt and bracket so that alignment can be maintained on installation.
Remove the front axle housing RH mounting bolt.
7. NOTE: Mark the bolt and bracket so that alignment can be maintained on installation.
Remove the front axle housing LH front mounting bolt.
8. NOTE: Mark the bolt and bracket so that alignment can be maintained on installation
Remove the front axle housing LH rear mounting bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3351
9. CAUTION: Use care when lowering the front axle housing, or the vacuum lines to the axle
solenoid may become disconnected or damaged.
Lower the axle to allow clearance for the oil pan to be removed.
All vehicles
10. NOTE: Be careful when removing the oil pan gasket. It is reusable.
Remove the 16 bolts, the oil pan and the gaskets. ^
Inspect the oil pan gasket for damage.
^ If damaged, discard the oil pan gasket and the oil pan-to-oil pump gaskets.
Installation
All vehicles
1. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges, which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Inspect the oil pan. Clean the mating surface for the oil pan with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
2. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with silicone gasket remover and metal surface
prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4
minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3352
Apply silicone gasket and sealant at the crankshaft rear seal retainer plate-to-cylinder block sealing
surface.
3. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with silicone gasket remover and metal surface
prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4
minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant at the engine front cover-to-cylinder block sealing surface.
4. Install the oil pan gasket and the oil pan and loosely install the 16 bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3353
5. Tighten the bolts in 3 stages, in the sequence shown.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.).
^ Stage 2: Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 3: Tighten an additional 60°.
4WD vehicles
6. CAUTION: Use care when positioning the front axle housing, or the vacuum lines to the axle
solenoid may become disconnected or damaged.
Position the front axle housing and loosely install the 3 bolts, aligning the bolt location marks made
during removal.
7. Install the front axle housing RH mounting bolt.
^ Tighten to 89 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3354
8. Install the front axle housing LH front mounting bolt.
^ Tighten to 89 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
9. Install the front axle housing LH rear mounting bolt.
^ Tighten to 89 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
All vehicles
10. Position the frame crossmember and the 4 bolts.
^ Tighten to 102 Nm (75 ft. lbs.).
11. Install the wire harness bracket and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
12. Fill the crankcase with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3358
C103
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE (EOP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pick Up/Strainer > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pick Up/Strainer: Service and Repair
Oil Pump Screen and Pickup Tube
Material
Removal
1. Remove the oil pan.
2. Remove the 3 bolts and the oil pump screen and pickup tube.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Make sure the O-ring is in place and not damaged. A missing or damaged O-ring can
cause foam in the lubrication system, low oil
pressure and severe engine damage.
NOTE: Clean and inspect the mating surfaces and install a new O-ring. Lubricate the O-ring with
clean engine oil prior to installation.
Position the oil pump screen and pickup tube and install the bolts. ^
Tighten the oil pump screen and pickup tube-to-oil pump bolts to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
^ Tighten the oil pump screen and pickup tube-to-spacer bolt to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
2. Install the oil pan.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Oil pressure minimum at 2,000 rpm (engine at normal operating temperature)
............................................................................................ 517 kPa (75 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch,
Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications
Intake Manifold: Specifications
Intake manifold bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.) Final pass ..................................................................
................................................................................................................... 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
Throttle body bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.) Final pass ..................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. tighten 90°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Intake Manifold
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3377
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3378
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3379
Removal
WARNING: Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not
running. Before servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel
system pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or
a fire hazard.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3380
1. Drain the cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System. 2. Disconnect the
fuel supply hose spring lock coupling from the fuel rail. For additional information, refer to Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction. 3. Remove the generator. For additional information, refer to Alternator.
4. Remove the air cleaner. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 5.
Disconnect the upper radiator hose from the thermostat housing. 6. Disconnect the heater coolant
hose from the coolant bypass tube. 7. Disconnect the quick connect coupling and remove the
evaporative emissions system (EVAP) tube from the intake manifold. For additional
information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction.
8. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV)
tube. For additional information, refer to Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction.
9. Disconnect the fuel rail pressure and temperature sensor electrical connector and vacuum
connector.
10. Disconnect the 8 fuel injector electrical connectors. 11. Disconnect the throttle position (TP)
sensor and electronic acceleration control electrical connectors.
12. Disconnect the heated PCV intake fitting electrical connector. 13. Disconnect the brake booster
vacuum hose from the intake manifold vacuum tube. 14. Remove the 10 intake manifold bolts
15. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Remove the 3 bolts, the coolant bypass tube and discard the gaskets. ^
Clean and inspect the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep.
Follow the directions on the packaging.
16. Disconnect the charge motion control valve (CMCV) electrical connector. 17. Disconnect the
manifold vacuum tube from the valve cover stud and the support bracket.
18. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper harness electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3381
19. Disconnect the LH and RH knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 20. Remove the nut and
disconnect the engine wiring harness retainer from the CMCV stud.
21. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Remove the intake manifold and discard the gaskets. ^
Inspect and clean the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow
the directions on the packaging.
Installation
1. NOTE: Electrical and vacuum harnesses must not restrict movement of the CMCV control rods
at rear of the intake manifold. Use extreme care
on installation of the intake manifold to prevent any pinching of electrical and vacuum harnesses.
Using new intake manifold gaskets, position the intake manifold.
2. Using new gaskets, position the coolant crossover and install the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
3. Install the intake manifold bolts and tighten in 2 stages, in the sequence shown.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.).
^ Stage 2: Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
4. Connect the engine wiring harness retainer to the CMCV stud and install the nut.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
5. Connect the CMCV electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3382
6. Connect the CHT sensor jumper harness electrical connector.
7. Connect the LH and RH KS electrical connectors. 8. Connect the manifold vacuum tube to the
support bracket and the valve cover stud. 9. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the intake
manifold vacuum tube.
10. Connect the heated PCV intake fitting electrical connector. 11. Connect the TP sensor and
electronic acceleration control electrical connectors. 12. Connect the 8 fuel injector electrical
connectors. 13. Connect the fuel rail pressure and temperature sensor electrical connector and
vacuum connector. 14. Connect the fuel supply spring lock coupling to the fuel rail. For additional
information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 15. Position the PCV tube and connect the
quick connect couplings. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 16.
Position the EVAP tube and connect the quick connect coupling to the intake manifold. For
additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction.
17. Connect the heater coolant hose to the coolant bypass. 18. Connect the upper radiator hose to
the thermostat housing. 19. Install the generator. For additional information, refer to Alternator. 20.
Install the air cleaner. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 21. Fill
and bleed the engine cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3383
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Disassembly and Assembly
Intake Manifold Assembly
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3384
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3385
Special Tool(s)
Disassembly
1. Remove the 4 bolts and the throttle body (TB). 2. Remove the 4 bolts and the fuel rail. 3.
Remove the fuel injector-to-fuel rail locking clip and separate the fuel injectors from the fuel rail.
^ Discard the 2 O-ring seals from each fuel injector.
4. Remove the vacuum tube assembly from the intake manifold. 5. Remove the charge motion
control valve (CMCV) rod locking clips. 6. Remove the stud bolt, the 2 bolts and the CMCV. 7.
Remove the 2 bolts and the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) heater element.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
8. Remove the engine noise shield insulator from the intake manifold.
Assembly
1. Install the engine noise shield insulator onto the intake manifold.
2. NOTE: Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using a new O-ring seal, install the PCV heater element and the 2 bolts. ^
Tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
3. Position the CMCV and install the stud bolt and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
4. Install the CMCV rod locking clips. 5. Install the vacuum tube assembly onto the intake manifold.
6. NOTE: Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install new O-ring seals on each of the fuel injectors.
7. Assemble the fuel injectors onto the fuel rail and install the locking clips. 8. Install the fuel rail
and fuel injector assembly onto the intake manifold. 9. Install the 4 fuel rail bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3386
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
10. Install the TB and tighten the bolts in 2 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
^ Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90°.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Diagrams
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Diagrams
Engine - Lower End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3391
Engine - Lower End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3392
Engine - Lower End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3393
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Rear Seal with Retainer Plate
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3394
Material
Removal
1. Remove the transmission. 2. Remove the 8 bolts and the flexplate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3395
3. Using the special tools, remove the crankshaft oil slinger.
^ Discard the crankshaft oil slinger.
4. Using the special tools, remove the crankshaft rear seal.
^ Discard the crankshaft rear seal.
5. Remove the 2 oil pan-to-crankshaft rear seal retainer plate bolts. 6. Remove the 6 bolts and the
crankshaft rear seal retainer plate.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
NOTE: Clean the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Clean and inspect the mating surface.
2. NOTE: If the rear crankshaft seal retaining plate is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant
must be removed and the sealing area cleaned with
silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to
dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this
procedure can cause future oil leaks.
NOTE: The silicone must be applied on the groove along the retainer plate.
Apply a 4.06 mm (0.16 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant around the crankshaft rear seal
retainer plate sealing surface.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3396
3. Install the crankshaft rear seal retainer plate and the 6 bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
4. Install the 2 crankshaft rear seal retainer plate-to-oil pan bolts and tighten in 2 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 2: Tighten an additional 60°.
5. NOTE: Lubricate the inner lip of the crankshaft rear seal with clean engine oil.
Using the special tools, install a new crankshaft rear seal.
6. Using the special tools, install a new crankshaft rear oil slinger.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3397
7. Install the flexplate and tighten the 8 bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the transmission.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Diagrams
Front Crankshaft Seal: Diagrams
Engine - Front End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3401
Engine - Front End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3402
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Front Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3403
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the engine cooling fan lower shroud. For additional
information, refer to Cooling System.
3. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from the crankshaft pulley.
4. Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt and washer.
^ Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
5. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3404
6. Using the special tool, remove and discard the crankshaft front seal.
Installation
1. Lubricate the engine front cover and the new crankshaft front seal inner lip with clean engine oil.
2. Using the special tools, install the new crankshaft front seal.
3. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with metal surface prep and silicone gasket
remover. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4
minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant to the Woodruff key slot in the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3405
4. Using the special tool, install the crankshaft pulley.
5. Using a new crankshaft pulley bolt, install the bolt and washer and tighten the bolt in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 2: Loosen 360°.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90°.
6. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt onto the crankshaft pulley. 7.
Install the engine cooling fan lower shroud. For additional information, refer to Cooling System.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair
Valve Seals
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. Depending on the valve being serviced, remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2. Remove the spark
plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 3. Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for
the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with the intake valve and the exhaust valves
closed.
4. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into the
original locations.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller follower.
5. Use compressed air in the cylinder to hold both valves in position.
^ Apply a minimum of 965 kPa (140 psi) of compressed air into the cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3409
6. CAUTION: If air pressure has forced the piston to the bottom of the cylinder, any loss of air
pressure will allow the valve to fall into the cylinder.
If air pressure must be removed, support the valve prior to removal.
CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for locations.
NOTE: If a valve drops into the cylinder, remove the cylinder head.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the valve spring retainer keys.
7. Remove the valve spring retainer, the valve spring and the valve seal.
^ Discard the valve seal.
8. Inspect the components.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the valve seal and valve stem with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the special tool, install a new valve seal.
2. Using the special tool, install the valve spring, the valve spring retainer and the valve spring
retainer keys. 3. Relieve the air pressure from the cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3410
4. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into the
original locations.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller follower with clean engine oil prior to installation.
^ Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller follower.
5. Install the spark plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 6. Depending on the
valve being serviced, install the LH or RH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3415
C103
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE (EOP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Temperature
Sensor/Switch, Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See: Camshaft,
Lifters and Push Rods/Camshaft/Service and Repair
2. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See: Camshaft,
Lifters and Push Rods/Camshaft/Service and Repair
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the special
tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must
be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components. See:
Remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket from the timing chain.
4. Inspect the front of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for missing or damaged roll pins.
- If the roll pins are missing or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be installed.
5. Inspect the rear of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for a deformed or damaged location pin.
- If the location pin is deformed or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be
installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3426
6. Visually inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for squareness (A). If the trigger wheel or
spring is deformed or damaged (B), install a new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
If installing a new camshaft phaser and sprocket, transfer the original scribe mark to the new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
2. NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to
valves and pistons will result.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Align the scribe marks and position the camshaft phaser and sprocket into the timing chain.
3. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See: Camshaft,
Lifters and Push Rods/Camshaft/Service and Repair
4. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See: Camshaft,
Lifters and Push Rods/Camshaft/Service and Repair
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Timing Chain: Service and Repair
Timing Drive Components
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
Removal
1. Remove the engine front cover.
2. Remove the crankshaft sensor ring from the crankshaft.
3. Position the crankshaft keyway at the 12 o'clock position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3430
4. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft will require one
full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
The number 1 cylinder camshaft exhaust lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by
noting the position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the number 1 cylinder.
5. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into the
original locations.
Remove only the 3 roller followers shown in the illustration from the RH cylinder head.
6. CAUTION: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder. If a valve drops into the cylinder, the
cylinder head must be removed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3431
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the special tool, remove the 3 designated roller followers in the previous step from the RH
cylinder head.
7. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into the
original locations.
Remove only the 3 roller followers shown in the illustration from the LH cylinder head.
8. CAUTION: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder. If a valve drops into the cylinder, the
cylinder head must be removed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3432
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the special tool, remove the 3 designated roller followers in the previous step from the LH
cylinder head.
9. CAUTION: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set.
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise and position the crankshaft keyway at the 6 o'clock position.
10. CAUTION: If one or both of the tensioner mounting bolts are loosened or removed, the
tensioner-sealing bead must be inspected for seal
integrity. If cracks, tears, separation from the tensioner body or permanent compression of the seal
bead is observed, install a new tensioner or engine damage may occur.
Remove the bolts, the LH timing chain tensioner and tensioner arm.
11. CAUTION: If one or both of the tensioner mounting bolts are loosened or removed, the
tensioner-sealing bead must be inspected for seal
integrity. If cracks, tears, separation from the tensioner body or permanent compression of the seal
bead is observed, install a new tensioner or engine damage may occur.
Remove the bolts, the RH timing chain tensioner and tensioner arm.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3433
12. Remove the RH and LH timing chains and the crankshaft sprocket.
^ Remove the RH timing chain from the camshaft sprocket.
^ Remove the RH timing chain from the crankshaft sprocket.
^ Remove the LH timing chain from the camshaft sprocket.
^ Remove the LH timing chain and crankshaft sprocket.
13. NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Remove the LH and RH timing chain guides. ^
Remove the bolts.
^ Remove both timing chain guides.
14. CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3434
CAUTION: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser sprocket assembly or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser unit.
Using the special tool, remove the bolt and the RH camshaft phaser sprocket assembly. ^
Discard the camshaft phaser sprocket bolt.
15. CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
CAUTION: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser sprocket assembly or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser unit.
Using the special tool, remove the bolt and the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly. ^
Discard the camshaft phaser sprocket bolt.
16. CAUTION: Remove the front thrust camshaft bearing cap straight upward from the bearing
towers or the bearing cap may be damaged from
sideloading.
Remove the 2 bolts and the RH cylinder head camshaft front bearing cap.
17. NOTICE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft bearing cap locations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove the remaining 8 bolts in the sequence shown and remove the RH cylinder head camshaft
bearing caps.
18. Clean and inspect the RH camshaft bearing caps.
The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3435
19. Remove the RH camshaft.
20. CAUTION: Remove the front thrust camshaft bearing cap straight upward from the bearing
towers or the bearing cap may be damaged from
sideloading.
Remove the 2 bolts and the LH cylinder head camshaft bearing cap.
21. NOTICE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft bearing cap locations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove the remaining 8 bolts in the sequence shown and remove the LH cylinder head camshaft
bearing caps.
22. Clean and inspect the LH camshaft bearing caps.
The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
23. Remove the LH camshaft.
24. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into the
original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3436
Remove all of the remaining roller followers from the cylinder heads.
Installation
1. Install the LH and RH camshafts.
^ Lubricate the camshaft and camshaft journals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
2. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the LH and RH camshaft bearing caps in their original locations. ^
Lubricate the camshaft bearing caps with clean engine oil.
^ Position the front camshaft bearing cap.
^ Position the remaining camshaft bearing caps.
^ Install the bolts loosely.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.). in the sequence shown.
3. CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the camshaft phaser sprockets and new camshaft phaser bolts finger tight.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3437
4. CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
CAUTION: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser sprocket assembly or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser unit.
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Using the special tool, tighten the LH and RH camshaft phaser sprocket bolts in 2 stages. ^
Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
5. Using the special tool, position the crankshaft keyway at the 11 o'clock position.
6. CAUTION: Timing chain procedures must be followed exactly or damage to valves and pistons
will result.
CAUTION: Prior to installation, inspect the tensioner-sealing bead for seal integrity. If cracks, tears,
separation from the tensioner body or permanent compression of the seal bead is observed, install
a new tensioner.
Compress the tensioner plunger, using a vise.
7. Install a retaining clip on the tensioner to hold the plunger in during installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3438
8. Remove the tensioner from the vise.
9. If the copper links are not visible, mark two links on one end and one link on the other end, and
use as timing marks.
10. Install the crankshaft sprocket, making sure the flange faces forward.
11. Install the 4 bolts and the LH and RH timing chain guides.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3439
12. Position the lower end of the LH (inner) timing chain on the crankshaft sprocket, aligning the
timing mark on the outer flange of the crankshaft
sprocket with the single copper (marked) link on the chain.
13. NOTE: Make sure the upper half of the timing chain is below the tensioner arm dowel.
Position the timing chain on the camshaft sprocket with the camshaft sprocket timing mark
positioned between the two copper (marked) chain links.
14. NOTE: The LH timing chain tensioner arm has a bump near the dowel hole for identification.
Position the LH timing chain tensioner arm on the dowel pin and install the LH timing chain
tensioner and bolts. ^
Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
15. Remove the retaining clip from the LH timing chain tensioner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3440
16. Position the lower end of the RH (outer) timing chain on the crankshaft sprocket, aligning the
timing mark on the sprocket with the single copper
(marked) chain link.
17. NOTE: The lower half of the timing chain must be positioned above the tensioner arm dowel.
NOTE:The camshaft phaser and sprocket will be stamped with one of the illustrated timing marks
for the RH camshaft.
Position the RH timing chain on the camshaft phaser and sprocket wil the timing mark positioned
between the 2 copper (marked) chain links.
18. Position the RH timing chain tensioner arm on the dowel pin and install the RH timing chain
tensioner and bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3441
19. Remove the retaining clip from the RH timing chain tensioner.
20. As a post-check, verify correct alignment of all timing marks.
21. Install the crankshaft sensor ring on the crankshaft.
22. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed into their original
locations. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder. If
a valave drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3442
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the speical tool, install all of the camshaft roller followers. Lubricate the roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
23. Install the engine front cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications
Timing Chain Tensioner: Specifications
timing chain tensioner and bolts ..........................................................................................................
..................................................... 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications
Timing Cover: Specifications
Timing cover front bolts & nuts
Fasteners 1 through 15 .......................................................................................................................
............................................. 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) Fasteners 6 & 7 ........................................................
....................................................................................................................... 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.)
Timing cover lower bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
............................................ 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.) Final pass ..................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. 60°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3449
Timing Cover: Service and Repair
Engine Front Cover
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3450
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3452
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the engine oil. 3. Remove the engine cooling fan. For
additional information, refer to Cooling System. 4. Remove the RH valve cover. 5. Remove the LH
valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3453
6. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt.
7. Remove the nut and the power steering pressure hose support bracket.
8. Remove the nut and the transmission cooler tube support bracket. 9. Remove the crankshaft
pulley bolt and washer.
^ Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
10. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3454
11. Using the special tool, remove and discard the crankshaft front seal. 12. Remove the 3 bolts
and the 3 accessory drive idler pulleys. 13. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump pulley. 14.
Remove the 3 bolts and the accessory drive belt tensioner. 15. Disconnect the RH camshaft
position (CMP) sensor electrical connector. 16. Remove the bolt and the RH CMP sensor.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
17. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Disconnect the radio ignition interference capacitor electrical connectors.
18. Remove the nut and the RH radio ignition interference capacitor. 19. Disconnect the LH CMP
sensor electrical connector. 20. Remove the bolt and the LH CMP sensor.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
21. Remove the nut and the LH radio ignition interference capacitor. 22. Remove the bolts and
position the power steering pump assembly aside. 23. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP)
sensor electrical connector. 24. Remove the 4 front oil pan bolts.
25. Remove the bolts and the studs.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3455
26. Remove the engine front cover from the front cover to cylinder block dowel. 27. Remove the
bolt and the CKP sensor.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
28. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Remove and discard the engine front cover gaskets. ^
Clean the mating surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
^ Inspect the mating surfaces.
Installation
1. Install the CKP sensor and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
NOTE: If the engine front cover is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and
the sealing area cleaned with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions
on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer.
Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
NOTE: Make sure that the engine front cover gasket is in place on the engine front cover before
installation.
Apply a bead of silicone gasket and sealant along the cylinder head-to-cylinder block surface and
the oil pan-to-cylinder block surface, at the locations shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3456
3. Install new engine front cover gaskets on the engine front cover. Position the engine front cover
onto the dowels. Install the fasteners finger tight.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3457
4. Tighten the engine front cover fasteners in 2 stages, in the sequence shown.
^ Stage 1: Tighten fasteners 1 through 15 to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 2: Tighten fasteners 6 and 7 to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
5. Loosely install the bolts, then tighten the bolts in 2 stages, in the sequence shown.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 2: Tighten an additional 60°.
6. Connect the CKP sensor electrical connector. 7. Position the power steering pump assembly
and install the bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
8. Position the power steering pressure hose support bracket and install the nut.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3458
9. Position the transmission cooler tube support bracket and install the nut.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
10. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using a new O-ring seal, install the RH CMP sensor and the bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
11. Connect the RH CMP sensor electrical connector. 12. Install the LH radio ignition interference
capacitor and the nut.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
13. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using a new O-ring seal, install the LH CMP sensor and the bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
14. Connect the LH CMP sensor electrical connector. 15. Install the RH radio ignition interference
capacitor and the nut.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
16. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Connect the radio ignition interference capacitor electrical connectors.
17. Install the accessory drive belt tensioner and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
18. Install the coolant pump pulley and the 4 bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
19. Install the 3 accessory drive idler pulleys and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3459
20. Lubricate the engine front cover and the crankshaft front seal inner lip with clean engine oil.
21. Using the special tools, install the crankshaft front seal into the engine front cover.
22. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with silicone gasket remover and metal surface
prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4
minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant to the Woodruff key slot on the crankshaft pulley.
23. Use the special tool to install the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3460
24. Tighten the new crankshaft pulley bolt in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 2: Loosen 360°.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
^ Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90°.
25. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt. 26. Install the RH valve
cover. 27. Install the LH valve cover. 28. Install the engine cooling fan. For additional information,
refer to Cooling System. 29. Fill the crankcase with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page
3466
C1452
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3467
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS Systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
Variable Camshaft Timing System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3468
achieved. A difference between the desired and actual camshaft position represents a position
error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a
default position if a concern is detected. A related DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL SOLENOID
LH Shown, RH Similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the variable camshaft timing (VCT) oil
control solenoid electrical connector. 3. Remove the VCT oil control solenoid grommet. 4. Remove
the bolt and the VCT oil control solenoid. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
Key on, engine off.................................................................................................................................
.............................................240-310 kPa (35-45 psi) Engine running.................................................
..................................................................................................................................193-310 kPa
(28-45 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Measured/PID Values
Hot Idle Speed .....................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 600-650 RPM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER INTAKE PIPE
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air cleaner element.
2. Reach into the opening of the air cleaner assembly and depress the locking tab on the air
cleaner intake pipe to release the air cleaner intake pipe
from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3483
3. Remove the air cleaner intake tube assembly.
4. CAUTION: The air cleaner intake pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unusual engine
noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Release the retaining clips and remove the air cleaner element tray. 2. Remove the air cleaner
element from the air cleaner element tray.
3. CAUTION: The air cleaner element tray must be fully seated to the air cleaner housing. Failure
to do so will result in unusual engine
noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter
> Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: The electrical connector is located on the LH frame rail under the driver side door.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Start the engine and allow it to idle until it stalls. 4. After the engine stalls, crank the engine for
approximately 5 seconds to make sure the fuel rail pressure has been released. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the OFF position.
6. When fuel system service is complete, connect the electrical connector.
7. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
8. Install the diagnostic tool. Turn the key ON with the engine OFF. Cycle the key OFF, then ON.
Select the appropriate vehicle and engine qualifier.
Clear all diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and carry out a PCM reset.
9. Start the vehicle and check the fuel system for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Eight separate ignition coils:
- are mounted directly above each spark plug.
- are controlled by the powertrain control module (PCM) for correct firing sequence.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Timing > Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Item ......................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Specification
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Eight separate ignition coils:
- are mounted directly above each spark plug.
- are controlled by the powertrain control module (PCM) for correct firing sequence.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3502
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3503
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3504
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3505
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3506
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3507
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3508
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3509
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3510
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3511
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page
3512
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Spark Plug Gap
Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Gap
Spark Plug Gap
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.040 - 0.050 inch (1.02 - 1.27 mm)
NOTE: Spark plug gap not adjustable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Spark Plug Gap > Page 3515
Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Torque
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
................................................... 34 Nm (25.0 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3516
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark Plug ...........................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... PZT-2F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3517
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Engine Ignition - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3518
Engine Ignition - LH
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug.
2. NOTE:
- Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before removing the
spark plugs.
- If an original spark plug is used, make sure it is installed in the same cylinder from which it was
taken. New spark plugs can be used in any cylinder.
Remove the spark plugs. To install, tighten to 34 Nm (25 lb-ft).
3. Inspect the spark plugs. Install new spark plugs as necessary. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 1)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 2)
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75 percent of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit
Chart.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 3522
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test-Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of five compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test-Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75 percent of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit
Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 1)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 2)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 3523
Compression Test-Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty. 2. If compression does not
improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly. 3. If two adjacent cylinders indicate low
compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does not increase compression, the head
gasket may
be leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75 percent of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
This engine is equipped with hydraulic valve lifters. No adjustment is required.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Water pump bolts ................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 3530
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Coolant Pump
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. Remove the cooling fan. 3. Loosen the 4 coolant pump
pulley bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 3531
4. Rotate the belt tensioner clockwise and disconnect the accessory drive belt from the coolant
pump pulley. 5. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump pulley. 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the
coolant pump.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect the mating surfaces. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
^ Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine coolant prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Bypass Hose > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Thermostat Bypass Hose: Service and Repair
Bypass Tube
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. Remove the intake manifold. 3. Remove the 3 bolts, the
bypass tube, and discard the bypass tube gaskets.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect the mating surfaces and clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep and silicone
gasket remover. Follow the directions on the packaging.
^ Install new bypass tube gaskets.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
COOLING SYSTEM
BASE RADIATOR
With aux rear heat ...............................................................................................................................
........................................ 20.7 quarts (19.6 liters) Without aux rear heat ...........................................
....................................................................................................................... 19.4 quarts (18.4 liters)
HEAVY DUTY TRAILER TOW RADIATOR
With aux rear heat ...............................................................................................................................
........................................ 20.9 quarts (19.8 liters) Without aux rear heat ...........................................
....................................................................................................................... 19.7 quarts (18.6 liters)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 3540
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE COOLANT
Motorcraft Premium Gold Engine Coolant (yellow-colored)
Ford P/N
............................................................................................................................................................
VC-7-A (U.S., except CA, OR and NM) Ford P/N ...............................................................................
.................................................................................................. VC-7-B (CA, OR and NM)
Ford Specification ................................................................................................................................
................................................ WSS-M97B51-A1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair
Degas Bottle
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. Disconnect the 2 coolant hoses from the degas bottle. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the degas bottle.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Description and Operation
FAN CONTROL
The PCM monitors certain parameters (such as engine coolant temperature, vehicle speed, A/C
on/off status, A/C pressure) to determine engine cooling fan needs.
For variable speed electric fan(s):
Five Hundred/Freestyle/Montego, Fusion/Milan/Zephyr, Crown Victoria/Grand Marquis, Town Car:
FCV Duty Cycle Output From PCM (negative Duty Cycle)
LS: FCV Duty Cycle Output From PCM
The PCM controls the fan speed and operation using a duty cycle output on the fan control variable
(FCV) circuit. The fan controller (located at or integral to the engine cooling fan assembly) receives
the FCV command and operates the cooling fan at the speed requested (by varying the power
applied to the fan motor).
For relay controlled fans:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3548
2.0L Focus (with A/C) And Taurus: PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
2.3L Escape: PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
Freestar, Monterey: PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
The PCM controls the fan operation through the fan control (FC) (single speed fan applications),
low fan control (LFC), medium fan control (MFC), and/or high fan control (HFC) outputs. Some
applications will have the xFC circuit wired to 2 separate relays.
For 3-speed fans, although the PCM output circuits are called low, medium, and high fan control
(FC), cooling fan speed is controlled by a combination of these outputs. Refer to the table.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
FAN SPEED SENSOR (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch With Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The powertrain control
module (PCM) uses the frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop
control of the cooling fan clutch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Fan Blade: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Cooling Fan - Blade, Clutch and Shroud
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and resonator. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction.
2. Remove the retainers and the radiator sight shield. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the lower cooling
fan shroud.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.).
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the upper cooling fan shroud.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.).
5. Using the special tools, remove the cooling fan assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3556
Fan Blade: Service and Repair Disassembly and Assembly
Cooling Fan and Fan Clutch
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the 4 cooling fan-to-cooling fan clutch bolts and separate the clutch from the cooling
fan.
^ To assemble, tighten to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
2. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fan Clutch: Description and Operation
COOLING FAN CLUTCH
Cooling Fan Clutch With Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
The cooling fan clutch is an electrically actuated viscous clutch that consists of 3 main elements:
- a working chamber
- a reservoir chamber
- a cooling fan clutch actuator valve and a fan speed sensor (FSS)
The cooling fan clutch actuator valve controls the fluid flow from the reservoir into the working
chamber. Once viscous fluid is in the working chamber, shearing of the fluid results in fan rotation.
The cooling fan clutch actuator valve is activated with a pulse width modulated (PWM) output
signal from the powertrain control module (PCM). By opening and closing the fluid port valve, the
PCM can control the cooling fan clutch speed. The cooling fan clutch speed is measured by a
Hall-effect sensor and is monitored by the PCM during closed loop operation.
The PCM optimizes fan speed based on engine coolant temperature (ECT), engine oil temperature
(EOT), transmission fluid temperature (TFT), intake air temperature (IAT), or air conditioning
requirements. When an increased demand for fan speed is requested for vehicle cooling, the PCM
monitors the fan speed through the Hall-effect sensor. If a fan speed increase is required, the PCM
outputs the PWM signal to the fluid port, providing the required fan speed increase.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3560
Fan Clutch: Testing and Inspection
Fan Clutch Test
1. Spin the fan blade by hand. A light resistance should be felt. If there is no resistance or very high
resistance, the minimum and maximum fan
speeds must be checked as follows:
Fan Clutch Test - Minimum Speed Requirement
1. Use a suitable marker to mark the coolant pump pulley, one of the fan blade retaining bolts and
the crankshaft pulley. 2. Connect a tachometer to the engine. 3. Install a throttle adjusting tool. 4.
Connect a digital photoelectric tachometer.
5. WARNING: To avoid the possibility of personal injury or damage to the vehicle, do not operate
the engine until the fan blade has been
first examined for possible cracks and separation.
Start the engine and run it at approximately 1,500 rpm until the normal operating temperature has
been achieved. The A/C must be off.
6. Adjust the engine speed to 2,300 rpm. 7. Operate the digital photoelectric tachometer at 3,000
rpm and aim it at the coolant pump pulley. Adjust the engine speed until the light flash and
the coolant pump pulley mark are synchronized.
8. Aim the digital photoelectric tachometer at the fan blade bolts. Adjust the strobe light until the
light flash is synchronized with the marked fan
blade bolt (the fan blade appears to stand still).
9. The fan blade speed must not be greater than 1,500 rpm at 3,000 coolant pump rpm.
10. Turn the engine off. 11. If the fan blade speed was greater than 1,500 rpm, install a new fan
clutch.
Fan Clutch Test - Maximum Speed Requirement
1. Carry out Steps 1 through 5 of the Fan Clutch Test-Minimum Speed Requirement.
2. NOTE: The temperature of air in front of the clutch should be above 96°C (205°F) for maximum
fan speed.
Block off areas on each side of the radiator in the engine compartment and the front of the radiator
grille. This will raise the temperature of the air striking the fan clutch and should cause the fan
blade to operate at maximum speed.
3. On the electronic manual temperature control (EMTC), select panel mode, with A/C and
recirculation buttons requested ON. On the electronic
automatic temperature control (EATC), select panel mode, with A/C and recirculation buttons ON
and the blower motor switch in the HI position.
4. Adjust the strobe to 3,000 rpm.
5. WARNING: To avoid the possibility of personal injury or damage to the vehicle, do not operate
the engine until the fan blade has been
first examined for possible cracks and separation.
Start the engine and adjust the engine speed until the digital photoelectric tachometer light and the
water pump pulley mark are synchronized.
6. Aim the digital photoelectric tachometer light at the fan blade retaining bolts. Adjust the digital
photoelectric tachometer light until the light flash
is synchronized with the marked fan blade bolt (the fan blade appears to stand still).
7. If the fan blade speed is less than 2,300 rpm, install a new fan clutch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Fan Clutch: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Cooling Fan - Blade, Clutch and Shroud
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and resonator. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction.
2. Remove the retainers and the radiator sight shield. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the lower cooling
fan shroud.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.).
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the upper cooling fan shroud.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.).
5. Using the special tools, remove the cooling fan assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3563
Fan Clutch: Service and Repair Disassembly and Assembly
Cooling Fan and Fan Clutch
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the 4 cooling fan-to-cooling fan clutch bolts and separate the clutch from the cooling
fan.
^ To assemble, tighten to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
2. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3564
Fan Clutch: Tools and Equipment
Fan Clutch Holding Tool AST tool# 8005
Allows the technician to hold the water pump pulleuy in place while loosening the radiator fan.
2009 Suggested user price: $41.20
Assenmacher Specialty Tools 1 800 525 2943
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3569
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > CHT Sensor
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor:
^ is mounted into the wall of the cylinder head and is not connected to any coolant passages.
^ sends the PCM a signal indicating cylinder head temperature.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 121 °C (250°F), the PCM disables half of the fuel
injectors at a time. The PCM will alternate which fuel injectors are disabled every 32 engine cycles.
The cylinders that are not being fuel injected act as air pumps to aid in engine cooling.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 166°C (330°F), the PCM disables all of the fuel
injectors until the engine temperature drops below approximately 1 54°C (31 0°F).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > CHT Sensor > Page 3572
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Cylinder Head Temperature Sensor
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the aluminum cylinder head and measures the metal temperature.
The CHT sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer
coolant temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM
initiates a fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system
concern such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result
damage to major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling
strategy, the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3573
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Fan Shroud: Service and Repair
Cooling Fan - Blade, Clutch and Shroud
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and resonator. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction.
2. Remove the retainers and the radiator sight shield. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the lower cooling
fan shroud.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.).
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the upper cooling fan shroud.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.).
5. Using the special tools, remove the cooling fan assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Core: Customer Interest A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 3585
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 3586
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 3592
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 3593
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3594
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection
HEATER CORE
WARNING: Carbon monoxide is colorless, odorless and dangerous. If it is necessary to operate
the engine with the vehicle in a closed area such as a garage, always use an exhaust collector to
vent the exhaust gases outside the closed area.
1. NOTE: Testing of returned heater cores reveals that a large percentage of heater cores were
good and did not require replacement. If a heater
core leak is suspected, the heater core must be tested by carrying out the plugged heater core
component test before the heater core pressure test. Carry out a system inspection by checking
the heater system thoroughly as follows:
Inspect for evidence of coolant leakage at the heater water hose to heater core attachments. A
coolant leak in the heater water hose could follow the heater core tube to the heater core and
appear as a leak in the heater core.
2. NOTE: Spring-type clamps are installed as original equipment. Installation and overtightening of
non-specification clamps can cause leakage at
the heater water hose connection and damage the heater core.
Check the integrity of the heater water hose clamps.
Heater Core - Plugged
WARNING: The heater core inlet hose will become too hot to handle if the system is working
correctly.
1. Check to see that the engine coolant is at the correct level. 2. Start the engine and turn on the
heater. 3. When the engine coolant reaches operating temperature, feel the heater core outlet hose
to see if it is hot.
If it is not hot: -
the heater core may have an air pocket.
- the heater core may be plugged.
- the thermostat is not working correctly.
Heater Core - Pressure Test
Use the Radiator/Heater Core Pressure Tester to perform the pressure test.
1. NOTE: Due to space limitations, a bench test may be necessary for pressure testing.
Drain the coolant from the cooling system.
2. Disconnect the heater water hoses from the heater core. 3. Install a short piece of heater water
hose, approximately 101 mm (4 inches) long on each heater core tube.
4. Fill the heater core and heater water hoses with water and install Plug BT-7422-B and adapter
BT-7422-A from the Radiator/Heater Core
Pressure Tester in the heater water hose ends. Secure the heater water hoses, plug and adapter
with hose clamps.
5. Attach the pump and gauge assembly from the Radiator/Heater Core Pressure Tester to the
adapter. 6. Close the bleed valve at the base of the gauge. Pump 138 kPa (20 psi) of air pressure
into the heater core. 7. Observe the pressure gauge for a minimum of 3 minutes. 8. If the pressure
drops, check the heater water hose connections to the core tubes for leaks. If the heater water
hoses do not leak, remove the
heater core from the vehicle and perform the bench test.
Heater Core - Bench Test
1. Remove the heater core from the vehicle. 2. Drain all of the coolant from the heater core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3595
3. Connect the 101 mm (4 inch) test heater water hoses with plug and adapter to the core tubes.
Then connect the Radiator/Heater Core Pressure
Tester to the adapter.
4. Apply 138 kPa (20 psi) of air pressure to the heater core. Submerge the heater core in water.
5. If a leak is observed, install a new heater core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core
HEATER CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be leak tested before it is removed
from the vehicle.
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the dash panel seal. 3.
Remove the 3 temperature blend door actuator screws. 4. Remove the temperature blend door
actuator. 5. Remove the 4 heater core cover screws. 6. Remove the heater core cover. 7. Remove
the heater core. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core > Page 3598
Heater Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core
AUXILIARY HEATER CORE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the auxiliary climate control housing.
2. Remove the screws and the evaporator/heater core access cover.
3. Remove the heater core. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: Customer Interest A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 3607
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 3608
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 3614
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 3615
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Hose Coupling
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Hose Coupling
HEATER HOSE COUPLING
Remover, Heater Hose Inlet Tube
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect
1. WARNING: The engine must be off, fully cool and the cooling system fully depressurized before
attempting to disconnect any heater
water hoses. Failure to comply with this warning can result in serious injury or burns from hot liquid
escaping out of the engine cooling system.
Depressurize the engine cooling system.
2. Push the heater water hose toward the tube to fully expose the locking tabs.
3. NOTE: When compressing the white coupling retainer, the Heater Hose Disconnect Tool must
be perpendicular to and on the highest point of the
coupling.
Push the special tool over the coupling retainer windows to compress the retainer locking tabs.
4. NOTE: A slight twisting motion while pulling on the heater water hose may be necessary to
assist in the removal.
Pull the heater water hose away from the heater core tube.
5. Plug the heater water hose. 6. Remove the white coupling retainer from the tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Hose Coupling > Page 3618
7. Spread the retainer tabs apart and slide the retainer off the tube. 8. Discard the retainer.
Connect
1. Clean the tubes and lubricate with MERPOL(R) meeting Ford specification ESE-M99B144-B or
plain water.
2. Install a new coupling retainer, spacer, and lubricated O-ring seals into the quick disconnect
coupling housing.
3. Push the heater water hose with a quick disconnect coupling onto the tube. 4. Make sure the
coupling is fully engaged by lightly pulling on the heater water hose.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Hose Coupling > Page 3619
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Outlet and Inlet Line
AUXILIARY HEATER OUTLET AND INLET LINE
Removal
CAUTION: To avoid refrigerant loss, clearly differentiate the auxiliary heater lines from the auxiliary
refrigerant lines before beginning this procedure.
NOTE:
- The auxiliary heater inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly. The auxiliary
heater inlet line and outlet line are each installed from the factory as 1-piece assemblies. The
replacement parts are supplied as separate kits containing multiple piece lines for ease of
installation.
- The following procedure can be used to remove and install 1 or both the auxiliary heater inlet and
auxiliary heater outlet lines. If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed and installed, cut or
disconnect only the desired line at the specified points within the procedure.
1. Drain the engine coolant. 2. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
3. Detach the auxiliary heater lines.
1 Disconnect the heater hose(s).
2 Remove the 2 line bracket bolts.
3 Remove the line bracket.
4. Remove the spare tire. 5. Raise the vehicle. 6. Remove the RH front wheel. 7. Remove the RH
fender splash shield.
8. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the heater hose(s).
9. Remove the muffler.
10. Remove the RH catalytic converter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Hose Coupling > Page 3620
11. Remove the 3 bolts and the heat shield.
12. Remove the bolts.
13. Remove the nut and the line bracket.
14. Remove the bolt and the heat shield.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Hose Coupling > Page 3621
15. Remove the nuts and the remaining line brackets.
16. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary heater line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new line(s).
17. Remove the auxiliary heater line(s) in 3 separate pieces.
Installation
1. Partially lower the vehicle.
2. Attach the rear portion of the auxiliary heater lines.
1 Connect the heater hoses.
2 Install the line bracket.
3 Install the bolts.
3. Install the front auxiliary heater line(s) and connect the heater hose(s).
- Clean and lubricate the heater hoses with plain water only if needed.
4. Raise the vehicle.
5. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the middle auxiliary heater line(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Hose Coupling > Page 3622
6. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 line brackets.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
7. Tighten the middle auxiliary heater line fittings. 8. Inspect the auxiliary heater lines for correct
installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as needed.
9. Install the heat shield and the bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
10. Install the heat shield and the bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
11. Install the RH catalytic converter. 12. Install the muffler. 13. Partially lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Hose Coupling > Page 3623
14. Install the heat shield bolt.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
15. Install the line bracket.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Install the spare tire. 18. Install the RH quarter trim panel. 19. Fill the
engine coolant level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection
Radiator: Testing and Inspection
Radiator Leak Test, Removed From Vehicle
CAUTION: Never leak test an aluminum radiator in the same water that copper/brass radiators are
tested in. Flux and caustic cleaners may be present in the cleaning tank and they will damage
aluminum radiators.
NOTE: Always install plugs in the oil cooler fittings before leak testing or cleaning any radiator.
1. Leak test the radiator in clean water with 138 kPa (20 psi) air pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 3627
Radiator: Service and Repair
Radiator
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system.
2. Remove the pin-type retainers and the air deflector cover. 3. Remove the cooling fan and
shroud. 4. Disconnect the upper radiator coolant hose from the radiator. 5. Disconnect the degas
bottle return hose from the radiator. 6. Disconnect the lower radiator coolant hose from the radiator.
7. Push the special tool into the fitting to release the tube retaining clip and remove the
transmission cooler lines from the radiator. 8. Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 radiator support
brackets.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 3628
9. Remove the radiator and the 4 radiator insulators.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Radiator Cap: Testing and Inspection
Cap - Pressure Relief
1. WARNING: Never remove the pressure relief cap while the engine is operating or when the
cooling system is hot. Failure to follow these
instructions can result in damage to the cooling system or engine or personal injury. To avoid
having scalding hot coolant or steam blow out of the degas bottle when removing the pressure
relief cap, wait until the engine has cooled, then wrap a thick cloth around the pressure relief cap
and turn it slowly. Step back while the pressure is released from the cooling system. When you are
sure all the pressure has been released, turn and remove the pressure relief cap (still with a cloth).
Inspect the pressure relief cap and seals for damage or deterioration. Install a new pressure relief
cap if necessary.
2. Fit the pressure relief cap to Radiator/Heater Core Pressure Tester Kit using the aftermarket
adapter.
3. NOTE: If the plunger of the pressure tester is depressed too fast, an incorrect pressure reading
will result.
Slowly pump the pressure tester until the pressure gauge stops increasing and note the highest
pressure reading. Release pressure and repeat test. Install a new pressure relief cap if the
pressure is not between 99.3 - 121.4 kPa (14.4 - 17.6 psi).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
FAN SPEED SENSOR (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch With Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The powertrain control
module (PCM) uses the frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop
control of the cooling fan clutch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3640
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > CHT Sensor
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor:
^ is mounted into the wall of the cylinder head and is not connected to any coolant passages.
^ sends the PCM a signal indicating cylinder head temperature.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 121 °C (250°F), the PCM disables half of the fuel
injectors at a time. The PCM will alternate which fuel injectors are disabled every 32 engine cycles.
The cylinders that are not being fuel injected act as air pumps to aid in engine cooling.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 166°C (330°F), the PCM disables all of the fuel
injectors until the engine temperature drops below approximately 1 54°C (31 0°F).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > CHT Sensor > Page 3643
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Cylinder Head Temperature Sensor
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the aluminum cylinder head and measures the metal temperature.
The CHT sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer
coolant temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM
initiates a fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system
concern such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result
damage to major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling
strategy, the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 3644
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications
Thermostat: Specifications
Thermostat Opening Temperatures
Starts to open ......................................................................................................................................
.................................... 86.7 - 90.6°C (188 - 195°F) Fully open ..........................................................
................................................................................................................... 97.8 - 101.7°C (208 215°F)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3648
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3649
Thermostat: Testing and Inspection
Thermostat
A new thermostat should be installed only after these electrical and mechanical tests have been
carried out.
Thermostat - Electrical Test
NOTE: The electrical thermostat test is most accurate if carried out indoors at less than 37.8°C
(100°F) ambient air. This test may be carried out with or without the hood open and with the engine
warm or cold.
1. Check the engine coolant level. Fill as needed. 2. With the ignition OFF, voltage values (0-5 V)
may now be monitored while the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor retains its connection to
the wiring harness. A diagnostic tool may be used to monitor the CHT on vehicles equipped with
data link connector (DLC). The SBDS sequence to use for the screen is: Toolbox-Electronic Engine
Control and DCL-Item.
3. Place the automatic transmission in PARK (P) or the manual transmission in NEUTRAL (N) and
engage the parking brake.
4. Start the engine and allow the engine to idle throughout this test. Allow the engine to run for 2
minutes, then record the CHT voltage. Record the
CHT voltage every 60 seconds. When the CHT voltage trend changes direction or only changes
slightly (0.03 volt or less) from the previous reading, record this as the thermostat opening voltage.
Use the voltage and corresponding coolant temperature chart.
5. If the coolant thermostat opening voltage is greater than 0.67 volt and less than 86°C (187°F),
install a new coolant thermostat. 6. If the coolant thermostat opening voltage is less than 0.58 volt
and greater than 86°C (187°F), the coolant thermostat is good and a new coolant
thermostat should not be installed. GO to Symptom Chart for further instructions. See: Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Diagnosis By Symptom
Thermostat - Mechanical Test
1. Remove the thermostat. 2. Check the thermostat for seating. Hold the thermostat up to a lighted
background. Leakage of light around the thermostat valve at room
temperature indicates that a new thermostat should be installed. Some thermostats have a small
leakage notch at one location on the perimeter of the thermostat valve, which is considered normal.
3. Immerse the thermostat in a boiling antifreeze and water mixture. 4. For additional information,
refer to Specifications for thermostat opening temperature.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3650
Thermostat: Service and Repair
Thermostat and Thermostat Housing
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. If replacing the thermostat housing, disconnect the upper
radiator hose from the thermostat. 3. Remove the 2 bolts, the thermostat housing and the
thermostat. Discard the O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect the sealing surfaces. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
^ Install a new O-ring seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Housing, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Housing, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3654
Thermostat Housing: Service and Repair
Thermostat and Thermostat Housing
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. If replacing the thermostat housing, disconnect the upper
radiator hose from the thermostat. 3. Remove the 2 bolts, the thermostat housing and the
thermostat. Discard the O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect the sealing surfaces. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
^ Install a new O-ring seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Water pump bolts ................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3658
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Coolant Pump
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. Remove the cooling fan. 3. Loosen the 4 coolant pump
pulley bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3659
4. Rotate the belt tensioner clockwise and disconnect the accessory drive belt from the coolant
pump pulley. 5. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump pulley. 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the
coolant pump.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect the mating surfaces. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
^ Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine coolant prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
CATALYST AND EXHAUST SYSTEMS
Overview
V-Engines
In-Line Engines
The catalytic converter and exhaust Systems work together to control the release of harmful engine
exhaust emissions into the atmosphere. The engine exhaust gas consists mainly of nitrogen (N),
carbon dioxide (CO2) and water vapor (H2O). However, it also contains carbon monoxide (CO),
oxides of nitrogen (NOx), hydrogen (H), and various unburned hydrocarbons (HCs). The major air
pollutants of CO, NOx, and HCs, and their emission into the atmosphere must be controlled.
The exhaust system generally consists of an exhaust manifold, front exhaust pipe, front heated
oxygen sensor (HO2S), rear exhaust pipe, catalyst HO2S, a muffler, and an exhaust tailpipe. The
catalytic converter is typically installed between the front and rear exhaust pipes. On some vehicle
applications, more than one catalyst is used between the front and rear exhaust pipes. Catalytic
converter efficiency is monitored by the on-board diagnostic (OBD) system strategy in the PCM.
For information on the OBD catalyst monitor, refer to the description for the Catalyst Efficiency
Monitor.
The number of HO2Ss used in the exhaust stream and the location of these sensors depend on the
vehicle emission certification level (LEV, LEV-II, ULEV, PZEV). On most vehicles only 2 HO2Ss are
used in an exhaust stream. The front sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control while the ones after the catalyst (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor
catalyst efficiency. However, some partial zero emission vehicles (PZEV) use 3 HO2Ss for each
engine bank. The stream 1 sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) located before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control, the stream 2 sensors (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor the light-off
catalyst, and the stream 3 sensors (HO2S13/HO2S23) located after the catalyst are used for long
term fuel trim control to optimize catalyst efficiency (fore aft oxygen sensor control). Current PZEV
vehicles use only a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 3664
4-cylinder engine, so only the bank 1 HO2Ss are used.
Catalytic Converter
A catalyst is a material that remains unchanged when it initiates and increases the speed of a
chemical reaction. A catalyst also enables a chemical reaction to occur at a lower temperature. The
concentration of exhaust gas products released to the atmosphere must be controlled. The
catalytic converter assists in this task. It contains a catalyst in the form of a specially treated
ceramic honeycomb structure saturated with catalytically active precious metals. As the exhaust
gases come in contact with the catalyst, they are changed into mostly harmless products. The
catalyst initiates and speeds up heat producing chemical reactions of the exhaust gas components
so they are used up as much as possible.
Light Off Catalyst
As the catalyst heats up, converter efficiency rises rapidly. The point at which conversion efficiency
exceeds 50% is called catalyst light off. For most catalysts this point occurs at 246°C to 302°C
(475°F to 575°F). A fast light catalyst is a 3-way catalyst (TWC) that is located as close to the
exhaust manifold as possible. Because the light off catalyst is located close to the exhaust manifold
it lights off faster and reduce emissions quicker than the catalyst located under the body. Once the
catalyst lights off, the catalyst quickly reaches the maximum conversion efficiency for that catalyst.
Three-Way Catalyst (TWC) Conversion Efficiency
TWC Conversion Efficiency Chart
A TWC requires a stoichiometric fuel ratio, 14.7 pounds of air to 1 pound of fuel (14.7:1), for high
conversion efficiency. In order to achieve these high efficiencies, the air/fuel ratio must be tightly
controlled with a narrow window of stoichiometry. Deviations outside of this window greatly
decrease the conversion efficiency. For example a rich mixture decreases the HC and CO
conversion efficiency while a lean mixture decreases the NOx conversion efficiency.
Exhaust System
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 3665
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 2 HO2S Configuration
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 3 HO2S Configuration
The purpose of the exhaust system is to convey engine emissions from the exhaust manifold to the
atmosphere. Engine exhaust emissions are directed from the engine exhaust manifold to the
catalytic converter through the front exhaust pipe. A HO2S is mounted on the front exhaust pipe
before the catalyst. The catalytic converter reduces the concentration of CO, unburned HCs, and
NOx in the exhaust emissions to an acceptable level. The reduced exhaust emissions are directed
from the catalytic converter past another HO2S mounted in the rear exhaust pipe and then on into
the muffler. Finally, the exhaust emissions are directed to the atmosphere through an exhaust
tailpipe.
On some PZEV, there is a total of 3 HO2S in the exhaust stream. One near the exhaust manifold
(stream 1), one in the middle of the light-off catalyst (stream 2), and the third (stream 3) is mounted
after the light-off catalyst.
Underbody Catalyst
The underbody catalyst is located after the light off catalyst. The underbody catalyst may be in-line
with the light off catalyst, or the underbody catalyst may be common to 2 light off catalysts, forming
a Y pipe configuration. For an exact configuration of the catalyst and exhaust system for a specific
vehicle, refer to Catalytic Converter, Exhaust System.
Three-Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
The TWC converter contains either platinum (Pt) and rhodium (Rh) or palladium (Pd) and rhodium
(Rh). The TWC converter catalyzes the oxidation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 3666
reactions of unburned HCs and CO and the reduction reaction of NOx. The 3-way conversion can
be best accomplished by always operating the engine air fuel/ratio at or close to stoichiometry.
Exhaust Manifold Runners
The exhaust manifold runners collect exhaust gases from engine cylinders. The number of exhaust
manifolds and exhaust manifold runners depends on the engine configuration and number of
cylinders.
Exhaust Pipes
Exhaust pipes are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to
increase the life of the product. The pipes serve as guides for the flow of exhaust gases from the
engine exhaust manifold through the catalytic converter and the muffler.
Heated Oxygen Sensors (HO2S)
The HO2S provide the powertrain control module (PCM) with voltage and frequency information
related to the oxygen content of the exhaust gas.
Muffler
Mufflers are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to increase
the life of the product. The muffler reduces the level of noise produced by the engine, and also
reduces the noise produced by exhaust gases as they travel from the catalytic converter to the
atmosphere.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
Exhaust manifold nuts .........................................................................................................................
................................................. 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > General Procedures
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair General Procedures
Exhaust Manifold-Inspection
Special Tools And Equipment
Special Tool(s)
1. Place a straight edge across the exhaust manifold flanges and check for warping with a feeler
gauge.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3672
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold - LH
Exhaust Manifold - LH
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3673
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the air cleaner housing. For additional information,
refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 3. Remove the generator. For additional information, refer
to Alternator. 4. Remove the LH inner fenderwell. 5. Remove the upper radiator shroud. For
additional information, refer to Cooling System.
6. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the LH engine mount through bolt or damage to
the cage nut can occur.
NOTE: If the LH engine mount through bolt nut is missing or damaged install a new nut using
service part number W709375. If the LH engine mount through bolt nut cage is damaged or
missing, remove the cage and install a new nut using service part number W520516-S301.
Remove the LH engine support insulator bolt. ^
To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs.).
7. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when loosening the RH engine mount nut or damage to the
engine mount can occur.
Loosen the RH engine mount nut. ^
To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3674
8. Remove the 4 exhaust manifold-to-catalytic converter nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
9. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts or
damage to the transmission mount can occur.
Loosen the 2 transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts. ^
To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.).
10. Remove the 2 bolts and the exhaust manifold heat shield.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
4WD vehicles
11. Remove the front driveshaft.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3675
12. Install the special tools and raise the engine.
13. Remove the 8 nuts and the exhaust manifold.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) in the sequence shown.
14. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These may cause
scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths. Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing surfaces.
NOTE: Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Remove and discard the exhaust manifold gaskets. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface
prep.
15. Inspect the exhaust manifold. 16. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3676
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold - RH
Exhaust Manifold - RH
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3677
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the air cleaner housing. For additional information,
refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 3. Remove the generator. For additional information, refer
to Alternator. 4. Remove the starter. For additional information, refer to Starter. 5. Remove the RH
inner fenderwell. 6. Remove the upper radiator shroud. For additional information, refer to Cooling
System.
7. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when loosening the LH engine mount through bolt or damage to
the cage nut can occur.
NOTE: If the LH engine mount through bolt nut is missing or damaged install a new nut using
service part number W709375. If the LH engine mount through bolt nut cage is damaged or
missing, remove the cage and install a new nut using service part number W520516-S301.
Loosen the LH engine support insulator bolt. ^
To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs.).
8. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the RH engine mount nut or damage to the
engine mount can occur.
Remove the RH engine mount nut. ^
To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3678
9. Remove the 4 exhaust manifold-to-catalytic converter nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
10. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts
or damage to the transmission mount can occur.
Loosen the 2 transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts. ^
To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.).
11. Remove the 4 bolts and position the sway bar down.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
12. Install the special tools and raise the engine.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 3679
13. Remove the 8 nuts and the exhaust manifold.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) in the sequence shown.
14. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs, or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These may
cause scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths.
Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing surfaces.
NOTE: Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Remove and discard the exhaust manifold gaskets. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface
prep.
15. Inspect the exhaust manifold. 16. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair
Exhaust Y-Pipe - Dual Catalytic Converter
Material
Removal
CAUTION: Do not use oil- or grease-based lubricants on isolators as they deteriorate the rubber.
NOTE: The exhaust Y-pipe-dual catalytic converter is a 2-piece assembly. The RH and LH
converters can be serviced separately as needed.
Both RH and LH catalytic converters
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Disconnect the heated oxygen and catalyst monitor sensors.
3. NOTE: LH catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nuts shown, RH similar.
Remove and discard the catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nuts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 3683
4. Loosen the RH catalytic converter to LH catalytic converter clamp.
LH converter only
5. NOTE: Use caution removing the catalytic converter. Make sure not to damage the manifold
outlet flare, the converter inlet flare or the studs.
Separate and remove the LH converter.
RH converter only
6. Remove and discard the bolts and flag nuts at the RH converter-to-muffler flange. 7. Using a
suitable jack stand, support the muffler.
8. Detach the isolators from the muffler assembly. 9. Lower the muffler assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 3684
10. NOTE: Use caution removing the catalytic converter. Make sure not to damage the manifold
outlet flare, the converter inlet flare or the studs.
Remove the transmission mounting bracket isolator cap bolt, transmission mounting bracket
isolator cap and the RH converter.
Both RH and LH catalytic converters
11. If necessary, remove the heated oxygen and the catalyst monitor sensors.
Installation
Both RH and LH catalytic converters
CAUTION: Do not tighten the fasteners until all components are assembled and aligned, making
sure to tighten all fasteners beginning at the front of the vehicle.
NOTE: Clean the mating surfaces of the manifold outlet flare and the catalytic converter inlet flare.
Also clean the mating surfaces of the muffler inlet pipe and catalytic converter. Make sure not to
damage the manifold outlet flare, the converter inlet flare or the studs.
NOTE: Always install new fasteners and gaskets.
1. NOTE: Make sure to apply anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the sensors before installation.
If removed, install the heated oxygen and the catalyst monitor sensors. ^
Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
RH catalytic converter
2. If not already installed, position the RH catalytic converter-to-LH catalytic converter clamp.
3. NOTE: Use caution installing the catalytic converter. Make sure not to damage the manifold
outlet flare, the converter inlet flare or the studs.
Position the RH catalytic converter and loosely install the nuts to the exhaust manifold.
4. Install the transmission mounting bracket isolator cap and loosely install the bolt.
5. Install the isolators to the muffler assembly. 6. Loosely install new RH catalytic
converter-to-muffler bolts and flag nuts.
LH catalytic converter
7. If not already installed, position the RH catalytic converter to LH catalytic converter clamp.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 3685
8. NOTE: Use caution installing the catalytic converter. Make sure not to damage the manifold
outlet flare, the converter inlet flare or the studs.
Position the LH catalytic converter and loosely install the nuts to the exhaust manifold.
RH and LH catalytic converters
9. Align the exhaust system.
10. To seat the RH catalytic converter to the RH exhaust manifold, tighten the new catalytic
converter nuts in this sequence.
^ Tighten the upper nut to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
^ Tighten the lower nut to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
11. Tighten the transmission mounting bracket isolator cap bolt.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
12. Tighten the RH catalytic converter-to-LH catalytic converter clamp.
^ Tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 3686
13. To seat the LH catalytic converter to the LH exhaust manifold, tighten the new catalytic
converter nuts in this sequence.
^ Snug the inner nut.
^ Tighten the outer nut to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
^ Tighten the inner nut to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
14. Tighten the RH catalytic converter-to-muffler bolts and flag nuts.
^ Tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
15. Connect the heated oxygen and catalyst monitor sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Heat Shield: Service and Repair
Exhaust Heat Shields
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Inspect the exhaust system for loose or missing heat shields
or foreign material trapped between the heat shields and the exhaust system
components.
3. If any heat shields are loose, install worm gear clamps.
^ Use either of these clamps: F0TZ-5A231-A or W705949-S300.
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs.).
^ Trim off the excess ear of the worm clamp.
4. If the heat shields are missing, install new heat shields or exhaust system components as
necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Muffler: Service and Repair
Muffler and Tailpipe
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Do not use oil- or grease-based lubricants on isolators as they deteriorate the rubber.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Loosen the clamp, separate the isolator from the hanger and remove:
^ An extension pipe for Expedition models.
^ A resonator for Navigator models.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
3. Remove the 4 nuts and 2 stabilizer bar brackets.
^ Allow the bar to hang from the links.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
5. Detach the isolators from the muffler.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 3693
6. Remove and discard the bolts and flag nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
7. CAUTION: Make sure not to make contact with the axle boots while routing the muffler outlet
over the rear axle or damage to the boots may
result.
Remove the muffler and tailpipe assembly.
8. NOTE: Clean the mating surfaces of the inlet pipe and catalytic converter.
NOTE: Always install new fasteners.
NOTE: Check the exhaust hanger isolators for wear or damage, install new isolators, if necessary.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Body Control Module: Locations
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE (VSM)
View 151-17 (RH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3700
Body Control Module: Diagrams
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE (VSM)
C2113a
C2113b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3701
C2113c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver
Seat Module (DSM)
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
may result.
- Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload module configuration information to
the appropriate diagnostic equipment. This information needs to be downloaded into the new
module once installed.
1. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the driver seat module forward to remove it from the bracket.
2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
4. CAUTION: Once the module is installed it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the diagnostic tool into
the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver
Seat Module (DSM) > Page 3704
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Vehicle Security Module
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE
Removal
CAUTION: The steps included in the vehicle security module removal and installation procedure
are critical to restoring the vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring systems to normal
operation. A new vehicle security module is delivered in manufacturing mode with 6 pre-set
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) related to the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). The
presence of these DTCs requires the installation procedures be followed in order to clear the DTCs
and enable normal vehicle security module operations.
1. NOTE: Prior to the removal of the vehicle security module, it is necessary to upload the module
configuration information to the diagnostic tool.
This information must be downloaded to the new vehicle security module after installation.
Disconnect the battery.
2. Remove the pin-type retainer and the RH A-pillar lower trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver
Seat Module (DSM) > Page 3705
3. Remove the glove compartment. 4. Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors. 5. Remove the 2
screws and the vehicle security module.
Installation
1. Position the vehicle security module and install the 2 screws.
- Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
2. Connect the 3 electrical connectors. 3. Position the RH A-pillar lower trim panel and install the
pin-type retainer. 4. Install the glove compartment 5. Connect the battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for vehicle security module
operation and clears DTC B2477. The clearing
of the DTC indicates the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the vehicle security
module.
Download the vehicle security module configuration information from the diagnostic tool to the
vehicle security module.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the vehicle security
module has recognized the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. Clear the DTCs.
9. NOTE:
- DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the vehicle security module.
- This step is required to clear DTC C2780, allow the vehicle security module to exit the
manufacturing mode, and to be sure there are no other concerns with the newly programmed
vehicle security module.
Carry out the vehicle security module on-demand self-test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position sensor (TPS), and mechanical throttle
body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph) Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The throttle position (TP) sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The
redundant throttle position signals are required for
increased monitoring reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle,
decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing
voltage). During normal operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control
strategy as the indication of throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 3709
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 3710
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 3711
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. Therefore, the E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly
monitor selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of
the IPC and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it
takes appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 3712
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 3713
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 5% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 5% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key-on,
engine off.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard-stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard-stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide Open Throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of Range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard-stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard-stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H-driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3719
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3720
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3721
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3722
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3723
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3724
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3725
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3726
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3727
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3728
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3729
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3730
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3731
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3732
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3733
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3734
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3735
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3736
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175b (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3737
C175b (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3738
C175e (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3739
C175e (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3740
C175t (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3741
C175t (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The flash electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM) is contained in an
integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module (PCM). The EEPROM contains the
vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the vehicle, and is capable of being
programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate fault code P1635
or P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various
hardware or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this
procedure properly may generate fault code P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An
incorrect tire/axle ratio is one of the main causes for fault code P1639. This is described under
Making Changes to the VID Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The
VID block contains many items used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items
include the vehicle identification number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed
limit, tire size, axle ratio, the presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly
(ESOF) versus manual shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and
supported by the VID block is displayed on the diagnostic tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the diagnostic tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again
to reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the
diagnostic tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and will need programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
the use of a diagnostic tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle.
The stored data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Manual data entry must be carried out if the old module is damaged or incapable of
communicating. Remove and install a new PCM. Using a compatible diagnostic tool, select and
carry out the module/parameter programming, referring to the diagnostic tool manufacturer's
instruction manual. Make certain that all parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire
size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches),
axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF may result in codes P1635 and P1639. You may be
instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center for the information needed to manually update the
VID block with the diagnostic tool. Contact the center only if the old PCM cannot be used or the
data is corrupt. For Ford and L-M technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional
Technician Society (PTS) website for As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index.
Non-Ford technicians use the Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the
Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and L-M technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the PTS
website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle when using the worldwide
diagnostic system (WDS) or New Generation STAR (NGS).
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to PCM/Module Reprogramming on the diagnostic tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to PCM/Module Reprogramming on the diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) > Page 3744
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Refer to Computers and Control Systems for correct worldwide diagnostic system (WDS)
hook-up procedure.
If servicing the powertrain control module (PCM), connect the diagnostic tool to the vehicle. Allow
the diagnostic tool to identify the vehicle and obtain configuration data. All programmable module information will automatically be retrieved by the WDS.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) > Page 3745
3. Disconnect the PCM electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 4 bolts and the PCM.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. If servicing the PCM bracket, remove the 3 bolts and the PCM bracket.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3749
C2160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3750
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3751
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 3756
C4033
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 3757
Fuel Pump Control Unit: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Driver Module (FPDM)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. NOTE: The fuel pump driver module (FPDM) is located on the top of the LH frame rail near the
fuel tank filler pipe.
Disconnect the FPDM electrical connector.
4. Remove the bolts and the FPDM.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3761
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Central Junction Box (CJB) and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3765
C2160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3766
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3767
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3773
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3774
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3778
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3779
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3780
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. If the hot wire electronic
sensing element must be replaced, then the entire assembly must be replaced. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
The current required to maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow.
The MAF sensor then outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air
mass. The PCM calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired
air/fuel ratio. This input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC),
shift and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology (IBT) with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3781
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1 > Page 3787
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3788
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston No.
1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing the
sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP signal to
select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3789
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3796
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3797
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3798
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the accessory drive belt. 4. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 7. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3802
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > CHT Sensor
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor:
^ is mounted into the wall of the cylinder head and is not connected to any coolant passages.
^ sends the PCM a signal indicating cylinder head temperature.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 121 °C (250°F), the PCM disables half of the fuel
injectors at a time. The PCM will alternate which fuel injectors are disabled every 32 engine cycles.
The cylinders that are not being fuel injected act as air pumps to aid in engine cooling.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 166°C (330°F), the PCM disables all of the fuel
injectors until the engine temperature drops below approximately 1 54°C (31 0°F).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > CHT Sensor > Page 3805
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Cylinder Head Temperature Sensor
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the aluminum cylinder head and measures the metal temperature.
The CHT sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer
coolant temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM
initiates a fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system
concern such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result
damage to major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling
strategy, the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 3806
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
NOTE: The Ford GT uses a piezoelectric sonar type fuel level sensor. The sensor is located in the
tank and the sensor signal is provided as a communications network message by the instrument
cluster to the PCM.
The FLI is either a hard wire signal input to the PCM from the fuel pump (FP) module or a
communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type FLI sensor
connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 3810
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 3811
Part 2
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 3812
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel and vapor tubes from the fuel pump module.
3. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
4. CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 3813
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 3817
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube quick connect couplings from the fuel
vapor/grade vent valves. 3. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube quick connect couplings from the fuel
pump module. 4. Remove the fuel pressure sensor tube assembly. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
- Leak test the system. See: Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle. See: Emission Control
Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair
Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3821
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3822
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3823
fuel, spark, and air flow.
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. However, one is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard
OBD/cold weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the
intake manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature
information to the PCM to control border-line spark and to help determine intercooler efficiency.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 >
Page 3829
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3830
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3831
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE (EOP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3838
C104
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3839
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3840
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Service and Repair
OIL TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Drain the engine oil. 4. Disconnect the engine oil temperature (EOT) sensor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the EOT sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
- Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3845
Oxygen Sensor: Harness Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3846
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3847
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3848
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission Without Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3849
View 151-9 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission With Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3850
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3851
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3852
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3853
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission Without Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3854
View 151-9 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission With Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22
C141
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3857
C142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3858
C171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3859
C172
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3860
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3863
3. Using the special tool, remove the HO2S.
- To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3864
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3865
3. Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor.
- To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 3870
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR
DPFE Sensor
The DPFE sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer that monitors the differential
pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly. The differential pressure
feedback sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as the downstream pressure hose
(REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI and REF hose connections are
marked on the DPFE sensor housing for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger
diameter hose). The DPFE sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the
metering orifice and supplies it to the powertrain control module (PCM) as EGR flow rate feedback.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor > Page 3875
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor - Tube Mounted
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR - TUBE MOUNTED
DPFE Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted DPFE sensor is identical in operation as the larger plastic DPFE sensors and
uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3879
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 3882
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases corrosion resistance on terminals
and increases connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body. As the TP
sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM from the
TP. Those conditions are closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration), part throttle (includes cruise
or moderate acceleration), wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on
crank), and throttle angle rate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 3883
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and the air cleaner
assembly. 3. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the air cleaner and air cleaner inlet pipe. 4.
Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3887
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3890
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3891
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3892
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3893
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3894
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3895
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3896
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3897
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3898
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3899
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3900
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3901
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3902
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3903
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3904
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3905
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3906
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3907
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3908
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
4R70E/4R75E Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Adjustment
Special Tools
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual lever shift control cable.
3. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3909
4. Loosen the digital transmission range (TR) sensor bolts.
5. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
6. CAUTION: Tightening one bolt before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor and tighten the bolts in an alternating sequence.
^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Install the manual control lever.
^ Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual lever shaft outer nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3910
8. With the manual lever in overdrive connect the shift lever control cable. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3911
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tools
Removal
NOTE: Manual shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3912
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual control lever shift control cable.
3. Disconnect the digital TR electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
5. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the digital TR sensor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3913
1. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
2. Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
3. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3914
5. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
6. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information generated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 3919
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or HALL-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a
frequency that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low
velocity, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the
sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated
by the VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR
DPFE Sensor
The DPFE sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer that monitors the differential
pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly. The differential pressure
feedback sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as the downstream pressure hose
(REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI and REF hose connections are
marked on the DPFE sensor housing for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger
diameter hose). The DPFE sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the
metering orifice and supplies it to the powertrain control module (PCM) as EGR flow rate feedback.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor > Page 3925
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor - Tube Mounted
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR - TUBE MOUNTED
DPFE Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted DPFE sensor is identical in operation as the larger plastic DPFE sensors and
uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3930
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3931
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3935
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3936
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3937
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. If the hot wire electronic
sensing element must be replaced, then the entire assembly must be replaced. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
The current required to maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow.
The MAF sensor then outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air
mass. The PCM calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired
air/fuel ratio. This input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC),
shift and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology (IBT) with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3938
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Rail
Pressure Sensor
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Rail
Pressure Sensor > Page 3943
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Rail
Pressure/Temperature Sensor
C1475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Rail
Pressure/Temperature Sensor > Page 3946
C435
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 3949
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail. Both pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the
fuel pump. The speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid
state. The dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which
allows the injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 3950
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Disconnect the fuel
rail pressure and temperature (FRPT) sensor electrical and vacuum connectors. 4. Remove the 2
bolts and the FRPT sensor and discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal.
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3954
C1475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail. Both pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the
fuel pump. The speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid
state. The dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which
allows the injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor > Page 3957
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Temperature (FRT) Sensor
FUEL RAIL TEMPERATURE (FRT) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Temperature (FRT) Sensor
The FRT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRT sensor measures the temperature of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 3958
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Disconnect the fuel
rail pressure and temperature (FRPT) sensor electrical and vacuum connectors. 4. Remove the 2
bolts and the FRPT sensor and discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal.
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3962
C4168
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3963
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3964
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the LH rear interior quarter trim panel. 3.
Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the
IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3968
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 3971
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases corrosion resistance on terminals
and increases connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body. As the TP
sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM from the
TP. Those conditions are closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration), part throttle (includes cruise
or moderate acceleration), wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on
crank), and throttle angle rate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 3972
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and the air cleaner
assembly. 3. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the air cleaner and air cleaner inlet pipe. 4.
Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
1 > Page 3979
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3980
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston No.
1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing the
sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP signal to
select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3981
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3985
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3986
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3987
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the accessory drive belt. 4. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 7. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3993
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3994
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3995
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3996
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3997
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3998
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3999
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4000
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4001
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4002
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4003
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4004
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4005
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4006
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4007
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4008
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4009
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4010
C250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4011
Ignition Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4012
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4013
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Lower tilt release handle to access second screw.
Remove the lower steering column shroud. ^
Remove the screws.
3. NOTE: The screw is located behind the multi-function switch.
Remove the screw and the upper steering column shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4014
4. Remove the bolt, push the release and position the multi-function switch aside.
5. Disconnect the ignition switch electrical connector.
6. Remove the ignition switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Make sure that the spring located under the ignition switch is positioned on the steering column
lock rod.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 4020
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4021
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4022
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
Key on, engine off.................................................................................................................................
.............................................240-310 kPa (35-45 psi) Engine running.................................................
..................................................................................................................................193-310 kPa
(28-45 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Measured/PID Values
Hot Idle Speed .....................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 600-650 RPM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER INTAKE PIPE
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air cleaner element.
2. Reach into the opening of the air cleaner assembly and depress the locking tab on the air
cleaner intake pipe to release the air cleaner intake pipe
from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4034
3. Remove the air cleaner intake tube assembly.
4. CAUTION: The air cleaner intake pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unusual engine
noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Release the retaining clips and remove the air cleaner element tray. 2. Remove the air cleaner
element from the air cleaner element tray.
3. CAUTION: The air cleaner element tray must be fully seated to the air cleaner housing. Failure
to do so will result in unusual engine
noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: The electrical connector is located on the LH frame rail under the driver side door.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Start the engine and allow it to idle until it stalls. 4. After the engine stalls, crank the engine for
approximately 5 seconds to make sure the fuel rail pressure has been released. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the OFF position.
6. When fuel system service is complete, connect the electrical connector.
7. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
8. Install the diagnostic tool. Turn the key ON with the engine OFF. Cycle the key OFF, then ON.
Select the appropriate vehicle and engine qualifier.
Clear all diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and carry out a PCM reset.
9. Start the vehicle and check the fuel system for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Eight separate ignition coils:
- are mounted directly above each spark plug.
- are controlled by the powertrain control module (PCM) for correct firing sequence.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Item ......................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Specification
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Eight separate ignition coils:
- are mounted directly above each spark plug.
- are controlled by the powertrain control module (PCM) for correct firing sequence.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4053
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4054
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4055
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4056
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4057
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4058
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4059
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4060
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4061
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4062
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 4063
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Spark Plug Gap
Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Gap
Spark Plug Gap
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.040 - 0.050 inch (1.02 - 1.27 mm)
NOTE: Spark plug gap not adjustable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Spark Plug Gap > Page 4066
Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Torque
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
................................................... 34 Nm (25.0 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4067
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark Plug ...........................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... PZT-2F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4068
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Engine Ignition - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4069
Engine Ignition - LH
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug.
2. NOTE:
- Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before removing the
spark plugs.
- If an original spark plug is used, make sure it is installed in the same cylinder from which it was
taken. New spark plugs can be used in any cylinder.
Remove the spark plugs. To install, tighten to 34 Nm (25 lb-ft).
3. Inspect the spark plugs. Install new spark plugs as necessary. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 1)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 2)
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75 percent of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit
Chart.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 4073
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test-Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of five compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test-Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75 percent of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit
Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 1)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart (Part 2)
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 4074
Compression Test-Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty. 2. If compression does not
improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly. 3. If two adjacent cylinders indicate low
compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does not increase compression, the head
gasket may
be leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75 percent of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
This engine is equipped with hydraulic valve lifters. No adjustment is required.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 4082
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 4083
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4087
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4088
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4089
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. If the hot wire electronic
sensing element must be replaced, then the entire assembly must be replaced. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
The current required to maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow.
The MAF sensor then outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air
mass. The PCM calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired
air/fuel ratio. This input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC),
shift and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology (IBT) with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4090
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4094
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4095
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4096
fuel, spark, and air flow.
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. However, one is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard
OBD/cold weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the
intake manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature
information to the PCM to control border-line spark and to help determine intercooler efficiency.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Body Control Module: Locations
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE (VSM)
View 151-17 (RH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4100
Body Control Module: Diagrams
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE (VSM)
C2113a
C2113b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4101
C2113c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
may result.
- Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload module configuration information to
the appropriate diagnostic equipment. This information needs to be downloaded into the new
module once installed.
1. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the driver seat module forward to remove it from the bracket.
2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
4. CAUTION: Once the module is installed it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the diagnostic tool into
the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) > Page 4104
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Vehicle Security Module
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE
Removal
CAUTION: The steps included in the vehicle security module removal and installation procedure
are critical to restoring the vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring systems to normal
operation. A new vehicle security module is delivered in manufacturing mode with 6 pre-set
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) related to the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). The
presence of these DTCs requires the installation procedures be followed in order to clear the DTCs
and enable normal vehicle security module operations.
1. NOTE: Prior to the removal of the vehicle security module, it is necessary to upload the module
configuration information to the diagnostic tool.
This information must be downloaded to the new vehicle security module after installation.
Disconnect the battery.
2. Remove the pin-type retainer and the RH A-pillar lower trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) > Page 4105
3. Remove the glove compartment. 4. Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors. 5. Remove the 2
screws and the vehicle security module.
Installation
1. Position the vehicle security module and install the 2 screws.
- Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
2. Connect the 3 electrical connectors. 3. Position the RH A-pillar lower trim panel and install the
pin-type retainer. 4. Install the glove compartment 5. Connect the battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for vehicle security module
operation and clears DTC B2477. The clearing
of the DTC indicates the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the vehicle security
module.
Download the vehicle security module configuration information from the diagnostic tool to the
vehicle security module.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the vehicle security
module has recognized the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. Clear the DTCs.
9. NOTE:
- DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the vehicle security module.
- This step is required to clear DTC C2780, allow the vehicle security module to exit the
manufacturing mode, and to be sure there are no other concerns with the newly programmed
vehicle security module.
Carry out the vehicle security module on-demand self-test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4109
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Signal: Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 4112
Brake Signal: Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS)/BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code is set by the PCM strategy.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1 > Page 4118
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4119
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston No.
1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing the
sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP signal to
select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4120
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4127
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4128
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4129
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the accessory drive belt. 4. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 7. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Data Link Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4135
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4136
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4137
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4138
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4139
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4140
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4141
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4142
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4143
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4144
Data Link Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4145
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4146
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4147
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4148
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4149
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4150
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4151
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4152
C251
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4156
C1368
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4157
Electronic Throttle Actuator: Description and Operation
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL (TAC)
The electronic TAC is a DC motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2 wires). The gear ratio from the
motor to the throttle plate shaft is 17:1. There are 2 designs for the TAC, parallel and in-series. The
parallel design has the motor under the bore parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing. Two springs
are used; one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger assembly that
results in a default angle when no power is applied. The force of the plunger spring is 2 times
stronger than the main spring. The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48
km/h (30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard stop angle. The closed
throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75 degree). This
hard stop setting is not adjustable and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine
airflow required at idle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position sensor (TPS), and mechanical throttle
body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph) Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The throttle position (TP) sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The
redundant throttle position signals are required for
increased monitoring reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle,
decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing
voltage). During normal operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control
strategy as the indication of throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4161
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4162
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4163
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. Therefore, the E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly
monitor selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of
the IPC and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it
takes appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4164
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4165
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 5% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 5% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key-on,
engine off.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard-stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard-stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide Open Throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of Range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard-stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard-stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H-driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4171
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4172
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4173
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4174
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4175
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4176
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4177
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4178
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4179
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4180
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4181
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4182
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4183
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4184
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4185
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4186
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4187
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4188
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175b (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4189
C175b (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4190
C175e (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4191
C175e (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4192
C175t (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4193
C175t (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The flash electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM) is contained in an
integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module (PCM). The EEPROM contains the
vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the vehicle, and is capable of being
programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate fault code P1635
or P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various
hardware or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this
procedure properly may generate fault code P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An
incorrect tire/axle ratio is one of the main causes for fault code P1639. This is described under
Making Changes to the VID Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The
VID block contains many items used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items
include the vehicle identification number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed
limit, tire size, axle ratio, the presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly
(ESOF) versus manual shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and
supported by the VID block is displayed on the diagnostic tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the diagnostic tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again
to reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the
diagnostic tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and will need programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
the use of a diagnostic tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle.
The stored data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Manual data entry must be carried out if the old module is damaged or incapable of
communicating. Remove and install a new PCM. Using a compatible diagnostic tool, select and
carry out the module/parameter programming, referring to the diagnostic tool manufacturer's
instruction manual. Make certain that all parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire
size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches),
axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF may result in codes P1635 and P1639. You may be
instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center for the information needed to manually update the
VID block with the diagnostic tool. Contact the center only if the old PCM cannot be used or the
data is corrupt. For Ford and L-M technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional
Technician Society (PTS) website for As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index.
Non-Ford technicians use the Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the
Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and L-M technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the PTS
website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle when using the worldwide
diagnostic system (WDS) or New Generation STAR (NGS).
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to PCM/Module Reprogramming on the diagnostic tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to PCM/Module Reprogramming on the diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) >
Page 4196
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Refer to Computers and Control Systems for correct worldwide diagnostic system (WDS)
hook-up procedure.
If servicing the powertrain control module (PCM), connect the diagnostic tool to the vehicle. Allow
the diagnostic tool to identify the vehicle and obtain configuration data. All programmable module information will automatically be retrieved by the WDS.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) >
Page 4197
3. Disconnect the PCM electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 4 bolts and the PCM.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. If servicing the PCM bracket, remove the 3 bolts and the PCM bracket.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4201
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > CHT Sensor
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor:
^ is mounted into the wall of the cylinder head and is not connected to any coolant passages.
^ sends the PCM a signal indicating cylinder head temperature.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 121 °C (250°F), the PCM disables half of the fuel
injectors at a time. The PCM will alternate which fuel injectors are disabled every 32 engine cycles.
The cylinders that are not being fuel injected act as air pumps to aid in engine cooling.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 166°C (330°F), the PCM disables all of the fuel
injectors until the engine temperature drops below approximately 1 54°C (31 0°F).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > CHT Sensor > Page 4204
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Cylinder Head Temperature Sensor
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the aluminum cylinder head and measures the metal temperature.
The CHT sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer
coolant temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM
initiates a fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system
concern such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result
damage to major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling
strategy, the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4205
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
NOTE: The Ford GT uses a piezoelectric sonar type fuel level sensor. The sensor is located in the
tank and the sensor signal is provided as a communications network message by the instrument
cluster to the PCM.
The FLI is either a hard wire signal input to the PCM from the fuel pump (FP) module or a
communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type FLI sensor
connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4209
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4210
Part 2
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4211
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel and vapor tubes from the fuel pump module.
3. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
4. CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4212
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4216
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube quick connect couplings from the fuel
vapor/grade vent valves. 3. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube quick connect couplings from the fuel
pump module. 4. Remove the fuel pressure sensor tube assembly. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
- Leak test the system. See: Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle. See: Emission Control
Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair
Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Description and Operation
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
NOTE: The IAC valve assembly is not adjustable and cannot be cleaned, also some IAC valves are
normally open and others are normally closed. Some IAC valves require engine vacuum to
operate.
The IAC valve assembly controls the engine idle speed and provides a dashpot function. The IAC
valve assembly meters intake air around the throttle plate through a bypass within the IAC valve
assembly and throttle body. The PCM determines the desired idle speed or bypass air and signals
the IAC valve assembly through a specified duty cycle. The IAC valve responds by positioning the
IAC valve to control the amount of bypassed air. The PCM monitors engine RPM and increases or
decreases the IAC duty cycle in order to achieve the desired RPM.
The PCM uses the IAC valve assembly to control:
- no touch start
- cold engine fast idle for rapid warm-up
- idle (corrects for engine load)
- stumble or stalling on deceleration (provides a dashpot function)
- over-temperature idle boost
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Information Bus: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4224
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4225
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4226
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4227
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4228
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4229
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4230
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4231
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4232
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4233
Information Bus: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4234
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4235
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4236
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4237
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4238
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4239
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4240
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4241
Information Bus: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
14-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4242
14-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4243
14-3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4244
14-4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4245
14-5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4246
14-6
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4247
Information Bus: Description and Operation
COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
The ABS module uses the high speed controller area network (CAN). The ABS module controls the
brake pressure to the 4 wheels to keep the vehicle under control while braking.
Restraints Control Module (RCM)
The RCM communicates on the international standards organization (ISO) 9141 communications
network. The RCM controls the deployment of the air bags based on sensor input.
Vehicle Security Module
The vehicle security module uses the medium speed CAN. The vehicle security module controls a
variety of systems: exterior lamps
- interior lamps
- lock functions
- monitors the entry doors and radio
- perimeter security
- power windows
- remote keyless entry (RKE)/keyless entry
- tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS)
- warning chimes
- windshield wipers
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
The PCM communicates on the high speed CAN. The PCM controls the engine for better fuel
economy, emissions control, failure mode detection and storage. The PCM also controls 4x4
functionality.
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
The EATC module uses the medium speed CAN. The EATC module controls automatic climate
functions that maintain the vehicle interior temperature at a constant setting.
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
The DSM uses the medium speed CAN. The DSM controls the positioning and programming of the
driver seat, pedals and both outside mirrors.
Parking Aid Module
The parking aid module uses the ISO 9141 communications network (Expedition only), or the
medium speed CAN (Navigator only). The module controls sensors in the rear bumper that detect
close objects when the transmission is in REVERSE.
Transmission Control Module (TCM)
The TCM uses the high speed CAN (Navigator only). The TCM controls transmission shifting, the
electronic pressure control, and the torque converter clutch.
Instrument Cluster
The instrument cluster uses the medium speed CAN. The instrument cluster also uses the high
speed CAN to communicate with other modules. It is an analog face cluster with a digital odometer.
The instrument cluster displays a variety of information.
Power Liftgate Module
The power liftgate module uses the medium speed CAN (Navigator only). The module controls the
motor that opens and closes the liftgate.
Air Suspension Control Module
The air suspension control module uses the medium speed CAN. The air suspension control
module controls the air compressor motor (through a solid state relay) and all system solenoids.
The module also provides power to front and rear height sensors on 4-wheel air suspension
systems, or rear height sensors on the rear-wheel suspension systems. The module controls
vehicle height adjustments by monitoring 2 height sensors, vehicle speed, a steering sensor,
acceleration input, the door ajar signal, transfer case signals and the brake switch. The module
also conducts all fail-safe and diagnostic strategies and contains self-test and communication
software for testing the vehicle and module.
Climate Controlled Seat Module
The climate controlled seat module uses the medium speed CAN. The climate controlled seat
module controls the temperature of the driver and passenger seats.
Navigation System Module
The navigation module is on the SCP communications network (Navigator only). The navigation
system module controls the global positioning system on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network
Information Bus: Testing and Inspection Module Communications Network
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
The vehicle has 4 module communications networks:
- the standard corporate protocol (SCP) communications network (Navigator with navigation
system only)
- the international standards organization (ISO) 9141 communications network
- the medium speed controller area network (CAN)
- the high speed CAN
The diagnostic tool connects to all 4 networks through the data link connector (DLC). This makes
diagnosis and testing of these systems easier by allowing one diagnostic tester to be able to
diagnose and control any module on the 4 networks from one connector. The DLC can be found
under the instrument panel between the steering column and the audio unit.
Standard Corporate Protocol (SCP) Communications Network
The SCP communications network (Navigator with navigation system only) remains operational
even with the severing of one of the SCP communications network circuits. Communications also
continue if one of the SCP communications network circuits are shorted to ground or voltage, or if
some but not all termination resistors are lost. The SCP communications network allows
inter-module communication.
International Standards Organization (ISO) 9141 Communications Network
The ISO 9141 communications network is a single circuit communications network, circuit 70
(LB/WH). The restraint control module (RCM) and the parking aid module (Expedition only) are
located on the ISO 9141 communication network. The ISO 9141 communications network does not
permit intermodule communication. When the diagnostic tool communicates to modules on the ISO
9141 communications network, the diagnostic tool must request all information, or initiate module
commands. The ISO 9141 communications network does not function if the circuit is shorted to
ground or battery voltage. Also, if one of the modules on the ISO 9141 communications network
loses power or shorts internally, communications to that module fail.
Medium Speed Controller Area Network (CAN)
The medium speed CAN has an unshielded twisted pair cable, data plus circuit 2180 (WH/BK) and
data minus, circuit 2181 (BK/YE). The medium speed CAN is used for the air suspension control
module, the climate controlled seat module, the driver seat module (DSM), the electronic automatic
temperature control (EATC) module, the instrument cluster, the parking aid module (Navigator
only), power liftgate module, and the vehicle security module communications. The medium speed
CAN is not designed to operate under single point fault conditions. If either circuit is shorted to
voltage or CAN data plus is shorted to ground, module-to-module and module-to-tester
communication is not possible. If CAN data minus is shorted to ground or an open exists on either
bus line, module-to-module and module-to-tester communication is marginal at best. The CAN bus
may remain operational when one of the two termination resistors are not present.
High Speed Controller Area Network (CAN)
The high speed CAN has an unshielded twisted pair cable, data plus circuit 1814 (WH/LB) and
data minus circuit 1815 (PK/LB). The high speed CAN is a high speed communications network
used for the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, the instrument cluster, the transmission control
module (TCM) and the powertrain control module (PCM) communication. The high speed CAN is
not designed to operate under single point fault conditions. If either circuit is shorted to voltage or
CAN data plus is shorted to ground, module-to-module and module-to-tester communication is not
possible. If CAN data minus is shorted to ground or an open exists on either bus line,
module-to-module and module-to-tester communication is marginal at best. The CAN bus may
remain operational when one of the two termination resistors are not present.
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical
damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Central junction box (CJB) fuse 41 (20A)
- Wiring harness
- Connections
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step. 4. If the cause is not visually evident, connect the diagnostic
tool to the data link connector (DLC) and select the vehicle to be tested from the
diagnostic tool menu. If the diagnostic tool does not communicate with the vehicle: check that the program card is correctly installed.
- check the connections to the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4250
- check the ignition switch position.
5. If the diagnostic tool still does not communicate with the vehicle, refer to the diagnostic tool
operating manual. 6. GO to Pinpoint Test PC. See: Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Test PC (Precheck)
U0073-U1900
Pinpoint Test PC (Precheck)
PINPOINT TEST PC: DATA LINK DIAGNOSTICS NETWORK TEST
PC1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4251
Test A: The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST A: THE ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS) MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND
TO THE DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
A1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4252
A2-A3
Normal Operation
The ABS module communicates with the diagnostic tool through the high speed controller area
network (CAN), circuits 1814 (WH/LB) and 1815 (PK/LB). Check the high speed CAN circuits 1814
(WH/LB) and 1815 (PK/LB) between the ABS module C135 and the data link connector (DLC)
C251. The total resistance values must not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance is more than 5
ohms there is an open in one of the CAN circuits, damage to the DLC C251, damage to the ABS
module C135, or a problem in an in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- high speed CAN circuit 1814 (WH/LB) open
- high speed CAN circuit 1815 (PK/LB) open
- ABS module
- ABS module C135
Test B: The Restraint Control Module (RCM) Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST B: THE RESTRAINT CONTROL MODULE (RCM) DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4253
B1-B2
B3
Normal Operation
The restraint control module (RCM) communicates with the diagnostic tool through the international
standards organization (ISO) 9141 communications network, circuit 70 (LB/WH). Check circuit 70
(LB/WH) between the RCM C310a and the data link connector (DLC) C251. The total resistance
value must not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an open in the
ISO 9141 communications network circuit, damage to the DLC C251, damage to the RCM C310a,
or a problem in an in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- ISO 9141 circuit 70 (LB/WH) open
- RCM
- RCM C310a
Test C: The Vehicle Security Module Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST C: THE VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE
DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4254
C1
C2-C3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4255
Normal Operation
The vehicle security module communicates with the diagnostic tool through the medium speed
controller area network (CAN), circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE). Check circuits 2180
(WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE) between the vehicle security module C2113c and the data link
connector (DLC) C251. The total resistance values must not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance
is more than 5 ohms there is an open in one of the medium speed CAN circuits, damage to the
DLC C251, damage to the vehicle security module C2113c, or a problem in an in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- medium speed CAN circuit 2180 (WH/BK) open
- medium speed CAN circuit 2181 (BK/YE) open
- vehicle security module
- vehicle security module C2113c
Test D: The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST D: THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
D1-D2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4256
D2-D3
Normal Operation
The PCM communicates with the diagnostic tool through the high speed controller area network
(CAN), circuits 1814 (WH/LB) and 1815 (PK/LB). Check the high speed CAN circuits 1814 (WH/LB)
and 1815 (PK/LB) between the PCM C175b and the data link connector (DLC) C251. The total
resistance values must not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an
open in one of the CAN circuits, damage to the DLC C251, damage to the PCM C175b, or a
problem in an in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- high speed CAN circuit 1814 (WH/LB) open
- high speed CAN circuit 1815 (PK/LB) open
- PCM
- PCM C175b
Test E: The Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module Does Not Respond To The
Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST E: THE ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL (EATC)
MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4257
E1-E3
Normal Operation
The EATC module communicates with the diagnostic tool through the medium speed controller
area network (CAN), circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE). Check circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and
2181 (BK/YE) between the EATC C228b and the data link connector (DLC) C251. The total
resistance values must not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an
open in one of the medium speed CAN circuits, damage to the DLC C251, damage to the EATC
C228b, or a problem in an in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- medium speed CAN circuit 2180 (WH/BK) open
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4258
- medium speed CAN circuit 2181 (BK/YE) open
- EATC module
- EATC module C228b
Test F: The Driver Seat Module (DSM) Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST F: THE DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM) DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE
DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
F1-F2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4259
F2-F3
Normal Operation
The DSM communicates with the diagnostic tool through the medium speed controller area
network (CAN), circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE). Check circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and 2181
(BK/YE) between the DSM C341c and the data link connector (DLC) C251. The total resistance
values must not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an open in
one of the medium speed CAN circuits, damage to the DLC C251, damage to the DSM C341c, or a
problem in an in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- medium speed CAN circuit 2180 (WH/BK) open
- medium speed CAN circuit 2181 (BK/YE) open
- DSM
- DSM C341c
Test G: The Parking Aid Module Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST G: THE PARKING AID MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE DIAGNOSTIC
TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4260
G1-G3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4261
G3-G4
Normal Operation
The Navigator parking aid module communicates with the diagnostic tool through the medium
speed controller area network (CAN), circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE). The Expedition
parking aid module communicates with the diagnostic tool through the international standards
organization (ISO) 9141 communications network, circuit 70 (LB/WH). Check the communication
circuits between the parking aid module C4226 (Expedition) or C4014b (Navigator) and the data
link connector (DLC) C251. The total resistance values must not be more than 5 ohms. If the
resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an open in one of the communication network circuits,
damage to the DLC C251, damage to the parking aid module connectors, or a problem in an in-line
connector.
Possible Causes
- ISO 9141 circuit 70 (LB/WH) open (Expedition only)
- medium speed CAN circuit 2180 (WH/BK) open (Navigator only)
- medium speed CAN circuit 2181 (BK/YE) open (Navigator only)
- parking aid module
- parking aid module C4226 (Expedition) or C4014b (Navigator)
Test H: The Transmission Control Module (TCM) Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST H: THE TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE (TCM) DOES NOT RESPOND
TO THE DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4262
H1-H3
Normal Operation
The TCM communicates with the diagnostic tool through the high speed controller area network
(CAN), circuits 1814 (WH/LB) and 1815 (PK/LB). Check the high speed CAN circuits 1814 (WH/LB)
and 1815 (PK/LB) between the TCM C1473 and the data link connector (DLC) C251. The total
resistance values must not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an
open in one of the CAN circuits, damage to the DLC C251, damage to the TCM C1473, or a
problem in an in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- high speed CAN circuit 1814 (WH/LB) open
- high speed CAN circuit 1815 (PK/LB) open
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4263
- TCM
- TCM C1473
Test I: The Instrument Cluster Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST I: THE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE DIAGNOSTIC
TOOL
I1-I2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4264
I2-I3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4265
I4
Normal Operation
The instrument cluster communicates with the diagnostic tool through both the high speed
controller area network (CAN), circuits 1814 (WH/LB) and 1815 (PK/LB) and the medium speed
CAN, circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE). Check both sets of CAN circuits between the
instrument cluster C220b and the data link connector (DLC) C251. The total resistance values must
not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an open in one of the CAN
circuits, damage to the DLC C251, damage to the instrument cluster C220b, or a problem in an
in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- high speed CAN circuit 1814 (WH/LB) open
- high speed CAN circuit 1815 (PK/LB) open
- medium speed CAN circuit 2180 (WH/BK) open
- medium speed CAN circuit 2181 (BK/YE) open
- instrument cluster
- instrument cluster C220b
Test J: The Power Liftgate Module Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST J: THE POWER LIFTGATE MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE
DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
J1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4266
J2-J3
Normal Operation
The power liftgate module communicates with the diagnostic tool through the medium speed
controller area network (CAN), circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE). Check circuits 2180
(WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE) between the power liftgate module C4174d and the data link connector
(DLC) C251. The total resistance values must not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance is more
than 5 ohms there is an open in one of the medium speed CAN circuits, damage to the DLC C251,
damage to the power liftgate module C4174d, or a problem in an in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- medium speed CAN circuit 2180 (WH/BK) open
- medium speed CAN circuit 2181 (BK/YE) open
- power liftgate module
- power liftgate module C4174d
Test K: The Air Suspension Control Module Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST K: THE AIR SUSPENSION CONTROL MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4267
K1-K2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4268
K2-K3
Normal Operation
The air suspension control module communicates with the diagnostic tool through the medium
speed controller area network (CAN), circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE). Check circuits
2180 (WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE) between the air suspension control module C2324b (Expedition)
or C2131b (Navigator) and the data link connector (DLC) C251. The total resistance values must
not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an open in one of the
medium speed CAN circuits, damage to the DLC C251, damage to the air suspension control
module C2324b (Expedition) or C2131b (Navigator), or a problem in an in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- medium speed CAN circuit 2180 (WH/BK) open
- medium speed CAN circuit 2181 (BK/YE) open
- air suspension control module
- air suspension control module C2324b (Expedition only)
- air suspension control module C2131b (Navigator only)
Test L: The Climate Controlled Seat Module Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST L: THE CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4269
L1-L2
L3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4270
Normal Operation
The climate controlled seat module communicates with the diagnostic tool through the medium
speed controller area network (CAN), circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE). Check circuits
2180 (WH/BK) and 2181 (BK/YE) between the climate controlled seat module C3265b and the data
link connector (DLC) C251. The total resistance values must not be more than 5 ohms. If the
resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an open in one of the medium speed CAN circuits, damage
to the DLC C251, damage to the climate controlled seat module C3265b, or a problem in an in-line
connector.
Possible Causes
- medium speed CAN circuit 2180 (WH/BK) open
- medium speed CAN circuit 2181 (BK/YE) open
- climate controlled seat module
- climate controlled seat module C3265b
Test M: The Navigation System Module Does Not Respond To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST M: THE NAVIGATION SYSTEM MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE
DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
M1-M2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4271
M3-M4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4272
M4-M5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4273
M6
Normal Operation
The navigation system module communicates with the diagnostic tool through the standard
corporate protocol (SCP) communication network, circuits 914 (TN/OG) and 915 (PK/LB). Check
circuits 914 (TN/OG) and 915 (PK/LB) between the navigation system module C2279a and the
data link connector (DLC) C251. The total resistance values must not be more than 5 ohms. If the
resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an open in one of the SCP communications circuits,
damage to the DLC C251, damage to the navigation system module C2279a, or a problem in an
in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- SCP communication network, circuits 914 (TN/OG) open
- SCP communication network, circuits 915 (PK/LB) open
- navigation system module
- navigation system module C2279a
Test N: No International Standards Organization (ISO) 9141 Communications Network
Communication
PINPOINT TEST N: NO INTERNATIONAL STANDARDS ORGANIZATION (ISO) 9141
COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK COMMUNICATION
N1-N2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4274
N2-N4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4275
N4-N7
Normal Operation
The restraint control module (RCM), and the parking aid module (if equipped) communicate with
the diagnostic tool through the ISO 9141 communications network, circuit 70 (LB/WH). Check
circuit 70 (LB/WH) between the RCM C310a, parking aid module C4226 and the data link
connector (DLC) C251. The total resistance value must not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance
is more than 5 ohms there is an open in the ISO 9141 communications network circuit, damage to
the DLC C251, damage to the RCM or parking aid module connector, or a problem in an in-line
connector.
Possible Causes
- ISO 9141 communications network circuit 70 (LB/WH) open, short to ground, or short to voltage
- DLC C251
- RCM
- RCM C310a
- parking aid module
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4276
- parking aid module C4226
Test O: No High Speed Controller Area Network (CAN) Communication
PINPOINT TEST O: NO HIGH SPEED CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (CAN)
COMMUNICATION
O1-O3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4277
O3-O4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4278
O4-O5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4279
O6-O7
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4280
O8-O11
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4281
O12-O14
O15
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4282
Normal Operation
The high speed CAN has an unshielded twisted pair cable, circuits 1814 (WH/LB) and 1815
(PK/LB). The powertrain control module (PCM), instrument cluster, the anti-lock brake system
(ABS) module, and the transmission control module (TCM) are all on the high speed CAN. The
total resistance values from the data link connector (DLC) C251 must not be more than 5 ohms. If
the resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an open in one of the CAN circuits, damage to the DLC
C251, damage to one of the communications network module connectors, or damage to an in-line
connector.
Possible Causes
- high speed CAN circuit 1814 (WH/LB) open, short to ground, or short to voltage
- high speed CAN circuit 1815 (PK/LB) open, short to ground, or short to voltage
- DLC C251
- PCM
- PCM C175b
- instrument cluster
- instrument cluster C220b
- ABS module
- ABS module C135
- TCM
- TCM C1473 (if equipped)
Test P: No Medium Speed Controller Area Network (CAN) Communication
PINPOINT TEST P: NO MEDIUM SPEED CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (CAN)
COMMUNICATION
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4283
P1-P3
P3-P4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4284
P5-P6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4285
P6-P7
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4286
P8-P9
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4287
P9-P10
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4288
P10-P11
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4289
P12-P14
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4290
P15-P19
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4291
P20-P23
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4292
P24-P27
Normal Operation
The medium speed CAN has an unshielded twisted pair cable, circuits 2180 (WH/BK) and 2181
(BK/YE). The modules listed below all communicate with the diagnostic tool using the medium
speed CAN. The total resistance values from the data link connector (DLC) C251 to an individual
module must not be more than 5 ohms. If the resistance is more than 5 ohms there is an open in
one of the medium speed CAN circuits, damage to the DLC C251, damage to one of the
communications network module connectors, or damage to an in-line connector.
Possible Causes
- medium speed CAN circuit 2180 (WH/BK) open, short to ground, or short to voltage
- medium speed CAN circuit 2181 (BK/YE) open, short to ground, or short to voltage
- DLC C251
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4293
- air suspension control module
- air suspension control module C2131b (Navigator) or C2324b (Expedition) (if equipped)
- climate controlled seat module
- climate controlled seat module C3265b
- driver seat module (DSM)
- DSM C341c
- electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module
- EATC module C228b
- instrument cluster
- instrument cluster C220b
- parking aid module (if equipped)
- parking aid module C4226 (Expedition) or C4014b (Navigator)
- power liftgate module (if equipped)
- power liftgate module C4174d
- vehicle security module
- vehicle security module C2113c
Test Q: No Module/Network Communication - No Power To The Diagnostic Tool
PINPOINT TEST Q: NO MODULE/NETWORK COMMUNICATION - NO POWER TO THE
DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
Q1-Q3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4294
Q4
Normal Operation
The diagnostic tool connects to the data link connector (DLC) C251 to communicate with the high
speed controller area network (CAN), medium speed CAN, international standards organization
(ISO) 9141 communications network and the standard corporate protocol (SCP) communication
network. If communication can not be established, the diagnostic tool and the DLC C251 must be
checked for damage. If the diagnostic tool and the DLC C251 are OK, ground circuits 570
(BK/WH), 875 (BK/LB) and voltage circuit 40 (LB/WH) must be checked for an open condition.
Possible Causes
- DLC C251
- fuse
- diagnostic tool
- circuit 40 (LB/WH) open
- circuit 570 (BK) open
- circuit 875 (BK/LB) open
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4295
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4296
Symptom Chart (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4297
Information Bus: Testing and Inspection Module Configuration
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
Definition of Terms
Calibration update: Some modules are designed to be flashed or reflashed with complete new
software packages. This process of reflashing the module is a calibration update.
Programmable parameters: These are options contained within the existing software. These
include items such as tire size, customer preference items and anti-theft options. The current
settings are downloaded from an existing module then uploaded to a new module. They can also
be configured using the diagnostic tool. Programming the parameters is different from updating
calibrations as no software is changed, only the options already contained in the software.
Some modules must be programmed as part of the repair procedure. If this procedure is not
followed the module does not function correctly and may set a number of diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs), including B2477 or P1639, which indicate that some necessary data has not been
programmed into the module.
Modules that need programming should not be exchanged between vehicles. In most cases the
parameter values or settings are unique to that vehicle, and if not set correctly cause concerns or
faults.
The WDS automatically attempts to retrieve the module configuration information from all modules.
If the module does not contain correct information, the diagnostic tool either requests As Built data
or displays a list of items needed to manually configure the module. The diagnostic tool programs
the module based on the data entered.
For additional WDS/diagnostic tool programming procedures, refer to Programmable Module
Installation.
There are 3 different methods that are used for module programming: programmable module installation (PMI)
- calibration update
- programmable parameters
Some modules do not support all 3 methods.
PMI The PMI method is used when a new programmable module is installed on the vehicle. It is no
longer necessary to command the diagnostic tool to gather module option content from the old
module. The diagnostic tool automatically obtains any available module option content information
from the old module during the vehicle ID routine that runs when the diagnostic tool is initially
connected to the vehicle. It is important that you connect the WDS to the vehicle and allow it to
identify the vehicle and obtain configuration data prior to removing any modules.
Calibration Update Calibration update is used to install a new calibration and strategy into a
module.
Programmable Parameters If a module that has been modified using programmable parameters
needs to be installed, the PMI procedure maintains the parameters in their altered state if the WDS
is able to communicate with the old module during vehicle ID. Otherwise, it may be necessary to
use programmable parameters to return the parameters to the altered state.
Vehicle Identification (VID) Block
Some powertrain control modules (PCMs) contain a memory area called a VID block.
The PCM VID block may contain the factory settings for the configurable modules unless the PCM
is flashed with a new calibration, in which case some PCM parameters may be modified.
As-Built Data Center
The As-Built Data Center maintains a record of the vehicle configuration in a database. The vehicle
identification number (VIN) is required to obtain this information. The As-Built Data Center records
the applicable module configurations stored in each module before the vehicle leaves the factory.
The As-Built Data Center always reflects the original build of the vehicle as it left the factory. Only
contact the As-Built Data Center when directed to do so by the diagnostic tool.
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Module Communications Network > Page 4298
1. Visually inspect for obvious signs of electrical damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Wiring harness
- Connectors
Configurable Modules
The vehicle contains the following modules that are configurable: anti-lock brake system (ABS) module
- driver seat module (DSM)
- dual automatic temperature control (DATC) module
- instrument cluster
- navigation system module
- powertrain control module (PCM)
- power liftgate module
- temperature-controlled seat module
- vehicle dynamics module
- vehicle security module
Programmable Parameters Index
Programmable Parameters Index
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4299
Information Bus: Service and Repair
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Worldwide Diagnostic System (WDS)
Special Tool(s)
Using the Vehicle Communication Module (VCM) When the Original Body Chassis Electrical
Module is Not Available
1. Install the new module. 2. Using the VCM and the latest version of the service function card,
SELECT: Programmable Module Installation. 3. Select the module being installed. 4. Follow the
on-screen instructions. 5. SELECT: Retrieve Module Configuration - Old ECU and press trigger. 6.
Follow the on-screen instructions. 7. The VCM attempts to retrieve the module data.
- If the module data is available, go to Step A.
- If the VCM displays: Call As-Built Data Center, go to Step B.
Step A 1. SELECT: Restore Configuration - New ECU. Press trigger. 2. The VCM completes
loading the retrieved data and displays Module Download Successful. 3. Test the module for
correct operation.
Step B 1. Press the trigger. 2. If the VCM asks for vehicle data, enter the vehicle data, then press
store. 3. The VCM asks for module data line 1. Enter the data and press store. 4. The VCM then
asks if there is an additional line of data available for that address. Select YES or NO depending on
the information in the As Built
Data Sheet.
5. Repeat Steps 3 and 4 until the answer is NO for Step 4. 6. The VCM should show a screen
stating that the module data was stored. Press the trigger. 7. Follow the on-screen instructions. 8.
SELECT: Restore Configuration - New ECU. Press the trigger. 9. The VCM completes loading the
retrieved data and displays Module Download Successful.
10. Test the module for correct operation.
Using the Vehicle Communication Module (VCM) When the Original Body Chassis Electrical
Module is Available
1. With the original module still installed, using the VCM and the latest version of the service
function card, SELECT: Programmable Module
Installation.
2. Select the module being installed and press the trigger. 3. Follow the on-screen instructions. 4.
SELECT: Retrieve Module Configuration - Old ECU. Press the trigger. 5. Follow the on-screen
instructions. 6. INSTALL new module, SELECT: Restore Configuration - New ECU. Press the
trigger. 7. The VCM completes loading the retrieved data and displays Module Download
Successful. 8. Test the module for correct operation.
Using the Worldwide Diagnostic System (WDS) When the Original Body Chassis Electrical Module
is Not Available
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the WDS and ID the vehicle as normal. 3. From the Toolbox
icon, select and highlight Module Programming. Then highlight the module that was installed and
press the check mark. 4. Select and highlight Programmable Module Installation. Then highlight the
module that was installed and press the check mark. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the
ignition key to the RUN position and press the check mark. 6. The WDS retrieves the module data,
automatically downloads the data into the new module, and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 7. If the data is not available in the module, the WDS displays a screen stating to
contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data from
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4300
WWW.FMCDEALER.COM at this time and press the check mark.
8. Enter the module data (the module address and line are displayed to the left of the 3 entry
boxes) and press the check mark. 9. The WDS downloads the data into the new module and
displays Operation Successful - Programming Complete.
10. Test the module for correct operation.
Using the Worldwide Diagnostic System (WDS) When the Original Body Chassis Electrical Module
is Available
1. Connect the WDS and ID the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select and highlight
Module Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select and highlight Programmable Module
Installation. 4. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and
press the check mark. 5. Install the new module and press the check mark. 6. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 7. The module
configuration is complete. 8. Test the module for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4301
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 4307
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4308
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4309
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4313
C2160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4314
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4315
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (MIL)
MIL (applications With A Dedicated Hard Wire MIL Circuit)
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, Or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately 4 seconds.
- For applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit, the PCM illuminates the MIL until a profile
ignition pickup (PIP) signal is detected. The Ranger uses a hard wire circuit.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if: an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- no PIP signal is detected (applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit). The PIP signal is
generated in the PCM using the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor. For these applications, the MIL
can be helpful in diagnosing a no start.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the Hardware Limited Operation Strategy (HLOS).
- the MIL circuit is shorted to ground (applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if: an indicator or instrument cluster concern is present.
- the MIL circuit is open (applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit).
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the diagnostic tool must be sent, or 3
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE (EOP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM
> Component Information > Locations > Page 4325
C104
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM
> Component Information > Locations > Page 4326
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM
> Component Information > Locations > Page 4327
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Service and Repair
OIL TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Drain the engine oil. 4. Disconnect the engine oil temperature (EOT) sensor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the EOT sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
- Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4332
Oxygen Sensor: Harness Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4333
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4334
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4335
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission Without Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4336
View 151-9 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission With Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4337
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4338
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4339
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4340
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission Without Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4341
View 151-9 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission With Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
C141
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 4344
C142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 4345
C171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 4346
C172
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4347
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 4350
3. Using the special tool, remove the HO2S.
- To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 4351
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 4352
3. Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor.
- To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 4357
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust
Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR
DPFE Sensor
The DPFE sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer that monitors the differential
pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly. The differential pressure
feedback sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as the downstream pressure hose
(REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI and REF hose connections are
marked on the DPFE sensor housing for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger
diameter hose). The DPFE sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the
metering orifice and supplies it to the powertrain control module (PCM) as EGR flow rate feedback.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust
Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor > Page 4362
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor - Tube Mounted
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR - TUBE MOUNTED
DPFE Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted DPFE sensor is identical in operation as the larger plastic DPFE sensors and
uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Body Control Module: Locations
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE (VSM)
View 151-17 (RH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4367
Body Control Module: Diagrams
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE (VSM)
C2113a
C2113b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4368
C2113c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
may result.
- Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload module configuration information to
the appropriate diagnostic equipment. This information needs to be downloaded into the new
module once installed.
1. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the driver seat module forward to remove it from the bracket.
2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
4. CAUTION: Once the module is installed it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the diagnostic tool into
the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) >
Page 4371
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Vehicle Security Module
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE
Removal
CAUTION: The steps included in the vehicle security module removal and installation procedure
are critical to restoring the vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring systems to normal
operation. A new vehicle security module is delivered in manufacturing mode with 6 pre-set
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) related to the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). The
presence of these DTCs requires the installation procedures be followed in order to clear the DTCs
and enable normal vehicle security module operations.
1. NOTE: Prior to the removal of the vehicle security module, it is necessary to upload the module
configuration information to the diagnostic tool.
This information must be downloaded to the new vehicle security module after installation.
Disconnect the battery.
2. Remove the pin-type retainer and the RH A-pillar lower trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) >
Page 4372
3. Remove the glove compartment. 4. Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors. 5. Remove the 2
screws and the vehicle security module.
Installation
1. Position the vehicle security module and install the 2 screws.
- Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
2. Connect the 3 electrical connectors. 3. Position the RH A-pillar lower trim panel and install the
pin-type retainer. 4. Install the glove compartment 5. Connect the battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for vehicle security module
operation and clears DTC B2477. The clearing
of the DTC indicates the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the vehicle security
module.
Download the vehicle security module configuration information from the diagnostic tool to the
vehicle security module.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the vehicle security
module has recognized the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. Clear the DTCs.
9. NOTE:
- DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the vehicle security module.
- This step is required to clear DTC C2780, allow the vehicle security module to exit the
manufacturing mode, and to be sure there are no other concerns with the newly programmed
vehicle security module.
Carry out the vehicle security module on-demand self-test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position sensor (TPS), and mechanical throttle
body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph) Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The throttle position (TP) sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The
redundant throttle position signals are required for
increased monitoring reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle,
decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing
voltage). During normal operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control
strategy as the indication of throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
4376
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
4377
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
4378
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. Therefore, the E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly
monitor selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of
the IPC and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it
takes appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
4379
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
4380
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 5% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 5% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key-on,
engine off.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard-stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard-stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide Open Throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of Range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard-stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard-stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H-driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4386
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4387
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4388
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4389
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4390
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4391
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4392
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4393
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4394
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4395
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4396
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4397
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4398
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4399
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4400
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4401
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4402
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4403
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175b (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4404
C175b (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4405
C175e (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4406
C175e (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4407
C175t (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4408
C175t (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flash Electrically Erasable
Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The flash electrically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM) is contained in an
integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module (PCM). The EEPROM contains the
vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the vehicle, and is capable of being
programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate fault code P1635
or P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various
hardware or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this
procedure properly may generate fault code P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An
incorrect tire/axle ratio is one of the main causes for fault code P1639. This is described under
Making Changes to the VID Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The
VID block contains many items used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items
include the vehicle identification number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed
limit, tire size, axle ratio, the presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly
(ESOF) versus manual shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and
supported by the VID block is displayed on the diagnostic tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the diagnostic tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again
to reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the
diagnostic tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and will need programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
the use of a diagnostic tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle.
The stored data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Manual data entry must be carried out if the old module is damaged or incapable of
communicating. Remove and install a new PCM. Using a compatible diagnostic tool, select and
carry out the module/parameter programming, referring to the diagnostic tool manufacturer's
instruction manual. Make certain that all parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire
size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches),
axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF may result in codes P1635 and P1639. You may be
instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center for the information needed to manually update the
VID block with the diagnostic tool. Contact the center only if the old PCM cannot be used or the
data is corrupt. For Ford and L-M technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional
Technician Society (PTS) website for As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index.
Non-Ford technicians use the Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the
Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and L-M technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the PTS
website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle when using the worldwide
diagnostic system (WDS) or New Generation STAR (NGS).
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to PCM/Module Reprogramming on the diagnostic tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to PCM/Module Reprogramming on the diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flash Electrically Erasable
Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) > Page 4411
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Refer to Computers and Control Systems for correct worldwide diagnostic system (WDS)
hook-up procedure.
If servicing the powertrain control module (PCM), connect the diagnostic tool to the vehicle. Allow
the diagnostic tool to identify the vehicle and obtain configuration data. All programmable module information will automatically be retrieved by the WDS.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flash Electrically Erasable
Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) > Page 4412
3. Disconnect the PCM electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 4 bolts and the PCM.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. If servicing the PCM bracket, remove the 3 bolts and the PCM bracket.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4416
C2160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4417
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4418
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4423
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4424
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4428
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4429
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4430
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. If the hot wire electronic
sensing element must be replaced, then the entire assembly must be replaced. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
The current required to maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow.
The MAF sensor then outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air
mass. The PCM calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired
air/fuel ratio. This input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC),
shift and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology (IBT) with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4431
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position
Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position
Sensor 1 > Page 4437
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4438
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston No.
1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing the
sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP signal to
select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4439
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4446
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4447
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4448
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the accessory drive belt. 4. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 7. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4452
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
CHT Sensor
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor:
^ is mounted into the wall of the cylinder head and is not connected to any coolant passages.
^ sends the PCM a signal indicating cylinder head temperature.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 121 °C (250°F), the PCM disables half of the fuel
injectors at a time. The PCM will alternate which fuel injectors are disabled every 32 engine cycles.
The cylinders that are not being fuel injected act as air pumps to aid in engine cooling.
^ if the temperature exceeds approximately 166°C (330°F), the PCM disables all of the fuel
injectors until the engine temperature drops below approximately 1 54°C (31 0°F).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
CHT Sensor > Page 4455
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Cylinder Head Temperature Sensor
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the aluminum cylinder head and measures the metal temperature.
The CHT sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer
coolant temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM
initiates a fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system
concern such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result
damage to major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling
strategy, the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 4456
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
NOTE: The Ford GT uses a piezoelectric sonar type fuel level sensor. The sensor is located in the
tank and the sensor signal is provided as a communications network message by the instrument
cluster to the PCM.
The FLI is either a hard wire signal input to the PCM from the fuel pump (FP) module or a
communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type FLI sensor
connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4460
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4461
Part 2
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4462
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel and vapor tubes from the fuel pump module.
3. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
4. CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4463
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 4467
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube quick connect couplings from the fuel
vapor/grade vent valves. 3. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube quick connect couplings from the fuel
pump module. 4. Remove the fuel pressure sensor tube assembly. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
- Leak test the system. See: Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle. See: Emission Control
Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair
Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4471
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4472
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4473
fuel, spark, and air flow.
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. However, one is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard
OBD/cold weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the
intake manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature
information to the PCM to control border-line spark and to help determine intercooler efficiency.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 4479
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4480
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4481
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE (EOP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations > Page 4488
C104
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations > Page 4489
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Locations > Page 4490
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Service and Repair
OIL TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Drain the engine oil. 4. Disconnect the engine oil temperature (EOT) sensor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the EOT sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 21 Nm (15 lb-ft).
- Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4495
Oxygen Sensor: Harness Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4496
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4497
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4498
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission Without Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4499
View 151-9 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission With Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4500
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4501
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4502
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4503
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission Without Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4504
View 151-9 (Transmission - 6HP26 Automatic Transmission With Four-Wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22
C141
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 4507
C142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 4508
C171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 4509
C172
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4510
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 4513
3. Using the special tool, remove the HO2S.
- To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 4514
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 4515
3. Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor.
- To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 4520
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR
DPFE Sensor
The DPFE sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer that monitors the differential
pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly. The differential pressure
feedback sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as the downstream pressure hose
(REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI and REF hose connections are
marked on the DPFE sensor housing for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger
diameter hose). The DPFE sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the
metering orifice and supplies it to the powertrain control module (PCM) as EGR flow rate feedback.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor > Page 4525
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor - Tube Mounted
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR - TUBE MOUNTED
DPFE Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted DPFE sensor is identical in operation as the larger plastic DPFE sensors and
uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4529
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 4532
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases corrosion resistance on terminals
and increases connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body. As the TP
sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM from the
TP. Those conditions are closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration), part throttle (includes cruise
or moderate acceleration), wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on
crank), and throttle angle rate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
4533
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and the air cleaner
assembly. 3. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the air cleaner and air cleaner inlet pipe. 4.
Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
4537
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4540
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4541
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4542
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4543
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4544
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4545
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4546
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4547
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4548
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4549
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4550
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4551
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4552
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4553
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4554
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4555
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4556
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4557
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
4558
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
4R70E/4R75E Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Adjustment
Special Tools
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual lever shift control cable.
3. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
4559
4. Loosen the digital transmission range (TR) sensor bolts.
5. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
6. CAUTION: Tightening one bolt before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor and tighten the bolts in an alternating sequence.
^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Install the manual control lever.
^ Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual lever shaft outer nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
4560
8. With the manual lever in overdrive connect the shift lever control cable. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
4561
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tools
Removal
NOTE: Manual shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
4562
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual control lever shift control cable.
3. Disconnect the digital TR electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
5. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the digital TR sensor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
4563
1. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
2. Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
3. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
4564
5. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
6. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information generated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 4569
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or HALL-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a
frequency that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low
velocity, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the
sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated
by the VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4573
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 4576
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases corrosion resistance on terminals
and increases connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body. As the TP
sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM from the
TP. Those conditions are closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration), part throttle (includes cruise
or moderate acceleration), wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on
crank), and throttle angle rate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4577
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and the air cleaner
assembly. 3. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the air cleaner and air cleaner inlet pipe. 4.
Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4581
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4584
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4585
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4586
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4587
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4588
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4589
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4590
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4591
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4592
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4593
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4594
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4595
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4596
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4597
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4598
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4599
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4600
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4601
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4602
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
4R70E/4R75E Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Adjustment
Special Tools
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual lever shift control cable.
3. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4603
4. Loosen the digital transmission range (TR) sensor bolts.
5. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
6. CAUTION: Tightening one bolt before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor and tighten the bolts in an alternating sequence.
^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Install the manual control lever.
^ Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual lever shaft outer nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4604
8. With the manual lever in overdrive connect the shift lever control cable. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4605
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tools
Removal
NOTE: Manual shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4606
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual control lever shift control cable.
3. Disconnect the digital TR electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
5. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the digital TR sensor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4607
1. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
2. Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
3. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4608
5. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
6. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page 4613
C1452
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4614
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS Systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
Variable Camshaft Timing System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4615
achieved. A difference between the desired and actual camshaft position represents a position
error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a
default position if a concern is detected. A related DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL SOLENOID
LH Shown, RH Similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the variable camshaft timing (VCT) oil
control solenoid electrical connector. 3. Remove the VCT oil control solenoid grommet. 4. Remove
the bolt and the VCT oil control solenoid. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information generated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 4623
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or HALL-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a
frequency that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low
velocity, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the
sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated
by the VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Diverter Solenoid >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Diverter Solenoid: Description and Operation
SECONDARY AIR INJECTION (AIR) BYPASS SOLENOID
Secondary AIR Bypass Solenoid
The secondary AIR bypass solenoid is used by the PCM to control vacuum to the secondary air
injection diverter (AIR diverter) valve. The secondary AIR bypass solenoid is a normally closed
solenoid. The secondary AIR bypass solenoid also has a filtered vent feature to permit vacuum
release.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Diverter Valve >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Diverter Valve: Description and Operation
SECONDARY AIR DIVERTER VALVE
Secondary AIR Diverter Valve
The secondary AIR diverter valve is used with the secondary AIR pump to provide on/off control of
air to the exhaust manifold and catalytic converter. When the secondary AIR pump is on and
vacuum is supplied to the AIR diverter valve, air passes the integral check valve disk. When the
secondary AIR pump is off, and vacuum is removed from the AIR diverter valve, the integral check
valve disk is held on the seat and stops air from being drawn into the exhaust system and prevents
the back flow of the exhaust into the secondary AIR system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Injection Pump: Description and Operation
SECONDARY AIR PUMP
Secondary Air Pump
The secondary AIR pump provides pressurized air to the secondary AIR system. The secondary
AIR pump functions independently of RPM and is controlled by the PCM. The secondary AIR pump
is only used for short periods of time. Delivery of air is dependent on the amount of system
backpressure and system voltage. The secondary AIR pump draws dry filtered air from the Intake
Air System down stream of the MAF/IAT sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
CATALYST AND EXHAUST SYSTEMS
Overview
V-Engines
In-Line Engines
The catalytic converter and exhaust Systems work together to control the release of harmful engine
exhaust emissions into the atmosphere. The engine exhaust gas consists mainly of nitrogen (N),
carbon dioxide (CO2) and water vapor (H2O). However, it also contains carbon monoxide (CO),
oxides of nitrogen (NOx), hydrogen (H), and various unburned hydrocarbons (HCs). The major air
pollutants of CO, NOx, and HCs, and their emission into the atmosphere must be controlled.
The exhaust system generally consists of an exhaust manifold, front exhaust pipe, front heated
oxygen sensor (HO2S), rear exhaust pipe, catalyst HO2S, a muffler, and an exhaust tailpipe. The
catalytic converter is typically installed between the front and rear exhaust pipes. On some vehicle
applications, more than one catalyst is used between the front and rear exhaust pipes. Catalytic
converter efficiency is monitored by the on-board diagnostic (OBD) system strategy in the PCM.
For information on the OBD catalyst monitor, refer to the description for the Catalyst Efficiency
Monitor.
The number of HO2Ss used in the exhaust stream and the location of these sensors depend on the
vehicle emission certification level (LEV, LEV-II, ULEV, PZEV). On most vehicles only 2 HO2Ss are
used in an exhaust stream. The front sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control while the ones after the catalyst (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor
catalyst efficiency. However, some partial zero emission vehicles (PZEV) use 3 HO2Ss for each
engine bank. The stream 1 sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) located before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control, the stream 2 sensors (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor the light-off
catalyst, and the stream 3 sensors (HO2S13/HO2S23) located after the catalyst are used for long
term fuel trim control to optimize catalyst efficiency (fore aft oxygen sensor control). Current PZEV
vehicles use only a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4638
4-cylinder engine, so only the bank 1 HO2Ss are used.
Catalytic Converter
A catalyst is a material that remains unchanged when it initiates and increases the speed of a
chemical reaction. A catalyst also enables a chemical reaction to occur at a lower temperature. The
concentration of exhaust gas products released to the atmosphere must be controlled. The
catalytic converter assists in this task. It contains a catalyst in the form of a specially treated
ceramic honeycomb structure saturated with catalytically active precious metals. As the exhaust
gases come in contact with the catalyst, they are changed into mostly harmless products. The
catalyst initiates and speeds up heat producing chemical reactions of the exhaust gas components
so they are used up as much as possible.
Light Off Catalyst
As the catalyst heats up, converter efficiency rises rapidly. The point at which conversion efficiency
exceeds 50% is called catalyst light off. For most catalysts this point occurs at 246°C to 302°C
(475°F to 575°F). A fast light catalyst is a 3-way catalyst (TWC) that is located as close to the
exhaust manifold as possible. Because the light off catalyst is located close to the exhaust manifold
it lights off faster and reduce emissions quicker than the catalyst located under the body. Once the
catalyst lights off, the catalyst quickly reaches the maximum conversion efficiency for that catalyst.
Three-Way Catalyst (TWC) Conversion Efficiency
TWC Conversion Efficiency Chart
A TWC requires a stoichiometric fuel ratio, 14.7 pounds of air to 1 pound of fuel (14.7:1), for high
conversion efficiency. In order to achieve these high efficiencies, the air/fuel ratio must be tightly
controlled with a narrow window of stoichiometry. Deviations outside of this window greatly
decrease the conversion efficiency. For example a rich mixture decreases the HC and CO
conversion efficiency while a lean mixture decreases the NOx conversion efficiency.
Exhaust System
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4639
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 2 HO2S Configuration
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 3 HO2S Configuration
The purpose of the exhaust system is to convey engine emissions from the exhaust manifold to the
atmosphere. Engine exhaust emissions are directed from the engine exhaust manifold to the
catalytic converter through the front exhaust pipe. A HO2S is mounted on the front exhaust pipe
before the catalyst. The catalytic converter reduces the concentration of CO, unburned HCs, and
NOx in the exhaust emissions to an acceptable level. The reduced exhaust emissions are directed
from the catalytic converter past another HO2S mounted in the rear exhaust pipe and then on into
the muffler. Finally, the exhaust emissions are directed to the atmosphere through an exhaust
tailpipe.
On some PZEV, there is a total of 3 HO2S in the exhaust stream. One near the exhaust manifold
(stream 1), one in the middle of the light-off catalyst (stream 2), and the third (stream 3) is mounted
after the light-off catalyst.
Underbody Catalyst
The underbody catalyst is located after the light off catalyst. The underbody catalyst may be in-line
with the light off catalyst, or the underbody catalyst may be common to 2 light off catalysts, forming
a Y pipe configuration. For an exact configuration of the catalyst and exhaust system for a specific
vehicle, refer to Catalytic Converter, Exhaust System.
Three-Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
The TWC converter contains either platinum (Pt) and rhodium (Rh) or palladium (Pd) and rhodium
(Rh). The TWC converter catalyzes the oxidation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4640
reactions of unburned HCs and CO and the reduction reaction of NOx. The 3-way conversion can
be best accomplished by always operating the engine air fuel/ratio at or close to stoichiometry.
Exhaust Manifold Runners
The exhaust manifold runners collect exhaust gases from engine cylinders. The number of exhaust
manifolds and exhaust manifold runners depends on the engine configuration and number of
cylinders.
Exhaust Pipes
Exhaust pipes are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to
increase the life of the product. The pipes serve as guides for the flow of exhaust gases from the
engine exhaust manifold through the catalytic converter and the muffler.
Heated Oxygen Sensors (HO2S)
The HO2S provide the powertrain control module (PCM) with voltage and frequency information
related to the oxygen content of the exhaust gas.
Muffler
Mufflers are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to increase
the life of the product. The muffler reduces the level of noise produced by the engine, and also
reduces the noise produced by exhaust gases as they travel from the catalytic converter to the
atmosphere.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams
C1195
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4645
Canister Purge Control Valve: Description and Operation
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CANISTER PURGE VALVE
EVAP Canister Purge Valve
Electronic EVAP Canister Purge Valve
NOTE: The EVAP canister purge valve may also be referred to as a vapor management valve
(VMV).
The EVAP canister purge valve is part of the enhanced EVAP system that is controlled by the
PCM. This valve controls the flow of vapors (purging) from the EVAP canister to the intake manifold
during various engine operating modes. The EVAP canister purge valve is a normally closed valve.
The electronic EVAP canister purge valve controls the flow of vapors electronically by way of a
solenoid thereby, eliminating the need for an electronic vacuum regulator and vacuum diaphragm.
The PCM outputs a signal between 0% and 100% duty cycle to control the EVAP canister purge
valve. On applications with an electronic EVAP canister purge valve, the PCM outputs a signal
between 0 mA and 1,000 mA to control the solenoid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4646
Canister Purge Control Valve: Service and Repair
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER PURGE VALVE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The evaporative emissions system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquid fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions can result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the evaporative emissions (EVAP) canister
purge solenoid electrical connector. 3. Disconnect the 2 fuel vapor tubes quick connect couplings.
4. Remove the EVAP canister purge solenoid from the bracket. 5. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
- Leak Test the system. See: Testing and Inspection/Evaporative Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emissions repair verification drive cycle. See: Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Service and Repair
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4650
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The evaporative emissions system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquid fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions can result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the spare tire. 4. Disconnect the evaporative emissions (EVAP) canister vent solenoid
electrical connector. 5. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube quick connect coupling from the EVAP
canister. 6. Disconnect the fuel vapor vent tube from the dust separator.
7. Remove the EVAP canister bolt to side rail.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4651
8. Remove the EVAP canister and fuel filler pipe bolt to crossmember.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
9. Remove the 2 EVAP canister bolts to spare tire carrier.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
10. Place the EVAP canister bracket assembly on a clean work surface.
11. Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid-to-EVAP canister hose.
12. Disconnect the hose from the dust separator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4652
13. Release the tabs and remove the EVAP canister from the bracket. 14. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
- Leak test the system. See: Testing and Inspection/Evaporative Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emissions repair verification drive cycle. See: Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Solenoid, Evaporative System > Component Information > Description and Operation
Leak Detection Solenoid: Description and Operation
CANISTER VENT (CV) SOLENOID
Typical Canister Vent (CV) Solenoid
During the evaporative emissions (EVAP) leak check monitor, the CV solenoid seals the EVAP
canister from the atmospheric pressure. This allows the EVAP canister purge valve to obtain the
target vacuum in the fuel tank during the EVAP leak check monitor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 4659
C4116
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 4660
Leak Detection Valve: Service and Repair
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER VENT SOLENOID
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 4661
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The evaporative emissions system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquid fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions can result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the spare tire. 4. Disconnect the evaporative emissions (EVAP) canister vent solenoid
electrical connector. 5. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube quick connect coupling from the EVAP
canister. 6. Disconnect the fuel vapor vent tube from the dust separator.
7. Remove the EVAP canister bolt to side rail.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 4662
8. Remove the EVAP canister and fuel filler pipe bolt to crossmember.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
9. Remove the 2 EVAP canister bolts to spare tire carrier.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
10. Place the EVAP canister bracket assembly on a clean work surface.
11. Disconnect the hoses and remove the EVAP canister vent solenoid from the EVAP canister
bracket. 12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Carry out the evaporative emission system leak test. See: Testing and Inspection/Evaporative
Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emissions repair verification drive cycle. See: Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid > Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid: Description and Operation
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) VACUUM REGULATOR (EVR) SOLENOID
EVR Solenoid
Vacuum Output (IN-HG)
EVR Solenoid Data
The EVR solenoid is an electromagnetic device which is used to regulate the vacuum supply to the
EGR valve. The solenoid contains a coil which magnetically controls the position of a disc to
regulate the vacuum. As the duty cycle to the coil increases, the vacuum signal passed through the
solenoid to the EGR valve also increases. Vacuum not directed to the EGR valve is vented through
the solenoid vent to atmosphere. Note that at 0% duty cycle (no electrical signal applied), the EVR
solenoid allows some vacuum to pass, but not enough to open the EGR valve.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Tube
> Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Tube: Description and Operation
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) ORIFICE TUBE ASSEMBLY
EGR Orifice Tube Assembly
The orifice tube assembly is a section of tubing connecting the exhaust system to the intake
manifold. The assembly provides the flow path for the EGR to the intake manifold and also
contains the metering orifice and 2 pressure pick-up tubes. The internal metering orifice creates a
measurable pressure drop across it as the EGR valve opens and closes. This pressure differential
across the orifice is picked up by the differential pressure feedback EGR (DPFE) sensor which
provides feedback to the powertrain control module (PCM).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve
ELECTRIC EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EEGR) VALVE
EEGR Motor/Valve Assembly
Depending on the application, the EEGR valve is a water cooled or an air cooled motor/valve
assembly. The motor is commanded to move in 52 discrete steps as it acts directly on the EEGR
valve. The position of the valve determines the rate of EGR. The built-in spring works to close the
valve (against the motor opening force).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve > Page 4674
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System Module (ESM)
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM MODULE (ESM)
ESM
The ESM is an integrated differential pressure feedback EGR (DPFE) system. It functions in the
same manner as the conventional DPFE system, however the various system components have
been integrated into a single component called the ESM. The flange of the valve portion of the
ESM bolts directly to the intake manifold with a metal gasket that forms the measuring orifice. This
arrangement increases system reliability, response time, and system precision. By relocating the
EGR orifice from the exhaust to the intake side of the EGR valve, the downstream pressure signal
measures manifold absolute pressure (MAP). The system provides the powertrain control module
(PCM) with a differential DPFE signal, identical to a traditional DPFE system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve > Page 4675
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) VALVE
Typical EGR Valve
Test Graph
The EGR valve in the differential pressure feedback EGR (DPFE) system is a conventional,
vacuum-actuated. The valve increases or decreases the flow of EGR. As vacuum applied to the
EGR valve diaphragm overcomes the spring force, the valve begins to open. As the vacuum signal
weakens, at 5.4 kPa (1.6 in-Hg) or less, the spring force closes the valve. The EGR valve is fully
open at about 15 kPa (4.5 in-Hg).
Since EGR flow requirement varies greatly, providing repair specifications on flow rate is
impractical. The on-board diagnostic (OBD) system monitors the EGR valve function and triggers a
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) if the test criteria is not met. The EGR valve flow rate is not
measured directly as part of the diagnostic procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Pressure
Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR
DPFE Sensor
The DPFE sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer that monitors the differential
pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly. The differential pressure
feedback sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as the downstream pressure hose
(REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI and REF hose connections are
marked on the DPFE sensor housing for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger
diameter hose). The DPFE sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the
metering orifice and supplies it to the powertrain control module (PCM) as EGR flow rate feedback.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Pressure
Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation > Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor > Page 4680
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor - Tube Mounted
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR - TUBE MOUNTED
DPFE Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted DPFE sensor is identical in operation as the larger plastic DPFE sensors and
uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation > PCV
Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair
PCV Heater: Service and Repair
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV) HEATER ELEMENT
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV)
heater element electrical connector. 3. Disconnect the quick release couplings and remove the
PCV tube. 4. Remove the bolt and the PCV heater element.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using a new O-ring seal, install the PCV heater element and the bolt. Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation > PCV
Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4685
2. Position the PCV tube and connect the quick release couplings. 3. Connect the PCV heater
element electrical connector. 4. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Diagrams
C190
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR
DPFE Sensor
The DPFE sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer that monitors the differential
pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly. The differential pressure
feedback sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as the downstream pressure hose
(REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI and REF hose connections are
marked on the DPFE sensor housing for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger
diameter hose). The DPFE sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the
metering orifice and supplies it to the powertrain control module (PCM) as EGR flow rate feedback.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor > Page 4694
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation Differential Pressure Feedback
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) (DPFE) Sensor - Tube Mounted
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) (DPFE)
SENSOR - TUBE MOUNTED
DPFE Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted DPFE sensor is identical in operation as the larger plastic DPFE sensors and
uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
Key on, engine off.................................................................................................................................
.............................................240-310 kPa (35-45 psi) Engine running.................................................
..................................................................................................................................193-310 kPa
(28-45 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: The electrical connector is located on the LH frame rail under the driver side door.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Start the engine and allow it to idle until it stalls. 4. After the engine stalls, crank the engine for
approximately 5 seconds to make sure the fuel rail pressure has been released. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the OFF position.
6. When fuel system service is complete, connect the electrical connector.
7. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
8. Install the diagnostic tool. Turn the key ON with the engine OFF. Cycle the key OFF, then ON.
Select the appropriate vehicle and engine qualifier.
Clear all diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and carry out a PCM reset.
9. Start the vehicle and check the fuel system for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information >
Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Measured/PID Values
Hot Idle Speed .....................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 600-650 RPM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Accelerator Pedal - Fixed
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal - Fixed
ACCELERATOR PEDAL - FIXED
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the accelerator pedal position sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the 3 bolts and the accelerator pedal assembly.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Accelerator Pedal - Fixed > Page 4710
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal - Adjustable
ACCELERATOR PEDAL - ADJUSTABLE
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: The brake pedal and the accelerator pedal must be in the same position when installing
a new cable or a new pedal. The pedals must be in the all the way forward or the all the way
rearward position.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the accelerator pedal position sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the 3 nuts and the accelerator pedal assembly.
- To install, tighten to 13 Nm (10 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4714
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4715
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner
Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER INTAKE PIPE
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air cleaner element.
2. Reach into the opening of the air cleaner assembly and depress the locking tab on the air
cleaner intake pipe to release the air cleaner intake pipe
from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner
Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4720
3. Remove the air cleaner intake tube assembly.
4. CAUTION: The air cleaner intake pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unusual engine
noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Release the retaining clips and remove the air cleaner element tray. 2. Remove the air cleaner
element from the air cleaner element tray.
3. CAUTION: The air cleaner element tray must be fully seated to the air cleaner housing. Failure
to do so will result in unusual engine
noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4727
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4728
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4729
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. If the hot wire electronic
sensing element must be replaced, then the entire assembly must be replaced. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
The current required to maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow.
The MAF sensor then outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air
mass. The PCM calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired
air/fuel ratio. This input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC),
shift and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology (IBT) with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4730
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information >
Specifications
Fuel: Specifications
Fuel ......................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. 87 Octane
CHOOSING THE RIGHT FUEL
Use only UNLEADED FUEL. The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law and could damage your
vehicle. Your vehicle was not designed to use fuel or fuel additives with metallic compounds,
including manganese-based additives. Studies indicate that these additives can cause your
vehicles emission control system to deteriorate more rapidly. In Canada, premium grade fuel
generally contains more metallic additives than regular fuel. We recommend using regular grade
fuel. In Canada, many fuels contain metallic additives, but fuels free of such additives may be
available; check with your local fuel dealer. Do not use fuel containing methanol. It can damage
critical fuel system components. Repairs to correct the effects of using a fuel for which your vehicle
was not designed may not be covered by your warranty.
OCTANE RECOMMENDATIONS
Your vehicle is designed to use "Regular" unleaded gasoline with pump (R+M)/2 octane rating of
87. We do not recommend the use of gasolines labeled as "Regular" that are sold with octane
ratings of 86 or lower in high altitude areas. Do not be concerned if your engine sometimes knocks
lightly. However, if it knocks heavily under most driving conditions while you are using fuel with the
recommended octane rating.
FUEL QUALITY
If you are experiencing starting, rough idle or hesitation driveability problems, try a different brand
of unleaded gasoline. "Premium" unleaded gasoline is not recommended for vehicles designed to
use "Regular" unleaded gasoline because it may cause these problems to become more
pronounced. It should not be necessary to add any aftermarket products to your fuel tank if you
continue to use high quality fuel of the recommended octane rating. Aftermarket products could
cause damage to the fuel system. Repairs to correct the effects of using an aftermarket product in
your fuel may not be covered by your warranty. Many of the worlds automakers approved the
World-wide Fuel Charter that recommends gasoline specifications to provide improved
performance and emission control system protection for your vehicle. Gasolines that meet the
World-wide Fuel Charter should be used when available. Ask your fuel supplier about gasolines
that meet the World-wide Fuel Charter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
CHECK FUEL CAP INDICATOR
NOTE: The check fuel cap indicator on the Hanger is a dedicated output signal that is controlled by
the PCM.
The check fuel cap indicator is a communications network message sent by the PCM. The PCM
sends the message to illuminate the lamp when the strategy determines that there is a failure in the
vapor management system due to the fuel filler cap not being sealed correctly. This would be
detected by the inability to pull vacuum in the fuel tank, after a fueling event.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: The electrical connector is located on the LH frame rail under the driver side door.
Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Start the engine and allow it to idle until it stalls. 4. After the engine stalls, crank the engine for
approximately 5 seconds to make sure the fuel rail pressure has been released. 5. Turn the ignition
switch to the OFF position.
6. When fuel system service is complete, connect the electrical connector.
7. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
8. Install the diagnostic tool. Turn the key ON with the engine OFF. Cycle the key OFF, then ON.
Select the appropriate vehicle and engine qualifier.
Clear all diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and carry out a PCM reset.
9. Start the vehicle and check the fuel system for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector: Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector Resistance ......................................................................................................................
............................................................. 11 - 18 Ohms
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4745
Fuel Injector: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Fuel Injector Flow and Leakage ........................................................................................ Refer to
Pinpoint Test HC7 at Computers and Control Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1
C181
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4748
C182
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4749
C183
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4750
C184
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4751
Fuel Injector: Diagrams
C181
C182
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4752
C183
C184
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4753
C185
C186
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4754
C187
C188
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4755
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation
FUEL INJECTORS
Fuel Injectors
CAUTION: Do not apply battery positive voltage (B+) directly to the fuel injector electrical connector
terminals. The solenoids may be damaged internally in a matter of seconds.
The fuel injector is a solenoid-operated valve that meters fuel flow to the engine. The fuel injector is
opened and closed a constant number of times per crankshaft revolution. The amount of fuel is
controlled by the length of time the fuel injector is held open.
The fuel injector is normally closed, and is operated by 12-volt VPWR from the electronic engine
control power relay. The ground signal is controlled by the PCM.
The injector is the deposit resistant injector (DRI) type and does not have to be cleaned. However,
it can be flow checked and, if found outside of specification, a new fuel injector should be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4756
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair
FUEL INJECTORS
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4757
Part 2
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
CAUTION:
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube.
1. Disconnect the fuel supply tube spring lock coupling. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe. 4. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector. 5. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose. 6. Disconnect the positive crankcase
ventilation (PCV) tube. 7. Disconnect the crankcase ventilation tube. 8. Disconnect the 8 fuel
injector electrical connectors. 9. Remove the 8 fuel injector-to-fuel rail locking clips
10. Remove the 4 fuel rail bolts and the fuel rail.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4758
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
11. CAUTION: Use O-ring seals that are made of special fuel-resistant material. Use of ordinary
O-rings can cause the fuel system to leak.
Do not reuse the O-ring seals.
NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Remove the fuel injectors and the fuel injector O-ring seals. Discard the O-ring seals.
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Spring Lock Couplings
SPRING LOCK COUPLINGS
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect
WARNING:
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
NOTE: These couplings are used to connect the fuel hoses to the fuel supply manifold.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
2. Remove the fuel tube safety clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4763
3. Install the special tool.
4. Close and push the special tool into the open side of the cage.
5. Separate the fitting.
Connect
CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
1. Inspect and clean both coupling ends. Install new O-ring seals and garter springs if necessary.
- Lubricate the O-ring seals with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4764
2. Fit the male fitting into the female end and push until the garter spring snaps over the flared end
of the female fitting.
3. Make sure the coupling is engaged by pulling on the lines and install the fuel tube safety clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4765
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Vapor Tube Fittings
VAPOR TUBE FITTINGS
Disconnect
WARNING:
- The evaporative emission system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or fuel liquid is present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
NOTE: If the fuel tube retainer clip is broken or damaged, install a new clip using a suitable fuel line
disconnect tool to separate the retaining clip legs. Once the retainer legs have been separated, lift
the clip out of the connector housing, lifting from the stamped side of the connector body.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect the vapor tube fitting.
- Push the connector toward the tube or fitting to release pressure.
- Press the quick connect fitting button and pull the fuel tube to disconnect.
Connect
CAUTION: Make sure the quick connect fitting clicks into place when installing the tube. To make
sure that the quick connect fitting is fully seated, pull on the tube.
NOTE: If the fuel tube retainer clip is broken or damaged, install a new clip using a suitable fuel line
disconnect tool to separate the retaining clip legs. Once the retainer legs have been separated, lift
the clip out of the connector housing, lifting from the stamped side of the connector body.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4766
1. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube or fitting before connecting.
Connect the quick connect fitting.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4767
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Quick Connect Coupling
QUICK CONNECT COUPLING
Disconnect - Type 1
WARNING:
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. Disconnect the quick connect fitting.
- Push the connector toward the tube to release pressure.
- Push the release tab clockwise.
- Disconnect the quick connect fitting.
Connect - Type 1
CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
1. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube or fitting before connecting.
Connect the quick connect fitting.
Disconnect - Type 2
WARNING:
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4768
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
NOTE: These couplings are used to connect the fuel tank fuel lines to the front fuel lines and the
pump/sender assembly ports.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
2. Press the tab corners to release the locking tab.
3. Pull the locking tab to the release position.
4. Disconnect the quick connect fitting.
- Push the fitting toward the tube to release pressure.
- Press the tab corners to release the fitting.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4769
- Disconnect the quick connect fitting.
Connect - Type 2
CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
NOTE: If the fuel tube retainer clip is broken or damaged, install a new clip using a suitable fuel line
disconnect tool to separate the retaining clip legs. Once the retainer legs have been separated, lift
the clip out of the connector housing, lifting from the stamped side of the connector body.
1. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube or fitting before connecting.
Connect the tube into the quick connect fitting.
2. CAUTION: Make sure the quick connect fitting clicks into place when installing the tube. To
make sure that the quick connect fitting is
fully seated, pull on the fitting.
Press the locking tab down into the locked position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Rail Pressure Sensor
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Rail Pressure Sensor > Page 4774
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Rail Pressure/Temperature Sensor
C1475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Rail Pressure/Temperature Sensor > Page 4777
C435
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 4780
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail. Both pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the
fuel pump. The speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid
state. The dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which
allows the injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4781
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Disconnect the fuel
rail pressure and temperature (FRPT) sensor electrical and vacuum connectors. 4. Remove the 2
bolts and the FRPT sensor and discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal.
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Pulsation Damper >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Pressure Pulsation Damper: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PULSE DAMPER
Typical Fuel Rail Pulse Damper
The fuel rail pulse damper is located on the fuel rail and reduces the fuel system noise caused by
the pulsing of the fuel injectors. The vacuum port located on the damper is connected to manifold
vacuum to avoid fuel spillage if the pulse damper diaphragm ruptures. The fuel rail pulse damper
should not be confused with a fuel pressure regulator; it does not regulate the fuel rail pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
Key on, engine off.................................................................................................................................
.............................................240-310 kPa (35-45 psi) Engine running.................................................
..................................................................................................................................193-310 kPa
(28-45 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Control
Unit > Component Information > Locations
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Control
Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 4792
C4033
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Control
Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 4793
Fuel Pump Control Unit: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Driver Module (FPDM)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. NOTE: The fuel pump driver module (FPDM) is located on the top of the LH frame rail near the
fuel tank filler pipe.
Disconnect the FPDM electrical connector.
4. Remove the bolts and the FPDM.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4797
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Central Junction Box (CJB) and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Page 4801
Part 2
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
CAUTION:
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube.
1. Disconnect the fuel supply tube spring lock coupling. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe. 4. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector. 5. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose. 6. Disconnect the positive crankcase
ventilation (PCV) tube. 7. Disconnect the crankcase ventilation tube. 8. Disconnect the fuel rail
pressure and temperature sensor electrical and vacuum connectors.
9. NOTE: Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Page 4802
Remove the 2 bolts and the fuel rail pressure and temperature sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
10. Disconnect the 8 fuel injector electrical connectors. 11. Remove the 8 fuel injector-to-fuel rail
locking clips. 12. Remove the 4 fuel rail bolts and the fuel rail.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
13. CAUTION: Use O-ring seals that are made of special fuel-resistant material. Use of ordinary
O-rings can cause the fuel system to leak.
Do not reuse the O-ring seals. Lubricate the O-ring seals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Remove the fuel injectors and the fuel injector O-ring seals. Discard the O-ring seals.
14. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair
FUEL LINES
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4806
mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
CAUTION:
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Release the fuel system pressure. 3.
Disconnect the fuel filter outlet tube spring lock coupling. 4. Disconnect the fuel tube-to-fuel rail
spring lock coupling. 5. Disconnect the fuel tube from the position retainer brackets and remove the
fuel tube assembly. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Filler Hose: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4811
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard.
CAUTION:
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Remove the fuel tank filler cap.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4812
4. Remove the 3 screws. 5. Disconnect the fuel tank filler pipe vent tube from the fuel pump
module. 6. Loosen the hose clamp and disconnect the fuel tank filler pipe-to-fuel tank hose. 7.
Disconnect the vapor tube from the evaporative emissions (EVAP) system dust separator.
8. Remove the 2 bolts from the fuel tank filler pipe support bracket.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
9. Remove the fuel tank filler pipe assembly.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump Module (FPM)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 4817
Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump Module (FPM)
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 4818
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module and Reservoir
FUEL PUMP MODULE AND RESERVOIR
Fuel Pump Module And Reservoir
The fuel pump module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge
check valve that maintains the system pressure after the ignition key has been turned off to
minimize starting concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle
maneuvers with low tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4819
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4820
Part 2
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4821
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel and vapor tubes from the fuel pump module.
3. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
4. CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4822
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Diagrams
C433
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Fuel Tank Unit: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump Module (FPM)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 4828
Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump Module (FPM)
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 4829
Fuel Tank Unit: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module and Reservoir
FUEL PUMP MODULE AND RESERVOIR
Fuel Pump Module And Reservoir
The fuel pump module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge
check valve that maintains the system pressure after the ignition key has been turned off to
minimize starting concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle
maneuvers with low tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4833
C1475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail. Both pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the
fuel pump. The speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid
state. The dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which
allows the injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor > Page 4836
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Temperature (FRT) Sensor
FUEL RAIL TEMPERATURE (FRT) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Temperature (FRT) Sensor
The FRT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRT sensor measures the temperature of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4837
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Disconnect the fuel
rail pressure and temperature (FRPT) sensor electrical and vacuum connectors. 4. Remove the 2
bolts and the FRPT sensor and discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal.
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Description and Operation
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
NOTE: The IAC valve assembly is not adjustable and cannot be cleaned, also some IAC valves are
normally open and others are normally closed. Some IAC valves require engine vacuum to
operate.
The IAC valve assembly controls the engine idle speed and provides a dashpot function. The IAC
valve assembly meters intake air around the throttle plate through a bypass within the IAC valve
assembly and throttle body. The PCM determines the desired idle speed or bypass air and signals
the IAC valve assembly through a specified duty cycle. The IAC valve responds by positioning the
IAC valve to control the amount of bypassed air. The PCM monitors engine RPM and increases or
decreases the IAC duty cycle in order to achieve the desired RPM.
The PCM uses the IAC valve assembly to control:
- no touch start
- cold engine fast idle for rapid warm-up
- idle (corrects for engine load)
- stumble or stalling on deceleration (provides a dashpot function)
- over-temperature idle boost
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4844
C4168
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4845
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4846
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the LH rear interior quarter trim panel. 3.
Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the
IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4850
C2160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4851
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4852
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 4857
C4033
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 4858
Fuel Pump Control Unit: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Driver Module (FPDM)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. NOTE: The fuel pump driver module (FPDM) is located on the top of the LH frame rail near the
fuel tank filler pipe.
Disconnect the FPDM electrical connector.
4. Remove the bolts and the FPDM.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 4862
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Central Junction Box (CJB) and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4866
C2160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4867
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4868
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4873
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4874
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4878
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4879
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4880
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. If the hot wire electronic
sensing element must be replaced, then the entire assembly must be replaced. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
The current required to maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow.
The MAF sensor then outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air
mass. The PCM calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired
air/fuel ratio. This input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC),
shift and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology (IBT) with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4881
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Rail Pressure
Sensor
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Rail Pressure
Sensor > Page 4886
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Rail
Pressure/Temperature Sensor
C1475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Rail
Pressure/Temperature Sensor > Page 4889
C435
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail
Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail
Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 4892
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail. Both pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the
fuel pump. The speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid
state. The dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which
allows the injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
4893
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Disconnect the fuel
rail pressure and temperature (FRPT) sensor electrical and vacuum connectors. 4. Remove the 2
bolts and the FRPT sensor and discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal.
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4897
C1475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail
Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail. Both pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the
fuel pump. The speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid
state. The dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which
allows the injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail
Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor > Page 4900
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Temperature (FRT) Sensor
FUEL RAIL TEMPERATURE (FRT) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Temperature (FRT) Sensor
The FRT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRT sensor measures the temperature of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4901
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Disconnect the fuel
rail pressure and temperature (FRPT) sensor electrical and vacuum connectors. 4. Remove the 2
bolts and the FRPT sensor and discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Install a new O-ring seal.
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal prior to installation.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4905
C4168
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4906
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4907
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the LH rear interior quarter trim panel. 3.
Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the
IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4911
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 4914
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases corrosion resistance on terminals
and increases connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body. As the TP
sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM from the
TP. Those conditions are closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration), part throttle (includes cruise
or moderate acceleration), wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on
crank), and throttle angle rate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4915
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and the air cleaner
assembly. 3. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the air cleaner and air cleaner inlet pipe. 4.
Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Throttle Body: Service and Repair
THROTTLE BODY
Removal
WARNING: Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: The throttle body bore and plate area have a special coating and cannot be cleaned.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 3. Disconnect the
electronic throttle control electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor
electrical connector. 5. Remove the 4 bolts and the throttle body (TB) assembly.
- Discard the TB O-ring seal.
Installation
1. Using a new O-ring seal, install the TB and tighten the 4 bolts in 2 stages.
- Stage 1: Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector. 3. Connect the electronic throttle control electrical
connector. 4. Install the air cleaner assembly. 5. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4922
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 4925
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases corrosion resistance on terminals
and increases connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body. As the TP
sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM from the
TP. Those conditions are closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration), part throttle (includes cruise
or moderate acceleration), wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on
crank), and throttle angle rate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4926
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner inlet pipe and the air cleaner
assembly. 3. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector. 3. Install the air cleaner and air cleaner inlet pipe. 4.
Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams
C1442
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4931
Variable Induction Control Actuator: Description and Operation
INTAKE MANIFOLD TUNING VALVE (IMTV)
WARNING: Substantial opening and closing torque is applied by this system. To prevent injury, be
careful to keep fingers away from lever mechanisms when actuated.
The IMTV is a motorized actuated unit mounted directly to the intake manifold. The IMTV actuator
controls a shutter device attached to the actuator shaft. There is no monitor input to the PCM with
this system to indicate shutter position.
The motorized IMTV unit is not energized below approximately 2,600 RPM. The shutter is in the
closed position not allowing airflow blend to occur in the intake manifold. Above approximately
2,600 RPM the motorized unit is energized. The motorized unit is commanded on by the PCM
initially at a 100 percent duty cycle to move the shutter to the open position, and then falling to
approximately 50 percent to continue to hold the shutter open.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4932
Variable Induction Control Actuator: Service and Repair
CHARGE MOTION CONTROL VALVE (CMCV)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the charge motion control valve (CMCV) RH and LH
rods from the intake manifold. 3. Remove the stud bolt, the 2 bolts and the CMCV.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Eight separate ignition coils:
- are mounted directly above each spark plug.
- are controlled by the powertrain control module (PCM) for correct firing sequence.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Number One Cylinder >
Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Item ......................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Specification
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Eight separate ignition coils:
- are mounted directly above each spark plug.
- are controlled by the powertrain control module (PCM) for correct firing sequence.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1 > Page 4946
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4947
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston No.
1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing the
sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP signal to
select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4948
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4952
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4953
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4954
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the accessory drive belt. 4. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 7. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Coil-On-Plug Misfire Diagnostic Tips
Ignition Coil: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Coil-On-Plug Misfire Diagnostic Tips
TSB 05-22-8
11/14/05
WDS COP KIT DIAGNOSTIC TIPS - COIL ON PLUG (COP) IGNITION SYSTEMS - ENGINE
MISFIRE OR ROUGH RUNNING
FORD: 1996-1999 Taurus SHO 1998-2006 Crown Victoria, Mustang 2000 Taurus 2002-2005
Thunderbird 2003-2006 Focus 2004-2006 Taurus 2005-2006 Five Hundred, Freestyle 1997-2006
E-Series, Expedition, F-150 1999-2006 F-Super Duty 2000-2005 Excursion, F-53 2001-2006
Escape 2002-2005 Explorer 2005-2006 Escape Hybrid
LINCOLN: 1997-1998 Mark VIII 1998-2002 Continental 1998-2006 Town Car 2000-2006 LS
1998-2006 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 1998-2006 Grand Marquis 2000 Sable 2004-2005 Sable 2005-2006 Montego
2002-2005 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner 2006 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 04-16-01 to update the vehicle applications and model years.
NOTE
FOLLOW THIS TSB PROCEDURE ONLY IF THERE ARE NO SPECIFIC MISFIRE TSBs/SSMs
RELEASED FOR THE VEHICLE SYMPTOM BEING EXPERIENCED.
ISSUE Approximately 50% of coil on plug (COP) coils returned for warranty do not have a problem.
ACTION The misfiring cylinder must be identified through Self-Test misfire codes or through WDS
Power Balance. Rule out base engine problems, rule out fuel problems, and then look at ignition
problems (be sure to rule out coil primary circuit issues). Once the above steps have been
completed, and the issue is in the secondary part of the ignition system, the oscilloscope procedure
outlined in this TSB can isolate the difference between a coil or spark plug problem.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The optional WDS COP Kit available through Rotunda will provide more accurate diagnosis and
help reduce replacement of non-defective parts. The Kit (418-F5528) can be purchased through
1-800-ROTUNDA.
The following material will detail the diagnostic steps on WDS to take the guesswork out of misfire
diagnosis using the COP Kit. The following procedure is for cylinder specific misfires and not
random misfires. Random misfires have a different root cause and are not covered by this TSB.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Coil-On-Plug Misfire Diagnostic Tips > Page 4959
Misfire Definition: A misfiring cylinder is lacking power relative to the other cylinders. The causes
for a cylinder specific misfire could be fuel, spark, or mechanical problems.
Perform a thorough visual inspection. If no visible concerns are found use the following WDS tools
for misfire diagnosis:
^ Self-test (Check for codes first)
Power Balance (Identify the cylinder of concern)
^ Relative Compression (Rule out a possible mechanical issue)
^ Fuel (Make sure fuel injectors are not restricted)
^ Ignition (Make sure spark plugs and coils are working properly)
^ Oscilloscope (Detailed signal analysis)
NOTE
USE THE ENCYCLOPEDIA BUTTON IN THE LOWER LEFT CORNER OF THE SCREEN FOR
DETAILED INFORMATION ON THE WDS TOOL BEING DISPLAYED.
If there is a self-test code identifying a particular cylinder then you just need to determine if it is a
fuel, ignition, or possibly a mechanical problem. Proceed to Step 2 after running Relative
Compression to rule out any mechanical issues. If there is no self-test code and the customer
concern is a miss, proceed to Step 1.
Step 1: (Select Toolbox Icon, then Powertrain, then Power Balance)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Coil-On-Plug Misfire Diagnostic Tips > Page 4960
The cylinder specific miss has to be identified as shown in the example in Figure 2 in order to
proceed with the remaining steps. If the miss does not occur at idle (in the bay), try to brake torque
the engine. This extra loading should reproduce the miss in the bay. If the miss cannot be
reproduced during brake torque, select Relative Compression under Powertrain on WDS before
going on a road test to rule out mechanical problems. If Relative Compression shows a problem
then the base engine issue must be serviced. If Relative Compression results are good (Figure 3),
road test under as many different driving conditions as possible until the miss occurs on Power
Balance. Some misses may be very intermiffent so be patient and concentrate on steady load
conditions. Once a cylinder dropout is identified proceed to Step 2.
Step 2: (Select Toolbox Icon, then Powertrain, then Fuel System Test)
Run Fuel System Test on WDS to determine if there may be a fuel problem. After completing fuel
Pressure/Leakdown test, select Injector flow to isolate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Coil-On-Plug Misfire Diagnostic Tips > Page 4961
a restricted injector as shown in Figure 4. If all the injectors are within specification, proceed to
Step 3.
Step 3: (Select Toolbox Icon, then Powertrain, then Ignition System Test)
Run Ignition System Test on WDS to determine if there is an ignition problem. Look at both
duration (DUR) and kilovolts (KV) and look for values that standout from the rest as shown in
Figure 5 and Figure 6.
NOTE
LIVE DISPLAY HAS TO AVERAGE IGNITION VALUES BECAUSE THERE IS TOO MUCH DATA
TO DISPLAY. MAKE A CAPTURE TO VIEW EACH ENGINE EVENT WITHOUT AVERAGING.
THIS CAN BE HELPFUL WHEN THE PROBLEM IS INTERMITTENT. IF THE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Coil-On-Plug Misfire Diagnostic Tips > Page 4962
MISS IS EXTREMELY INTERMITTENT AND DOES NOT SHOW UP IN IGNITION, PROCEED TO
STEP 4.
If either spark duration or peak KV on the Red Probe (Suspect Cylinder) are offset from the values
displayed on the Black Probe (Known Good Cylinder) then the problem is in the ignition system.
Rule out coil primary circuit issues before proceeding to coil secondary issues such as the spark
plug , coil boot, or possibly the coil. Use the WDS Oscilloscope with the COP kit to determine if the
issue is the coil or the spark plug.
Step 4: (Select Toolbox, then Oscilloscope)
WARNING
SECONDARY IGNITION VOLTAGES ARE VERY HIGH. KEEP HANDS AND TOOLS AWAY
FROM THE END OF THE COIL THAT SUPPLIES THE SPARK.
SET-UP: With the engine off, pull the suspect coil from the cylinder well and turn it upside down so
the coil cannot spark to any other surface as shown in Figure 1. Wrap a clean shop cloth around
the hard shell of the coil to help keep the coil propped up and stable.
CAUTION
THE COIL BOOT CAN BE DAMAGED IF THE COIL SPARKS TO ANOTHER SURFACE DURING
THIS PROCEDURE.
Keep the coil connected to the harness and leave the WDS COP clip attached to the coil. Route
the coil clip wire and cable away from the coil being tested as well as other coils to avoid noise
interference. Disconnect the injector of the cylinder being tested so raw fuel is not washing the
cylinder. This is a stress test for the coil. The type of waveform displayed on the oscilloscope will
show whether a coil or the plug is the problem if all previous steps have been followed. Keep hands
and tools away from the end of the coil that supplies the spark.
COP Stress Test Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Coil-On-Plug Misfire Diagnostic Tips > Page 4963
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Coil-On-Plug Misfire Diagnostic Tips > Page 4964
Go to the Oscilloscope Tool and select Channel 3, then select Auto, then select
COP_STRESS_TEST_RED. This pre-configured setting will zoom-in on the peak firing of the coil
being tested. Start the engine and be sure the coil is not sparking to any surface. If the coil is
sparking to other surfaces, turn the engine off immediately and readjust the coil so it cannot spark
to any other surface. Restart the engine and touch the Red Man icon to start the oscilloscope. All
settings are pre-configured and no adjustments are necessary. Compare the waveform you get
with the examples provided in Figures 7, 8, and 9). Figure 7 is a good waveform. If your waveform
is similar to Figure 7 the coil is working correctly. Suspect the spark plug.
Figure 8 and Figure 9 are examples of problem coils. Replace the coil if the waveform is similar to
Figures 8 or 9. The coil is causing the misfire when the peak firing appears like those shown in
Figures 8 and 9. Notice the difference in the peak-firing signal when compared to the good peak
signal in Figure 7.
Figure 9 shows a more dramatic fault in the peak failure.
Most root causes of misfire issues can be identified quickly using the steps outlined above. Some
misfire issues can be difficult making the oscilloscope an important part of your diagnostic toolbox.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 05-13-4
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4965
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil on Plug 1
C111
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil on Plug 1 > Page 4968
C112
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil on Plug 1 > Page 4969
C113
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil on Plug 1 > Page 4970
C114
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil on Plug 1 > Page 4971
Ignition Coil: Diagrams
C111
C112
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil on Plug 1 > Page 4972
C113
C114
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil on Plug 1 > Page 4973
C115
C116
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil on Plug 1 > Page 4974
C117
C118
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil on Plug 1 > Page 4975
C174
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Engine Ignition
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation Engine Ignition
ENGINE IGNITION
The electronic ignition system is a coil-on-plug ignition system. The coil-on-plug ignition system
consists of the following components:
- Crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
- Ignition coils
- Spark plugs
The CKP sensor:
- is a variable reluctance sensor.
- is triggered by a 36-minus-1 tooth sensor ring mounted on the crankshaft.
- provides base timing and crankshaft speed (rpm) to the powertrain control module (PCM).
The 8 separate ignition coils:
- change low voltage signals from the PCM to high voltage pulses.
- produce the high voltage pulses to the spark plugs.
- are connected directly to each spark plug.
The spark plugs:
- change high voltage pulses into a spark which ignites the fuel and air mixture.
- originally equipped on the vehicle have a platinum-enhanced active electrode for long life.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Engine Ignition > Page 4978
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation Coil On Plug (COP)
COIL ON PLUG (COP)
Coil On Plug (COP)
The COP ignition operates similar to a standard coil pack ignition except each plug has one coil per
plug. The COP has 3 different modes of operation: engine crank, engine running, and CMP failure
mode effects management (FMEM).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Engine Ignition > Page 4979
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation Coil Pack
COIL PACK
Typical Six-Tower Coil Pack
Horizontal Connector 6-Tower Coil Pack
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Engine Ignition > Page 4980
Series 5 6-Tower Coil Pack
Four-Tower Coil Packs
The PCM provides a grounding switch for the coil primary circuit. When the switch is closed,
voltage is applied to the coil primary circuit. This creates a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Engine Ignition > Page 4981
magnetic field around the primary coil. The PCM opens the switch, causing the magnetic field to
collapse, inducing the high voltage in the secondary coil windings and firing the spark plug. The
spark plugs are paired so that as one spark plug fires on the compression stroke, the other spark
plug fires on the exhaust stroke. The next time the coil is fired the order is reversed. The next pair
of spark plugs fire according to the engine firing order.
Coil packs come in 4-tower, 6-tower horizontal and series 5 6-tower models. Two adjacent coil
towers share a common coil and are called a matched pair. For 6-tower coil pack (6 cylinder)
applications, the matched pairs are 1 and 5, 2 and 6, and 3 and 4. For 4-tower coil pack (4 cylinder)
applications, the matched pairs are 1 and 4, and 2 and 3.
When the coil is fired by the PCM, spark is delivered through the matched pair towers to their
respective spark plugs. The spark plugs are fired simultaneously and are paired so that as one fires
on the compression stroke, the other spark plug fires on the exhaust stroke. The next time the coil
is fired, the situation is reversed. The next pair of spark plugs fire according to the engine firing
order.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 4982
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair
IGNITION COIL-ON-PLUG
Engine Ignition - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 4983
Engine Ignition - LH
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the ignition coil electrical connector. 3.
Remove the bolt and the ignition coil.
- Remove the ignition coil, using a twisting motion while pulling up on the ignition coil.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
4. NOTE: Verify that the ignition coil spring is correctly located inside the ignition coil boot and that
there is no damage to the tip of the boot.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Apply a light coat of dielectric compound to the inside of the ignition coil boots.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 4989
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4990
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4991
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1 > Page 4998
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4999
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston No.
1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing the
sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP signal to
select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5000
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the camshaft position (CMP) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5004
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5005
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5006
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the accessory drive belt. 4. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 5.
Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 7. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor. Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5012
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5013
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5014
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5015
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5016
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5017
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5018
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5019
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5020
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5021
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5022
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5023
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5024
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5025
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5026
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5027
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5028
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5029
C250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5030
Ignition Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5031
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5032
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Lower tilt release handle to access second screw.
Remove the lower steering column shroud. ^
Remove the screws.
3. NOTE: The screw is located behind the multi-function switch.
Remove the screw and the upper steering column shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5033
4. Remove the bolt, push the release and position the multi-function switch aside.
5. Disconnect the ignition switch electrical connector.
6. Remove the ignition switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Make sure that the spring located under the ignition switch is positioned on the steering column
lock rod.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 5039
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5040
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5041
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5046
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5047
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5048
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5049
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5050
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5051
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5052
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5053
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5054
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5055
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 5056
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Spark Plug Gap
Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Gap
Spark Plug Gap
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.040 - 0.050 inch (1.02 - 1.27 mm)
NOTE: Spark plug gap not adjustable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Spark Plug Gap > Page 5059
Spark Plug: Specifications Spark Plug Torque
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
................................................... 34 Nm (25.0 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5060
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark Plug ...........................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... PZT-2F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5061
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Engine Ignition - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5062
Engine Ignition - LH
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug.
2. NOTE:
- Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before removing the
spark plugs.
- If an original spark plug is used, make sure it is installed in the same cylinder from which it was
taken. New spark plugs can be used in any cylinder.
Remove the spark plugs. To install, tighten to 34 Nm (25 lb-ft).
3. Inspect the spark plugs. Install new spark plugs as necessary. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5070
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5071
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5072
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5073
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5074
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5075
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5076
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5077
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5078
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5079
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5080
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5081
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5082
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5083
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5084
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5085
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5086
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5087
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5088
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift and Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5089
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5090
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5091
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5092
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5093
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page 5098
latches. Please refer to the appropriate vehicle shop manual to determine location of the front air
bag sensors. The side air bag sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillar. To deplete
the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable. Wait at least one minute before proceeding with the
procedure to allow the backup power supply to deplete its energy.
2. Remove the supplemental restraint system (SRS) steering column clockspring.
3. Remove the 3 bolts and remove the clockspring mounting bracket from the steering column.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
4. Remove the 3 screws and position the wiring harnesses aside.
5. Disconnect the interlock actuator electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page 5099
6. Remove the 2 screws and position the actuator aside.
7. Remove the 2 bolts and position the selector lever detent bracket aside.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
8. Remove the shift lock actuator from the detent bracket and remove the shift lock actuator. 9. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page 5100
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Floor Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Floor Shift Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake shift interlock actuator is not serviced individually. If replacement is required,
install a new floor shift selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5105
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5106
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5107
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5108
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5109
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5110
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5111
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5112
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5113
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5114
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5115
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5116
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5117
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5118
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5119
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5120
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5121
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5122
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5123
Shift Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift and Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5124
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5125
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5126
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5127
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5128
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5133
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5134
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5135
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5136
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5137
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5138
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5139
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5140
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5141
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5142
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5143
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5144
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5145
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5146
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5147
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5148
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5149
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5150
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5151
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift and Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5152
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5153
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5154
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5155
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5156
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Four Wheel Drive (4WD) control module is integral to the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) and is not serviced separately.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5170
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The transfercase Low to High and High to Low relays are located in the Auxiliary relay box 1
located in the engine compartment. LH side, front.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to High Relay
C1129
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information >
Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 5173
C1173
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case Low to High Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 5176
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 5177
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case High to Low Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 5178
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5185
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5186
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5187
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5188
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5189
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5190
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5191
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5192
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5193
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5194
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5195
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5196
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5197
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5198
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5199
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5200
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5201
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5202
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5208
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5209
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5210
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5211
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5212
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5213
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5214
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5215
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5216
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5217
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5218
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5219
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5220
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5221
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5222
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5223
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5224
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5225
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5230
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5231
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5232
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5233
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5234
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5235
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5236
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5237
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5238
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5239
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5240
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5241
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5242
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5243
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5244
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5245
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5246
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5251
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5252
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5253
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5254
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5255
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5256
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5257
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5258
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5259
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5260
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5261
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5262
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5263
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5264
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5265
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5266
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5267
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5268
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5272
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5275
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5276
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5277
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5278
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5279
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5280
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5281
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5282
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5283
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5284
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5285
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5286
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5287
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5288
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5289
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5290
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5291
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5292
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5293
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
4R70E/4R75E Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Adjustment
Special Tools
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual lever shift control cable.
3. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5294
4. Loosen the digital transmission range (TR) sensor bolts.
5. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
6. CAUTION: Tightening one bolt before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor and tighten the bolts in an alternating sequence.
^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Install the manual control lever.
^ Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual lever shaft outer nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5295
8. With the manual lever in overdrive connect the shift lever control cable. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5296
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tools
Removal
NOTE: Manual shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5297
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual control lever shift control cable.
3. Disconnect the digital TR electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
5. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the digital TR sensor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5298
1. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
2. Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
3. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5299
5. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
6. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5304
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5305
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5306
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5309
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5310
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5311
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5312
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5313
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5314
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5315
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5316
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5317
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5318
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5319
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5320
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5321
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5322
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5323
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5324
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5325
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5326
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Views
C193
C143
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5327
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Speed Sensors
Speed Sensors
NOTE: Only remove the affected sensor.
Removal All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist,
OSS sensor
2. Disconnect the output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the OSS
sensor bolt. 4. Remove the OSS sensor.
TSS sensor
5. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the TSS
sensor bolt. 7. Remove the TSS sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5328
Installation TSS sensor
1. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the TSS sensor. 2. Install the TSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
OSS sensor
4. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the OSS sensor. 5. Install the OSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
6. Connect the OSS sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5333
C284
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 06-13-9 >
Jul > 06 > Engine Controls - Hard Start/MIL ON/Multiple DTC's Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Hard Start/MIL
ON/Multiple DTC's Set
TSB 06-13-9
07/10/06
HARD START, LOW POWER AT 3500 RPM, MIL ON P0340, P0344, P0172, P0175 AND
EXPEDITION ONLY - IDLES TOO FAST COLD
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-4-15 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition/Navigators may exhibit a hard start during multiple restart
attempts or during hot soak restart attempts and / or the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on with
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0340, P0344, P0172, and / or P0175 and / or a reduction in
power between 3500 and 4500 RPM during wide open throttle (WOT) application. Some customers
may describe the condition as feeling like the transmission is slipping, a lack of transmission upshift
or a hesitation. 2005-2006 Expedition (only) may also exhibit a higher than normal idle on cold
start.
ACTION Follow normal diagnostics for the vehicle symptom(s) to determine if there is an actual
physical issue with the fuel / ignition / exhaust systems and / or base engine causing the
symptom(s). If no issues are found during normal diagnostics and the symptoms still occur,
reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS Release B43.4
or later. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061309A 2005-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator 5.4L 3V: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes And Reprogram The Powertrain
Control Module (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12650D84)
MT061309 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 06-5-1 >
Mar > 06 > Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough
Idle Condition
TSB 06-5-1
03/20/06
COLD START ROUGH IDLE EXPEDITION 4X2 ONLY
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition 4x2 vehicles may exhibit an idle vibration during cold start at
1400 RPM, that lasts for a few seconds. The symptom is perceived as shaking of the entire vehicle
when the engine is first started after being off for an extended period of time in warm weather in
excess of a few hours, such as overnight, with ambient temperatures greater than 60° F (16° C).
The issue is not typically accompanied by unusual engine or fan noise. It is independent of air
conditioning compressor engagement (bumps, bangs, or thumps) and air suspension pump
operation (audible hum or buzz accompanied by an associated vibration).
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to resolve the concern.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using normal Workshop Manual diagnostics:
a. Verify the integrity of the fuel system (fuel injectors, fuel pump, fuel quality) and repair as
necessary.
b. Check ignition system (spark plugs, ignition coils), mechanical engine operation, and repair as
necessary.
2. Check the engine assembly exhaust mounting systems for ground-outs, damage, and repair as
necessary.
3. If no concerns are found or cold start symptoms continue, reprogram the powertrain control
module (PCM) to the latest calibration using WDS release B41.10 and higher or B42.1 and higher.
This new calibration is not included in the B42 CD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
COLD ENGINE IDLE SPEED WILL DROP TO 1250 RPM AND WARM DRIVE IDLE SPEED WILL
INCREASE TO 650 RPM. THIS CALIBRATION IS MATCHED TO THE SERVICE
ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS LISTED IN THIS TSB. DO NOT RE-INSTALL THE
ORIGINAL ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS AFTER PERFORMING THIS RECALIBRATION.
4. Replace the left hand and right hand engine mounts. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section
303-01 - Engine Support Insulators
5. Replace the transmission mount. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 307-01B - Transmission
Insulator & Retainer
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
060501A 2005 Expedition 4X2: 3.7 Hrs. Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount,
Reprogram The Powertrain Control Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84,
050415A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 06-5-1 >
Mar > 06 > Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition > Page 5346
052301A)
060501B 2006 Expedition 4X2: 3.6 Hrs.
Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount, Reprogram The Powertrain Control
Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84, 050415A, 052301A)
MT060501 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 05-23-1 >
Nov > 05 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0351-P0358/Delayed Shifts
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0351-P0358/Delayed Shifts
TSB 05-23-1
11/28/05
MIL ON WITH DTC P0351-P0358 - LACK OF UPSHIFT
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-21-15 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition vehicles built before 9/29/2005 and Navigator vehicles built
before 10/19/2005 may exhibit any/all of the following symptoms:
^ Malfunction indicator lamp on (MIL) with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0351-P0358 and no
drivability symptoms
^ (Navigator only) Delayed 1-2 shifts or lack of upshift, especially at low speeds with no DTCs. This
condition may be due to the driver resting his/her foot on the brake pedal while accelerating
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using WDS
release B39.9 and higher or B40.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the B40 CD.
Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
NOTE
DO NOT PERFORM THIS TSB FOR DTC P0351-0358 IF DRIVEABILITY SYMPTOMS ARE
PRESENT. FOLLOW NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS INSTEAD.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052301A 2005-2006 0.4 Hr
Expedition/Navigator: Check For Diagnostic Trouble Codes And Reprogram The Powertrain
Control Module (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
06-13-9 > Jul > 06 > Engine Controls - Hard Start/MIL ON/Multiple DTC's Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Hard
Start/MIL ON/Multiple DTC's Set
TSB 06-13-9
07/10/06
HARD START, LOW POWER AT 3500 RPM, MIL ON P0340, P0344, P0172, P0175 AND
EXPEDITION ONLY - IDLES TOO FAST COLD
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-4-15 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition/Navigators may exhibit a hard start during multiple restart
attempts or during hot soak restart attempts and / or the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on with
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0340, P0344, P0172, and / or P0175 and / or a reduction in
power between 3500 and 4500 RPM during wide open throttle (WOT) application. Some customers
may describe the condition as feeling like the transmission is slipping, a lack of transmission upshift
or a hesitation. 2005-2006 Expedition (only) may also exhibit a higher than normal idle on cold
start.
ACTION Follow normal diagnostics for the vehicle symptom(s) to determine if there is an actual
physical issue with the fuel / ignition / exhaust systems and / or base engine causing the
symptom(s). If no issues are found during normal diagnostics and the symptoms still occur,
reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS Release B43.4
or later. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061309A 2005-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator 5.4L 3V: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes And Reprogram The Powertrain
Control Module (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12650D84)
MT061309 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
06-5-1 > Mar > 06 > Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Cold
Start Rough Idle Condition
TSB 06-5-1
03/20/06
COLD START ROUGH IDLE EXPEDITION 4X2 ONLY
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition 4x2 vehicles may exhibit an idle vibration during cold start at
1400 RPM, that lasts for a few seconds. The symptom is perceived as shaking of the entire vehicle
when the engine is first started after being off for an extended period of time in warm weather in
excess of a few hours, such as overnight, with ambient temperatures greater than 60° F (16° C).
The issue is not typically accompanied by unusual engine or fan noise. It is independent of air
conditioning compressor engagement (bumps, bangs, or thumps) and air suspension pump
operation (audible hum or buzz accompanied by an associated vibration).
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to resolve the concern.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using normal Workshop Manual diagnostics:
a. Verify the integrity of the fuel system (fuel injectors, fuel pump, fuel quality) and repair as
necessary.
b. Check ignition system (spark plugs, ignition coils), mechanical engine operation, and repair as
necessary.
2. Check the engine assembly exhaust mounting systems for ground-outs, damage, and repair as
necessary.
3. If no concerns are found or cold start symptoms continue, reprogram the powertrain control
module (PCM) to the latest calibration using WDS release B41.10 and higher or B42.1 and higher.
This new calibration is not included in the B42 CD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
COLD ENGINE IDLE SPEED WILL DROP TO 1250 RPM AND WARM DRIVE IDLE SPEED WILL
INCREASE TO 650 RPM. THIS CALIBRATION IS MATCHED TO THE SERVICE
ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS LISTED IN THIS TSB. DO NOT RE-INSTALL THE
ORIGINAL ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS AFTER PERFORMING THIS RECALIBRATION.
4. Replace the left hand and right hand engine mounts. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section
303-01 - Engine Support Insulators
5. Replace the transmission mount. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 307-01B - Transmission
Insulator & Retainer
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
060501A 2005 Expedition 4X2: 3.7 Hrs. Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount,
Reprogram The Powertrain Control Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84,
050415A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
06-5-1 > Mar > 06 > Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition > Page 5360
052301A)
060501B 2006 Expedition 4X2: 3.6 Hrs.
Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount, Reprogram The Powertrain Control
Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84, 050415A, 052301A)
MT060501 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
05-23-1 > Nov > 05 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0351-P0358/Delayed Shifts
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0351-P0358/Delayed Shifts
TSB 05-23-1
11/28/05
MIL ON WITH DTC P0351-P0358 - LACK OF UPSHIFT
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-21-15 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition vehicles built before 9/29/2005 and Navigator vehicles built
before 10/19/2005 may exhibit any/all of the following symptoms:
^ Malfunction indicator lamp on (MIL) with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0351-P0358 and no
drivability symptoms
^ (Navigator only) Delayed 1-2 shifts or lack of upshift, especially at low speeds with no DTCs. This
condition may be due to the driver resting his/her foot on the brake pedal while accelerating
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using WDS
release B39.9 and higher or B40.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the B40 CD.
Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
NOTE
DO NOT PERFORM THIS TSB FOR DTC P0351-0358 IF DRIVEABILITY SYMPTOMS ARE
PRESENT. FOLLOW NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS INSTEAD.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052301A 2005-2006 0.4 Hr
Expedition/Navigator: Check For Diagnostic Trouble Codes And Reprogram The Powertrain
Control Module (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5372
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5373
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5374
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5375
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5376
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5377
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5378
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5379
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5380
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5381
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5382
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5383
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5384
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5385
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5386
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5387
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5388
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5389
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5390
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift
and Torque Converter Clutch Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5391
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5392
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5393
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5394
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5395
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page 5400
latches. Please refer to the appropriate vehicle shop manual to determine location of the front air
bag sensors. The side air bag sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillar. To deplete
the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable. Wait at least one minute before proceeding with the
procedure to allow the backup power supply to deplete its energy.
2. Remove the supplemental restraint system (SRS) steering column clockspring.
3. Remove the 3 bolts and remove the clockspring mounting bracket from the steering column.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
4. Remove the 3 screws and position the wiring harnesses aside.
5. Disconnect the interlock actuator electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page 5401
6. Remove the 2 screws and position the actuator aside.
7. Remove the 2 bolts and position the selector lever detent bracket aside.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
8. Remove the shift lock actuator from the detent bracket and remove the shift lock actuator. 9. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page 5402
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Floor Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Floor Shift Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake shift interlock actuator is not serviced individually. If replacement is required,
install a new floor shift selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5407
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5408
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5409
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5410
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5411
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5412
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5413
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5414
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5415
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5416
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5417
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5418
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5419
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5420
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5421
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5422
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5423
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5424
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5425
Shift Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift
and Torque Converter Clutch Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5426
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5427
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5428
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5429
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5430
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5435
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5436
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5437
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5438
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5439
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5440
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5441
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5442
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5443
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5444
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5445
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5446
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5447
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5448
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5449
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5450
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5451
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5452
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5453
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift
and Torque Converter Clutch Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5454
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5455
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5456
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5457
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5458
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5465
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5466
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5467
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5468
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5469
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5470
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5471
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5472
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5473
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5474
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5475
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5476
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5477
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5478
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5479
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5480
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5481
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5482
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5483
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift
and Torque Converter Clutch Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5484
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5485
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5486
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5487
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5488
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
> Page 5493
latches. Please refer to the appropriate vehicle shop manual to determine location of the front air
bag sensors. The side air bag sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillar. To deplete
the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable. Wait at least one minute before proceeding with the
procedure to allow the backup power supply to deplete its energy.
2. Remove the supplemental restraint system (SRS) steering column clockspring.
3. Remove the 3 bolts and remove the clockspring mounting bracket from the steering column.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
4. Remove the 3 screws and position the wiring harnesses aside.
5. Disconnect the interlock actuator electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
> Page 5494
6. Remove the 2 screws and position the actuator aside.
7. Remove the 2 bolts and position the selector lever detent bracket aside.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
8. Remove the shift lock actuator from the detent bracket and remove the shift lock actuator. 9. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
> Page 5495
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Floor Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Floor Shift Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake shift interlock actuator is not serviced individually. If replacement is required,
install a new floor shift selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5500
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5501
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5502
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5503
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5504
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5505
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5506
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5507
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5508
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5509
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5510
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5511
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5512
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5513
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5514
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5515
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5516
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5517
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5518
Shift Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift
and Torque Converter Clutch Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5519
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5520
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5521
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5522
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5523
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5528
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5529
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5530
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5531
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5532
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5533
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5534
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5535
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5536
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5537
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5538
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5539
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5540
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5541
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5542
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5543
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 5544
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5545
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5546
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift
and Torque Converter Clutch Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5547
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5548
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5549
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5550
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5551
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 1-2 Accumulator
Accumulator: Service and Repair 1-2 Accumulator
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission 1-2 Accumulator Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Compress the 1-2 accumulator piston and remove the accumulator piston retaining ring.
4. Remove the 1-2 shift accumulator assembly.
1 Remove the 1-2 accumulator cover.
2 Remove the inner and outer 1-2 accumulator springs.
3 Remove the 1-2 accumulator piston.
4 Remove the 1-2 accumulator upper spring.
Installation
1. Install the 1-2 shift accumulator assembly.
1 Install the 1-2 accumulator upper spring.
2 Install the 1-2 accumulator piston.
3 Install the inner and outer 1-2 accumulator springs.
4 Install the 1-2 accumulator cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 1-2 Accumulator > Page 5556
2. Compress the 1-2 accumulator piston and remove the accumulator piston retaining ring. 3.
Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 1-2 Accumulator > Page 5557
Accumulator: Service and Repair 2-3 Accumulator
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission 2-3 Accumulator Removal
1. Remove the main control valve body.
2. Remove the 2-3 accumulator piston retainer.
3. Remove the accumulator piston and spring.
Installation
1. Install the 2-3 accumulator assembly.
1 Install the accumulator piston.
2 Install the accumulator piston spring.
3 Install the accumulator spring retainer.
2. Install the main control valve body.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band, A/T > Component
Information > Application and ID > 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission
Band: Application and ID 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission
Clutch Pressure Chart (Part 1)
Clutch Pressure Chart (Part 2)
Band and Clutch Application Chart A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band, A/T > Component
Information > Application and ID > 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission > Page 5562
Band and Clutch Application Chart B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band, A/T > Component
Information > Application and ID > 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission > Page 5563
Band: Application and ID 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Clutch Application Chart (Part 1)
Clutch Application Chart (Part 2)
Clutch Application Chart (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reverse Servo Assembly
Band Apply Servo: Service and Repair Reverse Servo Assembly
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Reverse Servo Assembly
Special Tools
Removal
1. Remove the main control valve body.
2. Using the special tool, remove the reverse band servo retaining ring.
1 Compress the servo spring.
2 Remove the reverse band servo retaining ring.
3. Remove the reverse servo assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reverse Servo Assembly > Page 5568
1 Remove the reverse band servo cover.
2 Remove the reverse band servo piston and rod.
3 Remove the reverse band servo spring.
Installation
NOTE: This is not an ordinary installation procedure and does not compensate for band wear.
1. NOTE: Lubricate the reverse piston seal to facilitate assembly and prevent damage to the seal.
Install the reverse servo return spring and piston. ^
Do not install the piston cover.
2. Install the special tool and tighten the band apply bolt.
^ Tighten to 5.6 Nm (50 inch lbs.).
3. Attach the special tool to the transmission.
^ Position the indicator stem on the flat portion of the reverse servo piston and zero the dial
indicator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reverse Servo Assembly > Page 5569
4. Loosen the bolt until the piston stops against the tool.
5. Verify that the amount of piston travel on the dial indicator is within specification.
6. If piston travel is not within specification, select and install the correct servo piston assembly to
bring the servo piston travel within specification.
1 One groove
2 Two groove
3 Three groove
7. Remove the dial indicator and servo selection tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reverse Servo Assembly > Page 5570
8. Install the correct reverse servo assembly.
1 Install the reverse band servo spring.
2 Install the reverse band servo piston and rod.
3 Install the reverse band servo cover.
9. Using the special tool, install the reverse servo retaining ring.
1 Compress the servo spring.
2 Install the reverse band servo retaining ring.
10. Install the main control valve body.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reverse Servo Assembly > Page 5571
Band Apply Servo: Service and Repair Overdrive Servo
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Overdrive Servo
Special Tools
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the main control valve body.
3. NOTE: If the tool is not available, extreme care must be taken. Spring pressure will force
overdrive servo piston assembly out of case. Case bore
damage may result from trying to pry on overdrive servo internal retaining ring.
Using the special tool, compress the servo spring to remove the overdrive servo retaining ring.
4. Remove the overdrive servo piston and return spring.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reverse Servo Assembly > Page 5572
1. Install the overdrive servo piston assembly.
1 Install the overdrive servo piston return spring.
2 Install the overdrive servo piston assembly.
2. Use the special tool to install the overdrive servo piston retaining ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5577
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5578
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5579
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5580
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5581
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5582
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5583
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5584
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5585
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5586
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5587
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5588
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5589
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5590
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5591
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5592
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5593
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5594
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid ..............................................................................................................................
.............................................. 13.9 quarts (13.1 liters)
NOTE: Indicates only approximate dry-fill capacity. Some applications may vary based on cooler
size and if equipped with an in-tank cooler. The amount of transmission fluid and fluid level should
be set by the indication on the dipsticks normal operating range.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5599
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid Type
Fluid Type ............................................................................................................................................
............................................. MERCON V XT-5-QM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
6HP26 Automatic Transmission Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
CAUTION: When internal damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch plate
material can travel into the torque converter and the transmission fluid cooler. These contaminates
are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent further concerns, remove these
contaminates from the cooler lines and install a new cooler before placing the transmission in use.
1. Install a new transmission fluid cooler if any fluid leak are indicated or a major metallic failure is
indicated. 2. Using a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner, flush the fluid cooler and lines.
3. NOTE: Rubber hoses must be attached to the ends of the fluid cooler tubes, to aid in connecting
them to the cleaner.
Connect the cleaner pressure and return lines appropriately. 1
Connect the pressure line to the fluid cooler inlet tube.
2 Connect the return line to the fluid cooler outlet tube.
3 Place the outlet end of the return line in the fluid tank reservoir.
4. NOTE: Cycling the fluid pump on and off will help dislodge contaminants in the cooler system.
Switch the fluid pumps on. Allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes.
5. Switch the fluid pump off. 6. Disconnect the cleaner pressure line at the fluid cooler tube. 7.
Using compressed air, blow through the fluid cooler inlet tube until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove
the rubber hoses from the fluid cooler tubes.
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Special Tools
Material
Drain
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5602
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove and discard the fluid pan drain plug and allow the fluid to drain.
Refill
1. Install a new fluid pan drain plug.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
2. Remove the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case, near the transmission
electrical connector.
3. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5603
transmission failure.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add 4.7 liters (5 quarts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid
fill hole. Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
4. Install the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case, near the transmission electrical
connector.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
5. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 6. With the special tool connected, the engine idling (600 - 750 rpm) in
PARK and the transmission temperature at 30°C - 50°C (86°F - 122°F),
check and adjust the transmission fluid level.
7. If more fluid is needed, remove the fluid fill plug on the side of the case and fill with clean
automatic transmission fluid until the fluid runs out of
the bottom of the hole.
Check Fluid Level and Condition
Check Fluid Level and Condition Fluid Level Check
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period at high highway speeds, in city
traffic, during hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the fluid must cool down to obtain an accurate
reading.
NOTE: The transmission fluid temperature must not be allowed to exceed 50°C (122°F) when
checking the fluid level.
The fluid temperature should be between 30°C - 50°C (86°F - 122°F) closer to 50°C (122°F) when
checking the fluid level. This vehicle is not equipped with a fluid level indicator. An incorrect level
may affect the transmission operation and can result in transmission failure. Under normal
circumstances, the fluid level should not be checked during normal maintenance. If the
transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level should be
checked. 1. With the transmission in P (PARK), the engine at idle (600 - 750 rpm) and foot pressed
on the brake, move the range selector lever through each
gear and allow engagement of each gear. Place the transmission range selector lever in the P
position.
2. With the engine idling (600 - 750 rpm) in PARK, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the fluid fill plug
located on the side of the transmission case. 4. Partially add fluid until fluid starts to come out. Wait
until the fluid stops or just drips from the hole. 5. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
High Fluid Level
CAUTION: A fluid level that is too high can cause the fluid to become aerated due to the churning
action of the rotating internal parts. This will
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5604
cause erratic control pressure, foaming, loss of fluid from the vent tube and possible transmission
failure.
If an overfill reading is indicated, drain and refill the transmission.
Low Fluid Level
A low fluid level can result in poor transmission engagement, slipping or failure. This may also
indicate a leak in one of the transmission seals or gaskets.
Adding Fluid
CAUTION: The use of any other type of transmission fluid than specified can result in transmission
failure.
If fluid must be added, add fluid in 0.5 liter (1/2 quart)increments through the fluid fill plug. Do not
overfill the fluid. For fluid type, refer to the specification chart.
Fluid Condition Check
1. Check the fluid level. 2. Remove the fluid fill plug and allow the fluid to drip onto a facial tissue
and examine the stain.
3. NOTE: The transmission fluid could be 2 different colors. The factory fill fluid is clear. The
replacement fluid is red.
Observe the color and the odor. The color under normal circumstances should be dark reddish or
clear, not black or have a burnt odor.
4. If evidence of solid material is found, the transmission fluid pan should be removed for further
inspection. 5. If the stain is a foamy pink color, this may indicate coolant in the transmission. The
engine cooling system should also be inspected at this time. 6. If fluid contamination or
transmission failure is confirmed by the sediment in the bottom of the fluid pan, the transmission
must be disassembled
and completely cleaned. This includes the torque converter and fluid cooler tubes. A new oil-to-air
cooler must be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5605
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
1. CAUTION: Do not use any supplemental transmission fluid additives or cleaning agents. The
use of these products could cause internal
transmission components to fail; this will effect the operation of the transmission.
Conduct backflushing with a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner. Test your equipment to
make sure that a vigorous fluid flow is present before proceeding. Install a new filter in the flush
equipment if flow is weak or contaminated.
2. If equipped, remove and discard the transmission fluid in-line filter. 3. Remove the transmission
fluid cooler bypass valve and install rubber hoses in its place. 4. To aid in attaching the cleaner to
the transmission steel cooler lines, connect 2 additional rubber hoses to the transmission end of
the steel
transmission cooler lines as described below. ^
Connect the cleaner tank pressure line to the steel transmission cooler return line (longest line).
^ Connect a tank return hose to the steel transmission cooler pressure line (shorter line). Place the
outlet end of this hose in the tank reservoir.
5. Turn on the pump and allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes (cycling switch on and
off will help dislodge contaminants in cooler
system).
6. Switch off the pump and disconnect the pressure hose from the transmission cooler return line.
7. Use compressed air to blow out the cooler(s) and lines (blow air into the transmission cooler
return line) until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove the rubber return hose from the remaining steel
cooler line. 9. Remove the rubber hoses and reinstall the transmission fluid cooler bypass valve.
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Special Tools
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5606
special Tools
Draining, all vehicles using a suitable flush and fill machine
CAUTION: Always refer to the instructions supplied with the flush and fill machine.
NOTE: Draining fluid from the transmission by removing only the fluid pan is acceptable for normal
or severe duty fluid maintenance.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Use a suitable flush and fill machine to
change the fluid. 3. When connecting the flush and fill machine, connect the machine to the fluid
cooler tube after the fluid cooler on the cooler return line. This will
help remove any foreign material trapped in the fluid coolers.
Refill
1. Use only clean automatic transmission fluid. 2. Once the fluid exchange has been completed,
disconnect the flush and fill machine. Reconnect any disconnected fluid cooler tubes. 3. With the
engine running and the transmission at normal operating temperature 66 - 77°C (150 - 170°F),
check and adjust the transmission fluid
level and check for any leaks. If fluid is needed, add fluid in increments of 0.24 liter (0.5 pint) until
the correct level is achieved (fluid should be in the cross-hatched area of the fluid level indicator).
Draining, all vehicles not using a suitable flush and fill machine
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Loosen the transmission fluid pan bolts and allow the fluid to drain.
3. After the fluid has drained, remove the transmission fluid pan. 4. Do not remove the fluid filter. It
is not necessary to change the fluid filter during a normal maintenance fluid change.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5607
5. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan, transmission fluid pan gasket and magnet. 6.
Thoroughly flush the cooler tubes.
Refill
1. Position the magnet into the transmission fluid pan.
2. NOTE: The fluid pan gasket is reusable, clean and inspect for damage. If not damaged, the
gasket should be reused.
Install the fluid pan and gasket. 1
Position the fluid pan with the gasket in place.
2 Install the bolts.
1 Tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.).
3. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid can result in the transmission failing to
operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
Fill the transmission. Add 4.7 liters (5 qts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission
through the fluid filler tube.
4. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 5. With the engine running and the transmission at normal operating
temperature 66 - 77°C (150 - 170°F), check and adjust the transmission fluid
level and check for any leaks. If fluid is needed, add fluid in increments of 0.24 liter (0.5 pint) until
the correct level is achieved (fluid should be in the cross-hatched area of the fluid level indicator).
Check Fluid Level and Condition
Check Fluid Level and Condition Fluid Level Check
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level indicator shows the fluid below the DO
NOT DRIVE mark or internal failure could result.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5608
NOTE: If vehicle has been operated for an extended period of time at highway speeds, in city
traffic, in hot weather or when pulling a trailer, the fluid needs to cool down to obtain an accurate
reading.
NOTE: The fluid level reading on the indicator will differ from operating and ambient temperatures.
The correct reading should be within the normal operating temperature range.
Under normal circumstances, the fluid level should be checked during normal maintenance. If the
transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or has signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level should be
checked.
1. With the transmission in (P) PARK, the engine at idle, foot pressed on the brake, move the range
selector lever through each gear and allow
engagement of each gear. Place the range selector lever in the PARK position.
2. Wipe the fluid level indicator cap and remove the indicator. 3. Wipe the indicator with a clean
cloth.
4. Install the indicator back in the filler tube until it is fully seated, then remove the indicator. The
fluid level should be within the normal operating
temperature range.
High Fluid Level
A fluid level that is too high may cause the fluid to become aerated due to the churning action of
the rotating internal parts. This will cause erratic control pressure, foaming, loss of fluid from the
vent tube and possible transmission malfunction and/or damage. If an overfill reading is indicated
drain and refill the transmission.
Low Fluid Level
A low fluid level could result in poor transmission engagement, slipping, malfunction and/or
damage. This could also indicate a leak in one of the transmission seals or gaskets.
Adding Fluid
CAUTION: The use of any type of transmission fluid other than specified could result in
transmission malfunction and/or damage.
If fluid needs to be added, add fluid in 0.25L (1/2 pint) increments through the filler tube. Do not
overfill the fluid. For fluid type, refer to the General Specifications chart.
Fluid Condition Check
1. Check the fluid level. 2. Observe the color and the odor. The color under normal circumstances
should be dark reddish, not brown or black or have a burnt odor. 3. Hold the fluid level indicator
over a white facial tissue and allow the fluid to drip onto the facial tissue and examine the stain. 4. If
evidence of solid material is found, the transmission fluid pan should be removed for further
inspection. 5. If the stain is a foamy pink color, this may indicate coolant in the transmission. The
engine cooling system should also be inspected at this time. 6. If fluid contamination or
transmission failure is confirmed by the sediment in the bottom of the fluid pan, the transmission
must be disassembled
and completely cleaned. This includes the torque converter, coolers and cooler lines.
7. Carry out diagnostic checks and adjustments; refer to Diagnosis By Symptom See: Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5609
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/4R70E/4R75E/Diagnosis By Symptom.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter
Special Tools
Transmission Fluid In-line Filter with an OTA cooler
NOTE: Use the following guidelines for installing the transmission fluid in-line filter: ^
If the transmission was overhauled and the vehicle was equipped with an in-line fluid filter, install a
new in-line fluid filter.
^ If the transmission was overhauled and the vehicle was not equipped with an in-line fluid filter,
install a new in-line fluid filter kit.
^ If the transmission is being installed for a non-internal repair, do not install an in-line filter or filter
kit.
^ If installing a new or a Ford-authorized remanufactured transmission, install the in-line
transmission fluid filter that is supplied.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. If equipped, remove the bolts and the skid plate.
3. Remove the section of the rubber hose and steel line as illustrated.
^ Clean and de-burr the end of the steel line.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 5614
4. NOTE: Be sure the cooler tube is fully seated in the body of the fitting before final tightening of
the ferrule nut.
Install the tubing ferrule hose assembly connector onto the end of the steel fluid cooler tube.
Finger-tighten the ferrule nut, then tighten the nut an additional 1-1/2 turns to seat the ferrule in the
connector.
5. CAUTION: The filter has a bypass valve in it. The red arrow on the filter indicates the direction of
fluid flow through the filter. The filter must
be installed in the fluid cooler return line with the red arrow on the filter pointing away from the
transmission fluid cooler and toward the transmission (the return line has fluid coming out of the
cooler going to the transmission). If the fluid filter is not installed correctly, it will cause internal
transmission damage.
CAUTION: Do not install any rubber hoses or steel tubing with a bend entering the filter greater
than 60 degrees.
Using a suitable length of hose install the filter. Tighten the hose clamps.
6. Clean a section of the transmission fluid pan and install the sticker.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 5615
7. If equipped, install the skid plate and the bolts. 8. Fill the transmission with clean automatic
transmission fluid.
^ Verify for correct operation.
^ Check the filter for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 5616
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter - Without an OTA Cooler
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Transmission Fluid In-line Filter - without an OTA cooler
NOTE: Use the following guidelines for installing the transmission fluid in-line filter: ^
If the transmission was overhauled and the vehicle was equipped with an in-line fluid filter, install a
new in-line fluid filter.
^ If the transmission was overhauled and the vehicle was not equipped with an in-line fluid filter,
install a new in-line fluid filter kit.
^ If the transmission is being installed for a non-internal repair, do not install an in-line filter or filter
kit.
^ If installing a new or a Ford-authorized remanufactured transmission, install the in-line
transmission fluid filter that is supplied.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the cooler tubes retainers.
3. Remove the section of the steel tube as illustrated.
^ Clean and de-burr the end of the steel tubes.
4. NOTE: Be sure the cooler tube is fully seated in the body of the fitting before final tightening of
the ferrule nut.
Install the tubing ferrule hose assembly connector onto the end of the steel fluid cooler tubes.
Finger-tighten the ferrule nut, then tighten the nut an additional 1-1/2 turns to seat the ferrule in the
connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 5617
5. CAUTION: The filter has a bypass valve in it. The red arrow on the filter indicates the direction of
fluid flow through the filter. The filter must
be installed in the fluid cooler return line with the red arrow on the filter pointing away from the
transmission fluid cooler and toward the transmission (the return line has fluid coming out of the
cooler going to the transmission). If the fluid filter is not installed correctly, it will cause internal
transmission damage.
CAUTION: Do not install any rubber hoses or steel tubing with a bend entering the filter greater
than 60 degrees.
Using a suitable length of hose install the filter. Tighten the hose clamps.
6. Install one cooler tube retainer as Illustrated.
7. Secure the cooler tubes together with a tie strap.
8. Clean a section of the transmission fluid pan and install the sticker. 9. Fill the transmission with
clean automatic transmission fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 5618
^ Verify for correct operation.
^ Check the filter for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 5619
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
Material
Removal
CAUTION: Do not use any supplemental transmission fluid additives or cleaning agents. The use
of these products could cause internal transmission components to fail; this will effect the operation
of the transmission. Use of a fluid other than specified could result in transmission failure.
NOTE: Normal maintenance requires periodic automatic transmission fluid changes. If a major
repair, such as a clutch, band, bearing, etc., is required, the automatic transmission will need to be
removed for repair. The transmission fluid needs to be changed if evidence of fluid contamination is
found.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Drain transmission fluid.
^ Loosen the transmission fluid pan bolts and allow fluid to drain. After fluid is drained remove the
bolts.
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and transmission fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 5620
4. Pull down evenly and remove the transmission fluid filter and seal.
5. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan, gasket and magnet.
Installation
1. CAUTION: If installing a new filter and the seal remains in the main control bore, carefully use a
small screwdriver to remove the seal. Use care
not to damage the main control bore.
NOTE: If transmission is being repaired for a contamination related failure, use a new filter and
seal. The filter may be reused if no excessive contamination is present.
Install a new fluid filter and seal as required.
2. Position the pan magnet into the transmission fluid pan.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid In-Line Filter > Page 5621
3. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket is reusable.
Clean and inspect for damage; if not damaged, the gasket should be reused. ^
Install the transmission fluid pan and gasket.
1 Position the transmission fluid pan and gasket.
2 Install the transmission fluid pan bolts.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.).
4. NOTE: When filling a dry transmission and converter, start with a minimum of 4.7 liters (5
quarts).
Fill the transmission to the correct level with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Fluid Line/Hose: Service and Repair 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes
Special Tools
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Separate the fluid cooler lines.
3. Using the special tool, disconnect the fluid cooler tube from the auxiliary transmission fluid
cooler.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5626
4. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube retainer from the front of the engine.
5. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube rear support bracket from the side of the
transmission.
6. NOTE: The cooler tube band seals and backer rings may remain in the transmission case.
Carefully remove them from the case if retained. ^
Disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the transmission.
7. Disconnect the engine oil level sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5627
8. If equipped, remove the RH bolt and nut for the front axle, lower the RH side of the axle.
9. Remove the 4 nuts and lower the front sway bar.
10. Using the special tool, disconnect the fluid cooler tube from the auxiliary transmission fluid
cooler.
11. Disconnect the secondary latch from the upper transmission fluid cooler connector at the
radiator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5628
12. Using the special tool, disconnect the upper transmission fluid cooler tube from the radiator.
13. Disconnect the secondary latch from the lower transmission fluid cooler connector at the
radiator.
14. Using the special tool, disconnect the lower transmission fluid cooler tube from the radiator. 15.
Remove the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the vehicle.
Installation
1. Position the transmission fluid cooler tubes in the vehicle.
2. Connect the lower transmission fluid cooler tube to the radiator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5629
3. Install the secondary latch to the lower transmission fluid cooler tube at the radiator.
4. Connect the upper transmission fluid cooler tube to the radiator.
5. Install the secondary latch to the upper transmission fluid cooler tube at the radiator.
6. NOTE: Inspect the case to make sure that the old band seals and backer rings are not stuck in
the case.
NOTE: Install new band seals and backer rings on the ends of the cooler lines prior to installing.
Install new seals on the transmission fluid cooler tubes. 1
Transmission fluid cooler tube.
2 Retainer plate.
3 Backer ring.
4 Band seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5630
7. NOTE: Inspect the case to make sure that the old band seals and backer rings are not stuck in
the case.
NOTE: Install new band seals and backer rings on the ends of the cooler lines prior to installing.
Position the fluid cooler lines into the transmission, then install the bolt for the transmission cooler
line retainer. ^
Tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the transmission fluid cooler tube retainer to the side of the transmission.
^ Tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
9. Install the transmission fluid cooler tube retainer to the front of the engine.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
10. Connect the fluid cooler tubes into the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5631
11. Position the sway bar in place and install the 4 nuts.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
12. If removed, position the axle and install the RH bolt and nut.
^ Tighten to 102 Nm (75 ft. lbs.).
13. Connect the engine oil level sensor electrical connector. 14. With the vehicle idling (600 - 750
rpm) in PARK, and the transmission temperature at 30°C - 50°C (86°F - 122°F), check and adjust
the
transmission fluid level.
15. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Remove the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case near the transmission electrical
connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5632
16. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid can result in the transmission failing to
operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid fill hole.
^ Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
17. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Install the fluid fill plug. ^
Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
18. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges, checking for
engagements.
19. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
If more fluid is needed, start the engine. ^
Remove the fluid fill plug on the side of the case, fill with clean automatic transmission fluid until
fluid adjust starts to dribble out of the hole.
^ Install the fill plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5633
Fluid Line/Hose: Service and Repair 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes , With Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes, With Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Special Tools
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the transmission.
3. Disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the thermostatic valve.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5634
4. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube retainer from the front of the engine.
5. Using the special tool, disconnect the fluid cooler tube from the auxiliary transmission fluid
cooler.
6. Using the special tool, disconnect the fluid cooler tube from the auxiliary transmission fluid
cooler.
7. Remove the secondary latch from the upper transmission fluid cooler tube at the radiator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5635
8. Using the special tool, disconnect the upper transmission fluid cooler tube from the radiator.
9. Remove the secondary latch from the lower transmission fluid cooler tube at the radiator.
10. Using the special tool, disconnect the lower transmission fluid cooler tube from the radiator. 11.
Remove the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the vehicle.
Installation
1. Position the transmission fluid cooler tubes in the vehicle.
2. Connect the lower transmission fluid cooler tube to the radiator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5636
3. Install the secondary latch to the lower transmission fluid cooler tube at the radiator.
4. Connect the upper transmission fluid cooler tube to the radiator.
5. Install the secondary latch to the upper transmission fluid cooler tube at the radiator.
6. Connect the fluid cooler tubes into the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5637
7. Install the transmission fluid cooler tube retainer to the front of the engine.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
8. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tubes to the thermostatic valve.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
9. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tubes to the transmission.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
10. Fill the transmission with the specified type and quantity of transmission fluid. 11. Check for
leaks.
Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes, Without Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes, Without Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Special Tools
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5638
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the transmission.
3. Disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the thermostatic valve.
4. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube retainer from the front of the engine.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5639
5. Remove the secondary latch from the upper transmission fluid cooler tube at the radiator.
6. Using the special tool, disconnect the upper transmission fluid cooler tube from the radiator.
7. Remove the secondary latch from the lower transmission fluid cooler tube at the radiator.
8. Using the special tool, disconnect the lower transmission fluid cooler tube from the radiator. 9.
Remove the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the vehicle.
Installation
1. Position the transmission fluid cooler tubes in the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5640
2. Connect the lower transmission fluid cooler tube to the radiator.
3. Install the secondary latch to the lower transmission fluid cooler tube at the radiator.
4. Connect the upper transmission fluid cooler tube to the radiator.
5. Install the secondary latch to the upper transmission fluid cooler tube at the radiator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5641
6. Install the transmission fluid cooler tube retainer to the front of the engine.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
7. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tubes to the thermostatic valve.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
8. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tubes to the transmission.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
9. Fill the transmission with the specified type and quantity of transmission fluid.
10. Check for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Fluid Pan: Specifications
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission
Install the transmission fluid pan bolts.
Tighten to .............................................................................................................................................
........................................ 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.).
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Install a new fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
Tighten to .............................................................................................................................................
....................................... 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5645
Fluid Pan: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
Material
Removal
CAUTION: Do not use any supplemental transmission fluid additives or cleaning agents. The use
of these products could cause internal transmission components to fail; this will effect the operation
of the transmission. Use of a fluid other than specified could result in transmission failure.
NOTE: Normal maintenance requires periodic automatic transmission fluid changes. If a major
repair, such as a clutch, band, bearing, etc., is required, the automatic transmission will need to be
removed for repair. The transmission fluid needs to be changed if evidence of fluid contamination is
found.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Drain transmission fluid.
^ Loosen the transmission fluid pan bolts and allow fluid to drain. After fluid is drained remove the
bolts.
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and transmission fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5646
4. Pull down evenly and remove the transmission fluid filter and seal.
5. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan, gasket and magnet.
Installation
1. CAUTION: If installing a new filter and the seal remains in the main control bore, carefully use a
small screwdriver to remove the seal. Use care
not to damage the main control bore.
NOTE: If transmission is being repaired for a contamination related failure, use a new filter and
seal. The filter may be reused if no excessive contamination is present.
Install a new fluid filter and seal as required.
2. Position the pan magnet into the transmission fluid pan.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5647
3. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket is reusable.
Clean and inspect for damage; if not damaged, the gasket should be reused. ^
Install the transmission fluid pan and gasket.
1 Position the transmission fluid pan and gasket.
2 Install the transmission fluid pan bolts.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.).
4. NOTE: When filling a dry transmission and converter, start with a minimum of 4.7 liters (5
quarts).
Fill the transmission to the correct level with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators - A/T
> Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5657
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5658
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5659
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5660
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5661
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5662
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5663
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5664
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5665
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5666
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5667
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5668
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5669
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5670
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5671
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5672
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5673
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5674
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5679
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5680
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5681
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5682
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5683
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5684
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5685
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5686
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5687
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5688
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5689
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5690
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5691
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5692
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5693
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5694
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5695
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5696
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5697
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift
and Torque Converter Clutch Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5698
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5699
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5700
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5701
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5702
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Output Shaft Seal
Output Shaft Seal
Special Tools
Material
Removal All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
4x2 vehicles
2. Remove the rear driveshaft.
3. Remove and discard the output shaft flange nut.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5707
4. Remove the output shaft flange.
5. Remove the output shaft seal.
4x4 vehicles
6. Remove the transfer case.
7. Remove the 11 bolts and the extension housing.
8. Remove the output shaft seal.
Installation 4x2 vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5708
1. Position a new output shaft seal.
2. Using the special tool, install the output shaft seal.
3. Install the output shaft flange.
4. Install a new output shaft flange nut.
^ After installing the new nut, it must be staked at the slots to prevent it from coming loose.
^ Tighten to 120 Nm (89 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the rear driveshaft.
4x4 vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5709
6. Position the output shaft seal.
7. Using the special tool, install a new output shaft seal.
8. Install the extension housing and the 11 bolts.
^ Tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
9. Install the transfer case.
All vehicles
10. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 11. With the engine idling (600 - 750 rpm) in PARK and the
transmission temperature at 30°C - 50°C (86°F - 122°F), check and adjust the
transmission fluid level.
12. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5710
With the engine still running and the vehicle in PARK, remove the fluid fill plug. The fill plug is
located on the RH rear side of the case near the transmission electrical connector.
13. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or
transmission failure.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid fill hole. Stop when the
fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
14. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
15. With the engine still running in PARK, check the fluid level. If more fluid is needed, remove the
fluid fill plug and fill with clean automatic
transmission fluid until the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5711
16. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Manual Control Lever Shaft and Seal
Manual Control Lever Shaft and Seal
Special Tools
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the shift cable end and remove the shift cable bracket bolts. Position the cable and
bracket aside.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5712
3. Remove and discard the transmission fluid pan drain plug and allow the fluid to drain.
4. Install a new transmission fluid pan drain plug.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
5. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan, gasket, filter and magnets are serviced as a complete unit.
Remove the transmission fluid pan assembly.
6. CAUTION: Do not pull on the wire harness to disconnect the connector or damage to the
connector will occur.
Disconnect the main transmission electrical harness by twisting the outer shell and pulling back on
the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5713
7. Press the release tab and pull down on the bulkhead connector retainer.
8. With the release tab down, pull the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector.
9. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins. Electrostatic charge may occur and will
cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Pull the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector out of the transmission.
10. Remove the 10 bolts from the mechatronic assembly and remove the mechatronic assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5714
11. Remove the park rod actuating plate.
12. Remove the manual control lever.
1 Remove the roll pin.
2 Slide the manual control lever shaft out of the case.
3 Hold the spacer to keep it from falling out of the case.
4 Remove the manual valve inner lever and the park rod as an assembly.
13. Remove and discard the manual control lever seal.
Installation
1. Position a new manual control lever seal in place.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5715
2. Using the special tool, install a new manual control lever shaft seal.
3. Install the manual lever in the case.
1 Slide the manual lever in the case.
2 Position the spacer in place while sliding the manual lever into the spacer.
3 Position the manual valve inner lever while sliding the manual lever and lining up the roll pin hole.
4 Install the roll pin.
4. Position the park rod in place. Push down on the park pawl and position the park rod in place.
5. While holding the park rod down, install the park rod actuating plate.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
6. Position the mechatronic assembly in place and loosely install the 10 bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5716
7. Tighten the mechatronic bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
8. Install new O-rings on the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector.
9. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins. Electrostatic charge may occur and will
cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down, push the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector into the
transmission.
10. Press up on the tab and lock the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector in place.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5717
11. Install the transmission fluid pan. Tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
12. Install the shift cable bracket bolts and connect the shift cable end.
^ Tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
13. Connect the main transmission electrical harness by pushing it in and twisting the outer shell to
lock it in place.
14. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Remove the fluid fill plug. ^
The fill plug is located on the RH rear side of the case near the transmission electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5718
15. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or
transmission failure.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add 4.7 liters (5 quarts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid
fill hole. Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
16. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
17. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 18. With the engine idling (600 - 750 rpm) in PARK and the
transmission temperature at 30°C - 50°C (86°F - 122°F), check and adjust the
transmission fluid level.
19. With the engine still running in PARK check the fluid level. If more fluid is needed, remove the
fluid fill plug on the side of the case and fill with
clean automatic transmission fluid until the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5719
20. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5720
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission
Extension Housing Gasket
Extension Housing Gasket
Material
Removal All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
4x2 vehicles
2. NOTE: To maintain initial driveshaft balance, mark the rear driveshaft yoke and axle flange so
they may be installed in their original positions.
Mark the driveshaft flange and the rear pinion flange for correct alignment during assembly.
3. Remove the 4 driveshaft bolts and the driveshaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5721
4. Slide the driveshaft back enough to index-mark the driveshaft, the extension housing and the
output shaft. Separate the driveshaft from the
transmission.
4x4 vehicles
5. Remove the transfer case.
All vehicles
6. Use the high-lift jack to support the transmission.
7. NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Remove the 2 bolts retaining the heat shield to the transmission support crossmember.
8. Loosen, but do not remove the transmission-to-crossmember nuts.
9. Remove the crossmember-to-frame bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5722
10. Remove the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts and remove the crossmember.
5.4L engines
11. Remove the nut from the exhaust bracket.
12. Remove the 2 bolts, the rear transmission mount and the exhaust hanger. 13. Lower the
transmission to access the extension housing bolts.
14. Remove the fuel line bracket from the extension housing nut.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5723
15. NOTE: 4x2 shown, 4x4 similar.
Remove the extension housing and gasket. 1
Remove the nuts and bolts.
2 Remove the extension housing and gasket.
^ Allow fluid to drain into suitable container.
Installation All vehicles
1. NOTE: 4x2 shown, 4x4 similar.
Install the extension housing and a new gasket. 1
Position the extension housing gasket and the extension housing.
2 Install the bolts and nuts.
^ Tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
2. Install the fuel line bracket.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
3. Raise and position the transmission.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5724
4. Position the exhaust hanger, the rear transmission insulator and install the bolts.
^ Tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.).
5. Install the exhaust bracket nut.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
6. Position the crossmember and loosely install the transmission mount-to-crossmember nut.
7. Install the crossmember-to-frame bolts.
^ Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5725
8. Lower the transmission on the crossmember and tighten the rear mount nuts.
^ Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
9. NOTE: 4x2 shown, 4x4 similar.
Remove the high-lift transmission Jack.
10. Install the 2 bolts retaining the heat shield to the transmission support crossmember.
^ Tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
4x4 vehicles
11. Install the transfer case.
4x2 vehicles
12. NOTE: The output shaft and the driveshaft are a balanced assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5726
Install the driveshaft. ^
Align the yellow dots and position the driveshaft on the transmission.
13. NOTE: To maintain driveshaft balance, install the driveshaft yoke and flange in the original
position that was marked during removal.
Install the rear driveshaft and the 4 bolts. ^
Tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.).
All vehicles
14. Lower the vehicle. 15. Fill the transmission with clean automatic transmission fluid.
^ Verify for correct operation.
^ Check for leaks.
Extension Housing Seal
Extension Housing Seal
Special Tools
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5727
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: The output shaft and driveshaft are a balanced assembly.
Mark the driveshaft flange and the rear pinion flange for correct alignment during assembly.
3. Remove the 4 driveshaft bolts.
4. Slide the driveshaft back enough to index-mark the driveshaft, the extension housing and the
output shaft. Separate the driveshaft from the
transmission.
5. Using the special tools, remove the extension housing seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5728
Installation
1. NOTE: When installing the new seal, make sure that the drain hole in the seal is in the 6 o'clock
position.
Using the special tool, install a new extension housing seal.
2. NOTE: The output shaft and the driveshaft are a balanced assembly.
Install the driveshaft. ^
Align all the index marks and position the driveshaft on the transmission.
^ Install the driveshaft.
3. NOTE: To maintain driveshaft balance, install the driveshaft yoke and flange in the original
position that was marked during removal.
Install the rear driveshaft and the 4 bolts. ^
Tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.).
4. Check the level of the transmission fluid, add clean automatic transmission fluid as necessary.
Manual Control Lever Shaft and Seal
Manual Control Lever Shaft and Seal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5729
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Use care not to damage the manual control lever shaft bore. The new seal can leak.
CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever nut.
NOTE: When removing the manual control lever shaft retaining pin, use a soft cloth to protect the
surface of the case.
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
4x4 vehicles
2. Remove the front driveshaft shield nuts and remove the shield.
3. NOTE: Index-mark the front and rear flange.
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the front driveshaft from the vehicle.
Index-mark the front and rear flange, disconnect the front driveshaft and position aside.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5730
All vehicles
4. Loosen, but do not remove the transmission fluid pan bolts and allow the fluid to drain. Once the
fluid has drained, remove the bolts.
5. Remove the transmission fluid pan and gasket.
6. Disconnect the shift cable end.
7. Disconnect the digital transmission range (TR) electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5731
8. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
9. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the sensor.
10. Remove the manual control valve detent lever bolt and spring.
11. Remove the manual control lever shaft retaining pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5732
12. Remove the inner manual control lever shaft nut and slide the manual control lever shaft out of
the case.
13. Remove the manual control lever shaft seal.
Installation All vehicles
1. Using the special tool, install the manual control lever seal.
2. Install the manual valve detent lever into the manual valve.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5733
3. Install the manual control lever shaft.
1 Install the manual control lever shaft.
2 Install the inner manual control lever shaft nut.
^ Tighten to 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.).
3 Install the manual valve control lever shaft retaining pin.
4. Install the manual valve detent lever spring and bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
5. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
6. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5734
7. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
8. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
9. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
10. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5735
11. Position the pan magnet into the transmission fluid pan.
12. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket is reusable.
Clean and inspect for damage; if not damaged, the gasket should be reused. ^
Install the transmission fluid pan and gasket.
1 Position the transmission fluid pan and gasket.
2 Install the transmission fluid pan bolts.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.).
4x4 vehicles
13. Install the front driveshaft and align the index marks made during removal. Install the 4 bolts.
^ Tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5736
14. Install the front driveshaft shield and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
All vehicles
15. NOTE: Start by filling the transmission with 4.7 liters (5 quarts) of clean automatic transmission
fluid.
Fill the transmission to the correct level with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5742
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5743
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5744
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5745
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5746
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5747
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5748
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5749
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5750
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5751
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5752
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5753
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5754
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5755
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5756
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5757
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5758
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5759
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5765
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5766
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5767
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5768
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5769
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5770
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5771
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5772
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5773
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5774
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5775
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5776
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5777
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5778
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5779
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5780
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5781
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5782
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5787
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5788
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5789
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5790
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5791
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5792
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5793
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5794
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5795
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5796
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5797
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5798
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5799
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5800
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5801
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5802
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5803
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5808
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5809
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5810
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5811
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5812
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5813
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5814
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5815
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5816
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5817
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5818
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5819
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5820
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5821
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5822
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5823
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5824
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5825
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 5829
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5832
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5833
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5834
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5835
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5836
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5837
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5838
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5839
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5840
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5841
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5842
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5843
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5844
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5845
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5846
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5847
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5848
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5849
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5850
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
4R70E/4R75E Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Adjustment
Special Tools
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual lever shift control cable.
3. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5851
4. Loosen the digital transmission range (TR) sensor bolts.
5. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
6. CAUTION: Tightening one bolt before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor and tighten the bolts in an alternating sequence.
^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Install the manual control lever.
^ Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual lever shaft outer nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5852
8. With the manual lever in overdrive connect the shift lever control cable. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5853
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tools
Removal
NOTE: Manual shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5854
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual control lever shift control cable.
3. Disconnect the digital TR electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
5. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the digital TR sensor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5855
1. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
2. Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
3. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5856
5. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
6. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page
5861
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page
5862
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page
5863
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5866
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5867
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5868
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5869
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5870
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5871
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5872
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5873
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5874
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5875
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5876
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5877
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5878
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5879
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5880
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5881
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5882
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5883
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Views
C193
C143
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5884
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Speed Sensors
Speed Sensors
NOTE: Only remove the affected sensor.
Removal All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist,
OSS sensor
2. Disconnect the output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the OSS
sensor bolt. 4. Remove the OSS sensor.
TSS sensor
5. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the TSS
sensor bolt. 7. Remove the TSS sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5885
Installation TSS sensor
1. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the TSS sensor. 2. Install the TSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
OSS sensor
4. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the OSS sensor. 5. Install the OSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
6. Connect the OSS sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page
5891
latches. Please refer to the appropriate vehicle shop manual to determine location of the front air
bag sensors. The side air bag sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillar. To deplete
the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable. Wait at least one minute before proceeding with the
procedure to allow the backup power supply to deplete its energy.
2. Remove the supplemental restraint system (SRS) steering column clockspring.
3. Remove the 3 bolts and remove the clockspring mounting bracket from the steering column.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
4. Remove the 3 screws and position the wiring harnesses aside.
5. Disconnect the interlock actuator electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page
5892
6. Remove the 2 screws and position the actuator aside.
7. Remove the 2 bolts and position the selector lever detent bracket aside.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
8. Remove the shift lock actuator from the detent bracket and remove the shift lock actuator. 9. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page
5893
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Floor Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Floor Shift Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake shift interlock actuator is not serviced individually. If replacement is required,
install a new floor shift selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5898
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5899
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5900
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5901
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5902
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5903
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5904
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5905
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5906
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5907
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5908
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5909
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5910
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5911
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5912
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5913
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5914
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5915
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5916
Shift Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift
and Torque Converter Clutch Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5917
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5918
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5919
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5920
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5921
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams
C2096
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5925
Shifter A/T: Adjustments
Selector Lever Indicator Adjustment
1. Remove the upper instrument panel steering column cover. 2. Place the transmission control
selector lever in the (D) position.
^ Rotate the transmission control selector lever clockwise until it bottoms out (1st gear), then rotate
2 detents counterclockwise ((D) position).
3. Hang a 3 pound weight on the transmission control selector lever.
4. Center the pointer in the middle of the (D) position.
^ Rotate the thumbwheel located on the bottom of the steering column to adjust the pointer.
5. Remove the 3 pound weight. 6. Carefully move the shift control selector lever from detent to
detent and compare with transmission settings.
^ Readjust if necessary.
7. Install the upper instrument panel steering column cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever Button
Selector Lever Button
Selector Lever Button
Removal
1. Place a small screwdriver in the slot at the bottom of the ring and slide the button assembly out
and remove it from the knob.
Installation
1. NOTE: The tool relief opening should be at the bottom of the button assembly.
NOTE: It may be necessary to put pressure on the top of the selector lever knob bezel while
installing the selector lever button.
Install the selector lever button.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5928
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever Bezel
Selector Lever Bezel Removal
Selector Lever Bezel
1. Lift and remove the floor shift PRNDL trim plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5929
2. Place a small screwdriver in the slot at the bottom of the ring and slide the button assembly out
and remove it from the knob.
3. Using a small flat-blade screwdriver, lift up on the shift knob bezel and remove the bezel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5930
4. Remove the 2 selector lever knob screws and remove the knob.
5. Remove the screws and the console finish panel.
6. Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors from the bezel.
7. Carefully release the retaining clips from the bezel and remove the bezel.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5931
1. Position the bezel on the selector lever and fasten the 3 tabs.
2. Connect the 3 electrical connectors.
3. Install the console finish panel and the 2 screws.
4. Install the selector lever knob and the 2 screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5932
5. NOTE: The selector lever button spring must be aligned on the locator on the underside of the
selector lever knob bezel.
Install the selector lever knob bezel.
6. NOTE: The tool relief opening should be at the bottom of the button assembly.
NOTE: It may be necessary to put pressure on the top of the selector lever knob bezel while
installing the selector lever button.
Install the selector lever button.
7. Install the PRNDL trim plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5933
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever Knob
Selector Lever Knob Removal
Selector Lever Knob
1. Place a small screwdriver in the slot at the bottom of the ring and slide the button assembly out
and remove it from the knob.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5934
2. Using a small flat-blade screwdriver, lift up on the shift knob bezel and remove the bezel.
3. Remove the 2 selector lever knob screws and remove the knob.
Installation
1. Install the selector lever knob and the 2 screws.
2. NOTE: The selector lever button spring must be aligned on the locator on the underside of the
selector lever knob bezel.
Install the selector lever knob bezel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5935
3. NOTE: The tool relief opening should be at the bottom of the button assembly.
NOTE: It may be necessary to put pressure on the top of the selector lever knob bezel while
installing the selector lever button.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5936
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever - Column Shift
Selector Lever - Column Shift
Selector Lever - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches. Please refer to
the appropriate vehicle shop manual to determine the location of the front air bag sensors. The side
air bag sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillar. To deplete the backup power supply
energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute. Be sure to disconnect
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5937
auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable. Wait at least one minute before proceeding with the
procedure to allow the backup power supply to deplete its energy.
2. Remove the steering wheel.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the bottom steering column shroud.
4. Remove the screw and the top steering column shroud.
5. Disconnect the transmission control switch electrical connector.
6. CAUTION: Never reinstall the old gearshift lever pin.
Remove the pin and the selector lever. Discard the selector lever pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5938
7. NOTE: A new gearshift lever pin must be installed whenever removed.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5939
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever - Floor Shift
Selector Lever - Floor Shift
Selector Lever - Floor Shift (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5940
Selector Lever - Floor Shift (Part 2)
Removal and Installation
1. Lift and remove the floor shift PRNDL trim plate.
2. Place a small screwdriver in the slot at the bottom of the ring and slide the button assembly out
and remove it from the knob.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5941
3. Using a small flat-blade screwdriver, lift up on the shift knob bezel and remove the bezel.
4. Remove the 2 shift lever knob screws and remove the knob. Slide the knob button out when the
knob is removed.
5. Remove the spring from the top of the selector handle. 6. Position the window regulator control
panel aside.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5942
7. Remove the screws and the console finish panel.
8. Remove the left side console access panel.
9. Disconnect the transmission shift cable from the transmission selector arm
10. Remove the transmission shift cable retaining clip from the floor shift mechanism through the
console access.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5943
11. Remove the 4 nuts retaining the floor shift mechanism to the floor.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
12. Remove the 3 bolts retaining the upper shift bracket to the console.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
13. Remove the remaining bolt in the upper shift bracket from the console access panel side of the
shift mechanism.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
14. Disconnect the floor shift mechanism wire harness connector. 15. Remove the floor shift
mechanism from the console.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Button > Page 5944
16. Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors from the light bar bezel.
17. Carefully release the retaining clips from the light bar bezel and remove the bezel.
18. The selector lever is serviced as an assembly. 19. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Cable and Bracket Adjustment Column Shift
Shift Cable: Adjustments Cable and Bracket Adjustment Column Shift
Cable and Bracket Adjustment Column Shift
1. Place the gearshift lever in the (D) position.
^ Place a 3 pound weight on the gearshift lever.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
3. Disconnect the transmission shift cable from the manual control lever.
4. NOTE: Make sure the cable moves freely.
Unlock the lock tab on the transmission shift cable.
5. Place the manual control lever in the (D) position.
1 Place the manual control lever in the 1st gear position.
2 Move the manual control lever 2 detents to the (D) position.
6. Connect the transmission shift cable to the manual control lever.
7. Lock the transmission shift cable lock tab. 8. Remove the 3 pound weight. 9. Carefully move the
manual control lever from detent to detent and compare with transmission settings. Verify that the
vehicle will start in PARK
or NEUTRAL and backup lamps illuminate in REVERSE. If not, Steps 1-5 must be repeated. ^
Readjust if necessary.
10. Vehicles equipped with a 4R70E/4R75E transmission, carry out the digital transmission range
(TR) sensor adjustment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Cable and Bracket Adjustment Column Shift > Page 5950
Shift Cable: Adjustments Cable and Bracket Adjustment Floor Shift
Cable and Bracket Adjustment Floor Shift
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Place the gearshift lever in the
(D) position.
3. Disconnect the transmission shift cable from the manual control lever.
4. NOTE: Make sure the cable moves freely.
Unlock the lock tab on the transmission shift cable.
5. Place the manual control lever in the (D) position.
^ Place the manual control lever in the 1st gear position.
^ Move the manual control lever 3 detents to the (D) position.
6. NOTE: Apply pressure to the selector lever cable end while connecting it to the manual lever to
make sure the selector lever has not moved out of
the (D) position.
Connect the transmission shift cable to the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Cable and Bracket Adjustment Column Shift > Page 5951
7. Lock the transmission shift cable lock tab. 8. Carefully move the manual control lever from detent
to detent and compare with transmission settings. Verify that the vehicle will start in PARK
or NEUTRAL and backup lamps illuminate in REVERSE. If not, Steps 1 through 5 must be
repeated. ^
Readjust if necessary.
9. Vehicles equipped with a 4R70E/4R75E transmission, carry out the digital transmission range
(TR) sensor adjustment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket Column Shift
Shift Cable: Service and Repair Selector Lever Cable and Bracket Column Shift
Selector Lever Cable and Bracket Column Shift
Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel lower finish panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket Column Shift > Page 5954
2. NOTE: To prevent cable damage, do not apply force to the transmission shift cable assembly
between the steering column transmission selector
lever arm and the steering column bracket.
Disconnect the transmission shift cable from the steering column. ^
Disconnect the transmission shift cable from the transmission selector lever arm and support.
^ Carefully lift the 2 locking tabs and disconnect the transmission shift cable from the steering
column bracket.
3. Remove the cable retaining screw.
4. Push the rubber grommet and transmission shift cable through the floor panel. 5. With the
vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
6. NOTE: To prevent shift cable damage, do not apply force to the transmission shift cable between
the manual control lever and the transmission
shift cable bracket.
Disconnect the transmission shift cable from the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket Column Shift > Page 5955
7. Carefully pry behind the transmission shift cable lock tab to release the transmission shift cable
from the bracket.
8. Remove the shift cable bracket from the transmission.
^ Remove the bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
^ Remove the bracket.
9. Remove the cable from the cable route assist clip located at the transmission bell housing.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
CAUTION: Make sure the cable is inserted into the cable route assist clip. Failure to do so can
result in exhaust contact.
^ Adjust the shift cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket Column Shift > Page 5956
Shift Cable: Service and Repair Selector Lever Cable and Bracket Floor Shift
Selector Lever Cable and Bracket Floor Shift
Selector Lever Cable And Bracket- Floor Shift (Part 1)
Selector Lever Cable And Bracket- Floor Shift (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket Column Shift > Page 5957
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Lift and remove the floor shift PRNDL trim plate. 3. Position the window regulator control panel
aside.
4. Remove the screws and the console finish panel.
5. Disconnect the transmission shift cable from the transmission selector arm
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket Column Shift > Page 5958
6. Remove the left side console access panel.
7. Remove the transmission shift cable retaining clip from the floor shift mechanism through the
console access panel. 8. Push the rubber grommet and transmission shift cable through the floor
panel.
9. Remove the transmission shift cable from the automatic transmission.
10. Remove the shift cable bracket from the transmission.
^ Remove the bolts and the shift cable bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Adjust the shift cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5963
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5964
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5965
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5966
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5967
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5968
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5969
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5970
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5971
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5972
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5973
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5974
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5975
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5976
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5977
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5978
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5979
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter: Description and Operation 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter
The torque converter is a 3-element unit containing a dual plate clutch. The clutch can be
controlled and engaged in any gear 1st to 6th. Calibration parameters may be set to allow lock-up
in a higher gear only. The clutch is applied by removing fluid pressure from one side of the plate.
The torque converter transmits and multiplies torque. The torque converter includes the following 3
elements: ^
Impeller assembly
^ Turbine assembly
^ Reactor assembly
The standard torque converter components operate as follows: Rotation of the converter housing
and impeller set the fluid in motion. ^
The turbine reacts to the fluid motion from the impeller, transferring rotation to the geartrain through
the input shaft.
^ The reactor redirects fluid going back into the impeller, allowing for torque multiplication.
^ Power is transmitted from the torque converter to the planetary gearsets and other components
through the input shaft.
Torque Converter Clutch
The torque converter clutch is a device that reduces, slip in the torque converter and, therefore,
helps to keep fuel consumption to a minimum.
The torque converter clutch is engaged and released by the control system.
Pressure at the torque converter clutch piston is determined by an electronic pressure control
valve.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5984
Torque Converter: Description and Operation 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter
The torque converter transmits and multiplies torque. The torque converter is a 4-element device: ^
Impeller assembly
^ Turbine assembly
^ Reactor assembly
^ Clutch and damper assembly
The standard torque converter components operate as follows: ^
Rotation of the converter housing and impeller set the fluid in motion.
^ The turbine reacts to the fluid motion from the impeller, transferring rotation to the geartrain
through the input shaft.
^ The reactor redirects fluid going back into the impeller, allowing for torque multiplication.
^ The clutch and damper assembly dampens powertrain torsional vibration and provides a direct
mechanical connection for improved efficiency.
Torque Converter
^ Power is transmitted from the torque converter to the planetary gearsets and other components
through the input shaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter Diagnosis
Prior to torque converter installation, all diagnostic procedures must be followed. This is to prevent
the unnecessary installation of good torque converters. Only after a complete diagnostic evaluation
can the decision be made to install a new torque converter. Begin with the normal diagnostic
procedures as follows:
1. Preliminary inspection. 2. Know and understand the customer's concern. 3. Verify the condition carry out the torque converter operation test. 4. Carry out diagnostic procedures.
^ Carry out on-board diagnostics; refer to Diagnostics. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes/6HP26 Automatic Transmission
- Repair all non-transmission related DTC's first.
- Repair all transmission DTC's.
- Rerun on-board diagnostic to Verify repair.
^ Carry out Stall Speed Test. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/6HP26 Automatic
Transmission/Non-Trouble Code Procedures/Stall Speed Test
^ Carry out Diagnostic Routines. Refer to Diagnosis By Symptom. See: Transmission Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/6HP26 Automatic
Transmission/Diagnosis By Symptom
- Use the Diagnosis by Symptom to locate the appropriate routine that best describes the
symptom(s). The routine will list all possible components that may cause or contribute to the
symptom. Check each component listed, diagnose and repair as required before changing the
torque converter.
Torque Converter Operation Test
This test verifies that the torque converter clutch control system and the torque converter are
operating correctly.
1. Carry out Quick Test with diagnostic tool. Refer to Computers. Check for DTC's. 2. Connect a
tachometer to the engine. 3. Bring the engine to normal operating temperature by driving the
vehicle at highway speeds for approximately 15 minutes in D6 position. 4. After normal operating
temperature is reached, maintain a constant speed of about 80 km/h (50 mph) and tap the brake
pedal with the left foot. 5. Engine rpm should increase when the brake pedal is tapped and
decrease about 5 seconds after the pedal is released. If this does not occur, see
Torque Converter Operation Concerns. Refer to Diagnosis By Symptom. See: Transmission
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/6HP26
Automatic Transmission/Diagnosis By Symptom
6. If the vehicle stalls in D6 or at idle with the vehicle at a stop, move the transmission range
selector lever to the manual 1 position. If the vehicle
stalls, see Torque Converter Operation Concerns. Refer to Diagnosis By Symptom. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures/6HP26 Automatic Transmission/Diagnosis By Symptom If the vehicle does not stall in
D6, refer to Diagnosis By Symptom. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/6HP26 Automatic Transmission/Diagnosis By
Symptom
NOTE: The following is a list of common vehicle concerns that have been misdiagnosed as torque
converter clutch shudder.
For diagnosis of the following items, refer to Computers. ^
Spark plugs - check for cracks, high resistance or broken insulators
^ Plug wires
^ Fuel injector - filter may be plugged
^ Fuel contamination - engine driveability concerns
^ EGR valve - valve may let in too much exhaust gas and cause engine to run lean
^ Vacuum leak - engine will not get correct air/fuel mixture
^ MAP/MAF sensor - incorrect air/fuel mixture
^ H02S sensor - too rich/lean air/fuel mixture
^ Fuel pressure - may be too low
^ Engine mounts - loose/damaged mounts can cause vibration concerns
^ Axle joints - check for vibration
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5987
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter Diagnosis
Prior to installing new or remanufactured torque converters, all diagnostic procedures must be
followed This is to prevent the unnecessary installation of new or remanufactured torque
converters. Only after a complete diagnostic evaluation can the decision be made to install a new
or remanufactured torque converter. Begin with the normal diagnostic procedures as follows:
1. Preliminary inspection. 2. Know and understand the customer's concern. 3. Verify the condition carry out the torque converter operation test. 4. Carry out diagnostic procedures.
^ Carry out on-board diagnostics; refer to Diagnostics.
- Repair all non-transmission related DTC's first.
- Repair all transmission DTC's.
- Rerun on-board diagnostic to verify repair.
^ Carry out Line Pressure Test. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/4R70E/4R75E - Automatic
Transmission/Non-Trouble Code Procedures/Line Pressure Test
^ Carry out Stall Speed Test. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/4R70E/4R75E - Automatic
Transmission/Non-Trouble Code Procedures/Stall Speed Test
^ Carry out Diagnostic Routines. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/4R70E/4R75E/Diagnostic Routines
- Use the Diagnosis by Symptom Index to locate the appropriate routine that best describes the
symptom(s). The routine will list all possible components that may cause or contribute to the
symptom. Check each component listed, diagnose and repair as required before changing the
torque converter.
Torque Converter Operation Test
This test verifies that the torque converter clutch control system and the torque converter are
operating correctly.
1. Carry out Quick Test with diagnostic tool. For additional information, refer to Computers and
control systems. 2. Connect a tachometer to the engine. 3. ]Bring the engine to normal operating
temperature by driving the vehicle at highway speeds for approximately 15 minutes in (D) position.
4. After normal operating temperature is reached, maintain a constant vehicle speed of about 80
km/h (50 mph) and tap brake pedal with the left
foot.
5. Engine rpm should increase when brake pedal is tapped and decrease about 5 seconds after
pedal is released. If this does not occur, see torque
converter operation concerns. For additional information, refer to Diagnosis By Symptom. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures/4R70E/4R75E/Diagnosis By Symptom
6. If the vehicle stalls in (D) or manual 2 at idle with vehicle at a stop, move the transmission range
selector lever to manual 1 position. If the vehicle
stalls, see torque converter operation concerns. For additional information, refer to Diagnosis By
Symptom. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures/4R70E/4R75E/Diagnosis By Symptom If the vehicle does not stall in (D),
refer to Diagnosis By Symptom. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/4R70E/4R75E/Diagnosis By Symptom
7. If the vehicle exhibits a vibration during the road test complete the Road Test Evaluation Form.
This form will aid the technician in determining
the source of the vibration.
NOTE: The following is a list of common vehicle concerns that have been misdiagnosed as torque
converter clutch shudder. For diagnosis of the following items refer to Computers.
^ Spark plugs - check for cracks, high resistance or broken insulators.
^ Plug wires.
^ Fuel injector - filter may be plugged.
^ Fuel contamination - engine runs poor.
^ EGR valve - valve may let in too much exhaust gas and cause engine to run lean.
^ Vacuum leak - engine will not get correct air/fuel mixture.
^ MAP/MAF sensor - incorrect air/fuel mixture. H02S sensor - too rich/lean air/fuel mixture.
- Fuel pressure - may be too low.
- Engine mounts - loose/damaged mounts can cause vibration concerns.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5988
Torque Converter Toad Evaluation Forum (Part 1)
Torque Converter Toad Evaluation Forum (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5989
- Axle joints - check for vibration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Torque Converter Clutch: > 09-20-14 >
Oct > 09 > A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift
Torque Converter Clutch: Customer Interest A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift
TSB 09-20-14
10/19/09
UN-COMMANDED TCC APPLY ON THE 1-2 SHIFT CAUSING PERCEPTION OF HESITATION
AND/OR LACK OF POWER DURING SHIFT
FORD: 2005-2010 Crown Victoria 2005-2006 Expedition 2005-2010 E-150, E-250, E-350, F-150
LINCOLN: 2005-2010 Town Car 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2005-2010 Grand Marquis
This article supersedes TSB 6-22-7 to update the Issue Statement, vehicle model years and model
line covered.
ISSUE Some 2005-2010 vehicles equipped with a 4R70/75E-W transmission may experience an
un-commanded torque converter clutch (TCC) apply or TCC partial apply immediately after the 1-2
shift. This may result in the perception that the vehicle lacks power or that the transmission is
up-shifting too early. Additional symptoms of uncommanded TCC apply when coming to a stop
(before the 2-1 downshift is commanded), are engine stalling or lugging when engaging manual
2nd while at a stop and code P1742 may be present in continuous memory. However, the vehicle
should operate normally in park, reverse, neutral and manual 1st gear.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure for verification and repair.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Monitor (TCC %) solenoid command state - duty cycle and (TC SLIP ACT) torque converter
clutch slippage - RPM, while in 2nd, 3rd or 4th gear
with a TCC % reading 0.
a. If TCC % = 0 and TC SLIP ACT = less than 20 RPM then inspect the number 7 check ball in the
main control valve body for damage. Replace
as required following the appropriate Workshop Manual (WSM) under Disassembly and Assembly
of Subassemblies - Main Control Valve Body. (Figure 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Torque Converter Clutch: > 09-20-14 >
Oct > 09 > A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift > Page 5998
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS PERFORMED IN 2ND GEAR AUTO (NOT MANUAL 2). MONITOR (TC
SLIP ACT) AFTER THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) COMMANDS 2ND GEAR
AND BEFORE THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS) READS 35 MPH (56 KM/H).
b. If you receive any other reading, this procedure does not apply; follow normal diagnostic
procedures as outlined in the appropriate WSM.
NOTE
IT IS NORMAL FOR THE PCM TO COMMAND 4TH GEAR AT SPEEDS AS LOW AS 19 MPH (30
KM/H) WITH LIGHT ACCELERATION WHEN THE THROTTLE POSITION IS LESS THEN 20%.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092014A 2005-2010 Crown Victoria, 2.3 Hrs.
Grand Marquis, Town Car, Econoline 150/250/350, 2005-2006 Expedition: Includes Time To
Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor
Operations)
092014A 2005-2010 F-150, 2.2 Hrs.
2006-2008 Mark LT: Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7E195 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Torque Converter Clutch: >
09-20-14 > Oct > 09 > A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift
Torque Converter Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On
1-2 Upshift
TSB 09-20-14
10/19/09
UN-COMMANDED TCC APPLY ON THE 1-2 SHIFT CAUSING PERCEPTION OF HESITATION
AND/OR LACK OF POWER DURING SHIFT
FORD: 2005-2010 Crown Victoria 2005-2006 Expedition 2005-2010 E-150, E-250, E-350, F-150
LINCOLN: 2005-2010 Town Car 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2005-2010 Grand Marquis
This article supersedes TSB 6-22-7 to update the Issue Statement, vehicle model years and model
line covered.
ISSUE Some 2005-2010 vehicles equipped with a 4R70/75E-W transmission may experience an
un-commanded torque converter clutch (TCC) apply or TCC partial apply immediately after the 1-2
shift. This may result in the perception that the vehicle lacks power or that the transmission is
up-shifting too early. Additional symptoms of uncommanded TCC apply when coming to a stop
(before the 2-1 downshift is commanded), are engine stalling or lugging when engaging manual
2nd while at a stop and code P1742 may be present in continuous memory. However, the vehicle
should operate normally in park, reverse, neutral and manual 1st gear.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure for verification and repair.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Monitor (TCC %) solenoid command state - duty cycle and (TC SLIP ACT) torque converter
clutch slippage - RPM, while in 2nd, 3rd or 4th gear
with a TCC % reading 0.
a. If TCC % = 0 and TC SLIP ACT = less than 20 RPM then inspect the number 7 check ball in the
main control valve body for damage. Replace
as required following the appropriate Workshop Manual (WSM) under Disassembly and Assembly
of Subassemblies - Main Control Valve Body. (Figure 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Torque Converter Clutch: >
09-20-14 > Oct > 09 > A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift > Page 6004
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS PERFORMED IN 2ND GEAR AUTO (NOT MANUAL 2). MONITOR (TC
SLIP ACT) AFTER THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) COMMANDS 2ND GEAR
AND BEFORE THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS) READS 35 MPH (56 KM/H).
b. If you receive any other reading, this procedure does not apply; follow normal diagnostic
procedures as outlined in the appropriate WSM.
NOTE
IT IS NORMAL FOR THE PCM TO COMMAND 4TH GEAR AT SPEEDS AS LOW AS 19 MPH (30
KM/H) WITH LIGHT ACCELERATION WHEN THE THROTTLE POSITION IS LESS THEN 20%.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092014A 2005-2010 Crown Victoria, 2.3 Hrs.
Grand Marquis, Town Car, Econoline 150/250/350, 2005-2006 Expedition: Includes Time To
Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor
Operations)
092014A 2005-2010 F-150, 2.2 Hrs.
2006-2008 Mark LT: Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7E195 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6009
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6010
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6011
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6012
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6013
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6014
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6015
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6016
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6017
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6018
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6019
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6020
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6021
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6022
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6023
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6024
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6025
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6026
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6027
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift
and Torque Converter Clutch Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6028
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6029
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6030
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6031
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6032
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Torque Converter Cover: Service and Repair
6HP26 Automatic Transmission Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
CAUTION: When internal damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch plate
material can travel into the torque converter and the transmission fluid cooler. These contaminates
are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent further concerns, remove these
contaminates from the cooler lines and install a new cooler before placing the transmission in use.
1. Install a new transmission fluid cooler if any fluid leak are indicated or a major metallic failure is
indicated. 2. Using a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner, flush the fluid cooler and lines.
3. NOTE: Rubber hoses must be attached to the ends of the fluid cooler tubes, to aid in connecting
them to the cleaner.
Connect the cleaner pressure and return lines appropriately. 1
Connect the pressure line to the fluid cooler inlet tube.
2 Connect the return line to the fluid cooler outlet tube.
3 Place the outlet end of the return line in the fluid tank reservoir.
4. NOTE: Cycling the fluid pump on and off will help dislodge contaminants in the cooler system.
Switch the fluid pumps on. Allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes.
5. Switch the fluid pump off. 6. Disconnect the cleaner pressure line at the fluid cooler tube. 7.
Using compressed air, blow through the fluid cooler inlet tube until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove
the rubber hoses from the fluid cooler tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications
General Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications > Page 6040
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 6041
Transmission Cooler: Locations
4R70E, 4R75E Transmissions With Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
4R70E, 4R75E Transmissions Without Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 6042
6HP26 Transmission With Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
6HP26 Automatic Transmission Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
CAUTION: When internal damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch plate
material can travel into the torque converter and the transmission fluid cooler. These contaminates
are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent further concerns, remove these
contaminates from the cooler lines and install a new cooler before placing the transmission in use.
1. Install a new transmission fluid cooler if any fluid leak are indicated or a major metallic failure is
indicated. 2. Using a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner, flush the fluid cooler and lines.
3. NOTE: Rubber hoses must be attached to the ends of the fluid cooler tubes, to aid in connecting
them to the cleaner.
Connect the cleaner pressure and return lines appropriately. 1
Connect the pressure line to the fluid cooler inlet tube.
2 Connect the return line to the fluid cooler outlet tube.
3 Place the outlet end of the return line in the fluid tank reservoir.
4. NOTE: Cycling the fluid pump on and off will help dislodge contaminants in the cooler system.
Switch the fluid pumps on. Allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes.
5. Switch the fluid pump off. 6. Disconnect the cleaner pressure line at the fluid cooler tube. 7.
Using compressed air, blow through the fluid cooler inlet tube until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove
the rubber hoses from the fluid cooler tubes.
Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Special Tools
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 6045
Materials
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Using the special tool, disconnect the fluid cooler tube from the auxiliary transmission fluid
cooler.
3. Using the special tool, disconnect the fluid cooler tube from the auxiliary transmission fluid
cooler.
4. Remove the pushpin retainers and remove the air deflector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 6046
5. Remove the 3 bolts and remove the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler.
Installation
1. Install the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler and install the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
2. Position the air deflector and install the pushpin retainers.
3. Connect the fluid cooler tubes into the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler. 4. With the vehicle
idling (600 - 750 rpm) in PARK, and the transmission temperature at 30°C - 50°C (86°F - 122°F),
check and adjust the
transmission fluid level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 6047
5. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Remove the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case near the transmission electrical
connector.
6. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid can result in the transmission failing to
operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid fill hole.
^ Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
7. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Install the fluid fill plug. ^
Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
8. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges, checking for
engagements.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 6048
9. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
If more fluid is needed, start the engine. ^
Remove the fluid fill plug on the side of the case, fill with clean automatic transmission fluid until
fluid just starts to dribble out of the hole.
^ Install the fill plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 6049
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair 4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
1. CAUTION: Do not use any supplemental transmission fluid additives or cleaning agents. The
use of these products could cause internal
transmission components to fail; this will effect the operation of the transmission.
Conduct backflushing with a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner. Test your equipment to
make sure that a vigorous fluid flow is present before proceeding. Install a new filter in the flush
equipment if flow is weak or contaminated.
2. If equipped, remove and discard the transmission fluid in-line filter. 3. Remove the transmission
fluid cooler bypass valve and install rubber hoses in its place. 4. To aid in attaching the cleaner to
the transmission steel cooler lines, connect 2 additional rubber hoses to the transmission end of
the steel
transmission cooler lines as described below. ^
Connect the cleaner tank pressure line to the steel transmission cooler return line (longest line).
^ Connect a tank return hose to the steel transmission cooler pressure line (shorter line). Place the
outlet end of this hose in the tank reservoir.
5. Turn on the pump and allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes (cycling switch on and
off will help dislodge contaminants in cooler
system).
6. Switch off the pump and disconnect the pressure hose from the transmission cooler return line.
7. Use compressed air to blow out the cooler(s) and lines (blow air into the transmission cooler
return line) until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove the rubber return hose from the remaining steel
cooler line. 9. Remove the rubber hoses and reinstall the transmission fluid cooler bypass valve.
Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler - 4R70E,4R75E
Special Tools
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 6050
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Using the special tool, disconnect the fluid cooler tube from the auxiliary transmission fluid
cooler.
3. Using the special tool, disconnect the fluid cooler tube from the auxiliary transmission fluid
cooler.
4. Remove the pushpin retainers and remove the air deflector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 6051
5. Remove the 3 bolts and remove the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler.
Installation
1. Install the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler and install the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
2. Position the air deflector and install the pushpin retainers.
3. Connect the fluid cooler tubes into the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler. 4. Fill the transmission
with the specified type and quantity of transmission fluid. 5. Check for leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6059
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6060
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6061
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6062
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6063
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6064
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6065
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6066
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6067
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6068
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6069
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6070
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6071
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6072
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6073
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6074
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6075
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6076
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Mount: > 06-5-1 > Mar > 06 >
Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition
Transmission Mount: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition
TSB 06-5-1
03/20/06
COLD START ROUGH IDLE EXPEDITION 4X2 ONLY
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition 4x2 vehicles may exhibit an idle vibration during cold start at
1400 RPM, that lasts for a few seconds. The symptom is perceived as shaking of the entire vehicle
when the engine is first started after being off for an extended period of time in warm weather in
excess of a few hours, such as overnight, with ambient temperatures greater than 60° F (16° C).
The issue is not typically accompanied by unusual engine or fan noise. It is independent of air
conditioning compressor engagement (bumps, bangs, or thumps) and air suspension pump
operation (audible hum or buzz accompanied by an associated vibration).
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to resolve the concern.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using normal Workshop Manual diagnostics:
a. Verify the integrity of the fuel system (fuel injectors, fuel pump, fuel quality) and repair as
necessary.
b. Check ignition system (spark plugs, ignition coils), mechanical engine operation, and repair as
necessary.
2. Check the engine assembly exhaust mounting systems for ground-outs, damage, and repair as
necessary.
3. If no concerns are found or cold start symptoms continue, reprogram the powertrain control
module (PCM) to the latest calibration using WDS release B41.10 and higher or B42.1 and higher.
This new calibration is not included in the B42 CD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
COLD ENGINE IDLE SPEED WILL DROP TO 1250 RPM AND WARM DRIVE IDLE SPEED WILL
INCREASE TO 650 RPM. THIS CALIBRATION IS MATCHED TO THE SERVICE
ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS LISTED IN THIS TSB. DO NOT RE-INSTALL THE
ORIGINAL ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS AFTER PERFORMING THIS RECALIBRATION.
4. Replace the left hand and right hand engine mounts. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section
303-01 - Engine Support Insulators
5. Replace the transmission mount. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 307-01B - Transmission
Insulator & Retainer
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
060501A 2005 Expedition 4X2: 3.7 Hrs. Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount,
Reprogram The Powertrain Control Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84,
050415A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Mount: > 06-5-1 > Mar > 06 >
Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition > Page 6085
052301A)
060501B 2006 Expedition 4X2: 3.6 Hrs.
Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount, Reprogram The Powertrain Control
Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84, 050415A, 052301A)
MT060501 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Mount: > 06-5-1 >
Mar > 06 > Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition
Transmission Mount: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle
Condition
TSB 06-5-1
03/20/06
COLD START ROUGH IDLE EXPEDITION 4X2 ONLY
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition 4x2 vehicles may exhibit an idle vibration during cold start at
1400 RPM, that lasts for a few seconds. The symptom is perceived as shaking of the entire vehicle
when the engine is first started after being off for an extended period of time in warm weather in
excess of a few hours, such as overnight, with ambient temperatures greater than 60° F (16° C).
The issue is not typically accompanied by unusual engine or fan noise. It is independent of air
conditioning compressor engagement (bumps, bangs, or thumps) and air suspension pump
operation (audible hum or buzz accompanied by an associated vibration).
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to resolve the concern.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using normal Workshop Manual diagnostics:
a. Verify the integrity of the fuel system (fuel injectors, fuel pump, fuel quality) and repair as
necessary.
b. Check ignition system (spark plugs, ignition coils), mechanical engine operation, and repair as
necessary.
2. Check the engine assembly exhaust mounting systems for ground-outs, damage, and repair as
necessary.
3. If no concerns are found or cold start symptoms continue, reprogram the powertrain control
module (PCM) to the latest calibration using WDS release B41.10 and higher or B42.1 and higher.
This new calibration is not included in the B42 CD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
COLD ENGINE IDLE SPEED WILL DROP TO 1250 RPM AND WARM DRIVE IDLE SPEED WILL
INCREASE TO 650 RPM. THIS CALIBRATION IS MATCHED TO THE SERVICE
ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS LISTED IN THIS TSB. DO NOT RE-INSTALL THE
ORIGINAL ENGINE/TRANSMISSION MOUNTS AFTER PERFORMING THIS RECALIBRATION.
4. Replace the left hand and right hand engine mounts. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section
303-01 - Engine Support Insulators
5. Replace the transmission mount. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 307-01B - Transmission
Insulator & Retainer
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
060501A 2005 Expedition 4X2: 3.7 Hrs. Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount,
Reprogram The Powertrain Control Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84,
050415A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Mount: > 06-5-1 >
Mar > 06 > Engine Controls - Cold Start Rough Idle Condition > Page 6091
052301A)
060501B 2006 Expedition 4X2: 3.6 Hrs.
Replace Both Engine Mounts, and Transmission Mount, Reprogram The Powertrain Control
Module (Do Not Use With 6038A, 6068A, 12650D, 12650D84, 050415A, 052301A)
MT060501 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6092
Transmission Mount: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Transmission Insulator and Retainer Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the rear transmission support nuts. 3. Install a suitable transmission Jack.
4. Slightly raise the rear of the transmission and remove the bolts. Remove the rear transmission
mount.
Installation
1. Install the rear transmission mount and the bolts.
^ Tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6093
2. Lower the transmission onto the crossmember and install the nuts.
^ Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 6097
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6100
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6101
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6102
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6103
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6104
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6105
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6106
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6107
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6108
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6109
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6110
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6111
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6112
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6113
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6114
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6115
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6116
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6117
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6118
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
4R70E/4R75E Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Adjustment
Special Tools
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual lever shift control cable.
3. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6119
4. Loosen the digital transmission range (TR) sensor bolts.
5. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
6. CAUTION: Tightening one bolt before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor and tighten the bolts in an alternating sequence.
^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Install the manual control lever.
^ Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual lever shaft outer nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6120
8. With the manual lever in overdrive connect the shift lever control cable. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6121
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tools
Removal
NOTE: Manual shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6122
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual control lever shift control cable.
3. Disconnect the digital TR electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
5. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the digital TR sensor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6123
1. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
2. Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
3. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6124
5. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
6. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Pressure Test
Port, A/T > Component Information > Locations > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Air Pressure Test
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Pressure Test
Port, A/T > Component Information > Locations > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 6129
Transmission Air Test Plate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 6134
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 6135
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 6136
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6139
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6140
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6141
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6142
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6143
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6144
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6145
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6146
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6147
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6148
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6149
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6150
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6151
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6152
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6153
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6154
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6155
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6156
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Views
C193
C143
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6157
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Speed Sensors
Speed Sensors
NOTE: Only remove the affected sensor.
Removal All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist,
OSS sensor
2. Disconnect the output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the OSS
sensor bolt. 4. Remove the OSS sensor.
TSS sensor
5. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the TSS
sensor bolt. 7. Remove the TSS sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6158
Installation TSS sensor
1. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the TSS sensor. 2. Install the TSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
OSS sensor
4. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the OSS sensor. 5. Install the OSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
6. Connect the OSS sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Body: > 09-20-14 > Oct > 09 > A/T Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift
Valve Body: Customer Interest A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift
TSB 09-20-14
10/19/09
UN-COMMANDED TCC APPLY ON THE 1-2 SHIFT CAUSING PERCEPTION OF HESITATION
AND/OR LACK OF POWER DURING SHIFT
FORD: 2005-2010 Crown Victoria 2005-2006 Expedition 2005-2010 E-150, E-250, E-350, F-150
LINCOLN: 2005-2010 Town Car 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2005-2010 Grand Marquis
This article supersedes TSB 6-22-7 to update the Issue Statement, vehicle model years and model
line covered.
ISSUE Some 2005-2010 vehicles equipped with a 4R70/75E-W transmission may experience an
un-commanded torque converter clutch (TCC) apply or TCC partial apply immediately after the 1-2
shift. This may result in the perception that the vehicle lacks power or that the transmission is
up-shifting too early. Additional symptoms of uncommanded TCC apply when coming to a stop
(before the 2-1 downshift is commanded), are engine stalling or lugging when engaging manual
2nd while at a stop and code P1742 may be present in continuous memory. However, the vehicle
should operate normally in park, reverse, neutral and manual 1st gear.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure for verification and repair.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Monitor (TCC %) solenoid command state - duty cycle and (TC SLIP ACT) torque converter
clutch slippage - RPM, while in 2nd, 3rd or 4th gear
with a TCC % reading 0.
a. If TCC % = 0 and TC SLIP ACT = less than 20 RPM then inspect the number 7 check ball in the
main control valve body for damage. Replace
as required following the appropriate Workshop Manual (WSM) under Disassembly and Assembly
of Subassemblies - Main Control Valve Body. (Figure 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Body: > 09-20-14 > Oct > 09 > A/T Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift > Page 6167
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS PERFORMED IN 2ND GEAR AUTO (NOT MANUAL 2). MONITOR (TC
SLIP ACT) AFTER THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) COMMANDS 2ND GEAR
AND BEFORE THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS) READS 35 MPH (56 KM/H).
b. If you receive any other reading, this procedure does not apply; follow normal diagnostic
procedures as outlined in the appropriate WSM.
NOTE
IT IS NORMAL FOR THE PCM TO COMMAND 4TH GEAR AT SPEEDS AS LOW AS 19 MPH (30
KM/H) WITH LIGHT ACCELERATION WHEN THE THROTTLE POSITION IS LESS THEN 20%.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092014A 2005-2010 Crown Victoria, 2.3 Hrs.
Grand Marquis, Town Car, Econoline 150/250/350, 2005-2006 Expedition: Includes Time To
Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor
Operations)
092014A 2005-2010 F-150, 2.2 Hrs.
2006-2008 Mark LT: Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7E195 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 09-20-14 > Oct >
09 > A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift
TSB 09-20-14
10/19/09
UN-COMMANDED TCC APPLY ON THE 1-2 SHIFT CAUSING PERCEPTION OF HESITATION
AND/OR LACK OF POWER DURING SHIFT
FORD: 2005-2010 Crown Victoria 2005-2006 Expedition 2005-2010 E-150, E-250, E-350, F-150
LINCOLN: 2005-2010 Town Car 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2005-2010 Grand Marquis
This article supersedes TSB 6-22-7 to update the Issue Statement, vehicle model years and model
line covered.
ISSUE Some 2005-2010 vehicles equipped with a 4R70/75E-W transmission may experience an
un-commanded torque converter clutch (TCC) apply or TCC partial apply immediately after the 1-2
shift. This may result in the perception that the vehicle lacks power or that the transmission is
up-shifting too early. Additional symptoms of uncommanded TCC apply when coming to a stop
(before the 2-1 downshift is commanded), are engine stalling or lugging when engaging manual
2nd while at a stop and code P1742 may be present in continuous memory. However, the vehicle
should operate normally in park, reverse, neutral and manual 1st gear.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure for verification and repair.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Monitor (TCC %) solenoid command state - duty cycle and (TC SLIP ACT) torque converter
clutch slippage - RPM, while in 2nd, 3rd or 4th gear
with a TCC % reading 0.
a. If TCC % = 0 and TC SLIP ACT = less than 20 RPM then inspect the number 7 check ball in the
main control valve body for damage. Replace
as required following the appropriate Workshop Manual (WSM) under Disassembly and Assembly
of Subassemblies - Main Control Valve Body. (Figure 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 09-20-14 > Oct >
09 > A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2 Upshift > Page 6173
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS PERFORMED IN 2ND GEAR AUTO (NOT MANUAL 2). MONITOR (TC
SLIP ACT) AFTER THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) COMMANDS 2ND GEAR
AND BEFORE THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS) READS 35 MPH (56 KM/H).
b. If you receive any other reading, this procedure does not apply; follow normal diagnostic
procedures as outlined in the appropriate WSM.
NOTE
IT IS NORMAL FOR THE PCM TO COMMAND 4TH GEAR AT SPEEDS AS LOW AS 19 MPH (30
KM/H) WITH LIGHT ACCELERATION WHEN THE THROTTLE POSITION IS LESS THEN 20%.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092014A 2005-2010 Crown Victoria, 2.3 Hrs.
Grand Marquis, Town Car, Econoline 150/250/350, 2005-2006 Expedition: Includes Time To
Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor
Operations)
092014A 2005-2010 F-150, 2.2 Hrs.
2006-2008 Mark LT: Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7E195 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6174
Valve Body: Locations
Check Ball Location
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6175
Main Control Valve Body Disassembled View (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6176
Main Control Valve Body Disassembled View (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6177
Main Control Valve Body Disassembled View (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6178
Valve Body: Diagrams
Main Control Valve Body Disassembled View (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6179
Main Control Valve Body Disassembled View (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6180
Main Control Valve Body Disassembled View (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E
Valve Body: Service and Repair 4R70E/4R75E
Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6183
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6184
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Main Control Valve Body
Main Control Valve Body
Special Tools
Removal
1. Drain transmission fluid and remove the transmission fluid pan and filter. For additional
information, refer to Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6185
Check Ball Location
2. CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector
ends. Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to
disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids. 1
Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead inter-connector.
3. Remove the manual control valve detent lever bolt and spring.
4. Remove the 24 valve body-to-case bolts and the EPC bracket bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6186
5. Remove the main control valve body and discard the pump outlet screen.
Installation
1. NOTE: Make sure that the drive pin of the manual valve detent lever assembly engages the
manual valve in the correct location prior to installing
the bolts.
Position the main control valve body gasket and main control valve body using 2 bolts as a guide.
2. NOTE: The main control valve body bolts will be tightened in later steps.
Loosely install the long main control valve body bolts.
3. NOTE: The main control valve body bolts will be tightened in later steps.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6187
Loosely install the 12 short main control valve body bolts.
4. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Position the EPC solenoid bracket and loosely install the bolt.
5. Install the manual control valve detent lever spring and loosely install the bolt.
6. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6188
7. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact, install a new lead frame.
8. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
^ Connect the bulkhead inter-connector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
^ Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
^ Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
^ Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
^ Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
9. Install the transmission filter and pan.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6189
Valve Body: Service and Repair 6HP26
Main Control Valve Body
Special Tools
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pull on the wire harness to disconnect the connector or damage to the
connector will occur.
Disconnect the main transmission electrical harness by twisting the outer shell and pulling back on
the connector.
3. Remove and discard the transmission fluid pan drain plug and allow the fluid to drain.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6190
4. Install a new fluid pan drain plug.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
5. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan, gasket, filter and magnets are serviced as a complete unit.
Remove the transmission fluid pan assembly.
6. Press the release tab and pull down on the bulkhead connector retainer.
7. With the release tab down, pull the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6191
8. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins. Electrostatic charge may occur and will
cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Pull the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector out of the transmission.
9. Remove the 10 bolts from the mechatronic assembly and remove the mechatronic assembly.
Installation
1. Position the mechatronic assembly in place and loosely install the 10 retaining bolts.
2. Tighten the mechatronic bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6192
3. Install new O-rings seals on the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins.
Electrostatic charge may occur and will cause damage to the mechatronic unit. With the release
tab down, push the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector into the transmission.
5. Press up on the tab and lock the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector in place.
6. Install the fluid pan.
^ Tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6193
7. Connect the main transmission electrical harness by pushing it in and twisting the outer shell to
lock it in place.
8. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Remove the fluid fill plug. ^
The fill plug is located on the RH rear side of the case near the transmission electrical connector.
9. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate correctly or transmission
failure.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add 4.7 liters (5 quarts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid
fill hole. Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4R70E/4R75E > Page 6194
10. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Install the fluid fill plug. ^
Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
11. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 12. With the engine idling (600 - 750 rpm) in PARK and the
transmission temperature at 30°C - 50°C (86°F - 122°F), check and adjust the
transmission fluid level.
13. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this
procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
With the engine still running in PARK, check the fluid level. ^
If more fluid is needed, remove the fluid fill plug and fill with clean automatic transmission fluid until
the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
14. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Differential Oil Capacity
FRONT AXLE ......................................................................................................................................
................................. 3.5 - 3.7 pints (1.8 - 2.0 liters)
REAR AXLE Conventional differential .................................................................................................
..................................................................... 4.5 pints (2.13 liters) Limited-slip differential .................
..................................................................................................................................................... 4.25
pints (2.01 liters)
NOTE: Your vehicles rear axle is filled with a synthetic rear axle lubricant and is considered
lubricated for life. These lubricants are not to be checked or changed unless a leak is suspected,
service is required or the axle has been submerged in water. The axle lubricant should be changed
any time the axle has been submerged in water.
NOTE: Add 4 oz. (118 ml) of Additive Friction Modifier XL-3 (or equivalent) for complete refill of
Ford Limited Slip axles.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 6200
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Differential Fluid Type
REAR AXLE Motorcraft SAE 75W-140 Synthetic Rear Axle Lube Ford P/N ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
. XY-75W140-QL Ford Specification ...................................................................................................
................................................................................... WSL-M2C192-A
FRONT AXLE Motorcraft SAE 80W-90 Premium Rear Axle Lube Ford P/N ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... XY-80W90-QL Ford Specification ...................................................................................................
................................................................................... WSP-M2C197-A
NOTE: Add 4.0 oz. (118 ml) of Additive Friction Modifier XL-3 or equivalent for complete refill of
Ford Limited Slip rear axles.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair
Differential Output Shaft Bearing: Service and Repair
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Special Tools
Material
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6205
2. NOTE: If removing the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal only, engage the tangs of the special tool
on the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
Using the special tools, remove the stub shaft pilot bearing and the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
1
Firmly engage the tangs of the special tool on the stub shaft pilot bearing.
2 Remove the bearing and the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
3. Inspect the seal Journal for rust, nicks and scratches. Polish the seal journal surface with fine
crocus cloth, if necessary. 4. Lubricate the new stub shaft pilot bearing with axle lubricant.
5. CAUTION: Installation of the stub shaft pilot bearing or stub shaft oil seat without the correct
tools can result in early bearing or seal failure. If
the stub shaft pilot bearing becomes cocked in the bore during installation, remove it and install a
new one.
Place the stub shaft pilot bearing onto the special tools.
6. Install the stub shaft pilot bearing into the rear axle housing bore.
7. NOTE: Do not disassemble the new oil seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6206
Install the seal onto the special tools.
8. Carefully align the stub shaft pilot bearing seal with the housing bore and install the stub shaft
pilot bearing seal flush in the differential housing.
^ Strike only the handle. Directly striking the installer tool will damage the seal.
9. Remove and discard the halfshaft excluder seal, if equipped.
10. CAUTION: Inspect the stub shaft seal journal for rust, nicks or scratches prior to installing the
halfshaft. Polish the seat journal with fine crocus
cloth, if required.
Install the halfshaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Pinion Flange: Service and Repair Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Drive Pinion Flange and Drive Pinion Seal
Special Tools
Materials
Removal
CAUTION: Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies, brake calipers and brake discs to prevent
brake drag during the drive pinion bearing preload adjustment.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6211
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the RH kick
panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which
can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury and vehicle damage.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist. For additional information refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies.
3. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose. Provide a suitable
support.
Remove the rear brake calipers and the brake discs. Position the brake calipers aside.
4. Remove the rear driveshaft assembly.
5. Install a Nm (inch lbs.) torque wrench on the nut and record the torque necessary to maintain
rotation of the drive pinion gear through several
revolutions.
6. CAUTION: After removing the pinion nut, discard it. Use a new nut for installation.
Use the special tool to hold the pinion flange while removing the pinion nut.
7. Index-mark the drive pinion flange and the drive pinion gear stem to maintain initial balance
during installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6212
8. Using the special tool, remove the drive pinion flange.
9. Force up on the metal flange of the drive pinion seal. Install gripping pliers and strike with a
hammer until the pinion seal is removed.
Installation
1. Lubricate the lips of the new drive pinion seal with grease.
2. CAUTION: If the drive pinion seal becomes misaligned during installation, remove it and install a
new seal.
Using the special tool, install the drive pinion seal.
3. Lubricate the drive pinion flange splines with rear axle lubricant.
4. NOTE: Disregard the index marks if installing a new drive pinion flange.
Position the drive pinion flange.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6213
5. Using the special tool, install the drive pinion flange.
6. Position the new drive pinion nut.
7. CAUTION: Do not under any circumstance loosen the nut to reduce preload. If it is necessary to
reduce preload, install a new drive pinion
collapsible spacer and nut.
CAUTION: Remove the special tool while taking preload readings with the Nm (inch-pound) torque
wrench.
Use the special tool to hold the pinion flange while tightening the nut. ^
Rotate the pinion occasionally to make sure the pinion bearings seat correctly. Take frequent
pinion bearing torque preload readings by rotating the drive pinion gear with a Nm (inch lbs.) torque
wrench.
^ If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is lower than the specification for used bearings,
tighten the nut to specification. If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is higher than the
specification for used bearings, tighten the nut to the original reading as recorded.
^ Refer to the torque specification for used pinion bearings.
8. CAUTION: Install the driveshaft with new bolts. If new bolts are not available, apply seater to the
threads of the original bolts.
CAUTION: Align the index marks.
CAUTION: The driveshaft flange yoke fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. To make sure that the
yoke seats squarely on the flange, tighten the bolts evenly in a cross pattern as shown.
Install the rear driveshaft.
9. Install the rear brake discs and the brake calipers.
10. Install the rear wheel and tire assemblies. 11. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6214
12. If equipped with air suspension, reactivate the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6215
Pinion Flange: Service and Repair Ford 8.8-Inch - Front Drive Axle/Differential
Drive Pinion Seal
Special Tools
Removal
1. Remove the front axle universal joint flange.
2. CAUTION: Do not damage the front axle housing. Force up on the metal flange of the rear axle
drive pinion seal.
Install gripping pliers and strike with a hammer to remove the pinion seal.
Installation
1. Clean the pinion seal bore and use the Drive Pinion Oil Seal Installer to install the pinion seal. 2.
Install the front axle universal joint flange.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Special Tools
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6220
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly.
2. NOTE: If removing the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal only, engage the tangs of the special tool
on the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
Using the special tools, remove the stub shaft pilot bearing and the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
1
Firmly engage the tangs of the special tool on the stub shaft pilot bearing.
2 Remove the bearing and the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
3. Inspect the seal Journal for rust, nicks and scratches. Polish the seal journal surface with fine
crocus cloth, if necessary. 4. Lubricate the new stub shaft pilot bearing with axle lubricant.
5. CAUTION: Installation of the stub shaft pilot bearing or stub shaft oil seat without the correct
tools can result in early bearing or seal failure. If
the stub shaft pilot bearing becomes cocked in the bore during installation, remove it and install a
new one.
Place the stub shaft pilot bearing onto the special tools.
6. Install the stub shaft pilot bearing into the rear axle housing bore.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6221
7. NOTE: Do not disassemble the new oil seal.
Install the seal onto the special tools.
8. Carefully align the stub shaft pilot bearing seal with the housing bore and install the stub shaft
pilot bearing seal flush in the differential housing.
^ Strike only the handle. Directly striking the installer tool will damage the seal.
9. Remove and discard the halfshaft excluder seal, if equipped.
10. CAUTION: Inspect the stub shaft seal journal for rust, nicks or scratches prior to installing the
halfshaft. Polish the seat journal with fine crocus
cloth, if required.
Install the halfshaft.
Drive Pinion Flange and Drive Pinion Seal
Drive Pinion Flange and Drive Pinion Seal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6222
Special Tools
Materials
Removal
CAUTION: Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies, brake calipers and brake discs to prevent
brake drag during the drive pinion bearing preload adjustment.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the RH kick
panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which
can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury and vehicle damage.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist. For additional information refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6223
2. Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies.
3. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose. Provide a suitable
support.
Remove the rear brake calipers and the brake discs. Position the brake calipers aside.
4. Remove the rear driveshaft assembly.
5. Install a Nm (inch lbs.) torque wrench on the nut and record the torque necessary to maintain
rotation of the drive pinion gear through several
revolutions.
6. CAUTION: After removing the pinion nut, discard it. Use a new nut for installation.
Use the special tool to hold the pinion flange while removing the pinion nut.
7. Index-mark the drive pinion flange and the drive pinion gear stem to maintain initial balance
during installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6224
8. Using the special tool, remove the drive pinion flange.
9. Force up on the metal flange of the drive pinion seal. Install gripping pliers and strike with a
hammer until the pinion seal is removed.
Installation
1. Lubricate the lips of the new drive pinion seal with grease.
2. CAUTION: If the drive pinion seal becomes misaligned during installation, remove it and install a
new seal.
Using the special tool, install the drive pinion seal.
3. Lubricate the drive pinion flange splines with rear axle lubricant.
4. NOTE: Disregard the index marks if installing a new drive pinion flange.
Position the drive pinion flange.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6225
5. Using the special tool, install the drive pinion flange.
6. Position the new drive pinion nut.
7. CAUTION: Do not under any circumstance loosen the nut to reduce preload. If it is necessary to
reduce preload, install a new drive pinion
collapsible spacer and nut.
CAUTION: Remove the special tool while taking preload readings with the Nm (inch-pound) torque
wrench.
Use the special tool to hold the pinion flange while tightening the nut. ^
Rotate the pinion occasionally to make sure the pinion bearings seat correctly. Take frequent
pinion bearing torque preload readings by rotating the drive pinion gear with a Nm (inch lbs.) torque
wrench.
^ If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is lower than the specification for used bearings,
tighten the nut to specification. If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is higher than the
specification for used bearings, tighten the nut to the original reading as recorded.
^ Refer to the torque specification for used pinion bearings.
8. CAUTION: Install the driveshaft with new bolts. If new bolts are not available, apply seater to the
threads of the original bolts.
CAUTION: Align the index marks.
CAUTION: The driveshaft flange yoke fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. To make sure that the
yoke seats squarely on the flange, tighten the bolts evenly in a cross pattern as shown.
Install the rear driveshaft.
9. Install the rear brake discs and the brake calipers.
10. Install the rear wheel and tire assemblies. 11. Lower the vehicle. 12. If equipped with air
suspension, reactivate the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 6226
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Ford 8.8-Inch - Front Drive Axle/Differential
Drive Pinion Seal
Special Tools
Removal
1. Remove the front axle universal joint flange.
2. CAUTION: Do not damage the front axle housing. Force up on the metal flange of the rear axle
drive pinion seal.
Install gripping pliers and strike with a hammer to remove the pinion seal.
Installation
1. Clean the pinion seal bore and use the Drive Pinion Oil Seal Installer to install the pinion seal. 2.
Install the front axle universal joint flange.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Front Drive Halfshafts
Axle Shaft Assembly: Specifications Front Drive Halfshafts
General Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 6232
Axle Shaft Assembly: Specifications Rear Drive Halfshafts
General Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Drive Halfshafts
Axle Shaft Assembly: Description and Operation Front Drive Halfshafts
Front Drive Halfshafts
Front Wheel Halfshaft and Joint, Disassembled View
Front Wheel Halfshaft and Joint, Disassembled View
New halfshaft components are available as follows: ^
A repair kit includes the boots, clamps, snap ring, retaining ring and grease.
^ A new inboard CV joint (plunge-type).
^ A new outboard CV joint and interconnecting shaft assembly includes the outboard front wheel
halfshaft joint (fixed-type), boot and clamps.
^ A new integrated wheel end disconnect assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 6235
Axle Shaft Assembly: Description and Operation Rear Drive Halfshafts
Rear Drive Halfshafts
^ The RH and LH halfshafts are different lengths, with the LH halfshaft being the longer of the 2.
^ Inboard and outboard CV joints connect to a splined shaft.
^ An axle circlip retains the splined inboard CV joint to the differential side gear. Install a new axle
circlip every time the halfshaft is removed from the vehicle.
^ A rear axle wheel hub retainer secures the side shaft assembly (interconnecting shaft and
outboard CV joint) to the rear hub. Install a new rear axle wheel hub retainer every time you
remove the halfshaft from the vehicle.
Halfshaft Handling
CAUTION: Never pick up or hold the halfshaft by the inboard or outboard CV joint only.
NOTE: Only the inner CV joints are removable for installation of new CV boots and clamps. The
boots and clamps are the only serviced parts of the halfshaft assembly.
Handle all halfshaft components carefully during removal and installation procedures. ^
The halfshaft assemblies are not repairable. Install new assemblies if worn/damaged.
^ To separate the halfshaft from the rear hub, press the outboard CV joint from the rear hub.
^ To separate the halfshaft from the differential, apply a load to the back face of the inboard CV
joint assembly to overcome the axle circlip.
^ Do not over-angle the CV joints.
^ Install new differential stub shaft seals whenever the halfshafts are removed.
^ Damage will occur to an assembled inboard CV joint if it is over-plunged outward from the joint
housing.
^ Never use a hammer to remove or install the halfshafts.
^ Never use the halfshaft assembly as a lever to position other components. Always support the
free end of the halfshaft.
^ Do not allow the boots to contact sharp edges or hot exhaust components.
^ Handle the halfshaft by the interconnecting shaft only to avoid pull-apart and potential damage to
the CV joints.
^ Do not drop assembled halfshafts. The impact can cut the boots from the inside without evidence
of external damage.
Wheel and Tire Balancing, Rear
WARNING: Do not balance the rear wheels and tires while mounted on the vehicle.
Hoisting
CAUTION: Use a frame-contact hoist only. Vehicle or component damage can result if other types
of hoists are used.
Never raise the vehicle using the halfshafts as lift points.
Undercoating and Rustproofing
During undercoating and rustproofing procedures, protect the boots from the coating materials.
Foreign materials on the rubber boots will cause extreme advanced wear.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Axle Shaft Assembly: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Front Drive Halfshafts
Halfshaft Removal and Installation
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the left rear
quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs,
which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the front wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the dust cap.
4. Remove and discard the axle nut.
^ To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the vacuum/vent line at the vacuum/vent port of the integrated wheel end disconnect.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6238
6. Remove the 3 integrated wheel end (IWE) retaining bolts to the steering knuckle.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
7. Remove the tie-rod end nut.
^ Disconnect the tie-rod end from the steering knuckle.
^ Discard the tie-rod end nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
8. Remove the upper ball joint nut.
^ Disconnect the upper ball Joint from the steering knuckle.
^ Discard the upper ball joint nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
9. CAUTION: Do not damage the hub seal.
NOTE: Allow the steering knuckle to swing outboard while keeping the constant velocity shaft
pushed inboard.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6239
Once clearance is available, remove the constant velocity shaft Joint outboard end and integrated
wheel end disconnect from the steering knuckle hub bearing.
10. Remove the IWE disconnect from the outboard constant velocity joint housing.
11. Remove the 6 halfshaft-to-axle bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 82 Nm (60 ft. lbs.).
12. Separate the halfshaft from the axle and the hub, and remove the assembly from the vehicle.
13. CAUTION: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the
halfshaft nut.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Install a new axle nut, tie-rod end nut and an upper ball joint nut.
Rear Drive Halfshafts
Halfshaft
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6240
Special Tools
Removal and Installation
NOTE: This procedure applies to both rear halfshaft assemblies.
1. CAUTION: Do not loosen the rear axle wheel hub retainer until after the wheel and tire assembly
is removed from the vehicle. Wheel bearing
damage will occur if the wheel bearing is unloaded with the weight of the vehicle applied.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, raise and support the vehicle.
2. Remove the rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the rear axle wheel hub retainer and the washer. ^
To install, tighten to 345 Nm (254 ft. lbs.).
4. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the halfshaft from the knuckle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6241
5. Disconnect the toe link from the rear knuckle.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the bolt retaining the knuckle to the lower control arm.
^ To install, tighten to 400 Nm (295 ft. lbs.).
7. Pivot the rear knuckle on the upper control arm bolts and support the knuckle in a raised
position.
8. CAUTION: Do not damage the axle shaft oil seal or the machined sealing surface on the inboard
CV joint housing.
CAUTION: Do not allow the splines on inboard CV joint housing to touch the axle shaft oil seal.
NOTE: A circlip retains the inboard CV joint housing to the differential side gear in the axle.
Using the special tool, disengage the inboard CV joint housing from the differential side gear.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6242
9. Remove the halfshaft assembly from the vehicle.
10. Remove and discard the halfshaft retainer circlip.
11. Remove and discard the halfshaft excluder seal, if equipped.
^ Do not install a new excluder seal.
12. CAUTION: Always install a new differential stub shaft seal.
CAUTION: Always install the halfshaft with a new retainer circlip and a new rear axle wheel hub
retainer.
CAUTION: Never use power tools to tighten the rear axle wheel hub retainer.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6243
Axle Shaft Assembly: Service and Repair Disassembly and Assembly
Front Drive Halfshafts
Halfshaft
Special Tools
Material
Disassembly
1. Remove the halfshaft from the vehicle.
2. CAUTION: Do not damage the boot.
Remove the boot clamps.
3. Separate the boot from the inboard CV joint housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6244
4. Remove the retaining ring.
5. Remove the inboard CV joint housing.
6. Index-mark the inner race and ball cage.
7. Remove the 6 balls.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6245
8. Remove the snap ring.
9. Remove the inner race and the ball cage.
10. Remove the inboard boot.
11. Remove the boot clamps.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6246
12. Remove the outboard boot.
13. NOTE: If the grease is contaminated, clean and inspect the joint for wear. Install a new
outboard CV Joint and interconnecting shaft assembly if
worn/damaged.
Check the grease for contamination.
Assembly
1. Position the outboard boot on the shaft.
2. Pack the outboard CV Joint with 165 grams (5.82 ounces) of grease.
1 Use constant velocity joint grease or equivalent provided in the boot kit.
2 Spread any remaining grease from the kit evenly inside the boot.
3. Install the outboard boot.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6247
1 Clean the boot mounting surface.
2 Seat the boot in the Joint boot groove.
4. Make sure a shaft groove is exposed by positioning the small end of the boot in the groove
closest to the constant velocity joint housing.
5. Position the boot clamps.
6. NOTE: Tighten the through-bolt until the tool is in the CLOSED position.
Using the special tool, install the 2 boot clamps.
7. Position the boot clamp on the shaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6248
8. Position the inboard boot on the shaft.
9. Position the ball cage on the shaft with the tapered end facing the boot.
10. NOTE: Align the index marks.
Position the inner race on the shaft with the counterbored end facing the boot.
11. Install the snap ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6249
12. Lubricate and position the 6 balls.
^ Use constant velocity joint grease or equivalent provided in the boot kit.
13. Fill the inboard CV joint housing with 235 grams (8.29 ounces) of grease.
^ Use constant velocity joint grease or equivalent provided in the boot kit.
14. Make sure a shaft groove is exposed by positioning the small end of the boot in the groove
closest to the constant velocity joint housing.
15. Position the boot clamp on the inboard CV Joint housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6250
16. Position the inboard CV Joint housing on the ball and race assembly.
17. Install the retaining ring.
18. Remove any excess grease from the mating surface. Seat the boot in the joint boot groove.
19. Set the halfshaft assembled length to specification.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6251
20. CAUTION: Do not damage the boot.
Insert a dull screwdriver blade under the boot to release the pressure.
21. NOTE: Tighten the through-bolt until the tool is in the closed position.
Using the special tool, install the 2 boot clamps.
22. NOTE: Maintain a clean work surface.
Compress the integrated wheel end disconnect on the bench to collapse the vacuum chamber.
23. While the integrated wheel end disconnect is collapsed, install a vacuum cap on the vacuum
port.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6252
24. CAUTION: Do not install the integrated wheel end disconnect in the knuckle. It must be
installed on the outer constant velocity joint housing.
Install the integrated wheel end disconnect on the outer constant velocity Joint housing.
25. CAUTION: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the
halfshaft nut.
Install the halfshaft in the vehicle.
Rear Drive Halfshafts
Halfshaft Joint
Special Tools
Materials
Disassembly
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly from the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6253
2. For the inboard CV joint, carry out the following:
1 Remove and discard the boot clamps.
1 Use diagonal cutters to cut the clamp.
2 Remove the inboard CV joint housing.
3. NOTE: Install the halfshaft in a soft-jaw vise.
For the inboard CV joint, carry out the following: 1
Remove and discard the retainer circlip.
2 Slide the boot away from the CV joint.
4. Using a suitable 3-jaw puller, remove the CV joint.
5. Remove and discard the tri-lobe insert and the boot.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6254
6. NOTE: The outboard CV joint is not removable from the halfshaft. The boot must be removed or
installed from the inboard CV joint side of the
shaft.
For the outboard CV joint, carry out the following: 1
Remove and discard the boot clamps.
2 Remove and discard the boot.
7. Inspect the grease, packed in the inboard CV joint and the outboard CV Joint, for contamination.
Rub some of the grease from each joint between
2 fingers. Any gritty feeling indicates contamination. Wash all of the grease from the inboard CV
joint, the inboard CV joint housing, the outboard CV Joint and the interconnecting shaft. Thoroughly
dry all of the components and inspect them for wear or damage.
Discard the assembly, if necessary. Only proceed as follows if not discarding the assembly.
8. On the inboard end, remove and discard the retainer circlip.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Clean any excess grease from the boot mounting surfaces before installing the boot.
For the outboard CV joint, carry out the following: 1
Slide the boot on the interconnecting shaft.
2 Pack the outboard CV joint with 275 grams (9.7 ounces) of grease.
3 Spread any remaining grease evenly inside the boot.
4 Install the boot by seating it in the groove in the CV joint housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6255
2. NOTE: Tighten the through-bolt until the special tool is in the closed position.
Using the special tool, install both boot clamps.
3. NOTE: Install the halfshaft in a soft-jaw vise.
NOTE: The lip on the end of the tri-lobe insert must seat against the end of the boot.
For the inboard CV joint, carry out the following: 1
Position the clamp on the interconnecting shaft.
2 Position the boot on the interconnecting shaft.
3 Install the tri-lobe insert.
4. NOTE: One side of the inboard CV joint has a chamfer cut in the edge of joint at the inner
diameter near the splines.
Install the inboard CV Joint so that the chamfer faces the outboard end of the halfshaft. Install the
CV joint.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6256
5. Install the retainer circlip.
6. NOTE: Clean any excess grease from the boot mounting surfaces before installing the boot.
For the inboard CV joint, carry out the following: 1
Pack the inboard CV joint housing with 325 grams (11.5 ounces) of grease.
2 Spread any remaining grease evenly inside the boot and on the CV joint.
3 Install the inboard CV Joint housing, seating the boot in the groove in the housing.
7. Set the halfshaft assembled length to specification.
1 Measure the entire assembly length.
2 Push in or pull out on the inner joint as necessary to adjust the halfshaft assembled length to
specification.
3 Hold the inner joint to prevent the assembled length from changing, and insert a small flat-blade
screwdriver between the boot and the Joint to equalize the pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6257
8. NOTE: Tighten the through-bolt until the special tool is in the closed position.
Using the special tool, install both boot clamps.
9. CAUTION: Do not over expand or twist the circlip during installation.
Install a new retainer circlip.
10. Install the halfshaft assembly in the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3 > Sep > 08
> Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
Seals and Gaskets: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
TSB 08-19-3
09/29/08
UNITIZED SEAL DIAGNOSIS - LEAK / GREASE OIL SEPARATION - AXLE BEARING SEAL 8.8
IFS, 8.8 IRS, AND 9.75 IRS AXLES
FORD: 2002-2008 Explorer 2003-2008 Expedition 2006-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2003-2005 Aviator 2003-2008 Navigator
MERCURY: 2002-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-05 to update the model years, Part List and Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Explorer, Explorer Sport Track, and Mountaineer
vehicles equipped with rear axle unitized cartridge seal, 2007-2008 Expedition-Navigator AWD
equipped with front and rear axle unitized cartridge seal.
2003-2005 Expedition-Navigator, 2002-2005, Explorer-Mountaineer, 2003-2005 Aviator equipped
with unitized cartridge rear axle seal, may exhibit oil separation from the internal lube found in the
unitized cartridge seal. This oil separation appears to be, and is often misdiagnosed, as an axle
lube leak. The majority of the vehicles with this condition will be located in northern Canada and
Alaska due to the extreme cold weather.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL UNTIL YOU COMPLETE THIS
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE. FAILURE TO PROPERLY DIAGNOSE THE ISSUE MAY
RESULT IN UNNECESSARILY REPLACING THE SEAL, RESULTING IN A REPEAT CONCERN.
NOTE
THIS DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE IS ONLY NECESSARY ON VEHICLES WITH THE NEW
UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL. THIS SEAL HAS BEEN USED IN PRODUCTION FROM 2006
MODEL YEAR TO PRESENT, HOWEVER, SOME VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 2006 MODEL
YEAR MAY HAVE THIS NEW UPDATED UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL INSTALLED AS A
SERVICE
REPAIR.
1. Raise vehicle, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-02.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3 > Sep > 08
> Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 6266
NOTE
IF SEAL IS OLD DESIGN RADIAL LIP SEAL STYLE, (SEE FIGURES 1 AND 2 TO IDENTIFY
RADIAL LIP SEAL) THERE IS NO INTERNAL GREASE PRESENT IN SEAL TO SEPARATE.
THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTIC.
2. Check axle half shaft seal to ensure that it is unitized cartridge design.
3. Clean axle housing around the seal area using Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner or
equivalent cleaner. Wipe lube or oil with rag and let the housing dry.
4. Add 0.5 to 1 ounce (14.8 to 29.6 ml) Rotunda Dye-Lite® Leak Detection Dye for Gasoline Engine
Oil 164-R3700, also contained in 164-R0756 to the axle following the appropriate Workshop
Manual.
NOTE
ADDING THE DYE ON SOME VEHICLES WILL REQUIRE THE REAR WHEEL ABS SPEED
SENSOR TO BE REMOVED. REFER TO THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL DRAIN
AND FILL PROCEDURE.
5. Road test vehicle a minimum distance 15 miles (24 km) at a minimum speed of 25 MPH (40
Km/h).
NOTE
A BRIGHT ORANGE AREA WILL IDENTIFY AXLE LUBE LEAK. FOR EXTREMELY SMALL OIL
SEPARATION, ADDITIONAL AXLE OPERATION TIME MAY BE REQUIRED FOR THE LEAK TO
APPEAR.
6. Raise vehicle to check for signs of leak.
a. Use Rotunda 12V Master UV Leak Detector Kit 164-R0756 or equivalent to look for signs of
leak.
7. If there is not a verifiable lube leak, clean axle near seal area and return the vehicle to the
customer.
NOTE
IF THERE IS NO SIGNS OF LUBE LEAK, THIS MEANS THAT THE SUBSTANCE WHICH WAS
PRESENT PRIOR TO THE PROCEDURE WAS OIL WHICH HAD SEPARATED FROM THE
GREASE INTERNAL TO THE SEAL. THIS OIL IS A PRE-LUBE, AND IS NOT NECESSARY
ONCE THE AXLE SEAL IS BROKEN IN. ONCE THE OIL SEPARATION HAS OCCURRED,
THERE SHOULD BE NO
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3 > Sep > 08
> Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 6267
FURTHER OIL SEPARATION FROM THE SEAL. REMOVING THE SEAL AND INSTALLING A
NEW SEAL MIGHT CREATE A SITUATION WHERE THE OIL WILL SEPARATE, RESULTING IN
THE SAME CONCERN.
8. If there is a verifiable axle lube leak, replace seal following the Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 205, or look at instruction sheet included in Axle Shaft Seal Kit.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081903A 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks. Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With
4139A, 4139A2)
081903A 2002-2008 Explorer, 0.7 Hr.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, 2002-2005 Aviator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks.
Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of
The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903B 2003-2008 Expedition 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903C 2003-2008 Expedition 2.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903D 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3 > Sep > 08
> Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 6268
Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed
With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2006-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac :Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time
To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2002-2005 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Mountaineer:Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2003-2005 Aviator:Replace 0.8 Hr.
Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903E 2006-2008 Explorer, 2.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To
Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2002-2005 Explorer, 1.5 Hrs.
Mountaineer: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3 > Sep > 08
> Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 6269
4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2005 Aviator: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides.
This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4A109 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3
> Sep > 08 > Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
TSB 08-19-3
09/29/08
UNITIZED SEAL DIAGNOSIS - LEAK / GREASE OIL SEPARATION - AXLE BEARING SEAL 8.8
IFS, 8.8 IRS, AND 9.75 IRS AXLES
FORD: 2002-2008 Explorer 2003-2008 Expedition 2006-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2003-2005 Aviator 2003-2008 Navigator
MERCURY: 2002-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-05 to update the model years, Part List and Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Explorer, Explorer Sport Track, and Mountaineer
vehicles equipped with rear axle unitized cartridge seal, 2007-2008 Expedition-Navigator AWD
equipped with front and rear axle unitized cartridge seal.
2003-2005 Expedition-Navigator, 2002-2005, Explorer-Mountaineer, 2003-2005 Aviator equipped
with unitized cartridge rear axle seal, may exhibit oil separation from the internal lube found in the
unitized cartridge seal. This oil separation appears to be, and is often misdiagnosed, as an axle
lube leak. The majority of the vehicles with this condition will be located in northern Canada and
Alaska due to the extreme cold weather.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL UNTIL YOU COMPLETE THIS
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE. FAILURE TO PROPERLY DIAGNOSE THE ISSUE MAY
RESULT IN UNNECESSARILY REPLACING THE SEAL, RESULTING IN A REPEAT CONCERN.
NOTE
THIS DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE IS ONLY NECESSARY ON VEHICLES WITH THE NEW
UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL. THIS SEAL HAS BEEN USED IN PRODUCTION FROM 2006
MODEL YEAR TO PRESENT, HOWEVER, SOME VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 2006 MODEL
YEAR MAY HAVE THIS NEW UPDATED UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL INSTALLED AS A
SERVICE
REPAIR.
1. Raise vehicle, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-02.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3
> Sep > 08 > Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 6275
NOTE
IF SEAL IS OLD DESIGN RADIAL LIP SEAL STYLE, (SEE FIGURES 1 AND 2 TO IDENTIFY
RADIAL LIP SEAL) THERE IS NO INTERNAL GREASE PRESENT IN SEAL TO SEPARATE.
THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTIC.
2. Check axle half shaft seal to ensure that it is unitized cartridge design.
3. Clean axle housing around the seal area using Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner or
equivalent cleaner. Wipe lube or oil with rag and let the housing dry.
4. Add 0.5 to 1 ounce (14.8 to 29.6 ml) Rotunda Dye-Lite® Leak Detection Dye for Gasoline Engine
Oil 164-R3700, also contained in 164-R0756 to the axle following the appropriate Workshop
Manual.
NOTE
ADDING THE DYE ON SOME VEHICLES WILL REQUIRE THE REAR WHEEL ABS SPEED
SENSOR TO BE REMOVED. REFER TO THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL DRAIN
AND FILL PROCEDURE.
5. Road test vehicle a minimum distance 15 miles (24 km) at a minimum speed of 25 MPH (40
Km/h).
NOTE
A BRIGHT ORANGE AREA WILL IDENTIFY AXLE LUBE LEAK. FOR EXTREMELY SMALL OIL
SEPARATION, ADDITIONAL AXLE OPERATION TIME MAY BE REQUIRED FOR THE LEAK TO
APPEAR.
6. Raise vehicle to check for signs of leak.
a. Use Rotunda 12V Master UV Leak Detector Kit 164-R0756 or equivalent to look for signs of
leak.
7. If there is not a verifiable lube leak, clean axle near seal area and return the vehicle to the
customer.
NOTE
IF THERE IS NO SIGNS OF LUBE LEAK, THIS MEANS THAT THE SUBSTANCE WHICH WAS
PRESENT PRIOR TO THE PROCEDURE WAS OIL WHICH HAD SEPARATED FROM THE
GREASE INTERNAL TO THE SEAL. THIS OIL IS A PRE-LUBE, AND IS NOT NECESSARY
ONCE THE AXLE SEAL IS BROKEN IN. ONCE THE OIL SEPARATION HAS OCCURRED,
THERE SHOULD BE NO
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3
> Sep > 08 > Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 6276
FURTHER OIL SEPARATION FROM THE SEAL. REMOVING THE SEAL AND INSTALLING A
NEW SEAL MIGHT CREATE A SITUATION WHERE THE OIL WILL SEPARATE, RESULTING IN
THE SAME CONCERN.
8. If there is a verifiable axle lube leak, replace seal following the Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 205, or look at instruction sheet included in Axle Shaft Seal Kit.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081903A 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks. Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With
4139A, 4139A2)
081903A 2002-2008 Explorer, 0.7 Hr.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, 2002-2005 Aviator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks.
Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of
The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903B 2003-2008 Expedition 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903C 2003-2008 Expedition 2.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903D 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3
> Sep > 08 > Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 6277
Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed
With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2006-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac :Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time
To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2002-2005 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Mountaineer:Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2003-2005 Aviator:Replace 0.8 Hr.
Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903E 2006-2008 Explorer, 2.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To
Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2002-2005 Explorer, 1.5 Hrs.
Mountaineer: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3
> Sep > 08 > Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 6278
4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2005 Aviator: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides.
This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4A109 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
6279
Seals and Gaskets: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-19-3 Date: 080929
Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
TSB 08-19-3
09/29/08
UNITIZED SEAL DIAGNOSIS - LEAK / GREASE OIL SEPARATION - AXLE BEARING SEAL 8.8
IFS, 8.8 IRS, AND 9.75 IRS AXLES
FORD: 2002-2008 Explorer 2003-2008 Expedition 2006-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2003-2005 Aviator 2003-2008 Navigator
MERCURY: 2002-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-05 to update the model years, Part List and Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Explorer, Explorer Sport Track, and Mountaineer
vehicles equipped with rear axle unitized cartridge seal, 2007-2008 Expedition-Navigator AWD
equipped with front and rear axle unitized cartridge seal.
2003-2005 Expedition-Navigator, 2002-2005, Explorer-Mountaineer, 2003-2005 Aviator equipped
with unitized cartridge rear axle seal, may exhibit oil separation from the internal lube found in the
unitized cartridge seal. This oil separation appears to be, and is often misdiagnosed, as an axle
lube leak. The majority of the vehicles with this condition will be located in northern Canada and
Alaska due to the extreme cold weather.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL UNTIL YOU COMPLETE THIS
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE. FAILURE TO PROPERLY DIAGNOSE THE ISSUE MAY
RESULT IN UNNECESSARILY REPLACING THE SEAL, RESULTING IN A REPEAT CONCERN.
NOTE
THIS DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE IS ONLY NECESSARY ON VEHICLES WITH THE NEW
UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL. THIS SEAL HAS BEEN USED IN PRODUCTION FROM 2006
MODEL YEAR TO PRESENT, HOWEVER, SOME VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 2006 MODEL
YEAR MAY HAVE THIS NEW UPDATED UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL INSTALLED AS A
SERVICE
REPAIR.
1. Raise vehicle, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-02.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
6280
NOTE
IF SEAL IS OLD DESIGN RADIAL LIP SEAL STYLE, (SEE FIGURES 1 AND 2 TO IDENTIFY
RADIAL LIP SEAL) THERE IS NO INTERNAL GREASE PRESENT IN SEAL TO SEPARATE.
THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTIC.
2. Check axle half shaft seal to ensure that it is unitized cartridge design.
3. Clean axle housing around the seal area using Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner or
equivalent cleaner. Wipe lube or oil with rag and let the housing dry.
4. Add 0.5 to 1 ounce (14.8 to 29.6 ml) Rotunda Dye-Lite® Leak Detection Dye for Gasoline Engine
Oil 164-R3700, also contained in 164-R0756 to the axle following the appropriate Workshop
Manual.
NOTE
ADDING THE DYE ON SOME VEHICLES WILL REQUIRE THE REAR WHEEL ABS SPEED
SENSOR TO BE REMOVED. REFER TO THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL DRAIN
AND FILL PROCEDURE.
5. Road test vehicle a minimum distance 15 miles (24 km) at a minimum speed of 25 MPH (40
Km/h).
NOTE
A BRIGHT ORANGE AREA WILL IDENTIFY AXLE LUBE LEAK. FOR EXTREMELY SMALL OIL
SEPARATION, ADDITIONAL AXLE OPERATION TIME MAY BE REQUIRED FOR THE LEAK TO
APPEAR.
6. Raise vehicle to check for signs of leak.
a. Use Rotunda 12V Master UV Leak Detector Kit 164-R0756 or equivalent to look for signs of
leak.
7. If there is not a verifiable lube leak, clean axle near seal area and return the vehicle to the
customer.
NOTE
IF THERE IS NO SIGNS OF LUBE LEAK, THIS MEANS THAT THE SUBSTANCE WHICH WAS
PRESENT PRIOR TO THE PROCEDURE WAS OIL WHICH HAD SEPARATED FROM THE
GREASE INTERNAL TO THE SEAL. THIS OIL IS A PRE-LUBE, AND IS NOT NECESSARY
ONCE THE AXLE SEAL IS BROKEN IN. ONCE THE OIL SEPARATION HAS OCCURRED,
THERE SHOULD BE NO
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
6281
FURTHER OIL SEPARATION FROM THE SEAL. REMOVING THE SEAL AND INSTALLING A
NEW SEAL MIGHT CREATE A SITUATION WHERE THE OIL WILL SEPARATE, RESULTING IN
THE SAME CONCERN.
8. If there is a verifiable axle lube leak, replace seal following the Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 205, or look at instruction sheet included in Axle Shaft Seal Kit.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081903A 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks. Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With
4139A, 4139A2)
081903A 2002-2008 Explorer, 0.7 Hr.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, 2002-2005 Aviator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks.
Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of
The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903B 2003-2008 Expedition 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903C 2003-2008 Expedition 2.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903D 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
6282
Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed
With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2006-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac :Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time
To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2002-2005 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Mountaineer:Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2003-2005 Aviator:Replace 0.8 Hr.
Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903E 2006-2008 Explorer, 2.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To
Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2002-2005 Explorer, 1.5 Hrs.
Mountaineer: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
6283
4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2005 Aviator: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides.
This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4A109 42
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-19-3 Date: 080929
Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
TSB 08-19-3
09/29/08
UNITIZED SEAL DIAGNOSIS - LEAK / GREASE OIL SEPARATION - AXLE BEARING SEAL 8.8
IFS, 8.8 IRS, AND 9.75 IRS AXLES
FORD: 2002-2008 Explorer 2003-2008 Expedition 2006-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2003-2005 Aviator 2003-2008 Navigator
MERCURY: 2002-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-05 to update the model years, Part List and Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Explorer, Explorer Sport Track, and Mountaineer
vehicles equipped with rear axle unitized cartridge seal, 2007-2008 Expedition-Navigator AWD
equipped with front and rear axle unitized cartridge seal.
2003-2005 Expedition-Navigator, 2002-2005, Explorer-Mountaineer, 2003-2005 Aviator equipped
with unitized cartridge rear axle seal, may exhibit oil separation from the internal lube found in the
unitized cartridge seal. This oil separation appears to be, and is often misdiagnosed, as an axle
lube leak. The majority of the vehicles with this condition will be located in northern Canada and
Alaska due to the extreme cold weather.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL UNTIL YOU COMPLETE THIS
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE. FAILURE TO PROPERLY DIAGNOSE THE ISSUE MAY
RESULT IN UNNECESSARILY REPLACING THE SEAL, RESULTING IN A REPEAT CONCERN.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
6284
NOTE
THIS DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE IS ONLY NECESSARY ON VEHICLES WITH THE NEW
UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL. THIS SEAL HAS BEEN USED IN PRODUCTION FROM 2006
MODEL YEAR TO PRESENT, HOWEVER, SOME VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 2006 MODEL
YEAR MAY HAVE THIS NEW UPDATED UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL INSTALLED AS A
SERVICE
REPAIR.
1. Raise vehicle, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-02.
NOTE
IF SEAL IS OLD DESIGN RADIAL LIP SEAL STYLE, (SEE FIGURES 1 AND 2 TO IDENTIFY
RADIAL LIP SEAL) THERE IS NO INTERNAL GREASE PRESENT IN SEAL TO SEPARATE.
THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTIC.
2. Check axle half shaft seal to ensure that it is unitized cartridge design.
3. Clean axle housing around the seal area using Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner or
equivalent cleaner. Wipe lube or oil with rag and let the housing dry.
4. Add 0.5 to 1 ounce (14.8 to 29.6 ml) Rotunda Dye-Lite® Leak Detection Dye for Gasoline Engine
Oil 164-R3700, also contained in 164-R0756 to the axle following the appropriate Workshop
Manual.
NOTE
ADDING THE DYE ON SOME VEHICLES WILL REQUIRE THE REAR WHEEL ABS SPEED
SENSOR TO BE REMOVED. REFER TO THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL DRAIN
AND FILL PROCEDURE.
5. Road test vehicle a minimum distance 15 miles (24 km) at a minimum speed of 25 MPH (40
Km/h).
NOTE
A BRIGHT ORANGE AREA WILL IDENTIFY AXLE LUBE LEAK. FOR EXTREMELY SMALL OIL
SEPARATION, ADDITIONAL AXLE OPERATION TIME MAY BE REQUIRED FOR THE LEAK TO
APPEAR.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
6285
6. Raise vehicle to check for signs of leak.
a. Use Rotunda 12V Master UV Leak Detector Kit 164-R0756 or equivalent to look for signs of
leak.
7. If there is not a verifiable lube leak, clean axle near seal area and return the vehicle to the
customer.
NOTE
IF THERE IS NO SIGNS OF LUBE LEAK, THIS MEANS THAT THE SUBSTANCE WHICH WAS
PRESENT PRIOR TO THE PROCEDURE WAS OIL WHICH HAD SEPARATED FROM THE
GREASE INTERNAL TO THE SEAL. THIS OIL IS A PRE-LUBE, AND IS NOT NECESSARY
ONCE THE AXLE SEAL IS BROKEN IN. ONCE THE OIL SEPARATION HAS OCCURRED,
THERE SHOULD BE NO FURTHER OIL SEPARATION FROM THE SEAL. REMOVING THE
SEAL AND INSTALLING A NEW SEAL MIGHT CREATE A SITUATION WHERE THE OIL WILL
SEPARATE, RESULTING IN THE SAME CONCERN.
8. If there is a verifiable axle lube leak, replace seal following the Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 205, or look at instruction sheet included in Axle Shaft Seal Kit.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081903A 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks. Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With
4139A, 4139A2)
081903A 2002-2008 Explorer, 0.7 Hr.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, 2002-2005 Aviator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks.
Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of
The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903B 2003-2008 Expedition 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903C 2003-2008 Expedition 2.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
6286
Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903D 2006-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac :Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time
To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2002-2005 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Mountaineer:Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2003-2005 Aviator:Replace 0.8 Hr.
Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903E 2006-2008 Explorer, 2.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To
Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
6287
Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2002-2005 Explorer, 1.5 Hrs.
Mountaineer: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2005 Aviator: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides.
This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4A109 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS
High Temperature 4x4 Front Axle & Wheel Bearing Grease
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
...................................................... E8TZ-19590-A Ford Specification ................................................
................................................................................................................................... ESA-M1C198-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6291
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist.
3. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the rear halfshaft nut and washer. ^
To install, tighten to 300 Nm (221 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6292
4. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV Joint from the wheel hub.
5. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the brake disc.
7. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector and detach the wheel speed sensor
harness from the retainer.
8. Remove the bolt and detach the harness from the retainers. To install, tighten the bolt to 15 Nm
(11 ft. lbs.). 9. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and hub assembly bolts, the wheel bearing assembly
and the wheel speed sensor as an assembly.
^ Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake shield.
^ Discard the bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 ft. lbs.).
10. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and hub assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front axle nut .......................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 27 Nm (20 ft.lbs.) Rear axle wheel hub retainer ...........................
...................................................................................................................................... 345 Nm (254
ft.lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 6300
C1157
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear
Rear - Navigator 4WD, Expedition 4WD And 2WD
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear > Page 6306
Front, Expedition And Navigator
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Driveshaft - Front
Driveshaft - Front
Material
Removal and Installation
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the rear jack
storage area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which
can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maint./Service.
2. Remove the 3 front driveshaft shield nuts and the front driveshaft shield.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
3. Index-mark the front flange to the pinion flange. Index-mark the rear flange to the transfer case
flange.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 6309
4. Remove the 4 rear flange-to-transfer case flange bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 104 Nm (77 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the 4 front flange-to-pinion flange bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 112 Nm (83 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the front driveshaft from the vehicle.
7. CAUTION: If new bolts to retain the driveshaft to the axle and the driveshaft to the transfer case
are not available, coat the threads of the original
bolts with threadlock and sealer.
CAUTION: The front driveshaft must be installed with the boot toward the transfer case to prevent
damage to the boot from the exhaust system.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 6310
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Driveshaft - Rear
Driveshaft - Rear, Expedition
Material
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This
can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the rear jack storage area.
Failure to do so can result in the unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can
result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maint./Service.
2. Index-mark the driveshaft flange to the rear axle pinion flange.
3. Remove the 4 driveshaft flange bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 112 Nm (83 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 6311
4. CAUTION: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the rear axle pinion flange pilot. Never hammer on
the driveshaft or any of its components to
disconnect the driveshaft from the pinion flange.
Pry only in the area shown, with a suitable tool, to disconnect the driveshaft flange from the pinion
flange. Using a suitable tool, disconnect the driveshaft flange from the rear axle pinion flange.
5. NOTE: Do not rotate the driveshaft when removing the slip yoke from the transmission output
shaft.
Index-mark the driveshaft slip yoke and the transmission extension housing. Mark the transmission
output shaft to the transmission extension housing after removing the driveshaft.
6. CAUTION: Coat the threads of the original bolts with sealer.
CAUTION: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the rear axle pinion flange pilot. To make sure that
the driveshaft flange seats squarely on the pinion flange, tighten the bolts evenly in a cross pattern
as shown.
CAUTION: Make sure all index marks are aligned.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Tighten the driveshaft flange bolts to 112 Nm (83 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 6312
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Driveshaft Slip Yoke Boot
Driveshaft Slip Yoke Boot
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driveshaft.
2. Index the driveshaft to the center bearing for correct alignment during installation.
3. Disconnect the slip yoke boot.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 6313
4. Separate the driveshaft.
5. Remove the slip yoke boot.
6. NOTE: Lubricate the slip yoke splines with premium long-life grease.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Align the index marks for correct alignment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Driveshaft Universal Joint - Single Cardan
Special Tools
Disassembly
1. Remove the driveshaft.
2. CAUTION: Do not clamp the driveshaft in the jaws of a vise or a similar holding fixture.
Carefully place the driveshaft on a suitable workbench.
3. NOTE: Index the driveshaft components relative to the driveshaft tube. Make sure all
components are reassembled in the same relationship to
maintain correct balance.
Index the driveshaft and driveshaft components.
4. Position the special tool in a vise.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page
6318
5. Remove the snap rings from the universal joint.
6. NOTE: If necessary, use a pair of pliers to remove a bearing cup if it cannot be pressed out all
the way.
Remove the driveshaft flange yoke. 1
Position the driveshaft flange in the special tool.
2 Press out the bearing cup.
3 Rotate the driveshaft flange yoke.
4 Press on the spider to remove the remaining bearing cup.
5 Remove the driveshaft flange yoke.
7. Repeat the previous step to remove the remaining bearing cups and spider from the driveshaft.
8. Clean the yoke area at the end of the driveshaft and flange yoke.
Assembly
NOTE: Universal Joint service kits are to be installed as complete assemblies only. Do not use
components from other universal joints.
1. Clamp the special tool in a vise.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page
6319
2. Install a new bearing cup.
1 Start a new bearing cup into the driveshaft yoke.
2 Position a new spider in the driveshaft yoke.
3 Install the driveshaft into the special tool.
4 Press the bearing cup below the yoke surface.
3. Remove the driveshaft from the special tool and install the snap ring. 4. Repeat the previous
steps to install the remaining bearing cups.
5. NOTE: Do not strike the bearings. If binding, strike the yoke with a brass or plastic hammer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page
6320
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Ford 8.8-Inch - Front Drive Axle/Differential
Universal Joint Flange - Front
Special Tools
Material
Removal
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel area. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations.
CAUTION: This operation disturbs the pinion bearing preload. Carefully reset the preload during
assembly.
1. Position the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Remove the front wheel and tire assemblies.
3. CAUTION: Remove the front brake caliper to prevent drag during the drive pinion bearing
preload adjustment.
CAUTION: Do not allow the calipers to hang from the brake hoses.
Remove the front brake calipers. Wire the caliper aside.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page
6321
4. Index-mark the front driveshaft to the axle universal joint flange.
5. CAUTION: Do not allow the driveshaft to hang unsupported.
Disconnect and support the front driveshaft. 1
Remove the 4 bolts.
2 Carefully disconnect and support the front driveshaft.
6. Using a Nm (inch/pound) torque wrench, measure the torque necessary to maintain pinion
rotation. Record the measurement for reference during
installation.
7. CAUTION: After removing the pinion nut, discard it. Use a new pinion nut for installation.
Install the special tool and remove the pinion nut.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page
6322
8. Index-mark the axle universal joint flange to the pinion stem.
9. Using the special tool, separate the axle universal joint flange from the pinion gear.
10. Remove the flange. 11. Inspect the axle universal Joint flange for burrs, the nut counterbore
and the seal contact surface for nicks, and the bearing cone contact area for
damage. Install a new flange if necessary.
12. Check the pinion stem splines for burrs. If burrs are evident, remove them with a fine crocus
cloth.
Installation
1. Lubricate the axle universal joint flange splines and the pinion seal.
^ Use front axle lubricant.
2. CAUTION: Never install the axle universal joint flange with a hammer or power tools.
NOTE: Disregard the scribe marks if installing a new flange.
Align the index-marks and position the axle universal joint flange on the pinion shaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page
6323
3. NOTE: Rotate the pinion gear occasionally to make sure the pinion bearings seat correctly.
Using the special tool, install the axle universal joint flange.
4. CAUTION: Do not loosen the pinion nut to reduce preload under any circumstance. If it is
necessary to reduce preload, install a new drive pinion
collapsible spacer and pinion nut.
Install the special tool, and tighten the pinion nut. ^
Rotate the pinion gear occasionally to make sure the pinion bearings are seating correctly. Take
frequent pinion bearing torque preload readings by rotating the pinion gear with a Nm (inch/pound)
torque wrench.
^ If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is lower than the specification for used bearings, then
tighten the pinion nut to the specification. If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is higher than
the specification for used bearings, then tighten the pinion nut to the original reading as recorded.
5. Align the index-marks then attach the front driveshaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ford 9.57-Inch - Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page
6324
6. Inspect and, if necessary, fill the differential.
^ Use rear axle lubricant.
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. If equipped with air suspension, reactivate the system by turning on the air
suspension switch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications
Flex Plate: Specifications
Flexplate bolts .....................................................................................................................................
................................................. 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
6328
Flex Plate: Diagrams
Engine - Lower End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
6329
Engine - Lower End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
6330
Engine - Lower End
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
6331
Flex Plate: Service and Repair
Flexplate
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the transmission.
2. Remove the 8 bolts and the flexplate.
^ To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.) in the sequence shown.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and
Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Power Take-Off > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Power Take-Off: Description and Operation
POWER TAKE-OFF (PTO) SWITCH AND CIRCUITS
The PTO circuit is used by the PCM to disable some of the on-board diagnostics (OBD) monitors
during PTO operation. The PTO switch is normally open. When the PTO unit is activated, the PTO
switch is closed and battery voltage is supplied to the PTO input circuit. This indicates to the PCM
that an additional load is being applied to the engine. The PTO indicator lamp illuminates when the
PTO system is functioning correctly and flashes when the PTO system is damaged.
When the PTO unit is activated, the PCM disables some OBD monitors, which may not function
reliably during PTO operation. Without the PTO circuit information to the PCM, false diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) may be set during PTO operation. Prior to an Inspection/Maintenance test,
the vehicle will have to be operated with the PTO disengaged long enough to successfully
complete the OBD Monitors.
PTO CIRCUITS DESCRIPTION
The 3 PTO input circuits are PTO mode, PTO engage, and PTO RPM.
The PTO engage circuit is used when the operator is requesting the PCM to check the needed
inputs required to initiate the PTO engagement.
The PTO RPM circuit is used for the operator to request additional engine RPM for PTO operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Four Wheel Drive (4WD) control module is integral to the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) and is not serviced separately.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6348
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The transfercase Low to High and High to Low relays are located in the Auxiliary relay box 1
located in the engine compartment. LH side, front.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to
High Relay
C1129
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to
High Relay > Page 6351
C1173
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer
Case Low to High Relay
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case Low to High Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer
Case Low to High Relay > Page 6354
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer
Case Low to High Relay > Page 6355
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case High to Low Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer
Case Low to High Relay > Page 6356
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6363
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6364
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6365
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6366
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6367
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6368
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6369
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6370
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6371
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6372
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6373
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6374
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6375
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6376
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6377
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6378
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6379
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6380
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6386
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6387
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6388
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6389
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6390
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6391
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6392
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6393
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6394
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6395
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6396
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6397
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6398
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6399
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6400
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6401
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6402
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 6403
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6408
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6409
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6410
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6411
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6412
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6413
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6414
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6415
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6416
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6417
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6418
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6419
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6420
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6421
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6422
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6423
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6424
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6429
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6430
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6431
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6432
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6433
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6434
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6435
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6436
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6437
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6438
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6439
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6440
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6441
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6442
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6443
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6444
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6445
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6446
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 6450
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6453
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6454
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6455
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6456
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6457
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6458
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6459
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6460
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6461
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6462
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6463
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6464
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6465
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6466
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6467
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6468
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6469
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6470
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6471
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
4R70E/4R75E Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Adjustment
Special Tools
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual lever shift control cable.
3. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6472
4. Loosen the digital transmission range (TR) sensor bolts.
5. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
6. CAUTION: Tightening one bolt before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor and tighten the bolts in an alternating sequence.
^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Install the manual control lever.
^ Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual lever shaft outer nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6473
8. With the manual lever in overdrive connect the shift lever control cable. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6474
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tools
Removal
NOTE: Manual shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6475
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual control lever shift control cable.
3. Disconnect the digital TR electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
5. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the digital TR sensor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6476
1. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
2. Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
3. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6477
5. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
6. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS)
Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS)
Sensor > Page 6482
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS)
Sensor > Page 6483
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS)
Sensor > Page 6484
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6487
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6488
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6489
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6490
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6491
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6492
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6493
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6494
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6495
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6496
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6497
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6498
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6499
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6500
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6501
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6502
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6503
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6504
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Views
C193
C143
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6505
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Speed Sensors
Speed Sensors
NOTE: Only remove the affected sensor.
Removal All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist,
OSS sensor
2. Disconnect the output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the OSS
sensor bolt. 4. Remove the OSS sensor.
TSS sensor
5. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the TSS
sensor bolt. 7. Remove the TSS sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6506
Installation TSS sensor
1. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the TSS sensor. 2. Install the TSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
OSS sensor
4. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the OSS sensor. 5. Install the OSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
6. Connect the OSS sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6511
C284
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Four Wheel Drive (4WD) control module is integral to the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) and is not serviced separately.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information
> Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Transfer Case: Capacity Specifications
Transfer Case Capacity .......................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 2.0 Quarts
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information
> Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 6520
Fluid - Transfer Case: Fluid Type Specifications
Transfer Case Fluid
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................. Mercon ATF
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6521
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair
Transfer Case Draining and Filling
Special Tools
Materials
1. Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid. Clean the drain plug and the drain plug area. Apply
thread sealant to the drain plug threads. Reinstall
the drain plug.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
2. Clean the area around the fill plug. Remove the fill plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6522
3. CAUTION: Incorrect fluid fill can result in transfer case failure.
Using the special tool, fill the transfer case to specification. ^
The fluid must be just below the fill plug hole. Fill the case until the fluid slowly flows over the fill
plug threads. Clean the fluid from the fill plug area.
4. Apply thread sealant to the fill plug threads, then install the fill plug.
^ Tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6526
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The transfercase Low to High and High to Low relays are located in the Auxiliary relay box 1
located in the engine compartment. LH side, front.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to High Relay
C1129
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 6529
C1173
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case Low to High Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 6532
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 6533
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case High to Low Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 6534
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6538
C284
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Four Wheel Drive (4WD) control module is integral to the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) and is not serviced separately.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6546
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The transfercase Low to High and High to Low relays are located in the Auxiliary relay box 1
located in the engine compartment. LH side, front.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to High Relay
C1129
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 6549
C1173
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case Low to High Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page
6552
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page
6553
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case High to Low Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page
6554
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair
Transfer Case Rear Output Shaft Oil Seal
Special Tools
Removal
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. Failure to do this will result is unexpected inflation or deflation of the vehicle during these
operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Index-mark the rear driveshaft yoke and pinion flange to maintain initial driveshaft
balance during installation.
Remove the rear driveshaft.
3. Using a suitable tool, remove the oil seal.
Installation
1. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Using the special tool, install the oil seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6562
C284
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6570
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6571
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6572
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6573
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6574
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6575
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6576
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6577
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6578
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6579
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6580
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6581
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6582
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6583
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6584
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6585
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6586
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6587
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6588
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift and Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6589
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6590
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6591
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6592
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6593
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page 6598
latches. Please refer to the appropriate vehicle shop manual to determine location of the front air
bag sensors. The side air bag sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillar. To deplete
the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable. Wait at least one minute before proceeding with the
procedure to allow the backup power supply to deplete its energy.
2. Remove the supplemental restraint system (SRS) steering column clockspring.
3. Remove the 3 bolts and remove the clockspring mounting bracket from the steering column.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
4. Remove the 3 screws and position the wiring harnesses aside.
5. Disconnect the interlock actuator electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page 6599
6. Remove the 2 screws and position the actuator aside.
7. Remove the 2 bolts and position the selector lever detent bracket aside.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.).
8. Remove the shift lock actuator from the detent bracket and remove the shift lock actuator. 9. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Column Shift > Page 6600
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Floor Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator Floor Shift Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake shift interlock actuator is not serviced individually. If replacement is required,
install a new floor shift selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6605
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6606
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6607
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6608
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6609
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6610
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6611
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6612
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6613
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6614
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6615
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6616
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6617
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6618
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6619
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6620
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6621
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6622
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6623
Shift Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift and Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6624
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6625
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6626
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6627
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6628
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6633
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6634
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6635
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6636
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6637
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6638
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6639
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6640
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6641
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6642
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6643
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6644
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6645
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6646
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6647
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6648
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6649
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6650
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6651
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicles
Special Tools
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for pin
condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage. Clean, repair
or install a new connector or component as required.
Shift Solenoids Pre-Diagnosis
Use the following shift solenoid operation information when carrying out Pinpoint Test A. See:
Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Tests/Test A: Shift and Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoids
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6652
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6653
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always off" (Part 3)
Failed off due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck off.
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 1)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 2)
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Always On" (Part 3)
Failed on due to powertrain control module and or vehicle wiring concerns, shift solenoid
electrically or hydraulically stuck on.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6654
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Electronic Pressure Control (EPC) Solenoid
Special Tools
Removal
CAUTION: Do not pull on the molded lead frame. This may cause damage to the connector ends.
Carefully pry up on the locking tabs to disconnect the solenoids. Disconnect the molded lead frame
from the solenoids.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain transmission fluid and remove the
transmission fluid pan and filter.
3. Disconnect the molded lead frame from the solenoids.
1 Disconnect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB.
2 Disconnect the torque converter clutch (TCC).
3 Disconnect the electronic pressure control (EPC) solenoid.
4 Disconnect the bulkhead interconnector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6655
4. Remove the EPC solenoid.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the EPC solenoid O-rings with clean automatic transmission fluid.
Install the EPC solenoid, bracket and bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
2. Inspect the lead frame for damage.
^ Using the special tool, check all lead frame solenoid connections. The gauge should fit tightly and
not fall out after being inserted.
^ If the special tool passes through any lead frame connector pins or does not feel like it makes a
good contact,
^ Install a new lead frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6656
3. Connect the molded lead frame to the solenoids.
1 Connect the shift solenoid SSA and SSB by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
2 Connect the TCC by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in place. Make
sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
3 Connect the EPC solenoid by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the connector in
place. Make sure that the terminals pass fully through the connector slots.
4 Connect the bulkhead interconnector by pressing it in place by hand and fully seating the
connector in place.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan and filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Four Wheel Drive (4WD) control module is integral to the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) and is not serviced separately.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6670
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The transfercase Low to High and High to Low relays are located in the Auxiliary relay box 1
located in the engine compartment. LH side, front.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to High Relay
C1129
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 6673
C1173
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case Low to High Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 6676
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 6677
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Testing and Inspection Transfer Case High to Low Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Transfer Case Low to High Relay > Page 6678
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6685
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6686
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6687
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6688
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6689
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6690
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6691
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6692
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6693
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6694
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6695
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6696
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6697
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6698
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6699
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6700
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6701
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6702
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6708
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6709
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6710
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6711
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6712
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6713
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6714
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6715
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6716
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6717
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6718
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6719
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6720
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6721
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6722
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6723
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6724
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6725
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6730
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6731
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6732
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6733
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6734
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6735
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6736
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6737
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6738
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6739
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6740
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6741
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6742
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6743
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6744
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6745
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6746
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6751
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6752
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6753
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6754
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6755
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6756
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6757
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6758
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6759
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6760
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6761
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6762
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6763
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6764
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6765
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6766
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6767
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 6768
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6772
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6775
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6776
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6777
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6778
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6779
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6780
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6781
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6782
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6783
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6784
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6785
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6786
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6787
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6788
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6789
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6790
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6791
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6792
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6793
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Adjustments
4R70E/4R75E Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Adjustment
Special Tools
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual lever shift control cable.
3. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control lever nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6794
4. Loosen the digital transmission range (TR) sensor bolts.
5. NOTE: The manual lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
6. CAUTION: Tightening one bolt before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor and tighten the bolts in an alternating sequence.
^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Install the manual control lever.
^ Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual lever shaft outer nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6795
8. With the manual lever in overdrive connect the shift lever control cable. 9. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6796
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tools
Removal
NOTE: Manual shift lever must be in the NEUTRAL position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6797
2. CAUTION: Do not pry on the swivel tube to disconnect the transmission shift linkage.
Disconnect the manual control lever shift control cable.
3. Disconnect the digital TR electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: Discard the outer manual control lever shaft nut. Do not reuse. The old nut will not
retain the torque specification.
Remove the manual control lever. 1
Remove and discard the manual control nut.
2 Remove the manual control lever.
5. Remove the digital TR sensor bolts and the digital TR sensor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6798
1. Install the digital TR sensor and loosely install the bolts.
2. Using the special tool, align the digital TR sensor slots. The tool is designed to fit snug.
3. CAUTION: Tightening one screw before tightening the other may cause the sensor to bind or
become damaged.
Tighten the digital TR sensor bolts. ^
Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
4. Install the manual control lever.
1 Position the manual control lever.
2 Install a new manual control lever nut.
^ Tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6799
5. Connect the digital TR sensor electrical connector.
6. Connect the shift cable end to the manual lever with the lever in the (D) position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 6804
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 6805
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 6806
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6809
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6810
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6811
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6812
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6813
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6814
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6815
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6816
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6817
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6818
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6819
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6820
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6821
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6822
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6823
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6824
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6825
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6826
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Views
C193
C143
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 6827
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
4R70E/4R75E Automatic Transmission Speed Sensors
Speed Sensors
NOTE: Only remove the affected sensor.
Removal All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist,
OSS sensor
2. Disconnect the output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the OSS
sensor bolt. 4. Remove the OSS sensor.
TSS sensor
5. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the TSS
sensor bolt. 7. Remove the TSS sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 6828
Installation TSS sensor
1. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the TSS sensor. 2. Install the TSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
OSS sensor
4. Lubricate the O-ring seal and install the OSS sensor. 5. Install the OSS sensor bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
6. Connect the OSS sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6833
C284
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Service and Repair
ABS Sensor Block: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control
sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor > Page 6843
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor
C147
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor > Page 6846
C148
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6850
C135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6851
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new module, it must be calibrated and configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical connector. 3. Remove the 3 bolts
and the ABS module.
^ To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6852
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
Material
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6856
2. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical connector.
3. CAUTION: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of
specific design and only authorized parts should be
used when installing new inlet brake tubes.
NOTE: Plug each open port to prevent brake fluid from spilling.
Disconnect the 6 brake tube fittings. ^
To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the 3 hydraulic control unit (HCU)-to-bracket bolts and the HCU.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control
sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Disconnect
the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the steering
wheel rotation sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-24 (Center Console)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6866
C280
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Right Front
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Right Front > Page 6871
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Right Front > Page 6872
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6875
C440
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6876
C160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6877
C426
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the wheel speed sensor
harness retainer bolt and detach the retainers.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the 2 caliper anchor bolts and position the caliper, pads and anchor plate aside. ^
Support the caliper with mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 6880
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake shoes. 2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the
retaining clips. 3. Remove the rear wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6884
C245
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6885
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control
sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Bleeding: > 05-26-21 > Dec > 05 > Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
Brake Bleeding: Customer Interest Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > 05-26-21 > Dec > 05 > Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
Brake Bleeding: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > Page 6899
Brake Bleeding: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-26-21 Date: 051231
Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > Page 6900
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-26-21 Date: 051231
Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > Page 6901
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the 4 wheel anti-lock brake (4WABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the 4WABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add recommended brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear waste line to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in
a container partially filled with recommended brake
fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the diagnostic tool.
Connect the diagnostic tool DCL cable adapter into the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the
dash and follow the diagnostic tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the diagnostic tool service bleed procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6904
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Gravity
Gravity
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with brake fluid.
2. Bleed the rear disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free
end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
rear disc brake caliper.
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6905
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Manual
Manual
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper.
6. Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6906
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6907
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Pressure
Pressure
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
^ WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Bleed the longest line first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough specified brake fluid
to complete the bleeding operation.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with the specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 5. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then tighten rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
7. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6908
8. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir and install the brake master cylinder filler cap.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6909
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the 4 wheel anti-lock brake (4WABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the 4WABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add recommended brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear waste line to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in
a container partially filled with recommended brake
fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the diagnostic tool.
Connect the diagnostic tool DCL cable adapter into the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the
dash and follow the diagnostic tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the diagnostic tool service bleed procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6910
Gravity
Gravity
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with brake fluid.
2. Bleed the rear disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free
end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
rear disc brake caliper.
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
Manual
Manual
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6911
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper.
6. Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Pressure
Pressure
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
^ WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6912
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Bleed the longest line first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough specified brake fluid
to complete the bleeding operation.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with the specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 5. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then tighten rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
7. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6913
8. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir and install the brake master cylinder filler cap.
Brake System Bleeding
Brake System Bleeding
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6914
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with brake fluid. 3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until
clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and
install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fittings until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tubes.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
Master Cylinder, Bench
Master Cylinder, Bench
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 6915
1. Support the brake master cylinder body in a vise and fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with
specified brake fluid.
^ Use clean brake fluid.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir. 3.
Slowly depress the primary piston until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air bubbles.
4. Remove the short brake tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and Repair
Brake Pedal Assy: Service and Repair
Brake Pedal and Bracket
NOTE: Adjustable brake pedal and bracket shown, fixed brake pedal and bracket similar.
Removal and Installation
Adjustable pedal vehicles
1. CAUTION: The brake pedal and the accelerator pedal must be in the same position when
installing a new cable or a new pedal. The pedals must
be all the way forward or all the way rearward.
Disconnect the battery negative cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. Remove the accelerator pedal-to-brake pedal cable.
All vehicles
3. CAUTION: The booster pushrod must be installed with the pushrod offset, if present, pointing
downward.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Page 6919
Remove the stoplight switch self-lock pin cover, the pin and slide the stoplight switch, booster push
rod and the bushing off the brake pedal pin.
4. NOTE: Do not apply the brake pedal during the removal or installation of the speed control
deactivation switch.
Disconnect the electrical connector and turn the speed control deactivator switch counterclockwise
to detach it from the brake pedal bracket.
5. Remove the bulkhead sound insulator. 6. Remove the 4 brake pedal bracket nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.).
7. Remove the brake pedal bracket bolts and remove the brake pedal and bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Caliper: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes - Roughness or Shudder
When Braking
Brake Caliper: Customer Interest Brakes - Roughness or Shudder When Braking
TSB 06-12-5
06/26/06
BRAKE SHUDDER
FORD: 2004-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2004-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-3-17 to add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2004-2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles built between 12/18/2003 and 03/01/2006
may experience repeat front brake roughness and / or shudder while braking.
ACTION Determine if the vehicle has the old level rotors. If old level rotors, replace the front rotors
and front caliper assemblies. If vehicle has new level rotors replace caliper assemblies and turn or
replace the rotors as appropriate.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the build date of the front rotors. The build date is stamped on the inside of the rotor,
between the fins (Figure 1). If the rotor date code is before 4H23 (4=2004, H=August, 23=23rd),
replace the front rotors and front caliper assemblies. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 206-03
for front rotor and caliper replacement procedure.
NOTE
REPLACE CALIPERS WITH NEW SERVICE FIX CALIPER ASSEMBLIES BY REMOVING THE
CALIPERS AT THE KNUCKLES. THE SERVICE REPLACEMENT CALIPERS WILL BE
PRE-ASSEMBLED WITH ANCHOR, SPRINGS, AND PADS. THE CALIPERS SHOULD BE
INSTALLED AS A UNIT WITHOUT DISASSEMBLY.
2. If the rotor date code is 4H23 or greater replace the caliper assemblies and use the on-the-car
brake lathe to turn the rotor if still within minimum thickness specification. If rotor is beyond
machinable thickness, replace the front rotors.
NOTE
DUE TO THE PISTON SEAL ROLLBACK DESIGN CHANGE WITHIN THE CALIPER, THE
PEDAL TRAVEL MAY INCREASE APPROXIMATELY 9/32" (7 MM). THIS INCREASE IN TRAVEL
IS CONSIDERED NORMAL. THIS CHANGE DOES NOT AFFECT BRAKE STOPPING
DISTANCE AND/OR BRAKE EFFECTIVENESS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Caliper: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes - Roughness or Shudder
When Braking > Page 6929
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061205A 2004-2006 0.9 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Replace Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001B2PT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
061205B 2004-2006 1.5 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Refinish Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001BPT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2B120 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Caliper: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes - Roughness
or Shudder When Braking
Brake Caliper: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Roughness or Shudder When Braking
TSB 06-12-5
06/26/06
BRAKE SHUDDER
FORD: 2004-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2004-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-3-17 to add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2004-2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles built between 12/18/2003 and 03/01/2006
may experience repeat front brake roughness and / or shudder while braking.
ACTION Determine if the vehicle has the old level rotors. If old level rotors, replace the front rotors
and front caliper assemblies. If vehicle has new level rotors replace caliper assemblies and turn or
replace the rotors as appropriate.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the build date of the front rotors. The build date is stamped on the inside of the rotor,
between the fins (Figure 1). If the rotor date code is before 4H23 (4=2004, H=August, 23=23rd),
replace the front rotors and front caliper assemblies. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 206-03
for front rotor and caliper replacement procedure.
NOTE
REPLACE CALIPERS WITH NEW SERVICE FIX CALIPER ASSEMBLIES BY REMOVING THE
CALIPERS AT THE KNUCKLES. THE SERVICE REPLACEMENT CALIPERS WILL BE
PRE-ASSEMBLED WITH ANCHOR, SPRINGS, AND PADS. THE CALIPERS SHOULD BE
INSTALLED AS A UNIT WITHOUT DISASSEMBLY.
2. If the rotor date code is 4H23 or greater replace the caliper assemblies and use the on-the-car
brake lathe to turn the rotor if still within minimum thickness specification. If rotor is beyond
machinable thickness, replace the front rotors.
NOTE
DUE TO THE PISTON SEAL ROLLBACK DESIGN CHANGE WITHIN THE CALIPER, THE
PEDAL TRAVEL MAY INCREASE APPROXIMATELY 9/32" (7 MM). THIS INCREASE IN TRAVEL
IS CONSIDERED NORMAL. THIS CHANGE DOES NOT AFFECT BRAKE STOPPING
DISTANCE AND/OR BRAKE EFFECTIVENESS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Caliper: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes - Roughness
or Shudder When Braking > Page 6935
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061205A 2004-2006 0.9 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Replace Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001B2PT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
061205B 2004-2006 1.5 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Refinish Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001BPT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2B120 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6936
General Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6939
Front Brake Disc System
Front Brake Disc System
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6940
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can
result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the brake pads.
3. CAUTION: Install a new lining if it is worn to or past the specified thickness above the metal
backing plate or rivets. Install new pads in complete
axle sets.
Inspect the pads for wear or contamination.
4. Disconnect the front brake hose.
^ Use new copper washers to connect the front brake hose.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the disc brake caliper bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
6. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary. 7. Inspect the disc
brake caliper for leaks.
^ If leaks are found, the brake caliper must be disassembled.
8. Bleed the brake system. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6941
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Caliper
Material
Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6942
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the RH kick
panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which
can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the brake hose flow bolt and disconnect the hose.
^ Remove and discard the copper washers.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
3. Remove the brake pads.
4. Inspect the disc brake caliper for leaks.
^ If leaks are found, disassembly is required.
5. Bleed the brake system. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6943
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Rear
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Material
Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 brake fluid will cause permanent damage to
brake components and will render the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6944
brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
^ If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is half full.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 3. Using the large C-clamp, compress the pistons into the caliper
housing.
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the brake pads from the caliper anchor plate. 6. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor
plate bolts and the brake caliper anchor plate.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Test the brakes for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6945
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Front
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Removal
Front Brake Disc System
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6946
Front Brake Disc System
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid in the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled.
2. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can
result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: Install new brake pads if the lining(s) are worn to or past the specified thickness
above the metal backing plate or rivets. Install new
pads in complete axle sets.
Inspect the brake pads for wear or contamination. ^
Install new pads as necessary.
4. CAUTION: If the anchor housing spring is to be reused, do not force the anchor housing spring
off the brake caliper or damage to the spring can
occur. Do not install a damaged anchor housing spring.
Remove the anchor housing spring.
5. NOTE: The LH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the upper
brake caliper cavity.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6947
For the LH brake caliper, release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force at the center of the anchor housing spring and pull outward at the bottom of the anchor
housing spring to remove it from the lower brake caliper cavity.
6. Rotate the spring upward then remove it from the brake caliper.
7. NOTE: The RH anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the lower brake
caliper cavity. The illustration below shows the
anchor housing spring end with 2 tabs.
For RH brake caliper, release the upper portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force at the center of the anchor housing spring and pull outward at the top of the anchor
housing spring to remove it from the upper brake caliper cavity.
8. Rotate the spring downward then remove it from the brake caliper.
9. NOTE: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the guide pins and position the caliper aside. ^
Remove the zero-drag spring.
^ Remove and discard the brake caliper-to-anchor plate guide pins and boots.
10. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate bolts. 11. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate.
Installation
1. Install the brake caliper anchor plate and bolts.
^ Tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.).
2. Using brake parts cleaner, clean the inner surfaces of the brake caliper where the brake pads
attach.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6948
3. Install new brake hardware as follows:
^ Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
^ Apply grease to the inside of the guide pin bushing. Do not apply grease to the guide pin threads.
^ Push the guide pins into the bushing.
4. Install the inboard brake pad into the brake caliper. 5. Remove the protective paper from the
outboard brake pad and install it into the brake caliper. 6. Install the brake caliper on the brake disc.
7. Install the guide pins and install the dust caps.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
^ Install the guide pin boots.
8. Install the zero-drag spring.
NOTE: If present, the 2-tabbed end of the anchor housing spring must be installed first.
9. Install the anchor housing spring.
1 Insert the tab of the anchor housing spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2 Twist the tab into the brake caliper cavity (LH side-upper brake caliper cavity/RH side-lower
brake caliper cavity).
10. Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
11. Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the brake caliper anchor plate. 12. Push
down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched and
seated in the brake caliper cavities.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6949
13. NOTE: The latch MUST be positioned as shown.
Verify that the anchor housing spring is correctly latched.
14. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6950
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair
Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6951
Front Brake Disc System
Front Brake Disc System
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6952
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can
result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the brake pads.
3. CAUTION: Install a new lining if it is worn to or past the specified thickness above the metal
backing plate or rivets. Install new pads in complete
axle sets.
Inspect the pads for wear or contamination.
4. Disconnect the front brake hose.
^ Use new copper washers to connect the front brake hose.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the disc brake caliper bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
6. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary. 7. Inspect the disc
brake caliper for leaks.
^ If leaks are found, the brake caliper must be disassembled.
8. Bleed the brake system. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Caliper Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Caliper
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6953
Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the RH kick
panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which
can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the brake hose flow bolt and disconnect the hose.
^ Remove and discard the copper washers.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6954
3. Remove the brake pads.
4. Inspect the disc brake caliper for leaks.
^ If leaks are found, disassembly is required.
5. Bleed the brake system. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Rear
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6955
Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 brake fluid will cause permanent damage to
brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
^ If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is half full.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 3. Using the large C-clamp, compress the pistons into the caliper
housing.
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6956
^ Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the brake pads from the caliper anchor plate. 6. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor
plate bolts and the brake caliper anchor plate.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Test the brakes for normal operation.
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Front
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Removal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6957
Front Brake Disc System
Front Brake Disc System
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid in the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled.
2. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can
result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: Install new brake pads if the lining(s) are worn to or past the specified thickness
above the metal backing plate or rivets. Install new
pads in complete axle sets.
Inspect the brake pads for wear or contamination. ^
Install new pads as necessary.
4. CAUTION: If the anchor housing spring is to be reused, do not force the anchor housing spring
off the brake caliper or damage to the spring can
occur. Do not install a damaged anchor housing spring.
Remove the anchor housing spring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6958
5. NOTE: The LH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the upper
brake caliper cavity.
For the LH brake caliper, release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force at the center of the anchor housing spring and pull outward at the bottom of the anchor
housing spring to remove it from the lower brake caliper cavity.
6. Rotate the spring upward then remove it from the brake caliper.
7. NOTE: The RH anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the lower brake
caliper cavity. The illustration below shows the
anchor housing spring end with 2 tabs.
For RH brake caliper, release the upper portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force at the center of the anchor housing spring and pull outward at the top of the anchor
housing spring to remove it from the upper brake caliper cavity.
8. Rotate the spring downward then remove it from the brake caliper.
9. NOTE: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the guide pins and position the caliper aside. ^
Remove the zero-drag spring.
^ Remove and discard the brake caliper-to-anchor plate guide pins and boots.
10. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate bolts. 11. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate.
Installation
1. Install the brake caliper anchor plate and bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6959
^ Tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.).
2. Using brake parts cleaner, clean the inner surfaces of the brake caliper where the brake pads
attach. 3. Install new brake hardware as follows:
^ Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
^ Apply grease to the inside of the guide pin bushing. Do not apply grease to the guide pin threads.
^ Push the guide pins into the bushing.
4. Install the inboard brake pad into the brake caliper. 5. Remove the protective paper from the
outboard brake pad and install it into the brake caliper. 6. Install the brake caliper on the brake disc.
7. Install the guide pins and install the dust caps.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
^ Install the guide pin boots.
8. Install the zero-drag spring.
NOTE: If present, the 2-tabbed end of the anchor housing spring must be installed first.
9. Install the anchor housing spring.
1 Insert the tab of the anchor housing spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2 Twist the tab into the brake caliper cavity (LH side-upper brake caliper cavity/RH side-lower
brake caliper cavity).
10. Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
11. Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the brake caliper anchor plate. 12. Push
down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched and
seated in the brake caliper cavities.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6960
13. NOTE: The latch MUST be positioned as shown.
Verify that the anchor housing spring is correctly latched.
14. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Caliper Disassembly and Assembly, Front
Brake Caliper
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6961
Front Brake Disc System
Front Brake Disc System
Disassembly
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6962
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the brake caliper.
2. Apply low air pressure to the fluid port in the brake caliper.
1 Place a block of wood between the caliper bridge and the caliper pistons.
2 Apply low air pressure to the fluid port in the brake caliper to force out the caliper pistons.
3 Remove the block of wood and the caliper pistons.
3. Remove the caliper piston seals and boots. 4. Inspect the caliper bores for scoring or corrosion.
If scoring and corrosion exist, install a new brake caliper assembly.
Assembly
1. Lubricate the caliper piston boots, caliper pistons, caliper piston seals and caliper bores with
DOT 3 brake fluid.
2. Install the caliper pistons into the caliper bores.
1 Install the piston seals onto the caliper pistons.
2 Install the caliper piston boots onto the caliper pistons.
3 Insert the caliper pistons into the caliper bores.
4 Press the caliper pistons into the caliper bores.
3. Install the brake caliper.
Caliper Disassembly and Assembly, Rear
Brake Caliper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6963
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6964
Rear Brake Disc Components
Disassembly
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the disc brake caliper. 2. Drain the remaining brake fluid from the disc brake caliper. 3.
Secure the disc brake caliper in a vise. 4. Remove the caliper piston.
^ Place a block of wood between the caliper bridge and the caliper piston.
^ Apply low air pressure to the fluid port in the disc brake caliper.
^ Force out the caliper piston to the block of wood.
^ Remove the block of wood and the caliper piston.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6965
5. NOTE: Do not hone the cylinder bore. Caliper pistons are not available for honed cylinder bores.
If the disc brake caliper cylinder bore or piston
is excessively scored or corroded, install a new disc brake caliper.
Remove and discard the piston seal and dust boot.
Assembly
CAUTION: Never reuse the piston seal or dust boot.
NOTE: Never reuse brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system or has been
allowed to stand in an open container for an extended period of time.
1. Lubricate these items with brake fluid:
^ Cylinder bore.
^ Piston seal.
^ Caliper piston.
^ Dust boot.
2. Install the piston seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6966
3. Using the special tools, install the dust boot.
4. CAUTION: Be careful not to damage or dislodge the piston seal.
CAUTION: Insert the caliper piston squarely into the caliper bore.
Install the caliper piston. ^
Place the brake caliper in a vise.
^ Place the piston squarely against the dust boot.
^ While applying shop air into the brake caliper, push the piston squarely into the brake caliper
bore.
5. Install the disc brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Pad: > 05-26-21 > Dec > 05 > Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
Brake Pad: Customer Interest Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Pad: > 05-26-21 > Dec > 05 > Brakes - Unintended
Brake Assist
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6980
Brake Pad: Specifications
Brake Pads
Minimum brake pad thickness
............................................................................................................................................................
2.0 mm (0.079 inch) Maximum brake pad thickness variation (pad-to-pad)
........................................................................................................................ 2.0 mm (0.079 inch)
Maximum brake pad taper wear (in any direction)
............................................................................................................................. 3.0 mm (0.118 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Front
Brake Pads
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6983
Front Brake Disc System
Front Brake Disc System
Removal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6984
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid in the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled.
2. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can
result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information,
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: Install new brake pads if the lining(s) are worn to or past the specified thickness
above the metal backing plate or rivets. Install new
pads in complete axle sets.
Inspect the brake pads for wear or contamination and install new pads as necessary.
4. CAUTION: If the anchor housing spring is to be reused, do not force the anchor housing spring
off the brake caliper or damage to the spring can
occur. Do not install a damaged anchor housing spring.
Remove the anchor housing spring.
5. NOTE: The LH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the upper
brake caliper cavity.
For the LH brake caliper, release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force at the center of the anchor housing spring and pull outward at the bottom of the anchor
housing spring to remove it from the lower brake caliper cavity.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6985
6. Rotate the spring upward then remove it from the brake caliper.
7. NOTE: The RH anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the lower brake
caliper cavity. The illustration below shows the
anchor housing spring end with 2 tabs.
For RH brake caliper, release the upper portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force at the center of the anchor housing spring and pull outward at the top of the anchor
housing spring to remove it from the upper brake caliper cavity.
8. Rotate the spring downward then remove it from the brake caliper.
9. NOTE: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the guide pins and position the caliper aside. ^
Remove the zero-drag spring.
^ Remove and discard the brake caliper-to-anchor plate guide pins and boots.
10. Remove the brake pads from the brake caliper.
11. NOTE: Use a wood block or a used brake pad to protect the brake caliper piston boots.
Compress the brake caliper pistons.
12. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary.
Installation
1. Using brake parts cleaner, clean the inner surfaces of the brake caliper where the brake pads
attach. 2. Install new brake hardware as follows:
^ Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6986
^ Apply grease to the inside of the guide pin bushing. Do not apply grease to the guide pin threads.
^ Push the guide pins into the bushing.
3. Install the inboard brake pad into the brake caliper. 4. Remove the protective paper from the
outboard brake pad and install it into the brake caliper. 5. Install the brake caliper on the brake disc.
6. Install the guide pins and install the dust caps.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
^ Install the guide pin boots.
7. Install the zero-drag spring.
NOTE: If present, the 2-tabbed end of the anchor housing spring must be installed first.
8. Install the anchor housing spring.
1 Insert the tab of the anchor housing spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2 Twist the tab into the brake caliper cavity (LH side-upper brake caliper cavity/RH side-lower
brake caliper cavity).
9. Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
10. Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the brake caliper anchor plate. 11. Push
down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched and
seated in the brake caliper cavities.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6987
12. NOTE: The latch MUST be positioned as shown.
Verify that the anchor housing spring is correctly latched.
13. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6988
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Rear
Brake Pads
Material
Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6989
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Using a clear suction device, remove brake fluid in the master cylinder reservoir until the
reservoir is half full.
2. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the RH kick
panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which
can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: Install new pads if the lining(s) are worn to or past the specified thickness above the
metal backing plate. Install new pads in
complete axle sets.
Inspect the brake pads for wear or contamination and install new pads as necessary.
4. Remove the anchor housing spring.
^ Squeeze at the center of the spring until it unlatches from the brake caliper at both ends.
^ Rotate the spring, then remove it from the caliper housing.
5. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang by the flexible brake hose or damage to the
hose can occur.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6990
Remove the caps and the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
6. Remove the brake pads from the caliper. 7. Using a suitable clamp, press the piston into the
caliper. 8. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary.
Installation
1. Install the brake pads to the caliper. 2. Position the caliper onto the anchor plate and install the 2
brake caliper guide pin bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the anchor housing spring.
1 Insert the upper anchor housing spring end into the brake caliper cavity.
2 Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the lower arm onto the anchor plate.
4. Position the upper arm onto the anchor plate, then press down and inward until it is correctly
seated and latched into the brake caliper cavities.
5. NOTE: The latch MUST be positioned as shown.
Verify that the anchor housing spring is correctly latched.
6. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Rotor/Disc: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes - Roughness or
Shudder When Braking
Brake Rotor/Disc: Customer Interest Brakes - Roughness or Shudder When Braking
TSB 06-12-5
06/26/06
BRAKE SHUDDER
FORD: 2004-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2004-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-3-17 to add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2004-2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles built between 12/18/2003 and 03/01/2006
may experience repeat front brake roughness and / or shudder while braking.
ACTION Determine if the vehicle has the old level rotors. If old level rotors, replace the front rotors
and front caliper assemblies. If vehicle has new level rotors replace caliper assemblies and turn or
replace the rotors as appropriate.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the build date of the front rotors. The build date is stamped on the inside of the rotor,
between the fins (Figure 1). If the rotor date code is before 4H23 (4=2004, H=August, 23=23rd),
replace the front rotors and front caliper assemblies. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 206-03
for front rotor and caliper replacement procedure.
NOTE
REPLACE CALIPERS WITH NEW SERVICE FIX CALIPER ASSEMBLIES BY REMOVING THE
CALIPERS AT THE KNUCKLES. THE SERVICE REPLACEMENT CALIPERS WILL BE
PRE-ASSEMBLED WITH ANCHOR, SPRINGS, AND PADS. THE CALIPERS SHOULD BE
INSTALLED AS A UNIT WITHOUT DISASSEMBLY.
2. If the rotor date code is 4H23 or greater replace the caliper assemblies and use the on-the-car
brake lathe to turn the rotor if still within minimum thickness specification. If rotor is beyond
machinable thickness, replace the front rotors.
NOTE
DUE TO THE PISTON SEAL ROLLBACK DESIGN CHANGE WITHIN THE CALIPER, THE
PEDAL TRAVEL MAY INCREASE APPROXIMATELY 9/32" (7 MM). THIS INCREASE IN TRAVEL
IS CONSIDERED NORMAL. THIS CHANGE DOES NOT AFFECT BRAKE STOPPING
DISTANCE AND/OR BRAKE EFFECTIVENESS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Rotor/Disc: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes - Roughness or
Shudder When Braking > Page 6999
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061205A 2004-2006 0.9 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Replace Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001B2PT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
061205B 2004-2006 1.5 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Refinish Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001BPT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2B120 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Rotor/Disc: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes Roughness or Shudder When Braking
Brake Rotor/Disc: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Roughness or Shudder When Braking
TSB 06-12-5
06/26/06
BRAKE SHUDDER
FORD: 2004-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2004-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-3-17 to add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2004-2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles built between 12/18/2003 and 03/01/2006
may experience repeat front brake roughness and / or shudder while braking.
ACTION Determine if the vehicle has the old level rotors. If old level rotors, replace the front rotors
and front caliper assemblies. If vehicle has new level rotors replace caliper assemblies and turn or
replace the rotors as appropriate.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the build date of the front rotors. The build date is stamped on the inside of the rotor,
between the fins (Figure 1). If the rotor date code is before 4H23 (4=2004, H=August, 23=23rd),
replace the front rotors and front caliper assemblies. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 206-03
for front rotor and caliper replacement procedure.
NOTE
REPLACE CALIPERS WITH NEW SERVICE FIX CALIPER ASSEMBLIES BY REMOVING THE
CALIPERS AT THE KNUCKLES. THE SERVICE REPLACEMENT CALIPERS WILL BE
PRE-ASSEMBLED WITH ANCHOR, SPRINGS, AND PADS. THE CALIPERS SHOULD BE
INSTALLED AS A UNIT WITHOUT DISASSEMBLY.
2. If the rotor date code is 4H23 or greater replace the caliper assemblies and use the on-the-car
brake lathe to turn the rotor if still within minimum thickness specification. If rotor is beyond
machinable thickness, replace the front rotors.
NOTE
DUE TO THE PISTON SEAL ROLLBACK DESIGN CHANGE WITHIN THE CALIPER, THE
PEDAL TRAVEL MAY INCREASE APPROXIMATELY 9/32" (7 MM). THIS INCREASE IN TRAVEL
IS CONSIDERED NORMAL. THIS CHANGE DOES NOT AFFECT BRAKE STOPPING
DISTANCE AND/OR BRAKE EFFECTIVENESS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Rotor/Disc: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes Roughness or Shudder When Braking > Page 7005
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061205A 2004-2006 0.9 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Replace Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001B2PT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
061205B 2004-2006 1.5 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Refinish Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001BPT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2B120 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7006
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications
Brake Disc
Minimum disc thickness
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ 27.0 mm (1.06 inch) Rear ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................................. 19.0 mm (0.74 inch)
Minimum thickness to machine
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ 28.3 mm (1.11 inch) Rear ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................................. 19.6 mm (0.77 inch)
Maximum disc runout
Rear .....................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.025 mm (0.001 inch)
Maximum disc thickness variation
Rear .....................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.013 mm (0.005 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Brake Disc Machining
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Brake Disc Machining
Brake Disc Machining
Special Tool(s)
Material
CAUTION: Do not use a bench lathe to machine the brake discs.
NOTE: Read the entire operating manual and view the video shipped with the lathe before
installing, operating, or repairing the lathe.
NOTE: If the thickness of the brake disc is less than the minimum thickness to machine
specification, install a new brake disc. This will make sure that the brake disc will be above
minimum thickness after machining.
NOTE: Do not machine new brake discs.
NOTE: Lateral runout and disc thickness variation measurements are not required because correct
adjustment of the on-vehicle brake lathe will make sure that these dimensions are within
specifications.
1. NOTE: It is not necessary to disconnect the brake line from the brake caliper.
Position the brake caliper and brake caliper anchor bracket aside.
2. For vehicles with a 2-piece brake disc and hub assembly:
1 Mark the brake disc and the wheel stud for correct indexing during re-assembly.
2 Remove the brake disc from the hub.
3 CAUTION: Do not use an abrasive sanding disc since it will remove paint or other protective
finishes from the wheel or metal from the mounting surfaces, adversely affecting corrosion
protection and brake disc lateral runout.
Remove corrosion from the wheel mounting surface, both disc mounting surfaces, and hub
mounting surface.
4 Align the match marks and install the brake disc on the hub.
3. Machine the brake disc using an on-car brake lathe.
1 Install the hub adapter and silencer belt, if necessary.
2 Install the cutting lathe.
3 If the lathe is not self adjusting, adjust the lathe oscillation using a dial indicator. Total indicated
reading (TIR) target is 0.000 mm (0.000 inch), maximum is 0.08 mm (0.003 inch).
4 Center the cutting head, adjust the cutting bits, and install the chip deflector.
5 NOTE: The depth of cut should be between 0.10 and 0.20 mm (0.004 and 0.008 inch). Lighter
cuts will cause the bit to heat up and wear faster. Heavier cuts will cause poor brake disc surface
finish.
Machine the brake disc.
6 Remove the lathe and, if installed, the silencer belt.
7 Remove the hub adapter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Brake Disc Machining > Page 7009
4. Remove the metal shavings. 5. For vehicles with a 2-piece brake disc and hub assembly:
1 Remove the brake disc from the hub.
2 Remove metal shavings from the hub, the brake disc mounting surfaces and from the ABS
sensors.
3 Apply anti-seize lubricant to the hub mounting surface to prevent corrosion.
4 Align the match marks and install the brake disc on the hub.
6. NOTE: It is not required to install new brake pads if friction material properties are within
guidelines.
Install the brake caliper and brake caliper anchor bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Brake Disc Machining > Page 7010
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Disc Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Disc
Removal and Installation
Front Brake Disc System
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Brake Disc Machining > Page 7011
Front Brake Disc System
1. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate. 2. Remove the brake disc. 3. Inspect the brake disc and
resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Brake Disc Machining > Page 7012
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Disc Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Disc
Removal and Installation
Rear Brake Disc Components
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the RH kick
panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which
can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL. position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. NOTE: When removing the disc brake caliper in this procedure, it is not necessary to disconnect
the rear wheel brake hose.
Remove the brake caliper anchor plate bolts. ^
To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.).
3. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang by the flexible brake hose or damage to the
hose can occur.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Brake Disc Machining > Page 7013
Remove the anchor plate and caliper as an assembly and position aside. ^
Support the caliper with mechanic's wire.
4. NOTE: If the brake disc binds on the parking brake shoe, remove the adjustment hole access
plug and contract the parking brake shoe.
Remove the brake disc.
5. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary. 6. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Brake Disc Machining > Page 7014
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Shield Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Disc Shield
Removal and Installation
Front Brake Disc System
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Brake Disc Machining > Page 7015
Front Brake Disc System
1. Remove the brake disc. 2. Remove the brake disc shield screws.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
3. Remove the brake disc shield. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Bleeding: > 05-26-21 > Dec > 05 > Brakes - Unintended Brake
Assist
Brake Bleeding: Customer Interest Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > 05-26-21 > Dec > 05 > Brakes Unintended Brake Assist
Brake Bleeding: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > Page 7030
Brake Bleeding: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-26-21 Date: 051231
Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > Page 7031
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-26-21 Date: 051231
Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Bleeding: > Page 7032
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the 4 wheel anti-lock brake (4WABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the 4WABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add recommended brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear waste line to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in
a container partially filled with recommended brake
fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the diagnostic tool.
Connect the diagnostic tool DCL cable adapter into the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the
dash and follow the diagnostic tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the diagnostic tool service bleed procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7035
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Gravity
Gravity
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with brake fluid.
2. Bleed the rear disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free
end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
rear disc brake caliper.
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7036
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Manual
Manual
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper.
6. Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7037
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7038
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Pressure
Pressure
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
^ WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Bleed the longest line first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough specified brake fluid
to complete the bleeding operation.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with the specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 5. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then tighten rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
7. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7039
8. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir and install the brake master cylinder filler cap.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7040
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS)
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the 4 wheel anti-lock brake (4WABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the 4WABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add recommended brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear waste line to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in
a container partially filled with recommended brake
fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the diagnostic tool.
Connect the diagnostic tool DCL cable adapter into the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the
dash and follow the diagnostic tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the diagnostic tool service bleed procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7041
Gravity
Gravity
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with brake fluid.
2. Bleed the rear disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free
end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
rear disc brake caliper.
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH
front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
Manual
Manual
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7042
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper.
6. Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Pressure
Pressure
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
^ WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7043
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Bleed the longest line first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough specified brake fluid
to complete the bleeding operation.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with the specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
tube to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 5. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then tighten rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.).
6. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
7. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7044
8. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir and install the brake master cylinder filler cap.
Brake System Bleeding
Brake System Bleeding
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7045
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with brake fluid. 3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until
clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and
install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fittings until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tubes.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
Master Cylinder, Bench
Master Cylinder, Bench
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the specified brake fluid. Never reuse
the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (4WABS) > Page 7046
1. Support the brake master cylinder body in a vise and fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with
specified brake fluid.
^ Use clean brake fluid.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir. 3.
Slowly depress the primary piston until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air bubbles.
4. Remove the short brake tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Caliper: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes Roughness or Shudder When Braking
Brake Caliper: Customer Interest Brakes - Roughness or Shudder When Braking
TSB 06-12-5
06/26/06
BRAKE SHUDDER
FORD: 2004-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2004-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-3-17 to add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2004-2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles built between 12/18/2003 and 03/01/2006
may experience repeat front brake roughness and / or shudder while braking.
ACTION Determine if the vehicle has the old level rotors. If old level rotors, replace the front rotors
and front caliper assemblies. If vehicle has new level rotors replace caliper assemblies and turn or
replace the rotors as appropriate.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the build date of the front rotors. The build date is stamped on the inside of the rotor,
between the fins (Figure 1). If the rotor date code is before 4H23 (4=2004, H=August, 23=23rd),
replace the front rotors and front caliper assemblies. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 206-03
for front rotor and caliper replacement procedure.
NOTE
REPLACE CALIPERS WITH NEW SERVICE FIX CALIPER ASSEMBLIES BY REMOVING THE
CALIPERS AT THE KNUCKLES. THE SERVICE REPLACEMENT CALIPERS WILL BE
PRE-ASSEMBLED WITH ANCHOR, SPRINGS, AND PADS. THE CALIPERS SHOULD BE
INSTALLED AS A UNIT WITHOUT DISASSEMBLY.
2. If the rotor date code is 4H23 or greater replace the caliper assemblies and use the on-the-car
brake lathe to turn the rotor if still within minimum thickness specification. If rotor is beyond
machinable thickness, replace the front rotors.
NOTE
DUE TO THE PISTON SEAL ROLLBACK DESIGN CHANGE WITHIN THE CALIPER, THE
PEDAL TRAVEL MAY INCREASE APPROXIMATELY 9/32" (7 MM). THIS INCREASE IN TRAVEL
IS CONSIDERED NORMAL. THIS CHANGE DOES NOT AFFECT BRAKE STOPPING
DISTANCE AND/OR BRAKE EFFECTIVENESS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Caliper: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes Roughness or Shudder When Braking > Page 7055
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061205A 2004-2006 0.9 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Replace Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001B2PT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
061205B 2004-2006 1.5 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Refinish Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001BPT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2B120 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Caliper: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes
- Roughness or Shudder When Braking
Brake Caliper: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Roughness or Shudder When Braking
TSB 06-12-5
06/26/06
BRAKE SHUDDER
FORD: 2004-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2004-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-3-17 to add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2004-2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles built between 12/18/2003 and 03/01/2006
may experience repeat front brake roughness and / or shudder while braking.
ACTION Determine if the vehicle has the old level rotors. If old level rotors, replace the front rotors
and front caliper assemblies. If vehicle has new level rotors replace caliper assemblies and turn or
replace the rotors as appropriate.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the build date of the front rotors. The build date is stamped on the inside of the rotor,
between the fins (Figure 1). If the rotor date code is before 4H23 (4=2004, H=August, 23=23rd),
replace the front rotors and front caliper assemblies. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 206-03
for front rotor and caliper replacement procedure.
NOTE
REPLACE CALIPERS WITH NEW SERVICE FIX CALIPER ASSEMBLIES BY REMOVING THE
CALIPERS AT THE KNUCKLES. THE SERVICE REPLACEMENT CALIPERS WILL BE
PRE-ASSEMBLED WITH ANCHOR, SPRINGS, AND PADS. THE CALIPERS SHOULD BE
INSTALLED AS A UNIT WITHOUT DISASSEMBLY.
2. If the rotor date code is 4H23 or greater replace the caliper assemblies and use the on-the-car
brake lathe to turn the rotor if still within minimum thickness specification. If rotor is beyond
machinable thickness, replace the front rotors.
NOTE
DUE TO THE PISTON SEAL ROLLBACK DESIGN CHANGE WITHIN THE CALIPER, THE
PEDAL TRAVEL MAY INCREASE APPROXIMATELY 9/32" (7 MM). THIS INCREASE IN TRAVEL
IS CONSIDERED NORMAL. THIS CHANGE DOES NOT AFFECT BRAKE STOPPING
DISTANCE AND/OR BRAKE EFFECTIVENESS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Caliper: > 06-12-5 > Jun > 06 > Brakes
- Roughness or Shudder When Braking > Page 7061
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061205A 2004-2006 0.9 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Replace Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001B2PT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
061205B 2004-2006 1.5 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace Front Brake Calipers, Refinish Rotors (Do Not Use With 2000A,
2001BFA, 2001B2P, 2001BPT, 2001B5FT, 2001B8F, 2001B8FT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2B120 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7062
General Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7065
Front Brake Disc System
Front Brake Disc System
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7066
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can
result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the brake pads.
3. CAUTION: Install a new lining if it is worn to or past the specified thickness above the metal
backing plate or rivets. Install new pads in complete
axle sets.
Inspect the pads for wear or contamination.
4. Disconnect the front brake hose.
^ Use new copper washers to connect the front brake hose.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the disc brake caliper bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
6. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary. 7. Inspect the disc
brake caliper for leaks.
^ If leaks are found, the brake caliper must be disassembled.
8. Bleed the brake system. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7067
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Caliper
Material
Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7068
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the RH kick
panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which
can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the brake hose flow bolt and disconnect the hose.
^ Remove and discard the copper washers.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
3. Remove the brake pads.
4. Inspect the disc brake caliper for leaks.
^ If leaks are found, disassembly is required.
5. Bleed the brake system. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7069
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Rear
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Material
Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 brake fluid will cause permanent damage to
brake components and will render the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7070
brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
^ If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is half full.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 3. Using the large C-clamp, compress the pistons into the caliper
housing.
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the brake pads from the caliper anchor plate. 6. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor
plate bolts and the brake caliper anchor plate.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Test the brakes for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7071
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Front
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Removal
Front Brake Disc System
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7072
Front Brake Disc System
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid in the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled.
2. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can
result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: Install new brake pads if the lining(s) are worn to or past the specified thickness
above the metal backing plate or rivets. Install new
pads in complete axle sets.
Inspect the brake pads for wear or contamination. ^
Install new pads as necessary.
4. CAUTION: If the anchor housing spring is to be reused, do not force the anchor housing spring
off the brake caliper or damage to the spring can
occur. Do not install a damaged anchor housing spring.
Remove the anchor housing spring.
5. NOTE: The LH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the upper
brake caliper cavity.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7073
For the LH brake caliper, release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force at the center of the anchor housing spring and pull outward at the bottom of the anchor
housing spring to remove it from the lower brake caliper cavity.
6. Rotate the spring upward then remove it from the brake caliper.
7. NOTE: The RH anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the lower brake
caliper cavity. The illustration below shows the
anchor housing spring end with 2 tabs.
For RH brake caliper, release the upper portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force at the center of the anchor housing spring and pull outward at the top of the anchor
housing spring to remove it from the upper brake caliper cavity.
8. Rotate the spring downward then remove it from the brake caliper.
9. NOTE: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the guide pins and position the caliper aside. ^
Remove the zero-drag spring.
^ Remove and discard the brake caliper-to-anchor plate guide pins and boots.
10. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate bolts. 11. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate.
Installation
1. Install the brake caliper anchor plate and bolts.
^ Tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.).
2. Using brake parts cleaner, clean the inner surfaces of the brake caliper where the brake pads
attach.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7074
3. Install new brake hardware as follows:
^ Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
^ Apply grease to the inside of the guide pin bushing. Do not apply grease to the guide pin threads.
^ Push the guide pins into the bushing.
4. Install the inboard brake pad into the brake caliper. 5. Remove the protective paper from the
outboard brake pad and install it into the brake caliper. 6. Install the brake caliper on the brake disc.
7. Install the guide pins and install the dust caps.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
^ Install the guide pin boots.
8. Install the zero-drag spring.
NOTE: If present, the 2-tabbed end of the anchor housing spring must be installed first.
9. Install the anchor housing spring.
1 Insert the tab of the anchor housing spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2 Twist the tab into the brake caliper cavity (LH side-upper brake caliper cavity/RH side-lower
brake caliper cavity).
10. Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
11. Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the brake caliper anchor plate. 12. Push
down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched and
seated in the brake caliper cavities.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7075
13. NOTE: The latch MUST be positioned as shown.
Verify that the anchor housing spring is correctly latched.
14. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7076
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair
Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7077
Front Brake Disc System
Front Brake Disc System
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7078
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can
result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the brake pads.
3. CAUTION: Install a new lining if it is worn to or past the specified thickness above the metal
backing plate or rivets. Install new pads in complete
axle sets.
Inspect the pads for wear or contamination.
4. Disconnect the front brake hose.
^ Use new copper washers to connect the front brake hose.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the disc brake caliper bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
6. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary. 7. Inspect the disc
brake caliper for leaks.
^ If leaks are found, the brake caliper must be disassembled.
8. Bleed the brake system. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Caliper Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Caliper
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7079
Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the RH kick
panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which
can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the brake hose flow bolt and disconnect the hose.
^ Remove and discard the copper washers.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7080
3. Remove the brake pads.
4. Inspect the disc brake caliper for leaks.
^ If leaks are found, disassembly is required.
5. Bleed the brake system. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Rear
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7081
Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 brake fluid will cause permanent damage to
brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
^ If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is half full.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 3. Using the large C-clamp, compress the pistons into the caliper
housing.
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7082
^ Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the brake pads from the caliper anchor plate. 6. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor
plate bolts and the brake caliper anchor plate.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Test the brakes for normal operation.
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Front
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Removal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7083
Front Brake Disc System
Front Brake Disc System
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid in the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled.
2. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can
result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: Install new brake pads if the lining(s) are worn to or past the specified thickness
above the metal backing plate or rivets. Install new
pads in complete axle sets.
Inspect the brake pads for wear or contamination. ^
Install new pads as necessary.
4. CAUTION: If the anchor housing spring is to be reused, do not force the anchor housing spring
off the brake caliper or damage to the spring can
occur. Do not install a damaged anchor housing spring.
Remove the anchor housing spring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7084
5. NOTE: The LH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the upper
brake caliper cavity.
For the LH brake caliper, release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force at the center of the anchor housing spring and pull outward at the bottom of the anchor
housing spring to remove it from the lower brake caliper cavity.
6. Rotate the spring upward then remove it from the brake caliper.
7. NOTE: The RH anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the lower brake
caliper cavity. The illustration below shows the
anchor housing spring end with 2 tabs.
For RH brake caliper, release the upper portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force at the center of the anchor housing spring and pull outward at the top of the anchor
housing spring to remove it from the upper brake caliper cavity.
8. Rotate the spring downward then remove it from the brake caliper.
9. NOTE: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the guide pins and position the caliper aside. ^
Remove the zero-drag spring.
^ Remove and discard the brake caliper-to-anchor plate guide pins and boots.
10. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate bolts. 11. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate.
Installation
1. Install the brake caliper anchor plate and bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7085
^ Tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.).
2. Using brake parts cleaner, clean the inner surfaces of the brake caliper where the brake pads
attach. 3. Install new brake hardware as follows:
^ Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
^ Apply grease to the inside of the guide pin bushing. Do not apply grease to the guide pin threads.
^ Push the guide pins into the bushing.
4. Install the inboard brake pad into the brake caliper. 5. Remove the protective paper from the
outboard brake pad and install it into the brake caliper. 6. Install the brake caliper on the brake disc.
7. Install the guide pins and install the dust caps.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
^ Install the guide pin boots.
8. Install the zero-drag spring.
NOTE: If present, the 2-tabbed end of the anchor housing spring must be installed first.
9. Install the anchor housing spring.
1 Insert the tab of the anchor housing spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2 Twist the tab into the brake caliper cavity (LH side-upper brake caliper cavity/RH side-lower
brake caliper cavity).
10. Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
11. Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the brake caliper anchor plate. 12. Push
down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched and
seated in the brake caliper cavities.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7086
13. NOTE: The latch MUST be positioned as shown.
Verify that the anchor housing spring is correctly latched.
14. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Caliper Disassembly and Assembly, Front
Brake Caliper
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7087
Front Brake Disc System
Front Brake Disc System
Disassembly
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7088
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the brake caliper.
2. Apply low air pressure to the fluid port in the brake caliper.
1 Place a block of wood between the caliper bridge and the caliper pistons.
2 Apply low air pressure to the fluid port in the brake caliper to force out the caliper pistons.
3 Remove the block of wood and the caliper pistons.
3. Remove the caliper piston seals and boots. 4. Inspect the caliper bores for scoring or corrosion.
If scoring and corrosion exist, install a new brake caliper assembly.
Assembly
1. Lubricate the caliper piston boots, caliper pistons, caliper piston seals and caliper bores with
DOT 3 brake fluid.
2. Install the caliper pistons into the caliper bores.
1 Install the piston seals onto the caliper pistons.
2 Install the caliper piston boots onto the caliper pistons.
3 Insert the caliper pistons into the caliper bores.
4 Press the caliper pistons into the caliper bores.
3. Install the brake caliper.
Caliper Disassembly and Assembly, Rear
Brake Caliper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7089
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7090
Rear Brake Disc Components
Disassembly
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the disc brake caliper. 2. Drain the remaining brake fluid from the disc brake caliper. 3.
Secure the disc brake caliper in a vise. 4. Remove the caliper piston.
^ Place a block of wood between the caliper bridge and the caliper piston.
^ Apply low air pressure to the fluid port in the disc brake caliper.
^ Force out the caliper piston to the block of wood.
^ Remove the block of wood and the caliper piston.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7091
5. NOTE: Do not hone the cylinder bore. Caliper pistons are not available for honed cylinder bores.
If the disc brake caliper cylinder bore or piston
is excessively scored or corroded, install a new disc brake caliper.
Remove and discard the piston seal and dust boot.
Assembly
CAUTION: Never reuse the piston seal or dust boot.
NOTE: Never reuse brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system or has been
allowed to stand in an open container for an extended period of time.
1. Lubricate these items with brake fluid:
^ Cylinder bore.
^ Piston seal.
^ Caliper piston.
^ Dust boot.
2. Install the piston seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 7092
3. Using the special tools, install the dust boot.
4. CAUTION: Be careful not to damage or dislodge the piston seal.
CAUTION: Insert the caliper piston squarely into the caliper bore.
Install the caliper piston. ^
Place the brake caliper in a vise.
^ Place the piston squarely against the dust boot.
^ While applying shop air into the brake caliper, push the piston squarely into the brake caliper
bore.
5. Install the disc brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component Information
> Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Motorcraft High Performance DOT 3 Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... PM-1 Ford Specification ................................................
..................................................................................................................................... ESA-M6C25-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7099
C124
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7100
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Hydraulic Brake Actuation
The brake pedal is connected to the power brake booster, which is connected to the brake master
cylinder. The brake pedal is either fixed or adjustable; non-memory or memory is available. When
the brake pedal is depressed, brake fluid is pushed from the master cylinder through the metal
tubing and flexible hoses to the front disc brake calipers and the rear disc brake calipers. The front
disc brake caliper pistons are forced outward against the brake pads and contact the braking
surface of the brake discs. The brake fluid enters the rear disc brake calipers, forcing the rear disc
brake caliper pistons outward against the brake pads. The brake pads press against the braking
surface on the brake discs. When the brake pedal is released, the pressure is relieved, returning
the brake caliper pistons and the brake pads to the released position.
The dual brake system is split front and rear with the front wheel brakes comprising one circuit and
the rear wheel brakes, the other circuit.
The ability of a brake system to stop the vehicle is dependent on the available traction.
Brake Master Cylinder
The brake master cylinder is a dual-piston type.
The brake master cylinder is assisted by a power brake booster.
These conditions are considered normal and are not indications that the brake master cylinder is in
need of repair or replacement. ^
Low brake fluid level detected without signs of leakage. This condition is caused by displacement
of brake fluid from the brake master cylinder reservoir into the disc brake calipers to compensate
for normal brake wear. Add brake fluid as needed.
^ A momentary or slight ripple of brake fluid inside the brake master cylinder reservoir upon
application or release of the brake pedal.
A trace of brake fluid found on the outside of the power brake booster below the brake master
cylinder mounting flange. This condition results from the lubricating action of the brake master
cylinder wiping seal.
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
The brake fluid level warning switch is an integral part of the brake master cylinder reservoir. It
consists of a float containing a magnet and a reed switch mounted in the bottom of the brake
master cylinder reservoir.
When the brake fluid in the brake master cylinder reservoir gets to a predetermined level, the
floating magnet actuates the reed switch, causing the red brake warning indicator to illuminate.
Loss of brake fluid from either the primary (front) or secondary (rear) system will cause this system
to activate. If the brake fluid level warning switch is inoperative, a new brake master cylinder
reservoir must be installed.
Tubes and Hoses
CAUTION: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of a
specific design and new authorized parts only should be installed.
Steel tubing with flex hoses are used in the hydraulic tubes between the brake master cylinder and
the hydraulic control unit (HCU). Steel tubing is used between the HCU and the front and rear
hoses.
Double flared brake tubing provides good leakproof connections.
When replacing hydraulic brake tubing, hoses or connectors, tighten all connections securely. After
replacement, bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Brake Hose/Line: Description and Operation
Hydraulic Brake Actuation
The brake pedal is connected to the power brake booster, which is connected to the brake master
cylinder. The brake pedal is either fixed or adjustable; non-memory or memory is available. When
the brake pedal is depressed, brake fluid is pushed from the master cylinder through the metal
tubing and flexible hoses to the front disc brake calipers and the rear disc brake calipers. The front
disc brake caliper pistons are forced outward against the brake pads and contact the braking
surface of the brake discs. The brake fluid enters the rear disc brake calipers, forcing the rear disc
brake caliper pistons outward against the brake pads. The brake pads press against the braking
surface on the brake discs. When the brake pedal is released, the pressure is relieved, returning
the brake caliper pistons and the brake pads to the released position.
The dual brake system is split front and rear with the front wheel brakes comprising one circuit and
the rear wheel brakes, the other circuit.
The ability of a brake system to stop the vehicle is dependent on the available traction.
Brake Master Cylinder
The brake master cylinder is a dual-piston type.
The brake master cylinder is assisted by a power brake booster.
These conditions are considered normal and are not indications that the brake master cylinder is in
need of repair or replacement. ^
Low brake fluid level detected without signs of leakage. This condition is caused by displacement
of brake fluid from the brake master cylinder reservoir into the disc brake calipers to compensate
for normal brake wear. Add brake fluid as needed.
^ A momentary or slight ripple of brake fluid inside the brake master cylinder reservoir upon
application or release of the brake pedal.
A trace of brake fluid found on the outside of the power brake booster below the brake master
cylinder mounting flange. This condition results from the lubricating action of the brake master
cylinder wiping seal.
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
The brake fluid level warning switch is an integral part of the brake master cylinder reservoir. It
consists of a float containing a magnet and a reed switch mounted in the bottom of the brake
master cylinder reservoir.
When the brake fluid in the brake master cylinder reservoir gets to a predetermined level, the
floating magnet actuates the reed switch, causing the red brake warning indicator to illuminate.
Loss of brake fluid from either the primary (front) or secondary (rear) system will cause this system
to activate. If the brake fluid level warning switch is inoperative, a new brake master cylinder
reservoir must be installed.
Tubes and Hoses
CAUTION: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of a
specific design and new authorized parts only should be installed.
Steel tubing with flex hoses are used in the hydraulic tubes between the brake master cylinder and
the hydraulic control unit (HCU). Steel tubing is used between the HCU and the front and rear
hoses.
Double flared brake tubing provides good leakproof connections.
When replacing hydraulic brake tubing, hoses or connectors, tighten all connections securely. After
replacement, bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock
Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
Material
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock
Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7107
2. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical connector.
3. CAUTION: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of
specific design and only authorized parts should be
used when installing new inlet brake tubes.
NOTE: Plug each open port to prevent brake fluid from spilling.
Disconnect the 6 brake tube fittings. ^
To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the 3 hydraulic control unit (HCU)-to-bracket bolts and the HCU.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Brake Master Cylinder: Description and Operation
Hydraulic Brake Actuation
The brake pedal is connected to the power brake booster, which is connected to the brake master
cylinder. The brake pedal is either fixed or adjustable; non-memory or memory is available. When
the brake pedal is depressed, brake fluid is pushed from the master cylinder through the metal
tubing and flexible hoses to the front disc brake calipers and the rear disc brake calipers. The front
disc brake caliper pistons are forced outward against the brake pads and contact the braking
surface of the brake discs. The brake fluid enters the rear disc brake calipers, forcing the rear disc
brake caliper pistons outward against the brake pads. The brake pads press against the braking
surface on the brake discs. When the brake pedal is released, the pressure is relieved, returning
the brake caliper pistons and the brake pads to the released position.
The dual brake system is split front and rear with the front wheel brakes comprising one circuit and
the rear wheel brakes, the other circuit.
The ability of a brake system to stop the vehicle is dependent on the available traction.
Brake Master Cylinder
The brake master cylinder is a dual-piston type.
The brake master cylinder is assisted by a power brake booster.
These conditions are considered normal and are not indications that the brake master cylinder is in
need of repair or replacement. ^
Low brake fluid level detected without signs of leakage. This condition is caused by displacement
of brake fluid from the brake master cylinder reservoir into the disc brake calipers to compensate
for normal brake wear. Add brake fluid as needed.
^ A momentary or slight ripple of brake fluid inside the brake master cylinder reservoir upon
application or release of the brake pedal.
A trace of brake fluid found on the outside of the power brake booster below the brake master
cylinder mounting flange. This condition results from the lubricating action of the brake master
cylinder wiping seal.
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
The brake fluid level warning switch is an integral part of the brake master cylinder reservoir. It
consists of a float containing a magnet and a reed switch mounted in the bottom of the brake
master cylinder reservoir.
When the brake fluid in the brake master cylinder reservoir gets to a predetermined level, the
floating magnet actuates the reed switch, causing the red brake warning indicator to illuminate.
Loss of brake fluid from either the primary (front) or secondary (rear) system will cause this system
to activate. If the brake fluid level warning switch is inoperative, a new brake master cylinder
reservoir must be installed.
Tubes and Hoses
CAUTION: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of a
specific design and new authorized parts only should be installed.
Steel tubing with flex hoses are used in the hydraulic tubes between the brake master cylinder and
the hydraulic control unit (HCU). Steel tubing is used between the HCU and the front and rear
hoses.
Double flared brake tubing provides good leakproof connections.
When replacing hydraulic brake tubing, hoses or connectors, tighten all connections securely. After
replacement, bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition Test
Brake Master Cylinder: Testing and Inspection Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition Test
Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition Test
1. Disconnect the brake lines at the brake master cylinder. 2. Plug the outlet ports of the brake
master cylinder. 3. Apply the brakes. If brake pedal height cannot be maintained, the brake master
cylinder has an internal leak and must be rebuilt or installed new.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition Test > Page 7113
Brake Master Cylinder: Testing and Inspection Compensator Port Check
Compensator Port Check
The purpose of the compensator ports in the brake master cylinder is to supply any additional
brake fluid required by the system due to brake pad wear and to allow brake fluid returning from the
brake lines to the brake master cylinder to enter the brake master cylinder reservoir.
The returning brake fluid will cause a slight turbulence in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
Turbulence seen in the brake master cylinder reservoir upon release of the brake pedal is normal
and shows that the compensating ports are not plugged.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7114
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair
Brake Master Cylinder
Material
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Brake fluid contains polyglycol ethers and polyglycols. Avoid contact with eyes. Wash
hands thoroughly after handling. If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes with running water for 15
minutes. Get medical attention if irritation persists. If taken internally, drink water and induce
vomiting. Get medical attention immediately. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
All vehicles
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
Vehicles with cruise control
2. Disconnect the brake pressure switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7115
All vehicles
3. Disconnect the brake fluid level switch. 4. Loosen the brake pipe fittings and disconnect the
brake pipes.
^ Plug the master cylinder ports.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the 2 brake master cylinder nuts and the brake master cylinder.
^ To install, tighten to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Front
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Parking Brake Cable - Front
Parking Brake Cable - Front
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake control.
2. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located near the jack
storage area in the rear of the passenger compartment. Failure to do so may result in unexpected
inflation or deflation of the air springs which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these
operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
3. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Front > Page 7121
4. Remove the front park brake cable P-clip-to-frame bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the front parking brake cable and conduit.
^ Pry the rubber seal from the front floor pan.
^ Compress the retainer and release the conduit from the bracket.
^ Remove the front cable and conduit from the cable union.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Front > Page 7122
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Parking Brake Cable - Rear
Parking Brake Cable - RH Rear
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Verify that the parking brake control is fully released.
NOTE: This step will require the aid of an assistant.
Relieve the tension on the parking brake cable system. ^
Pull down on the front parking brake cable at the connector clip.
^ Insert a 4 mm (5/32 inch) pin into the parking brake lever lockout hole.
2. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Front > Page 7123
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH rear
quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs,
which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. Disconnect the RH rear cable.
^ Remove the RH rear cable from the cable union.
^ Compress the cable clip and release the conduit from the equalizer.
4. Remove the RH rear cable from the retaining clip. 5. Remove the bolt and the wireform bracket
from the upper control arm.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the rear park brake cable P-clip-to-frame bolt from the crossmember.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
7. Compress the retainer and release the conduit, then unclip the cable end fitting from the brake
caliper lever. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Front > Page 7124
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Parking Brake Cable - LH Rear
Parking Brake Cable - LH Rear
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Verify that the parking brake control is fully released.
NOTE: This step will require the aid of an assistant.
Relieve the tension on the parking brake cable system. ^
Pull down on the front parking brake cable at the connector clip.
^ Insert a 4 mm (5/32 inch) pin into the parking brake lever lockout hole.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Front > Page 7125
2. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH rear
quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs,
which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. Separate the LH rear cable from the equalizer.
4. Remove the conduit from the bracket.
1 Compress the retainer.
2 Remove the conduit from the bracket.
5. NOTE: Be sure to correctly install the park brake cable retainer spring during installation or the
park brake system will not operate correctly.
Remove the LH rear cable. 1
Remove the LH rear cable from the retaining clip.
2 Disconnect the park brake cable retainer spring.
3 Disconnect the ABS sensor wire from the retaining clip.
6. Remove the wireform bracket retaining screw and the bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
7. Compress the retainer and release the conduit, then unclip the cable end fitting from the brake
caliper lever. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Control: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Control
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Verify that the parking brake control is fully released.
NOTE: This step will require the aid of an assistant.
Relieve tension on the parking brake cable system. ^
Pull down on the front parking brake cable at the connector clip.
^ Insert a 4 mm (5/32 inch) pin into the parking brake lever lockout hole.
2. Remove the door scuff plate. 3. Remove the 2 screws and the instrument panel steering column
cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7129
^ Pull the weatherstrip back to release the edge of the panel.
4. Remove the parking brake release handle bolts. 5. Remove the retainer and the cowl trim panel.
6. Disconnect the parking brake release solenoid electrical connector. 7. Disconnect the parking
brake switch electrical connector. 8. Remove the 3 parking brake control-to-cowl panel bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
9. Straighten the tab on the take-up spool.
10. Disconnect the park brake cable conduit end fitting and remove the park brake control.
^ Compress the park brake cable conduit end fitting retainer to disconnect it from the control.
11. Remove the release handle and cable assembly from the controller. 12. Remove the release
solenoid.
^ Pry the mounting bracket apart slightly to release the solenoid.
13. Remove the parking brake control. 14. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Release Motor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Release Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7133
C2132
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Release Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Release Switch: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Release Switch
NOTE: Floor shift shown, column shift similar.
Removal and Installation
Column shift (Expedition only)
1. NOTE: The parking brake release switch is located on the steering column. It is serviced as an
assembly with the brake shift interlock.
Remove the brake shift interlock/park brake release switch assembly.
Floor shift
2. Remove the floor shift selector lever. 3. Disconnect the parking brake release switch electrical
connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Release Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7137
4. Remove the 2 parking brake release switch screws and remove the switch.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Make sure the switch is correctly aligned with the extension on the shifter before installing the
screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Shoe: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Shoes
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7141
1. NOTE: Verify that the parking brake control is fully released.
NOTE: This step will require the aid of an assistant.
Relieve the tension on the parking brake cable system. ^
Pull down on the front parking brake cable at the coupler.
^ Insert a 4 mm (5/32 inch) pin into the parking brake lever.
2. Remove the brake disc. 3. Remove the front parking brake shoe retaining clip and pin. 4.
Remove the parking brake shoe adjuster.
^ Using a suitable tool, spread the bottom of the parking brake shoes apart.
^ Remove the parking brake shoe adjuster.
5. Remove the parking brake shoe adjuster spring. 6. Slide the front parking brake shoe up and out
of the guide flange.
7. Remove the front parking brake shoe.
^ Rotate the front parking brake shoe outward.
^ Remove the parking brake shoe return spring.
8. Remove the rear parking brake shoe.
^ Remove the retaining clip and pin.
^ Remove the rear parking brake shoe.
9. Inspect the components for excessive wear or damage and install new parts as required.
Installation
1. NOTE: Before installation, lubricate the parking brake shoe contact points using silicone brake
caliper grease.
Install the rear parking brake shoe. ^
Hold the rear parking brake shoe in position.
^ Install the retaining pin and clip.
2. Install the front parking brake shoe.
^ Install the parking brake shoe return spring to the rear parking brake shoe and to the front parking
brake shoe.
^ Rotate the front parking brake shoe into the guide flange.
3. Slide the front parking brake shoe down into position on the flange. 4. Install the front parking
brake shoe retaining pin and clip. 5. Install the parking brake shoe adjuster spring. 6. Install the
parking brake shoe adjuster.
^ Using a suitable tool, spread the bottom of the parking brake shoes apart.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7142
^ Install the parking brake shoe adjuster.
7. Using the special tool, measure the inside diameter of the drum portion of the rear brake disc.
^ Record the measurement.
8. NOTE: Make sure that the parking brake shoes are correctly centered. Take the measurement at
the widest point across the center of the parking
brake shoes.
Using the special tool, measure the parking brake shoe diameter. ^
Rotate the adjuster to set the parking brake shoe diameter to 0.5 mm (0.02 inch) less than the
recorded inside diameter of the drum portion of the rear brake disc.
9. Install the brake disc.
10. NOTE: This step will require the aid of an assistant.
Enable the parking brake cable system. ^
Pull down on the front parking brake cable at the coupler.
^ Remove the retaining pin from the parking brake lever.
11. Check the operation of the parking brake.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7146
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7151
C149
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Vacuum Brake Booster: > 05-26-21 > Dec > 05 > Brakes Unintended Brake Assist
Vacuum Brake Booster: Customer Interest Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vacuum Brake Booster: > 05-26-21 > Dec >
05 > Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
Vacuum Brake Booster: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Unintended Brake Assist
TSB 05-26-21
12/31/05
UNINTENDED BRAKE ASSIST
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition/Navigator may exhibit excessive pedal travel and/or low pedal
effort, due to the mechanical or electronic brake assist being activated.
ACTION Review the brake assist characteristics and follow the Service Procedure if required.
Brake Assist Characteristics: The booster gain will be increased during panic braking, which
increases brake pressure and reduces pedal forces. The brakes will go to maximum pressure and
the tires will chirp, sounding as if the tires are locking up (normal anti-lock brake control should be
present). The pedal efforts will drop dramatically since the booster is providing maximum boost,
which allows the pedal to travel with little effort; this is normal. It feels as if the pedal travels
excessively, but the system is generating maximum brake pressure when this occurs; again, this is
normal.
When statically applying the brake pedal very hard, you may hear or feel (in the pedal) a slight
click. This is the brake assist feature engaging inside the booster. The system will remain active as
long as the brake pedal is depressed.
NOTE
MECHANICAL BRAKE ASSIST BOOSTERS ARE USED ON VEHICLES NOT EQUIPPED WITH
RIDE STABILITY CONTROL.
Vehicles equipped with Ride Stability Control receive an electronic active booster, which provides
the brake assist feature by activating an electronic solenoid inside the booster. The active booster
will provide similar pedal feedback when the feature is engaged, but the subtle clicks will not be
present.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To service, first advise the customer that the feature is there to help assist during panic braking.
If the customer did not experience a panic braking situation, then the brake assist may have been
unintended, on a mechanical brake assist system. Check for conditions that would lower the brake
pedal height and activate the brake assist.
1. Check for air in the brake lines, repair any leaks and bleed the brake lines as necessary. Refer
to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 General Procedures.
2. Inspect the brake linings for excessive wear, which can increase the pedal travel and engage the
mechanical brake assist. Refer to the Workshop Manual, Section 206-00 Diagnosis and Testing.
3. Check the vacuum line between the booster and the manifold for obstructions or kinks. Repair as
necessary.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2001 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7165
Vacuum Brake Booster: Description and Operation
Brake Booster
The power brake booster: ^
is a dual diaphragm, vacuum-assisted power brake booster.
^ reduces brake pedal pressure and travel distance.
^ is divided into separate vacuum and atmospheric pressure chambers by a diaphragm.
If the power assist fails, the brake system will continue to operate with increased brake pedal effort.
Hose and Check Valve
The power brake booster check valve: ^
closes when the engine is turned off.
^ in the closed position, traps engine vacuum in the power brake booster.
^ retains vacuum to provide several power-assisted brake applications with the engine off.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7166
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection
Brake Booster
1. Check the hydraulic brake system for leaks or insufficient fluid. 2. With the transmission in
NEUTRAL, stop the engine and apply the parking brake control. Apply the brake pedal several
times to exhaust all
vacuum in the system.
3. Apply the brake pedal and hold it in the applied position. Start the engine. If the vacuum system
is operating, the brake pedal will tend to move
downward under constant foot pressure. If no motion is felt, the power brake booster system is not
functioning.
Brake Booster Operation Check
1. Remove the vacuum booster hose from the check valve connection. Manifold vacuum must be
available at the check valve end of the vacuum
booster hose with the engine at idle speed and the transmission in NEUTRAL. If the manifold
vacuum is available to the power brake booster, connect the vacuum booster hose to the power
brake booster check valve and repeat Steps 2 and 3 of the Brake Booster check. If no downward
movement of the brake pedal is felt, install a new power brake booster.
2. Operate the engine a minimum of 10 seconds at fast idle. Stop the engine, and let the vehicle
stand for 10 minutes. Then apply the brake pedal
with approximately 89 N (20 lb) of force. The brake pedal feel should be the same as that noted
with the engine operating. If the brake pedal feels hard (no power assist), install a new power brake
booster check valve and retest. If the brake pedal feels spongy, bleed the hydraulic system to
remove air.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7167
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair
Brake Booster
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7168
2. Loosen the clamp and separate the air cleaner outlet tube and resonator from the air cleaner. 3.
Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 4. Lift the air cleaner assembly
from the air cleaner tray. 5. Remove the 3 power steering reservoir screws and position the
reservoir aside.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
6. Disconnect the brake fluid level switch and if equipped, the brake pressure switch.
7. NOTE: Support the master cylinder with a wire tie or mechanic's wire.
Remove and discard the 2 brake master cylinder nuts and position the master cylinder aside. ^
To install, tighten to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.).
8. Remove the 2 degas bottle bolts and position the degas bottle aside.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
9. If equipped, disconnect the pedal travel sensor and solenoid electrical connectors.
10. Release the compression clamp and disconnect the vacuum brake booster hose. 11. Remove
the cotter pin cover, pin, washer, bushing and switch, and disconnect the booster pushrod.
12. NOTE: The booster pushrod must be installed with the pushrod offset pointing downward.
Remove the 4 brake booster-to-pedal bracket nuts and remove the vacuum brake booster. ^
To access the retaining nuts, fold back the sound insulation.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Use new nuts when installing the master cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: Testing and Inspection
Check Valve
The function of the power brake booster check valve is to allow manifold vacuum to enter the
power brake booster and prevent the escape of vacuum in case manifold vacuum is lost during
sustained full throttle operation.
To test the function of the power brake booster check valve: ^
Start and run the engine for at least 10 seconds.
^ Operate the brake pedal to check for power assist.
^ Disconnect the vacuum booster hose from the power brake booster. Do not remove the power
brake booster check valve from the power brake booster.
^ There should be enough vacuum retained in the power brake booster for at least one more
power-assisted brake operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7176
C135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7177
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new module, it must be calibrated and configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical connector. 3. Remove the 3 bolts
and the ABS module.
^ To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7178
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Service and Repair
ABS Sensor Block: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control
sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Booster Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Booster Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7186
C149
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7190
C124
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7191
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Hydraulic Brake Actuation
The brake pedal is connected to the power brake booster, which is connected to the brake master
cylinder. The brake pedal is either fixed or adjustable; non-memory or memory is available. When
the brake pedal is depressed, brake fluid is pushed from the master cylinder through the metal
tubing and flexible hoses to the front disc brake calipers and the rear disc brake calipers. The front
disc brake caliper pistons are forced outward against the brake pads and contact the braking
surface of the brake discs. The brake fluid enters the rear disc brake calipers, forcing the rear disc
brake caliper pistons outward against the brake pads. The brake pads press against the braking
surface on the brake discs. When the brake pedal is released, the pressure is relieved, returning
the brake caliper pistons and the brake pads to the released position.
The dual brake system is split front and rear with the front wheel brakes comprising one circuit and
the rear wheel brakes, the other circuit.
The ability of a brake system to stop the vehicle is dependent on the available traction.
Brake Master Cylinder
The brake master cylinder is a dual-piston type.
The brake master cylinder is assisted by a power brake booster.
These conditions are considered normal and are not indications that the brake master cylinder is in
need of repair or replacement. ^
Low brake fluid level detected without signs of leakage. This condition is caused by displacement
of brake fluid from the brake master cylinder reservoir into the disc brake calipers to compensate
for normal brake wear. Add brake fluid as needed.
^ A momentary or slight ripple of brake fluid inside the brake master cylinder reservoir upon
application or release of the brake pedal.
A trace of brake fluid found on the outside of the power brake booster below the brake master
cylinder mounting flange. This condition results from the lubricating action of the brake master
cylinder wiping seal.
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
The brake fluid level warning switch is an integral part of the brake master cylinder reservoir. It
consists of a float containing a magnet and a reed switch mounted in the bottom of the brake
master cylinder reservoir.
When the brake fluid in the brake master cylinder reservoir gets to a predetermined level, the
floating magnet actuates the reed switch, causing the red brake warning indicator to illuminate.
Loss of brake fluid from either the primary (front) or secondary (rear) system will cause this system
to activate. If the brake fluid level warning switch is inoperative, a new brake master cylinder
reservoir must be installed.
Tubes and Hoses
CAUTION: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of a
specific design and new authorized parts only should be installed.
Steel tubing with flex hoses are used in the hydraulic tubes between the brake master cylinder and
the hydraulic control unit (HCU). Steel tubing is used between the HCU and the front and rear
hoses.
Double flared brake tubing provides good leakproof connections.
When replacing hydraulic brake tubing, hoses or connectors, tighten all connections securely. After
replacement, bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor > Page 7196
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor
C147
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Primary Brake Pressure Sensor > Page 7199
C148
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control
sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Release Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Release Switch: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Release Switch
NOTE: Floor shift shown, column shift similar.
Removal and Installation
Column shift (Expedition only)
1. NOTE: The parking brake release switch is located on the steering column. It is serviced as an
assembly with the brake shift interlock.
Remove the brake shift interlock/park brake release switch assembly.
Floor shift
2. Remove the floor shift selector lever. 3. Disconnect the parking brake release switch electrical
connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Release Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7206
4. Remove the 2 parking brake release switch screws and remove the switch.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Make sure the switch is correctly aligned with the extension on the shifter before installing the
screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7210
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Disconnect
the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the steering
wheel rotation sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-24 (Center Console)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7217
C280
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Right Front
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Right Front > Page 7222
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Right Front > Page 7223
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 7226
C440
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 7227
C160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 7228
C426
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the wheel speed sensor
harness retainer bolt and detach the retainers.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the 2 caliper anchor bolts and position the caliper, pads and anchor plate aside. ^
Support the caliper with mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 7231
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake shoes. 2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the
retaining clips. 3. Remove the rear wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7235
C245
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7236
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control
sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7244
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7245
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7246
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7247
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7248
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7249
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7250
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7251
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7252
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7253
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7254
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7255
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7256
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7257
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7258
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7259
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7260
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7261
C250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7262
Ignition Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7263
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7264
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Lower tilt release handle to access second screw.
Remove the lower steering column shroud. ^
Remove the screws.
3. NOTE: The screw is located behind the multi-function switch.
Remove the screw and the upper steering column shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7265
4. Remove the bolt, push the release and position the multi-function switch aside.
5. Disconnect the ignition switch electrical connector.
6. Remove the ignition switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Make sure that the spring located under the ignition switch is positioned on the steering column
lock rod.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Neutral Safety Switch: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 7269
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 7270
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Starter Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7275
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Central Junction Box (CJB), in the engine compartment, RH
side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7276
C2163
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7277
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair
Battery Cable: Service and Repair
BATTERY CABLES
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Page 7283
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Remove the nut
and position the ground cable terminal aside at the starter.
- To install, tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb-ft).
4. Remove the nut and position the starter solenoid positive cable terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
5. Remove the nut and position the starter solenoid wire terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
6. Disconnect the 2 battery cable harness locators from the A/C compressor mounting bolts. 7.
Remove the bolt and position the battery ground cable-to-frame terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
8. Remove the nut and position the generator harness terminal and the CJB cable terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
9. Remove the bolt and position the battery ground cable-to-cowl panel terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
10. Disconnect the battery cable harness in-line electrical connector and remove the battery cable
assembly. 11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Alternator: > 06-19-12 > Oct > 06 > Charging System - DTC
P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349
Alternator: Customer Interest Charging System - DTC P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349
TSB 06-19-12
10/02/06
DTC P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349-4.6L 3V AND 5.4L 3V
FORD: 2005-2006 Mustang 2004-2005 F-150 2005-2006 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006 Explorer
2007 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
MERCURY: 2006 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 06-2-9 to add a production fix date for Expedition and Navigator and
service parts updated.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 F-Super Duty and Expedition/Navigator vehicles built prior to 12/14/2005
and 2004-2005 F-150 vehicles, equipped with 5.4L 3V engine, and 2005-2006 Mustang GT
vehicles, equipped with 4.6L 3V engine, may exhibit a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0340 and/or
P0344; or 2006 Explorer 4dr/Mountaineer and 2007 Explorer Sport Trac vehicles equipped with a
4.6L 3V engine may exhibit a DTC P0345 and/or P0349. This may be due to a malfunctioning
diode or open phase connection in the generator.
ACTION Perform a generator frequency test to diagnose cause of concern. Do not replace the
generator unless a frequency test indicates a fault. This TSB provides step-by-step directions for
performing a generator frequency test using the WDS oscilloscope function.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
USING THE OSCILLOSCOPE TO MEASURE PEAK-TO-PEAK VOLTAGE IS NOT A GOOD
INDICATOR OF A FAULTY GENERATOR.
NOTE
ENSURE THERE IS NO BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTED TO THE VEHICLE.
1. Ensure the connections to the battery terminals, engine grounds, and generator B+ are clean
and secure.
2. Attach WDS battery cable clamps to battery/battery cables.
3. Turn on WDS.
4. Select the Toolbox Icon, (upper left of WDS screen).
5. Select Oscilloscope and then click OK.
6. Select Channel 1, Auto, Generator Ripple.
7. Select Calculations, Channel 1, Frequency.
8. Select Calculations again.
9. Push the RUN/STOP button. A waveform should display on the screen.
10. Start the vehicle and leave at idle (engine speed less than 800 RPM).
11. Turn on vehicle loads (high beams, blower set on high, heated seats, defroster, etc).
12. Examine the frequency reading on WDS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Alternator: > 06-19-12 > Oct > 06 > Charging System - DTC
P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349 > Page 7293
NOTE
WDS CAN CALCULATE THE FREQUENCY AUTOMATICALLY. THE CALCULATED
FREQUENCY IS LOCATED ON THE LOWER LEFT AREA OF THE OSCILLOSCOPE SCREEN.
SOMETIMES THE FREQUENCY CANNOT BE CALCULATED BECAUSE THE WDS CANNOT
RECOGNIZE AND MEASURE PEAK VALUES. IF THE WDS CANNOT CALCULATE THE
FREQUENCY, IT WILL DISPLAY "INVALID" WHERE THE FREQUENCY READING SHOULD BE.
THIS IS NORMAL IF THE RIPPLE VOLTAGE IS TOO LOW.
13. For a proper visible wave pattern, adjust the voltage scale and time scale until a good wave
pattern is visible. Typically, a setting of 1mS/div and 100mV/div is a good starting point and can be
adjusted as necessary.
14. Run vehicle until signal is steady. Then select the "RUN/STOP" button to freeze the waveform.
15. Determine if the generator is faulty based on frequency measurement:
NOTE
FREQUENCY IS DEPENDENT ON ENGINE RPM. PERFORM ALL TESTS AT IDLE OR
FREQUENCY READINGS WILL BE INACCURATE.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Alternator: > 06-19-12 > Oct > 06 > Charging System - DTC
P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349 > Page 7294
a. Compare the WDS saved waveform to the sample waveforms in Figure 1. If measured ripple
frequency is lower than 500 Hz, then generator is faulty and should be replaced. If generator is not
faulty proceed to Step 16.
b. If frequency calculation cannot be made by WDS, it can be calculated manually. See
MANUALLY CALCULATE FREQUENCY. If calculated ripple frequency is lower than 500 Hz, then
generator is faulty and should be replaced. If generator is not faulty proceed to Step 16.
MANUALLY CALCULATE FREQUENCY
^ Count the number of complete voltage dips over a given range of divisions on the scope trace
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Alternator: > 06-19-12 > Oct > 06 > Charging System - DTC
P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349 > Page 7295
^ Divide the number of voltage dips by the number of divisions to get the average voltage
dips/division
^ Divide the value in Step 2 by the time scale (e.g. 1mS/div = .001 sec/division) to get frequency
NOTE
THIS METHOD OF CALCULATING FREQUENCY IS SLIGHTLY DIFFERENT THAN THE
METHOD USED BY WDS, SO THE FREQUENCY MEASUREMENT VS. CALCULATED MAY BE
SLIGHTLY DIFFERENT.
16. If the frequency test does not indicate a fault with the generator, proceed with normal
Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis (PC/ED) diagnostics for the DTC. For F-Super Duty
vehicles only, if the DTCs are still present after diagnostics, reprogram the powertrain control
module (PCM) to the latest calibration using WDS release B38.11 and higher or B39.2 and higher.
Calibration files may also be obtained at the website. This new calibration is not included in the B39
CD. (DO NOT REPROGRAM EXPEDITION/NAVIGATOR, F-150, MUSTANG, EXPLORER,
MOUNTAINEER OR EXPLORER SPORT TRAC).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061912A 2005-2006 0.8 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator 5.4L 3V: Diagnose Generator Using WDS, If Generator Is Found Defective
Replace Generator (Do Not Use With 10346A, 10200A)
061912B 2005-2006 Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2004-2005 F-150 5.4L 3V:
Diagnose Generator Using WDS, If Generator Is Found Defective Replace Generator (Do Not Use
With 10346A, 10200A)
061912C 2005-2006 Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
5.4L 3V: Diagnose Generator Using WDS, If Generator Is Found To Be Functioning Properly
Reprogram The Powertrain Control Module (Do Not Use With 10346A, 10200A, 12650D,
12650D84)
061912D 2005-2006 Mustang 4.6L 0.8 Hr.
3V: Diagnose Generator Using WDS, If Generator Is Found Defective Replace Generator (Do Not
Use With 10346A 10200A, 9926A, 12650D,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Alternator: > 06-19-12 > Oct > 06 > Charging System - DTC
P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349 > Page 7296
1 2650D84)
061912E 2006 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer/2007 Explorer Sport Trac 4.6L 3V: Diagnose Generator Using WDS, If
Generator Is Found Defective Replace Generator. (Do Not Use With 10346A 10200A, 9926A,
12650D, 1 2650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
10346 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Alternator: > 06-19-12 > Oct > 06 > Charging System - DTC
P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349
Alternator: All Technical Service Bulletins Charging System - DTC P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349
TSB 06-19-12
10/02/06
DTC P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349-4.6L 3V AND 5.4L 3V
FORD: 2005-2006 Mustang 2004-2005 F-150 2005-2006 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006 Explorer
2007 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
MERCURY: 2006 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 06-2-9 to add a production fix date for Expedition and Navigator and
service parts updated.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 F-Super Duty and Expedition/Navigator vehicles built prior to 12/14/2005
and 2004-2005 F-150 vehicles, equipped with 5.4L 3V engine, and 2005-2006 Mustang GT
vehicles, equipped with 4.6L 3V engine, may exhibit a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0340 and/or
P0344; or 2006 Explorer 4dr/Mountaineer and 2007 Explorer Sport Trac vehicles equipped with a
4.6L 3V engine may exhibit a DTC P0345 and/or P0349. This may be due to a malfunctioning
diode or open phase connection in the generator.
ACTION Perform a generator frequency test to diagnose cause of concern. Do not replace the
generator unless a frequency test indicates a fault. This TSB provides step-by-step directions for
performing a generator frequency test using the WDS oscilloscope function.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
USING THE OSCILLOSCOPE TO MEASURE PEAK-TO-PEAK VOLTAGE IS NOT A GOOD
INDICATOR OF A FAULTY GENERATOR.
NOTE
ENSURE THERE IS NO BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTED TO THE VEHICLE.
1. Ensure the connections to the battery terminals, engine grounds, and generator B+ are clean
and secure.
2. Attach WDS battery cable clamps to battery/battery cables.
3. Turn on WDS.
4. Select the Toolbox Icon, (upper left of WDS screen).
5. Select Oscilloscope and then click OK.
6. Select Channel 1, Auto, Generator Ripple.
7. Select Calculations, Channel 1, Frequency.
8. Select Calculations again.
9. Push the RUN/STOP button. A waveform should display on the screen.
10. Start the vehicle and leave at idle (engine speed less than 800 RPM).
11. Turn on vehicle loads (high beams, blower set on high, heated seats, defroster, etc).
12. Examine the frequency reading on WDS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Alternator: > 06-19-12 > Oct > 06 > Charging System - DTC
P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349 > Page 7302
NOTE
WDS CAN CALCULATE THE FREQUENCY AUTOMATICALLY. THE CALCULATED
FREQUENCY IS LOCATED ON THE LOWER LEFT AREA OF THE OSCILLOSCOPE SCREEN.
SOMETIMES THE FREQUENCY CANNOT BE CALCULATED BECAUSE THE WDS CANNOT
RECOGNIZE AND MEASURE PEAK VALUES. IF THE WDS CANNOT CALCULATE THE
FREQUENCY, IT WILL DISPLAY "INVALID" WHERE THE FREQUENCY READING SHOULD BE.
THIS IS NORMAL IF THE RIPPLE VOLTAGE IS TOO LOW.
13. For a proper visible wave pattern, adjust the voltage scale and time scale until a good wave
pattern is visible. Typically, a setting of 1mS/div and 100mV/div is a good starting point and can be
adjusted as necessary.
14. Run vehicle until signal is steady. Then select the "RUN/STOP" button to freeze the waveform.
15. Determine if the generator is faulty based on frequency measurement:
NOTE
FREQUENCY IS DEPENDENT ON ENGINE RPM. PERFORM ALL TESTS AT IDLE OR
FREQUENCY READINGS WILL BE INACCURATE.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Alternator: > 06-19-12 > Oct > 06 > Charging System - DTC
P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349 > Page 7303
a. Compare the WDS saved waveform to the sample waveforms in Figure 1. If measured ripple
frequency is lower than 500 Hz, then generator is faulty and should be replaced. If generator is not
faulty proceed to Step 16.
b. If frequency calculation cannot be made by WDS, it can be calculated manually. See
MANUALLY CALCULATE FREQUENCY. If calculated ripple frequency is lower than 500 Hz, then
generator is faulty and should be replaced. If generator is not faulty proceed to Step 16.
MANUALLY CALCULATE FREQUENCY
^ Count the number of complete voltage dips over a given range of divisions on the scope trace
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Alternator: > 06-19-12 > Oct > 06 > Charging System - DTC
P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349 > Page 7304
^ Divide the number of voltage dips by the number of divisions to get the average voltage
dips/division
^ Divide the value in Step 2 by the time scale (e.g. 1mS/div = .001 sec/division) to get frequency
NOTE
THIS METHOD OF CALCULATING FREQUENCY IS SLIGHTLY DIFFERENT THAN THE
METHOD USED BY WDS, SO THE FREQUENCY MEASUREMENT VS. CALCULATED MAY BE
SLIGHTLY DIFFERENT.
16. If the frequency test does not indicate a fault with the generator, proceed with normal
Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis (PC/ED) diagnostics for the DTC. For F-Super Duty
vehicles only, if the DTCs are still present after diagnostics, reprogram the powertrain control
module (PCM) to the latest calibration using WDS release B38.11 and higher or B39.2 and higher.
Calibration files may also be obtained at the website. This new calibration is not included in the B39
CD. (DO NOT REPROGRAM EXPEDITION/NAVIGATOR, F-150, MUSTANG, EXPLORER,
MOUNTAINEER OR EXPLORER SPORT TRAC).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061912A 2005-2006 0.8 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator 5.4L 3V: Diagnose Generator Using WDS, If Generator Is Found Defective
Replace Generator (Do Not Use With 10346A, 10200A)
061912B 2005-2006 Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2004-2005 F-150 5.4L 3V:
Diagnose Generator Using WDS, If Generator Is Found Defective Replace Generator (Do Not Use
With 10346A, 10200A)
061912C 2005-2006 Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
5.4L 3V: Diagnose Generator Using WDS, If Generator Is Found To Be Functioning Properly
Reprogram The Powertrain Control Module (Do Not Use With 10346A, 10200A, 12650D,
12650D84)
061912D 2005-2006 Mustang 4.6L 0.8 Hr.
3V: Diagnose Generator Using WDS, If Generator Is Found Defective Replace Generator (Do Not
Use With 10346A 10200A, 9926A, 12650D,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Alternator: > 06-19-12 > Oct > 06 > Charging System - DTC
P0340/P0344/P0345/P0349 > Page 7305
1 2650D84)
061912E 2006 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer/2007 Explorer Sport Trac 4.6L 3V: Diagnose Generator Using WDS, If
Generator Is Found Defective Replace Generator. (Do Not Use With 10346A 10200A, 9926A,
12650D, 1 2650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
10346 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Alternator: Electrical Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Voltage.................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................12 volts Generator
amps...............................................................................65/110 amp (max) @ 1,800-6,000
generator rpm, approximately 500-2,000 engine rpm
Generator
Load at 2,000 rpm................................................................................................................................
....................................................................65 amps No Load at 2,000 rpm........................................
.......................................................................................................................between 13.2 and 15.5
volts
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 7308
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Alternator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7311
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7312
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7313
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7314
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7315
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7316
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7317
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7318
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7319
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7320
Alternator: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7321
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7322
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7323
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7324
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7325
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7326
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7327
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7328
Alternator: Connector Views
C102a
C102b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7329
Alternator: Application and ID
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Generator
Rating..............................................................................................65/110 amp (max) @
1,800-6,000 generator rpm, approximately 500-2,000 engine rpm Generator pulley ratio...................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................2.96:1 Voltage regulator type...........................................................................................
...............................................................Electronic internal with generator
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7330
Alternator: Description and Operation
GENERATOR
The generator is belt-driven by the engine accessory drive system. The generator has an internal
voltage regulator that is not replaced separately. A new generator and voltage regulator are
repaired as an assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7331
Alternator: Service and Repair
GENERATOR
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Do not allow any metal object to come in contact with the generator housing and
internal diode cooling fins. A short circuit may result and burn out the diodes.
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. For Navigator, release the 2 retainers and remove the engine cover. 3.
Remove the air cleaner intake pipe. 4. Rotate the front end accessory drive belt tensioner
counterclockwise and position the accessory drive belt aside. 5. Remove the harness locator from
the generator bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7332
6. Remove the 4 bolts and the generator bracket.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Remove the 2 bolts and position the generator aside.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
8. Disconnect the generator electrical connector. 9. Position the generator B+ protective cover
aside, remove the nut and position the generator B+ terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
10. Remove the generator. 11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Lock > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Ignition Lock: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - NON FUNCTIONAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the ignition
lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer. 4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering
column lock gear.
- Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage.
5. NOTE: Use a new ignition lock cylinder.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Verify ignition switch lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Lock > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional > Page 7338
Ignition Lock: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - FUNCTIONAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the accessory position.
Remove the ignition lock cylinder. 1. Press the release pin. 2
Remove the lock cylinder. Verify the ignition switch lock operation.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7344
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7345
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7346
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7347
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7348
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7349
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7350
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7351
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7352
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7353
Ignition Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7354
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7355
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7356
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7357
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7358
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7359
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7360
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7361
C250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 7362
Ignition Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 7363
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 7364
Ignition Switch: Service and Repair
Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Lower tilt release handle to access second screw.
Remove the lower steering column shroud. ^
Remove the screws.
3. NOTE: The screw is located behind the multi-function switch.
Remove the screw and the upper steering column shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 7365
4. Remove the bolt, push the release and position the multi-function switch aside.
5. Disconnect the ignition switch electrical connector.
6. Remove the ignition switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Make sure that the spring located under the ignition switch is positioned on the steering column
lock rod.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Neutral Safety Switch: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7369
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7370
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Cable > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-19-14 > Oct > 06 > Starting System- No Crank Condition
Starter Cable: Customer Interest Starting System- No Crank Condition
TSB 06-19-14
10/02/06
NO CRANK / STARTER TERMINAL FATIGUE
FORD: 1997-2007 Crown Victoria 1997-2004 F-150 Heritage 1997-2006 Expedition 1998-2006
E-Series 1999-2006 F-Super Duty 2002-2007 Explorer 2004-2006 F-150 2007 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 1998-2006 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2002-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some vehicles may exhibit a no crank condition due to an open circuit in the starter relay to
starter motor circuit at the starter motor connection.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
A new starter terminal wiring pigtail kit is released eliminating the need to replace the entire
harness for the terminal connection.
NOTE
TERMINAL KIT ONLY SERVICES THE STARTER RELAY TO STARTER MOTOR CIRCUIT. THE
KIT DOES NOT SERVICE STARTER MOTOR BATTERY POWER CIRCUIT.
Refer to instruction sheet contained in Wiring Pigtail Kit for wiring harness service procedure.
NOTE
REFERENCE THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL SERVICE SECTION 303-06 FOR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF THE STARTER MOTOR WIRING TERMINAL CONNECTION
PROCEDURES.
Parts Block WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty
Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061914A Install Wiring Pigtail kit (Do 0.4 Hr.
Not Use With 14200A)
MT061914 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Cable > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-19-14 > Oct > 06 > Starting System- No Crank Condition > Page 7379
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14A280 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Cable > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-19-14 > Oct > 06 > Starting System- No Crank Condition
Starter Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Starting System- No Crank Condition
TSB 06-19-14
10/02/06
NO CRANK / STARTER TERMINAL FATIGUE
FORD: 1997-2007 Crown Victoria 1997-2004 F-150 Heritage 1997-2006 Expedition 1998-2006
E-Series 1999-2006 F-Super Duty 2002-2007 Explorer 2004-2006 F-150 2007 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 1998-2006 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2002-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some vehicles may exhibit a no crank condition due to an open circuit in the starter relay to
starter motor circuit at the starter motor connection.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
A new starter terminal wiring pigtail kit is released eliminating the need to replace the entire
harness for the terminal connection.
NOTE
TERMINAL KIT ONLY SERVICES THE STARTER RELAY TO STARTER MOTOR CIRCUIT. THE
KIT DOES NOT SERVICE STARTER MOTOR BATTERY POWER CIRCUIT.
Refer to instruction sheet contained in Wiring Pigtail Kit for wiring harness service procedure.
NOTE
REFERENCE THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL SERVICE SECTION 303-06 FOR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF THE STARTER MOTOR WIRING TERMINAL CONNECTION
PROCEDURES.
Parts Block WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty
Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061914A Install Wiring Pigtail kit (Do 0.4 Hr.
Not Use With 14200A)
MT061914 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Cable > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-19-14 > Oct > 06 > Starting System- No Crank Condition > Page
7385
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14A280 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Cable > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Starter Cable: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt
Minder' Chime
Seat Belt Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder'
Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Cable > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Starter Cable: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt
Minder' Chime > Page 7391
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Cable > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Starter Cable: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt
Minder' Chime > Page 7397
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Starter Motor: > 06-19-14 > Oct > 06 > Starting System- No Crank Condition
Starter Motor: Customer Interest Starting System- No Crank Condition
TSB 06-19-14
10/02/06
NO CRANK / STARTER TERMINAL FATIGUE
FORD: 1997-2007 Crown Victoria 1997-2004 F-150 Heritage 1997-2006 Expedition 1998-2006
E-Series 1999-2006 F-Super Duty 2002-2007 Explorer 2004-2006 F-150 2007 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 1998-2006 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2002-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some vehicles may exhibit a no crank condition due to an open circuit in the starter relay to
starter motor circuit at the starter motor connection.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
A new starter terminal wiring pigtail kit is released eliminating the need to replace the entire
harness for the terminal connection.
NOTE
TERMINAL KIT ONLY SERVICES THE STARTER RELAY TO STARTER MOTOR CIRCUIT. THE
KIT DOES NOT SERVICE STARTER MOTOR BATTERY POWER CIRCUIT.
Refer to instruction sheet contained in Wiring Pigtail Kit for wiring harness service procedure.
NOTE
REFERENCE THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL SERVICE SECTION 303-06 FOR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF THE STARTER MOTOR WIRING TERMINAL CONNECTION
PROCEDURES.
Parts Block WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty
Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061914A Install Wiring Pigtail kit (Do 0.4 Hr.
Not Use With 14200A)
MT061914 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Starter Motor: > 06-19-14 > Oct > 06 > Starting System- No Crank Condition >
Page 7406
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14A280 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Starter Motor: > 06-19-14 > Oct > 06 > Starting System- No Crank
Condition
Starter Motor: All Technical Service Bulletins Starting System- No Crank Condition
TSB 06-19-14
10/02/06
NO CRANK / STARTER TERMINAL FATIGUE
FORD: 1997-2007 Crown Victoria 1997-2004 F-150 Heritage 1997-2006 Expedition 1998-2006
E-Series 1999-2006 F-Super Duty 2002-2007 Explorer 2004-2006 F-150 2007 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 1998-2006 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2002-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some vehicles may exhibit a no crank condition due to an open circuit in the starter relay to
starter motor circuit at the starter motor connection.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
A new starter terminal wiring pigtail kit is released eliminating the need to replace the entire
harness for the terminal connection.
NOTE
TERMINAL KIT ONLY SERVICES THE STARTER RELAY TO STARTER MOTOR CIRCUIT. THE
KIT DOES NOT SERVICE STARTER MOTOR BATTERY POWER CIRCUIT.
Refer to instruction sheet contained in Wiring Pigtail Kit for wiring harness service procedure.
NOTE
REFERENCE THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL SERVICE SECTION 303-06 FOR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF THE STARTER MOTOR WIRING TERMINAL CONNECTION
PROCEDURES.
Parts Block WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty
Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061914A Install Wiring Pigtail kit (Do 0.4 Hr.
Not Use With 14200A)
MT061914 Claim Additional Labor Actual
Required As Actual Time Time
Or Use SLTS Operation If Available
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Starter Motor: > 06-19-14 > Oct > 06 > Starting System- No Crank
Condition > Page 7412
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14A280 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Starter Motor: Electrical Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Normal engine cranking speed.............................................................................................................
................................................................140-220 rpm Starter motor armature shaft maximum
runout...........................................................................................................................................0.11
mm (0.004 in) Starter motor brush manufactured length......................................................................
..............................................................................16.8 mm (0.66 in.) Starter motor brush spring tens
ion.........................................................................................................................................................
...............18 N (65 oz) Starter motor commutator maximum runout.....................................................
..........................................................................................0.12 mm (0.005 in) Starter motor diameter
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................101.6 mm (4.0 in) Starter motor maximum load...............................................................
......................................................................................................................800 amps Starter motor
minimum stall torque (at 5
volts)........................................................................................................................................14.7
Nm (10.8 lb-ft) Starter motor no load current draw...............................................................................
..........................................................................................60-80 amps Starter motor normal load
current draw..........................................................................................................................................
....................130-220 amps Starter circuit maximum voltage drop (engine at normal operating
temperature).......................................................................................................0.5 volts
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 7415
Torque Specificiations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7416
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7417
Starter Motor: Diagrams
C197a
C197b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7418
Starter Motor: Service and Repair
STARTER MOTOR
Removal
WARNING: When carrying out maintenance on the starting system, be aware that the heavy gauge
leads are connected directly to the battery. Make sure the protective caps are in place when
maintenance is completed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Remove the starter terminal cover and remove the nut and the solenoid S-terminal electrical
connection. 4. Remove the nut and the solenoid B-terminal electrical connection. 5. Remove the
nut and the starter battery ground cable from the stud. 6. Remove the 2 bolts, the stud bolt and the
starter motor.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7419
1. Position the starter and install the 2 bolts and the stud bolt in 3 stages.
- Stage 1: Install the 2 starter bolts and the stud bolt finger tight.
- Stage 2: Tighten the upper bolt to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Stage 3: Tighten the lower bolt and stud bolt to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
2. Position the starter battery ground cable onto the stud and install the nut.
- Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
3. Connect the solenoid B terminal electrical connection and install the nut.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Connect the solenoid S terminal electrical connection and install the nut and the starter terminal
cover.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
5. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
Starter Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7423
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Central Junction Box (CJB), in the engine compartment, RH
side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7424
C2163
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7425
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7426
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear
C474
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear > Page 7432
C2033
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear > Page 7433
C3063
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear > Page 7434
C3064
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear > Page 7435
C3243
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1
C174
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1 > Page 7440
C194
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box
Fuse: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7445
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7446
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7447
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7448
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7449
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7450
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7452
Fuse: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7453
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7455
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7456
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7457
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7460
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7461
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7462
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7463
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7464
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7465
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7466
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7467
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7468
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7469
Fuse: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7470
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7471
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7472
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7473
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7474
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7475
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7476
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box
Fuse: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7479
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7480
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7481
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7482
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7483
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7484
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7485
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7486
Fuse: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7487
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7488
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7489
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7490
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7491
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box
Fuse Block: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7496
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7497
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7498
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7499
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7500
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7501
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7502
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7503
Fuse Block: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7504
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7505
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7506
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7507
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7508
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7511
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7512
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7513
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7514
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7515
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7516
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7517
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7518
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7519
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7520
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7521
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7522
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7523
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7524
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7525
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7526
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7527
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7528
Fuse Block: Connector Views
C270a
C270b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7529
C270c
C270d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7530
C270e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7531
C270f
C270g
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7532
C270h
C270j
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7533
C270k
C270m
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7534
C270n
C270p
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box
Fuse Block: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7537
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7538
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7540
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7541
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7542
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7543
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7544
Fuse Block: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7545
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7546
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7547
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7548
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7549
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7553
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7557
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C110-C314
C110
C133
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7562
C134
C144
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7563
C145
C146
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7564
C192
C210
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7565
C211
C212
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7566
C213
C214
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7567
C215
C219
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7568
C237
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7569
C238
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7570
C248
C260
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7571
C263
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7572
C265
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7573
C268
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7574
C291
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7575
C298
C299
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7576
C311
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7577
C312
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7578
C314
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7579
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C315-C2108
C315
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7580
C316
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7581
C327
C328
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7582
C340
C405
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7583
C406
C410
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7584
C411
C421
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7585
C422
C465
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7586
C494
C495
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7587
C510
C610
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7588
C700
C800
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7589
C913
C922
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7590
C925
C934
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7591
C935
C991
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7592
C1010
C1026
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7593
C2108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7597
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7598
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7599
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7604
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7608
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7612
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7613
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7614
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7619
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7620
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7621
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7622
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7623
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7624
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7625
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7626
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7627
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7628
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7629
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7630
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7631
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7632
Relay Box: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7633
C270a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7634
C270b
C270c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7635
C270d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7636
C270e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7637
C270f
C270g
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7638
C270h
C270j
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7639
C270k
C270m
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7640
C270n
C270p
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7643
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7644
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7645
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7646
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7647
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7648
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7649
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7650
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7651
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7652
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7653
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7654
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7655
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7660
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7661
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7662
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7663
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7664
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7665
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7666
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7667
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7668
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7669
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7670
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7671
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7672
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7673
Relay Box: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7674
C270a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7675
C270b
C270c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7676
C270d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7677
C270e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7678
C270f
C270g
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7679
C270h
C270j
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7680
C270k
C270m
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7681
C270n
C270p
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7684
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7685
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7686
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7687
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7688
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7689
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7690
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7691
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7692
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7693
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7694
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7695
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7696
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines
Wiring Harness: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines
TSB 06-17-8
09/04/06
SERVICE WIRING HARNESS REPLACEMENT GUIDELINES - SERVICE TIPS
FORD: 2000-2003 Focus 2005-2006 Focus 2005-2007 Mustang 2002 Ranger 2004-2007 F-150,
Freestar 2005 Escape 2005-2007 Expedition 2007 E-Series 2006-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN:
2005-2007 Navigator 2006-2007 Mark LI
MERCURY: 2004-2007 Monterey 2005 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 05-16-12 to update vehicle lines and model years.
ISSUE Ford Motor Company has "consolidated" high and low content harnesses to make the
service selection easier, and to reduce the number of harnesses required for service. Due to this
consolidation, service replacement harnesses may or may not look exactly like the production
harness being replaced. Service replacement harnesses may come equipped with additional
connectors that will not be used.
ACTION Should replacement of a production wire harness become necessary, determine whether
the harness is to be used in a WET or DRY environment, then refer to the appropriate Service
Procedure below.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF UNSURE WHETHER THE ENVIRONMENT FOR THE HARNESS WILL BE "WET" OR "DRY"
ALWAYS TREAT AS A "WET" ENVIRONMENT.
Extra Open Connectors - Procedure For "Dry" Environment/Interior Wiring Harness:
Any extra open connectors should be tucked, folded, and taped out of the way to avoid creating a
rattle or becoming loose (Figure 1). If space allows,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7701
position the connectors so they point downward this will avoid the connector catching water in case
of a water leak.
Extra Open Connectors - Procedure For "Wet" Environment/Exterior Wiring Harness:
1. Cut each wire from the extra connector as close to the connector as possible (Figure 2).
2. Using dual wall heat shrink tubing, position tubing over each individual wire (Figure 3).
3. Use a shielded, flameless heat gun to heat the repair area until the tubing shrinks and adhesive
flows out of both ends of the shrink tubing. While the adhesive is still hot, use pliers to pinch the
ends of the heat shrink tubing closed to form a moisture proof seal (Figure 4).
4. Use electrical tape to bundle the wires together, then stow the bundle under an existing harness
in the area.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7702
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7703
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-18-7 Date: 050922
Electrical - Wiring Soldering/Crimping Service Tips
TSB 05-18-7
09/22/05
WIRING - SOLDERING AND CRIMPING REPAIRS - SERVICE TIPS
FORD: 2000-2006 Crown Victoria, Focus, Mustang, Taurus 2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2006
Five Hundred, Ford GT, Freestyle 2006 Fusion 2000-2003 Explorer Sport, Windstar 2000-2005
Excursion 2000-2006 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-Super Duty, Ranger 2001-2005
Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2006 Escape 2004-2006 Freestar 2005-2006 Escape Hybrid 2000-2006
F-650, F-750 2006 Low Cab Forward
LINCOLN: 2000-2006 LS, Town Car 2006 Zephyr 2000-2006 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood
2003-2005 Aviator 2006 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2000-2002 Cougar 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2006 Grand Marquis 2005-2006 Montego
2006 Milan 2000-2006 Mountaineer 2004-2006 Monterey 2005-2006 Mariner 2006 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 03-11-6 to update the service procedure, vehicle lines and model
years.
ISSUE Wire harness repairs are supported through the availability of individual components such
as:
^ Wire terminals with machine crimped pigtails
^ Hard shell connectors
^ Dual wall heat shrink tubing
^ Complete, loaded, wiring pigtail kits
Some of the available tools and service parts that are helpful when performing wiring harness
repairs are:
^ Motorcraft Wiring Pigtail Catalog (see website for more information)
^ Rotunda Wire Splice Tool kit 164-R5903
^ General Wire Terminal Repair Kit (order through Ford Component Sales)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7704
Information on the pigtail and terminal repair kits can also be accessed by technicians via the P15
web site. To access on PTS:
^ Select the year/model of the vehicle on the P15 home page
^ Select the wiring tab
^ Select the link to the pigtail or terminal repair kit at the top right of screen.
Additional service information contained in this TSB detailing wire folding, soldering, and crimping
techniques may be helpful.
ACTION
REPAIR VS REPLACEMENT
The approved procedure is to repair wiring harnesses with pigtail kits, wire terminals, or hard shell
connectors when available. The only exceptions to this procedure are when:
^ The repair cost exceeds the cost to replace the wiring harness
^ There are no component parts released to service the wiring harness
RESTRAINTS RELATED WIRING REPAIRS
If restraints connectors or wiring circuits are contained in a stand-alone harness, do not repair
them; replace the restraints harness unless directed to repair the circuit by a TSB or other Ford
Motor Company publication.
If restraints connectors or wiring circuits are contained in the main vehicle wiring harnesses (14401,
14A005, etc.), they should be repaired using the solder and heat-shrink repair procedure specified
in this TSB. The General Wire Terminal Repair Kit contains gold plated terminated pigtails (with
white insulation) and dual wall heat shrink tubing to perform these repairs. Loaded wiring pigtail kits
with gold plated terminals are also available in the parts catalog.
Disclaimer
Service Tips
Refer to applicable model year wiring diagrams for circuit information.
Twisted Wire Circuits
For "Twisted Wire" circuit repair (Figure 1), the twisting must not be disrupted for more than 2" (51
mm) Twist the repaired wires in the same direction and with the same general twist rate as the
original wiring. Reapply the shielding on shielded circuits.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7705
Stagger the repairs to minimize harness diameter and maintain harness length (Figure 2).
Any leads that are not going to be used need to be sealed with dual wall heat shrink and stowed
(Figure 2). Silicone must not be used.
Excess wire from the harness can be folded back on itself to maintain the harness length.
Reapply any convolute and tape that was removed to make the repair.
For 16 AGW and Smaller Diameter Wire
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7706
1. Strip 1-1/2" (37.2 mm) of insulation from Wire # 1 and 3/4" (19.5 mm) of insulation from Wire # 2,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands (Figure 3). Pull wire straight from stripper. If wire is pulled
at an angle, wire strands may be cut off. If more than one (1) strand is cut off during stripping, cut
off the end and re-strip.
2. Install heat shrink tubing at least 1" (26 mm) away from one of the stripped ends being spliced.
Twist wires together. Solder wires together (Figure 4).
NOTE
USE ROSIN CORE MILDLY ACTIVATED (RMS) SOLDER. DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER
FOR WIRE REPAIR.
3. Bend Wire # 1 back in a straight line for sealing (Figure 4). Inspect solder joint bond.
NOTE
WAIT FOR SOLDER TO COOL BEFORE MOVING WIRES.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7707
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7708
4. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair (Figure 5).
NOTE
OVERLAP TUBING ON BOTH WIRES.
5. Use a shielded heat gun to heat the entire length of the heat shrink tubing until the hot melt
appears from both ends of the tubing. Durability of a heat shrink tubing splice is dependent on the
hot melt that will appear from both ends of the tube. The hot melt forms an adhesive seal between
the wire insulation and the heat shrink tubing, which prevents air and moisture from entering the
solder point (Figure 5).
For 14 AGW and Larger Diameter Wire (Excluding Restraints Wiring Repairs)
1. Strip 1/4" (6.35 mm) of insulation from pigtail wire end once the wire lengths are sized so repairs
can be staggered. Take care not to nick or cut wire strands. Pull wire straight from stripper. If wire
is pulled at an angle, wire strands may be cut off. If more than one (1) strand is cut off during
stripping, cut off the end and re-strip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7709
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7710
NOTE
THE STRIP LENGTH WILL VARY DEPENDING ON THE BUTT SPLICE AND WIRE IN
HARNESS. LONGER STRIP LENGTHS ARE REQUIRED WHEN THE WIRE NEEDS TO BE
FOLDED TO MATE WITH THE BUTT SPLICE. REFER TO FIGURE 10 CHART FOR STRIP
LENGTHS AND FOLDING TECHNIQUES.
2. Slide heat shrink tubing onto one (1) of the wire ends to be crimped, must be at least 1" (25.4
mm) away from stripped end (Figure 6).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7711
3. Identify the appropriate crimping chamber of the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper (or
equivalent) by matching the wire size on the dies with the wire size stamped on the butt splice
(Figure 7). Hold the crimping tool so the identified wire sizes are facing you. Squeeze tool handles
together until the ratchet releases, then allow the jaws of the tool to open fully.
4. Center one (1) end of the butt splice on the appropriate crimping chamber. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam of the butt splice toward the indenter (Figure 8).
5. Hold the butt splice in place and squeeze the tool handles together until the ratchet engages
sufficiently to hold the butt splice in position (typically one (1) or two (2) clicks). DO NOT deform the
butt splice.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7712
6. Insert stripped wire into the buff splice, making sure the insulation on wire does not enter the butt
splice (Figure 8).
7. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles together until ratchet releases. Allow tool
handles to open, then remove crimped butt splice.
8. To crimp the other half of the splice, reposition the un-crimped wire barrel in the same crimping
chamber, and repeat Steps 3-8. If splice cannot be turned for crimping the other half, turn the tool
around.
9. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. It is acceptable for crimp to be slightly
off center, but not off the end of the buff splice (Figure 9-a).
b. Wire insulation does not enter butt splice. Wire is flush with or extends slightly beyond end of
buff splice (Figure 9-b).
c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices (Figure 9-c).
10. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair (Figure 5).
NOTE
OVERLAP TUBING ON BOTH WIRES.
11. Use a shielded heat gun to heat the entire length of the heat shrink tubing until the hot melt
appears from both ends of the tubing. Durability of a heat shrink tubing splice is dependent on the
hot melt that will appear from both ends of the tube. The hot melt forms an adhesive seal between
the wire insulation and the heat shrink tubing, which prevents air and moisture from entering the
solder point (Figure 5).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear
C474
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear > Page 7718
C2033
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear > Page 7719
C3063
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear > Page 7720
C3064
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear > Page 7721
C3243
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1
C174
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1 > Page 7726
C194
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box
Fuse: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7731
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7732
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7733
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7734
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7735
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7736
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7737
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7738
Fuse: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7739
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7740
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7741
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7742
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction
Box > Page 7743
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7746
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7747
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7748
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7749
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7750
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7751
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7752
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7753
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7754
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7755
Fuse: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7756
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7757
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7758
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7759
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7760
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7761
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7762
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box
Fuse: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7765
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7766
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7767
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7768
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7769
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7770
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7771
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7772
Fuse: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7773
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7774
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7775
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7776
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Central
Junction Box > Page 7777
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box
Fuse Block: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7782
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7783
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7784
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7785
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7786
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7787
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7788
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7789
Fuse Block: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7790
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7791
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7792
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7793
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7794
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7797
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7798
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7799
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7800
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7801
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7802
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7803
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7804
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7805
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7806
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7807
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7808
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7809
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7810
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7811
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7812
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7813
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7814
Fuse Block: Connector Views
C270a
C270b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7815
C270c
C270d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7816
C270e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7817
C270f
C270g
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7818
C270h
C270j
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7819
C270k
C270m
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7820
C270n
C270p
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box
Fuse Block: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7823
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7824
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7825
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7826
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7827
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7828
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7829
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7830
Fuse Block: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7831
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7832
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7833
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7834
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7835
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7839
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7843
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C110-C314
C110
C133
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7848
C134
C144
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7849
C145
C146
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7850
C192
C210
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7851
C211
C212
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7852
C213
C214
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7853
C215
C219
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7854
C237
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7855
C238
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7856
C248
C260
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7857
C263
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7858
C265
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7859
C268
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7860
C291
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7861
C298
C299
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7862
C311
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7863
C312
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7864
C314
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7865
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C315-C2108
C315
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7866
C316
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7867
C327
C328
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7868
C340
C405
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7869
C406
C410
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7870
C411
C421
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7871
C422
C465
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7872
C494
C495
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7873
C510
C610
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7874
C700
C800
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7875
C913
C922
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7876
C925
C934
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7877
C935
C991
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7878
C1010
C1026
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C314 > Page 7879
C2108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7883
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7884
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7885
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7890
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7894
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7898
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7899
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7900
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7905
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7906
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7907
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7908
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7909
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7910
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7911
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7912
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7913
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7914
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7915
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7916
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Central Junction Box > Page 7917
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7918
Relay Box: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7919
C270a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7920
C270b
C270c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7921
C270d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7922
C270e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7923
C270f
C270g
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7924
C270h
C270j
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7925
C270k
C270m
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7926
C270n
C270p
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7929
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7930
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7931
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7932
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7933
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7934
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7935
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7936
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7937
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7938
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7939
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7940
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Central Junction Box > Page 7941
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box
Relay Box: Locations Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7946
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7947
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7948
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7949
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7950
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7951
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7952
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7953
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7954
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7955
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7956
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7957
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Central
Junction Box > Page 7958
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7959
Relay Box: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7960
C270a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7961
C270b
C270c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7962
C270d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7963
C270e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7964
C270f
C270g
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7965
C270h
C270j
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7966
C270k
C270m
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Page 7967
C270n
C270p
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Central Junction Box
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7970
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7971
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7972
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7973
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7974
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7975
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7976
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7977
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7978
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7979
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7980
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7981
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Central Junction Box > Page 7982
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines
Wiring Harness: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines
TSB 06-17-8
09/04/06
SERVICE WIRING HARNESS REPLACEMENT GUIDELINES - SERVICE TIPS
FORD: 2000-2003 Focus 2005-2006 Focus 2005-2007 Mustang 2002 Ranger 2004-2007 F-150,
Freestar 2005 Escape 2005-2007 Expedition 2007 E-Series 2006-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN:
2005-2007 Navigator 2006-2007 Mark LI
MERCURY: 2004-2007 Monterey 2005 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 05-16-12 to update vehicle lines and model years.
ISSUE Ford Motor Company has "consolidated" high and low content harnesses to make the
service selection easier, and to reduce the number of harnesses required for service. Due to this
consolidation, service replacement harnesses may or may not look exactly like the production
harness being replaced. Service replacement harnesses may come equipped with additional
connectors that will not be used.
ACTION Should replacement of a production wire harness become necessary, determine whether
the harness is to be used in a WET or DRY environment, then refer to the appropriate Service
Procedure below.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF UNSURE WHETHER THE ENVIRONMENT FOR THE HARNESS WILL BE "WET" OR "DRY"
ALWAYS TREAT AS A "WET" ENVIRONMENT.
Extra Open Connectors - Procedure For "Dry" Environment/Interior Wiring Harness:
Any extra open connectors should be tucked, folded, and taped out of the way to avoid creating a
rattle or becoming loose (Figure 1). If space allows,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7987
position the connectors so they point downward this will avoid the connector catching water in case
of a water leak.
Extra Open Connectors - Procedure For "Wet" Environment/Exterior Wiring Harness:
1. Cut each wire from the extra connector as close to the connector as possible (Figure 2).
2. Using dual wall heat shrink tubing, position tubing over each individual wire (Figure 3).
3. Use a shielded, flameless heat gun to heat the repair area until the tubing shrinks and adhesive
flows out of both ends of the shrink tubing. While the adhesive is still hot, use pliers to pinch the
ends of the heat shrink tubing closed to form a moisture proof seal (Figure 4).
4. Use electrical tape to bundle the wires together, then stow the bundle under an existing harness
in the area.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7988
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7989
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-18-7 Date: 050922
Electrical - Wiring Soldering/Crimping Service Tips
TSB 05-18-7
09/22/05
WIRING - SOLDERING AND CRIMPING REPAIRS - SERVICE TIPS
FORD: 2000-2006 Crown Victoria, Focus, Mustang, Taurus 2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2006
Five Hundred, Ford GT, Freestyle 2006 Fusion 2000-2003 Explorer Sport, Windstar 2000-2005
Excursion 2000-2006 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-Super Duty, Ranger 2001-2005
Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2006 Escape 2004-2006 Freestar 2005-2006 Escape Hybrid 2000-2006
F-650, F-750 2006 Low Cab Forward
LINCOLN: 2000-2006 LS, Town Car 2006 Zephyr 2000-2006 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood
2003-2005 Aviator 2006 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2000-2002 Cougar 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2006 Grand Marquis 2005-2006 Montego
2006 Milan 2000-2006 Mountaineer 2004-2006 Monterey 2005-2006 Mariner 2006 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 03-11-6 to update the service procedure, vehicle lines and model
years.
ISSUE Wire harness repairs are supported through the availability of individual components such
as:
^ Wire terminals with machine crimped pigtails
^ Hard shell connectors
^ Dual wall heat shrink tubing
^ Complete, loaded, wiring pigtail kits
Some of the available tools and service parts that are helpful when performing wiring harness
repairs are:
^ Motorcraft Wiring Pigtail Catalog (see website for more information)
^ Rotunda Wire Splice Tool kit 164-R5903
^ General Wire Terminal Repair Kit (order through Ford Component Sales)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7990
Information on the pigtail and terminal repair kits can also be accessed by technicians via the P15
web site. To access on PTS:
^ Select the year/model of the vehicle on the P15 home page
^ Select the wiring tab
^ Select the link to the pigtail or terminal repair kit at the top right of screen.
Additional service information contained in this TSB detailing wire folding, soldering, and crimping
techniques may be helpful.
ACTION
REPAIR VS REPLACEMENT
The approved procedure is to repair wiring harnesses with pigtail kits, wire terminals, or hard shell
connectors when available. The only exceptions to this procedure are when:
^ The repair cost exceeds the cost to replace the wiring harness
^ There are no component parts released to service the wiring harness
RESTRAINTS RELATED WIRING REPAIRS
If restraints connectors or wiring circuits are contained in a stand-alone harness, do not repair
them; replace the restraints harness unless directed to repair the circuit by a TSB or other Ford
Motor Company publication.
If restraints connectors or wiring circuits are contained in the main vehicle wiring harnesses (14401,
14A005, etc.), they should be repaired using the solder and heat-shrink repair procedure specified
in this TSB. The General Wire Terminal Repair Kit contains gold plated terminated pigtails (with
white insulation) and dual wall heat shrink tubing to perform these repairs. Loaded wiring pigtail kits
with gold plated terminals are also available in the parts catalog.
Disclaimer
Service Tips
Refer to applicable model year wiring diagrams for circuit information.
Twisted Wire Circuits
For "Twisted Wire" circuit repair (Figure 1), the twisting must not be disrupted for more than 2" (51
mm) Twist the repaired wires in the same direction and with the same general twist rate as the
original wiring. Reapply the shielding on shielded circuits.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7991
Stagger the repairs to minimize harness diameter and maintain harness length (Figure 2).
Any leads that are not going to be used need to be sealed with dual wall heat shrink and stowed
(Figure 2). Silicone must not be used.
Excess wire from the harness can be folded back on itself to maintain the harness length.
Reapply any convolute and tape that was removed to make the repair.
For 16 AGW and Smaller Diameter Wire
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7992
1. Strip 1-1/2" (37.2 mm) of insulation from Wire # 1 and 3/4" (19.5 mm) of insulation from Wire # 2,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands (Figure 3). Pull wire straight from stripper. If wire is pulled
at an angle, wire strands may be cut off. If more than one (1) strand is cut off during stripping, cut
off the end and re-strip.
2. Install heat shrink tubing at least 1" (26 mm) away from one of the stripped ends being spliced.
Twist wires together. Solder wires together (Figure 4).
NOTE
USE ROSIN CORE MILDLY ACTIVATED (RMS) SOLDER. DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER
FOR WIRE REPAIR.
3. Bend Wire # 1 back in a straight line for sealing (Figure 4). Inspect solder joint bond.
NOTE
WAIT FOR SOLDER TO COOL BEFORE MOVING WIRES.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7993
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7994
4. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair (Figure 5).
NOTE
OVERLAP TUBING ON BOTH WIRES.
5. Use a shielded heat gun to heat the entire length of the heat shrink tubing until the hot melt
appears from both ends of the tubing. Durability of a heat shrink tubing splice is dependent on the
hot melt that will appear from both ends of the tube. The hot melt forms an adhesive seal between
the wire insulation and the heat shrink tubing, which prevents air and moisture from entering the
solder point (Figure 5).
For 14 AGW and Larger Diameter Wire (Excluding Restraints Wiring Repairs)
1. Strip 1/4" (6.35 mm) of insulation from pigtail wire end once the wire lengths are sized so repairs
can be staggered. Take care not to nick or cut wire strands. Pull wire straight from stripper. If wire
is pulled at an angle, wire strands may be cut off. If more than one (1) strand is cut off during
stripping, cut off the end and re-strip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7995
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7996
NOTE
THE STRIP LENGTH WILL VARY DEPENDING ON THE BUTT SPLICE AND WIRE IN
HARNESS. LONGER STRIP LENGTHS ARE REQUIRED WHEN THE WIRE NEEDS TO BE
FOLDED TO MATE WITH THE BUTT SPLICE. REFER TO FIGURE 10 CHART FOR STRIP
LENGTHS AND FOLDING TECHNIQUES.
2. Slide heat shrink tubing onto one (1) of the wire ends to be crimped, must be at least 1" (25.4
mm) away from stripped end (Figure 6).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7997
3. Identify the appropriate crimping chamber of the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper (or
equivalent) by matching the wire size on the dies with the wire size stamped on the butt splice
(Figure 7). Hold the crimping tool so the identified wire sizes are facing you. Squeeze tool handles
together until the ratchet releases, then allow the jaws of the tool to open fully.
4. Center one (1) end of the butt splice on the appropriate crimping chamber. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam of the butt splice toward the indenter (Figure 8).
5. Hold the butt splice in place and squeeze the tool handles together until the ratchet engages
sufficiently to hold the butt splice in position (typically one (1) or two (2) clicks). DO NOT deform the
butt splice.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7998
6. Insert stripped wire into the buff splice, making sure the insulation on wire does not enter the butt
splice (Figure 8).
7. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles together until ratchet releases. Allow tool
handles to open, then remove crimped butt splice.
8. To crimp the other half of the splice, reposition the un-crimped wire barrel in the same crimping
chamber, and repeat Steps 3-8. If splice cannot be turned for crimping the other half, turn the tool
around.
9. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. It is acceptable for crimp to be slightly
off center, but not off the end of the buff splice (Figure 9-a).
b. Wire insulation does not enter butt splice. Wire is flush with or extends slightly beyond end of
buff splice (Figure 9-b).
c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices (Figure 9-c).
10. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair (Figure 5).
NOTE
OVERLAP TUBING ON BOTH WIRES.
11. Use a shielded heat gun to heat the entire length of the heat shrink tubing until the hot melt
appears from both ends of the tubing. Durability of a heat shrink tubing splice is dependent on the
hot melt that will appear from both ends of the tube. The hot melt forms an adhesive seal between
the wire insulation and the heat shrink tubing, which prevents air and moisture from entering the
solder point (Figure 5).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications Total
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications Total
ALIGNMENT SPECIFICATIONS
FRONT COIL SPRING SUSPENSION
CAMBER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... -0.3° ± 0.75° RH ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. -0.3° ± 0.75°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
CASTER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 5.3° ± 1.0° RH ...........................................................................
...................................................................................................................................... 5.3° ± 1.0°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
TOE @ CURB RIDE HEIGHT
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... --- RH ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. --Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0.14° ± 0.20°
NOTE: Positive value is toe-in, negative value is toe-out.
FRONT AIR SUSPENSION
CAMBER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
............................................ -0.6°/ -0.3° ± 0.75° RH ............................................................................
....................................................................................................................... -0.6°/ -0.3° ± 0.75°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
CASTER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 5.5°/5.4° ± 1.0° RH ............................................................................
............................................................................................................................. 5.5°/5.4° ± 1.0°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
TOE @ TRIM RIDE HEIGHT
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... --- RH ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. --Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0.14° ± 0.20°
NOTE: Positive value is toe-in, negative value is toe-out.
REAR COIL SPRING SUSPENSION
CAMBER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... -0.9° ± 0.75° RH ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. -0.9° ± 0.75°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
TOE @ CURB RIDE HEIGHT
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... --- RH ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. --Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0.20° ± 0.20°
NOTE: Positive value is toe-in, negative value is toe-out.
REAR AIR SUSPENSION
CAMBER
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... -1.0° ± 0.75° RH ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. -1.0° ± 0.75°
Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 0° ± 0.75°
TOE @ TRIM RIDE HEIGHT
LH ........................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... --- RH ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. --Total/Split .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0.20° ± 0.20°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications Total > Page 8004
NOTE: Positive value is toe-in, negative value is toe-out.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications Total > Page 8005
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 8006
Alignment: Description and Operation
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie-rods. The rear camber is adjusted by positioning the upper
arm-to-knuckle bolt in the upper arm-to-knuckle slot. The rear toe is adjusted by the use of the rear
toe links.
Camber
Negative and Positive Camber
Camber is the vertical tilt of the wheel when viewed from the front. Camber can be positive or
negative and has a direct effect on tire wear.
Caster
Caster
Caster is the deviation from vertical of an imaginary line drawn through the ball joints when viewed
from the side. The caster specifications will give the vehicle the best directional stability
characteristics when loaded and driven. The caster setting does not effect tire wear.
Toe
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 8007
Positive Toe (Toe In)
Negative Toe (Toe Out)
The vehicle toe setting: ^
affects tire wear and directional stability.
^ must be checked after adding aftermarket equipment, such as a snowplow.
Ride Height
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim height prior to measuring the vehicle ride height.
Front Ride Height Measurement
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 8008
Rear Ride Height Measurement
Wheel Track
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 8009
Dogtracking
Dogtracking is the condition in which the rear axle is not square to the chassis. Heavily crowned
roads can give the illusion of dogtracking.
Wander
Wander is the tendency of the vehicle to require frequent, random left and right steering wheel
corrections to maintain a straight path down a level road.
Shimmy
Shimmy, as observed by the driver, is large, consistent, rotational oscillations of the steering wheel
resulting from large, side-to-side (lateral) tire/wheel movements. Shimmy is usually experienced
near 64 km/h (40 mph), and can begin or be amplified when the tire contacts pot holes or
irregularities in the road surface.
Nibble
Sometimes confused with shimmy, nibble is a condition resulting from tire interaction with various
road surfaces or tire imbalance. This condition is observed by the driver as small rotational
oscillations of the steering wheel.
Poor Returnability/Sticky Steering
Poor returnability and sticky steering is used to describe the poor return of the steering wheel to
center after a turn or when the steering correction is completed.
Drift/Pull
Pull is a tugging sensation, felt by the hands on the steering wheel, that must be overcome to keep
the vehicle going straight. Drift describes what a vehicle with this condition does with hands off the
steering wheel. ^
A vehicle-related drift/pull, on a flat road, will cause a consistent deviation from the straight-ahead
path and require constant steering input in the opposite direction to counteract the effect
^ Drift/Pull may be induced by conditions external to the vehicle (such as wind or road camber).
Poor Groove Feel
Poor groove feel is, characterized by little or no buildup of turning effort felt in the steering wheel as
the wheel is rocked slowly left and right within very small turns around center or straight-ahead
(under 20 degrees of steering wheel turn). Efforts may be said to be "flat on center." ^
Under 20 degrees of turn, most of the turning effort that builds up comes from the mesh of gear
teeth in the steering gear. In this range, the steering wheel is not yet turned enough to feel the
effort from the self-aligning forces at the road wheel or tire patch.
^ In the diagnosis of a steering or alignment concern, it is important to understand the difference
between wander and poor groove feel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment Front
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber and Caster Adjustment Front
Camber and Caster Adjustment Front
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the front caster and
camber.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the caster and camber values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Remove and discard the lower arm front and rear nuts and bolts.
3. NOTE: New lower arm front and rear bolts must be installed with cam bolt kits (2L1Z-3B236-AC
for front bushing; and 2L1Z-3B236-AD for
rear bushing), to allow for adjustment of the arm in the frame slot. The vehicle should be supported
by the frame to ease movement of the lower arm in the slot.
Install the cam bolt kit and loosely install the nut.
4. To adjust the caster and camber, refer to the following chart.
^ Adjustments that require moving the front and the rear of the lower arm should be made equally.
5. While holding the cam bolt, tighten the nut to 270 Nm (199 ft. lbs.). 6. Cheek and, if necessary,
adjust the front toe.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment Front > Page 8012
Alignment: Service and Repair Front Toe Adjustment
Front Toe Adjustment
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the front toe.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the front toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Start the engine and center the steering wheel. 3. Turn the engine off and, using a suitable
steering wheel holding device, lock the steering wheel in the straight-ahead position.
4. Remove the steering gear bellows clamp(s).
5. Loosen the tie-rod end jam nut(s).
6. NOTE: Do not allow the steering gear bellows to twist while rotating the tie-rod.
Rotate the tie-rod(s) to achieve the desired toe setting.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment Front > Page 8013
7. CAUTION: Make sure to hold the tie-rod end stationary while tightening the jam nut or damage
to the boot can occur.
NOTE: Make sure that the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the jam nuts.
Tighten the tie-rod end jam nut(s) to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the steering gear bellows clamp(s). 9. Start the engine and center the steering wheel.
^ Recheck the toe settings and adjust as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment Front > Page 8014
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment - Rear
Camber Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the rear caster.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the rear caster value is not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Determine desired camber adjustment (subtract the specified camber angle from the measured
camber angle).
3. Mark a scribe line on the upper arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt head and upper arm.
Desired Camber Adjustment (In Degrees) (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment Front > Page 8015
Desired Camber Adjustment (In Degrees) (Part 2)
4. Use the following table to determine the camber adjustment required. Obtained by subtracting
the specified camber angle from the measure
camber angle.
5. Remove the upper arm-to-knuckle nut and install a new one until snug.
6. NOTE: Support the vehicle at the lower arm to ease the wheel knuckle movement in the upper
arm slot.
Position the upper arm-to-knuckle bolt in the upper arm slot as required to adjust the camber angle
to the value obtained in Step 4.
7. Tighten the upper arm-to-knuckle nut to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.). 8. Recheck the camber setting,
adjust as necessary. 9. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear toe.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment Front > Page 8016
Alignment: Service and Repair Rear Toe Adjustment
Rear Toe Adjustment
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the rear toe.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the rear toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Loosen the toe link jam nut(s).
3. Rotate the toe link tie-rod to achieve the desired toe setting.
4. NOTE: Make sure the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the jam nuts.
Tighten the toe link jam nut(s) to 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs.).
5. Recheck the rear toe setting, adjust as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment Front > Page 8017
Alignment: Service and Repair Ride Height Adjustments
Ride Height Adjustments
Special Tools
Inflation and Deflation of the Air Suspension System
1. NOTE: Make sure that the air suspension switch is in the ON position.
NOTE: Make sure that a battery voltage of at least 11 volts is maintained while carrying out this
procedure.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2. Connect the diagnostic tool to the data link connector (DLC). 3. Select Air Suspension Control
Module under Active Command Mode. 4. Follow the diagnostic tool directions to lift or vent the front
or rear suspension.
Calibration Ride Height Resetting
1. NOTE: Make sure that the air suspension switch is in the ON position.
NOTE: Make sure that a battery voltage of at least 11 volts is maintained while carrying out this
procedure.
Turn the ignition to the OFF position. Exit the vehicle, close all doors and allow the system to vent
the vehicle down to kneel height (approximately 45 seconds).
2. With the ignition in the ON position, shift the vehicle into DRIVE and then back to PARK. Exit the
vehicle, close all doors and allow the vehicle
to pump to trim (approximately 45 seconds).
3. Measure the ride height. 4. Open the LF door. 5. Connect the diagnostic tool to the data link
connector (DLC). 6. While outside of the vehicle, select the correct vehicle year, model and engine
type. 7. Select vehicle dynamic module (VDM). 8. Using the active command mode, vent or lift the
vehicle to achieve the correct ride height. 9. Select the "Save Calibration Values (Store Ride
Height)" diagnostic tool command to calibrate the VDM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 8023
C1300
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 8024
Compressor/Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 8025
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Suspension Control Module: Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8029
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8030
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
C2131a
C2131b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8031
C2324a
C2324b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8032
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. NOTE: The air suspension control module is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 air suspension control module electrical connectors.
3. Pull back the dash padding to expose the 2 module bracket nuts. 4. Remove the air suspension
control module nuts and the air suspension control module.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8033
5. NOTE: The air suspension control module is calibrated with information from the ride height
sensors. A new or exchanged air suspension control
module requires that the ride height adjustment calibration and pneumatic test be carried out.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Module: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Module Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage can result.
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) is integral to the vehicle security module
(VSM) and is not serviced separately.
NOTE: A new VSM module is delivered in manufacturing mode with pre-set diagnostic trouble
codes (DTC's). These DTC's require that a particular set of operations to be carried out in order to
clear them and enable the module for normal operations. The pre-set DTC's are as follows: ^
B2477 - Module Configuration Failure/Mismatch
^ B2868 - Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2869 - Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2870 - Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2871 - Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ C2780 - ECU in Manufacturing Mode
NOTE: A re-configured VSM may also set the above codes and will need to go through the same
set of procedures as a new module to enable normal operation.
1. NOTE: The steps included in the VSM removal and installation process are critical to restoring
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring
system operations and will permit a new or reconfigured module to operate as intended. Each step
is designed to carry out a particular operation and clear the manufacturing mode DTC's. Once
these DTC's are cleared, the new or reconfigured module will enter into normal operating mode.
Remove the VSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 8044
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 8048
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose
Ride Height Sensor: Customer Interest Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose
TSB 06-15-10
08/07/06
AIR SUSPENSION PERFORMANCE - HEIGHT SENSOR LINKAGE ARM DISENGAGING
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with an air suspension may
exhibit an air suspension height sensor linkage arm disengaging from the suspension ball stud or
height sensor rotating arm. This concern typically occurs with the rear sensor (Figure 1) but may
occur with the front sensors as well. If this occurs, the symptom will typically be the vehicle leaning
to one side, the vehicle sitting too low/high, a harsh ride, and/or an inoperative air suspension. In
addition, this concern may result in diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1725 (air suspension front
pneumatic failure) or C1726 (air suspension rear pneumatic failure).
ACTION When a linkage arm becomes disengaged, do not re-attach the arm and do not replace
the sensor unless broken. Instead, install a revised linkage arm on all three (3) sensor assemblies,
even if they have not detached from the ball stud. Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose > Page 8058
NOTE
LINKAGE ARMS USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT ARE SHOWN IN FIGURE 2. REVISED
LINKAGE ARMS (FIGURE 3) HAVE A NEW DESIGN THAT MAKES IT MORE DIFFICULT TO
DISENGAGE FROM THE BALL STUDS.
NOTE
IF THE SENSOR ASSEMBLY NEEDS TO BE REPLACED FOR ANY DAMAGE/FAILURE OTHER
THAN THE ONE DESCRIBED IN THIS TSB, THE REPLACEMENT ASSEMBLY IS SUPPLIED
WITH A NEW STYLE LINKAGE ARM, SO THERE IS NO NEED TO ORDER ADDITIONAL
LINKAGES FOR THE SERVICE REPAIR.
1. Replace linkage arms on all three (3) sensor assemblies following Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 204-05.
2. Discard the old linkage arms.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061510A 2003-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Three Linkage Arms, Includes Time To Check Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (Do Not Use With 5300A, 5300A7, 5300A8)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
5A967 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose
Ride Height Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor
Linkage Loose
TSB 06-15-10
08/07/06
AIR SUSPENSION PERFORMANCE - HEIGHT SENSOR LINKAGE ARM DISENGAGING
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with an air suspension may
exhibit an air suspension height sensor linkage arm disengaging from the suspension ball stud or
height sensor rotating arm. This concern typically occurs with the rear sensor (Figure 1) but may
occur with the front sensors as well. If this occurs, the symptom will typically be the vehicle leaning
to one side, the vehicle sitting too low/high, a harsh ride, and/or an inoperative air suspension. In
addition, this concern may result in diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1725 (air suspension front
pneumatic failure) or C1726 (air suspension rear pneumatic failure).
ACTION When a linkage arm becomes disengaged, do not re-attach the arm and do not replace
the sensor unless broken. Instead, install a revised linkage arm on all three (3) sensor assemblies,
even if they have not detached from the ball stud. Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose > Page
8064
NOTE
LINKAGE ARMS USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT ARE SHOWN IN FIGURE 2. REVISED
LINKAGE ARMS (FIGURE 3) HAVE A NEW DESIGN THAT MAKES IT MORE DIFFICULT TO
DISENGAGE FROM THE BALL STUDS.
NOTE
IF THE SENSOR ASSEMBLY NEEDS TO BE REPLACED FOR ANY DAMAGE/FAILURE OTHER
THAN THE ONE DESCRIBED IN THIS TSB, THE REPLACEMENT ASSEMBLY IS SUPPLIED
WITH A NEW STYLE LINKAGE ARM, SO THERE IS NO NEED TO ORDER ADDITIONAL
LINKAGES FOR THE SERVICE REPAIR.
1. Replace linkage arms on all three (3) sensor assemblies following Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 204-05.
2. Discard the old linkage arms.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061510A 2003-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Three Linkage Arms, Includes Time To Check Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (Do Not Use With 5300A, 5300A7, 5300A8)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
5A967 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Ride Height Sensor: > 05-16-11 > Aug > 05 > Restraints - Seat Belts Slow to Retract
Seat Belt Retractor: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Seat Belts Slow to Retract
TSB 05-16-11
08/22/05
SAFETY BELT RETRACTION SPEED
FORD: 2000-2003 Mustang 2000-2006 Crown Victoria, Taurus 2000-2003 Explorer Sport,
Windstar 2000-2005 Excursion, Explorer 2000-2006 E-Series, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Ranger 2001-2005 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2006 Escape 2004-2006 Freestar 2005-2006 Escape
Hybrid 2004-2006 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 2000-2002 Continental 2000-2006 LS, Town Car, Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2006 Grand Marquis 2000-2005 Mountaineer 2004-2006
Monterey 2005-2006 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 04-24-21 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE A service kit is now available to improve safety belt retraction speed.
ACTION See the part application chart and select the appropriate kit. Follow the Instruction Sheet
included in the kit. Refer to Workshop Manual Section 501-20A for additional information.
NOTE
TEFLON TAPE SHOULD ONLY BE USED ON THE FRONT ROW SEATS FOR VEHICLES
LISTED IN THIS TSB, WITH THE EXCEPTION OF THE AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR AND THE
MOUNTAINEER. TEFLON TAPE CAN ALSO BE USED ON SECOND ROW SEATS FOR THESE
THREE VEHICLES.
NOTE
FOR MUSTANG, AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR AND MOUNTAINEER, REFER TO THE
FOLLOWING BUILD DATE INFORMATION BEFORE PERFORMING THIS TSB. TEFLON TAPE
HAS ALREADY BEEN INSTALLED DURING PRODUCTION ON SOME OF THESE VEHICLES.
^ MUSTANG: Only install on vehicles built through 6/15/2003. Teflon tape was already installed on
vehicles built on/after 6/16/2003.
^ AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR/MOUNTAINEER (FRONT ROW SEATS): Only install on vehicles
built through 6/24/2004. Teflon tape was already installed on vehicles built on/after 6/25/2004.
^ AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR/MOUNTAINEER (SECOND ROW SEATS): Only install on vehicles
built through 10/21/2004. Teflon tape was already installed on vehicles built on/after 10/22/2004.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Ride Height Sensor: > 05-16-11 > Aug > 05 > Restraints - Seat Belts Slow to Retract > Page
8070
Parts Block
NOTE
THE LABOR OPERATIONS WITHIN THIS TSB CAN BE CLAIMED IN COMBINATION AS
NEEDED TO COVER THE REQUIRED REPAIRS.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
051611A Install Teflon Tape B 0.8 Hr.
Pillars Both Sides (Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim Panels If Necessary)
051611B Install Teflon Tape C 1.1 Hrs.
Pillars Both Sides (Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim Panels And Seats If Necessary)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
70611B08 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Ride Height Sensor: > 05-16-11 > Aug > 05 > Restraints - Seat Belts Slow to Retract > Page
8076
Parts Block
NOTE
THE LABOR OPERATIONS WITHIN THIS TSB CAN BE CLAIMED IN COMBINATION AS
NEEDED TO COVER THE REQUIRED REPAIRS.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
051611A Install Teflon Tape B 0.8 Hr.
Pillars Both Sides (Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim Panels If Necessary)
051611B Install Teflon Tape C 1.1 Hrs.
Pillars Both Sides (Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim Panels And Seats If Necessary)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
70611B08 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 8077
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
Front Height Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 8078
Rear Height Sensor
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH quarter trim panel. Failure to do so may result in unexpected
inflation or deflation of the air springs, which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these
operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All sensors
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the sensor arm from the
vehicle.
Front sensor
3. Remove and discard the 2 sensor nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
Rear sensor
4. Remove and discard the sensor nuts and bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
All sensors
5. Disconnect the sensor electrical connector.
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensors cannot be used on opposite sides of the vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the height sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 8082
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Suspension Mode Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Suspension Mode Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8086
C4169
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Sensor Training (Reset Procedure)
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system is not affected by wheel and tire rotation.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency (RF) noise.
RF noise is generated by electrical motor and appliance operation, cellular telephones and remote
transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 2. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to
the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
3. Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
6. The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if train mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center displays
"TRAIN LF TIRE", place the special tool on the valve stem of the LF tire pressure sensor. The horn
will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the TPMS
module.
7. Within 2 minutes after the horn sounds, place the special tool on the valve stem of the RF tire
pressure sensor.
NOTE: If the VSM (TPMS module integral to VSM) does not recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure
sensors during the tire training procedure, the horn will sound twice and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT" and the procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
When the tire training procedure is complete, the horn will sound once and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPLETE".
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8091
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Sensor
Special Tools
CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8092
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
Removal
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) will
not operate correctly if black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not remove the valve stem core to relieve the tire pressure.
CAUTION: If the valve stem core has been removed from the valve stem, reinstall the original valve
stem core. If the original valve stem core is damaged, a nickel-plated core must be installed.
Failure to use a nickel-plated core will result in corrosion and the possible loss of tire pressure.
NOTE: Release the tire pressure by removing the sensor valve stem nut.
With the valve stem at the 6 o'clock position, remove the sensor valve stem nut and push the
sensor by hand into the tire (with the cap on).
3. Using a suitable tire machine, separate both beads of the tire from the wheel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8093
4. CAUTION: Care should be taken not to damage the tire pressure sensor while separating the
outside bead of tire from the wheel.
Place the wheel and tire on the turntable of the tire machine, index-mark the valve stem and wheel
weight positions, lubricate the bead of the tire and dismount the outside bead of the tire from the
wheel.
5. Remove the tire pressure sensor from the tire. 6. Remove and discard the grommet from the tire
pressure sensor.
Installation
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The TPM's will not operate correctly if
black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. NOTE: Install a new sensor grommet or an air leak can occur.
Install a new grommet on the tire pressure sensor.
2. NOTE: Do not allow the tire to rotate relative to the rim while mounting the tire.
Lubricate and mount the outside and inside bead of the tire to the rim.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8094
3. CAUTION: Overtightening the tire pressure sensor valve stem nut can damage the tire pressure
sensor, undertightening can cause air leaks.
NOTE: Sensor position is critical for correct sensor operation. The "flat" side of the sensor must be
facing the wheel and the "slanted" side of the sensor must be facing away from the wheel. When
properly installed, there will be a very small gap between the sensor and the wheel.
NOTE: Tightening the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs.) equals approximately 2 clockwise turns after the
nut has been tightened by hand.
Push the side wall of the tire and install the tire pressure sensor. Tighten the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch
lbs.).
4. CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8095
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
CAUTION: Use only OEM valve caps (aluminum or plastic valve caps) with the tire pressure
sensors. Do not use brass-threaded valve caps with the tire pressure sensors.
Inflate the tire to the pressure specified on the safety certification sticker located on the driver or
door pillar.
5. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 6. Train the tire pressure sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Knuckle Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 8101
service expense. A new part with the same part number must be installed if installation becomes
necessary. Do not use a replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values
must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel hub.
2. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove the tie-rod end nut and detach the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle. ^
Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
3. Remove the brake hose bracket bolt and position the brake hose aside.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nut.
^ To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 475 Nm (350 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the 3 integrated wheel end disconnect bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
7. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
NOTE: To separate the ball joint from the wheel knuckle, loosely install the nut and then tap on the
end of the stud.
Remove the lower ball joint nut and separate the ball Joint from the knuckle. ^
Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.).
8. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove the upper ball Joint nut and the wheel knuckle. ^
Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
9. If necessary, remove the 3 brake disc shield bolts and remove the brake disc shield.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 11. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 8102
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Knuckle
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and hub assembly. 2. Remove the parking brake shoe retaining clips,
adjuster spring, return spring, adjuster and the parking brake shoes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 8103
3. Depress the tabs and detach the parking brake cable from the wheel knuckle. 4. Remove the toe
link-to-wheel knuckle nut and detach the toe link from the wheel knuckle.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the upper arm-to-wheel knuckle nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the lower arm-to-wheel knuckle nut, bolt and the wheel knuckle.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 400 Nm (295 ft. lbs.).
7. If necessary, using a suitable press and adapters, remove the wheel knuckle bushing. 8. To
install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear alignment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage
Power Steering Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage
TSB 07-1-7
01/22/07
MERCON(R) ATF REPLACED BY MERCON(R) V AS A SERVICE FLUID FOR SOME POWER
STEERING SYSTEMS
FORD: 1996-1997 Thunderbird 1996-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 1998-2003 Escort
2000-2007 Focus 2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2006 Ford GT 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle
2006-2007 Fusion 1996-1997 Aerostar 1996-2007 E-Series, Explorer, Ranger 1997-2004 F-53
Motorhome Chassis 1997-2007 Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty 1998-2003 Windstar 2000-2005
Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2005 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2007 Escape 2004-2007
Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1996-1997 Cargo 1996-1998 L-Series 1996-1999 F- B-Series
2000-2007 F-650, F-750 2006-2007 Low Cab Forward
LINCOLN: 1996-1998 Mark VIII 1996-1999 Continental 1996-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln
LS 2006 Zephyr 2007 MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator
2006-2007 Mark LT 2007 MKX
MERCURY: 1996-1997 Cougar 1996-2005 Sable 1996-2007 Grand Marquis 1999-2002 Cougar
2003-2004 Marauder 2005-2007 Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2007 Mountaineer 1998-2002
Villager 2004-2007 Monterey 2005-2007 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission Fluid is being replaced by MERCON(R) V as a
service fluid for power steering systems originally requiring MERCON(R).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage > Page 8109
ACTION Beginning immediately all power steering applications requiring MERCON(R) can now be
serviced using MERCON(R) V or MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission Fluid or dual usage fluids
labeled MERCON(R) / MERCON(R) V. After July 1, 2007, MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission
Fluid will no longer be manufactured, therefore, availability of this fluid will continue until remaining
inventory has been depleted.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Service power steering Systems requiring MERCON(R) with MERCON(R) V or MERCON(R)
Automatic Transmission Fluid or dual usage fluids labeled MERCON(R) / MERCON(R) V.
CAUTION
APPLICATIONS RECOMMENDING TYPE F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION AND POWER
STEERING FLUID MUST CONTINUE TO USE THAT PARTICULAR FLUID. USE OF ANY
OTHER FLUID MAY CAUSE REDUCED FUNCTIONALITY OR DAMAGE
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8110
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
POWER STEERING FLUID
Motorcraft MERCON ATF
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................................ XT-2-QDX Ford Specification .................................................
............................................................................................................................................ MERCON
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Cooler: Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Cooler
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
All vehicles
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH rear
quarter trim panel. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs,
which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position, if equipped.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Navigator vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8114
3. Remove the pushpins and the deflector shield.
All vehicles
4. Release the 2 clamps and disconnect the power steering fluid cooler hoses. 5. Remove the 2
bolts and remove the power steering fluid cooler.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. Using a suitable suction device, remove the power steering fluid from the fluid reservoir. 2.
Disconnect the supply hose from the fluid reservoir. 3. Disconnect the return hose from the fluid
reservoir. 4. Remove the fluid reservoir bolt and the fluid reservoir.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure
Line
Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line - 4x4
Materials
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 8122
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 8123
Part 2
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
All vehicles
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH
quarter trim panel rear. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air
springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position, if equipped.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the engine cooling fan. 4.
Remove the power steering pump pulley. 5. Disconnect the power steering pressure line-to-pump
fitting. Discard the Teflon seal. ^
To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
7. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-crossmember bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
8. Disconnect the power steering pressure line from the frame rail retainers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 8124
9. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-engine nut.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
Expedition vehicles
10. If equipped disconnect the power steering pressure sensor electrical connector and detach the
harness retainer.
All vehicles
CAUTION: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the
steering gear.
11. Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt and the power steering pressure line. Discard
the O-ring seal.
1 To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Using the special tool, install a new Teflon O-ring seal on the power steering pressure
line-to-pump fitting.
^ Install a new O-ring seal on the clamp plate end of the power steering pressure line.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 8125
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Fluid Cooler to Power Steering
Fluid Reservoir Return Hose
Power Steering Fluid Cooler to Power Steering Fluid Reservoir Return Hose
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
All vehicles
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located near in the LH
rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air
springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position, if equipped.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Using a suitable suction device, remove
the power steering fluid from the reservoir. 4. Remove the 3 power steering reservoir bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
5. Release the clamp, and disconnect power steering return line from the reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 8126
Navigator vehicles
6. Remove the pushpins and the deflector shield.
All vehicles
7. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering return line from the power steering cooler.
8. Disconnect the power steering return line from the frame rail retainer and remove the line. 9. To
install, reverse the removal procedure. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 8127
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Materials
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 8128
Part 2
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
All vehicles
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH rear
quarter trim panel. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs,
which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position, if equipped.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Navigator vehicles
3. Remove the pushpins and the deflector shield.
All vehicles
4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering return line from the power steering cooler.
5. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line > Page 8129
CAUTION: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the
steering gear.
6. Remove the steering line clamp plate bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 28 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
^ Discard the steering line O-ring seals.
7. Disconnect the line from frame rail retainers and remove the return line. 8. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
^ Install a new O-ring seals.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pressure Control Valve
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-35 (Chassis, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pressure Control Valve
> Component Information > Locations > Page 8133
C120
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump
Power Steering Pump
Special Tools
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 8138
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. Remove the engine cooling fan. 2. Remove the power steering pump pulley. 3. Release the
clamp and disconnect the supply hose from power steering pump.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 8139
4. Remove the pressure line bracket-to-engine nut.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
5. Disconnect the pressure line-to-pump fitting.
^ Discard the Teflon O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the 3 pump bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
^ Disconnect the harness retainer and remove the power steering pump.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Using the special tool, install a new Teflon O-ring on the pressure line-to-pump fitting.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 8140
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Pulley
Power Steering Pump Pulley
Special Tools
Removal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 8141
1. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from
the power steering pump pulley. 2. Remove the air cleaner intake pipe.
3. Using the special tool, remove the power steering pump pulley.
Installation
1. CAUTION: If the pulley has been removed and installed twice, install a new power steering
pump pulley.
Using the special tool, install the power steering pump pulley. ^
Inspect the pulley for paint marks in the web area near the hub. If there are 2 paint marks, install a
new pulley. If there is 1 paint mark or none at all, use a paint pencil to mark the web area of the
pulley near the hub.
2. Install the air cleaner intake pipe.
3. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt to the
power steering pump pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page
8147
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 8151
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8155
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety
canopy deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a seat mounted side air bag and/or a safety belt pretensioner (if equipped)
system is being serviced, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central junction
box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover and
remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and close
the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8161
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety canopy
module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8162
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central
junction box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover
and remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Remove the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
8. Remove the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8163
9. Remove the driver air bag module.
1 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
2 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
3 Disconnect the horn switch electrical connector.
4 Remove the driver air bag module.
Navigator
10. Disconnect the driver air bag module.
- Release the 2 tabs on each driver air bag module electrical connector and disconnect them. Label each driver air bag module electrical connector before disconnecting.
11. Release the tab and disconnect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector at
the top of the clockspring and remove the driver air
bag module.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8164
12. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tools to the clockspring electrical connectors at the top of
the steering column.
13. While pushing in on the 2 glove compartment door tabs, position the glove compartment
downward.
14. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the tab and disconnect the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
15. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
Vehicles with safety canopies
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8165
16. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
17. Remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
18. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8166
19. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
20. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide.
21. Remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
22. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8167
23. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the driver side safety
canopy electrical connector.
All vehicles 24. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB. 25. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
Vehicles with safety canopies
3. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the driver side
safety canopy electrical connector.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8168
5. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the driver side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
6. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row driver side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
7. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8169
8. Connect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
9. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
10. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8170
11. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger air
bag module electrical connector.
12. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
13. Close the glove compartment.
14. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tools from the clockspring electrical connector at the
top of the steering column.
Navigator
15. Connect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector to the connector end at the
top of the clockspring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8171
16. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module.
Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the
electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
Expedition
17. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
1 Connect the horn switch electrical connector.
2 CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the
driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal.
3 Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
All vehicles
18. Install the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8172
19. Install the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
20. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
21. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 22. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and
close the cover.
23. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
24. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 8173
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Prove Out Procedure
PROVE OUT PROCEDURE
Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the ON position and visually monitor the air bag indicator
with all SRS components connected or restraint system diagnostic tools installed. The air bag
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is
present, the air bag indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator will
need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Steering Gear: Service and Repair
Steering Gear
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 8177
Part 2
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the intermediate shaft to rotate while it is disconnected from the gear or
damage to the clockspring can occur. If there is
evidence that the intermediate shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be removed and recentered.
Hold the steering wheel in the straight-ahead position using a suitable holding device.
3. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH rear
quarter trim panel. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs,
which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position, if equipped.
4. Remove the engine cooling fan.
5. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent turning of the stud while removing the nut.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 8178
Remove the 2 nuts and disconnect the tie-rod ends from the wheel knuckles. ^
To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.).
7. Disconnect the lines from the frame rail retainers.
8. CAUTION: Do not allow the intermediate shaft to rotate while it is disconnected from the gear or
damage to the clockspring can occur. If there is
evidence that the intermediate shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be removed and recentered.
Remove the intermediate shaft-to-gear pinch bolt and disconnect the intermediate shaft from the
gear. ^
To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
9. Remove the steering line clamp plate bolt and disconnect the power steering lines.
^ Position the lines aside.
^ Discard the O-ring seals.
1 To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
Navigator vehicles
10. Disconnect the electrical connector.
^ Rotate the actuator until the connector housing is facing the steering gear input shaft.
11. Remove the left side lower arm-to-frame nut and bolt. Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 8179
12. Insert a block of wood between the left side lower arm and the frame.
All vehicles
13. Remove the 2 steering gear bracket-to-crossmember nuts and bolts. Discard the nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.).
14. CAUTION: Make sure the steering lines are clear from the removal path of the gear or damage
to the lines can result.
Remove the 2 steering gear bracket-to-gear nuts, bolts, and brackets. Discard the nuts. ^
To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
15. Remove the steering gear from the left side of the vehicle.
16. CAUTION: Make sure that the wheel end vacuum line is clear of the steering gear mounting
fasteners before tightening the bolts or damage to
the line can result.
CAUTION: Make sure to tighten the bracket-to-steering gear bolts (M14) before tightening the
bracket-to crossmember bolts (M12) or damage to the steering gear can result.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Install a new high pressure line O-ring seal and a new return line O-ring seal.
^ Fill and leak check the system.
^ Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Steering Shaft: Service and Repair
Steering Column Shaft
Steering Column Shaft
Removal and Installation All vehicles
1. CAUTION: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while the intermediate shaft is
disconnected or damage to the clockspring can result.
If there is evidence that the shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be removed and recentered.
Place the steering wheel in the straight-ahead position and turn the ignition switch to the OFF
position.
2. NOTE: A new bolt must be installed.
Remove the bolt and disconnect the intermediate shaft from the steering column.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 8183
^ Discard the bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
3. NOTE: A new bolt must be installed.
Remove the bolt and disconnect the upper intermediate shaft from the lower intermediate shaft. ^
Discard the bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the 2 bolts, the dash seal and the upper intermediate shaft.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
Navigator 4x4 vehicles
5. Remove the cooling fan and shroud.
All vehicles except Navigator 4x4
6. Raise and support the vehicle.
7. If equipped, remove the skid plate.
^ To install, tighten the front 2 bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
^ To install, tighten the rear 2 bolts to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
All vehicles
8. NOTE: A new bolt must be installed.
Remove the bolt and the lower intermediate shaft. ^
Discard the bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering
Wheel Is Loose
Steering Wheel: Customer Interest Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering Wheel Is Loose
TSB 07-4-3
03/05/07
LEATHER - WRAPPED STEERING WHEEL - LEATHER COMING LOOSE
FORD: 2000-2005 Thunderbird 2000-2007 Crown Victoria, Focus, Mustang, Taurus 2005-2007
Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1999-2003 Windstar 1999-2008 F-Super Duty
2000-2005 Excursion 2000-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, Ranger 2001-2003 Explorer Sport
2001-2007 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2008 Escape 2004-2007 F-150, Freestar 2005-2008 Escape
Hybrid 2007 Edge 2004-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 2000-2002 Continental 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2000-2007 Town Car 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 2000-2007 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT 2007 MKX
MERCURY: 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007 Montego 2006-2007 Milan
2000-2007 Mountaineer 2004-2007 Monterey 2005-2008 Mariner 2006-2008 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 04-24-3 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some vehicles equipped with leather-wrapped steering wheels may exhibit the leather
coming loose from the spoke area.
ACTION Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive to re-adhere the loose leather to the wheel spoke.
Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF RE-ADHERING LEATHER TO THE FRONT SIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL ONLY, OMIT
STEPS 1 AND 6. STEERING WHEEL/AIR BAG ASSEMBLY REMOVAL IS NECESSARY ONLY
WHEN REPAIRING LOOSE LEATHER ON THE BACKSIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL.
CAUTION
AVOID SKIN CONTACT WITH MOTORCRAFT INSTANT GEL ADHESIVE.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering
Wheel Is Loose > Page 8192
1. Remove the steering wheel (ONLY NECESSARY TO REPAIR BACKSIDE OF STEERING
WHEEL). Refer to Workshop Manual Sections 211-04 and 501-20B.
2. Fold loose leather out of the way.
3. Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive evenly over the wheel spoke.
4. Fold the leather back into its original position.
5. Smooth the leather tuck in for neat appearance, and apply pressure until the leather is bonded to
the wheel spoke (apply pressure for at least 30 seconds).
NOTE
THE ADHESIVE SHOULD BE COMPLETELY SET AFTER 5 MINUTES. DO NOT PULL ON THE
REPAIR AREA.
6. Reinstall steering wheel.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070403 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3600 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On
Steering Wheel Is Loose
Steering Wheel: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering Wheel Is
Loose
TSB 07-4-3
03/05/07
LEATHER - WRAPPED STEERING WHEEL - LEATHER COMING LOOSE
FORD: 2000-2005 Thunderbird 2000-2007 Crown Victoria, Focus, Mustang, Taurus 2005-2007
Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1999-2003 Windstar 1999-2008 F-Super Duty
2000-2005 Excursion 2000-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, Ranger 2001-2003 Explorer Sport
2001-2007 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2008 Escape 2004-2007 F-150, Freestar 2005-2008 Escape
Hybrid 2007 Edge 2004-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 2000-2002 Continental 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2000-2007 Town Car 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 2000-2007 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT 2007 MKX
MERCURY: 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007 Montego 2006-2007 Milan
2000-2007 Mountaineer 2004-2007 Monterey 2005-2008 Mariner 2006-2008 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 04-24-3 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some vehicles equipped with leather-wrapped steering wheels may exhibit the leather
coming loose from the spoke area.
ACTION Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive to re-adhere the loose leather to the wheel spoke.
Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF RE-ADHERING LEATHER TO THE FRONT SIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL ONLY, OMIT
STEPS 1 AND 6. STEERING WHEEL/AIR BAG ASSEMBLY REMOVAL IS NECESSARY ONLY
WHEN REPAIRING LOOSE LEATHER ON THE BACKSIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL.
CAUTION
AVOID SKIN CONTACT WITH MOTORCRAFT INSTANT GEL ADHESIVE.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On
Steering Wheel Is Loose > Page 8198
1. Remove the steering wheel (ONLY NECESSARY TO REPAIR BACKSIDE OF STEERING
WHEEL). Refer to Workshop Manual Sections 211-04 and 501-20B.
2. Fold loose leather out of the way.
3. Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive evenly over the wheel spoke.
4. Fold the leather back into its original position.
5. Smooth the leather tuck in for neat appearance, and apply pressure until the leather is bonded to
the wheel spoke (apply pressure for at least 30 seconds).
NOTE
THE ADHESIVE SHOULD BE COMPLETELY SET AFTER 5 MINUTES. DO NOT PULL ON THE
REPAIR AREA.
6. Reinstall steering wheel.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070403 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3600 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 8199
Steering Wheel: Service and Repair
STEERING WHEEL CONTROLS
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the driver air bag module.
Expedition
2. Remove the 2 screws and the steering wheel controls.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
3. Remove the 4 switch plate bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 8200
4. Remove the 2 steering wheel control screws and springs, and position the switch plate aside.
5. NOTE: Note the routing of the steering wheel controls harness on the module plate for
installation of the new steering wheel controls.
Disconnect the steering wheel controls harness from the clips, and remove the horn switch plate.
All vehicles
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair
Tie Rod: Service and Repair
Inner Tie Rod
Special Tools
Materials
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 8204
Removal
CAUTION: The boots and clamps are designed to provide an airtight seal and protect the internal
components of the steering gear. If the seal is not airtight the vacuum generated during turning will
draw water and contamination into the gear causing premature damage.
CAUTION: Zip ties do not produce an airtight seal and must not be used.
CAUTION: The inner ball joint grease is not compatible with water and contamination trapped in
the grease will degrade the life of the joint.
CAUTION: If present, the orientation of the vent tube must be noted so the boots and vent tubes
can be installed in the correct location.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Loosen the tie-rod end jam nut.
^ Tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.).
3. NOTE: The hex holding feature can be used to prevent turning of the stud while removing the
tie-rod end nut.
Remove the nut and disconnect the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle. ^
To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
4. NOTE: Note the number of times the tie-rod ends turn for assembly reference.
Remove the tie-rod end.
5. Remove the tie-rod end jam nut.
6. NOTE: If repairing the RH side, it will be necessary to pull back the LH inner tie rod bellows to
hold the steering gear.
Remove the inner and outer bellows boot clamps.
7. Remove the inner tie-rod bellows boot.
8. CAUTION: Place the steering gear at the center position. Use a 11/16 in. crowfoot on the flat of
the rack gear to resist rotation and to prevent
damage during removal and installation of the inner tie rod.
NOTE: An assistant may be needed for removal of the RH inner tie rod.
Using the special tool, remove the inner tie rod.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 8205
^ To install, tighten to 100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.).
9. CAUTION: Thoroughly remove any abrasive material. This material is extremely harmful to the
steering gear.
Thoroughly clean and inspect all the parts to be reused. Install new parts as necessary.
10. Lubricate the inner tic rod and steering gear housing with specified grease. Grease should be
applied at the groove, where the boot contacts and is
clamped to the housing and tie rod. ^
Check that the inner tie-rod bellows boot is positioned correctly over the steering gear housing
bead at the large inside diameter (ID) and is in the inner tie-rod groove at the small ID.
^ Check that the inner tie-rod bellows boot is not twisted and the breather tube is securely inserted
into the breather nipple at both inner tie-rod bellows boots.
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 12. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
Ball Joint: Specifications
Measure the ball joint deflection while an assistant pushes up and then pulls down on the upper
control arm, by hand. ^
If the deflection exceeds the specification, a new ball joint must be installed.
^ If the deflection meets the specification, no further action is required.
Wear limit .............................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 0-0.8 mm (0-0.032 in)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 8210
Ball Joint: Testing and Inspection
Ball Joint Inspection
1. Prior to inspecting the ball joints for wear, inspect the wheel bearings.
2. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch. Failure to do so can
result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the
vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
NOTE: In order to obtain accurate measurements, the suspension must be in full rebound with the
weight of the vehicle supported by the frame.
Raise and support the vehicle by the frame to allow the wheels to hang in the rebound position.
3. Inspect the ball joint and ball joint boot for damage.
^ If the ball joint or ball joint boot is damaged, install a new ball joint as necessary.
NOTE: Carry out Steps 4-6 to inspect the lower ball joint. Carry out Steps 7-9 to inspect the upper
ball joint.
4. CAUTION: Do not use any tools or equipment to move the wheel and tire assembly or
suspension components while checking for relative
movement. Suspension damage can occur. The use of tools or equipment will also create relative
movement that may not exist when using hand force.
Relative movement must be measured using hand force only.
NOTE: The weight of the wheel and tire assembly must be overcome to obtain an accurate
measurement on the dial indicator.
Inspect the ball joint for relative movement by alternately pulling downward and pushing upward on
the wheel and tire assembly by hand. Note any relative vertical movement between the wheel
knuckle and lower arm at the lower ball joint. ^
If relative movement is not felt or seen, the ball joint is OK. Do not install a new ball joint.
^ If relative movement is found, continue with Step 5.
5. NOTE: In order to obtain an accurate measurement, the dial indicator should be aligned as close
as possible with the vertical axis (center line) of
the ball joint.
To measure ball joint deflection, attach a suitable dial indicator with a flexible arm between the
lower control arm and the wheel knuckle or ball joint stud.
6. Measure the ball joint deflection while an assistant pushes up and pulls down on the wheel and
tire assembly, by hand.
^ If the deflection exceeds the specification, a new ball joint must be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 8211
^ If the deflection meets the specification, continue with the procedure.
7. CAUTION: Do not use any tools or equipment to move the wheel and tire assembly or
suspension components while checking for relative
movement. Suspension damage can occur. The use of tools or equipment will also create relative
movement that may not exist when using hand force.
Relative movement must be measured using hand force only. ^
Inspect the ball Joint for relative movement by alternately pulling downward and pushing upward on
the upper control arm by hand. Note any relative vertical movement between the wheel knuckle
and upper arm at the upper ball joint.
^ If relative movement is not felt or seen, the ball Joint is OK. Do not install a new ball joint.
^ If relative movement is found, continue with Step 8.
8. NOTE: In order to obtain an accurate measurement, the dial indicator should be aligned as close
as possible with the vertical axis of the ball joint.
To measure ball joint deflection, attach a suitable dial indicator with a flexible arm between the
upper control arm and the wheel knuckle or ball Joint stud.
9. Measure the ball joint deflection while an assistant pushes up and then pulls down on the upper
control arm, by hand.
^ If the deflection exceeds the specification, a new ball joint must be installed.
^ If the deflection meets the specification, no further action is required.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 8212
Ball Joint: Service and Repair
Ball Joint - Lower
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 8213
Removal
1. Remove the wheel knuckle. 2. Remove and discard the lower ball joint snap ring. 3. Using the
special tools, remove the lower ball joint.
Installation
1. Using a clean shop towel and the specified surface cleaner, clean the lower arm ball joint bore
and inspect for cracks or damage before installing a
new ball joint. If there is evidence of cracks or damage, a new lower arm must be installed.
2. CAUTION: Use care to prevent adhesive from contacting the ball joint boot or damage to the
boot may occur, causing premature ball joint
failure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 8214
NOTE: To allow the adhesive to fully cure, the vehicle must not be driven on the road for at least
one hour after the installation of a new ball joint .
Apply an even coat of adhesive (supplied with kit) to the lower arm ball joint bore and the ball joint.
3. CAUTION: Do not damage the lower ball joint boot when installing the special tool or premature
failure of the ball joint may occur.
NOTE: Make sure the ball joint snap ring is fully seated.
Using the special tools, install the lower ball joint.
Install the ball joint snap ring.
4. Using a clean shop towel and the specified surface cleaner, wipe any excess adhesive from the
ball joint and lower arm.
5. Install the wheel knuckle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Control Arm: Service and Repair Front
Lower Arm
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. Remove the wheel knuckle.
3. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nut. ^
To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the lower arm rearward nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 270 Nm (199 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the lower arm forward nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 270 Nm (199 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 8219
6. Remove the shock absorber lower nut, bolt and the lower arm.
^ Discard the shock absorber lower nut.
^ To install, tighten to 475 Nm (350 ft. lbs.).
7. CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower arm forward and rearward nuts and bolts until the installation
procedure is complete and the weight of the
vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 8220
Control Arm: Service and Repair Rear
Upper Arm
Upper Arm
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the parking brake cable wire form bracket bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the upper arm-to-wheel knuckle nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the upper arm forward nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 8221
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the upper arm rearward nut, bolt and the upper arm.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 250 Nm (184 ft. lbs.).
7. CAUTION: Do not tighten the upper arm forward and rearward nuts and bolts until the
installation procedure is complete and the weight of the
vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear alignment.
Lower Arm
Lower Arm
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 8222
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 8223
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist.
3. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link upper nut. ^
To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the shock absorber lower bolt and nut.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 400 Nm (295 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the lower arm forward nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 250 Nm (184 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the lower arm rear-ward nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 250 Nm (184 ft. lbs.).
7. Remove the lower arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt, nut and the lower arm.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 400 Nm (295 ft. lbs.).
8. If necessary, using a suitable press and adapters, remove the lower arm-to-wheel knuckle
bushing.
9. CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower arm forward and rearward nuts and bolts until the installation
procedure is complete and the weight of the
vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
10. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear alignment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Service and Repair > Spot Welds - Rear Cross Member & Side Members
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Service and Repair > Spot Welds - Rear Cross Member & Side Members > Page 8229
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Service and Repair > Spot Welds - Rear Cross Member & Side Members > Page 8230
Rear Cross-Member: Service and Repair Transmission Support Crossmember
TRANSMISSION SUPPORT CROSSMEMBER
Transmission Support Crossmember - Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. If equipped, remove the skid plate fasteners and skid plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Service and Repair > Spot Welds - Rear Cross Member & Side Members > Page 8231
3. Remove the LH and RH exhaust heat shield-to-crossmember fasteners. 4. Remove the 2
transmission mount nuts.
- To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
5. Support the transmission.
6. NOTE: Mark the transmission crossmember next to the edge of the frame bracket to make sure
the crossmember is installed in the same position
it was removed from.
Remove the 4 transmission crossmember bolts and transmission crossmember. To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Knuckle Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 8236
service expense. A new part with the same part number must be installed if installation becomes
necessary. Do not use a replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values
must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel hub.
2. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove the tie-rod end nut and detach the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle. ^
Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
3. Remove the brake hose bracket bolt and position the brake hose aside.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
4. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nut.
^ To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 475 Nm (350 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the 3 integrated wheel end disconnect bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.).
7. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
NOTE: To separate the ball joint from the wheel knuckle, loosely install the nut and then tap on the
end of the stud.
Remove the lower ball joint nut and separate the ball Joint from the knuckle. ^
Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.).
8. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove the upper ball Joint nut and the wheel knuckle. ^
Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
9. If necessary, remove the 3 brake disc shield bolts and remove the brake disc shield.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.).
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 11. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 8237
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Knuckle
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and hub assembly. 2. Remove the parking brake shoe retaining clips,
adjuster spring, return spring, adjuster and the parking brake shoes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 8238
3. Depress the tabs and detach the parking brake cable from the wheel knuckle. 4. Remove the toe
link-to-wheel knuckle nut and detach the toe link from the wheel knuckle.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the upper arm-to-wheel knuckle nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the lower arm-to-wheel knuckle nut, bolt and the wheel knuckle.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 400 Nm (295 ft. lbs.).
7. If necessary, using a suitable press and adapters, remove the wheel knuckle bushing. 8. To
install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear alignment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle Alignment Link > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Knuckle Alignment Link: Service and Repair
Toe Link
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist.
3. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove the toe link-to-wheel knuckle nut and separate the toe link from the wheel knuckle. ^
To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the toe link-to-frame nut and the toe link.
^ To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs.).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear toe.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 8246
C1300
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 8247
Compressor/Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 8248
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Suspension Control Module: Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8252
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8253
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
C2131a
C2131b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8254
C2324a
C2324b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8255
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. NOTE: The air suspension control module is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 air suspension control module electrical connectors.
3. Pull back the dash padding to expose the 2 module bracket nuts. 4. Remove the air suspension
control module nuts and the air suspension control module.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8256
5. NOTE: The air suspension control module is calibrated with information from the ride height
sensors. A new or exchanged air suspension control
module requires that the ride height adjustment calibration and pneumatic test be carried out.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Ride Height
Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Ride Height
Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose
Ride Height Sensor: Customer Interest Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose
TSB 06-15-10
08/07/06
AIR SUSPENSION PERFORMANCE - HEIGHT SENSOR LINKAGE ARM DISENGAGING
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with an air suspension may
exhibit an air suspension height sensor linkage arm disengaging from the suspension ball stud or
height sensor rotating arm. This concern typically occurs with the rear sensor (Figure 1) but may
occur with the front sensors as well. If this occurs, the symptom will typically be the vehicle leaning
to one side, the vehicle sitting too low/high, a harsh ride, and/or an inoperative air suspension. In
addition, this concern may result in diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1725 (air suspension front
pneumatic failure) or C1726 (air suspension rear pneumatic failure).
ACTION When a linkage arm becomes disengaged, do not re-attach the arm and do not replace
the sensor unless broken. Instead, install a revised linkage arm on all three (3) sensor assemblies,
even if they have not detached from the ball stud. Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Ride Height
Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Ride Height
Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose > Page 8266
NOTE
LINKAGE ARMS USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT ARE SHOWN IN FIGURE 2. REVISED
LINKAGE ARMS (FIGURE 3) HAVE A NEW DESIGN THAT MAKES IT MORE DIFFICULT TO
DISENGAGE FROM THE BALL STUDS.
NOTE
IF THE SENSOR ASSEMBLY NEEDS TO BE REPLACED FOR ANY DAMAGE/FAILURE OTHER
THAN THE ONE DESCRIBED IN THIS TSB, THE REPLACEMENT ASSEMBLY IS SUPPLIED
WITH A NEW STYLE LINKAGE ARM, SO THERE IS NO NEED TO ORDER ADDITIONAL
LINKAGES FOR THE SERVICE REPAIR.
1. Replace linkage arms on all three (3) sensor assemblies following Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 204-05.
2. Discard the old linkage arms.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061510A 2003-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Three Linkage Arms, Includes Time To Check Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (Do Not Use With 5300A, 5300A7, 5300A8)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
5A967 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Ride Height
Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Ride Height Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose
Ride Height Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor
Linkage Loose
TSB 06-15-10
08/07/06
AIR SUSPENSION PERFORMANCE - HEIGHT SENSOR LINKAGE ARM DISENGAGING
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with an air suspension may
exhibit an air suspension height sensor linkage arm disengaging from the suspension ball stud or
height sensor rotating arm. This concern typically occurs with the rear sensor (Figure 1) but may
occur with the front sensors as well. If this occurs, the symptom will typically be the vehicle leaning
to one side, the vehicle sitting too low/high, a harsh ride, and/or an inoperative air suspension. In
addition, this concern may result in diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1725 (air suspension front
pneumatic failure) or C1726 (air suspension rear pneumatic failure).
ACTION When a linkage arm becomes disengaged, do not re-attach the arm and do not replace
the sensor unless broken. Instead, install a revised linkage arm on all three (3) sensor assemblies,
even if they have not detached from the ball stud. Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Ride Height
Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Ride Height Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose > Page 8272
NOTE
LINKAGE ARMS USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT ARE SHOWN IN FIGURE 2. REVISED
LINKAGE ARMS (FIGURE 3) HAVE A NEW DESIGN THAT MAKES IT MORE DIFFICULT TO
DISENGAGE FROM THE BALL STUDS.
NOTE
IF THE SENSOR ASSEMBLY NEEDS TO BE REPLACED FOR ANY DAMAGE/FAILURE OTHER
THAN THE ONE DESCRIBED IN THIS TSB, THE REPLACEMENT ASSEMBLY IS SUPPLIED
WITH A NEW STYLE LINKAGE ARM, SO THERE IS NO NEED TO ORDER ADDITIONAL
LINKAGES FOR THE SERVICE REPAIR.
1. Replace linkage arms on all three (3) sensor assemblies following Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 204-05.
2. Discard the old linkage arms.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061510A 2003-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Three Linkage Arms, Includes Time To Check Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (Do Not Use With 5300A, 5300A7, 5300A8)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
5A967 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Ride Height
Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8273
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
Front Height Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Ride Height
Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8274
Rear Height Sensor
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH quarter trim panel. Failure to do so may result in unexpected
inflation or deflation of the air springs, which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these
operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All sensors
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the sensor arm from the
vehicle.
Front sensor
3. Remove and discard the 2 sensor nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
Rear sensor
4. Remove and discard the sensor nuts and bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
All sensors
5. Disconnect the sensor electrical connector.
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensors cannot be used on opposite sides of the vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the height sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 8278
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Suspension
Mode Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Suspension
Mode Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8282
C4169
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair
Stabilizer Bar and Link
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist.
3. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove the 2 stabilizer bar link upper nuts. ^
Discard the nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.).
4. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove the 2 stabilizer bar link lower nuts and the 2 stabilizer bar links. ^
Discard the nuts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8287
^ To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the 4 stabilizer bar bracket nuts, the 2 stabilizer bar brackets and the stabilizer bar.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.).
6. NOTE: Inspect and, if necessary, install new bushings.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Dryer, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Dryer: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Compressor Drier
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air compressor. 2. Remove the compressor drier screw.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.).
3. NOTE: Make sure that the drier O-ring does not remain inside of the compressor assembly.
Rotate the compressor drier 90 degrees counterclockwise to unlock, then remove the air
compressor drier.
4. NOTE: Inspect the compressor drier O-ring for damage and install a new O-ring as necessary.
NOTE: When installing the air lines, make sure the white air line is fully inserted into the fitting for
correct installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Line, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Line: Service and Repair
Air Line Repair
1. Cut the line at the damaged area.
2. Trim the sleeve material from both ends of the damaged line.
3. Taper both ends of the tube by shaving or sanding it 3 mm (0.11 inch) from the tips.
4. Install the repair filling.
5. NOTE: Check system for leaks.
Inflate the air suspension system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Shock Absorber - Front
Air Spring: Service and Repair Air Shock Absorber - Front
Air Shock Absorber - Front
Special Tools
Materials
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Shock Absorber - Front > Page 8299
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so may result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which may result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Do not remove an air spring under any circumstances when there is pressure in the air
spring. Do not remove any components supporting an air spring without either exhausting the air or
providing support for the air spring. Failure to follow these instructions may
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Shock Absorber - Front > Page 8300
result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the
same part number must be used if installation is necessary. Do not use a new part of lesser quality
or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of
correct retention of these parts.
1. Using the diagnostic too], vent the appropriate air spring(s). 2. Turn the air suspension switch to
the OFF position. 3. Remove and discard the 3 shock upper nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
4. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 5. Disconnect the air valve electrical
connector. 6. Disconnect the air line at the air valve.
^ Compress the orange quick connect lock ring, then pull downward on the air supply line.
7. Remove the shock lower nut, bolt and the air shock absorber and spring assembly.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 400 Nm (295 ft. lbs.).
8. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue with
Step 14.
NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the shock rod from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the shock rod nut. ^
To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
9. CAUTION: If the retainer tabs are broken, a new air spring must be installed.
NOTE: Index mark the air spring and the shock absorber for reference during the installation
procedure.
Depress the retainer tabs and remove the air spring assembly.
10. Remove the shock rod O-ring seal, washer and jounce bumper.
^ Discard the seal and washer.
11. Remove and discard the 2 air spring lower O-ring seals.
12. Remove the retainer pins and the upper mount.
^ Discard the pins.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Shock Absorber - Front > Page 8301
13. Remove and discard the 2 air spring upper O-ring seals.
14. CAUTION: Use a suitable press to install the upper mount retainer pins. Do not use a hammer
or damage may occur.
NOTE: During installation, use assembly kit 5B302.
NOTE: Apply a thin coat of grease to the new O-ring seals.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Shock Absorber - Front > Page 8302
Air Spring: Service and Repair Air Shock Absorber - Rear
Air Shock Absorber - Rear
Special Tools
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Shock Absorber - Front > Page 8303
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Shock Absorber - Front > Page 8304
Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which may result
in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not remove an air spring under any circumstances when there is pressure in the air
spring. Do not remove any components supporting an air spring without either exhausting the air or
providing support for the air spring. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the
same part number must be used if installation is necessary. Do not use a new part of lesser quality
or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of
correct retention of these parts.
1. Using the diagnostic tool, vent the appropriate air spring. 2. Turn the air suspension switch to the
OFF position. 3. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 4. Remove and discard the 3
shock upper nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
5. Disconnect the air valve electrical connector. 6. Disconnect the air line at the air valve.
Compress the orange quick connect lock ring, then pull downward on the air supply line. 7.
Remove the shock absorber lower nut and bolt
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 475 Nm (350 ft. lbs.).
8. Remove the air shock absorber.
9. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue with
Step 15.
NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the shock rod from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the shock rod nut.
To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
10. CAUTION: If the retainer tabs are broken, a new air spring must be installed.
NOTE: Index mark the air spring and shock absorber for reference during the installation
procedure.
Depress the retainer tabs and remove the air spring.
11. Remove the shock rod O-ring seal, washer and jounce bumper.
^ Discard the seal and washer.
12. Remove and discard the 2 air spring lower O-ring seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air Shock Absorber - Front > Page 8305
13. Remove the retainer pins and the upper mount.
^ Discard the pins.
14. Remove and discard the 2 air spring upper O-ring seals.
15. CAUTION: Use a suitable press to install the upper mount retainer pins. Do not use a hammer
or damage may occur.
NOTE: During installation, use assembly kit 5L74-5B302-AA
NOTE: Apply a thin coat of grease to the new O-ring seals.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump, Suspension Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Air Suspension Compressor Assembly
C1179
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump, Suspension Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Air Suspension Compressor Assembly >
Page 8310
C1300
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump, Suspension Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8311
Compressor/Pump: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Compressor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air suspension relay from the bracket. 2. Remove the windshield washer pump and
reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump, Suspension Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8312
3. Disconnect the air line from the compressor drier. Compress the orange quick connect lock ring
inward, then pull the line outward from the air
drier.
4. Disconnect the air compressor electrical connector. 5. Remove the air compressor bracket bolts
and remove the air compressor/drier assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.).
6. If the bracket will be discarded, remove the bracket from the air compressor.
1 Remove and discard the 3 screws and washers.
2 Remove and discard the 3 rubber isolators from the air compressor.
3 Remove and discard the silencer (muffler) retaining screws and remove the silencer from the
bracket.
7. NOTE: When installing the air lines, make sure the white air line is fully inserted into the fitting for
correct installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure that there are no objects trapped under or on the bracket.
Make sure that the air compressor is not in contact with any surrounding components that could
cause vibration noises.
NOTE: Make sure that the air compressor moves freely in the rubber isolators.
Make sure that the bracket has no deformations that could cause the 3 rubber isolators to load
against each other.
If installing a new bracket from the kit, only use the new fasteners supplied as instructed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 8316
C1300
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 8317
Compressor/Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 8318
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Damping Control Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Right/Left Front
View 151-35 (Chassis, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Damping Control Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Right/Left Front > Page 8323
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Damping Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Front
C1154
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Damping Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Front > Page 8326
C1155
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Damping Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Front > Page 8327
C4044
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Damping Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Front > Page 8328
C4045
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
Level Control Solenoid Valve: Service and Repair
Air Spring Solenoid Valve
Special Tools
Materials
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8332
Part 2
NOTE: Front shown rear similar.
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH quarter trim panel. Failure to do so may result in unexpected
inflation or deflation of the air springs, which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these
operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Do not remove an air spring under any circumstances when there is pressure in the air
spring. Do not remove any components supporting an air spring without either exhausting the air or
providing support for the air spring. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
NOTE: Front shown, rear similar.
1. If the air spring solenoid valve is functional, use the diagnostic tool to vent the appropriate air
spring(s). 2. Turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 3. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist. 4. Disconnect the air valve electrical connector. 5. Disconnect the air line at
the air valve.
^ Compress the orange quick connect lock ring, then pull downward on the air supply line.
6. CAUTION: Remove any dirt or other foreign material from the air spring assembly prior to
removing the air spring solenoid valve from the air
spring assembly.
Remove the air spring solenoid clip.
7. WARNING: The air spring solenoid valve has a 2 stage release. When removing a
non-functional solenoid and the air spring is inflated,
carefully rotate the solenoid counterclockwise until it reaches the first stage to release the air from
the air spring. Turn the solenoid to the second stage to remove the solenoid. Failure to follow these
instructions when removing a non-functional air spring solenoid may result in personal injury or
damage to components as high pressure air is vented uncontrolled.
Rotate the air spring solenoid and remove the solenoid.
8. NOTE: Inspect the air spring O-ring for damage and install a new O-ring as necessary. Lightly
lubricate the solenoid sea] area with silicone
grease.
NOTE: After installing the solenoid, it is necessary to inflate the air suspension system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8333
NOTE: When installing the air spring solenoid, make sure that the electrical connector is positioned
away from the air spring.
NOTE: When installing the air lines, make sure the white air line is fully inserted into the fitting for
correct installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Ride
Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Ride
Height Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose
Ride Height Sensor: Customer Interest Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose
TSB 06-15-10
08/07/06
AIR SUSPENSION PERFORMANCE - HEIGHT SENSOR LINKAGE ARM DISENGAGING
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with an air suspension may
exhibit an air suspension height sensor linkage arm disengaging from the suspension ball stud or
height sensor rotating arm. This concern typically occurs with the rear sensor (Figure 1) but may
occur with the front sensors as well. If this occurs, the symptom will typically be the vehicle leaning
to one side, the vehicle sitting too low/high, a harsh ride, and/or an inoperative air suspension. In
addition, this concern may result in diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1725 (air suspension front
pneumatic failure) or C1726 (air suspension rear pneumatic failure).
ACTION When a linkage arm becomes disengaged, do not re-attach the arm and do not replace
the sensor unless broken. Instead, install a revised linkage arm on all three (3) sensor assemblies,
even if they have not detached from the ball stud. Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Ride
Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Ride
Height Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose > Page 8342
NOTE
LINKAGE ARMS USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT ARE SHOWN IN FIGURE 2. REVISED
LINKAGE ARMS (FIGURE 3) HAVE A NEW DESIGN THAT MAKES IT MORE DIFFICULT TO
DISENGAGE FROM THE BALL STUDS.
NOTE
IF THE SENSOR ASSEMBLY NEEDS TO BE REPLACED FOR ANY DAMAGE/FAILURE OTHER
THAN THE ONE DESCRIBED IN THIS TSB, THE REPLACEMENT ASSEMBLY IS SUPPLIED
WITH A NEW STYLE LINKAGE ARM, SO THERE IS NO NEED TO ORDER ADDITIONAL
LINKAGES FOR THE SERVICE REPAIR.
1. Replace linkage arms on all three (3) sensor assemblies following Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 204-05.
2. Discard the old linkage arms.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061510A 2003-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Three Linkage Arms, Includes Time To Check Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (Do Not Use With 5300A, 5300A7, 5300A8)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
5A967 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Ride
Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Ride Height Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose
Ride Height Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor
Linkage Loose
TSB 06-15-10
08/07/06
AIR SUSPENSION PERFORMANCE - HEIGHT SENSOR LINKAGE ARM DISENGAGING
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with an air suspension may
exhibit an air suspension height sensor linkage arm disengaging from the suspension ball stud or
height sensor rotating arm. This concern typically occurs with the rear sensor (Figure 1) but may
occur with the front sensors as well. If this occurs, the symptom will typically be the vehicle leaning
to one side, the vehicle sitting too low/high, a harsh ride, and/or an inoperative air suspension. In
addition, this concern may result in diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1725 (air suspension front
pneumatic failure) or C1726 (air suspension rear pneumatic failure).
ACTION When a linkage arm becomes disengaged, do not re-attach the arm and do not replace
the sensor unless broken. Instead, install a revised linkage arm on all three (3) sensor assemblies,
even if they have not detached from the ball stud. Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Ride
Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Ride Height Sensor: > 06-15-10 > Aug > 06 > Suspension - Air Suspension Height Sensor Linkage Loose > Page 8348
NOTE
LINKAGE ARMS USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT ARE SHOWN IN FIGURE 2. REVISED
LINKAGE ARMS (FIGURE 3) HAVE A NEW DESIGN THAT MAKES IT MORE DIFFICULT TO
DISENGAGE FROM THE BALL STUDS.
NOTE
IF THE SENSOR ASSEMBLY NEEDS TO BE REPLACED FOR ANY DAMAGE/FAILURE OTHER
THAN THE ONE DESCRIBED IN THIS TSB, THE REPLACEMENT ASSEMBLY IS SUPPLIED
WITH A NEW STYLE LINKAGE ARM, SO THERE IS NO NEED TO ORDER ADDITIONAL
LINKAGES FOR THE SERVICE REPAIR.
1. Replace linkage arms on all three (3) sensor assemblies following Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 204-05.
2. Discard the old linkage arms.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061510A 2003-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Three Linkage Arms, Includes Time To Check Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (Do Not Use With 5300A, 5300A7, 5300A8)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
5A967 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Ride
Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8349
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
Front Height Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Ride
Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8350
Rear Height Sensor
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH quarter trim panel. Failure to do so may result in unexpected
inflation or deflation of the air springs, which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these
operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All sensors
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the sensor arm from the
vehicle.
Front sensor
3. Remove and discard the 2 sensor nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
Rear sensor
4. Remove and discard the sensor nuts and bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
All sensors
5. Disconnect the sensor electrical connector.
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensors cannot be used on opposite sides of the vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the height sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Suspension Control Module: Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8354
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8355
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
C2131a
C2131b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8356
C2324a
C2324b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8357
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. NOTE: The air suspension control module is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 air suspension control module electrical connectors.
3. Pull back the dash padding to expose the 2 module bracket nuts. 4. Remove the air suspension
control module nuts and the air suspension control module.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8358
5. NOTE: The air suspension control module is calibrated with information from the ride height
sensors. A new or exchanged air suspension control
module requires that the ride height adjustment calibration and pneumatic test be carried out.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Mode Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Mode Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8362
C4169
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Service and Repair
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8366
Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in
shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist. 3. Remove and discard the shock and spring assembly upper nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 400 Nm (295 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the shock absorber and spring assembly.
6. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue with
Step 9.
NOTE: For reference during assembly, index the upper mount, spring and shock absorber.
Using a suitable spring compressor, compress the spring until the tension is released from the
shock absorber.
7. While holding the shock rod, remove the nut and washer.
^ Remove the shock absorber.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
8. Remove the upper mount, dust boot and insulator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8367
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Rear
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear > Page 8372
This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter
trim panel. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which
can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist. 3. Remove and discard the shock and spring assembly upper nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.).
4. Remove the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 400 Nm (295 ft. lbs.).
5. Remove the shock absorber and spring assembly.
6. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue with
Step 9.
NOTE: For reference during assembly, index the upper mount, spring and shock absorber.
Using a suitable spring compressor, compress the spring until the tension is released from the
shock absorber.
7. While holding the shock rod, remove the nut and washer.
^ Remove the shock absorber.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear > Page 8373
8. Remove the upper mount, dust boot and insulator. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear > Page 8374
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Shock Absorber
"For information regarding this component please; refer to Air Spring service and repair"
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Torque Rod > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Torque Rod: > 05-16-1 > Aug > 05 > A/T/Suspension - Clunk/Thump From Rear
When Shifting A/T
Torque Rod: Customer Interest A/T/Suspension - Clunk/Thump From Rear When Shifting A/T
TSB 05-16-1
08/22/05
CLUNK/GRIND/THUMP NOISE FROM REAR OF VEHICLE WHEN TRANSMISSION IS SHIFTED
- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 6/13/2005
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles built before 6/13/2005, may exhibit a
clunk/grind/thump noise from the rear when the transmission is shifted, during a change in vehicle
direction or on acceleration. A vibration from the driveshaft/axle area may also be exhibited.
ACTION This noise may be due to the torque arm to rear axle housing attachment bolts becoming
loose. It may be necessary to replace the four (4) attachment bolts, and the torque arm if distorted.
The torque arm attaches at the front right side of the rear differential and the # 4 crossmember.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn off the air suspension switch if equipped.
2. Raise vehicle, refer to Workshop Manual Section 100-02.
3. Using a suitable jack-stand, support the rear axle housing.
4. Remove the four (4) torque arm to rear axle housing attachment bolts. Clean both mating
surfaces.
5. Inspect the torque arm for distortion.
a. If no distortion is found, replace only the four (4) torque arm to axle housing bolts and tighten to
150 lb-ft (200 N.m).
(1) Remove jack.
(2) Lower the vehicle.
(3) Turn on the air suspension switch if equipped.
b. If distortion is found, replace the torque arm and the four (4) torque arm to axle housing bolts.
Refer to torque arm replacement procedure.
TORQUE ARM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE
1. Remove front torque arm bolt and torque arm.
2. Install the new torque arm and front bolt, do not tighten at this time.
3. Install the four (4) new torque arm to axle assembly bolts and tighten to 150 lb-ft (200 N.m).
a. Loosen each bolt one revolution.
b. Re-tighten each bolt to 150 lb-ft. (200 N.m).
c. Tighten front torque arm bolt to 100 lb-ft. (135 N.m).
4. Remove jack.
5. Lower the vehicle.
6. Turn on the air suspension switch if equipped.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Torque Rod > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Torque Rod: > 05-16-1 > Aug > 05 > A/T/Suspension - Clunk/Thump From Rear
When Shifting A/T > Page 8383
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
051601A 2005-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Torque Arm To Axle Housing Bolts
051601B 2005-2006 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Torque Arm And Torque Arm Bolts
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4382 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Torque Rod > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Torque Rod: > 05-16-10 > Aug > 05 > Suspension/Frame - Rear End
Clunk/Thump/Grind Noise
Torque Rod: Customer Interest Suspension/Frame - Rear End Clunk/Thump/Grind Noise
TSB 05-16-10
08/22/05
CLUNK/GRIND/THUMP NOISE - FRAME REPAIR PROCEDURE
FORD: 2003 Expedition 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003 Navigator 2005-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003 Expedition/Navigator built 3/18/2003 through 9/3/2003 and 2005-2006 built
8/2/2004 to 6/13/2005 may exhibit a clunk/grind/thump noise from the rear of the vehicle. The
condition will occur when the transmission is shifted, the vehicle changes direction, or on
acceleration. Vehicles may also exhibit a vibration from the driveshaft/axle area. This may be due
to missing or damaged attachment bolts that secure the rear torque arm to the axle housing. In rare
cases, if symptoms are ignored and the bolts are allowed to completely disengage, the differential
may tip upwards allowing the driveshaft to make contact with the frame.
ACTION If frame damage is found, a service kit is available to repair and reinforce the frame. Refer
to the instruction sheet included in the kit.
Parts Block
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 05-16-1
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4612 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Torque Rod > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Torque Rod: > 05-16-1 > Aug > 05 > A/T/Suspension - Clunk/Thump
From Rear When Shifting A/T
Torque Rod: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T/Suspension - Clunk/Thump From Rear When
Shifting A/T
TSB 05-16-1
08/22/05
CLUNK/GRIND/THUMP NOISE FROM REAR OF VEHICLE WHEN TRANSMISSION IS SHIFTED
- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 6/13/2005
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles built before 6/13/2005, may exhibit a
clunk/grind/thump noise from the rear when the transmission is shifted, during a change in vehicle
direction or on acceleration. A vibration from the driveshaft/axle area may also be exhibited.
ACTION This noise may be due to the torque arm to rear axle housing attachment bolts becoming
loose. It may be necessary to replace the four (4) attachment bolts, and the torque arm if distorted.
The torque arm attaches at the front right side of the rear differential and the # 4 crossmember.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn off the air suspension switch if equipped.
2. Raise vehicle, refer to Workshop Manual Section 100-02.
3. Using a suitable jack-stand, support the rear axle housing.
4. Remove the four (4) torque arm to rear axle housing attachment bolts. Clean both mating
surfaces.
5. Inspect the torque arm for distortion.
a. If no distortion is found, replace only the four (4) torque arm to axle housing bolts and tighten to
150 lb-ft (200 N.m).
(1) Remove jack.
(2) Lower the vehicle.
(3) Turn on the air suspension switch if equipped.
b. If distortion is found, replace the torque arm and the four (4) torque arm to axle housing bolts.
Refer to torque arm replacement procedure.
TORQUE ARM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE
1. Remove front torque arm bolt and torque arm.
2. Install the new torque arm and front bolt, do not tighten at this time.
3. Install the four (4) new torque arm to axle assembly bolts and tighten to 150 lb-ft (200 N.m).
a. Loosen each bolt one revolution.
b. Re-tighten each bolt to 150 lb-ft. (200 N.m).
c. Tighten front torque arm bolt to 100 lb-ft. (135 N.m).
4. Remove jack.
5. Lower the vehicle.
6. Turn on the air suspension switch if equipped.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Torque Rod > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Torque Rod: > 05-16-1 > Aug > 05 > A/T/Suspension - Clunk/Thump
From Rear When Shifting A/T > Page 8393
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
051601A 2005-2006 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Torque Arm To Axle Housing Bolts
051601B 2005-2006 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Torque Arm And Torque Arm Bolts
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4382 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Torque Rod > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Torque Rod: > 05-16-10 > Aug > 05 > Suspension/Frame - Rear End
Clunk/Thump/Grind Noise
Torque Rod: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension/Frame - Rear End Clunk/Thump/Grind
Noise
TSB 05-16-10
08/22/05
CLUNK/GRIND/THUMP NOISE - FRAME REPAIR PROCEDURE
FORD: 2003 Expedition 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003 Navigator 2005-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003 Expedition/Navigator built 3/18/2003 through 9/3/2003 and 2005-2006 built
8/2/2004 to 6/13/2005 may exhibit a clunk/grind/thump noise from the rear of the vehicle. The
condition will occur when the transmission is shifted, the vehicle changes direction, or on
acceleration. Vehicles may also exhibit a vibration from the driveshaft/axle area. This may be due
to missing or damaged attachment bolts that secure the rear torque arm to the axle housing. In rare
cases, if symptoms are ignored and the bolts are allowed to completely disengage, the differential
may tip upwards allowing the driveshaft to make contact with the frame.
ACTION If frame damage is found, a service kit is available to repair and reinforce the frame. Refer
to the instruction sheet included in the kit.
Parts Block
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 05-16-1
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4612 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS
High Temperature 4x4 Front Axle & Wheel Bearing Grease
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
...................................................... E8TZ-19590-A Ford Specification ................................................
................................................................................................................................... ESA-M1C198-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 8401
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist.
3. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the rear halfshaft nut and washer. ^
To install, tighten to 300 Nm (221 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 8402
4. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV Joint from the wheel hub.
5. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the brake disc.
7. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector and detach the wheel speed sensor
harness from the retainer.
8. Remove the bolt and detach the harness from the retainers. To install, tighten the bolt to 15 Nm
(11 ft. lbs.). 9. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and hub assembly bolts, the wheel bearing assembly
and the wheel speed sensor as an assembly.
^ Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake shield.
^ Discard the bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 ft. lbs.).
10. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and hub assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front axle nut .......................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 27 Nm (20 ft.lbs.) Rear axle wheel hub retainer ...........................
...................................................................................................................................... 345 Nm (254
ft.lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8410
C1157
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
JACKING
WARNING:
- The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut down prior to hoisting, jacking or
towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension
switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel area. Failure to do so can result in unexpected
inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these
operations.
- Do not run the engine when jacking the vehicle. The wheels contacting the ground could cause
the vehicle to move.
- Support the vehicle prior to carrying out any procedure requiring the vehicle to be jacked off the
ground.
- Make sure the jack and jack stands are correctly located to prevent the vehicle from falling.
- Wheel chocks should be used to prevent the vehicle from rolling and falling off the jack.
CAUTION:
- Never use a halfshaft as a lifting point.
- If equipped with retractable running board, disable the system through the instrument cluster
controls.
Jacking Points - Front
Jacking Points - Front
The front jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located behind the front tire and
wheel assembly.
Jacking Points - Rear
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8415
Jacking Points - Rear
CAUTION: Do not use the differential housing as a lift point. Leaks or damage to the rear axle cover and
adjoining differential housing surface can occur if a floor jack or any lifting device is allowed to
contact the cover at any point where the cover joins the housing.
- Do not use the rear control arms as a lifting point.
The rear jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located in front of the rear tire
and wheel assembly.
LIFTING
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut down prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel area. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations.
CAUTION: Damage to suspension, exhaust and steering linkage components can occur if care is
not exercised when positioning the hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
Lifting Points - Twin Post Hoist
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8416
Lifting Points - Twin Post Hoist
Locate the front hoist adapters and rear hoist adapters (top of frame arc) as indicated.
Lifting Points - Drive On Hoist
Lifting Points - Drive On Hoist
The vehicle is supported by tires and suspension components.
Lifting Points - Floor Jack, Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8417
Lifting Points - Floor Jack, Front
The front can be lifted using a floor jack under the front control arm directly below the shock.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Relays and Modules - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Module: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Module Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage can result.
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) is integral to the vehicle security module
(VSM) and is not serviced separately.
NOTE: A new VSM module is delivered in manufacturing mode with pre-set diagnostic trouble
codes (DTC's). These DTC's require that a particular set of operations to be carried out in order to
clear them and enable the module for normal operations. The pre-set DTC's are as follows: ^
B2477 - Module Configuration Failure/Mismatch
^ B2868 - Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2869 - Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2870 - Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2871 - Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ C2780 - ECU in Manufacturing Mode
NOTE: A re-configured VSM may also set the above codes and will need to go through the same
set of procedures as a new module to enable normal operation.
1. NOTE: The steps included in the VSM removal and installation process are critical to restoring
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring
system operations and will permit a new or reconfigured module to operate as intended. Each step
is designed to carry out a particular operation and clear the manufacturing mode DTC's. Once
these DTC's are cleared, the new or reconfigured module will enter into normal operating mode.
Remove the VSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Sensor Training (Reset Procedure)
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system is not affected by wheel and tire rotation.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency (RF) noise.
RF noise is generated by electrical motor and appliance operation, cellular telephones and remote
transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 2. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to
the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
3. Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
6. The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if train mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center displays
"TRAIN LF TIRE", place the special tool on the valve stem of the LF tire pressure sensor. The horn
will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the TPMS
module.
7. Within 2 minutes after the horn sounds, place the special tool on the valve stem of the RF tire
pressure sensor.
NOTE: If the VSM (TPMS module integral to VSM) does not recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure
sensors during the tire training procedure, the horn will sound twice and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT" and the procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
When the tire training procedure is complete, the horn will sound once and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPLETE".
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8426
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Sensor
Special Tools
CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8427
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
Removal
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) will
not operate correctly if black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not remove the valve stem core to relieve the tire pressure.
CAUTION: If the valve stem core has been removed from the valve stem, reinstall the original valve
stem core. If the original valve stem core is damaged, a nickel-plated core must be installed.
Failure to use a nickel-plated core will result in corrosion and the possible loss of tire pressure.
NOTE: Release the tire pressure by removing the sensor valve stem nut.
With the valve stem at the 6 o'clock position, remove the sensor valve stem nut and push the
sensor by hand into the tire (with the cap on).
3. Using a suitable tire machine, separate both beads of the tire from the wheel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8428
4. CAUTION: Care should be taken not to damage the tire pressure sensor while separating the
outside bead of tire from the wheel.
Place the wheel and tire on the turntable of the tire machine, index-mark the valve stem and wheel
weight positions, lubricate the bead of the tire and dismount the outside bead of the tire from the
wheel.
5. Remove the tire pressure sensor from the tire. 6. Remove and discard the grommet from the tire
pressure sensor.
Installation
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The TPM's will not operate correctly if
black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. NOTE: Install a new sensor grommet or an air leak can occur.
Install a new grommet on the tire pressure sensor.
2. NOTE: Do not allow the tire to rotate relative to the rim while mounting the tire.
Lubricate and mount the outside and inside bead of the tire to the rim.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8429
3. CAUTION: Overtightening the tire pressure sensor valve stem nut can damage the tire pressure
sensor, undertightening can cause air leaks.
NOTE: Sensor position is critical for correct sensor operation. The "flat" side of the sensor must be
facing the wheel and the "slanted" side of the sensor must be facing away from the wheel. When
properly installed, there will be a very small gap between the sensor and the wheel.
NOTE: Tightening the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs.) equals approximately 2 clockwise turns after the
nut has been tightened by hand.
Push the side wall of the tire and install the tire pressure sensor. Tighten the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch
lbs.).
4. CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8430
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
CAUTION: Use only OEM valve caps (aluminum or plastic valve caps) with the tire pressure
sensors. Do not use brass-threaded valve caps with the tire pressure sensors.
Inflate the tire to the pressure specified on the safety certification sticker located on the driver or
door pillar.
5. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 6. Train the tire pressure sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure
Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Description and Operation
UNDERSTANDING YOUR TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System measures pressure in your four road tires and sends the tire
pressure readings to your vehicle every minute while you are driving and once every 6 hours when
your vehicle is parked. The Low Tire Warning Lamp will turn ON if the tire pressure is 25% below
the pressure listed on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (approximately 6 to 9 psi below the
manufacturers recommend tire pressure). If the tire pressure increases 2 psi above the Light ON
threshold, then the TPMS light will turn OFF. Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under
inflated and need to be inflated to the manufacturers recommended tire pressure. Even if the light
turns ON and a short time later turns OFF, your tire pressure still needs to be checked. In short,
once the light has turned ON, at least one tire may be under inflated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure
Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8435
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPM's Indicator and Vehicle Message Center Messages
The TPM's indicator and vehicle message center (if equipped) sometimes displays faults that
cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these messages as TPM's faults that must be serviced.
GO to Symptom Chart for the TPM's indicator operation and message center messages. See:
Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
TPM's Indicator Illuminates Continuously
The TPM's indicator remains on continuously for the following condition:
1. NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPM's functionality
before carrying out any diagnosis.
Low Tire Pressure - The TPM's indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays LOW
TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low. Tire
pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold placard pressure. Adjust the air pressure in
tires. Refer to Information BUS for diagnosis of the CAN bus. The TPM's indicator flashes for 20
seconds after prove-out and for the following 3 reasons:
1 No communication with the TPM's Module (integral to VSM) - The TPM's indicator is illuminated
when the instrument cluster (IC) has received no signals from the VSM for more than 5 seconds. If
equipped, the message center displays TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom
Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
2 Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
SENSOR FAULT when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
3 Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT when the tire pressure
monitoring system is malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Module
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Module: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Module Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage can result.
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) is integral to the vehicle security module
(VSM) and is not serviced separately.
NOTE: A new VSM module is delivered in manufacturing mode with pre-set diagnostic trouble
codes (DTC's). These DTC's require that a particular set of operations to be carried out in order to
clear them and enable the module for normal operations. The pre-set DTC's are as follows: ^
B2477 - Module Configuration Failure/Mismatch
^ B2868 - Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2869 - Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2870 - Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2871 - Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ C2780 - ECU in Manufacturing Mode
NOTE: A re-configured VSM may also set the above codes and will need to go through the same
set of procedures as a new module to enable normal operation.
1. NOTE: The steps included in the VSM removal and installation process are critical to restoring
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring
system operations and will permit a new or reconfigured module to operate as intended. Each step
is designed to carry out a particular operation and clear the manufacturing mode DTC's. Once
these DTC's are cleared, the new or reconfigured module will enter into normal operating mode.
Remove the VSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Sensor Training (Reset Procedure)
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system is not affected by wheel and tire rotation.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency (RF) noise.
RF noise is generated by electrical motor and appliance operation, cellular telephones and remote
transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 2. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to
the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
3. Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
6. The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if train mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center displays
"TRAIN LF TIRE", place the special tool on the valve stem of the LF tire pressure sensor. The horn
will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the TPMS
module.
7. Within 2 minutes after the horn sounds, place the special tool on the valve stem of the RF tire
pressure sensor.
NOTE: If the VSM (TPMS module integral to VSM) does not recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure
sensors during the tire training procedure, the horn will sound twice and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT" and the procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
When the tire training procedure is complete, the horn will sound once and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPLETE".
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8442
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Sensor
Special Tools
CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8443
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
Removal
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) will
not operate correctly if black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not remove the valve stem core to relieve the tire pressure.
CAUTION: If the valve stem core has been removed from the valve stem, reinstall the original valve
stem core. If the original valve stem core is damaged, a nickel-plated core must be installed.
Failure to use a nickel-plated core will result in corrosion and the possible loss of tire pressure.
NOTE: Release the tire pressure by removing the sensor valve stem nut.
With the valve stem at the 6 o'clock position, remove the sensor valve stem nut and push the
sensor by hand into the tire (with the cap on).
3. Using a suitable tire machine, separate both beads of the tire from the wheel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8444
4. CAUTION: Care should be taken not to damage the tire pressure sensor while separating the
outside bead of tire from the wheel.
Place the wheel and tire on the turntable of the tire machine, index-mark the valve stem and wheel
weight positions, lubricate the bead of the tire and dismount the outside bead of the tire from the
wheel.
5. Remove the tire pressure sensor from the tire. 6. Remove and discard the grommet from the tire
pressure sensor.
Installation
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The TPM's will not operate correctly if
black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. NOTE: Install a new sensor grommet or an air leak can occur.
Install a new grommet on the tire pressure sensor.
2. NOTE: Do not allow the tire to rotate relative to the rim while mounting the tire.
Lubricate and mount the outside and inside bead of the tire to the rim.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8445
3. CAUTION: Overtightening the tire pressure sensor valve stem nut can damage the tire pressure
sensor, undertightening can cause air leaks.
NOTE: Sensor position is critical for correct sensor operation. The "flat" side of the sensor must be
facing the wheel and the "slanted" side of the sensor must be facing away from the wheel. When
properly installed, there will be a very small gap between the sensor and the wheel.
NOTE: Tightening the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs.) equals approximately 2 clockwise turns after the
nut has been tightened by hand.
Push the side wall of the tire and install the tire pressure sensor. Tighten the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch
lbs.).
4. CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8446
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
CAUTION: Use only OEM valve caps (aluminum or plastic valve caps) with the tire pressure
sensors. Do not use brass-threaded valve caps with the tire pressure sensors.
Inflate the tire to the pressure specified on the safety certification sticker located on the driver or
door pillar.
5. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 6. Train the tire pressure sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection
Technical Service Bulletin # 05S35 Date: 050705
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8455
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED? Yes. OASIS will be activated by July 5, 2005
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? Yes
Available through by July 5, 2005.
Owner names and addresses will be available by July 18, 2005.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states provinces and countries.
Accordingly you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Inspect and if necessary correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TIRE REPLACEMENT GUIDELINES
^ Tires that fail the inspection must be replaced regardless of the mileage or the remaining tread on
the tire.
^ Ford Motor Company will only pay claims for the replacement tires ordered through the Ford Tire
Hotline that are listed in Attachment II under Ford Approved Replacement Tire List. Upgrades to
other brand and size tires are NOT allowed.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8456
^ Some vehicles may be equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Damaged
TPMS sensors are not covered under this program. Follow the instructions in Attachment III to
avoid damaging the TPMS sensor while dismounting the tire from the rim.
^ If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition call
the Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted (excluding the post-repair
wheel nut re-torque procedure - see below).
^ The owner letter will direct customers to the dealer to have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 500
miles (800km) after tire replacement. Dealers are to use the related damage flag to submit claims
for labor operation 05S35Z (post-repair wheel nut re-torque). Approval is not required for this labor
operation. This labor operation may only be claimed once after the original repair has been
completed.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company is offering a refund for owner-paid repairs covered by this recall if the repair
was performed prior to the date indicated in the reimbursement plan which is posted with this
bulletin. This plan is also available to owners through the Customer Relationship Center (CRC).
The CRC will direct owners to seek reimbursement through authorized dealers or at their option
directly through Ford Motor Company at P.O. Box 6251 Dearborn, MI 48121-6251.
^ Dealers are also authorized to refund owner-paid emergency repairs that were performed away
from an authorized servicing dealer after the end date specified in the reimbursement plan. Refund
claims that include other non-covered repairs or those judged by Ford to be excessive will not be
accepted for reimbursement.
^ This safety recall (tire tread inspection) must still be performed, even if the customer has paid for
a previous tire replacement Claiming a refund will not close the recall on this vehicle.
^ Refund Claiming Information (Submit on separate repair line.)
- Program Code: 05S35 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN
- Misc. Expense: REFUND - Misc. Expense: 0.2 Hrs.
RENTAL VEHICLES
Ford Motor Company will pay for a rental vehicle while a replacement tire is on order except for fuel
and insurance which will be at the owner's expense. Follow Extended Service Plan (ESP)
guidelines for rental dollar amounts. Enter the word "RENTAL" plus the number of days the vehicle
was used in the Miscellaneous Expense area of the recall claim form.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Enter each unique DOT code of the "new" replacement tires on the diagnostic code entry screen
in the Powertrain DTC fields. The "old" replaced tire DOT codes should be entered in the Body
DTC fields.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Enter the full part number of the replacement tire with the quantity of tires replaced. Tires will be
reimbursed at AtW Dealer cost +25% (mounting balancing valve stems and wheel weights
included).
- Virginia Dealers: Claim the additional 15% mark-up amount as miscellaneous expense code
"TIREMU".
^ Freight is not reimbursable. (Freight charges will be credited on the dealer's Ford Parts
statement.)
^ Tire disposal will be reimbursed see the Tire Disposal Allowance Attachment II.
^ Dealers may claim any applicable local waste tax - enter OTHER in the miscellaneous expense
area of the claim with the actual cost.
^ Refunds or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8457
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS ORDERING INFORMATION
The following part is necessary when changing a tire on a vehicle that is equipped with the optional
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
FORD APPROVED REPLACEMENT TIRE LIST
TIRE ORDERING INFORMATION
^ Tires must be ordered through the Ford Tire Hot Line. Identify the number of tires needed and
use the "05535 Replacement Tire Order Form" to order your tires. (See Attachment IV for the tire
order form.)
^ Tires will begin shipping the week of July 11, 2005
^ Orders will be fulfilled in the order they are received.
^ Ford Tire Hot Line hours are 8AM to 8PM Monday through Friday EST.
TIRE DESTRUCTION / MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
TIRE PRICE
For latest tire prices refer to the Tire Sales Tool on the website.
TIRE DISPOSAL ALLOWANCE
An allowance of $4.00 per tire is being provided for tire disposal. To claim the allowance enter the
dollar amount as "HANDLG" in the "MISC EXPENSE" area of the claim form.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST-REPAIR TORQUE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8458
The vehicle Owner's Guide states that each wheel that is removed and reinstalled must have the
wheel nuts re-tightened at 500 miles (800km) after service. This is required to permit the wheel
clamping system to seat correctly so that the wheel nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain
fully tightened. To claim this operation you must file a related damage claim using labor operation
05S35Z. This labor operation includes time to check the torque on all the wheel nuts.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves inspecting all four (4) tires of the vehicle for tread damaged caused by a
piece of metal on the conveyor line during vehicle assembly.
INSPECTION
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
2. Raise the vehicle on a hoist and inspect all four (4) tires for tread damage. See Figure 1.
^ If no tread damage is found, lower the vehicle, turn on the air suspension if equipped, and
release the vehicle.
^ Any tire found to have damaged tread must be replaced. Proceed to Tire Replacement.
TIRE REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8459
If the vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS), specific procedures
must be followed to remove and install the tire or damage to the TPMS sensors will occur. Related
damage claims for TPMS sensors will be rejected.
NOTE:
Vehicles equipped with TPMS can be identified by the presence of a metallic valve stem at each
wheel. Vehicles without TPMS will have rubber valve stems.
NOTE:
While the Workshop Repair Manual does not provide actual tire replacement procedures, it does
provide procedures for TPMS sensor removal and installation. To prevent damage to the sensor, it
must be removed and installed during tire removal and installation. Refer to Section 204-04 of the
ONLINE version of the 2006 Model Year Expedition/Navigator Workshop Repair Manual for the
most up-to-date service information available. Again, related damage claims for TPMS sensors will
be rejected.
1.
CAUTION: Do not remove the valve core from TPMS valve stem.
Remove the tire from the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor removal.
2. For vehicles without TPMS, install a new rubber valve stem.
3. Mount the new tire onto the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor installation.
4. Balance the wheel/tire assembly, then install it on the vehicle.
5. Tighten the wheel nuts to 204 Nm (150 lb-ft).
6. Lower the hoist and if equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the ON position.
7. Proceed to Tire Destruction/Mutilation.
TIRE DESTRUCTION/MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST REPAIR RETIGHTEN PROCEDURE
WARNING:
Re-tighten the wheel nuts at 800 km (500 miles) after any wheel change or any time the wheel nuts
are loosened. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
The Owner Guide and workshop repair manual recommend that each wheel removed and
reinstalled must have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 800 km (500 miles) after service. Wheel nut
torque specification is 204 Nm (150 lb-ft). This is required to permit the wheel clamping system to
seat correctly so that the wheel lug nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain fully tightened.
To claim this operation, refer to Attachment II.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8460
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8461
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8462
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8463
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > NHTSA05V310000 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for Damage
Tires: Recalls Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for Damage
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2006 Lincoln/Navigator 2006
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V310000 MFG'S
REPORT DATE: July 05, 2005
COMPONENT: Tires: Tread/Belt
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 10061
SUMMARY: On certain sport utility vehicles, the front and rear tires on the driver's side of affected
vehicles may have been damaged at the center tread during production.
CONSEQUENCE: Over time, the damage may be sufficient to allow belt corrosion ultimately
leading to a tread separation, which could result in a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect all four tires (to ensure inspection of the left hand side tires that may
have been rotated to the other side of the vehicle) for tire tread damage and, if necessary, replace
the damaged tire. The recall began on July 13, 2005. Owners should contact Ford at
1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 05S35. Please note that this program will expire on December 31, 2005.
Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety
Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns
Tires: Customer Interest 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns
TSB 08-21-11
10/27/08
4 WHEEL DRIVE/ALL WHEEL DRIVE - WITH CONTROL TRAC - SHUDDER ON
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION OR BINDING ON SLOW TURNS
FORD: 1997-2008 Expedition, Explorer 2006-2008 F-150 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac 2008
F-150
LINCOLN: 1998-2008 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2005 Mountaineer 2006-2008 Mountaineer
ISSUE Various 1997-2008 vehicles equipped with either 4 wheel drive or all wheel drive and
equipped with control trac may exhibit a shudder on acceleration/deceleration, binding in slow
speed turns or noise from the front driveline and/or transfer case. The shudder/binding will occur
with the vehicle being operated in the awd/auto 4x4 mode. The shudder/binding may be due to
incorrect tire circumference or improper tire inflation pressures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS DOES NOT APPLY TO 2006-2008 MOUNTAINEER WITH A 4.0L ENGINE OR 2007-2008
EXPLORER AND SPORT TRAC WITH 20 INCH WHEELS.
NOTE
VEHICLES ON THE LIST MAY REQUIRE REPLACEMENT OF TIRE/S IF THE TIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AVERAGE BETWEEN THE FRONT AND REAR AXLES ARE OUTSIDE OF
THE 1/2 INCH SPECIFICATION OR IF THE TIRE CIRCUMFERENCE FROM SIDE TO SIDE ON
EITHER AXLE EXCEEDS 1/2 INCH DIFFERENCE, THE SMALLER TIRE(S) MUST BE
REPLACED.
NOTE
REVIEW THE WARRANTY AND POLICY MANUAL FOR FORD MOTOR COMPANY TIRE
REPLACEMENT WARRANTY BEFORE PERFORMING THE SERVICE PROCEDURE.
NOTE
ONLY USE REPLACEMENT TIRE AND WHEEL THAT ARE THE SAME SIZE, LOAD INDEX,
SPEED RATING AND TYPE (SUCH AS P-METRIC VERSUS LT-METRIC OR ALL-SEASON
VERSUS ALL-TERRAIN) AS THOSE ORIGINALLY PROVIDED BY FORD. THE
RECOMMENDED TIRE AND WHEEL SIZE MAY BE FOUND ON EITHER THE SAFETY
COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION LABEL OR THE TIRE LABEL WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE
B-PILLAR OR EDGE OF THE DRIVER'S DOOR.
NOTE
ON SOME 4WD MODELS, THE INITIAL SHIFT FROM 2WD TO 4WD WHILE THE VEHICLE IS
MOVING CAN CAUSE A MOMENTARY CLUNK AND/OR BRIEF RATCHETING SOUND. THESE
SOUNDS ARE NORMAL AS THE FRONT DRIVETRAIN COMES UP TO SPEED AND IS NOT
CAUSE FOR CONCERN.
1. Review the tire label for correct tire size and tire inflation pressures located at the B-Pillar of the
driver's door.
2. If the tire size does not match the label, this procedure does not apply, follow normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
3. If the tire size is correct, ensure tire pressures are within specifications.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 8473
4. Raise the vehicle on the hoist, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 100-02.
5. Disconnect all wiring going to the transfer case and road test.
6. Is the shudder/binding present?
a. If the shudder/binding is still present, do not continue with this procedure, continue with WSM
normal diagnostic for 4X4.
b. If the shudder/binding is gone, proceed to Step 7.
7. Raise the vehicle on the hoist and reconnect all the wiring previously disconnected.
8. Using a tailor's tape or flexible measuring tape and measure the circumference of all four (4)
tires and record the measurements. (Figure 1)
9. Calculate the average of the circumference of the two (2) front tires and calculate the average of
the circumference of the two (2) rear tires. (Figure 2)
10. If the difference between these two averages is greater than 1/2" (12.7 mm), front to back or
side to side, replace the smallest circumference tire(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 8474
and remeasure the tire averages. Refer to WSM, Section 204-04 for tire replacement.
NOTE
WARRANTY COVERAGE ELIGIBILITY STARTS WITH 2007 NEW VEHICLE LIMITED
WARRANTY COVERAGE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082111A 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111A 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace TWO Tires. (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace Two (2) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 8475
Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150
Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do
Not Use With 1007A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A195 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns
TSB 08-21-11
10/27/08
4 WHEEL DRIVE/ALL WHEEL DRIVE - WITH CONTROL TRAC - SHUDDER ON
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION OR BINDING ON SLOW TURNS
FORD: 1997-2008 Expedition, Explorer 2006-2008 F-150 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac 2008
F-150
LINCOLN: 1998-2008 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2005 Mountaineer 2006-2008 Mountaineer
ISSUE Various 1997-2008 vehicles equipped with either 4 wheel drive or all wheel drive and
equipped with control trac may exhibit a shudder on acceleration/deceleration, binding in slow
speed turns or noise from the front driveline and/or transfer case. The shudder/binding will occur
with the vehicle being operated in the awd/auto 4x4 mode. The shudder/binding may be due to
incorrect tire circumference or improper tire inflation pressures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS DOES NOT APPLY TO 2006-2008 MOUNTAINEER WITH A 4.0L ENGINE OR 2007-2008
EXPLORER AND SPORT TRAC WITH 20 INCH WHEELS.
NOTE
VEHICLES ON THE LIST MAY REQUIRE REPLACEMENT OF TIRE/S IF THE TIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AVERAGE BETWEEN THE FRONT AND REAR AXLES ARE OUTSIDE OF
THE 1/2 INCH SPECIFICATION OR IF THE TIRE CIRCUMFERENCE FROM SIDE TO SIDE ON
EITHER AXLE EXCEEDS 1/2 INCH DIFFERENCE, THE SMALLER TIRE(S) MUST BE
REPLACED.
NOTE
REVIEW THE WARRANTY AND POLICY MANUAL FOR FORD MOTOR COMPANY TIRE
REPLACEMENT WARRANTY BEFORE PERFORMING THE SERVICE PROCEDURE.
NOTE
ONLY USE REPLACEMENT TIRE AND WHEEL THAT ARE THE SAME SIZE, LOAD INDEX,
SPEED RATING AND TYPE (SUCH AS P-METRIC VERSUS LT-METRIC OR ALL-SEASON
VERSUS ALL-TERRAIN) AS THOSE ORIGINALLY PROVIDED BY FORD. THE
RECOMMENDED TIRE AND WHEEL SIZE MAY BE FOUND ON EITHER THE SAFETY
COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION LABEL OR THE TIRE LABEL WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE
B-PILLAR OR EDGE OF THE DRIVER'S DOOR.
NOTE
ON SOME 4WD MODELS, THE INITIAL SHIFT FROM 2WD TO 4WD WHILE THE VEHICLE IS
MOVING CAN CAUSE A MOMENTARY CLUNK AND/OR BRIEF RATCHETING SOUND. THESE
SOUNDS ARE NORMAL AS THE FRONT DRIVETRAIN COMES UP TO SPEED AND IS NOT
CAUSE FOR CONCERN.
1. Review the tire label for correct tire size and tire inflation pressures located at the B-Pillar of the
driver's door.
2. If the tire size does not match the label, this procedure does not apply, follow normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
3. If the tire size is correct, ensure tire pressures are within specifications.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 8481
4. Raise the vehicle on the hoist, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 100-02.
5. Disconnect all wiring going to the transfer case and road test.
6. Is the shudder/binding present?
a. If the shudder/binding is still present, do not continue with this procedure, continue with WSM
normal diagnostic for 4X4.
b. If the shudder/binding is gone, proceed to Step 7.
7. Raise the vehicle on the hoist and reconnect all the wiring previously disconnected.
8. Using a tailor's tape or flexible measuring tape and measure the circumference of all four (4)
tires and record the measurements. (Figure 1)
9. Calculate the average of the circumference of the two (2) front tires and calculate the average of
the circumference of the two (2) rear tires. (Figure 2)
10. If the difference between these two averages is greater than 1/2" (12.7 mm), front to back or
side to side, replace the smallest circumference tire(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 8482
and remeasure the tire averages. Refer to WSM, Section 204-04 for tire replacement.
NOTE
WARRANTY COVERAGE ELIGIBILITY STARTS WITH 2007 NEW VEHICLE LIMITED
WARRANTY COVERAGE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082111A 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111A 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace TWO Tires. (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace Two (2) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 8483
Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150
Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do
Not Use With 1007A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A195 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection
Technical Service Bulletin # 05S35 Date: 050705
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page
8488
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED? Yes. OASIS will be activated by July 5, 2005
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? Yes
Available through by July 5, 2005.
Owner names and addresses will be available by July 18, 2005.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states provinces and countries.
Accordingly you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Inspect and if necessary correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TIRE REPLACEMENT GUIDELINES
^ Tires that fail the inspection must be replaced regardless of the mileage or the remaining tread on
the tire.
^ Ford Motor Company will only pay claims for the replacement tires ordered through the Ford Tire
Hotline that are listed in Attachment II under Ford Approved Replacement Tire List. Upgrades to
other brand and size tires are NOT allowed.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page
8489
^ Some vehicles may be equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Damaged
TPMS sensors are not covered under this program. Follow the instructions in Attachment III to
avoid damaging the TPMS sensor while dismounting the tire from the rim.
^ If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition call
the Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted (excluding the post-repair
wheel nut re-torque procedure - see below).
^ The owner letter will direct customers to the dealer to have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 500
miles (800km) after tire replacement. Dealers are to use the related damage flag to submit claims
for labor operation 05S35Z (post-repair wheel nut re-torque). Approval is not required for this labor
operation. This labor operation may only be claimed once after the original repair has been
completed.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company is offering a refund for owner-paid repairs covered by this recall if the repair
was performed prior to the date indicated in the reimbursement plan which is posted with this
bulletin. This plan is also available to owners through the Customer Relationship Center (CRC).
The CRC will direct owners to seek reimbursement through authorized dealers or at their option
directly through Ford Motor Company at P.O. Box 6251 Dearborn, MI 48121-6251.
^ Dealers are also authorized to refund owner-paid emergency repairs that were performed away
from an authorized servicing dealer after the end date specified in the reimbursement plan. Refund
claims that include other non-covered repairs or those judged by Ford to be excessive will not be
accepted for reimbursement.
^ This safety recall (tire tread inspection) must still be performed, even if the customer has paid for
a previous tire replacement Claiming a refund will not close the recall on this vehicle.
^ Refund Claiming Information (Submit on separate repair line.)
- Program Code: 05S35 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN
- Misc. Expense: REFUND - Misc. Expense: 0.2 Hrs.
RENTAL VEHICLES
Ford Motor Company will pay for a rental vehicle while a replacement tire is on order except for fuel
and insurance which will be at the owner's expense. Follow Extended Service Plan (ESP)
guidelines for rental dollar amounts. Enter the word "RENTAL" plus the number of days the vehicle
was used in the Miscellaneous Expense area of the recall claim form.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Enter each unique DOT code of the "new" replacement tires on the diagnostic code entry screen
in the Powertrain DTC fields. The "old" replaced tire DOT codes should be entered in the Body
DTC fields.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Enter the full part number of the replacement tire with the quantity of tires replaced. Tires will be
reimbursed at AtW Dealer cost +25% (mounting balancing valve stems and wheel weights
included).
- Virginia Dealers: Claim the additional 15% mark-up amount as miscellaneous expense code
"TIREMU".
^ Freight is not reimbursable. (Freight charges will be credited on the dealer's Ford Parts
statement.)
^ Tire disposal will be reimbursed see the Tire Disposal Allowance Attachment II.
^ Dealers may claim any applicable local waste tax - enter OTHER in the miscellaneous expense
area of the claim with the actual cost.
^ Refunds or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page
8490
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS ORDERING INFORMATION
The following part is necessary when changing a tire on a vehicle that is equipped with the optional
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
FORD APPROVED REPLACEMENT TIRE LIST
TIRE ORDERING INFORMATION
^ Tires must be ordered through the Ford Tire Hot Line. Identify the number of tires needed and
use the "05535 Replacement Tire Order Form" to order your tires. (See Attachment IV for the tire
order form.)
^ Tires will begin shipping the week of July 11, 2005
^ Orders will be fulfilled in the order they are received.
^ Ford Tire Hot Line hours are 8AM to 8PM Monday through Friday EST.
TIRE DESTRUCTION / MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
TIRE PRICE
For latest tire prices refer to the Tire Sales Tool on the website.
TIRE DISPOSAL ALLOWANCE
An allowance of $4.00 per tire is being provided for tire disposal. To claim the allowance enter the
dollar amount as "HANDLG" in the "MISC EXPENSE" area of the claim form.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST-REPAIR TORQUE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page
8491
The vehicle Owner's Guide states that each wheel that is removed and reinstalled must have the
wheel nuts re-tightened at 500 miles (800km) after service. This is required to permit the wheel
clamping system to seat correctly so that the wheel nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain
fully tightened. To claim this operation you must file a related damage claim using labor operation
05S35Z. This labor operation includes time to check the torque on all the wheel nuts.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves inspecting all four (4) tires of the vehicle for tread damaged caused by a
piece of metal on the conveyor line during vehicle assembly.
INSPECTION
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
2. Raise the vehicle on a hoist and inspect all four (4) tires for tread damage. See Figure 1.
^ If no tread damage is found, lower the vehicle, turn on the air suspension if equipped, and
release the vehicle.
^ Any tire found to have damaged tread must be replaced. Proceed to Tire Replacement.
TIRE REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page
8492
If the vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS), specific procedures
must be followed to remove and install the tire or damage to the TPMS sensors will occur. Related
damage claims for TPMS sensors will be rejected.
NOTE:
Vehicles equipped with TPMS can be identified by the presence of a metallic valve stem at each
wheel. Vehicles without TPMS will have rubber valve stems.
NOTE:
While the Workshop Repair Manual does not provide actual tire replacement procedures, it does
provide procedures for TPMS sensor removal and installation. To prevent damage to the sensor, it
must be removed and installed during tire removal and installation. Refer to Section 204-04 of the
ONLINE version of the 2006 Model Year Expedition/Navigator Workshop Repair Manual for the
most up-to-date service information available. Again, related damage claims for TPMS sensors will
be rejected.
1.
CAUTION: Do not remove the valve core from TPMS valve stem.
Remove the tire from the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor removal.
2. For vehicles without TPMS, install a new rubber valve stem.
3. Mount the new tire onto the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor installation.
4. Balance the wheel/tire assembly, then install it on the vehicle.
5. Tighten the wheel nuts to 204 Nm (150 lb-ft).
6. Lower the hoist and if equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the ON position.
7. Proceed to Tire Destruction/Mutilation.
TIRE DESTRUCTION/MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST REPAIR RETIGHTEN PROCEDURE
WARNING:
Re-tighten the wheel nuts at 800 km (500 miles) after any wheel change or any time the wheel nuts
are loosened. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
The Owner Guide and workshop repair manual recommend that each wheel removed and
reinstalled must have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 800 km (500 miles) after service. Wheel nut
torque specification is 204 Nm (150 lb-ft). This is required to permit the wheel clamping system to
seat correctly so that the wheel lug nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain fully tightened.
To claim this operation, refer to Attachment II.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page
8493
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page
8494
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page
8495
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page
8496
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > NHTSA05V310000 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection
for Damage
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for Damage
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2006 Lincoln/Navigator 2006
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V310000 MFG'S
REPORT DATE: July 05, 2005
COMPONENT: Tires: Tread/Belt
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 10061
SUMMARY: On certain sport utility vehicles, the front and rear tires on the driver's side of affected
vehicles may have been damaged at the center tread during production.
CONSEQUENCE: Over time, the damage may be sufficient to allow belt corrosion ultimately
leading to a tread separation, which could result in a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect all four tires (to ensure inspection of the left hand side tires that may
have been rotated to the other side of the vehicle) for tire tread damage and, if necessary, replace
the damaged tire. The recall began on July 13, 2005. Owners should contact Ford at
1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 05S35. Please note that this program will expire on December 31, 2005.
Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety
Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns
TSB 08-21-11
10/27/08
4 WHEEL DRIVE/ALL WHEEL DRIVE - WITH CONTROL TRAC - SHUDDER ON
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION OR BINDING ON SLOW TURNS
FORD: 1997-2008 Expedition, Explorer 2006-2008 F-150 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac 2008
F-150
LINCOLN: 1998-2008 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2005 Mountaineer 2006-2008 Mountaineer
ISSUE Various 1997-2008 vehicles equipped with either 4 wheel drive or all wheel drive and
equipped with control trac may exhibit a shudder on acceleration/deceleration, binding in slow
speed turns or noise from the front driveline and/or transfer case. The shudder/binding will occur
with the vehicle being operated in the awd/auto 4x4 mode. The shudder/binding may be due to
incorrect tire circumference or improper tire inflation pressures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS DOES NOT APPLY TO 2006-2008 MOUNTAINEER WITH A 4.0L ENGINE OR 2007-2008
EXPLORER AND SPORT TRAC WITH 20 INCH WHEELS.
NOTE
VEHICLES ON THE LIST MAY REQUIRE REPLACEMENT OF TIRE/S IF THE TIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AVERAGE BETWEEN THE FRONT AND REAR AXLES ARE OUTSIDE OF
THE 1/2 INCH SPECIFICATION OR IF THE TIRE CIRCUMFERENCE FROM SIDE TO SIDE ON
EITHER AXLE EXCEEDS 1/2 INCH DIFFERENCE, THE SMALLER TIRE(S) MUST BE
REPLACED.
NOTE
REVIEW THE WARRANTY AND POLICY MANUAL FOR FORD MOTOR COMPANY TIRE
REPLACEMENT WARRANTY BEFORE PERFORMING THE SERVICE PROCEDURE.
NOTE
ONLY USE REPLACEMENT TIRE AND WHEEL THAT ARE THE SAME SIZE, LOAD INDEX,
SPEED RATING AND TYPE (SUCH AS P-METRIC VERSUS LT-METRIC OR ALL-SEASON
VERSUS ALL-TERRAIN) AS THOSE ORIGINALLY PROVIDED BY FORD. THE
RECOMMENDED TIRE AND WHEEL SIZE MAY BE FOUND ON EITHER THE SAFETY
COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION LABEL OR THE TIRE LABEL WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE
B-PILLAR OR EDGE OF THE DRIVER'S DOOR.
NOTE
ON SOME 4WD MODELS, THE INITIAL SHIFT FROM 2WD TO 4WD WHILE THE VEHICLE IS
MOVING CAN CAUSE A MOMENTARY CLUNK AND/OR BRIEF RATCHETING SOUND. THESE
SOUNDS ARE NORMAL AS THE FRONT DRIVETRAIN COMES UP TO SPEED AND IS NOT
CAUSE FOR CONCERN.
1. Review the tire label for correct tire size and tire inflation pressures located at the B-Pillar of the
driver's door.
2. If the tire size does not match the label, this procedure does not apply, follow normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
3. If the tire size is correct, ensure tire pressures are within specifications.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 8506
4. Raise the vehicle on the hoist, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 100-02.
5. Disconnect all wiring going to the transfer case and road test.
6. Is the shudder/binding present?
a. If the shudder/binding is still present, do not continue with this procedure, continue with WSM
normal diagnostic for 4X4.
b. If the shudder/binding is gone, proceed to Step 7.
7. Raise the vehicle on the hoist and reconnect all the wiring previously disconnected.
8. Using a tailor's tape or flexible measuring tape and measure the circumference of all four (4)
tires and record the measurements. (Figure 1)
9. Calculate the average of the circumference of the two (2) front tires and calculate the average of
the circumference of the two (2) rear tires. (Figure 2)
10. If the difference between these two averages is greater than 1/2" (12.7 mm), front to back or
side to side, replace the smallest circumference tire(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 8507
and remeasure the tire averages. Refer to WSM, Section 204-04 for tire replacement.
NOTE
WARRANTY COVERAGE ELIGIBILITY STARTS WITH 2007 NEW VEHICLE LIMITED
WARRANTY COVERAGE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082111A 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111A 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace TWO Tires. (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace Two (2) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 8508
Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150
Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do
Not Use With 1007A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A195 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection
Technical Service Bulletin # 05S35 Date: 050705
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8514
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED? Yes. OASIS will be activated by July 5, 2005
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? Yes
Available through by July 5, 2005.
Owner names and addresses will be available by July 18, 2005.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states provinces and countries.
Accordingly you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Inspect and if necessary correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TIRE REPLACEMENT GUIDELINES
^ Tires that fail the inspection must be replaced regardless of the mileage or the remaining tread on
the tire.
^ Ford Motor Company will only pay claims for the replacement tires ordered through the Ford Tire
Hotline that are listed in Attachment II under Ford Approved Replacement Tire List. Upgrades to
other brand and size tires are NOT allowed.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8515
^ Some vehicles may be equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Damaged
TPMS sensors are not covered under this program. Follow the instructions in Attachment III to
avoid damaging the TPMS sensor while dismounting the tire from the rim.
^ If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition call
the Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted (excluding the post-repair
wheel nut re-torque procedure - see below).
^ The owner letter will direct customers to the dealer to have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 500
miles (800km) after tire replacement. Dealers are to use the related damage flag to submit claims
for labor operation 05S35Z (post-repair wheel nut re-torque). Approval is not required for this labor
operation. This labor operation may only be claimed once after the original repair has been
completed.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company is offering a refund for owner-paid repairs covered by this recall if the repair
was performed prior to the date indicated in the reimbursement plan which is posted with this
bulletin. This plan is also available to owners through the Customer Relationship Center (CRC).
The CRC will direct owners to seek reimbursement through authorized dealers or at their option
directly through Ford Motor Company at P.O. Box 6251 Dearborn, MI 48121-6251.
^ Dealers are also authorized to refund owner-paid emergency repairs that were performed away
from an authorized servicing dealer after the end date specified in the reimbursement plan. Refund
claims that include other non-covered repairs or those judged by Ford to be excessive will not be
accepted for reimbursement.
^ This safety recall (tire tread inspection) must still be performed, even if the customer has paid for
a previous tire replacement Claiming a refund will not close the recall on this vehicle.
^ Refund Claiming Information (Submit on separate repair line.)
- Program Code: 05S35 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN
- Misc. Expense: REFUND - Misc. Expense: 0.2 Hrs.
RENTAL VEHICLES
Ford Motor Company will pay for a rental vehicle while a replacement tire is on order except for fuel
and insurance which will be at the owner's expense. Follow Extended Service Plan (ESP)
guidelines for rental dollar amounts. Enter the word "RENTAL" plus the number of days the vehicle
was used in the Miscellaneous Expense area of the recall claim form.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Enter each unique DOT code of the "new" replacement tires on the diagnostic code entry screen
in the Powertrain DTC fields. The "old" replaced tire DOT codes should be entered in the Body
DTC fields.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Enter the full part number of the replacement tire with the quantity of tires replaced. Tires will be
reimbursed at AtW Dealer cost +25% (mounting balancing valve stems and wheel weights
included).
- Virginia Dealers: Claim the additional 15% mark-up amount as miscellaneous expense code
"TIREMU".
^ Freight is not reimbursable. (Freight charges will be credited on the dealer's Ford Parts
statement.)
^ Tire disposal will be reimbursed see the Tire Disposal Allowance Attachment II.
^ Dealers may claim any applicable local waste tax - enter OTHER in the miscellaneous expense
area of the claim with the actual cost.
^ Refunds or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8516
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS ORDERING INFORMATION
The following part is necessary when changing a tire on a vehicle that is equipped with the optional
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
FORD APPROVED REPLACEMENT TIRE LIST
TIRE ORDERING INFORMATION
^ Tires must be ordered through the Ford Tire Hot Line. Identify the number of tires needed and
use the "05535 Replacement Tire Order Form" to order your tires. (See Attachment IV for the tire
order form.)
^ Tires will begin shipping the week of July 11, 2005
^ Orders will be fulfilled in the order they are received.
^ Ford Tire Hot Line hours are 8AM to 8PM Monday through Friday EST.
TIRE DESTRUCTION / MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
TIRE PRICE
For latest tire prices refer to the Tire Sales Tool on the website.
TIRE DISPOSAL ALLOWANCE
An allowance of $4.00 per tire is being provided for tire disposal. To claim the allowance enter the
dollar amount as "HANDLG" in the "MISC EXPENSE" area of the claim form.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST-REPAIR TORQUE PROCEDURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8517
The vehicle Owner's Guide states that each wheel that is removed and reinstalled must have the
wheel nuts re-tightened at 500 miles (800km) after service. This is required to permit the wheel
clamping system to seat correctly so that the wheel nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain
fully tightened. To claim this operation you must file a related damage claim using labor operation
05S35Z. This labor operation includes time to check the torque on all the wheel nuts.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves inspecting all four (4) tires of the vehicle for tread damaged caused by a
piece of metal on the conveyor line during vehicle assembly.
INSPECTION
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
2. Raise the vehicle on a hoist and inspect all four (4) tires for tread damage. See Figure 1.
^ If no tread damage is found, lower the vehicle, turn on the air suspension if equipped, and
release the vehicle.
^ Any tire found to have damaged tread must be replaced. Proceed to Tire Replacement.
TIRE REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8518
If the vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS), specific procedures
must be followed to remove and install the tire or damage to the TPMS sensors will occur. Related
damage claims for TPMS sensors will be rejected.
NOTE:
Vehicles equipped with TPMS can be identified by the presence of a metallic valve stem at each
wheel. Vehicles without TPMS will have rubber valve stems.
NOTE:
While the Workshop Repair Manual does not provide actual tire replacement procedures, it does
provide procedures for TPMS sensor removal and installation. To prevent damage to the sensor, it
must be removed and installed during tire removal and installation. Refer to Section 204-04 of the
ONLINE version of the 2006 Model Year Expedition/Navigator Workshop Repair Manual for the
most up-to-date service information available. Again, related damage claims for TPMS sensors will
be rejected.
1.
CAUTION: Do not remove the valve core from TPMS valve stem.
Remove the tire from the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor removal.
2. For vehicles without TPMS, install a new rubber valve stem.
3. Mount the new tire onto the wheel. If the vehicle is equipped with TPMS, refer to the Workshop
Repair Manual for special instructions regarding the TPMS sensor installation.
4. Balance the wheel/tire assembly, then install it on the vehicle.
5. Tighten the wheel nuts to 204 Nm (150 lb-ft).
6. Lower the hoist and if equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the ON position.
7. Proceed to Tire Destruction/Mutilation.
TIRE DESTRUCTION/MUTILATION
Tires removed from vehicles must immediately be made unusable by either cutting the bead with
bolt cutters or drilling a one-inch diameter hole through the sidewall.
SPECIAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR POST REPAIR RETIGHTEN PROCEDURE
WARNING:
Re-tighten the wheel nuts at 800 km (500 miles) after any wheel change or any time the wheel nuts
are loosened. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
The Owner Guide and workshop repair manual recommend that each wheel removed and
reinstalled must have the wheel nuts re-tightened at 800 km (500 miles) after service. Wheel nut
torque specification is 204 Nm (150 lb-ft). This is required to permit the wheel clamping system to
seat correctly so that the wheel lug nuts will hold a uniform clamp load and remain fully tightened.
To claim this operation, refer to Attachment II.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8519
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8520
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8521
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05S35 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection > Page 8522
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > NHTSA05V310000 > Jul > 05 > Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for
Damage
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall - Tire Tread Inspection for Damage
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2006 Lincoln/Navigator 2006
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V310000 MFG'S
REPORT DATE: July 05, 2005
COMPONENT: Tires: Tread/Belt
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 10061
SUMMARY: On certain sport utility vehicles, the front and rear tires on the driver's side of affected
vehicles may have been damaged at the center tread during production.
CONSEQUENCE: Over time, the damage may be sufficient to allow belt corrosion ultimately
leading to a tread separation, which could result in a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect all four tires (to ensure inspection of the left hand side tires that may
have been rotated to the other side of the vehicle) for tire tread damage and, if necessary, replace
the damaged tire. The recall began on July 13, 2005. Owners should contact Ford at
1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 05S35. Please note that this program will expire on December 31, 2005.
Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety
Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS
High Temperature 4x4 Front Axle & Wheel Bearing Grease
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
...................................................... E8TZ-19590-A Ford Specification ................................................
................................................................................................................................... ESA-M1C198-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 8530
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist.
3. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the rear halfshaft nut and washer. ^
To install, tighten to 300 Nm (221 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 8531
4. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV Joint from the wheel hub.
5. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.).
6. Remove the brake disc.
7. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector and detach the wheel speed sensor
harness from the retainer.
8. Remove the bolt and detach the harness from the retainers. To install, tighten the bolt to 15 Nm
(11 ft. lbs.). 9. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and hub assembly bolts, the wheel bearing assembly
and the wheel speed sensor as an assembly.
^ Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake shield.
^ Discard the bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 ft. lbs.).
10. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and hub assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information
> Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front axle nut .......................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 27 Nm (20 ft.lbs.) Rear axle wheel hub retainer ...........................
...................................................................................................................................... 345 Nm (254
ft.lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8539
C1157
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Tighten the wheel nuts, using the pattern indicated, to
............................................................................................................. 204 Nm (150 ft. lbs.).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 8543
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair
Wheel Studs
Special Tools
Removal
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub assembly.
2. CAUTION: Never use a hammer to remove a wheel stud.
Damage to the wheel hub can result. ^
Place the wheel hub in a soft jawed vice and, using the special tool, remove the wheel stud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 8544
Installation
1. Position the new wheel stud in the wheel bearing and hub assembly, aligning the serrations in
the wheel hub flange made by the original wheel
stud.
2. CAUTION: Do not use power tools to install the wheel stud. The serrations on the flange can be
stripped.
NOTE: Do not use the wheel nut that came with the vehicle.
Install 4 washers and a wheel nut on the wheel stud and tighten the wheel nut until the stud seats
against the flange.
3. Remove the wheel nut and washers.
^ Discard the wheel nut.
4. Install the wheel bearing and wheel hub assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Temperature Blend Door Actuator, Driver
View 151-33 (Climate Control System)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Temperature Blend Door Actuator, Driver > Page 8551
View 151-33 (Climate Control System)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Temperature Blend Door Actuator, Driver > Page 8552
View 151-33 (Climate Control System)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Temperature Blend Door Actuator, Driver > Page 8553
View 151-34 (Auxiliary Climate Control)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Temperature Blend Door Actuator, Driver > Page 8554
View 151-34 (Auxiliary Climate Control)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Blend Door Actuator, Rear
C3004
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Blend Door Actuator, Rear > Page 8557
C2091
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Blend Door Actuator, Rear > Page 8558
C2092
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Blend Door Actuator, Rear > Page 8559
C3044
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Blend Door Actuator, Rear > Page 8560
C289
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator
Air Distribution
AUXILIARY TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - AIR DISTRIBUTION
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel cup holder and access panel.
2. Remove the 3 auxiliary actuator screws.
3. Disconnect the auxiliary actuator electrical connector. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Temperature
AUXILIARY TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - TEMPERATURE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator > Page 8563
2. Remove the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator.
1 Disconnect the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
2 Remove the 4 auxiliary temperature blend door actuator screws.
3 Remove the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator > Page 8564
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Temperature Blend Door Actuator
RH
TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - RH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel. Refer to: Body and Frame, Interior Moulding,
Dashboard/Instrument Panel, Service and Repair, Instrument Panel,
See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel
2. Disconnect the RH temperature blend door actuator electrical connector. 3. Remove the 3 RH
temperature blend door actuator screws. 4. Remove the RH temperature blend door actuator. 5. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
LH
TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - LH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator > Page 8565
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the 3 floor duct screws. 3.
Remove the floor duct. 4. Disconnect the LH temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
5. Remove the 3 LH temperature blend door actuator screws. 6. Remove the LH temperature blend
door actuator. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator > Page 8566
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Vacuum Control Motor
Air Inlet Door
VACUUM CONTROL MOTOR - AIR INLET DOOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel. Refer to: Body and Frame, Interior Moulding/Trim,
Dashboard/Instrument Panel, Service and Repair, Instrument
Panel, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel
2. Disconnect the air inlet door vacuum control motor vacuum connector. 3. Remove the 2 air inlet
door vacuum control motor screws. 4. Remove the air inlet door vacuum control motor. 5. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Floor Defrost Door
VACUUM CONTROL MOTOR - FLOOR DEFROST DOOR
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator > Page 8567
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the bolts and position the accelerator pedal aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
2. Disconnect the floor/defrost door vacuum control motor vacuum connector. 3. Remove the 2
floor/defrost door vacuum control motor screws. 4. Rotate the floor/defrost door vacuum control
motor until it clears the retaining arm and remove. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Panel Door
VACUUM CONTROL MOTOR - PANEL DOOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel. Refer to: Body and Frame, Interior Moulding/Trim,
Dashboard/Instrument Panel, Service and Repair, Instrument
Panel, See: Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel
2. Disconnect the panel door vacuum control motor vacuum connector. 3. Remove the 2 panel
door vacuum control motor screws. 4. Rotate the panel door vacuum control motor until it clears
the retaining arm and remove. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair > Floor
Duct
Air Duct: Service and Repair Floor Duct
FLOOR DUCT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the 3 floor duct screws. 3.
Remove the floor duct. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair > Floor
Duct > Page 8572
Air Duct: Service and Repair Footwell Duct - Rear
FOOTWELL DUCT - REAR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front seats. 2. Remove the center floor console.
3. NOTE: RH cowl trim and sill plate shown, LH similar.
Remove the RH and LH cowl trim panel and sill plates.
4. Fold back the carpet to completely uncover the rear footwell duct.
5. Remove the pin-type retainers and remove the duct. 6. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Register: Service and Repair
REGISTER
Removal and Installation
1. Fabricate a removal tool from a 3.175 mm (0.12 in) diameter rod.
2. Rotate the register with the removal tool to align the retaining ears with the clearance openings
and remove the register. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8579
C132
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8580
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8581
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Remove the upper radiator sight shield.
All vehicles
2. Detach and disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the
ambient air temperature sensor. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component Information
> Locations
View 151-34 (Auxiliary Climate Control)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component Information
> Locations > Page 8586
C4106
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component Information
> Locations > Page 8587
Auxiliary Blower Motor: Service and Repair
AUXILIARY BLOWER MOTOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the blower motor.
1 Disconnect the blower motor electrical connector.
2 Remove the 4 blower motor screws.
3 Remove the blower motor.
3. Remove the blower motor wheel
1 Remove the push clip.
2 Remove the blower motor wheel.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Locations Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8592
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8593
Blower Motor Relay: Locations Rear Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8594
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Blower Motor Relay
C2216
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8597
C4075
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8600
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8601
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor Assembly
View 151-34 (Auxiliary Climate Control)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor Assembly > Page 8607
View 151-33 (Climate Control System)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Blower Motor Resistor
C2185
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Blower Motor Resistor > Page 8610
C4107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Resistor
Blower Motor Resistor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Resistor > Page 8613
Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 8614
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair
AUXILIARY BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel access panel.
2. Remove the blower motor resistor.
1 Disconnect the blower motor resistor electrical connector.
2 Remove the 2 blower motor resistor screws and the blower motor resistor.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Blower Motor Switch
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the climate control assembly. 2. Pull and remove the blower motor switch knob. 3.
Release the 3 clips and remove the blower motor switch. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Blower Motor Switch > Page 8619
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Speed Control
BLOWER MOTOR SPEED CONTROL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator. 2. Disconnect the blower motor speed control
electrical connector. 3. Remove the blower motor speed control screw. 4. Remove the blower
motor speed control. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cabin Air Filter: Service and Repair
NOTE: The air distribution system of this vehicle cannot be equipped with a cabin air filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
C233
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor > Page 8628
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 8629
In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Disconnect the aspirator hose and the in-vehicle
temperature sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor screws. 4.
Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor > Page 8632
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity
Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor trim cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector and aspirator tube.
2. Remove the 2 in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor screws. 3. Remove the in-vehicle
temperature and humidity sensor. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Compressor Clutch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
Compressor Clutch: Customer Interest A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Compressor Clutch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C Inoperative/Blows Warm Air > Page 8642
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 >
A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
Compressor Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 >
A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air > Page 8648
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8649
Compressor Clutch: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Magnetic Clutch
Air gap clearance..................................................................................................................................
...................................0.35-0.75 mm (0.014-0.030 in)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8650
Compressor Clutch: Adjustments
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH AIR GAP ADJUSTMENT
1. Check the A/C clutch air gap at 3 equally spaced places between the clutch plate and the A/C
clutch pulley. 2. If the A/C clutch air gap is out of range, remove the clutch plate. Add or remove
spacers between the clutch plate hub and the compressor shaft
until the clearance is within specification.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8651
Compressor Clutch: Service and Repair
CLUTCH AND CLUTCH FIELD COIL
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. Remove the A/C compressor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8652
2. Remove the A/C clutch disc and hub nut.
1 Using the special tool, hold the A/C clutch disc and hub.
2 Remove the A/C clutch disc and hub nut.
3. Remove the A/C compressor pulley snap ring.
4. CAUTION: Do not use air tools. Damage to the A/C clutch pulley or A/C compressor may result.
Using the special tool, remove the A/C clutch pulley.
5. Remove the A/C clutch field coil snap ring. 6. Remove the A/C clutch field coil.
Installation
NOTE: The A/C clutch components should be reused unless obvious signs of damage are found. If
excessive grooving is found, a new A/C clutch disc and hub and a new A/C compressor pulley
must be installed together. Otherwise, each component can be installed individually where needed.
1. Visually inspect the A/C clutch disc and hub, A/C compressor pulley and A/C clutch field coil for
damage.
- Inspect for physical damage, including cracked or melted components or discoloration due to
excessive heat.
- Inspect for excessive wear, including grooving in the A/C clutch disc and hub or A/C compressor
pulley that is more than fingernail depth.
- Inspect for roughness in the A/C compressor pulley bearing.
2. Clean the A/C clutch field coil and pulley mounting surfaces. 3. Install the A/C clutch field coil.
4. NOTE: The A/C compressor pulley is a tight fit on the A/C compressor. It must be correctly
aligned during installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8653
Install the A/C compressor pulley. 1
Install the special tool.
2 Install the A/C compressor pulley.
5. Install the A/C compressor pulley snap ring with the bevel side out. 6. Place one nominal
thickness A/C clutch disc and hub spacer inside the clutch hub spline opening. 7. Install the A/C
clutch disc and hub.
8. Using the special tool, install the A/C compressor clutch disc and hub nut.
1 Hold the A/C clutch disc and hub with the special tool.
2 Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
9. Measure and adjust the clutch air gap by removing or adding A/C clutch disc and hub spacers.
10. Install the A/C compressor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
Compressor Clutch Coil: Customer Interest A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air >
Page 8662
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows
Warm Air
Compressor Clutch Coil: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows
Warm Air > Page 8668
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Coil: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
Seat Belt Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder'
Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Coil: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 8674
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Coil: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 8680
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8681
C100
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8682
Compressor Clutch Coil: Service and Repair
CLUTCH AND CLUTCH FIELD COIL
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. Remove the A/C compressor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8683
2. Remove the A/C clutch disc and hub nut.
1 Using the special tool, hold the A/C clutch disc and hub.
2 Remove the A/C clutch disc and hub nut.
3. Remove the A/C compressor pulley snap ring.
4. CAUTION: Do not use air tools. Damage to the A/C clutch pulley or A/C compressor may result.
Using the special tool, remove the A/C clutch pulley.
5. Remove the A/C clutch field coil snap ring. 6. Remove the A/C clutch field coil.
Installation
NOTE: The A/C clutch components should be reused unless obvious signs of damage are found. If
excessive grooving is found, a new A/C clutch disc and hub and a new A/C compressor pulley
must be installed together. Otherwise, each component can be installed individually where needed.
1. Visually inspect the A/C clutch disc and hub, A/C compressor pulley and A/C clutch field coil for
damage.
- Inspect for physical damage, including cracked or melted components or discoloration due to
excessive heat.
- Inspect for excessive wear, including grooving in the A/C clutch disc and hub or A/C compressor
pulley that is more than fingernail depth.
- Inspect for roughness in the A/C compressor pulley bearing.
2. Clean the A/C clutch field coil and pulley mounting surfaces. 3. Install the A/C clutch field coil.
4. NOTE: The A/C compressor pulley is a tight fit on the A/C compressor. It must be correctly
aligned during installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8684
Install the A/C compressor pulley. 1
Install the special tool.
2 Install the A/C compressor pulley.
5. Install the A/C compressor pulley snap ring with the bevel side out. 6. Place one nominal
thickness A/C clutch disc and hub spacer inside the clutch hub spline opening. 7. Install the A/C
clutch disc and hub.
8. Using the special tool, install the A/C compressor clutch disc and hub nut.
1 Hold the A/C clutch disc and hub with the special tool.
2 Tighten the nut to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
9. Measure and adjust the clutch air gap by removing or adding A/C clutch disc and hub spacers.
10. Install the A/C compressor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
Compressor Clutch Hub: Customer Interest A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C Inoperative/Blows Warm Air > Page 8693
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08
> A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
Compressor Clutch Hub: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08
> A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air > Page 8699
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Pulley > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Compressor Pulley: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
Compressor Pulley: Customer Interest A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Pulley > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Compressor Pulley: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C Inoperative/Blows Warm Air > Page 8708
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Pulley > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 >
A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
Compressor Pulley: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Pulley > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 >
A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air > Page 8714
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Diode HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams
C1086
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 8721
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 8722
C1008
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 8723
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH RELAY (A/CCR)
NOTE: The PCM PIDs WAC and wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WACF) are used to
monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR (may be referred to as the wide open throttle A/C cutoff [WAC] relay) is wired normally
open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch or EATC module and the A/C
clutch. The PCM receives a signal indicating that A/C is requested (for some applications, this
message is sent through the communications network). When A/C is requested, the PCM will
check other A/C related inputs that are available (such as ACPSW, ACCS). If these inputs indicate
A/C operation is OK, and the engine conditions are OK (such as coolant temperature, engine RPM,
throttle position), the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending
voltage to the A/CC.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 8724
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 8725
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Condenser HVAC: Testing and Inspection
A/C EVAPORATOR/CONDENSER CORE - ON VEHICLE LEAK TEST
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. NOTE: DO NOT leak test an A/C evaporator core with the suction accumulator/drier attached to
the core tubes.
Disconnect the suspect A/C evaporator core or A/C condenser core from the A/C system.
3. Clean the spring lock couplings. 4. Connect the appropriate test fittings from the R-12/R-134a Air
Conditioning Test Fitting Set to the evaporator or condenser tube connections.
5. NOTE: The automatic shut-off valves on some gauge set hoses do not open when connected to
the test fittings. If available, use hoses without
shut-off valves. If hoses with shut-off valves are used, make sure the valve opens when attached to
the test fittings or install an adapter which will activate the valve. The test is not valid if the shut-off
valve does not open.
Connect the red and blue hoses from the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set to the test fittings on the A/C
evaporator core or A/C condenser core. Connect the yellow hose to a known good vacuum pump.
6. Open both gauge set valves and start the vacuum pump. Allow the vacuum pump to operate for
a minimum of 45 minutes after the gauge set low
pressure gauge indicates 101 kPa (30 in-Hg). The 45 minute evacuation is necessary to remove
any refrigerant from oil left in the A/C evaporator core or A/C condenser core. If the refrigerant is
not completely removed from the oil, outgassing will degrade the vacuum and appear as a
refrigerant leak.
7. If the low pressure gauge reading will not drop to 101 kPa (30 in-Hg) when the valves on the
gauge and manifold set are open and the vacuum
pump is operating, close the gauge set valves and observe the low pressure gauge. If the pressure
rises rapidly to zero, a large leak is indicated. Recheck the test fitting connections and gauge set
connections before replacing the A/C evaporator core or A/C condenser core.
8. After evacuating for 45 minutes, close the gauge set valves and stop the vacuum pump.
Observe the low pressure gauge; it should remain at the
101 kPa (30 in-Hg) mark. If the low pressure gauge reading rises 34 or more kPa (10 or more in-Hg) of vacuum from the 101
kPa (30 in-Hg) position in 10 minutes, a leak is indicated.
- If a very small leak is suspected, wait 30 minutes and observe the vacuum gauge.
- If a small amount of vacuum is lost, operate the vacuum pump with gauge valves open for an
additional 30 minutes to remove any remaining refrigerant from the oil in the A/C evaporator core or
A/C condenser core. Then recheck for loss of vacuum.
- If a very small leak is suspected, allow the system to set overnight with vacuum applied and
check for vacuum loss.
9. If the A/C evaporator core or A/C condenser core does leak, as verified by the above procedure,
install a new A/C evaporator core or A/C
condenser core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 8729
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair
CONDENSER CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the upper radiator sight shield. 3. Remove the 2 condenser
fitting nuts and disconnect the condenser fittings.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. Remove the 2 radiator bracket bolts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
5. Remove the 2 radiator brackets. 6. Remove the 2 condenser bracket bolts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
7. Remove the 2 condenser brackets.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 8730
8. Remove the condenser core. 9. If a new condenser core is to be installed, transfer the air
deflectors from the old unit to the new unit.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
11. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Function Selector Switch Assembly, Front
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Function Selector Switch Assembly, Front > Page 8735
View 151-24 (Center Console)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Function Selector Switch Assembly, Front > Page 8736
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Function Selector Switch Assembly, Front > Page 8737
View 151-33 (Climate Control System)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Control Assembly: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8740
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8741
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8742
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8743
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8744
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8745
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8746
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8747
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8748
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8749
Control Assembly: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8750
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8751
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8752
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8753
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8754
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8755
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8756
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8757
Control Assembly: Connector Views
C294a
C294b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8758
C294c
C297
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8759
C989a
C989b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8760
C3198a
C3198b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Function Selector Switch
Function Selector Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Function Selector Switch > Page 8763
Front Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Function Selector Switch > Page 8764
Rear Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly
Control Assembly: Service and Repair Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly
Front
AUXILIARY CLIMATE CONTROL ASSEMBLY - FRONT
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. NOTE: Vehicle with moonroof shown, vehicle without moonroof similar.
Disengage the clips and remove the overhead console. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly > Page 8767
Vehicles with moonroof
2. Remove the 4 map light screws. 3. Remove the 2 map lights.
All vehicles
4. NOTE: Vehicle with moonroof shown, vehicle without moonroof similar.
Remove the 2 front auxiliary climate control assembly screws.
5. Remove the front auxiliary climate control assembly. 6. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Rear
AUXILIARY CLIMATE CONTROL ASSEMBLY - REAR
Removal and Installation
Navigator
1. Open the front floor console cover. 2. Remove the 2 floor console finish panel front screws. 3.
Open the rear cup holder and remove the floor console finish panel rear screw.
All vehicles
4. NOTE: Navigator shown, Expedition similar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly > Page 8768
Disengage the clips and remove the floor console finish panel. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
5. Remove the 4 rear auxiliary climate control assembly screws. 6. Remove the rear auxiliary
climate control assembly. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly > Page 8769
Control Assembly: Service and Repair Climate Control Assembly
CLIMATE CONTROL ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Remove the 4 climate control assembly screws. 3.
Remove the climate control assembly. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly > Page 8770
Control Assembly: Service and Repair Function Selector Switch
FUNCTION SELECTOR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the climate control assembly. 2. Pull and remove the function selector switch knob. 3.
Release the 2 clips and remove the function selector switch. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 8774
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams
C228a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 8775
C228b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Spring Lock Coupling
Coupler HVAC: Service and Repair Spring Lock Coupling
SPRING LOCK COUPLING
Remover, Refrigerant Coupling Spring
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect
1. Remove the spring lock coupling clip, if equipped.
2. CAUTION: Do not use metal tools to remove the O-ring seals. They can cause axial scratches
across the O-ring seal grooves, resulting in
refrigerant leaks.
Push the tool into the cage opening to release the female fitting from the spring lock coupling
spring and pull the fitting apart. Remove the O-ring seals using a non-metallic tool.
3. CAUTION: Do not use a screwdriver or similar tool to remove the A/C tube lock coupling spring;
this can cause axial scratches across
the O-ring seal grooves resulting in refrigerant leaks.
Remove the spring lock coupling spring with a small hooked wire.
Cleaning
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Spring Lock Coupling > Page 8780
1. Fabricate a cleaning tool from a 1/8 inch diameter brazing rod.
2. Cut an abrasive pad from maroon colored 3M Scotch Brite(R) with the dimensions
corresponding to the coupling size.
3. Assemble the pad to the tool. 4. Coat the abrasive pad with mineral oil. 5. Roll the pad on the
tool and install it in a variable speed drill motor.
6. CAUTION: Maintain low speed drill rotation when inserting or removing the cleaning tool to
prevent axial scratches which may cause
future leaks.
Polish for one minute at moderate speed (less than 1,500 rpm) or until the surface is clean and free
of scratches or foreign material.
7. Clean the fitting with a lint-free cloth. 8. Inspect the surface for grooves or scratches. If grooves
and scratches are still present, install a new component.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Spring Lock Coupling > Page 8781
9. Clean the O-ring seal grooves with a 300 mm (12 inch) length of natural fiber string.
- Loop the string around the grooves and pull the string back and forth.
10. Remove any foreign material from the grooves with a lint-free cloth.
Connect
1. Install the spring lock coupling spring.
2. Lubricate the inside of the coupling with PAG oil.
3. CAUTION: Use only the new O-ring seals. The use of any O-ring seals other than those
specified in the Ford Master Parts Catalog may
result in intermittent leakage during vehicle operation.
Install the O-ring seals. Lubricate the O-ring seals with mineral oil.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Spring Lock Coupling > Page 8782
4. Connect the spring lock coupling fittings with a twisting motion until the spring lock coupling
spring snaps over the flared end of the female
fitting.
5. Install the spring lock coupling clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Spring Lock Coupling > Page 8783
Coupler HVAC: Service and Repair Air Conditioning Line (Peanut) Fitting
AIR CONDITIONING LINE (PEANUT) FITTING
Disconnect
1. CAUTION: Support the female fitting with a wrench to prevent the tubes from twisting.
Remove the nut and separate the 2 halves of the peanut fitting.
2. CAUTION: Do not use metal tools to remove the O-ring seal. They can cause axial scratches
across the O-ring seal groove, resulting in
refrigerant leaks.
Remove the O-ring seal with a non-metallic tool.
Connect
1. Clean all dirt or foreign material from the fittings.
2. CAUTION: Use only the new O-ring seals. The use of any O-ring seals other than those
specified in the Ford Master Parts Catalog may
result in intermittent leakage during vehicle operation.
Install the O-ring seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Spring Lock Coupling > Page 8784
3. NOTE: When correctly assembled, the male and female fittings should be flush.
Assemble the male and female fittings together.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Evaporator Core: Testing and Inspection
A/C EVAPORATOR/CONDENSER CORE - ON VEHICLE LEAK TEST
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. NOTE: DO NOT leak test an A/C evaporator core with the suction accumulator/drier attached to
the core tubes.
Disconnect the suspect A/C evaporator core or A/C condenser core from the A/C system.
3. Clean the spring lock couplings. 4. Connect the appropriate test fittings from the R-12/R-134a Air
Conditioning Test Fitting Set to the evaporator or condenser tube connections.
5. NOTE: The automatic shut-off valves on some gauge set hoses do not open when connected to
the test fittings. If available, use hoses without
shut-off valves. If hoses with shut-off valves are used, make sure the valve opens when attached to
the test fittings or install an adapter which will activate the valve. The test is not valid if the shut-off
valve does not open.
Connect the red and blue hoses from the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set to the test fittings on the A/C
evaporator core or A/C condenser core. Connect the yellow hose to a known good vacuum pump.
6. Open both gauge set valves and start the vacuum pump. Allow the vacuum pump to operate for
a minimum of 45 minutes after the gauge set low
pressure gauge indicates 101 kPa (30 in-Hg). The 45 minute evacuation is necessary to remove
any refrigerant from oil left in the A/C evaporator core or A/C condenser core. If the refrigerant is
not completely removed from the oil, outgassing will degrade the vacuum and appear as a
refrigerant leak.
7. If the low pressure gauge reading will not drop to 101 kPa (30 in-Hg) when the valves on the
gauge and manifold set are open and the vacuum
pump is operating, close the gauge set valves and observe the low pressure gauge. If the pressure
rises rapidly to zero, a large leak is indicated. Recheck the test fitting connections and gauge set
connections before replacing the A/C evaporator core or A/C condenser core.
8. After evacuating for 45 minutes, close the gauge set valves and stop the vacuum pump.
Observe the low pressure gauge; it should remain at the
101 kPa (30 in-Hg) mark. If the low pressure gauge reading rises 34 or more kPa (10 or more in-Hg) of vacuum from the 101
kPa (30 in-Hg) position in 10 minutes, a leak is indicated.
- If a very small leak is suspected, wait 30 minutes and observe the vacuum gauge.
- If a small amount of vacuum is lost, operate the vacuum pump with gauge valves open for an
additional 30 minutes to remove any remaining refrigerant from the oil in the A/C evaporator core or
A/C condenser core. Then recheck for loss of vacuum.
- If a very small leak is suspected, allow the system to set overnight with vacuum applied and
check for vacuum loss.
9. If the A/C evaporator core or A/C condenser core does leak, as verified by the above procedure,
install a new A/C evaporator core or A/C
condenser core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Evaporator Core
EVAPORATOR CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator core must be vacuum leak tested before it
is removed from the vehicle.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
- A new evaporator core seal is supplied as a kit with the evaporator core service part. Failure to
install this seal, or failure to install it correctly, will result in air bypassing the evaporator core and
loss of cooling efficiency.
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing.
2. Remove the dash panel seal. 3. Detach the wire harness from the evaporator core cover.
4. Disconnect the air inlet vacuum control motor vacuum connector.
5. Remove the screws and detach the blower motor resistor or blower motor speed control and
wire harness from the plenum chamber.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core > Page 8790
6. Remove the 4 bottom evaporator core cover screws.
7. Remove the screws and position the heater core cover aside.
8. Remove the 5 upper evaporator core cover screws.
9. Remove the remaining upper evaporator core cover screws and the evaporator core cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core > Page 8791
10. Remove the evaporator core. 11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core > Page 8792
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Evaporator Core
AUXILIARY EVAPORATOR CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator core must be vacuum leak tested before it
is removed from the vehicle.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
1. Remove the auxiliary climate control housing.
2. Disconnect the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) fittings and remove the TXV.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
3. Remove the screws and the evaporator/heater core access cover. 4. Remove the evaporator
core. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Drain Tube: > 05-20-7 > Oct > 05 > A/C - Water Leaks Onto
Passenger Front Floor
Evaporator Drain Tube: Customer Interest A/C - Water Leaks Onto Passenger Front Floor
TSB 05-20-7
10/17/05
A/C CONDENSATION LEAKING ONTO THE PASSENGER FRONT FLOOR
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit water leaking on to the
passenger floor from the NC plenum drain tube area.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to determine if the water leak is from the air
conditioning drain tube and repair as necessary.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn off air suspension, if equipped.
2. Verify the leak is from the HVAC case drain seal and not from another source. Pull back the
carpet on the passenger floorboard and feel the HVAC drain tube seal for water (Figure 1A-1B).
a. If signs of water or moisture are present continue on with the TSB.
b. If there are no signs of water or moisture at the drain tube seal, follow normal diagnosis and
repair procedures.
3. Expedition only: Open hood and remove transmission dip stick.
4. Navigator only: Use Message Center to position running boards in the extended position (out
setting). Refer to Owners Guide, drivers control
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Drain Tube: > 05-20-7 > Oct > 05 > A/C - Water Leaks Onto
Passenger Front Floor > Page 8801
section for more information.
5. Remove the right front wheel following Workshop Manual, Section 204-04 procedure.
6. Remove right front fender splash shield.
7. Expedition only: Remove transmission dipstick tube from vehicle.
8. Pull back the engine compartment dash panel insulator far enough to expose the HVAC drain
tube (Figure 2B) by removing the push pin to the right of the drain (Figure 2A).
9. Push elbow (P/N F3LY-6A614-A) onto drain tube to install. Make sure the short end of the elbow
is pushed onto the drain tube, and the long end is pointed straight down (Figure 3). Only water may
be used to aid in pushing the elbow onto the drain tube. (Do not use soap or petroleum products on
the elbow).
10. Re-seat the engine compartment dash panel insulator and replace the push pin.
11. Expedition only: Install transmission dipstick and tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Drain Tube: > 05-20-7 > Oct > 05 > A/C - Water Leaks Onto
Passenger Front Floor > Page 8802
12. Verify the repair by ensuring condensation is dripping outside the vehicle and not running inside
onto the passenger floorboard.
13. Replace the right front fender splash shield and wheel.
14. Turn air suspension back on, if equipped.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052007A 2005-2006 Expedition: 0.9 Hr
Install Extension On Evaporator Drain (Do not use with 7228A)
052007B 2005-2006 Navigator: 0.7 Hr
Install Extension On Evaporator Drain (Do not use with 7228A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19B739 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Drain Tube: > 05-20-7 > Oct > 05 > A/C - Water Leaks
Onto Passenger Front Floor
Evaporator Drain Tube: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Water Leaks Onto Passenger Front
Floor
TSB 05-20-7
10/17/05
A/C CONDENSATION LEAKING ONTO THE PASSENGER FRONT FLOOR
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit water leaking on to the
passenger floor from the NC plenum drain tube area.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to determine if the water leak is from the air
conditioning drain tube and repair as necessary.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn off air suspension, if equipped.
2. Verify the leak is from the HVAC case drain seal and not from another source. Pull back the
carpet on the passenger floorboard and feel the HVAC drain tube seal for water (Figure 1A-1B).
a. If signs of water or moisture are present continue on with the TSB.
b. If there are no signs of water or moisture at the drain tube seal, follow normal diagnosis and
repair procedures.
3. Expedition only: Open hood and remove transmission dip stick.
4. Navigator only: Use Message Center to position running boards in the extended position (out
setting). Refer to Owners Guide, drivers control
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Drain Tube: > 05-20-7 > Oct > 05 > A/C - Water Leaks
Onto Passenger Front Floor > Page 8808
section for more information.
5. Remove the right front wheel following Workshop Manual, Section 204-04 procedure.
6. Remove right front fender splash shield.
7. Expedition only: Remove transmission dipstick tube from vehicle.
8. Pull back the engine compartment dash panel insulator far enough to expose the HVAC drain
tube (Figure 2B) by removing the push pin to the right of the drain (Figure 2A).
9. Push elbow (P/N F3LY-6A614-A) onto drain tube to install. Make sure the short end of the elbow
is pushed onto the drain tube, and the long end is pointed straight down (Figure 3). Only water may
be used to aid in pushing the elbow onto the drain tube. (Do not use soap or petroleum products on
the elbow).
10. Re-seat the engine compartment dash panel insulator and replace the push pin.
11. Expedition only: Install transmission dipstick and tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Drain Tube: > 05-20-7 > Oct > 05 > A/C - Water Leaks
Onto Passenger Front Floor > Page 8809
12. Verify the repair by ensuring condensation is dripping outside the vehicle and not running inside
onto the passenger floorboard.
13. Replace the right front fender splash shield and wheel.
14. Turn air suspension back on, if equipped.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052007A 2005-2006 Expedition: 0.9 Hr
Install Extension On Evaporator Drain (Do not use with 7228A)
052007B 2005-2006 Navigator: 0.7 Hr
Install Extension On Evaporator Drain (Do not use with 7228A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19B739 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE (ACET) SENSOR
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling, improve defrost/demist
performance, and reduce A/C clutch cycling.
NOTE: These values can vary 15 percent due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 8813
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) EVAPORATOR DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Lower the glove compartment. 2. Remove the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor
screw. 3. Disconnect the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor electrical connector.
4. Carefully pry the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor probe out of the heater core and
evaporator core housing. 5. Remove the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor. 6. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Expansion Valve: > 06-10-4 > May > 06 > A/C - Rear A/C Hoot/Whistle Noise
Expansion Valve: Customer Interest A/C - Rear A/C Hoot/Whistle Noise
TSB 06-10-4
05/29/06
HOOT OR WHISTLE NOISE FROM REAR A/C SYSTEM
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-21-1 to add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles built before 1/30/2006 may exhibit a hoot or
whistle noise inside the passenger compartment, coming from the rear auxiliary A/C system. The
noise will most likely be heard by the customer when driving the vehicle with the interior cooled
down, the rear A/C off, front A/C on, and the blower fan on the low speed setting.
ACTION Replace the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV), located near the rear auxiliary A/C
housing, following the Workshop Manual procedure (Removal And Installation: Thermostatic
Expansion Valve). The procedure can be found in Section 412-03B of the 2005 MY Workshop
Manual, or Section 412-02 of the 2006 MY Workshop Manual.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061004A 2005-2006 1.7
Expedition/Navigator: Hrs.
Replace The Thermostatic Expansion Valve Includes Time To Verify Concern, Recover, Evacuate,
Re- Charge Air Conditioning System: (Do not use with 19700A, 19700AZU, 19700A13)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19849 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Expansion Valve: > 06-10-4 > May > 06 > A/C - Rear A/C Hoot/Whistle Noise
Expansion Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Rear A/C Hoot/Whistle Noise
TSB 06-10-4
05/29/06
HOOT OR WHISTLE NOISE FROM REAR A/C SYSTEM
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-21-1 to add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles built before 1/30/2006 may exhibit a hoot or
whistle noise inside the passenger compartment, coming from the rear auxiliary A/C system. The
noise will most likely be heard by the customer when driving the vehicle with the interior cooled
down, the rear A/C off, front A/C on, and the blower fan on the low speed setting.
ACTION Replace the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV), located near the rear auxiliary A/C
housing, following the Workshop Manual procedure (Removal And Installation: Thermostatic
Expansion Valve). The procedure can be found in Section 412-03B of the 2005 MY Workshop
Manual, or Section 412-02 of the 2006 MY Workshop Manual.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
061004A 2005-2006 1.7
Expedition/Navigator: Hrs.
Replace The Thermostatic Expansion Valve Includes Time To Verify Concern, Recover, Evacuate,
Re- Charge Air Conditioning System: (Do not use with 19700A, 19700AZU, 19700A13)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19849 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Climate Control
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair Climate Control
Thermostatic Expansion Valve
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the powertrain control module (PCM) and PCM bracket.
3. Remove the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) fitting bolt.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the thermostatic expansion valve.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
6. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Thermostatic Expansion Valve Manifold and Tube Assembly
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE MANIFOLD AND TUBE ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
1. Recover the refrigerant.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Climate Control > Page 8829
2. Remove the nut and disconnect the A/C fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Remove the nut and disconnect the A/C fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) manifold and tube assembly.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
6. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Climate Control > Page 8830
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair Auxiliary Climate Control
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE
Removal and Installation
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
3. Disconnect the fittings and remove the thermostatic expansion valve.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
5. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Core: Customer Interest A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 8839
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 8840
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 8846
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 8847
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 09-20-14 > Oct > 09 > A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2
Upshift
Torque Converter Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On
1-2 Upshift
TSB 09-20-14
10/19/09
UN-COMMANDED TCC APPLY ON THE 1-2 SHIFT CAUSING PERCEPTION OF HESITATION
AND/OR LACK OF POWER DURING SHIFT
FORD: 2005-2010 Crown Victoria 2005-2006 Expedition 2005-2010 E-150, E-250, E-350, F-150
LINCOLN: 2005-2010 Town Car 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2005-2010 Grand Marquis
This article supersedes TSB 6-22-7 to update the Issue Statement, vehicle model years and model
line covered.
ISSUE Some 2005-2010 vehicles equipped with a 4R70/75E-W transmission may experience an
un-commanded torque converter clutch (TCC) apply or TCC partial apply immediately after the 1-2
shift. This may result in the perception that the vehicle lacks power or that the transmission is
up-shifting too early. Additional symptoms of uncommanded TCC apply when coming to a stop
(before the 2-1 downshift is commanded), are engine stalling or lugging when engaging manual
2nd while at a stop and code P1742 may be present in continuous memory. However, the vehicle
should operate normally in park, reverse, neutral and manual 1st gear.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure for verification and repair.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Monitor (TCC %) solenoid command state - duty cycle and (TC SLIP ACT) torque converter
clutch slippage - RPM, while in 2nd, 3rd or 4th gear
with a TCC % reading 0.
a. If TCC % = 0 and TC SLIP ACT = less than 20 RPM then inspect the number 7 check ball in the
main control valve body for damage. Replace
as required following the appropriate Workshop Manual (WSM) under Disassembly and Assembly
of Subassemblies - Main Control Valve Body. (Figure 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 09-20-14 > Oct > 09 > A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2
Upshift > Page 8853
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS PERFORMED IN 2ND GEAR AUTO (NOT MANUAL 2). MONITOR (TC
SLIP ACT) AFTER THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) COMMANDS 2ND GEAR
AND BEFORE THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS) READS 35 MPH (56 KM/H).
b. If you receive any other reading, this procedure does not apply; follow normal diagnostic
procedures as outlined in the appropriate WSM.
NOTE
IT IS NORMAL FOR THE PCM TO COMMAND 4TH GEAR AT SPEEDS AS LOW AS 19 MPH (30
KM/H) WITH LIGHT ACCELERATION WHEN THE THROTTLE POSITION IS LESS THEN 20%.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092014A 2005-2010 Crown Victoria, 2.3 Hrs.
Grand Marquis, Town Car, Econoline 150/250/350, 2005-2006 Expedition: Includes Time To
Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor
Operations)
092014A 2005-2010 F-150, 2.2 Hrs.
2006-2008 Mark LT: Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7E195 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 09-20-14 > Oct > 09 > A/T - Uncommanded TCC Lock Up On 1-2
Upshift > Page 8859
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS PERFORMED IN 2ND GEAR AUTO (NOT MANUAL 2). MONITOR (TC
SLIP ACT) AFTER THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) COMMANDS 2ND GEAR
AND BEFORE THE VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS) READS 35 MPH (56 KM/H).
b. If you receive any other reading, this procedure does not apply; follow normal diagnostic
procedures as outlined in the appropriate WSM.
NOTE
IT IS NORMAL FOR THE PCM TO COMMAND 4TH GEAR AT SPEEDS AS LOW AS 19 MPH (30
KM/H) WITH LIGHT ACCELERATION WHEN THE THROTTLE POSITION IS LESS THEN 20%.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092014A 2005-2010 Crown Victoria, 2.3 Hrs.
Grand Marquis, Town Car, Econoline 150/250/350, 2005-2006 Expedition: Includes Time To
Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor
Operations)
092014A 2005-2010 F-150, 2.2 Hrs.
2006-2008 Mark LT: Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis Outlined In This Article And Repair
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7E195 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 8860
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection
HEATER CORE
WARNING: Carbon monoxide is colorless, odorless and dangerous. If it is necessary to operate
the engine with the vehicle in a closed area such as a garage, always use an exhaust collector to
vent the exhaust gases outside the closed area.
1. NOTE: Testing of returned heater cores reveals that a large percentage of heater cores were
good and did not require replacement. If a heater
core leak is suspected, the heater core must be tested by carrying out the plugged heater core
component test before the heater core pressure test. Carry out a system inspection by checking
the heater system thoroughly as follows:
Inspect for evidence of coolant leakage at the heater water hose to heater core attachments. A
coolant leak in the heater water hose could follow the heater core tube to the heater core and
appear as a leak in the heater core.
2. NOTE: Spring-type clamps are installed as original equipment. Installation and overtightening of
non-specification clamps can cause leakage at
the heater water hose connection and damage the heater core.
Check the integrity of the heater water hose clamps.
Heater Core - Plugged
WARNING: The heater core inlet hose will become too hot to handle if the system is working
correctly.
1. Check to see that the engine coolant is at the correct level. 2. Start the engine and turn on the
heater. 3. When the engine coolant reaches operating temperature, feel the heater core outlet hose
to see if it is hot.
If it is not hot: -
the heater core may have an air pocket.
- the heater core may be plugged.
- the thermostat is not working correctly.
Heater Core - Pressure Test
Use the Radiator/Heater Core Pressure Tester to perform the pressure test.
1. NOTE: Due to space limitations, a bench test may be necessary for pressure testing.
Drain the coolant from the cooling system.
2. Disconnect the heater water hoses from the heater core. 3. Install a short piece of heater water
hose, approximately 101 mm (4 inches) long on each heater core tube.
4. Fill the heater core and heater water hoses with water and install Plug BT-7422-B and adapter
BT-7422-A from the Radiator/Heater Core
Pressure Tester in the heater water hose ends. Secure the heater water hoses, plug and adapter
with hose clamps.
5. Attach the pump and gauge assembly from the Radiator/Heater Core Pressure Tester to the
adapter. 6. Close the bleed valve at the base of the gauge. Pump 138 kPa (20 psi) of air pressure
into the heater core. 7. Observe the pressure gauge for a minimum of 3 minutes. 8. If the pressure
drops, check the heater water hose connections to the core tubes for leaks. If the heater water
hoses do not leak, remove the
heater core from the vehicle and perform the bench test.
Heater Core - Bench Test
1. Remove the heater core from the vehicle. 2. Drain all of the coolant from the heater core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 8861
3. Connect the 101 mm (4 inch) test heater water hoses with plug and adapter to the core tubes.
Then connect the Radiator/Heater Core Pressure
Tester to the adapter.
4. Apply 138 kPa (20 psi) of air pressure to the heater core. Submerge the heater core in water.
5. If a leak is observed, install a new heater core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core
HEATER CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be leak tested before it is removed
from the vehicle.
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the dash panel seal. 3.
Remove the 3 temperature blend door actuator screws. 4. Remove the temperature blend door
actuator. 5. Remove the 4 heater core cover screws. 6. Remove the heater core cover. 7. Remove
the heater core. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core > Page 8864
Heater Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core
AUXILIARY HEATER CORE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the auxiliary climate control housing.
2. Remove the screws and the evaporator/heater core access cover.
3. Remove the heater core. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core Case > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Heater Core Case: Service and Repair
HEATER CORE AND EVAPORATOR CORE HOUSING
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core Case > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 8868
Part 2
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator must be vacuum leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Drain the engine coolant. 3. Remove the instrument panel. Refer to:
Body and Frame, Interior Moulding/Trim, Dashboard/Instrument Panel, Service and Repair, See:
Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair
4. Remove the rear footwell duct. 5. Remove the powertrain control module (PCM) and PCM
bracket. 6. Disconnect the 2 heater hose quick-disconnect fittings at the heater core.
7. Remove the bolt and detach the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV).
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
8. Disconnect the evaporator outlet fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
9. Disconnect the evaporator inlet fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
10. Remove the thermostatic expansion valve bracket nut.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
11. Remove the 3 heater core and evaporator core housing nuts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core Case > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 8869
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
12. Disconnect the 2 vacuum lines at the top of the heater core and evaporator core housing. 13.
Detach the wire harness connectors from the bracket below the air inlet duct. 14. Remove the air
inlet duct bracket nut.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
15. Remove the plenum chamber nut.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
16. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 17. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
- Clean and lubricate the coolant hoses with plain water only if needed.
18. Fill the engine coolant level. 19. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: Customer Interest A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
8878
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
8879
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
> Page 8885
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
> Page 8886
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Hose Coupling
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Hose Coupling
HEATER HOSE COUPLING
Remover, Heater Hose Inlet Tube
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect
1. WARNING: The engine must be off, fully cool and the cooling system fully depressurized before
attempting to disconnect any heater
water hoses. Failure to comply with this warning can result in serious injury or burns from hot liquid
escaping out of the engine cooling system.
Depressurize the engine cooling system.
2. Push the heater water hose toward the tube to fully expose the locking tabs.
3. NOTE: When compressing the white coupling retainer, the Heater Hose Disconnect Tool must
be perpendicular to and on the highest point of the
coupling.
Push the special tool over the coupling retainer windows to compress the retainer locking tabs.
4. NOTE: A slight twisting motion while pulling on the heater water hose may be necessary to
assist in the removal.
Pull the heater water hose away from the heater core tube.
5. Plug the heater water hose. 6. Remove the white coupling retainer from the tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Hose Coupling > Page 8889
7. Spread the retainer tabs apart and slide the retainer off the tube. 8. Discard the retainer.
Connect
1. Clean the tubes and lubricate with MERPOL(R) meeting Ford specification ESE-M99B144-B or
plain water.
2. Install a new coupling retainer, spacer, and lubricated O-ring seals into the quick disconnect
coupling housing.
3. Push the heater water hose with a quick disconnect coupling onto the tube. 4. Make sure the
coupling is fully engaged by lightly pulling on the heater water hose.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Hose Coupling > Page 8890
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Outlet and Inlet Line
AUXILIARY HEATER OUTLET AND INLET LINE
Removal
CAUTION: To avoid refrigerant loss, clearly differentiate the auxiliary heater lines from the auxiliary
refrigerant lines before beginning this procedure.
NOTE:
- The auxiliary heater inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly. The auxiliary
heater inlet line and outlet line are each installed from the factory as 1-piece assemblies. The
replacement parts are supplied as separate kits containing multiple piece lines for ease of
installation.
- The following procedure can be used to remove and install 1 or both the auxiliary heater inlet and
auxiliary heater outlet lines. If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed and installed, cut or
disconnect only the desired line at the specified points within the procedure.
1. Drain the engine coolant. 2. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
3. Detach the auxiliary heater lines.
1 Disconnect the heater hose(s).
2 Remove the 2 line bracket bolts.
3 Remove the line bracket.
4. Remove the spare tire. 5. Raise the vehicle. 6. Remove the RH front wheel. 7. Remove the RH
fender splash shield.
8. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the heater hose(s).
9. Remove the muffler.
10. Remove the RH catalytic converter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Hose Coupling > Page 8891
11. Remove the 3 bolts and the heat shield.
12. Remove the bolts.
13. Remove the nut and the line bracket.
14. Remove the bolt and the heat shield.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Hose Coupling > Page 8892
15. Remove the nuts and the remaining line brackets.
16. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary heater line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new line(s).
17. Remove the auxiliary heater line(s) in 3 separate pieces.
Installation
1. Partially lower the vehicle.
2. Attach the rear portion of the auxiliary heater lines.
1 Connect the heater hoses.
2 Install the line bracket.
3 Install the bolts.
3. Install the front auxiliary heater line(s) and connect the heater hose(s).
- Clean and lubricate the heater hoses with plain water only if needed.
4. Raise the vehicle.
5. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the middle auxiliary heater line(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Hose Coupling > Page 8893
6. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 line brackets.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
7. Tighten the middle auxiliary heater line fittings. 8. Inspect the auxiliary heater lines for correct
installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as needed.
9. Install the heat shield and the bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
10. Install the heat shield and the bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
11. Install the RH catalytic converter. 12. Install the muffler. 13. Partially lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Hose Coupling > Page 8894
14. Install the heat shield bolt.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
15. Install the line bracket.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Install the spare tire. 18. Install the RH quarter trim panel. 19. Fill the
engine coolant level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly
COMPRESSOR MANIFOLD AND TUBE ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
All vehicles
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Disconnect the negative and positive battery cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 8899
3. Disconnect the electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the pressure cutoff switch electrical
connector. 5. Remove the compressor manifold and tube suction fitting nut and disconnect the
fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Vehicles with auxiliary A/C
6. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles
7. Remove the compressor manifold and tube assembly discharge fitting nut and disconnect the
fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
8. Loosen the compressor manifold bolt and remove the compressor manifold and tube assembly.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
10. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 8900
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
AUXILIARY EVAPORATOR OUTLET AND INLET LINE
Removal
NOTE:
- The auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly. The
auxiliary evaporator inlet line and outlet line are each installed from the factory as 1-piece
assemblies. The replacement parts are supplied as separate kits containing multiple piece lines for
ease of installation.
- The following procedure can be used to remove and install 1 or both the auxiliary evaporator inlet
and auxiliary evaporator outlet lines. If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed and
installed, cut or disconnect only the desired line at the specified points within the procedure.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. NOTE: If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Remove the nut(s) and disconnect the A/C fitting(s).
3. Remove the RH quarter trim panel. 4. Remove the spare tire.
5. NOTE: Both A/C fittings must be disconnected even if only one line is to be removed.
Disconnect the A/C fittings. Install new O-rings seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 8901
6. Remove the bolts and the line bracket. 7. Raise the vehicle. 8. Remove the spare tire carrier
splash shield. 9. Remove the RH front wheel.
10. Remove the RH fender splash shield. 11. Remove the muffler. 12. Remove the RH catalytic
converter.
13. Remove the 3 bolts and the heat shield.
14. Remove the bolts.
15. Remove the nut and the line bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 8902
16. Remove the bolt and the heat shield.
17. Remove the nuts and the remaining line brackets.
18. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary evaporator line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary evaporator line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new
line(s).
19. Remove the auxiliary evaporator line(s) in 3 separate pieces.
Installation
1. Partially lower the vehicle to allow access to both the rear auxiliary line fittings and the underside
of the vehicle.
2. Position the rear portion of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) and install the line bracket and bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 8903
3. Connect the A/C fittings.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. Install the front auxiliary evaporator line(s) and connect the A/C fittings.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
5. Raise the vehicle.
6. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the middle auxiliary evaporator line(s).
7. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 line brackets.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 8904
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
8. Tighten the middle auxiliary evaporator line fittings. 9. Inspect the auxiliary evaporator lines for
correct installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as needed.
10. Install the heat shield and the bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
11. Install the heat shield and the bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
12. Install the RH catalytic converter. 13. Install the muffler. 14. Partially lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor Manifold and Tube Assembly > Page 8905
15. Install the heat shield bolt.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
16. Install the line bracket.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
17. Install the spare tire carrier splash shield. 18. Install the RH front fender splash shield. 19.
Install the RH front wheel. 20. Lower the vehicle. 21. Install the RH quarter trim panel. 22. Install
the spare tire. 23. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. 24.
Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Plenum Chamber
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Plenum Chamber
PLENUM CHAMBER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Disconnect the 2 plenum chamber
vacuum connectors and position the vacuum harness aside. 3. Remove the 3 upper plenum
chamber screws. 4. Remove the 5 lower plenum chamber screws. 5. Remove the plenum
chamber. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Plenum Chamber > Page 8910
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing
HEATER CORE AND EVAPORATOR CORE HOUSING
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Plenum Chamber > Page 8911
Part 2
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator must be vacuum leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Drain the engine coolant. 3. Remove the instrument panel. Refer to:
Body and Frame, Interior Moulding/Trim, Dashboard/Instrument Panel, Service and Repair, See:
Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair
4. Remove the rear footwell duct. 5. Remove the powertrain control module (PCM) and PCM
bracket. 6. Disconnect the 2 heater hose quick-disconnect fittings at the heater core.
7. Remove the bolt and detach the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV).
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
8. Disconnect the evaporator outlet fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
9. Disconnect the evaporator inlet fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
10. Remove the thermostatic expansion valve bracket nut.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
11. Remove the 3 heater core and evaporator core housing nuts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Plenum Chamber > Page 8912
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
12. Disconnect the 2 vacuum lines at the top of the heater core and evaporator core housing. 13.
Detach the wire harness connectors from the bracket below the air inlet duct. 14. Remove the air
inlet duct bracket nut.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
15. Remove the plenum chamber nut.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
16. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 17. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
- Clean and lubricate the coolant hoses with plain water only if needed.
18. Fill the engine coolant level. 19. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Plenum Chamber > Page 8913
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Climate Control Housing
AUXILIARY CLIMATE CONTROL HOUSING
Removal and Installation
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Drain the engine cooling system. 3. Remove the RH quarter trim
panel. Refer to: Body and Frame, Interior Moulding/Trim, Trim Panel, Service and Repair, See:
Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Trim Panel/Service and Repair
4. Detach the upper air duct from the auxiliary housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Plenum Chamber > Page 8914
5. Remove the nuts and disconnect the auxiliary evaporator line fittings.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
6. Remove the bolts and the auxiliary line bracket.
7. Disconnect the heater hoses.
1 Using suitable tools, clamp off the heater hoses to prevent residual coolant from spilling into the
vehicle.
2 Disconnect the heater hoses.
8. Disconnect the drain hose. 9. Disconnect the blower motor electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the blower motor resistor electrical connector. 11. Disconnect the auxiliary
temperature blend door actuator electrical connector. 12. Disconnect the auxiliary mode door
actuator electrical connector. 13. Remove the 2 auxiliary climate control housing bolts. 14. Remove
auxiliary climate control housing. 15. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Clean and lubricate the coolant hoses with plain water only if needed.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
16. Fill the engine coolant level. 17. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Humidity Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Humidity Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
8918
Humidity Sensor: Service and Repair
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor trim cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector and aspirator tube.
2. Remove the 2 in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor screws. 3. Remove the in-vehicle
temperature and humidity sensor. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Receiver Dryer: Service and Repair
RECEIVER DRIER
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier is not required when repairing the air conditioning system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier.
All vehicles
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the condenser outlet fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Remove the receiver/drier outlet fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Vehicles with auxiliary A/C
4. Remove the auxiliary evaporator inlet line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles
5. Remove the receiver/drier bracket nut.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 8922
6. Detach the bracket and remove the receiver/drier. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
8. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Refrigerant and Capacity
Capacity without auxiliary climate control.............................................................................................
..........................................................1.13 kg (40 oz) Capacity with auxiliary climate control...............
.............................................................................................................................................1.64 kg
(58 oz)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 8927
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
REFRIGERANT TYPE
R134a Refrigerant
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... YN-19 Ford Specification ...............................................
....................................................................................................................................
WSH-M17B19-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page
8928
Refrigerant: Description and Operation
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM DYE
Fluorescent refrigerant system dye is added to the refrigerant system at the factory to assist in
refrigerant system leak diagnosis using a Rotunda-approved ultraviolet blacklight. It is not
necessary to add additional dye to the refrigerant system before diagnosing leaks, even if a
significant amount of refrigerant has been removed from the system. New suction accumulators are
shipped with a fluorescent dye "wafer" included in the desiccant bag which will dissolve after
approximately 30 minutes of continued A/C operation. It is not necessary to add dye after flushing
or filtering the refrigerant system because a new suction accumulator is installed as part of the
flushing or filtering procedure. Additional refrigerant system dye should only be added if more than
50% of the refrigerant system lubricant capacity has been lost due to a fitting separation, hose
rupture or other damage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection
Refrigerant: Testing and Inspection Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection
FLUORESCENT DYE LEAK DETECTION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Fluorescent Dye Detection
NOTE: Ford Motor Company vehicles are produced with R-134a fluorescent dye installed in the
refrigerant system from the factory. The location of leaks can be pinpointed by the bright
yellow-green glow of the fluorescent dye under a UV lamp. Since more than one leak can exist,
make sure to inspect each component, line and fitting in the refrigerant system for a leak.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection > Page 8931
1. Check for leaks using a Rotunda-approved UV lamp.
- Inspect all components, lines and fittings of the refrigerant system.
2. If a leak is found, recover the refrigerant. 3. Repair the refrigerant system leak(s). 4. Evacuate
and charge the refrigerant system. 5. After the leak(s) is/are repaired, remove any traces of
fluorescent dye with a general purpose oil solvent.
6. Verify the repair by running the vehicle for a short period of time and rechecking the area of the
leak with a Rotunda-approved UV lamp.
Fluorescent Dye Injection - Using an A/C Refrigerant Center and Dye Injector
NOTE:
- Fluorescent refrigerant system dye is added to the refrigerant system at the factory to assist in
refrigerant system leak diagnosis using a Rotunda-approved ultraviolet blacklight. It is not
necessary to add additional dye to the refrigerant system before diagnosing leaks, even if a
significant amount of refrigerant has been removed from the system. Replacement suction
accumulators and receiver/driers are shipped with a fluorescent dye "wafer" included in the
desiccant bag which will dissolve after approximately 30 minutes of continued A/C operation. It is
not necessary to add dye after flushing or filtering the refrigerant system because a new suction
accumulator or receiver/drier is installed as part of the flushing or filtering procedure. Additional
refrigerant system dye should only be added if more than 50% of the refrigerant system lubricant
capacity has been lost due to a fitting separation, hose rupture or other damage.
- Before using the R-134a fluorescent dye injector for the first time, refer to the manufacturers
instructions on evacuation of any non-condensable gasses from the hoses.
- Only connect the R-134a fluorescent dye injector to a manifold and gauge set or R-134a service
center when fluorescent dye is to be injected. The R-134a fluorescent dye injector has a one way
check valve that will prevent refrigerant system recovery and evacuation.
- Refrigerant system pressure should be between 413-551 kPa (60-80 psi) at 24°C (75°F) with the
engine off.
1. Connect an R-134a A/C refrigerant service center or a manifold and gauge set to the refrigerant
system service port valves.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection > Page 8932
2. Verify that the valves on the fluorescent dye injector are closed.
3. Fill the fluorescent dye injector reservoir with 7 ml (0.25 oz) of fluorescent dye. 4. Install the
fluorescent dye injector between the low-pressure service gauge port valve and the R-134a
refrigerant service center or manifold gauge
set.
5. Open all valves and inject the fluorescent dye into the refrigerant system. 6. When fluorescent
dye injection is complete, close all valves. 7. Recover the refrigerant from the R-134a fluorescent
dye injector. 8. Remove the fluorescent dye injector from the low-pressure service gauge port valve
and the R-134a A/C refrigerant service center or manifold
gauge set.
Fluorescent Dye Injection - Using a Dye Injector Loop Kit
NOTE:
- Fluorescent refrigerant system dye is added to the refrigerant system at the factory to assist in
refrigerant system leak diagnosis using a Rotunda-approved ultraviolet blacklight. It is not
necessary to add additional dye to the refrigerant system before diagnosing leaks, even if a
significant amount of refrigerant has been removed from the system. Replacement suction
accumulators and receiver/driers are shipped with a fluorescent dye "wafer" included in the
desiccant bag which will dissolve after approximately 30 minutes of continued A/C operation. It is
not necessary to add dye after flushing or filtering the refrigerant system because a new suction
accumulator or receiver/drier is installed as part of the flushing or filtering procedure. Additional
refrigerant system dye should only be added if more than 50% of the refrigerant system lubricant
capacity has been lost due to a fitting separation, hose rupture or other damage.
- Before using the R-134a fluorescent dye injector for the first time, refer to the equipment
manufacturers instructions on evacuation of non-condensable gasses from the hoses.
- Refrigerant system pressure should be between 413-551 kPa (60-80 psi) at 24°C.
1. Verify that the valves on the deluxe injector loop kit are closed.
2. Fill the deluxe injector loop kit reservoir with 7 ml (0.25 oz) of fluorescent dye.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection > Page 8933
3. Install the deluxe injector loop kit between the high-pressure and low-pressure service gauge
port valves.
4. CAUTION: Make sure all tools and hoses are clear of the engine cooling fan and drive belt
before starting the engine.
Start the engine.
5. Open the high-pressure service valve.
6. Open the deluxe injector loop kit valves and inject the fluorescent dye into the refrigerant system.
7. Close the high-pressure service valve to allow the pressure inside the deluxe injector loop kit to
equalize with the suction side of the refrigerant
system.
8. NOTE: Close the valves on the deluxe injector loop kit while the A/C compressor is operating.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection > Page 8934
Close the valves on the deluxe injector loop kit.
9. NOTE: Leave all valves on the special tool closed when not in use.
Disconnect the high-pressure and low-pressure service valves and remove the deluxe injector loop
kit from the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Fluorescent Dye Leak Detection > Page 8935
Refrigerant: Testing and Inspection Electronic Leak Detection
ELECTRONIC LEAK DETECTION
H10PM Refrigerant Leak Detector With Battery
Special Tool(s)
CAUTION: Good ventilation is necessary in the area where electronic A/C leak testing is to be
carried out. If the surrounding air is contaminated with refrigerant gas, the leak detector will indicate
this gas all the time. Odors from other chemicals such as antifreeze, diesel fuel, disc brake cleaner
or other cleaning solvents can cause the same problem. Using a fan to ventilate the area to be
tested before proceeding with the leak detection procedure is helpful in removing small traces of
contamination from the air, but the fan should be turned off during actual testing.
1. NOTE: The system pressure should be between 413-551 kPa (60-80 psi) at 24°C (75°F) with the
engine off.
Leak test the refrigerant system using the Refrigerant Leak Detector. Follow the instructions
included with the leak detector for handling and operation techniques.
2. If a leak is found, recover the refrigerant.
- Repair the system.
- Test the system for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) SYSTEM RECOVERY, EVACUATION AND CHARGING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Refrigerant System Recovery
NOTE:
- Ford Motor Company recommends use of an A/C service center to carry out recovery, evacuation
and charging of the refrigerant system. If an A/C service center is not available, refrigerant system
recovery, evacuation and charging may be accomplished using a separate recovery station,
vacuum pump, charging meter and manifold gauge set.
- Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in vacuum that
may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to
leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify
that no leaks are present.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure > Page 8938
1. Prior to recovering, you must verify the purity of the refrigerant. 2. Connect an R-134a refrigerant
service center to the low- and high-pressure service gauge port valves following the operating
instructions provided
by the equipment manufacturer.
3. Recover the refrigerant from the system following the operating instructions provided by the
equipment manufacturer. 4. Once the refrigerant service center has recovered the refrigerant,
switch OFF the power supply. 5. Allow the system to set for about 2 minutes, and observe the
system vacuum reading. If the vacuum is not lost, disconnect the recovery equipment. 6. If the
system does lose vacuum, repeat Steps 3 through 5 until the vacuum level remains stable for 2
minutes. 7. Carry out the required repairs.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure > Page 8939
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Evacuation and Charging
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) SYSTEM RECOVERY, EVACUATION AND CHARGING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Refrigerant System Evacuation Using an R-134a Service Center
NOTE:
- Ford Motor Company recommends use of an A/C service center to carry out recovery, evacuation
and charging of the refrigerant system. If an A/C service center is not available, refrigerant system
recovery, evacuation and charging may be accomplished using a separate recovery station,
vacuum pump, charging meter and manifold gauge set.
- Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in vacuum that
may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to
leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify
that no leaks are present.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure > Page 8940
1. Connect an R-134a service center to the low- and high-pressure service gauge port valves
following the operating instructions provided by the
equipment manufacturer.
2. Evacuate the system until the low-pressure gauge reads at least 99.4 kPa (29.5 in-Hg) of
vacuum and as close to 101.1 kPa (30 in-Hg) as
possible. Continue to operate the vacuum pump for a minimum of 45 minutes.
3. Turn off the vacuum pump. Observe the low-pressure gauge for 5 minutes to make sure that the
system vacuum is held. If vacuum is not held for 5
minutes, leak test the system, repair the leak and evacuate the system again.
Refrigerant System Evacuation Using an R-134a Manifold Gauge Set
NOTE:
- Ford Motor Company recommends use of an A/C service center to carry out recovery, evacuation
and charging of the refrigerant system. If an A/C service center is not available, refrigerant system
recovery, evacuation and charging may be accomplished using a separate recovery station,
vacuum pump, charging meter and manifold gauge set.
- Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in vacuum that
may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to
leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify
that no leaks are present.
1. Connect the R-134a manifold gauge set to the low-side and high-side service gauge port valves.
2. Connect the center (yellow) hose from the manifold gauge set to the suction port on the vacuum
pump. 3. Open all valves on the R-134a manifold gauge set and both service gauge port valves. 4.
Turn on the vacuum pump and evacuate the system until the low-pressure gauge reads at least
99.4 kPa (29.5 in-Hg) of vacuum and as close to
101.1 kPa (30 in-Hg) as possible. Continue to operate the vacuum pump for a minimum of 45
minutes.
5. Close the high-side and low-side valves on the manifold gauge set (not the service gauge port
valves) and turn off the vacuum pump. 6. Observe the low-pressure gauge for 5 minutes to make
sure that the system vacuum is held. If vacuum is not held for 5 minutes, leak test the
system, repair the leak and evacuate the system again.
Refrigerant System Charging Using an R-134a Service Center
NOTE:
- Ford Motor Company recommends use of an A/C service center to carry out recovery, evacuation
and charging of the refrigerant system. If an A/C service center is not available, refrigerant system
recovery, evacuation and charging may be accomplished using a separate recovery station,
vacuum pump, charging meter and manifold gauge set.
- Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak that may be
misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to leak-test all
refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify that no leaks
are present.
1. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. 2. Connect an R-134a
A/C service center to the low-side and high-side service gauge port valves following the operating
instructions provided by the
equipment manufacturer.
3. Set the refrigerant charge amount, and charge the refrigerant system following the instructions
provided by the equipment manufacturer.
Refrigerant System Charging
NOTE:
- Ford Motor Company recommends use of an A/C service center to carry out recovery, evacuation
and charging of the refrigerant system. If an A/C service center is not available, refrigerant system
recovery, evacuation and charging may be accomplished using a separate recovery station,
vacuum pump, charging meter and manifold gauge set.
- Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak that may be
misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to leak-test all
refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify that no leaks
are present.
1. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. 2. Assemble the
R-134a manifold gauge set, automatic refrigerant charging meter and R-134a supply tank following
the automatic refrigerant
charging meter operating instructions.
3. Charge the refrigerant system following the automatic refrigerant charging meter operating
instructions. 4. If the refrigerant flow stops before the refrigerant charge is complete, start the
engine, select A/C operation and allow the refrigerant charge to
complete.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure > Page 8941
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant Identification Testing
REFRIGERANT IDENTIFICATION TESTING
Refrigerant Identifier With Air-Radicator
Special Tool(s)
Refrigerant Identification
1. NOTE: An A/C refrigerant analyzer must be used to identify gas samples taken directly from the
refrigeration system or storage containers prior
to recovering or charging the refrigerant system.
Follow the instructions included with the refrigerant identifier to obtain the sample for testing.
2. The diagnostic tool will display one of the following:
- If the purity level of R-134a is 98% or greater by weight, the green "PASS" light emitting diode
(LED) will light. The weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12, R-22, hydrocarbons, and air will be
displayed on the digital display.
- If refrigerant R-134a does not meet the 98% purity level, the red "FAIL" LED will light and an
alarm will sound alerting the user of potential hazards. The weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12,
R-22, and hydrocarbons will be displayed on the digital display.
- If hydrocarbon concentrations are 2% or greater by weight, the red "FAIL" LED will light,
"Hydrocarbon High" will be displayed on the digital display, and an alarm will sound alerting the
user of potential hazards. The weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12, R-22, and hydrocarbons will
also be displayed on the digital display.
3. The percentage of air contained in the sample will be displayed if the R-134a content is 98% or
greater. The diagnostic tool eliminates the effect of
air when determining the refrigerant sample content because air is not considered a contaminant,
although air can affect A/C system performance. When the diagnostic tool has determined that a
refrigerant source is pure (R-134a is 98% or greater by weight) and air concentration levels are 2%
or greater by weight, the diagnostic tool will prompt the user if an air purge is desired.
4. If contaminated refrigerant is detected, repeat the refrigerant identification test to verify that the
refrigerant is indeed contaminated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Discharging and Recovery Procedure > Page 8942
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Contaminated Refrigerant Handling
CONTAMINATED REFRIGERANT HANDLING
CAUTION: If contaminated refrigerant is detected, DO NOT recover the refrigerant into R-134a
recovery/recycling equipment.
NOTE: A new suction accumulator or receiver/drier must be installed as directed by the air
conditioning system flushing procedure.
1. Recover the contaminated refrigerant using suitable recovery-only equipment designed for
capturing and storing contaminated refrigerant only.
- If this equipment is not available, contact an A/C service facility in your area with the correct
equipment to carry out this service.
2. Determine and correct the cause of the customers initial concern. 3. Flush the air conditioning
system. 4. Dispose of the contaminated refrigerant in accordance with all federal, state and local
regulations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL
TOTAL SYSTEM CAPACITY
Without auxiliary climate control
............................................................................................................................................................
266 ml (9.0 oz) With auxiliary climate control ......................................................................................
......................................................................... 414 ml (14.0 oz)
A/C COMPRESSOR
Add the same amount drained plus the amount collected during refrigerant recovery. NOTE: Rotate
the old A/C compressor shaft 8 to 10 full rotations (clockwise) while collecting the refrigerant oil in a
clean measuring cup. Service A/C compressors are shipped without refrigerant oil.
SUCTION ACCUMULATOR OR RECEIVER/DRIER
Add the quantity of oil drained, plus the amount collected during refrigerant recovery and 60 ml (2.0
fl oz). NOTE: Drill one 12.7 mm (1/2 inch) hole in the old suction accumulator or receiver/drier
cylinder and drain the oil into a clean measuring cup.
EVAPORATOR CORE ........................................................................................................................
................................................ 45 ml (1.5 fl oz.)
NOTE: Added to the amount collected during refrigerant recovery.
CONDENSER CORE ..........................................................................................................................
................................................. 60 ml (2.0 fl oz.)
NOTE: Added to the amount collected during refrigerant recovery.
EVAPORATOR CORE ORIFICE OR THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE
The amount collected during refrigerant recovery.
A/C PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
...................................................................................................................................................... 60
ml (2.0 fl oz.)
REFRIGERANT HOSE/LINE
.............................................................................................................................................................
60 ml (2.0 fl oz.)
NOTE: If an excessive amount of refrigerant oil is lost due to a hose rupture/separation or other
damage, the total system refrigerant oil capacity must be added.
O-RING LEAK REPAIR .......................................................................................................................
.............................................. 60 ml (2.0 fl oz.)
NOTE: The amount specified may be used for one or multiple O-ring leak repairs. Do not multiply
the refrigerant oil amount by the number of O-ring leaks being repaired.
SERVICE PORT LEAK REPAIR
....................................................................................................................................................... 60
ml (2.0 fl oz.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 8947
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL
PAG Refrigerant Compressor Oil (R-134a Systems)
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. F7AZ-19589-DA Motorcraft P/N .......................................................
............................................................................................................................................. YN-12-C
Ford Specification ................................................................................................................................
.................................................. WSH-M1C231-B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page
8948
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
REFRIGERANT OIL ADDING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
CAUTION: During normal A/C operation, oil is circulated through the system with the refrigerant,
and a small amount is retained in each component. If certain components of the system are
removed, some of the refrigerant oil will go with the component. To maintain the original total oil
charge, it is necessary to compensate for the oil lost by adding oil to the system with the new part.
Part 1
Part 2
1. Refer to the chart for refrigerant oil adding amounts and methods of installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page
8949
Refrigerant Oil Adding for New A/C Compressor Installation
NOTE: Service A/C compressors are shipped without refrigerant oil.
1. Rotate the old A/C compressor shaft 8 to 10 full rotations (clockwise) while collecting the
refrigerant oil in a clean measuring cup.
- Add the same amount plus the amount collected during refrigerant recovery.
Refrigerant Oil Adding for New Suction Accumulator or Receiver/Drier Installation
1. Drill one half-inch hole in the old suction accumulator or receiver/drier cylinder and drain the oil
into a clean measuring cup. 2. Add the quantity of oil drained, plus the amount collected during
refrigerant recovery and 60 ml (2 oz.).
Oil Injection Using a Dye/Lubricant Injector
NOTE: If fluorescent leak detection dye is also to be added during A/C charging, the dye may be
added to the dye/lubricant injector along with the refrigerant oil.
1. Evacuate the refrigerant system. 2. Assemble the dye/lubricant injector using the correct
adapters to match the amount of PAG oil to be injected.
3. Verify that all the valves on the dye/lubricant injector are closed.
4. Fill the dye/lubricant injector with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. 5. Install the dye/lubricant
injector between the low-side service gauge port valve and the refrigerant service station or
manifold gauge set. 6. Open all valves and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 8954
C1078
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 8958
C130
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Locations Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8964
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8965
Blower Motor Relay: Locations Rear Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8966
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Blower Motor Relay
C2216
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8969
C4075
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8972
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8973
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8974
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8978
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8979
C1008
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8980
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH RELAY (A/CCR)
NOTE: The PCM PIDs WAC and wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WACF) are used to
monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR (may be referred to as the wide open throttle A/C cutoff [WAC] relay) is wired normally
open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch or EATC module and the A/C
clutch. The PCM receives a signal indicating that A/C is requested (for some applications, this
message is sent through the communications network). When A/C is requested, the PCM will
check other A/C related inputs that are available (such as ACPSW, ACCS). If these inputs indicate
A/C operation is OK, and the engine conditions are OK (such as coolant temperature, engine RPM,
throttle position), the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending
voltage to the A/CC.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8981
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8982
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8986
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams
C228a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8987
C228b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 8992
C132
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 8993
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 8994
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Remove the upper radiator sight shield.
All vehicles
2. Detach and disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the
ambient air temperature sensor. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the climate control assembly. 2. Pull and remove the blower motor switch knob. 3.
Release the 3 clips and remove the blower motor switch. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Switch > Page 8999
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Speed Control
BLOWER MOTOR SPEED CONTROL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator. 2. Disconnect the blower motor speed control
electrical connector. 3. Remove the blower motor speed control screw. 4. Remove the blower
motor speed control. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
C233
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor > Page 9005
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9006
In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Disconnect the aspirator hose and the in-vehicle
temperature sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor screws. 4.
Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor > Page 9009
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity
Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor trim cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector and aspirator tube.
2. Remove the 2 in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor screws. 3. Remove the in-vehicle
temperature and humidity sensor. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE (ACET) SENSOR
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling, improve defrost/demist
performance, and reduce A/C clutch cycling.
NOTE: These values can vary 15 percent due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9013
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) EVAPORATOR DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Lower the glove compartment. 2. Remove the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor
screw. 3. Disconnect the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor electrical connector.
4. Carefully pry the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor probe out of the heater core and
evaporator core housing. 5. Remove the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor. 6. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Humidity Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Humidity Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9017
Humidity Sensor: Service and Repair
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor trim cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector and aspirator tube.
2. Remove the 2 in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor screws. 3. Remove the in-vehicle
temperature and humidity sensor. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 9022
C1078
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 9026
C130
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9030
C286
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Service Port HVAC: Locations
Clutch Cycling Thermostatic Expansion Valve Type Refrigerant System (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page
9034
Clutch Cycling Thermostatic Expansion Valve Type Refrigerant System (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9038
C286
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Harness HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Vacuum Harness HVAC: Service and Repair
VACUUM HOSE REPAIR - MINI-TUBE
Vacuum Pump Kit
Special Tool(s)
1. Measure the length of the damaged area of the mini-tube vacuum hose. 2. Cut a piece of
standard 1/8-inch inner diameter vacuum hose approximately 25 mm (1 inch) longer than the
damaged area of the mini-tube
vacuum hose.
3. Cut off the mini-tube vacuum hose on each side of the damaged area.
4. WARNING: Read the warning information on the product label to prevent possible personal
injury.
Dip the mini-tube hose ends in commercially available paint thinner containing methyl ethyl ketone
(MEK). This solvent will seal the mini-tube in the vacuum hose.
5. Insert the ends of the mini-tube vacuum hose approximately 9 mm (3/8 inch) into the ends of the
standard 1/8-inch repair vacuum hose section. 6. Shake the repair joint after assembly to make
sure the solvent is dispersed and the vacuum line is not plugged. 7. Test the system for a vacuum
leak in the repair area.
- Use the Vacuum Pump or equivalent.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Reservoir HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Vacuum Reservoir HVAC: Service and Repair
VACUUM RESERVOIR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the battery and battery tray. 2. Disconnect the vacuum reservoir vacuum connector. 3.
Remove the vacuum reservoir. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Solenoid Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Solenoid Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9048
C2093
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Solenoid Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9049
ATC Solenoid And Manifold
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Solenoid Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9050
Vacuum Solenoid Valve HVAC: Service and Repair
AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL SOLENOID AND MANIFOLD
Removal and Installation
Navigator
1. Remove the floor console trim panel.
Expedition
2. Remove the bolts and the instrument panel brace.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Solenoid Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9051
All vehicles
3. Disconnect the automatic temperature control (ATC) solenoid and manifold vacuum connector.
4. Disconnect the ATC solenoid and manifold electrical connector. 5. Remove the ATC solenoid
and manifold screw. 6. Remove the ATC solenoid and manifold. 7. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Inspection and Repair After
A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
Inspection and Repair After a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
WARNING: Remove restraint system diagnostic tools from the vehicle prior to road testing. If tools
are not removed, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) device may not deploy in a crash.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death in a crash and
possibly violate vehicle safety standards.
NOTE: After diagnosing or repairing a supplemental restraint system (SRS), the restraint system
diagnostic tools (if required) must be removed before operating the vehicle over the road.
NOTE: Deployable devices (such as air bag modules, pretensioners) may deploy alone or in
various combinations depending on the impact event.
NOTE: Always refer to the appropriate workshop manual procedures prior to carrying out vehicle
repairs affecting the SRS and safety belt system.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
All vehicles
1. NOTE: Refer to the correct removal and installation procedure for all SRS components being
installed.
When any deployable device or combination of devices are deployed and/or the restraints control
module (RCM) has the DTC B1231 (Event Threshold Exceeded) in memory, the repair of the
vehicle's SRS is to include the removal of all deployed devices and the installation of new
deployable devices, the removal and installation of new impact sensors, and the removal and
installation of a new RCM. DTCs must cleared from all required modules after repairs are carried
out.
Vehicles with occupant classification sensor (OCS) system
2. NOTE: After installation of new occupant classification sensor (OCS) system components carry
out the OCS System Reset procedure as
instructed in the workshop manual. Refer to the appropriate workshop manual for OCS system
removal and installation procedure.
When a vehicle has been involved in a collision and the occupant classification system module
(OCSM) has DTC B1231 stored in memory, the repair of the OCS system is to include the following
procedures for the specified system:
- For rail type OCS system, inspect the passenger side floorpan for damage and repair as
necessary. Install new OCS system rails.
- For weight sensor bolt type OCS system, inspect the passenger side floorpan for damage and
repair as necessary. Install a new seat track with OCS system weight sensor bolts. DTC must be
cleared from the OCSM before carrying out Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Reset.
Do not install a new OCSM unless DTC B1231 cannot be cleared.
- NOTE: Most bladder type OCSM do not store a DTC B1231 in memory after deployment. The
DTC B1231 is stored only by the RCM.
For bladder type OCS system, inspect for damage and repair as necessary. If installation of an
OCS system component is required, an OCS system service kit must be installed.
All vehicles
3. When any damage to the impact sensor mounting points or mounting hardware has occurred,
repair or install new mounting points and mounting
hardware as needed.
4. When the driver air bag module has deployed, a new clockspring must be installed.
5. New driver and/or front passenger safety belt systems (including retractors, buckles and height
adjusters) must be installed if the vehicle is
involved in a collision that results in deployment of the driver and/or front passenger safety belt
pretensioners. For additional information, refer to Safety Belt System.
6. Inspect the entire vehicle for damage, including the following components:
Steering column (deployable column if equipped) Instrument panel knee bolsters and mounting
points Instrument panel braces and brackets Instrument panel and mounting points Seats and seat
mounting points Safety belts, safety belt buckles and safety belt retractors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment > Page 9057
SRS wiring, wiring harnesses and connectors
7. After carrying out the review and inspection of the entire vehicle for damage, repair or install new
components as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment > Page 9058
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Safety Belt Procedure After
A Collision
SAFETY BELT PROCEDURE AFTER A COLLISION
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function: Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion of this section, a new safety belt assembly
must be installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet
metal must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and
attaching hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching
hardware may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. Before installing a new safety belt assembly, the safety belt attaching areas must be inspected
for damage and distortion. If the attaching points are
damaged and distorted, the sheet metal must be worked back to its original shape and structural
integrity.
2. Install the new safety belt(s). Carry out all applicable Functional Tests for the component(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety
canopy deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a seat mounted side air bag and/or a safety belt pretensioner (if equipped)
system is being serviced, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central junction
box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover and
remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and close
the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9064
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety canopy
module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9065
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central
junction box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover
and remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Remove the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
8. Remove the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9066
9. Remove the driver air bag module.
1 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
2 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
3 Disconnect the horn switch electrical connector.
4 Remove the driver air bag module.
Navigator
10. Disconnect the driver air bag module.
- Release the 2 tabs on each driver air bag module electrical connector and disconnect them. Label each driver air bag module electrical connector before disconnecting.
11. Release the tab and disconnect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector at
the top of the clockspring and remove the driver air
bag module.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9067
12. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tools to the clockspring electrical connectors at the top of
the steering column.
13. While pushing in on the 2 glove compartment door tabs, position the glove compartment
downward.
14. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the tab and disconnect the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
15. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
Vehicles with safety canopies
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9068
16. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
17. Remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
18. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9069
19. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
20. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide.
21. Remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
22. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9070
23. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the driver side safety
canopy electrical connector.
All vehicles 24. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB. 25. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
Vehicles with safety canopies
3. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the driver side
safety canopy electrical connector.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9071
5. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the driver side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
6. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row driver side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
7. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9072
8. Connect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
9. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
10. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9073
11. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger air
bag module electrical connector.
12. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
13. Close the glove compartment.
14. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tools from the clockspring electrical connector at the
top of the steering column.
Navigator
15. Connect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector to the connector end at the
top of the clockspring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9074
16. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module.
Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the
electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
Expedition
17. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
1 Connect the horn switch electrical connector.
2 CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the
driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal.
3 Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
All vehicles
18. Install the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9075
19. Install the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
20. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
21. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 22. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and
close the cover.
23. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
24. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9076
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Prove Out Procedure
PROVE OUT PROCEDURE
Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the ON position and visually monitor the air bag indicator
with all SRS components connected or restraint system diagnostic tools installed. The air bag
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is
present, the air bag indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator will
need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Air Bag Module
C256
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Air Bag Module > Page 9082
C9006
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Air Bag Module > Page 9083
C9007
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
9084
Air Bag: Description and Operation
Driver Air Bag Module
The driver air bag module: is installed new as an assembly.
- is mounted in the center of the steering wheel.
- cannot be interchanged between Expedition and Navigator vehicles.
Passenger air Bag Module
The passenger air bag module: is installed new as an assembly.
- is mounted in the passenger side of the instrument panel.
- cannot be interchanged between Expedition and Navigator vehicles.
Safety Canopy Module
Some vehicles can be equipped with optional safety canopies for protection during side impacts or
rollovers.
Vehicles equipped with safety canopies require a specific headliner. When installing a new
headliner on a vehicle equipped with safety canopies, make sure a headliner for safety canopies is
being used. The word "AIRBAG" will appear on the headliner where it meets each B-pillar trim
panel.
The safety canopy module: is installed as an assembly.
- is mounted above the headliner.
- attaches from the A-pillar frame to the C-pillar frame.
- is standard equipment on the Navigator and optional on the Expedition.
- cannot be interchanged from side to side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module
Air Bag: Service and Repair Driver Air Bag Module
DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 9087
Navigator
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 9088
All vehicles 1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs. 3. Remove
the 2 driver air bag module bolts.
Expedition 4. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors. 5. Disconnect the horn
switch electrical connector and remove the driver air bag module.
Navigator 6. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors. 7. Disconnect the
steering wheel controls electrical connector at the top of the clockspring and remove the driver air
bag module.
Installation
Navigator 1. Connect the steering wheel controls electrical connector at the top of the clockspring
and remove the driver air bag module.
2. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module.
Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the
electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors and position the driver air bag module to
the steering wheel.
Expedition 3. Connect the horn switch electrical connector.
4. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module.
Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the
electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors and position the driver air bag module to
the steering wheel.
All vehicles
5. NOTE:
- Inspect the driver air bag module back surface and steering wheel sides for any loose
components or objects. Cycle the plate spring and make sure the horn mechanism functions
correctly.
- Make sure to tighten the bolts in 2 stages to prevent horn effort concerns.
While holding the driver air bag module in place, keep it still at the center of the steering wheel and
install the 2 bolts. Stage 1: Tighten the outboard bolt (nearest the driver door) then the inboard bolt to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
- Stage 2: Tighten the outboard bolt and then the inboard bolt to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. CAUTION: If the opening between the driver air bag module trim cover and steering wheel is not
uniform, the horn mechanism may not
function correctly.
Inspect the opening between the driver air bag module trim cover and the steering wheel. If the
opening is not uniform, remove the 2 bolts and carry out the previous step once again.
7. Install the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs. 8. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 9089
Air Bag: Service and Repair Passenger Air Bag Module
PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 9090
Navigator
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the deployment door face down. This will reduce the
risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Air bag modules with discolored or damaged deployment doors must be replaced, not repainted.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 9091
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All vehicles
1. Depower the system. 2. Open and lower glove compartment door. 3. Disconnect the passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
Expedition
4. Remove the 3 air bag module bolts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Navigator
5. Remove the 3 air bag module bolts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
All vehicles
6. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment door.
Reaching one hand into the glove box opening, push out on the passenger air bag module and
remove the passenger air bag module from the instrument panel.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 8. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 9092
Air Bag: Service and Repair Safety Canopy Module
SAFETY CANOPY MODULE
Removal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 9093
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury from an accidental deployment, always carry or place a live
safety canopy module with the safety canopy and tear seam pointed away from your body. Failure
to do so can result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- After deployment, the surface of the safety canopy can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a
product of the gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap
and water afterwards.
- Never probe the connector on the safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety canopy
deployment which can result in personal injury.
- Anytime the safety canopy has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C pillar upper trim
panels and attaching hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and
hardware. Failure to do so can result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy deployment.
- Vehicles equipped with safety canopy modules require a specific headliner. When installing a new
headliner on a vehicle equipped with safety canopy modules, make sure a headliner for safety
canopy modules is being used. The word "AIRBAG" will appear on the headliner where it meets
each B-pillar trim panel. Failure to do so can result in personal injury in the event of a safety
canopy module deployment.
- Before installing the safety canopy module, inspect the roofline for any damage. If necessary, the
sheet metal must be reworked to its original condition and structural integrity. All damaged
fasteners must be replaced and any foreign objects removed. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury in the event of a safety canopy deployment.
- Inspect the safety canopy before installation. If the safety canopy is damaged or the cover has
separated or safety canopy material has been exposed, a new safety canopy module must be
installed. Do not attempt to repair the safety canopy module. Failure to follow these instructions can
result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of injury, do not obstruct or place objects in the deployment path of the safety
canopy module. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury in the event of a
safety canopy module deployment.
- Never put any type of fastener or tie strap around any part of the safety canopy module or interior
trim panel. This will prevent the safety canopy module from deploying correctly. Failure to do so
can result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and perform the diagnostic procedure again.
- Passenger side safety canopy module shown, driver side similar.
All vehicles 1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the headliner.
Vehicles with a moonroof
3. Separate the moonroof drain tube and position to the side.
All vehicles
4. CAUTION: Inspect the rivet nut and A-pillar sheet metal for damage. Install a new rivet nut if
necessary.
Remove the front tether cord bolt and bracket from the A-pillar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 9094
5. NOTE: If not installing a new safety canopy module, the pin-type retainer can remain installed.
Remove the front tether cord and pin-type retainer from the A-pillar.
6. Remove the safety canopy module bolt at the roofline near the A-pillar. 7. Remove the 2 bolts
and slide up and rotate out the rear tether bracket assembly from the C-pillar. 8. Disconnect the
safety canopy module electrical connector. 9. Remove the safety canopy wire harness and
electrical connector pin-type retainers at the C-pillar.
10. Remove the safety canopy module rear ramp bolt. 11. Remove the 3 safety canopy module
canister bolts. 12. Remove the 2 safety canopy module front ramp bolts.
13. Slide the front of the safety canopy up and rotate the hook out of the roofline sheet metal and
remove the safety canopy.
Installation
All vehicles
1. WARNING:
- Before installing the safety canopy module, inspect the roofline for any damage. If necessary, the
sheet metal must be reworked to its original condition and structural integrity. All damaged
fasteners must be replaced and any foreign objects removed. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- Before installing the safety canopy module, if the module is damaged or the cover has separated
or the safety canopy material has been exposed, install a new safety canopy module. Do not
attempt to repair the safety canopy. Failure to follow these instructions could result in personal
injury in the event of a safety canopy deployment.
- Never put any type of fastener or tie strap around any part of the safety canopy module or interior
trim panel. This will prevent the safety canopy module from deploying correctly. Failure to do so
can result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
With the safety canopy module positioned in the vehicle as shown, angle the rear of the safety
canopy module to the sheet metal, so that the deployment canister can be inserted into the sheet
metal opening.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 9095
2. Position the safety canopy and engage the front hook to the roofline sheet metal. 3. Install the
safety canopy module bolt at the roofline near the A-pillar.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 ft-in).
4. Install the 2 safety canopy module front ramp bolts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Install the safety canopy module rear ramp bolt.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
6. Install the 3 safety canopy module canister bolts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
7. Route and install the safety canopy wire harness and electrical connector pin-type retainers at
the C-pillar. 8. Connect the safety canopy electrical connector. 9. Rotate and slide down the rear
tether bracket assembly hook engaging it to the C-pillar sheet metal, then install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
10. Install the front tether cord bolt and bracket to the A-pillar.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
11. Make sure the tether is securely engaged into the pin-type retainer and install the pin-type
retainer to the A-pillar.
- If a new safety canopy module was not installed, route the tether and securely engage it into the
pin-type retainer at the A-pillar.
Vehicles with a moonroof
12. Route and connect the moonroof drain tube.
All vehicles 13. Install the headliner. 14. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9099
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployable
Components (Part 1)
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployable
Components (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9100
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Sensor Components
(Part 1)
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Sensor Components
(Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9101
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9102
C310b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9103
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
WARNING:
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, the RCM must be replaced whether or not the air bags have deployed. In
addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
NOTE: When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM
is being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
The restraints control module (RCM) carries out the following functions:
- deploys the air bag(s) in the event of a deployable crash.
- activates the safety belt buckle pretensioners to remove slack from the safety belt.
- monitors the SRS for faults.
- illuminates the air bag indicator if a fault is detected.
- flashes the air bag indicator to indicate the lamp fault code (LFC) detected.
- communicates through the data link connector (DLC) the current or historical Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTCs).
- signals the instrument cluster module to activate a chime if the air bag indicator is not available
and another SRS fault exists.
The RCM monitors the SRS for possible faults. If a fault is detected while the ignition switch is in
the ON position, the RCM will illuminate the air bag indicator located in the instrument cluster.
When the ignition is cycled (turned OFF and then ON), the air bag indicator will prove out by
lighting for 6 seconds and then off for 2 seconds. After the prove out, the air bag indicator will then
flash the 2-digit LFC. If an SRS fault exists, the air bag indicator will flash the LFC 5 times, then it
will remain illuminated for the rest of the key cycle. The RCM will also communicate the current and
historical DTCs through the DLC, to the diagnostic tool. If the air bag indicator does not function,
and the system detects a fault condition, the RCM will signal the instrument cluster module to
activate an audible chime. The chime is a series of 5 sets of 5 tone bursts. If the chime is heard,
the SRS and the air bag indicator require repair.
LFCs are prioritized. If 2 or more faults occur at the same time, the fault having the highest priority
will be displayed. After that fault has been corrected, the next highest priority fault will be displayed.
The RCM includes a backup power supply. This feature provides sufficient backup power to deploy
the front air bags and safety belt pretensioners in the event that the ignition circuit is lost or
damaged during impact. The backup power supply will deplete its stored energy approximately one
minute after the battery ground cable is disconnected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9104
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
Vehicles With A Center Console
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9105
Vehicles With 60/40 Front Bench Seat
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for proper air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) operation. If a vehicle equipped with an SRS system has been involved in a collision
in which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, the RCM must be replaced whether or not the air bags have deployed. In
addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage can result.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM is
being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9106
1. Depower the system.
Vehicles with a center console 2. Remove the center console.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat 3. Remove the 60 percent portion of the front bench seat. 4.
Remove the 3 nuts and the restraints control module (RCM) top bracket.
5. WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the
RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal injury.
Remove the 3 nuts and separate the RCM from the bracket.
All vehicles
6. Disconnect the small restraints control module (RCM) electrical connector.
1 Push down to release the retaining tab.
2 While releasing the retaining tab, pull out and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
7. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1 Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever away from the RCM,
disengaging the lever.
2 Pull out and disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat 8. Remove the RCM.
Vehicles with a center console 9. Remove the 4 RCM bracket bolts and RCM with the bracket.
Installation
Vehicles with a center console
1. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag restraints control module (RCM) bracket
retaining bolts is critical for correct system
operation.
Position the RCM with bracket and install the 4 bolts. Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9107
All vehicles
2. Make sure the connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before attempting
to connect the connector.
3. CAUTION: Putting the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM on an angle can cause bad
electrical connections and damage
components.
Position the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM.
- CAUTION: Do not push the connector on to where the lever pivots and seats itself. Light pressure
is needed to get the connector into position on the RCM before using the lever to fully seat the
connector.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9108
4. Connect the RCM electrical connector.
- Pivot the connector position assurance lever toward the RCM, drawing the connector in to the
RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat
6. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag restraints control module (RCM) to bracket
retaining nuts is critical for correct system
operation.
Position the RCM to the bracket and install the 3 nuts. Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
7. Position the RCM top bracket and install the nuts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Vehicles with a center console 8. Install the center console.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat 9. Install the 60 percent portion of the front bench seat.
All vehicles 10. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Diagrams
C218a
C218b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9112
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Description and Operation
CLOCKSPRING
The clockspring:
- is mounted on the steering column, behind the steering wheel.
- allows for continuous electrical connections between the driver air bag module and the restraints
control module (RCM) when the steering wheel is turned.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9113
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service and Repair
CLOCKSPRING
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and perform the diagnostic procedure again.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9114
1. Depower the system.
2. CAUTION: Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
Remove the steering wheel.
3. Apply 2 strips of masking tape across the clockspring to prevent accidental rotation when the
clockspring is removed.
4. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 5. From under the steering column, remove the 2 screws and the lower steering column
shroud.
6. From under the steering column remove the screw and then remove the upper steering column
shroud. 7. Remove the multi-function switch screw. 8. While releasing the retaining tab on the top,
slide the multi-function switch up and out of the way. 9. Remove the screws and slide the
clockspring off the steering column shaft.
10. Disconnect the clockspring electrical connectors and remove the clockspring. 11. Inspect the
clockspring bracket for damage and remove as necessary.
Installation
Vehicles receiving a new clockspring bracket 1. Install the clockspring bracket and screws.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
Vehicles receiving a new clockspring
2. NOTE: A new clockspring is supplied in a centralized position and held there with a key.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9115
Remove the key from the clockspring, holding the rotor in its centralized position. Do not allow the clockspring rotor to turn.
Vehicles needing clockspring recentering
3. WARNING: Incorrect centralization may result in premature component failure. If in doubt when
centralizing the clockspring, repeat
the centralizing procedure. Failure to follow this instruction may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
NOTE: If a clockspring has rotated out of center, follow through with this step.
Centralize the clockspring. 1
Hold the clockspring outer housing stationary.
2 CAUTION: Overturning will destroy the clockspring. The internal ribbon wire acts as the stop and
can be broken from its internal connection.
While turning the rotor counterclockwise, carefully feel for the ribbon wire to run out of length. Stop
turning when a slight resistance is felt.
3 Turn the clockspring clockwise approximately 2.75 turns. This is the center point of the
clockspring. Do not allow the rotor to turn from this position.
All vehicles 4. Connect the clockspring electrical connectors.
5. NOTE: Slight turning of the clockspring rotor is allowable for alignment purposes to the steering
column.
With the flats of the clockspring aligned to the flats of the steering column, slide the clockspring
onto the steering column and install the screws.
Vehicle repairs using the same clockspring 6. Remove the tape applied during clockspring removal.
All vehicles 7. Align the multi-function switch and slide it down into position and make sure the
retaining tab is engaged. 8. Install the multi-function switch screw. 9. Position the upper steering
column shroud, and from under the steering column, install the screw.
10. Position the lower steering column shroud and install the 2 screws. 11. If equipped, reposition
the gear selector cover to the steering column shrouds and engage the tabs.
12. CAUTION: If the vehicle is left unattended by the technician between centralizing the
clockspring and installing the steering wheel, the
centralizing procedure must be repeated.
Install the steering wheel.
13. Install the driver air bag module. 14. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Forward Crash Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9120
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9121
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9122
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9123
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Forward Crash Sensor
C177
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9126
C539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9127
C631
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9128
C9004
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9129
C9005
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 9130
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation
SENSORS
WARNING:
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, the RCM must be replaced whether or not the air bags have deployed. In
addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
For these vehicles, the SRS uses up to 8 sensors. Within the RCM there can be up to 3 safing
sensors which are not separately serviced. The RCM will always have at least 1 safing sensor for
front impact. Two more safing sensors are used if the vehicle is equipped with safety canopy
modules. The RCM is mounted to the center tunnel beneath the console or bench seat. All vehicles
will have a front impact severity sensor that is located in the front-center of the vehicle, mounted
near the bottom of the hood latch support bracket. If the vehicle is equipped with safety canopy
modules, there are 4 additional side impact sensors external to the RCM. One front row side
impact sensor is located behind each of the front door interior trim panels. One second row side
impact sensor is located at the base of each C-pillar. Mounting orientation is critical for correct
operation of all impact and rollover sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
FRONT IMPACT SEVERITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for proper system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and properly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Front bumper removed for clarity.
1. Depower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 9133
2. NOTE: The front impact severity sensor is mounted on the bottom of the hood latch support
bracket.
Remove the pin-type retainers and lower the front lower splash shield to access the front impact
severity sensor.
3. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag front impact severity sensor retaining nut is
critical for correct system operation.
CAUTION: If the hood latch support bracket or weld stud are damaged in any way that would affect
the way the front impact severity sensor mounts to its original manufactured position, a new hood
latch support bracket must be installed.
NOTE: Note the position of the front impact severity sensor locator tabs to the hood latch support bracket
alignment holes for installation.
- Make sure the hood latch support bracket and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are
clean and debris free.
Remove the front impact severity sensor nut. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft)
4. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the front impact severity sensor. 5. To install,
reverse the removal procedure. 6. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 9134
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - C-PILLAR
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 9135
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and perform the diagnostic procedure again.
- Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Lift to release and remove the rear door scuff plate. 3. Remove the
safety belt retractor anchor bolt. 4. Pull out at the front of the rear quarter trim panel, releasing the
retaining clips, allowing access to the side impact sensor. 5. Remove the side impact sensor bolt.
6. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector and remove the sensor and bracket.
Installation
1. Make sure the second row side impact sensor tabs are aligned to the bracket. 2. Position the
side impact sensor and bracket locator pin to the opening in the quarter panel sheet metal and
install the bolt.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
3. Connect the side impact sensor electrical connector. 4. Align the rear quarter trim panel and
push in, seating the retaining clips.
5. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the safety belt retractor anchor bolt. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
6. Install the rear door scuff plate. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 9136
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for proper system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and properly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the front interior door trim panel on the side with the affected
side impact sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 9137
3. Separate the weathershield enough to access the side impact sensor. 4. Disconnect the side
impact sensor electrical connector.
5. WARNING: The tightening torque of the side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for correct
system operation.
CAUTION: The ground wire must be placed between the bolt head and the sensor. Never position the ground
wire between the J-clip retaining nut and the sensor.
- Always replace the J-clip retaining nut whenever installing a side impact sensor.
NOTE: Make sure the side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign material.
- Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tabs for installation.
Remove the bolt and the side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9142
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployable
Components (Part 1)
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployable
Components (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9143
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Sensor Components
(Part 1)
Air Bag And Safety Belt Pretensioner Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Sensor Components
(Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9144
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9145
C310b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9146
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
WARNING:
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, the RCM must be replaced whether or not the air bags have deployed. In
addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
NOTE: When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM
is being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
The restraints control module (RCM) carries out the following functions:
- deploys the air bag(s) in the event of a deployable crash.
- activates the safety belt buckle pretensioners to remove slack from the safety belt.
- monitors the SRS for faults.
- illuminates the air bag indicator if a fault is detected.
- flashes the air bag indicator to indicate the lamp fault code (LFC) detected.
- communicates through the data link connector (DLC) the current or historical Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTCs).
- signals the instrument cluster module to activate a chime if the air bag indicator is not available
and another SRS fault exists.
The RCM monitors the SRS for possible faults. If a fault is detected while the ignition switch is in
the ON position, the RCM will illuminate the air bag indicator located in the instrument cluster.
When the ignition is cycled (turned OFF and then ON), the air bag indicator will prove out by
lighting for 6 seconds and then off for 2 seconds. After the prove out, the air bag indicator will then
flash the 2-digit LFC. If an SRS fault exists, the air bag indicator will flash the LFC 5 times, then it
will remain illuminated for the rest of the key cycle. The RCM will also communicate the current and
historical DTCs through the DLC, to the diagnostic tool. If the air bag indicator does not function,
and the system detects a fault condition, the RCM will signal the instrument cluster module to
activate an audible chime. The chime is a series of 5 sets of 5 tone bursts. If the chime is heard,
the SRS and the air bag indicator require repair.
LFCs are prioritized. If 2 or more faults occur at the same time, the fault having the highest priority
will be displayed. After that fault has been corrected, the next highest priority fault will be displayed.
The RCM includes a backup power supply. This feature provides sufficient backup power to deploy
the front air bags and safety belt pretensioners in the event that the ignition circuit is lost or
damaged during impact. The backup power supply will deplete its stored energy approximately one
minute after the battery ground cable is disconnected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9147
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
Vehicles With A Center Console
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9148
Vehicles With 60/40 Front Bench Seat
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for proper air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) operation. If a vehicle equipped with an SRS system has been involved in a collision
in which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, the RCM must be replaced whether or not the air bags have deployed. In
addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage can result.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM is
being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9149
1. Depower the system.
Vehicles with a center console 2. Remove the center console.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat 3. Remove the 60 percent portion of the front bench seat. 4.
Remove the 3 nuts and the restraints control module (RCM) top bracket.
5. WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the
RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal injury.
Remove the 3 nuts and separate the RCM from the bracket.
All vehicles
6. Disconnect the small restraints control module (RCM) electrical connector.
1 Push down to release the retaining tab.
2 While releasing the retaining tab, pull out and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
7. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1 Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever away from the RCM,
disengaging the lever.
2 Pull out and disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat 8. Remove the RCM.
Vehicles with a center console 9. Remove the 4 RCM bracket bolts and RCM with the bracket.
Installation
Vehicles with a center console
1. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag restraints control module (RCM) bracket
retaining bolts is critical for correct system
operation.
Position the RCM with bracket and install the 4 bolts. Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9150
All vehicles
2. Make sure the connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before attempting
to connect the connector.
3. CAUTION: Putting the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM on an angle can cause bad
electrical connections and damage
components.
Position the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM.
- CAUTION: Do not push the connector on to where the lever pivots and seats itself. Light pressure
is needed to get the connector into position on the RCM before using the lever to fully seat the
connector.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9151
4. Connect the RCM electrical connector.
- Pivot the connector position assurance lever toward the RCM, drawing the connector in to the
RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat
6. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag restraints control module (RCM) to bracket
retaining nuts is critical for correct system
operation.
Position the RCM to the bracket and install the 3 nuts. Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
7. Position the RCM top bracket and install the nuts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Vehicles with a center console 8. Install the center console.
Vehicles with 60/40 front bench seat 9. Install the 60 percent portion of the front bench seat.
All vehicles 10. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Control Module: > 05-22-17 > Nov >
05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
Seat Belt Control Module: Customer Interest Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Control Module: > 05-22-17 > Nov >
05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 9160
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: >
05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
Seat Belt Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder'
Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: >
05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 9166
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety
canopy deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a seat mounted side air bag and/or a safety belt pretensioner (if equipped)
system is being serviced, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central junction
box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover and
remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and close
the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9172
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety canopy
module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9173
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central
junction box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover
and remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Remove the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
8. Remove the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9174
9. Remove the driver air bag module.
1 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
2 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
3 Disconnect the horn switch electrical connector.
4 Remove the driver air bag module.
Navigator
10. Disconnect the driver air bag module.
- Release the 2 tabs on each driver air bag module electrical connector and disconnect them. Label each driver air bag module electrical connector before disconnecting.
11. Release the tab and disconnect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector at
the top of the clockspring and remove the driver air
bag module.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9175
12. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tools to the clockspring electrical connectors at the top of
the steering column.
13. While pushing in on the 2 glove compartment door tabs, position the glove compartment
downward.
14. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the tab and disconnect the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
15. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
Vehicles with safety canopies
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9176
16. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
17. Remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
18. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9177
19. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
20. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide.
21. Remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
22. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9178
23. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the driver side safety
canopy electrical connector.
All vehicles 24. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB. 25. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
Vehicles with safety canopies
3. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the driver side
safety canopy electrical connector.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9179
5. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the driver side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
6. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row driver side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
7. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9180
8. Connect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
9. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
10. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9181
11. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger air
bag module electrical connector.
12. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
13. Close the glove compartment.
14. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tools from the clockspring electrical connector at the
top of the steering column.
Navigator
15. Connect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector to the connector end at the
top of the clockspring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9182
16. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module.
Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the
electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
Expedition
17. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
1 Connect the horn switch electrical connector.
2 CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the
driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal.
3 Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
All vehicles
18. Install the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9183
19. Install the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
20. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
21. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 22. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and
close the cover.
23. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
24. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 9184
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Prove Out Procedure
PROVE OUT PROCEDURE
Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the ON position and visually monitor the air bag indicator
with all SRS components connected or restraint system diagnostic tools installed. The air bag
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is
present, the air bag indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator will
need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Description and Operation
Attaching Safety Seats With Tether Straps
Some manufacturers make child safety seats that include a tether strap that goes over the back of
the vehicle seat and attaches to an anchoring point. Other manufacturers offer the tether strap as
an accessory. Contact the manufacturer of the child safety seat for information about ordering a
tether strap.
Child safety seat tether anchors are manufactured into the vehicle. See the active restraint system
component location at the beginning or the owner's literature for locations.
For removal and installation of child safety seat tether anchors, refer to the appropriate procedure
or Seats for seat cushion frame replacement.
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)
The lower anchors and tethers for children (LATCH) system is a standardized and uniform
attachment system for installing child safety seats in passenger vehicles. LATCH-equipped child
safety seats have 2 lower attachments that connect to the vehicle portion of the LATCH system.
The vehicle portion of the system consists of 2 attachment points (6 mm wires) welded to the rear
seat cushion frame. The attachment points protrude from the bite line between the seat cushion
and seat backrest.
If a child safety seat was in use during a collision, inspect the vehicle portion of the system for
damage. If any of the attachment points (6 mm wires) are damaged, install a new seat cushion
frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 9189
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Service and Repair
CHILD SAFETY SEAT TETHER ANCHOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Position the third row seat backrest downward.
2. Release the seat back J-clips.
3. With the seat backrest trim cover and cushion positioned aside, remove the nut, bolt and the
tether anchor.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. WARNING: It is important that the bolt/anchor be securely tightened to specification. Otherwise,
the child's safety seat may not be
correctly secured and the child could be injured in case of a sudden stop or accident.
NOTE: Inspect the seat for damage. If the seat is found to be damaged, install new seat
components.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Seat Belt: Description and Operation
FASTENING SAFETY BELTS
WARNING: Do not introduce slack into the safety belt system because the belt locks upon impact
where it is positioned. Use the shoulder safety belt on the outside shoulder only. Never wear the
shoulder safety belt under the arm. Never swing the shoulder safety belt around the neck over the
inside shoulder. Never use a single belt for more than one person. Make sure the lap portion of the
belt is fitted snugly and as low as possible around the hips, not the waist. Failure to follow these
precautions could increase the chance and severity of injury in a collision.
Always follow the preceding safety precautions when fastening the safety belts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Safety Belt Cleaning
Seat Belt: Service and Repair Safety Belt Cleaning
SAFETY BELT CLEANING
1. WARNING: Do not bleach or re-dye the webbing, as the webbing may weaken.
Clean the safety belt webbing only with a mild soap solution recommended for cleaning upholstery
or carpets. Follow the instructions provided with the soap.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Safety Belt Cleaning > Page 9195
Seat Belt: Service and Repair Safety Belt Twisted At the Safety Belt Guide - Outboard
SAFETY BELT TWISTED AT THE SAFETY BELT GUIDE - OUTBOARD
1. Straighten the twisted belt webbing.
1 Grasp webbing at the safety belt guide.
2 Feed twisted portion of webbing up through safety belt guide.
2. Pull straightened belt downward to check for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Safety Belt Cleaning > Page 9196
Seat Belt: Service and Repair Safety Belt Tongue Rotated on Belt
SAFETY BELT TONGUE ROTATED ON BELT
1. Fold the safety belt as indicated.
2. Pull the safety belt tongue over the fold in the safety belt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Safety Belt Cleaning > Page 9197
Seat Belt: Service and Repair Safety Belt - Front, Center
SAFETY BELT - FRONT, CENTER
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Remove the cover. 2. Remove the bolt and route the safety belt out from the seat.
1 To install, tighten to 43 Nm (32 lb-ft).
3. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- When installing, make sure the safety belt anchor is on top of the seat bracket.
- Make sure the safety belt is accessible to the occupant after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Buckle: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER
NOTE: There is currently no restraint system diagnostic tool for the safety belt buckle pretensioner
under the seat connectors. If the ignition switch is turned to the ON or START position with the
safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector(s) disconnected, the DTC and flagged faults for
an open circuit will be activated.
The safety belt buckle and pretensioners are for the front outboard occupants, located on the
inboard side of the seats. This allows the front safety belt buckle end to move with the front seat.
The safety belt buckle and pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device that removes excess webbing from
the safety belt system. When the front air bag system is deployed, the pretensioner in the buckle
deploys, causing the buckle to move downward, pulling excess webbing from the lap and shoulder
safety belts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - FRONT CENTER SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Remove the cover. 2. Remove the bolt and route the safety belt buckle out of the seat.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- Make sure the safety belt buckle is accessible to the occupant after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9203
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Remove the second row 20 percent seat.
2. NOTE: It may be necessary to fold the seat to remove the side shield.
Remove the 2 screws and the pin-type retainer (not shown) and remove the inboard side shield.
3. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
seat frame.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9204
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 40 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - SECOND ROW, 40 PERCENT SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE: RH 40 percent seat shown, LH similar.
1. Pivot the 40 percent seat upward. 2. Remove the 2 screws and the seat side shield. 3. Remove
the screw and the lower pedestal cover. 4. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. NOTE: When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
seat frame.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9205
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 40 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - THIRD ROW, 40 PERCENT SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Remove the third row seat. 2. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. NOTE:
- When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the sheet
metal.
- Make sure the safety belt buckle is accessible to the passenger after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9206
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair
Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - FRONT CENTER SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Remove the cover. 2. Remove the bolt and route the safety belt buckle out of the seat.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- Make sure the safety belt buckle is accessible to the occupant after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT SEAT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9207
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Remove the second row 20 percent seat.
2. NOTE: It may be necessary to fold the seat to remove the side shield.
Remove the 2 screws and the pin-type retainer (not shown) and remove the inboard side shield.
3. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
seat frame.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 40 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - SECOND ROW, 40 PERCENT SEAT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9208
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE: RH 40 percent seat shown, LH similar.
1. Pivot the 40 percent seat upward. 2. Remove the 2 screws and the seat side shield. 3. Remove
the screw and the lower pedestal cover. 4. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. NOTE: When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
seat frame.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 40 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - THIRD ROW, 40 PERCENT SEAT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9209
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Remove the third row seat. 2. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. NOTE:
- When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the sheet
metal.
- Make sure the safety belt buckle is accessible to the passenger after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 60 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - THIRD ROW, 60 PERCENT SEAT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9210
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Remove the rear load floor panel. 2. Remove the mid-floor panel support.
- Remove the jack assembly.
- Remove the 2 pin-type retainers (not shown).
- Remove the 2 bolts.
- Position the load floor panels up, lift on the front of the mid-floor panel support to release the 3
retaining clips (not shown) and remove the support panel.
3. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle assembly.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. NOTE:
- When installing the safety belt buckle assembly, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
sheet metal.
- Make sure the safety belt buckles are accessible to the passengers after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
40 Percent Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9211
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER - 40 PERCENT SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
- All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped, buckles,
shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching
hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed
unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt
assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if
either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase the
risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- LH shown, RH similar.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3. Remove the 40
percent front seat.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9212
4. Release the hook-and-loop strip and pull the seat cushion trim cover up enough to expose the
safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
5. NOTE: Make note of the wire harness routing for installation.
Remove the safety belt buckle and pretensioner electrical connectors from the seat cushion frame.
Disconnect the usage detection switch electrical connector.
- Separate the safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector from the pin-type retainer.
6. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 8. Install the 40 percent front seat. 9. Repower the
SRS.
10. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
60 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER - 60 PERCENT SEAT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9213
Removal
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
- All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped, buckles,
shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching
hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed
unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt
assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if
either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase the
risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3. Remove the 60
percent front seat.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Front Center Seat > Page 9214
4. NOTE: Make note of the wire harness routing for installation.
Detach the electrical connectors and route out the wire harnesses.
5. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner assembly.
Installation
1. Install the safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
1 Position the safety belt buckle and pretensioner to the seat. Align the safety belt buckle and pretensioner locator tab to the hole in the seat frame.
- Check that the safety belt buckle end is accessible after positioning.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Route the safety belt buckle and pretensioner usage detection switch and pretensioner electrical
connectors as noted in removal.
2. Attach the electrical connectors and route the wire harnesses as noted in removal. 3. Install the
60 percent front seat. 4. Repower the SRS. 5. Check the active restraint system for correct
operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger
View 151-17 (RH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger > Page 9219
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver
C3065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver > Page 9222
C3066
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 9223
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE SWITCHES
As part of the supplemental restraint system (SRS), the driver and front outboard passenger safety
belt buckles are equipped with safety belt buckle switches. The safety belt buckle switches indicate
to the restraints control module (RCM) whether the safety belts are connected or disconnected.
The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage driver and
passenger air bag modules.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Control Module: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot
Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
Seat Belt Control Module: Customer Interest Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Control Module: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot
Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 9232
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
Seat Belt Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder'
Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 9238
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Extension > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Extension: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT EXTENSION ASSEMBLY
In certain cases, the safety belt may be too short, even when it is fully extended. About 20 cm (8 in)
can be added to the belt length by using a safety belt extension. Safety belt extensions are
available through any Ford or Lincoln Mercury dealer parts department at no cost. Safety belt
extensions are only available with black webbing. There are 2 extension assemblies available, one
for the front seating positions and one for the rear seating positions. They are not interchangeable.
Only use extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the safety belt. Manufacturer
identification is located at the end of the webbing on the label. Also, use the safety belt extension
only if the safety belt is too short for you when fully extended. Do not use the extension to change
the fit of the shoulder belt across the torso.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Shoulder Height Adjuster With Stripped Weld Nuts
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair Safety Belt Shoulder Height Adjuster With Stripped
Weld Nuts
SAFETY BELT SHOULDER HEIGHT ADJUSTER WITH STRIPPED WELD NUTS
1. Remove the B-pillar trim panel.
2. Use the half-inch drill with integral stop to drill out the damaged threads in the upper pillar
structure.
3. NOTE: After each rotation, back off tap slightly to remove new cuttings and be sure to blow out
any chips before proceeding.
Apply a suitable lubricant to the M14 x 1.5 tap with integral stop and tap new threads.
4. Use a threaded insert and screw it into the retapped hole until it is slightly below the surface.
5. Use a hammer to lightly tap the installation tool several times to seat the insert keys. 6. If the
bolt(s) on the height adjuster is not stripped, reinstall the original safety belt shoulder height
adjuster. If the bolt(s) is stripped, install a new
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Shoulder Height Adjuster With Stripped Weld Nuts > Page 9246
safety belt shoulder height adjuster.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Shoulder Height Adjuster With Stripped Weld Nuts > Page 9247
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair Safety Belt Shoulder Height Adjuster - Front Row
SAFETY BELT SHOULDER HEIGHT ADJUSTER - FRONT ROW
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Shoulder Height Adjuster With Stripped Weld Nuts > Page 9248
1. NOTE:
- Position the safety belt guide to the lowest position.
- Inspect the D-ring cover for damage. If the cover is damaged or does not remain closed install a
new D-ring cover.
Open the D-ring cover.
2. Remove the nut and the D-ring.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel.
- Remove the bolt cover and the bolt. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (11 lb-ft).
- Release the clips and slide the upper B-pillar panel downward.
4. Remove the safety belt shoulder height adjuster trim cover. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and the safety
belt shoulder height adjuster.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
6. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- When installing the upper B-pillar trim panel, insert the safety belt guide slide into the upper
B-pillar trim panel.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Shoulder Height Adjuster With Stripped Weld Nuts > Page 9249
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair Safety Belt Shoulder Height Adjuster - Second Row
SAFETY BELT SHOULDER HEIGHT ADJUSTER - SECOND ROW
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Shoulder Height Adjuster With Stripped Weld Nuts > Page 9250
1. NOTE: Inspect the D-ring cover for damage. If the cover is damaged or does not remain closed,
install a new D-ring cover.
Open the D-ring cover.
2. Remove the nut and the D-ring.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the C-pillar trim panel.
- Separate the weatherstripping along the C-pillar trim panel.
- Remove the bolt cover and bolt. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (11 lb-ft).
- Pull out to release the retainers and remove the C-pillar trim panel.
4. Remove the safety belt height adjuster cover. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and the safety belt shoulder
height adjuster.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Buzzer > Component Information
> Description and Operation
Seat Belt Reminder Buzzer: Description and Operation
Warning System - Driver Safety Belt
The driver safety belt incorporates a safety belt warning indicator switch, warning indicator and
chime. The warning indicator and chime are reminders to fasten the safety belt. If the driver safety belt is not buckled before the ignition key is turned to ON, the safety belt warning
light illuminates for 1 to 2 minutes and the warning chime sounds for 4 to 8 seconds.
- If the driver side safety belt is buckled while the indicator light is illuminated and the warning
chime is sounding, the safety belt warning light and warning chime turn OFF.
- If the safety belt is buckled before the key is turned to the ON position, the warning indicator will
come on for 4 to 8 seconds with no chime.
Belt Minder (if equipped)
The Belt Minder feature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt warning function. This feature
provides additional reminders to the driver that the driver's safety belt is unbuckled by intermittently
sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster.
To activate or deactivate the Belt Minder feature, refer to Seat Belt Systems or the owner's
literature.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Description and Operation
Warning System - Driver Safety Belt
The driver safety belt incorporates a safety belt warning indicator switch, warning indicator and
chime. The warning indicator and chime are reminders to fasten the safety belt. If the driver safety belt is not buckled before the ignition key is turned to ON, the safety belt warning
light illuminates for 1 to 2 minutes and the warning chime sounds for 4 to 8 seconds.
- If the driver side safety belt is buckled while the indicator light is illuminated and the warning
chime is sounding, the safety belt warning light and warning chime turn OFF.
- If the safety belt is buckled before the key is turned to the ON position, the warning indicator will
come on for 4 to 8 seconds with no chime.
Belt Minder (if equipped)
The Belt Minder feature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt warning function. This feature
provides additional reminders to the driver that the driver's safety belt is unbuckled by intermittently
sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster.
To activate or deactivate the Belt Minder feature, refer to Seat Belt Systems or the owner's
literature.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Retractor: > 05-16-11 > Aug > 05 > Restraints - Seat Belts
Slow to Retract
Seat Belt Retractor: Customer Interest Restraints - Seat Belts Slow to Retract
TSB 05-16-11
08/22/05
SAFETY BELT RETRACTION SPEED
FORD: 2000-2003 Mustang 2000-2006 Crown Victoria, Taurus 2000-2003 Explorer Sport,
Windstar 2000-2005 Excursion, Explorer 2000-2006 E-Series, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Ranger 2001-2005 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2006 Escape 2004-2006 Freestar 2005-2006 Escape
Hybrid 2004-2006 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 2000-2002 Continental 2000-2006 LS, Town Car, Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2006 Grand Marquis 2000-2005 Mountaineer 2004-2006
Monterey 2005-2006 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 04-24-21 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE A service kit is now available to improve safety belt retraction speed.
ACTION See the part application chart and select the appropriate kit. Follow the Instruction Sheet
included in the kit. Refer to Workshop Manual Section 501-20A for additional information.
NOTE
TEFLON TAPE SHOULD ONLY BE USED ON THE FRONT ROW SEATS FOR VEHICLES
LISTED IN THIS TSB, WITH THE EXCEPTION OF THE AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR AND THE
MOUNTAINEER. TEFLON TAPE CAN ALSO BE USED ON SECOND ROW SEATS FOR THESE
THREE VEHICLES.
NOTE
FOR MUSTANG, AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR AND MOUNTAINEER, REFER TO THE
FOLLOWING BUILD DATE INFORMATION BEFORE PERFORMING THIS TSB. TEFLON TAPE
HAS ALREADY BEEN INSTALLED DURING PRODUCTION ON SOME OF THESE VEHICLES.
^ MUSTANG: Only install on vehicles built through 6/15/2003. Teflon tape was already installed on
vehicles built on/after 6/16/2003.
^ AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR/MOUNTAINEER (FRONT ROW SEATS): Only install on vehicles
built through 6/24/2004. Teflon tape was already installed on vehicles built on/after 6/25/2004.
^ AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR/MOUNTAINEER (SECOND ROW SEATS): Only install on vehicles
built through 10/21/2004. Teflon tape was already installed on vehicles built on/after 10/22/2004.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Retractor: > 05-16-11 > Aug > 05 > Restraints - Seat Belts
Slow to Retract > Page 9265
Parts Block
NOTE
THE LABOR OPERATIONS WITHIN THIS TSB CAN BE CLAIMED IN COMBINATION AS
NEEDED TO COVER THE REQUIRED REPAIRS.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
051611A Install Teflon Tape B 0.8 Hr.
Pillars Both Sides (Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim Panels If Necessary)
051611B Install Teflon Tape C 1.1 Hrs.
Pillars Both Sides (Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim Panels And Seats If Necessary)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
70611B08 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Retractor: > 05-16-11 > Aug > 05 > Restraints Seat Belts Slow to Retract
Seat Belt Retractor: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Seat Belts Slow to Retract
TSB 05-16-11
08/22/05
SAFETY BELT RETRACTION SPEED
FORD: 2000-2003 Mustang 2000-2006 Crown Victoria, Taurus 2000-2003 Explorer Sport,
Windstar 2000-2005 Excursion, Explorer 2000-2006 E-Series, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Ranger 2001-2005 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2006 Escape 2004-2006 Freestar 2005-2006 Escape
Hybrid 2004-2006 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 2000-2002 Continental 2000-2006 LS, Town Car, Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2006 Grand Marquis 2000-2005 Mountaineer 2004-2006
Monterey 2005-2006 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 04-24-21 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE A service kit is now available to improve safety belt retraction speed.
ACTION See the part application chart and select the appropriate kit. Follow the Instruction Sheet
included in the kit. Refer to Workshop Manual Section 501-20A for additional information.
NOTE
TEFLON TAPE SHOULD ONLY BE USED ON THE FRONT ROW SEATS FOR VEHICLES
LISTED IN THIS TSB, WITH THE EXCEPTION OF THE AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR AND THE
MOUNTAINEER. TEFLON TAPE CAN ALSO BE USED ON SECOND ROW SEATS FOR THESE
THREE VEHICLES.
NOTE
FOR MUSTANG, AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR AND MOUNTAINEER, REFER TO THE
FOLLOWING BUILD DATE INFORMATION BEFORE PERFORMING THIS TSB. TEFLON TAPE
HAS ALREADY BEEN INSTALLED DURING PRODUCTION ON SOME OF THESE VEHICLES.
^ MUSTANG: Only install on vehicles built through 6/15/2003. Teflon tape was already installed on
vehicles built on/after 6/16/2003.
^ AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR/MOUNTAINEER (FRONT ROW SEATS): Only install on vehicles
built through 6/24/2004. Teflon tape was already installed on vehicles built on/after 6/25/2004.
^ AVIATOR, EXPLORER 4DR/MOUNTAINEER (SECOND ROW SEATS): Only install on vehicles
built through 10/21/2004. Teflon tape was already installed on vehicles built on/after 10/22/2004.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Retractor: > 05-16-11 > Aug > 05 > Restraints Seat Belts Slow to Retract > Page 9271
Parts Block
NOTE
THE LABOR OPERATIONS WITHIN THIS TSB CAN BE CLAIMED IN COMBINATION AS
NEEDED TO COVER THE REQUIRED REPAIRS.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
051611A Install Teflon Tape B 0.8 Hr.
Pillars Both Sides (Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim Panels If Necessary)
051611B Install Teflon Tape C 1.1 Hrs.
Pillars Both Sides (Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim Panels And Seats If Necessary)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
70611B08 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9272
Seat Belt Retractor: Description and Operation
Dual Locking Mode Retractors
WARNING: After any vehicle collision, the safety belt system at all outboard seating positions
(except driver, which has no "automatic locking retractor" feature) must be checked by a qualified
technician to verify that the "automatic locking retractor" feature for child seats is still functioning
correctly, in addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and
retractor assembly must be installed if the safety belt assembly's "automatic locking retractor"
feature or any other safety belt function is not operating correctly when checked according to the
procedures. Failure to install a new Belt and Retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in
collisions.
NOTE: When replacing a dual locking mode retractor, the retractor should be checked to make
sure it is not in the automatic locking retractor (ALR) mode after installation in the stowed position.
All outboard continuous-loop, 3-point retractor systems, except the driver position, are equipped
with the dual locking mode system.
The emergency locking retractor (ELR) mode will allow the occupant freedom of movement, locking
tight only on hard braking, hard cornering, or an impact of approximately 8 km/h (5 mph). The ELR
mode helps to reduce the forward movement of the driver and passengers. The ELR mode is
continuously in operation at all seating positions.
The ALR portion of this system does not allow the occupant freedom of movement. The ALR mode
is used when locking a child seat in at a seating position or when a tight belt fit is desired. The ALR
mode is automatically engaged when the webbing is fully extracted from the retractor and then
allowed to retract. As the webbing is retracted back onto the spool, an audible clicking sound is
made, indicating that the retractor is in ALR mode. The ALR mode is automatically disengaged
when most of the webbing is retracted back onto the spool.
The automatic locking mode must be used when installing a child safety seat in the front or rear
passenger seating positions where dual locking mode retractors are provided.
Energy Management Retractor
This vehicle has a safety belt system with an energy management feature at the front seating
positions to help further reduce the risk of injury in the event of a head-on collision.
The energy management retractor feature is designed to pay out webbing in a controlled manner.
This feature is designed to help reduce the belt force acting on the occupant's chest.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row,
Outboard
SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - SECOND ROW AND THIRD ROW, OUTBOARD
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's "automatic locking retractor" feature or any other
safety belt function is not operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection
procedures. Failure to install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in
collisions.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard > Page 9275
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Both retractors
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
Second row retractor
2. Remove the bolt and the safety belt retractor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Third row retractor
3. Remove the bolt and the safety belt retractor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Both retractors
4. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- Before installing the third row safety belt anchor, make sure the floor slotted plastic insert is still
present. If it is not, another insert must be installed.
- When installing the safety belt retractor, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the sheet
metal.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard > Page 9276
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Rear Center Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row
REAR CENTER SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - SECOND ROW
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard > Page 9277
Part 2
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's "automatic locking retractor" feature or any other
safety belt function is not operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection
procedures. Failure to install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in
collisions.
NOTE: The retractor may be equipped with an additional web stop button (small, thin, round button,
not to be confused with the larger web stop button) located on the safety belt webbing. This button
is only used for vehicle assembly and serves no other functional purpose. The button can possibly
be retracted under the trim bezel making it difficult to pull the safety belt webbing out of the
retractor. To service, remove this web stop button. Do not install a new safety belt retractor to
eliminate this condition. Any resulting appearance concerns with the webbing can be worked out by
hand.
1. Remove the second row 20 percent seat. 2. Remove the 2 screws on the inside of the RH side
shield. 3. Release the pin-type retainer and remove the RH side shields. 4. Remove the 2 screws
on the inside of the LH side shield. 5. Release the pin-type retainer and remove the LH side
shields. 6. Remove the screw and the left hinge side shield. 7. Unsnap the recliner pull strap
handle and pull the handle through the seat. 8. Remove the bolt and the safety belt retractor
anchor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
9. Release the J-clip.
10. Remove the screw from the seat backrest support panel and release the J-clips under the seat
backrest support panel. 11. Remove the safety belt guide cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard > Page 9278
12. Invert the seat backrest cover and remove the 2 pin-type retainers.
13. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop
strip, or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat backrest foam.
Remove the seat backrest cover.
14. Remove the seat backrest foam pad. 15. Remove the 6 seat backrest support panel screws.
16. Remove the 2 safety belt retractor cover screws and remove the cover. 17. Remove the safety
belt retractor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
18. Pinch and release the safety belt retractor guide from the seat backrest frame and remove the
safety belt retractor.
19. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- When installing the safety belt retractor, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the sheet
metal.
- Remove the shipping clip after safety belt retractor installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
20. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard > Page 9279
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Rear Center Safety Belt Retractor - Third Row
REAR CENTER SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - THIRD ROW
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard > Page 9280
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's "automatic locking retractor" feature or any other
safety belt function is not operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection
procedures. Failure to install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in
collisions.
NOTE: The retractor may be equipped with an additional web stop button (small, thin, round button,
not to be confused with the larger web stop button) located on the safety belt webbing. This button
is only used for vehicle assembly and serves no other functional purpose. The button can possibly
be retracted under the trim bezel making it difficult to pull the safety belt webbing out of the
retractor. To service, remove this web stop button. Do not install a new safety belt retractor to
eliminate this condition. Any resulting appearance concerns with the webbing can be worked out by
hand.
All seats
1. Remove the third row 60 percent seat backrest. 2. Remove the safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Depress the tab and remove the head restraint.
4. Release the J-clip.
5. Release the 2 J-clips.
Manual seat
6. Remove the 2 seat backrest release handle screws and remove the handle and cable assembly.
All seats
7. Remove the safety belt guide.
8. NOTE: The head restraint sleeve pins are not interchangeable, note location for installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard > Page 9281
Reach up into the seat backrest, squeeze, release and remove the head restraint sleeves.
9. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip
or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat backrest foam.
Invert the seat backrest trim cover and remove.
10. Remove the seat backrest foam pad.
11. Remove the 4 screws from the seat belt cover (2 shown). 12. Remove the safety belt retractor
bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
13. Pinch to release the safety belt guide and remove the safety belt retractor.
14. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- Remove the shipping clip after safety belt retractor installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
15. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard > Page 9282
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Front
SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - FRONT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ■automatic locking retractor" feature or any other
safety belt function is not operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection
procedures. Failure to install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in
collisions.
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
1. Remove the B-pillar trim panel. 2. Release the 2 pin-type retainers and the safety belt guide.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard > Page 9283
3. Remove the 3 bolts and the B-pillar trim panel bracket. 4. Remove the bolt and the safety belt
retractor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- When installing the safety belt retractor, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the sheet
metal
- Remove the shipping clip after safety belt retractor installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Pretensioner, Driver
C3201
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Pretensioner, Driver > Page 9288
C3202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Safety Belt System
Seat Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation Safety Belt System
Pretensioner System
All vehicles have a pretensioner system used with the front outboard safety belt buckles. This
works in conjunction with the front air bag system mounted in the steering wheel and instrument
panel.
If the vehicle is involved in a collision that results in deployment of the front air bags and safety belt
pretensioners, the driver and passenger seat belt system (including safety belt buckle and
pretensioners, safety belt retractors and height adjusters) must be replaced.
For diagnostic information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
For pretensioner buckle disposal information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Safety Belt Buckle And Pretensioner
NOTE: There is currently no restraint system diagnostic tool for the safety belt buckle pretensioner
under the seat connectors. If the ignition switch is turned to the ON or START position with the
safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector(s) disconnected, the DTC and flagged faults for
an open circuit will be activated.
The safety belt buckle and pretensioners are for the front outboard occupants, located on the
inboard side of the seats. This allows the front safety belt buckle end to move with the front seat.
The safety belt buckle and pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device that removes excess webbing from
the safety belt system. When the front air bag system is deployed, the pretensioner in the buckle
deploys, causing the buckle to move downward, pulling excess webbing from the lap and shoulder
safety belts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Safety Belt System > Page 9291
Seat Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation Supplemental Restraint System
SAFETY BELT PRETENSIONERS
NOTE: There is currently no restraint system diagnostic tool for the safety belt buckle pretensioner
under the seat connectors. When diagnosing the safety belt buckle pretensioners, it will be
necessary to disconnect the affected safety belt buckle pretensioner pigtail harness connector on
the component and install a restraint system diagnostic tool.
As part of the SRS, the driver and front outboard passenger safety belt buckles are equipped with
pretensioners. The safety belt buckle pretensioners remove excess slack from the safety belt
webbing. The pretensioners are activated by the restraints control module (RCM) when the module
detects a crash event force exceeding a programmed limit.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner
Seat Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner
40 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER - 40 PERCENT SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
- All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped, buckles,
shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching
hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed
unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt
assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if
either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase the
risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- LH shown, RH similar.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3. Remove the 40
percent front seat.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner > Page 9294
4. Release the hook-and-loop strip and pull the seat cushion trim cover up enough to expose the
safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
5. NOTE: Make note of the wire harness routing for installation.
Remove the safety belt buckle and pretensioner electrical connectors from the seat cushion frame.
Disconnect the usage detection switch electrical connector.
- Separate the safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector from the pin-type retainer.
6. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 8. Install the 40 percent front seat. 9. Repower the
SRS.
10. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
60 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER - 60 PERCENT SEAT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner > Page 9295
Removal
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
- All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped, buckles,
shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching
hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed
unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt
assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if
either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase the
risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3. Remove the 60
percent front seat.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner > Page 9296
4. NOTE: Make note of the wire harness routing for installation.
Detach the electrical connectors and route out the wire harnesses.
5. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner assembly.
Installation
1. Install the safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
1 Position the safety belt buckle and pretensioner to the seat. Align the safety belt buckle and pretensioner locator tab to the hole in the seat frame.
- Check that the safety belt buckle end is accessible after positioning.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Route the safety belt buckle and pretensioner usage detection switch and pretensioner electrical
connectors as noted in removal.
2. Attach the electrical connectors and route the wire harnesses as noted in removal. 3. Install the
60 percent front seat. 4. Repower the SRS. 5. Check the active restraint system for correct
operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner > Page 9297
Seat Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Safety Belt Pretensioner Disposal
Deployed
SAFETY BELT PRETENSIONER DISPOSAL - DEPLOYED
1. WARNING: The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses
when repairing an air bag equipped vehicle
and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt retractor pretensioner. Never
probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in pretensioner or air bag
deployment and could result in personal injury.
Dispose of the deployed safety belt pretensioner in the same manner as any other part to be
scrapped.
Inoperative
SAFETY BELT PRETENSIONER DISPOSAL - UNDEPLOYED, INOPERATIVE
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- Carry a live safety belt retractor pretensioner or safety belt buckle pretensioner so as to keep
fingers and clothing away from moveable parts. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
NOTE: All inoperative safety belt buckle pretensioners and safety belt retractor pretensioners have
been placed on the Mandatory Return List. All damaged safety belt buckle pretensioners and
safety belt retractor pretensioners must be treated the same as any inoperative live safety belt
buckle pretensioner or safety belt retractor pretensioner being returned.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the inoperative safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner from the vehicle. 3. Package and return the inoperative safety belt buckle
pretensioner or safety belt retractor pretensioner to Ford Motor Company.
Scrapped Vehicle
SAFETY BELT PRETENSIONER DISPOSAL - UNDEPLOYED, SCRAPPED VEHICLE
Remote Deployment
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- Remote deployment is to be performed outdoors with all personnel at least 6.1 meters (20 feet)
away to ensure personal safety. Due to the loud report which occurs when the safety belt
pretensioner is deployed, hearing protection is required.
- Do not position the safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt retractor pretensioner so that
moveable parts contact the support surface, as the forces of the deploying pretensioner can cause
it to ricochet and cause personal injury.
All vehicles
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner assembly from the vehicle.
Safety Belt Buckle Pretensioner Without a Hard-Wired Electrical Connector
3. Cut and remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector from the main seat wire
harness, leaving about 4 inches of extra wire. 4. Attach the electrical connector to the safety belt
buckle pretensioner.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner > Page 9298
5. Strip the wires near the electrical connector.
6. Obtain 2 wires (20 gauge minimum) at least 6.1 meters (20 feet) long and attach one end of
each wire to the safety belt buckle pretensioner wires. 7. Position the safety belt buckle
pretensioner assembly on a flat surface in an open outdoor area so that moveable parts do not
contact the support
surface.
8. Remain at least 6.1 meters (20 feet) away from the safety belt buckle pretensioner assembly.
9. Deploy the safety belt buckle pretensioner by touching the other ends of the 2 wires to the
terminals of a 12-volt battery.
10. To allow for cooling, wait at least 10 minutes before approaching the deployed safety belt
buckle pretensioner. 11. Dispose of the deployed safety belt buckle pretensioner in the same
manner as any other part to be scrapped.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9302
C356
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9303
Seat Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the inboard side of the seat
track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver seat
position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage driver
air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Forward Crash Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9309
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9310
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9311
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9312
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Forward Crash Sensor
C177
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9315
C539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9316
C631
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9317
C9004
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Forward Crash Sensor > Page 9318
C9005
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9319
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation
SENSORS
WARNING:
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, the RCM must be replaced whether or not the air bags have deployed. In
addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
For these vehicles, the SRS uses up to 8 sensors. Within the RCM there can be up to 3 safing
sensors which are not separately serviced. The RCM will always have at least 1 safing sensor for
front impact. Two more safing sensors are used if the vehicle is equipped with safety canopy
modules. The RCM is mounted to the center tunnel beneath the console or bench seat. All vehicles
will have a front impact severity sensor that is located in the front-center of the vehicle, mounted
near the bottom of the hood latch support bracket. If the vehicle is equipped with safety canopy
modules, there are 4 additional side impact sensors external to the RCM. One front row side
impact sensor is located behind each of the front door interior trim panels. One second row side
impact sensor is located at the base of each C-pillar. Mounting orientation is critical for correct
operation of all impact and rollover sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
FRONT IMPACT SEVERITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for proper system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and properly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Front bumper removed for clarity.
1. Depower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 9322
2. NOTE: The front impact severity sensor is mounted on the bottom of the hood latch support
bracket.
Remove the pin-type retainers and lower the front lower splash shield to access the front impact
severity sensor.
3. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag front impact severity sensor retaining nut is
critical for correct system operation.
CAUTION: If the hood latch support bracket or weld stud are damaged in any way that would affect
the way the front impact severity sensor mounts to its original manufactured position, a new hood
latch support bracket must be installed.
NOTE: Note the position of the front impact severity sensor locator tabs to the hood latch support bracket
alignment holes for installation.
- Make sure the hood latch support bracket and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are
clean and debris free.
Remove the front impact severity sensor nut. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft)
4. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the front impact severity sensor. 5. To install,
reverse the removal procedure. 6. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 9323
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - C-PILLAR
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 9324
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and perform the diagnostic procedure again.
- Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Lift to release and remove the rear door scuff plate. 3. Remove the
safety belt retractor anchor bolt. 4. Pull out at the front of the rear quarter trim panel, releasing the
retaining clips, allowing access to the side impact sensor. 5. Remove the side impact sensor bolt.
6. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector and remove the sensor and bracket.
Installation
1. Make sure the second row side impact sensor tabs are aligned to the bracket. 2. Position the
side impact sensor and bracket locator pin to the opening in the quarter panel sheet metal and
install the bolt.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
3. Connect the side impact sensor electrical connector. 4. Align the rear quarter trim panel and
push in, seating the retaining clips.
5. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the safety belt retractor anchor bolt. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
6. Install the rear door scuff plate. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 9325
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for proper system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Replace and properly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the front interior door trim panel on the side with the affected
side impact sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 9326
3. Separate the weathershield enough to access the side impact sensor. 4. Disconnect the side
impact sensor electrical connector.
5. WARNING: The tightening torque of the side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for correct
system operation.
CAUTION: The ground wire must be placed between the bolt head and the sensor. Never position the ground
wire between the J-clip retaining nut and the sensor.
- Always replace the J-clip retaining nut whenever installing a side impact sensor.
NOTE: Make sure the side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign material.
- Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tabs for installation.
Remove the bolt and the side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger
View 151-17 (RH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger > Page 9331
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver
C3065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver > Page 9334
C3066
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9335
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE SWITCHES
As part of the supplemental restraint system (SRS), the driver and front outboard passenger safety
belt buckles are equipped with safety belt buckle switches. The safety belt buckle switches indicate
to the restraints control module (RCM) whether the safety belts are connected or disconnected.
The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage driver and
passenger air bag modules.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9339
C356
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9340
Seat Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the inboard side of the seat
track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver seat
position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage driver
air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9346
C2075
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9347
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9348
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Amplifier > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Amplifier > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9353
Antenna Amplifier: Diagrams
C4194a
C4194b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Antenna, Navigation: Service and Repair
GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM (GPS) ANTENNA
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Remove the audio unit. 3. Remove the passenger airbag module. 4.
Remove the bolt and the GPS antenna. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Antenna Lead-In Cable - Front
Antenna Cable: Service and Repair Antenna Lead-In Cable - Front
ANTENNA LEAD-IN CABLE - FRONT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the audio unit.
2. Remove the RH scuff plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Antenna Lead-In Cable - Front > Page 9362
3. Remove the RH A-pillar lower trim panel. 4. Disconnect the rear antenna lead-in cable from the
front antenna lead-in cable.
5. NOTE: The antenna is an integral part of the wiring harness and cannot be replaced separately
from the harness. Cut the ends off of the old
antenna cable and tape the remainder to the wiring harness to prevent noise.
Remove the ground plate and remove the antenna cable ends.
6. NOTE: When installing the new cable, tape or wire-tie the new cable to the wiring harness to
prevent noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Antenna Lead-In Cable - Front > Page 9363
Antenna Cable: Service and Repair Antenna Lead-In Cable - Rear
ANTENNA LEAD-IN CABLE - REAR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH scuff plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Antenna Lead-In Cable - Front > Page 9364
2. Remove the RH A-pillar lower trim panel. 3. Disconnect the rear antenna lead-in cable from the
front antenna lead-in cable.
4. Remove the RH rear door scuff plate. 5. Remove the RH rear quarter trim. 6. Lower the
headliner enough to gain access to the rear antenna cable connection. 7. Disconnect the rear
antenna lead-in cable from the antenna isolator module.
8. NOTE: The antenna is an integral part of the wiring harness and cannot be replaced separately
from the harness. Cut the ends off of the old
antenna cable and tape the remainder to the wiring harness to prevent noise.
Remove the ground plate and remove the antenna cable ends.
9. NOTE: When installing the new cable, tape or wire tie the new cable to the wiring harness to
prevent noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System
Transponder > Component Information > Diagrams
C2007
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System
Transponder > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9369
Alarm System Transponder: Service and Repair
PASSIVE ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM (PATS) TRANSCEIVER
Removal And Installation
1. Remove the steering wheel. 2. Remove 2 screws and the lower steering column shroud. 3.
Remove the ignition lock cylinder cover. 4. Disconnect the PATS transceiver electrical connector.
5. Remove the screw and the PATS transceiver. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Keyless Entry - Keypad Diagnostics
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Technical Service Bulletins Keyless Entry - Keypad Diagnostics
TSB 06-15-8
08/07/06
KEYPAD DIAGNOSTICS - DEALER INSTALLED ACCESSORY
FORD: 1998-2006 Taurus 1999-2003 Escort 1999-2006 Mustang 2000-2006 Focus 2002-2005
Thunderbird 2005-2006 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006 Crown Victoria, Fusion 1998-2006
Expedition, Explorer, F-150, Ranger 1999 F-250 Light Duty 1999-2003 Windstar 1999-2006
F-Super Duty 2000-2005 Excursion 2000-2006 E-Series 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2005
Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2006 Escape 2004 F-150 Heritage 2004-2006 Freestar
LINCOLN: 1998-2006 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 1998-2006 Navigator
2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1998-2005 Sable 1999-2002 Cougar 2005-2006 Montego 2006 Grand Marquis, Milan
1998-2006 Mountaineer 2004-2006 Monterey 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some vehicles may experience a concern with the keyless entry keypad. In order to
properly diagnose the concern with the keyless entry keypad, it is important to identify whether the
keypad is a factory installed style (wired) or a Genuine Ford Accessory (GFA) radio frequency (RF)
style keypad.
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to identify GFA RF keypads and provide diagnostic
service tips.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
IDENTIFICATION:
1. Production installed keyless entry keypads are mounted flush with the surface of the vehicle and
are wired directly to the module controlling the vehicle's keyless entry system. This style keypad
can be diagnosed using the appropriate Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-14.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Keyless Entry - Keypad Diagnostics > Page 9375
2. Dealer installed GFA RF keypads are adhesive backed and protrude approximately 1/2" (13
mm) from the surface of the vehicle and there are no specific diagnostics available in the WSM
(Figure 1).
NOTE
THIS RF KEYPAD WAS ALSO US[D IN PRODUCTION ON 2004 F-SUPER DUTY VEHICLES
BUILT PRIOR TO 12/3/2003. REFER TO WSM, SECTION 501-14 FOR RF KEYPAD
DIAGNOSTICS FOR THESE VEHICLES.
GENUINE FORD ACCESSORY KEYPAD DIAGNOSTIC TIPS
1. The keypad operates similarly to a remote keyless entry (RKE) transmitter and is programmed
using a similar procedure.
Although the RF keypad is not specifically addressed in the WSM, the RKE transmitter
programming portion of the WSM, Section 501-14 can be used as a guide
NOTE
THE 7-8 AND 9-0 BUTTONS ON THE KEYPAD MUST BE PRESSED SIMULTANEOUSLY
DURING THE PROCEDURE IN ORDER FOR THE KEYPAD TO BE RECOGNIZED AS AN
ADDITIONAL REMOTE TRANSMITTER.
Since the GFA RF keypad is essentially another RKE transmitter, the transmitter diagnostic
pinpoint tests in the vehicle's WSM can also be referenced even though the buttons serving the
lock / unlock functions will differ
2. The GFA RF keypad is serviced as an assembly. The internal battery cannot be replaced
separately.
3. If the master code or owner selectable code is lost or forgotten, the GFA RF keypad must be
replaced. These codes are not stored in any vehicle module (with the exception of 2004 F-Super
Duty vehicles produced prior to 12/3/2003).
4. The GFA RF keypad and all RKE transmitters (the number of transmitters allowable will vary by
vehicle) must be reprogrammed together anytime the keypad is replaced, an RKE transmitter is
replaced, or the module controlling the keyless entry system on the vehicle (GEM/SJB/VSM/DDM
etc.) is replaced.
NOTE
THERE IS AN EXCEPTION TO TIP 4 FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH INTEGRATED
KEYHEAD TRANSMITTERS (IKTs) (FUSION/MILAN/ZEPHYR). THE GFA RF KEYPADS FOR
VEHICLES WITH IKTs MUST BE PROGRAMMED INDEPENDENTLY FROM THE IKTs. TURN
THE IGNITION FROM "OFF" TO "RUN" 8 TIMES WITHIN 10 SECONDS, WITH THE 8TH TIME
ENDING IN "RUN". THE DOOR LOCKS WILL CYCLE TO CONFIRM ENTERING
PROGRAMMING MODE. PRESS THE 7-8 AND 9-0 BUTTON ON THE KEYPAD
SIMULTANEOUSLY TO SEND A LOCK SIGNAL. TURN IGNITION TO OFF. THE LOCKS WILL
CYCLE AGAIN TO INDICATE THE END OF THE PROGRAMMING MODE.
5. The keypad will normally illuminate for 5 seconds after one or more buttons are pressed, and the
illumination will immediately turn off if the 7-8 and 9-0 buttons are pressed simultaneously (lock all
doors). The keypad contains an optical sensor and will not illuminate under bright lighting
conditions. The keypad may only illuminate briefly in colder temperatures in order to maximize the
battery power available to transmit a lock/unlock signal. The temperature at which this occurs will
vary depending upon the keypad battery age and condition. Both of these conditions are a normal
function of the Power Save Mode and do not indicate a need to replace the keypad.
6. After entering the keypad code, the system may unlock the driver's door, lock it, then unlock it
again, and the keypad will not even briefly illuminate. This is the Alert Mode and is an indication
that battery power is very low and the keypad must be replaced.
7. The keypad also contains an Anti-scan feature. If the wrong code has been entered 7 times (35
consecutive button presses) the keypad is disabled for one minute and the keypad lamp will flash
during this time.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Keyless Entry - Keypad Diagnostics > Page 9376
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14A626 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9377
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9378
C500
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair Remote Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD CODE PROGRAMMING
1. Enter the permanent factory remote keyless entry (RKE) keypad code. 2. Press the 1/2 button
within 5 seconds to activate the programming mode. Holding the 1/2 button for more than 2
seconds after activation erases
the stored customer code. The doors lock, then unlock, confirming the code is erased. The existing
code does not need to be erased to program a new code.
3. Within 5 seconds, enter the new 5-digit RKE keypad code. The doors lock and unlock to confirm
the new code is programmed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming > Page
9381
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair Autolock and Horn Chirp Programming
AUTOLOCK AND HORN CHIRP PROGRAMMING
1. Close all the doors. 2. Confirm that the ignition switch is in the OFF position. 3. Turn the ignition
switch from OFF to RUN.
4. NOTE: Steps 4 through 8 must be carried out within 30 seconds.
Press the power door lock UNLOCK button 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch from RUN to OFF. 6. Press the power door lock UNLOCK button 3
times. 7. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to RUN. 8. Verify the horn chirps. This indicates the
system is in the enable/disable mode is ready to accept program changes. 9. Press the power door
lock UNLOCK button 1 time to toggle the autolock/relock feature OFF.
10. Press the power door lock LOCK button once to enter the command. 11. Verify the horn chirps
1 time. There should only be 1 chirp indicating that autolock/relock feature is disabled. If 1 chirp is
heard, followed by a
longer sound of the horn, the autolock/relock feature has just been enabled. Return to Step 9.
12. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position to exit the enable/disable mode. 13. Exit the vehicle
and verify the horn chirps once to indicate that a feature has been changed and that
autolock/relock is disabled.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming > Page
9382
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair Remote Keyless Entry Keypad
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the exterior mirror.
2. Disconnect the RKE keypad electrical connector. 3. Remove the front door window glass.
4. CAUTION: Damage to the base moulding may occur during the removal procedure.
Remove the front door window base moulding.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming > Page
9383
5. Remove the RKE keypad. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY TRANSMITTER PROGRAMMING
NOTE:
- All remote keyless entry (RKE) transmitters must be programmed at the same time.
- Programming (or reprogramming) of the RKE transmitters can be accomplished using a
diagnostic tool or by carrying out the following steps:
1. The vehicle must be electronically unlocked before entering program mode using the door lock
control switch while the driver door is open. 2. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN
position 8 times within 10 seconds, with the eighth turn ending in RUN. If the module
successfully enters program mode, it locks and then unlocks all the doors.
3. Within 20 seconds, press any button on an RKE transmitter, and the doors lock and then unlock
to confirm that each RKE transmitter is
programmed. Repeat this step for each RKE transmitter.
4. If the door locks do not respond for any RKE transmitter, wait several seconds and press the
button again. If the door locks still fail to respond,
refer to Inspection and Verification. (Make sure that no more than the maximum number of RKE
transmitters are attempted to be programmed.) See: Body and Frame/Locks/Power Locks/Testing
and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Inspection and Verification
5. Exiting the programming mode is accomplished if one of the following occurs:
- The key transitions to the OFF position.
- 20 seconds have passed since entering programming mode or since the last RKE transmitter was
programmed.
- The maximum number (6) of RKE transmitters have been programmed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking
Assist Control Module: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Control Module: Customer Interest Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC
C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking
Assist Control Module: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 > Page 9396
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Parking Assist Control Module: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Parking Assist System - Speaker
Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Parking Assist Control Module: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 > Page
9402
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9403
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9404
Parking Assist Control Module: Diagrams
C4014a
C4014b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9405
C4226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9406
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
PARKING AID MODULE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9407
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the parking aid module.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
2 Remove the parking aid module screw.
3 Remove the parking aid module.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Inner/Outer Left
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Inner/Outer Left > Page 9412
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Inner/Outer Left > Page 9413
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor
C4191
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 9416
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Diagrams Parking Aid Ultrasonic Sensor
C4192
C4193
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 9417
C4009
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 9418
C4011
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 9419
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Diagrams
C4191
C4192
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 9420
C4193
C4009
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 9421
C4011
C4010
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page 9422
C4012
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9423
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair
PARKING AID SENSOR
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9424
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the rear bumper cover.
2. Remove the nuts and the foam absorber from the bumper cover. 3. Remove the ultrasonic
sensor(s).
1 Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
2 Release the locking tabs.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9425
3 Remove the ultrasonic sensor(s).
Navigator
4. Remove the radar sensor.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the two parking aid radar sensor nuts.
3 Remove the radar sensor.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking
Assist Warning Indicator: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Warning Indicator: Customer Interest Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC
C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking
Assist Warning Indicator: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 > Page 9434
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Parking Assist Warning Indicator: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Warning Indicator: All Technical Service Bulletins Parking Assist System - Speaker
Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Parking Assist Warning Indicator: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 >
Page 9440
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9441
C4015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9445
C253
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9446
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Description and Operation
INFORMATION AND MESSAGE CENTER
The message center display is a green vacuum fluorescent, fixed format display. The message
center is a 2-line display integrated into the center of the instrument cluster and is controlled by the
message center switches. Refer to the Owner's Literature for operating instructions.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
The message center is a vacuum fluorescent display, part of the instrument cluster. The message
center electronic functions use both hardwired, and controller area network (CAN) circuitry to
transmit and receive information. As a technician, it is very important to understand:
- where the input (command) originates.
- all the information (messages) necessary in order for a feature to operate.
- which module(s) receive(s) the input or command message.
- if the module that received the input (message) controls the output of the feature, or if it outputs a
message over the CAN to another module.
- which module controls the output of the feature.
The message center provides the following features:
- information displays
- setup displays
- warning messages
- system check messages
The message center information can be selected through a set of 3 buttons:
- INFO
- SETUP
- RESET
Information Displays The information displays are non-timed modes. The selected mode remains
on until the driver presses a message center button to change the mode or it is overridden by
another mode. The information display modes are: odometer
- trip odometer
- compass
- distance to empty (DTE)
- average fuel economy
Setup Displays The setup displays are timed modes and terminate after a finite interval. The setup
display modes are: system check
- English/metric units
- power liftgate on/off (if equipped)
- running board auto in/out (if equipped)
- easy exit seat (if equipped)
- autolamp delay
- language
Warning Messages The warning messages are single cycle, non-resettable and repetitive warning
messages. The single cycle warning messages are: CHECK SUSPENSION
- CHECK COMPASS MODULE
- NO RESPONSE COMPASS
- ENGINE TEMP DATA
- COMPASS DATA ERROR
- DOOR SENSOR DATA ERROR
- CHARGING SYSTEM DATA ERROR
- CHECK PARK ASSIST
- CHECK FUEL CAP
- LOW WASHER FLUID LEVEL
The single cycle warning messages display once whenever the ignition switch is turned to ON or a
fault occurs in a system and can be cleared by pressing the RESET button.
The repetitive warning messages are: LOW BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
- CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM
- LOW FUEL LEVEL
- LOW OIL PRESSURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9449
- CHECK ENGINE TEMPERATURE
- TEMPORARY 4x4 HIGH
- CHECK ADV/TRAC
- CHECK TIRE PRESSURE
The repetitive warning messages are displayed at a fixed interval whenever the ignition switch is
turned ON or is in the ACC position. To remove a repetitive warning message, press the RESET
button. The message only reoccurs after 10 minutes or until the warning condition is corrected.
The non-resettable warning messages are: DOOR AJAR
- STOP ENGINE SAFELY
- REDUCED ENGINE POWER
- ENGINE FAILSAFE MODE
- PARK ASSIST ON/OFF
- TRAIN LF TIRE
- TRAIN LR TIRE
- TRAIN RF TIRE
- TRAIN RR TIRE
- TRAIN SPARE TIRE
- TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPLETE
- TIRES NOT TRAINED
- PARK BRAKE ENGAGED
The non-resettable warning messages display whenever the ignition switch is turned to ON and a
fault occurs in a system. The fault must be corrected to clear the non-resettable warning
messages.
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step. 4. If the cause is not visually evident, connect the diagnostic tool to the data link
connector and select the vehicle to be tested from the diagnostic tool
menu. If the diagnostic tool does not communicate with the vehicle: check that the program card is correctly installed.
- check the connections to the vehicle.
- check the ignition switch position.
5. If the diagnostic tool still does not communicate with the vehicle, refer to the diagnostic tool
operating manual. 6. Carry out the diagnostic tool data link test. If the diagnostic tool responds with:
- ISO, SCP or CAN circuit fault; all electronic control units no response/not equipped, refer to
Information Bus (Module Communications Network).
- No response/not equipped for the instrument cluster, refer to Instrument Cluster.
- System passed, retrieve and record the continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs), erase the
continuous DTCs, and carry out self-test diagnostics for the instrument cluster.
7. If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, refer to the Instrument Cluster Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) Index. See: Diagnostic Trouble
Code Descriptions
8. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9450
B1209-U2013
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9451
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9452
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9453
Symptom Chart (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9454
Symptom Chart (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9455
Symptom Chart (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9456
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Pinpoint Tests
Test A: The Message Center Is Not Operating Correctly
PINPOINT TEST A: THE MESSAGE CENTER IS NOT OPERATING CORRECTLY
A1
Normal Operation
The message center functionality is controlled through the message center switches, which are
hardwired to the instrument cluster through circuit 1396 (VT/WH) and circuit 1411 (GY/OG). Each
message center switch uses a different resistance value allowing the instrument cluster to
determine which switch is pressed.
Possible Causes
- message center switches
- instrument cluster
Test B: The Compass Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST B: THE COMPASS IS INOPERATIVE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9457
B1-B3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9458
B3 Continued
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module receives voltage from central junction box (CJB) fuse 27 (5A) through
circuit 1003 (GY/YE) and is grounded through circuit 875 (BK/LB). The compass sensor module
communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster, and the direction is displayed in the
message center. The compass sensor module uses circuit 702 (WH/BK) and circuit 703 (WH/OG)
to communicate to the instrument cluster.
Possible Causes
- fuse
- circuit 702 (WH/BK) open or short to ground
- circuit 703 (WH/OG) open or short to ground
- circuit 875 (BK/LB) open
- circuit 1003 (GY/YE) open
- compass sensor module
Test C: The Compass Is Inaccurate
PINPOINT TEST C: THE COMPASS IS INACCURATE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9459
C1-C3
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster to
display in the message center.
Possible Causes
- compass sensor module
- vehicle magnetization
- zone setting
- calibration
Test D: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST D: THE MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9460
D1-D3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9461
D4-D5
Normal Operation
The message center switch assembly uses circuits 1396 (VT/WH) and 1411 (GY/OG) to
communicate the requested switch function to the message center.
Possible Causes
- circuit 1396 (VT/WH) open or short to ground
- circuit 1411 (GY/OG) open or short to ground
- message center switch
- instrument cluster
Test E: The Power Liftgate Display Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST E: THE POWER LIFTGATE DISPLAY IS INOPERATIVE
E1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9462
E2-E3
Normal Operation
The vehicle security module (VSM) sends a voltage reference signal through circuit 700 (WH/VT)
to the power liftgate module. When the reference signal loses the ground signal by the opening of
the power liftgate, the VSM sends a signal over the communication network to the instrument
cluster, illuminating the power liftgate display.
Possible Causes
- instrument cluster
- power liftgate
Test F: The Power Running Boards Display Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST F: THE POWER RUNNING BOARDS DISPLAY IS INOPERATIVE
F1-F3
Normal Operation
The instrument cluster receives the running board status from the power liftgate module over the
communication network. The retractable running boards are controlled by the power liftgate module
over the control circuits 1944 (BN/PK) (left side), and 1945 (VT/WH) (right side). The running board
motors are grounded through circuit 57 (BK). The retractable running board motors receive a
ground signal from the power liftgate module to deploy and an open signal to retract.
Possible Causes
- instrument cluster
- power running boards
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9463
Test G: The Park Assist On/Off Display Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST G: THE PARK ASSIST ON/OFF DISPLAY IS INOPERATIVE
G1-G3
Normal Operation
The parking aid system is enabled when the ignition switch is in the RUN position and REVERSE is
selected. The system can be disabled through the message center RESET switch located in the
instrument cluster. The parking aid menu is displayed until the transmission is taken out of
REVERSE. While the menu is displayed, pressing the message center RESET switch changes the
parking aid system status to OFF. The parking aid system is disabled if a fault is detected in 1 of
the 4 sensors, the parking aid speaker, or the parking aid module. This is indicated by the parking
aid disabled warning CHECK BACKUP AID displayed in the message center. The parking aid
module communicates with the instrument cluster through the communication network.
Possible Causes
- instrument cluster
- parking aid system
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9464
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Service and Repair
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel.
2. NOTE: Navigator is shown, Expedition is similar.
Press the tabs and remove the message center switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9465
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Diagrams
C9020
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9470
DVD Player: Service and Repair
DIGITAL VERSATILE DISC (DVD) PLAYER
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: When removing the DVD player do not pull on the display. This may cause damage to
the unit and void the warranty.
1. Open the video display door. 2. Remove the 4 DVD player screws.
3. NOTE: The DVD player must be supported while disengaging the clips.
Disengage the 3 retaining clips and remove the DVD player. Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Description and Operation
UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER
The HomeLink(R) universal transmitter provides a convenient way to substitute up to 3 hand-held
transmitters with a single built-in device. The universal transmitter:
- will operate garage doors, gates and home/office lighting and security systems.
- will actually learn and transmit the radio frequency of up to 3 hand-held transmitters from any of
the systems mentioned above.
- is an integral part of the left sun visor assembly and is powered by the vehicle battery and
charging system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern by operating the system. 2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of
mechanical damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Mechanical Damaged universal transmitter
- Damaged receiver
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step. 4. If the fault is not visually evident, verify the symptom and
refer to the Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9476
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9477
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Pinpoint Tests
PINPOINT TEST A: THE UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER IS INOPERATIVE
A1-A2
Normal Operation
The universal transmitter receives voltage on circuit 705 (LG/OG) and ground on circuit 57 (BK).
Possible Causes
- circuit 705 (LG/OG) open or short to ground
- circuit 57 (BK) open
- universal transmitter
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9478
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Service and Repair
UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER PROGRAMMING
WARNING: A garage door opening system that cannot stop or reverse itself after detecting an
object in its path does not meet current federal safety standards. To decrease the risk of serious
injury or death, do not use this HomeLink(R) transmitter with a door opening system that lacks stop
and reverse features as required by federal standards. This includes any garage door opening
system manufactured before April 1, 1982. For more information, call HomeLink(R) customer
assistance at 1-800-355-3515.
1. CAUTION: During this procedure, the system that you are programming will be made to operate.
Make sure that people or objects are
clear of the garage door or gate being programmed.
Verify the hand-held transmitter is operative.
2. Prepare for programming the universal transmitter by erasing all three channels by holding down
the two outside buttons until the red light begins
to flash (20-30 seconds). Release both buttons.
3. Select one of the three universal transmitter channels to be programmed by pressing the desired
button. 4. Hold the end of the hand-held transmitter 25-51mm (1-2 in) from the front surface of the
universal transmitter so that the red light can still be
seen.
5. NOTE: During programming, the hand-held transmitter may automatically stop transmitting after
two seconds, which may not be long enough to
program the universal transmitter. If programming this type of hand-held transmitter, continue to
hold the button on the universal transmitter while re-pressing the hand-held transmitter button
every two seconds (Canada only).
Use both hands to press the hand-held transmitter button and the desired button on the universal
transmitter. Do not release either button.
6. Hold down both buttons until the red light on the universal transmitter flashes, first slowly and
then rapidly. Release both buttons when the rapid
flashing begins. The universal transmitter has successfully learned the new frequency signal and
can be used in place of the hand-held transmitter(s).
7. NOTE: If the hand-held transmitter appears to program the universal transmitter but does not
open the garage door, the garage door opener may
have a "code protected" or "rolling code" feature.
To operate, simply press the appropriate button on the universal transmitter. The red light is on
while the signal is being transmitted.
Training a Garage Door Opener Equipped With "Rolling Codes"
1. Program the hand-held transmitter to the universal transmitter. 2. Train the garage door opener
receiver to recognize the universal transmitter.
1 Remove the cover panel from the garage door opener receiver.
2 Locate the training button on the garage door opener receiver. Location and color of the button
may vary by garage door opener manufacturer. Refer to the garage door opener instruction manual
or call HomeLink(R) customer assistance at 1-800-355-3515.
3 Press the training button on the garage door opener receiver for 1-2 seconds.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9479
4 Press the programmed universal transmitter button for as long as the universal transmitter red
light flashes (1-2 seconds). Release the button and re-press the button to confirm that the universal
transmitter is trained to the receiver.
5 The garage door opener should recognize the universal transmitter.
Erasing Channels
1. NOTE: Individual channels cannot be erased, but can be reprogrammed using the procedures
for programming.
To erase all three programmed channels, hold down the two outside buttons until the red light
begins to flash (20-30 seconds). Release both buttons.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 9484
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C341a
C341b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 9485
C341c
C341d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9489
C503
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9490
Seat Memory Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH - MEMORY SET
Memory Set Switch
Remove the memory set switch.
Measure the resistance between the indicated terminals while pressing the requested switches.
The resistance should be less than 5 ohms for each switch position.
If the resistance is not less than 5 ohms for each switch, install a new switch; otherwise, return to
the calling pinpoint test.
NOTE: Refer to multimeter user's manual for testing diodes.
To check the memory set switch LED, connect the positive meter lead to terminal 7 and the
negative lead to terminal 1. The meter should indicate greater than 0.3 volts. Reversing the leads,
the meter should read OL.
If the meter readings are not as indicated above, install a new switch; otherwise, return to the
calling pinpoint test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit
Navigation Module: Diagrams Audio/Navigation Control Unit
C2123a
C2123b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9497
C2123c
C2123d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9498
C2123e
C2123f
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9499
C2123g
C2253a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9500
C2253b
C2253c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9501
C2253d
C2253e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9502
Navigation Module: Diagrams Navigation Module
C2279a
C2279b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9503
Navigation Module: Service and Repair
NAVIGATION MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Remove the lower LH and RH front floor console panels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9504
3. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the navigation module.
1 Remove the 2 navigation module rear screws.
2 Remove the 2 navigation module lateral screws.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Motor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9509
C2003
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams
C2090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9516
Pedal Positioning Switch: Diagrams
C2089
C2235
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9517
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9518
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9519
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer Amplifier
C466
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer Amplifier > Page 9525
Amplifier: Diagrams Radio Amplifier
C2291a
C2291b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Subwoofer Amplifier
Amplifier: Service and Repair Subwoofer Amplifier
SUBWOOFER AMPLIFIER
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Remove the LH rear quarter trim panel. 3. Remove the 4 screws and
the subwoofer amplifier.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Subwoofer Amplifier > Page 9528
Amplifier: Service and Repair Audio Amplifier
AUDIO AMPLIFIER
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Remove the LH and RH floor console side finish panels.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the audio amplifier/navigation DVD assembly.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
4. Remove the 4 bolts and the audio amplifier. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc Player
(CD) > CD Changer > Component Information > Diagrams
C3028
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc Player
(CD) > CD Changer > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9533
CD Changer: Service and Repair
COMPACT DISC (CD) CHANGER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the mat from the bottom of the center console storage compartment.
2. NOTE: When removing the assembly, pull the front edge of the CD changer carrier back and lift
the assembly out.
Remove the 4 screws and the CD changer and carrier as an assembly. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. NOTE: Only carry out this step if installing a new CD changer.
Remove the 8 screws and the CD changer from the carrier.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Radio
Radio/Stereo: Diagrams Radio
C240a
C240b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Radio > Page 9538
C240c
C240d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Radio > Page 9539
C388
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control,
Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams
Remote Control: Diagrams
C349a
C349b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control,
Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9543
Remote Control: Service and Repair
REAR AUXILIARY AUDIO CONTROLS
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
1. Remove the 2 screws under the armrest cover. 2. Remove the bolt and the center console rear
trim panel.
- Disengage the 2 pin-type retainers.
- Disconnect the rear auxiliary audio controls electrical connector.
3. Remove the rear auxiliary audio controls unit.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control,
Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9544
- Remove the 4 screws.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Tweeter, Left Front
C513
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Tweeter, Left Front > Page 9549
C613
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Tweeter, Left Front > Page 9550
C4212
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Tweeter, Left Front > Page 9551
C523
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Tweeter, Left Front > Page 9552
Speaker: Diagrams
C513
C613
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Tweeter, Left Front > Page 9553
C4212
C523
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Tweeter, Left Front > Page 9554
C612
C702
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Tweeter, Left Front > Page 9555
C802
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9556
Speaker: Description and Operation
SPEAKERS
The speaker system consists of the following components:
- Subwoofer
- Speakers
On all vehicles:
- The rear speakers are located behind the rear door trim panels.
- The front speakers are located behind the front door trim panels.
- The subwoofer is located behind the LH quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Subwoofer Speaker
Speaker: Service and Repair Subwoofer Speaker
SUBWOOFER SPEAKER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the 3 bolts and the subwoofer speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Subwoofer Speaker > Page 9559
Speaker: Service and Repair Door Speaker
DOOR SPEAKER
Removal and Installation
All speakers
1. Remove the door trim panels.
Front door tweeter speaker
2. Remove the 2 screws and the door tweeter speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Front or rear door speaker
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Subwoofer Speaker > Page 9560
3. Remove the 4 screws and the speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All speakers
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9566
C2075
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9567
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9568
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit
Navigation Module: Diagrams Audio/Navigation Control Unit
C2123a
C2123b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9574
C2123c
C2123d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9575
C2123e
C2123f
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9576
C2123g
C2253a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9577
C2253b
C2253c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9578
C2253d
C2253e
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Audio/Navigation Control Unit > Page 9579
Navigation Module: Diagrams Navigation Module
C2279a
C2279b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9580
Navigation Module: Service and Repair
NAVIGATION MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Remove the lower LH and RH front floor console panels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9581
3. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the navigation module.
1 Remove the 2 navigation module rear screws.
2 Remove the 2 navigation module lateral screws.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Parking Assist Control Module: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Control Module: Customer Interest Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC
C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Parking Assist Control Module: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 > Page
9590
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Parking Assist Control Module: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC
C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Parking Assist System - Speaker
Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Parking Assist Control Module: > 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC
C1742/C1743 > Page 9596
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9597
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9598
Parking Assist Control Module: Diagrams
C4014a
C4014b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9599
C4226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9600
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
PARKING AID MODULE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9601
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the parking aid module.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
2 Remove the parking aid module screw.
3 Remove the parking aid module.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Inner/Outer Left
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Inner/Outer Left
> Page 9607
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Inner/Outer Left
> Page 9608
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor
C4191
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page
9611
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Diagrams Parking Aid Ultrasonic Sensor
C4192
C4193
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page
9612
C4009
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page
9613
C4011
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page
9614
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Diagrams
C4191
C4192
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page
9615
C4193
C4009
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page
9616
C4011
C4010
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Radar Sensor > Page
9617
C4012
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9618
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair
PARKING AID SENSOR
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9619
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the rear bumper cover.
2. Remove the nuts and the foam absorber from the bumper cover. 3. Remove the ultrasonic
sensor(s).
1 Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
2 Release the locking tabs.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9620
3 Remove the ultrasonic sensor(s).
Navigator
4. Remove the radar sensor.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the two parking aid radar sensor nuts.
3 Remove the radar sensor.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
C2090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9627
Pedal Positioning Switch: Diagrams
C2089
C2235
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9628
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9629
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9630
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9636
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9637
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9638
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9639
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9640
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9641
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9642
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9643
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9644
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9645
Trailer Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9646
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9647
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9648
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9649
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9650
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9651
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9652
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9653
Trailer Connector: Connector Views
C2142
C4098
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9654
C4099
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9655
Trailer Connector: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9656
95-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9657
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch: Service and Repair
TRAILER HITCH
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not permanently remove the trailer hitch. Always reinstall the hitch before delivery
of the vehicle to the customer. Failure to follow this warning could increase the risk of injury in a
rear end collision.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Remove the trailer hitch rear bumper cover trim panel.
3. Remove the trailer lighting plug cover and disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the trailer lighting plug.
1 Position the plug away from the trailer hitch.
2 Disconnect the electrical connector.
3 Remove the trailer lighting plug.
5. Remove the trailer hitch.
- Remove the 8 bolts. To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Do not reuse body support mounting fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each
fastener that has been removed or loosened.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Lamps: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9665
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9666
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9667
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9668
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9669
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9670
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9671
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9672
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9673
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9674
Trailer Lamps: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9675
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9676
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9677
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9678
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9679
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9680
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9681
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9682
Trailer Lamps: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9683
95-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9684
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Trailer Lamps: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Verify the exterior lighting system of the vehicle is operating
correctly. If not, refer to the appropriate pinpoint test. See: Pinpoint Tests 3. Visually inspect the
following for obvious signs of electrical damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Central junction box (CJB) fuse(s): 10 (20A) (trailer tow parking lamps relay, trailer tow reversing lamps relay)
- 13 (10A) (trailer tow battery charge relay coil)
- 29 (30A) (trailer tow electric brake controller)
- 36 (10A) (trailer tow RH stop/turn lamp)
- 42 (10A) (trailer tow LH stop/turn lamp)
- 106 (30A) (trailer tow battery charge relay)
- Circuitry
- Trailer
- Trailer tow battery charge relay
- Trailer tow parking lamps relay
- Trailer tow reversing lamps relay
- Trailer tow electric brake controller
- CJB
4. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step. 5. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom and
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9687
Trailer Lamps: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9688
Trailer Lamps: Pinpoint Tests
Test V: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST V: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
V1
Normal Operation
Ground for the trailer tow lamps is provided through circuit 206 (WH).
Possible Causes
- Circuit 206 (WH) open
- Trailer
Test W: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - RH Trailer Turn/Stop Lamp
PINPOINT TEST W: THE INDIVIDUAL TRAILER LAMP IS INOPERATIVE - RH TRAILER
TURN/STOP LAMP
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9689
W1-W2
Normal Operation
Voltage for the trailer tow RH turn/stop lamp is provided by the central junction box (CJB) fuse 36
(10A) through circuit 64 (DG).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 64 (DG) open
- Trailer
- CJB
Test X: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - LH Trailer Turn/Stop Lamp
PINPOINT TEST X: THE INDIVIDUAL TRAILER LAMP IS INOPERATIVE - LH TRAILER
TURN/STOP LAMP
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9690
X1-X2
Normal Operation
Voltage for the trailer tow LH turn/stop lamp is provided by the central junction box (CJB) fuse 42
(10A) through circuit 52 (YE).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 52 (YE) open
- Trailer
- CJB
Test Y: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Parking Lamps
PINPOINT TEST Y: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER PARKING LAMPS
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9691
Y1-Y4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9692
Y4-Y6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9693
Y7
Normal Operation
Voltage for the trailer tow parking lamps relay coil is supplied through circuit 14 (BN) when the
vehicle parking lamps are on. Ground for the trailer tow parking lamps relay coil is supplied through
circuit 57 (BK). Voltage for the trailer tow parking lamps relay supply is sent by the central junction
box (CJB) fuse 10 (20A). When the trailer tow parking lamps relay is energized, voltage is routed to
the trailer through circuit 962 (BN/WH).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 14 (BN) open
- Circuit 57 (BK) open
- Circuit 962 (BN/WH) open
- Trailer
- Trailer tow parking lamps relay
- CJB
Test Z: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Reversing Lamps
PINPOINT TEST Z: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER REVERSING LAMPS
Z1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9694
Z1-Z3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9695
Z3-Z4
Normal Operation
The trailer tow reversing lamps relay is integral to the central junction box (CJB). Voltage for the
trailer tow reversing lamps relay coil is supplied through circuit 140 (BK/PK) when the vehicle
reversing lamps are on. Ground for the trailer tow reversing lamps relay coil is supplied through
circuit 57 (BK). Voltage for the trailer tow reversing lamps relay supply is sent by the CJB fuse 10
(20A). When the trailer tow reversing lamps relay is energized, voltage is routed to the trailer
through circuit 963 (BK/LG).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 140 (BK/PK) open
- Circuit 57 (BK) open
- Circuit 963 (BK/LG) open
- Trailer
- CJB
Tests AA: The Trailer Lamps Are On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST AA: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9696
AA1-AA4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9697
AA4 Continued
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Parking Lamps
When the trailer tow parking lamps relay is energized, the voltage is routed to the trailer through
circuit 962 (BN/WH).
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Reversing Lamps
The trailer tow reversing lamps relay is integral to the central junction box (CJB). When the trailer
tow reversing lamps relay is energized, voltage is routed to the trailer through circuit 963 (BK/LG).
Possible Causes
- Circuit 962 (BN/WH) short to voltage
- Circuit 963 (BK/LG) short to voltage
- Trailer tow parking lamps relay
- Trailer
- CJB
Tests AB: The Trailer Battery Charging Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST AB: THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGING IS INOPERATIVE
AB1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9698
AB1-AB2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9699
AB3-AB5
Normal Operation
Voltage for the trailer tow battery charge relay coil is supplied by the central junction box (CJB) fuse
13 (10A) when the ignition switch is in the RUN position. Ground for the trailer tow battery charge
relay coil is supplied through circuit 57 (BK). Voltage for the trailer tow battery charge relay supply
is supplied by the CJB fuse 106 (30A). When the trailer tow battery charge relay is energized,
voltage is routed to the trailer through circuit 49 (OG).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 49 (OG) open
- Circuit 57 (BK) open
- Trailer tow battery charge relay
- Trailer
- CJB
Tests AC: The Trailer Electric Brakes Do Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST AC: THE TRAILER ELECTRIC BRAKES DO NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9700
AC1-AC2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9701
AC2-AC4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9702
AC5-AC6
Normal Operation
Voltage for the trailer tow electric brake controller is supplied by the central junction box (CJB) fuse
29 (30A) through circuit 50 (RD). Ground for the trailer tow electric brake controller coil is supplied
through circuit 206 (WH). Voltage input from the stoplamp switch is supplied through circuit 511
(LG). When the parking lamps are on, voltage for the trailer tow electric brake controller illumination
is supplied through circuit 14 (BN). Voltage output from the trailer tow electric brake controller
voltage to the trailer is sent through circuit 43 (DB).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 14 (BN) open
- Circuit 43 (DB) open or short to ground
- Circuit 50 (RD) open
- Circuit 206 (WH) open
- Circuit 511 (LG) open
- Trailer tow electric brake controller
- Trailer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9703
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9708
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
C2240
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 9711
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 9714
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 9715
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 9716
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9720
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9721
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9722
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9727
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9728
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9729
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9730
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9731
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9732
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9733
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9734
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9735
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9736
Trailer Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9737
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9738
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9739
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9740
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9741
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9742
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9743
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9744
Trailer Connector: Connector Views
C2142
C4098
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9745
C4099
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9746
Trailer Connector: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9747
95-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9748
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Locations
Body Control Module: Locations
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE (VSM)
View 151-17 (RH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9754
Body Control Module: Diagrams
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE (VSM)
C2113a
C2113b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9755
C2113c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
may result.
- Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload module configuration information to
the appropriate diagnostic equipment. This information needs to be downloaded into the new
module once installed.
1. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the driver seat module forward to remove it from the bracket.
2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
4. CAUTION: Once the module is installed it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the diagnostic tool into
the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) > Page 9758
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Vehicle Security Module
VEHICLE SECURITY MODULE
Removal
CAUTION: The steps included in the vehicle security module removal and installation procedure
are critical to restoring the vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring systems to normal
operation. A new vehicle security module is delivered in manufacturing mode with 6 pre-set
diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) related to the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). The
presence of these DTCs requires the installation procedures be followed in order to clear the DTCs
and enable normal vehicle security module operations.
1. NOTE: Prior to the removal of the vehicle security module, it is necessary to upload the module
configuration information to the diagnostic tool.
This information must be downloaded to the new vehicle security module after installation.
Disconnect the battery.
2. Remove the pin-type retainer and the RH A-pillar lower trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) > Page 9759
3. Remove the glove compartment. 4. Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors. 5. Remove the 2
screws and the vehicle security module.
Installation
1. Position the vehicle security module and install the 2 screws.
- Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
2. Connect the 3 electrical connectors. 3. Position the RH A-pillar lower trim panel and install the
pin-type retainer. 4. Install the glove compartment 5. Connect the battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for vehicle security module
operation and clears DTC B2477. The clearing
of the DTC indicates the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the vehicle security
module.
Download the vehicle security module configuration information from the diagnostic tool to the
vehicle security module.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the vehicle security
module has recognized the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. Clear the DTCs.
9. NOTE:
- DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the vehicle security module.
- This step is required to clear DTC C2780, allow the vehicle security module to exit the
manufacturing mode, and to be sure there are no other concerns with the newly programmed
vehicle security module.
Carry out the vehicle security module on-demand self-test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Running Board Motor Assembly, Left
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Running Board Motor Assembly, Left > Page 9765
View 151-17 (RH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Running Board Motor Assembly, Left
C3185
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Running Board Motor Assembly, Left > Page 9768
C3186
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9769
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor: Service and Repair
RETRACTABLE RUNNING BOARD MOTOR
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: If the retractable running board cannot be extracted, extend the running board by hand.
Extend the retractable running board.
2. Disconnect the retractable running board motor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9770
3. Remove the retractable running board motor.
- Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
- Remove the cover and retractable running board motor.
4. Disconnect the retractable running board sensor wiring harness. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair
FRONT BUMPER COVER
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9776
Navigator
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the lower air deflector.
- Remove the 8 pin-type retainers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9777
2. Remove the 2 front bumper cover lower pin-type retainers.
3. Remove the 3 front fender splash shield screws.
4. Remove the 2 front fender-to-front bumper cover bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Expedition
5. Disconnect the fog lamp electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9778
6. Remove the upper air deflector.
1 Remove the 8 pin-type retainers.
2 Remove the upper air deflector.
7. Remove the 2 bolts.
8. Release the front bumper cover clips and remove the front bumper cover.
Navigator
9. Disconnect the fog lamp electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9779
10. Release the front bumper cover clips and remove the front bumper.
All vehicles
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair
REAR BUMPER COVER
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Navigator shown, Expedition similar.
1. Remove the 5 rear fender splash shield bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair > Page 9784
2. Remove the rear 6 bumper cover nuts and bolts.
3. If equipped, disconnect the reverse parking aid electrical connector.
4. Remove the 2 rear bumper cover lower pin-type retainers.
5. Remove the liftgate trim.
- Remove the 2 pin-type retainers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair > Page 9785
6. Remove the rear bumper cover.
- Remove the 5 pin-type retainers and 2 bolts.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL PANEL GRILLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the windshield wipers. 2. Remove the cowl grille seal.
3. Remove the pin-type retainer and left side cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
4. Remove the right side cowl trim panel.
1 Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
2 Remove the pin-type retainer.
5. If necessary, adjust the windshield wiper arms. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Door Handle
EXTERIOR FRONT DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The front door window glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove the front door trim panel. 2. Position the watershield aside. 3. Open the clip and
disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod. 4. If equipped, disconnect the door lock cylinder
actuating rod from the lock cylinder.
5. NOTE: Push the exterior door handle out from the bottom surface of the handle.
Remove the 2 nuts and the exterior front door handle. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. NOTE: Make sure the door handle and the front door handle rod is in a relaxed position and that
the front door handle rod are all the way up
before closing the clips.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle > Page 9798
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches Exploded View
FRONT DOOR HANDLES, LOCKS AND LATCHES - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle > Page 9799
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Front Door, Fore and Aft
Front Door Hinge: Adjustments Hinge Adjustment - Front Door, Fore and Aft
HINGE ADJUSTMENT - FRONT DOOR, FORE AND AFT
NOTE: Check the rear door hinge adjustment before adjusting the front door hinge.
1. Remove the 2 door striker bolts and door striker. 2. Remove the front fender.
3. Loosen the front door hinge-to-body bolts. 4. Adjust the front door alignment to specification.
5. Tighten the front door hinge-to-body bolts to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft). 6. Install the front fender.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Front Door, Fore and Aft > Page 9804
7. Install and adjust the door striker.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Front Door, Fore and Aft > Page 9805
Front Door Hinge: Adjustments Hinge Adjustment - Front Door, Horizontal and Vertical
HINGE ADJUSTMENT - FRONT DOOR, HORIZONTAL AND VERTICAL
1. Remove the 2 door striker bolts and door striker.
2. Loosen the front door hinge-to-front door bolts enough to permit movement of the door. 3. Adjust
the front door alignment.
4. Tighten the front door hinge-to-front door bolts to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Install and adjust the door striker.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View
Front Door Latch: Service and Repair Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View
FRONT DOOR HANDLES, LOCKS AND LATCHES - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View > Page 9810
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View > Page 9811
Front Door Latch: Service and Repair Front Door Latch
FRONT DOOR LATCH
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: The door glass must be completely raised.
Remove the front door trim panel.
2. Position the watershield aside. 3. If equipped, disconnect the door lock cylinder actuating rod
from the lock cylinder. 4. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod. 5.
Remove and discard the 3 bolts and position the front door latch aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Disconnect the front door lock actuator and the door ajar switch electrical connectors.
7. Release the interior door handle actuating cable and remove the front door latch.
1 Position the cable cover aside.
2 Release the conduit and the interior door handle actuating cable.
8. NOTE: Make sure the door handle and the front door handle rod is in a relaxed position and that
the front door handle rod are all the way up
before closing the clips.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair
FRONT DOOR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left front door shown, right front similar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9815
1. Remove the window control switch plate.
- Use the service notch and disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Remove the door handle bezel.
- Use service notch.
3. CAUTION: To avoid damage to the door trim panel, lift the door trim panel by pulling directly
upward on the armrest to disengage the
panel clips.
Remove the 2 bolts and 3 screws and remove the door trim panel. Remove the finish cover to access the 2 center screws.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May > 07
> Body - Front Door Window Scratched
Front Door Window Glass: Customer Interest Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May > 07
> Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 9824
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May > 07
> Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 9825
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May > 07
> Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 9826
Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass:
One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF,
17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: Both Front Doors (Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May > 07
> Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 9827
Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5
> May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched
Front Door Window Glass: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5
> May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 9833
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5
> May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 9834
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5
> May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 9835
Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass:
One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF,
17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: Both Front Doors (Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5
> May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 9836
Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page
9837
Front Door Window Glass: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-10-5 Date: 070528
Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page
9838
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page
9839
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page
9840
Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass:
One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF,
17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: Both Front Doors (Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page
9841
Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-10-5 Date: 070528
Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page
9842
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page
9843
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page
9844
The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And
Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page
9845
Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9846
Front Door Window Glass: Service and Repair
FRONT DOOR WINDOW GLASS
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
2. Remove the front door weathershield.
Expedition
3. NOTE: Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
Connect the window control switch.
All vehicles
4. Lower the window glass to access the 2 window glass to regulator bolts.
5. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9847
6. Remove the front door glass channel bolt and position aside the channel.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
7. Remove the window glass-to-regulator bolts and front door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front > Page 9852
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
Front Door Window Motor: Diagrams Left Front
C518
C540
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 9855
C608
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9859
2. Remove the screws and the front door speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Remove the front door weathershield.
Expedition
4. NOTE: Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
Connect the window control switch.
All vehicles
5. Lower the window glass to access the 2 window glass-to-regulator bolts.
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9860
6. NOTE: Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
Disconnect the window control switch.
All vehicles
7. Remove the window glass-to-regulator bolts and front door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: Secure the front window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the front window glass with tape to the front door frame.
9. Position the interior door handle aside.
1 Remove the cable conduit fitting from the carrier assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9861
2 Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
3 Remove the cable from the door handle.
10. Release the crash sensor harness pin-type retainers.
11. Position the front door window regulator harness aside.
1 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2 Release the pin-type retainers.
12. Remove the front window regulator.
1 Loosen the 2 hanger bolts.
2 Remove the front window regulator bolts and front top run channel bolt. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Door Handle
EXTERIOR REAR DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The rear door window glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove the rear door trim panel. 2. Position the watershield aside.
3. Remove the childproof door lock cover. 4. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle
actuating rod.
5. NOTE: Push the exterior door handle out from the bottom surface of the handle.
Remove the 2 nuts and the exterior rear door handle. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. NOTE: Make sure the door handle and the rear door handle rod are in a relaxed position and the
rear door handle rod is all the way up before
closing the clips.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle > Page 9868
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Rear Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded
View
REAR DOOR HANDLES, LOCKS AND LATCHES - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle > Page 9869
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Door, Rear, Fore, Aft and Tilt
Rear Door Hinge: Adjustments Hinge Adjustment - Door, Rear, Fore, Aft and Tilt
HINGE ADJUSTMENT - DOOR, REAR, FORE, AFT AND TILT
1. Position the front seat in the full forward position.
2. Remove the 2 door striker bolts and door striker. 3. Remove the lower B-pillar trim panel.
4. Remove the B-pillar weathershield.
5. Loosen the hinge-to-B-pillar nuts enough to allow movement of the rear door. 6. Adjust the rear
door until it is uniform to adjacent panels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Door, Rear, Fore, Aft and Tilt > Page 9874
7. Tighten the hinge-to-B-pillar nuts to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
8. Install the B-pillar weathershield. 9. Install the lower B-pillar trim panel.
10. Install the door striker.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Door, Rear, Fore, Aft and Tilt > Page 9875
Rear Door Hinge: Adjustments Hinge Adjustment - Door, Rear, In, Out, Up and Down
HINGE ADJUSTMENT - DOOR, REAR, IN, OUT, UP AND DOWN
1. Remove the 2 door striker bolts and door striker.
2. Loosen the hinge-to-door bolts enough to allow door movement. 3. Adjust the door until it is
uniform to adjacent panels.
4. Tighten the hinge-to-door bolts to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Install the door striker.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View
Rear Door Latch: Service and Repair Rear Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View
REAR DOOR HANDLES, LOCKS AND LATCHES - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View > Page 9880
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View > Page 9881
Rear Door Latch: Service and Repair Rear Door Latch
REAR DOOR LATCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The rear door window glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove rear door trim panel. 2. Position the watershield aside.
3. Remove the childproof door lock cover. 4. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle
actuating rod. 5. Remove and discard the 3 bolts and position the rear door latch aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Disconnect the rear door lock actuator and ajar switch electrical connectors.
7. Release the interior door cable and remove the rear door latch.
1 Position the cable cover aside.
2 Release the conduit and the interior door handle actuating cable.
8. NOTE: Make sure the door handle and the rear door handle rod are in a relaxed position and the
rear door handle rod is all the way up before
closing the clips.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair
REAR DOOR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left rear door shown, right rear similar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9885
1. If equipped with power windows, remove the window control switch plate.
- Use the service notch.
2. Remove the door handle bezel.
- Use the service notch.
3. CAUTION: To avoid damage to the door trim panel, lift the door trim panel by pulling directly
upward on the armrest to disengage the
panel clips.
Remove the 2 bolts and 3 screws, and remove the door trim panel. Remove the finish cover to access the 2 center screws.
- If equipped, disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Window Glass
Rear Door Window Glass: Service and Repair Rear Door Window Glass
REAR DOOR WINDOW GLASS
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel.
2. Position back the rear door weathershield. 3. Connect the window control switch. 4. Lower the
window glass to access the 2 window glass to regulator bolts.
5. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
6. Remove the rear door glass channel bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Window Glass > Page 9890
7. Remove the window glass to regulator bolts and rear door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Window Glass > Page 9891
Rear Door Window Glass: Service and Repair Rear Door Window Glass - Stationary
REAR DOOR WINDOW GLASS - STATIONARY
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door window glass.
2. Remove the rear door exterior glass moulding. 3. Remove the rear door glass top run.
4. Remove the rear door stationary glass screw. 5. Remove the stationary rear door glass.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR - REAR DOOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9895
2. Remove the rear door speaker.
1 Remove the screws.
2 Disconnect the electrical connector.
3 Remove the speaker.
3. Remove the rear door weathershield. 4. Connect the window control switch. 5. Lower the
window glass to access the 2 window glass-to-regulator bolts. 6. Disconnect the window control
switch.
7. Remove the window glass-to-regulator bolts and rear door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: Secure the rear window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the rear window glass with tape to the front door frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9896
9. Disconnect the rear door window regulator electrical connectors.
10. Position the interior door handle aside.
- Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
11. Remove the rear door window regulator assembly.
- Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Hood Latch
Hood Latch: Service and Repair Hood Latch
HOOD LATCH
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 8 pin-type retainers and the upper radiator sight shield.
Expedition
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the hood latch.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
3. Release the hood latch cable from the hood latch.
Navigator
4. Remove the screw and position the secondary hood latch release handle aside.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
5. Remove the 2 bolts and the hood latch.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
6. Release the primary and secondary hood latch cables from the hood latch.
All vehicles
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the hood latch engages the striker in the latched position (secondary).
- Verify the hood latch engages the striker in the fully latched position (primary).
- Adjust the hood latch as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Hood Latch > Page 9902
Hood Latch: Service and Repair Hood Latch and Components - Exploded View
Hood Latch and Components - Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Hood Latch and Components - Exploded View
Hood Latch Release: Service and Repair Hood Latch and Components - Exploded View
Hood Latch and Components - Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Hood Latch and Components - Exploded View > Page 9907
Hood Latch Release: Service and Repair Hood Latch Release Handle
HOOD LATCH RELEASE HANDLE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Navigator secondary hood latch release handle and cable is removed as part of the
hood latch.
1. Remove the hood latch. 2. Remove the hood latch release handle and cable screw.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-ft).
3. Release the cable guides and push the cable through the dash panel and remove the hood latch
release handle and cable. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair
LIFTGATE WINDOW GLASS
Removal and Installation
Window glass assembly
1. Remove the rear window wiper motor.
2. Disconnect the rear window defrost electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9912
3. CAUTION:
- The liftgate glass must be supported when removing and installing the liftgate assist cylinders.
- Do not extend the socket clips more than 2.0 mm (0.08 in) or failure of the socket can occur.
Disconnect the 2 liftgate glass assist cylinders. 1
Insert a screwdriver blade under the socket clip and lift.
2 Gently pull the socket off the ball stud.
Window glass assembly or hinge assembly
4. Remove the liftgate glass hinge-to-body fasteners and remove the glass.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Window hinge assembly
5. Remove the liftgate glass to hinge fasteners and remove the glass.
- Apply Threadlock 262 to the liftgate glass to hinge fasteners during installation.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Window glass assembly or window hinge assembly
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 9916
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
C4174a
C4174b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 9917
C4174c
C4174d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 9918
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair
POWER LIFTGATE MODULE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Prior to removal of the power liftgate module, it is necessary to upload module configuration
information to a diagnostic tool. This information needs to be downloaded into the new power
liftgate module once installed.
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the power liftgate module.
1 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2 Remove the nut. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: Once the new power liftgate module is installed, it is necessary to download the module
configuration information from the diagnostic
tool into the new power liftgate module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Glass Actuator
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Glass Actuator > Page 9923
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Glass Actuator
C4040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Glass Actuator > Page 9926
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Actuator: Diagrams Liftgate Lock Actuator
C457
C4185
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9930
C4039
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hinge >
Component Information > Adjustments
Trunk / Liftgate Hinge: Adjustments
HINGE ADJUSTMENT - LIFTGATE
1. Loosen the liftgate hinge to liftgate bolts.
2. Adjust the liftgate alignment.
3. NOTE: The bolt washers must make full contact with the liftgate bracket when tightened.
Tighten the liftgate hinge-to-liftgate bolts to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Handle >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View
Trunk / Liftgate Handle: Service and Repair Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View
LIFTGATE HANDLE, LOCK AND LATCH - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Handle >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View > Page 9938
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Handle >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View > Page 9939
Trunk / Liftgate Handle: Service and Repair Liftgate Release Handle
LIFTGATE RELEASE HANDLE
Removal and Installation
All Vehicles
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Position the watershield aside.
Expedition
3. Remove the 2 nuts and position the liftgate release handle aside.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
4. Release the liftgate latch actuating cable from the liftgate release handle and remove the handle.
Navigator
5. Remove the 2 liftgate release handle nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. NOTE: Release the clips on the inside of license plate housing.
Remove the license plate housing. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
- Remove the 6 nuts.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
7. Release the liftgate release handle from the liftgate. 8. Disconnect the electrical connector and
release the liftgate latch actuating cable from the liftgate release handle and remove the handle.
All vehicles
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View
LIFTGATE HANDLE, LOCK AND LATCH - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View > Page 9944
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View > Page 9945
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch
LIFTGATE LATCH
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Position the watershield aside.
Vehicles with manual liftgate
3. Disconnect the liftgate latch electrical connectors.
Vehicles with power liftgate
4. CAUTION: Be careful not to kink the liftgate latch actuating cable while disconnecting it.
Disconnect the liftgate latch. 1
Disconnect the liftgate latch actuating cable.
2 Release the door lock actuator rod.
3 Release the actuating rod.
4 Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. Remove and discard the 3 bolts and position the liftgate latch aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Vehicles with manual liftgate
6. CAUTION: Be careful not to kink the liftgate latch actuating cable while disconnecting it from the
latch.
Disconnect the liftgate latch actuating cable and remove the liftgate latch.
Vehicles with power liftgate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View > Page 9946
7. CAUTION: Be careful not to kink the liftgate latch control cable while disconnecting it from the
latch.
Disconnect the liftgate latch control cable and remove the liftgate latch.
All vehicles
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View > Page 9947
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch - Window
LIFTGATE LATCH - WINDOW
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Open the liftgate window glass. 3. Disconnect the liftgate
window latch electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the liftgate window latch.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View > Page 9948
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch Remote Control
LIFTGATE LATCH REMOTE CONTROL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The liftgate latch remote control is available with power liftgate only.
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Position the watershield aside.
3. CAUTION: Be careful not to kink the liftgate latch actuating cable while disconnecting it from the
latch.
Disconnect the liftgate latch. 1
Release the liftgate latch actuator rod.
2 Disconnect the liftgate latch actuating cable.
4. Remove 3 bolts and position the liftgate latch remote control aside.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-in).
5. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the liftgate latch remote control. 6. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Cinching Motor
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Cinching Motor > Page 9953
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Cinching Motor > Page 9954
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Cinching Motor
C4188
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Cinching Motor > Page 9957
Trunk / Liftgate Motor: Diagrams Liftgate Drive Motor Assembly, Left
C997a
C997b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Cinching Motor > Page 9958
C996
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Cinching Motor > Page 9959
C4189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9960
Trunk / Liftgate Motor: Service and Repair
POWER LIFTGATE MOTOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9961
2. NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Position the front and rear door seals aside.
3. Remove the C-pillar trim panel. 4. Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
5. CAUTION: To prevent damage to the coat hanger retainer, use a 3/16-inch flat-blade
screwdriver for this step.
Remove the 4 coat hooks. Open the access cover.
- Insert a screwdriver into the slot and rotate.
6. If equipped with rear climate control, remove the center pin-type retainers.
7. Remove the rear pin-type retainers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9962
8. CAUTION: To avoid damaging the headliner, do not crease or bend it.
Partially lower the headliner to access the power liftgate motor.
9. Remove the upper liftgate trim.
10. Position the wiring harness aside.
11. Remove the power liftgate motor to liftgate bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
12. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the power liftgate motor bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
13. Remove the power liftgate motor pivot bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9963
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
14. Slide the power liftgate motor assembly forward and remove the power liftgate motor. 15. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View
Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid: Service and Repair Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View
LIFTGATE HANDLE, LOCK AND LATCH - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View > Page 9968
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Handle, Lock and Latch - Exploded View > Page 9969
Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch Actuator
LIFTGATE LATCH ACTUATOR
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Position the watershield aside.
3. Release the liftgate latch actuator rod from the liftgate latch. 4. Disconnect the liftgate latch
actuator electrical connector. 5. Remove the rivet and the liftgate latch actuator. 6. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
- Use the Heavy Duty Riveter to install the new rivet.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Striker >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Striker: Service and Repair
REAR WINDOW STRIKER AND WIPER PIVOT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
Removal
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm.
2. Remove the dust boot cover.
3. Remove the nut and the rear window glass handle.
4. Remove the nuts and the rear window striker and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. NOTE: An audible click should be heard as the striker engages the latch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Striker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9973
Push the rear window wiper striker and pivot shaft assembly into the wiper motor. The pivot shaft
pin should be aligned with the hole in the motor disc.
3. Install the rear window wiper motor alignment tool. If installing a new rear wiper motor, one is
provided with the motor assembly.
1 Make sure the alignment tool fits over the motor disc and striker assembly.
2 Make sure the alignment tool clips are securely engaged.
4. Carefully close the liftgate glass.
5. Open the liftgate. Install the rear window wiper striker and wiper pivot arm mounting assembly
nuts. Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. Remove the rear window wiper motor alignment tool. 7. Close the liftgate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Striker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9974
8. Install the rear window wiper pivot shaft nut and handle. Tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
9. Install the dust boot cover.
10. NOTE: This step makes sure that the wiper motor is in the PARK position.
Turn the rear window wiper switch ON and allow the motor to operate for at least one cycle. Turn
the rear window wiper switch to OFF.
11. Install the rear wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
1 Position the wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
2 Tighten the nut to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
3 Install the cover.
12. Open the liftgate. 13. Install the liftgate trim panel. 14. Test the liftgate and liftgate glass for
normal operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 9979
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 9980
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch
C4190
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 9983
C4187
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 9984
C9000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL PANEL GRILLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the windshield wipers. 2. Remove the cowl grille seal.
3. Remove the pin-type retainer and left side cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
4. Remove the right side cowl trim panel.
1 Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
2 Remove the pin-type retainer.
5. If necessary, adjust the windshield wiper arms. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Fender: Service and Repair
FENDER - EXPEDITION
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove the front fender splash shield.
2. Remove the 2 front fender-to-front bumper cover bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > System Information > Service and Repair > Page
9993
3. Remove the front fender-to-radiator support bolt.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 2 front fender lower bolts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
5. Remove the foam insulator.
- Remove the pin-type retainer.
6. Remove the 2 front fender inner bolts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > System Information > Service and Repair > Page
9994
7. Loosen the headlamp retaining bolt.
8. Remove the headlamp.
- Remove the bolts and disconnect the electrical connectors.
9. Remove the 2 front fender front bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
10. Remove the cowl panel grille.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > System Information > Service and Repair > Page
9995
11. Remove the front fender.
1 Remove the 4 bolts.
2 Remove the front fender. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Locations
> Page 10000
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Description and Operation
FRAME AND BODY MOUNTING
Frame Components
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Locations
> Page 10001
Spare Tire Winch
The frame is made up of 2 steel boxed side rails and crossmembers, which are welded to the 2
side rails. The transmission crossmember is bolted to the side rails. The side welded rails and
crossmembers are not replaced separately.
The service kits available for the frame are the following:
- RH front horn replacement kit (5D058)
- LH front horn replacement kit (5D059)
- Front bumper bracket replacement kit (17N775)
- 1B crossmember replacement kit (5C075)
- Transmission crossmember replacement kit (5059)
Refer to the instructions included in the kits for installation instructions.
Frame Mounted Heat Shields
All frame mounted heat shields are torqued to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Service and Repair Body Support - Number 1
BODY SUPPORT - NUMBER 1
No.1 Body Support Mount
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove the body mount bolt.
- To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
2. Loosen the remaining body mount bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 10004
3. Raise the vehicle body enough to remove the body mount bolts and body mount.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
4. NOTE:
- No lubricants of any kind are to be used during body mount installation.
- Do not reuse body mount fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each fastener that has
been removed or loosened.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 10005
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Service and Repair Body Support - Number 2 and Number 3
BODY SUPPORT - NUMBER 2 AND NUMBER 3
No.2 Body Support Mount
No.3 Body Support Mount
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Body mount No. 2, left side shown, all others similar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 10006
Upper and lower body support mount
1. Remove the body mount bolt and lower body mount.
- To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
Upper body mount
2. Loosen the remaining body mount bolts.
3. Raise the vehicle body enough to remove the upper body mount.
Upper and lower body mount
4. NOTE:
- No lubricants of any kind are to be used during body mount installation.
- Do not reuse body mount fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each fastener that has
been removed or loosened.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 10007
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Service and Repair Body Support - Number 4
BODY SUPPORT - NUMBER 4
No.4 Body Mount
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove the liftgate scuff plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 10008
2. Remove the body mount bolt cover.
3. Remove the body mount nut.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
4. Loosen the remaining body mount bolts.
5. Raise the vehicle body enough to remove the body mount bolts.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
6. NOTE:
- No lubricants of any kind are to be used during body mount installation.
- Do not reuse body mount fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each fastener that has
been removed or loosened.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 10009
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Service and Repair Body Support - Radiator Support
BODY SUPPORT - RADIATOR SUPPORT
Radiator Support Mount
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
Upper and lower body mount
1. Remove the lower radiator body mount.
1 Remove the lower radiator body mount bolt.
2 Remove the lower radiator body mount.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 10010
- To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
Upper body mount
2. Loosen the remaining body mount bolts.
3. Raise the vehicle body enough to remove the upper body mount.
Upper and lower body mount
4. NOTE:
- No lubricants of any kind are to be used during body mount installation.
- Do not reuse body mount fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each fastener that has
been removed or loosened.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Service and Repair > Spot Welds - Rear Cross Member & Side Members
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Service and Repair > Spot Welds - Rear Cross Member & Side Members > Page 10016
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Service and Repair > Spot Welds - Rear Cross Member & Side Members > Page 10017
Rear Cross-Member: Service and Repair Transmission Support Crossmember
TRANSMISSION SUPPORT CROSSMEMBER
Transmission Support Crossmember - Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. If equipped, remove the skid plate fasteners and skid plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Service and Repair > Spot Welds - Rear Cross Member & Side Members > Page 10018
3. Remove the LH and RH exhaust heat shield-to-crossmember fasteners. 4. Remove the 2
transmission mount nuts.
- To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
5. Support the transmission.
6. NOTE: Mark the transmission crossmember next to the edge of the frame bracket to make sure
the crossmember is installed in the same position
it was removed from.
Remove the 4 transmission crossmember bolts and transmission crossmember. To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch: Service and Repair
TRAILER HITCH
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not permanently remove the trailer hitch. Always reinstall the hitch before delivery
of the vehicle to the customer. Failure to follow this warning could increase the risk of injury in a
rear end collision.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Remove the trailer hitch rear bumper cover trim panel.
3. Remove the trailer lighting plug cover and disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the trailer lighting plug.
1 Position the plug away from the trailer hitch.
2 Disconnect the electrical connector.
3 Remove the trailer lighting plug.
5. Remove the trailer hitch.
- Remove the 8 bolts. To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Do not reuse body support mounting fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each
fastener that has been removed or loosened.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page
10025
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page
10026
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page
10027
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair
Grille: Service and Repair
RADIATOR GRILLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover.
2. Remove the clips and remove the front grille. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Arm Rest > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Arm Rest: Service and Repair
SEAT ARMREST - SECOND ROW
Removal and Installation
1. To access the armrest locking metal clip, pull the armrest material back on the top side of the
armrest for access to the release clip.
2. CAUTION: To remove armrests, do not pull them off with force. The locking metal clip will be
damaged and a new armrest will need to
be installed.
NOTE: Armrest removed to show detail of release button mechanism.
Use a tool such as a flat-bladed screwdriver to push the release button at the hinge point. The clip
will release and the armrest will slide off the pin.
3. CAUTION: To install armrests, do not push them on with force. The locking metal clip will be
damaged and a new armrest will need to
be installed.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. To install the armrest, push the release button and slide the armrest on the pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Console - Floor, Front
Console: Description and Operation Console - Floor, Front
CONSOLE - FLOOR, FRONT
The front floor console may consist of the following components:
- A/C integral control assembly
- A/C register (upper)
- Auxiliary A/C controls
- Auxiliary power point
- Center console finish panel
- Console finish panel mat
- Compact disc (CD) player mounting bracket
- CD player compartment trim panel
- Digital audio compact disc player
- Shift lever (Navigator)
- Window control switch panel (Navigator)
- Navigation system display module
- Navigation system module
- Video cassette player
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Console - Floor, Front > Page 10039
Console: Description and Operation Console - Floor, Rear
CONSOLE - FLOOR, REAR
The rear console consists of the following components:
- Armrest
- Cup holders
- Storage bin
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Console - Floor, Front > Page 10040
Console: Description and Operation Console - Overhead
CONSOLE - OVERHEAD
There are 2 versions of the overhead console, with and without the roof opening panel.
The overhead console with the roof opening panel may contain the following:
- Climate controls (optional)
- Map lamps/switches
- Roof opening panel switch
- Rear quarter window switches (optional)
The overhead console without the roof opening panel may contain the following:
- Climate controls (optional)
- Glasses storage bin
- Map lamps/switches
- Rear quarter window switches (optional)
- Storage bin
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Floor Console - Front
Console: Service and Repair Floor Console - Front
FLOOR CONSOLE - FRONT
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Floor Console - Front > Page 10043
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. Position the front seat forward.
2. Remove the 2 front floor console rear bolts.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. Position the front seats rearward. 4. Disconnect the battery.
5. Remove the console finish panel.
1 Remove the mat.
2 Remove the screw.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Floor Console - Front > Page 10044
6. Disconnect the front floor console electrical connectors.
1 Loosen the electrical connector bolt. To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
2 Disconnect the electrical connector.
7. Remove the floor console.
1 Remove the screws.
2 Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Floor Console - Front > Page 10045
Console: Service and Repair Floor Console - Rear
FLOOR CONSOLE - REAR
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Floor Console - Front > Page 10046
1. Remove the rear floor console.
1 Open the front bin.
2 Remove the cup holder.
3 Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety
canopy deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a seat mounted side air bag and/or a safety belt pretensioner (if equipped)
system is being serviced, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central junction
box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover and
remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and close
the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10052
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety canopy
module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10053
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central
junction box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover
and remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Remove the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
8. Remove the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10054
9. Remove the driver air bag module.
1 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
2 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
3 Disconnect the horn switch electrical connector.
4 Remove the driver air bag module.
Navigator
10. Disconnect the driver air bag module.
- Release the 2 tabs on each driver air bag module electrical connector and disconnect them. Label each driver air bag module electrical connector before disconnecting.
11. Release the tab and disconnect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector at
the top of the clockspring and remove the driver air
bag module.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10055
12. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tools to the clockspring electrical connectors at the top of
the steering column.
13. While pushing in on the 2 glove compartment door tabs, position the glove compartment
downward.
14. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the tab and disconnect the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
15. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
Vehicles with safety canopies
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10056
16. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
17. Remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
18. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10057
19. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
20. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide.
21. Remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
22. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10058
23. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the driver side safety
canopy electrical connector.
All vehicles 24. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB. 25. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
Vehicles with safety canopies
3. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the driver side
safety canopy electrical connector.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10059
5. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the driver side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
6. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row driver side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
7. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10060
8. Connect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
9. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
10. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10061
11. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger air
bag module electrical connector.
12. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
13. Close the glove compartment.
14. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tools from the clockspring electrical connector at the
top of the steering column.
Navigator
15. Connect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector to the connector end at the
top of the clockspring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10062
16. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module.
Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the
electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
Expedition
17. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
1 Connect the horn switch electrical connector.
2 CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the
driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal.
3 Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
All vehicles
18. Install the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10063
19. Install the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
20. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
21. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 22. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and
close the cover.
23. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
24. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 10064
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Prove Out Procedure
PROVE OUT PROCEDURE
Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the ON position and visually monitor the air bag indicator
with all SRS components connected or restraint system diagnostic tools installed. The air bag
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is
present, the air bag indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator will
need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Glove Compartment: Service and Repair
GLOVE COMPARTMENT
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Forcing the glove compartment past the stops will damage the dampener.
Open the glove compartment.
2. Disconnect the dampener.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 10068
3. Release the stops.
4. Remove the screws and the glove compartment. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Headliner: Service and Repair
HEADLINER
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
2. Position aside the front and rear door seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 10072
3. If equipped, remove the roof opening panel trim.
4. Remove the A-pillar trim panels.
- Remove the bolt covers and bolts.
5. Remove the 2 pushpin retainers from the A-pillar post. 6. Open and lower the glove
compartment.
7. Remove the pushpin retainer and disconnect the electronic compass/auto dimming rearview
mirror connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 10073
8. If equipped, remove the electronic compass sensor.
9. If equipped, disconnect the auto-dimming mirror electrical connector.
10. Remove the 2 sun visors and visor clips.
1 Remove the 8 screws.
2 Remove the 2 sun visors and visor clips. If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors.
11. If equipped, remove the overhead console. 12. If equipped, remove the DVD player. 13.
Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel. 14. Remove the C-pillar trim panel.
15. Position aside the RH quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 10074
- Remove the pushpins.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
16. Position aside the LH quarter trim panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
17. Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
18. CAUTION: To prevent damage to the coat hanger retainer, use a 3/16-inch flat-blade
screwdriver for this step.
Remove the 4 coat hooks. Open the access cover.
- Insert a screwdriver into the slot and rotate.
19. Disconnect the 2 electrical connectors at the right side C-pillar and 1 electrical connector at the
left side C-pillar.
Vehicles equipped with rear climate control
20. Remove the center pin-type retainers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 10075
21. Remove the rear pin-type retainers.
22. Tilt the headliner to release the vent duct.
All vehicles
23. Remove the headliner. 24. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Transfer parts as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel
Trim Panel: Service and Repair A-Pillar Trim Panel
A-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 2 front assist handle covers. 2. Remove the 2 bolts.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. NOTE: Carefully rotate the A-pillar trim panel during this step.
Pry the A-pillar trim panel to remove.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10080
Trim Panel: Service and Repair B-Pillar Trim Panel
B-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
Upper and lower
1. NOTE:
- Position the shoulder safety belt guide to the lowest position.
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or the cover does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide. 1
Position the shoulder safety belt guide cover up.
2 Remove the safety belt guide nut. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
2. Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel.
1 Remove the bolt cover and bolt. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2 Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel by pulling outward to release the clips.
Lower
3. Remove the front and rear door scuff plates.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10081
4. Position the lower B-pillar trim panel aside.
5. Remove the front safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
6. Feed the safety belt through the lower B-pillar trim panel and remove.
Upper and lower
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- When installing the upper B-pillar trim panel, insert the safety belt guide slide into the upper
B-pillar trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10082
Trim Panel: Service and Repair C-Pillar Trim Panel
C-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Right side shown, left side similar.
1. NOTE:
- Position the shoulder safety belt guide to the lowest position.
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or the cover does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide. 1
Position the shoulder safety belt cover up.
2 Remove the safety belt guide nut. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
2. Remove the C-pillar trim panel.
1 Remove the bolt cover and bolt. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2 Remove the C-pillar trim panel by pulling outward to release the retainers.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10083
Trim Panel: Service and Repair D-Pillar Trim Panel
D-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Right side with power vent windows and power liftgate shown, all others similar.
1. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide
cover is damaged or cover does not remain
closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide. 1
Position the shoulder safety guide cover up.
2 Remove the safety belt guide nut. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
2. Remove rear upper headliner trim panel.
3. Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
1 Disengage the upper clip by pulling downward.
2 Unseat the D-pillar trim panel and rotate forward to remove.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10084
Trim Panel: Service and Repair
A-Pillar Trim Panel
A-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 2 front assist handle covers. 2. Remove the 2 bolts.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. NOTE: Carefully rotate the A-pillar trim panel during this step.
Pry the A-pillar trim panel to remove.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
B-Pillar Trim Panel
B-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
Upper and lower
1. NOTE:
- Position the shoulder safety belt guide to the lowest position.
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or the cover does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide. 1
Position the shoulder safety belt guide cover up.
2 Remove the safety belt guide nut. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
2. Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel.
1 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10085
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2 Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel by pulling outward to release the clips.
Lower
3. Remove the front and rear door scuff plates.
4. Position the lower B-pillar trim panel aside.
5. Remove the front safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
6. Feed the safety belt through the lower B-pillar trim panel and remove.
Upper and lower
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- When installing the upper B-pillar trim panel, insert the safety belt guide slide into the upper
B-pillar trim panel.
C-Pillar Trim Panel
C-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Right side shown, left side similar.
1. NOTE:
- Position the shoulder safety belt guide to the lowest position.
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or the cover does not remain closed,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10086
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide. 1
Position the shoulder safety belt cover up.
2 Remove the safety belt guide nut. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
2. Remove the C-pillar trim panel.
1 Remove the bolt cover and bolt. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2 Remove the C-pillar trim panel by pulling outward to release the retainers.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
D-Pillar Trim Panel
D-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Right side with power vent windows and power liftgate shown, all others similar.
1. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide
cover is damaged or cover does not remain
closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide. 1
Position the shoulder safety guide cover up.
2 Remove the safety belt guide nut. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10087
2. Remove rear upper headliner trim panel.
3. Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
1 Disengage the upper clip by pulling downward.
2 Unseat the D-pillar trim panel and rotate forward to remove.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Interior Trim - Exploded View
INTERIOR TRIM - EXPLODED VIEW
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10088
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10089
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Liftgate Trim Panel
LIFTGATE TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
1. Open the liftgate glass and remove the scrivets.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10090
2. Open the liftgate and remove the upper liftgate trim panel.
- Pull lower corners toward the center on both sides and pull down along the top.
3. Remove the assist handle.
1 Remove the screws.
2 Remove the assist handle.
4. Remove the lower liftgate trim panel.
1 Hold the trim panel at the center area and slightly pull on the center clips to allow a tool to access
the clips.
2 Release the 12 clips 2 to 3 at a time, starting from the right side working to the left side.
3 Once all the clips are released, slide the liftgate trim panel forward and down, away from the
sheet metal.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Rear Quarter Trim Panel
REAR QUARTER TRIM PANEL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10091
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the C-pillar trim panel. 2. Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
3. Remove the liftgate scuff plate by pulling upward.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10092
4. Remove the rear floor loadspace trim panel.
5. Remove the floor jack assembly.
6. Remove the pin-type retainers and pull back the carpeting.
7. Remove the 2 bolts and the loadspace trim panel by pulling upward.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10093
8. Remove the third row seat safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
9. Remove the rear quarter trim panel pin-type retainer.
10. Remove the second row safety belt anchor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
11. Remove the rear door scuff plate by pulling upward.
12. NOTE: The seat back must not be folded completely down, as the quarter trim panel will not
have enough clearance to be removed.
Fold the seat back of the third row seat downward so that the top edge of the seat back is
positioned within approximately 203 mm (8 in) of the full DOWN position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 10094
13. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
- Disengage the rear clip on the base of the trim panel first, by pulling the bottom rear edge toward
the center of the vehicle.
- Disengage the remaining clips.
- If equipped, disconnect the power point and power third row seat switch electrical connector at
the rear.
14. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Door Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
DOOR LOCK CYLINDER
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Individual lock cylinders are repaired by discarding the inoperative lock cylinder and
building a new lock cylinder using the appropriate lock repair package. The lock repair package
includes a detailed instruction sheet to build the new lock cylinder to the current code of the
vehicle.
1. Remove the exterior front door handle. 2. Remove the retainer and the front door lock cylinder.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Keyless Entry - Keypad Diagnostics
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Technical Service Bulletins Keyless Entry - Keypad Diagnostics
TSB 06-15-8
08/07/06
KEYPAD DIAGNOSTICS - DEALER INSTALLED ACCESSORY
FORD: 1998-2006 Taurus 1999-2003 Escort 1999-2006 Mustang 2000-2006 Focus 2002-2005
Thunderbird 2005-2006 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006 Crown Victoria, Fusion 1998-2006
Expedition, Explorer, F-150, Ranger 1999 F-250 Light Duty 1999-2003 Windstar 1999-2006
F-Super Duty 2000-2005 Excursion 2000-2006 E-Series 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2005
Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2006 Escape 2004 F-150 Heritage 2004-2006 Freestar
LINCOLN: 1998-2006 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 1998-2006 Navigator
2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1998-2005 Sable 1999-2002 Cougar 2005-2006 Montego 2006 Grand Marquis, Milan
1998-2006 Mountaineer 2004-2006 Monterey 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some vehicles may experience a concern with the keyless entry keypad. In order to
properly diagnose the concern with the keyless entry keypad, it is important to identify whether the
keypad is a factory installed style (wired) or a Genuine Ford Accessory (GFA) radio frequency (RF)
style keypad.
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to identify GFA RF keypads and provide diagnostic
service tips.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
IDENTIFICATION:
1. Production installed keyless entry keypads are mounted flush with the surface of the vehicle and
are wired directly to the module controlling the vehicle's keyless entry system. This style keypad
can be diagnosed using the appropriate Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-14.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Keyless Entry - Keypad Diagnostics > Page 10105
2. Dealer installed GFA RF keypads are adhesive backed and protrude approximately 1/2" (13
mm) from the surface of the vehicle and there are no specific diagnostics available in the WSM
(Figure 1).
NOTE
THIS RF KEYPAD WAS ALSO US[D IN PRODUCTION ON 2004 F-SUPER DUTY VEHICLES
BUILT PRIOR TO 12/3/2003. REFER TO WSM, SECTION 501-14 FOR RF KEYPAD
DIAGNOSTICS FOR THESE VEHICLES.
GENUINE FORD ACCESSORY KEYPAD DIAGNOSTIC TIPS
1. The keypad operates similarly to a remote keyless entry (RKE) transmitter and is programmed
using a similar procedure.
Although the RF keypad is not specifically addressed in the WSM, the RKE transmitter
programming portion of the WSM, Section 501-14 can be used as a guide
NOTE
THE 7-8 AND 9-0 BUTTONS ON THE KEYPAD MUST BE PRESSED SIMULTANEOUSLY
DURING THE PROCEDURE IN ORDER FOR THE KEYPAD TO BE RECOGNIZED AS AN
ADDITIONAL REMOTE TRANSMITTER.
Since the GFA RF keypad is essentially another RKE transmitter, the transmitter diagnostic
pinpoint tests in the vehicle's WSM can also be referenced even though the buttons serving the
lock / unlock functions will differ
2. The GFA RF keypad is serviced as an assembly. The internal battery cannot be replaced
separately.
3. If the master code or owner selectable code is lost or forgotten, the GFA RF keypad must be
replaced. These codes are not stored in any vehicle module (with the exception of 2004 F-Super
Duty vehicles produced prior to 12/3/2003).
4. The GFA RF keypad and all RKE transmitters (the number of transmitters allowable will vary by
vehicle) must be reprogrammed together anytime the keypad is replaced, an RKE transmitter is
replaced, or the module controlling the keyless entry system on the vehicle (GEM/SJB/VSM/DDM
etc.) is replaced.
NOTE
THERE IS AN EXCEPTION TO TIP 4 FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH INTEGRATED
KEYHEAD TRANSMITTERS (IKTs) (FUSION/MILAN/ZEPHYR). THE GFA RF KEYPADS FOR
VEHICLES WITH IKTs MUST BE PROGRAMMED INDEPENDENTLY FROM THE IKTs. TURN
THE IGNITION FROM "OFF" TO "RUN" 8 TIMES WITHIN 10 SECONDS, WITH THE 8TH TIME
ENDING IN "RUN". THE DOOR LOCKS WILL CYCLE TO CONFIRM ENTERING
PROGRAMMING MODE. PRESS THE 7-8 AND 9-0 BUTTON ON THE KEYPAD
SIMULTANEOUSLY TO SEND A LOCK SIGNAL. TURN IGNITION TO OFF. THE LOCKS WILL
CYCLE AGAIN TO INDICATE THE END OF THE PROGRAMMING MODE.
5. The keypad will normally illuminate for 5 seconds after one or more buttons are pressed, and the
illumination will immediately turn off if the 7-8 and 9-0 buttons are pressed simultaneously (lock all
doors). The keypad contains an optical sensor and will not illuminate under bright lighting
conditions. The keypad may only illuminate briefly in colder temperatures in order to maximize the
battery power available to transmit a lock/unlock signal. The temperature at which this occurs will
vary depending upon the keypad battery age and condition. Both of these conditions are a normal
function of the Power Save Mode and do not indicate a need to replace the keypad.
6. After entering the keypad code, the system may unlock the driver's door, lock it, then unlock it
again, and the keypad will not even briefly illuminate. This is the Alert Mode and is an indication
that battery power is very low and the keypad must be replaced.
7. The keypad also contains an Anti-scan feature. If the wrong code has been entered 7 times (35
consecutive button presses) the keypad is disabled for one minute and the keypad lamp will flash
during this time.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Keyless Entry - Keypad Diagnostics > Page 10106
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14A626 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10107
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10108
C500
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Remote Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair Remote Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD CODE PROGRAMMING
1. Enter the permanent factory remote keyless entry (RKE) keypad code. 2. Press the 1/2 button
within 5 seconds to activate the programming mode. Holding the 1/2 button for more than 2
seconds after activation erases
the stored customer code. The doors lock, then unlock, confirming the code is erased. The existing
code does not need to be erased to program a new code.
3. Within 5 seconds, enter the new 5-digit RKE keypad code. The doors lock and unlock to confirm
the new code is programmed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Remote Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming > Page 10111
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair Autolock and Horn Chirp Programming
AUTOLOCK AND HORN CHIRP PROGRAMMING
1. Close all the doors. 2. Confirm that the ignition switch is in the OFF position. 3. Turn the ignition
switch from OFF to RUN.
4. NOTE: Steps 4 through 8 must be carried out within 30 seconds.
Press the power door lock UNLOCK button 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch from RUN to OFF. 6. Press the power door lock UNLOCK button 3
times. 7. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to RUN. 8. Verify the horn chirps. This indicates the
system is in the enable/disable mode is ready to accept program changes. 9. Press the power door
lock UNLOCK button 1 time to toggle the autolock/relock feature OFF.
10. Press the power door lock LOCK button once to enter the command. 11. Verify the horn chirps
1 time. There should only be 1 chirp indicating that autolock/relock feature is disabled. If 1 chirp is
heard, followed by a
longer sound of the horn, the autolock/relock feature has just been enabled. Return to Step 9.
12. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position to exit the enable/disable mode. 13. Exit the vehicle
and verify the horn chirps once to indicate that a feature has been changed and that
autolock/relock is disabled.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Remote Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming > Page 10112
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair Remote Keyless Entry Keypad
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the exterior mirror.
2. Disconnect the RKE keypad electrical connector. 3. Remove the front door window glass.
4. CAUTION: Damage to the base moulding may occur during the removal procedure.
Remove the front door window base moulding.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Remote Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming > Page 10113
5. Remove the RKE keypad. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY TRANSMITTER PROGRAMMING
NOTE:
- All remote keyless entry (RKE) transmitters must be programmed at the same time.
- Programming (or reprogramming) of the RKE transmitters can be accomplished using a
diagnostic tool or by carrying out the following steps:
1. The vehicle must be electronically unlocked before entering program mode using the door lock
control switch while the driver door is open. 2. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN
position 8 times within 10 seconds, with the eighth turn ending in RUN. If the module
successfully enters program mode, it locks and then unlocks all the doors.
3. Within 20 seconds, press any button on an RKE transmitter, and the doors lock and then unlock
to confirm that each RKE transmitter is
programmed. Repeat this step for each RKE transmitter.
4. If the door locks do not respond for any RKE transmitter, wait several seconds and press the
button again. If the door locks still fail to respond,
refer to Inspection and Verification. (Make sure that no more than the maximum number of RKE
transmitters are attempted to be programmed.) See: Power Locks/Testing and Inspection/Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Inspection and Verification
5. Exiting the programming mode is accomplished if one of the following occurs:
- The key transitions to the OFF position.
- 20 seconds have passed since entering programming mode or since the last RKE transmitter was
programmed.
- The maximum number (6) of RKE transmitters have been programmed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 10122
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 10123
View 151-30 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 10124
View 151-31 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front
C525
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front > Page 10127
C603
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front > Page 10128
C704
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front > Page 10129
C804
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View
Power Door Lock Actuator: Service and Repair Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded
View
FRONT DOOR HANDLES, LOCKS AND LATCHES - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View > Page 10132
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View > Page 10133
Power Door Lock Actuator: Service and Repair Front Door Lock Actuator
FRONT DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door latch. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the front door lock actuator.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View > Page 10134
Power Door Lock Actuator: Service and Repair Rear Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded
View
REAR DOOR HANDLES, LOCKS AND LATCHES - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View > Page 10135
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front Door Handles, Locks and Latches - Exploded View > Page 10136
Power Door Lock Actuator: Service and Repair Rear Door Lock Actuator
REAR DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door latch. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the rear door lock actuator.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 10141
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
C505
C541
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side > Page 10144
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
C605
C632
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 10145
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 10146
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10152
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C341a
C341b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10153
C341c
C341d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10157
C503
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10158
Seat Memory Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH - MEMORY SET
Memory Set Switch
Remove the memory set switch.
Measure the resistance between the indicated terminals while pressing the requested switches.
The resistance should be less than 5 ohms for each switch position.
If the resistance is not less than 5 ohms for each switch, install a new switch; otherwise, return to
the calling pinpoint test.
NOTE: Refer to multimeter user's manual for testing diodes.
To check the memory set switch LED, connect the positive meter lead to terminal 7 and the
negative lead to terminal 1. The meter should indicate greater than 0.3 volts. Reversing the leads,
the meter should read OL.
If the meter readings are not as indicated above, install a new switch; otherwise, return to the
calling pinpoint test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Exterior Mirror Motor Synchronization
Power Mirror Motor: Service and Repair Exterior Mirror Motor Synchronization
EXTERIOR MIRROR MOTOR SYNCHRONIZATION
NOTE:
- This procedure must be performed any time the power folding mirrors are manually folded IN or
OUT, or if the position of the mirror case has been moved without using the mirror control switch.
- If the power folding mirrors are folded or unfolded continuously (6 to 10 cycles), the power lockout
feature will disable the system for 2 minutes to prevent damage to the power fold motors. After 2
minutes have elapsed, normal operation will resume.
1. Set the mirror control switch to the CENTER position.
NOTE: It may be necessary to cycle the power folding mirrors IN or OUT up to 4 times before they
are synchronized.
2. Use the mirror control switch (press rearward) to automatically cycle the power folding mirrors IN
and OUT 4 times. 3. When an audible popping sound is heard, the power folding mirror motors are
synchronized.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Exterior Mirror Motor Synchronization > Page 10163
Power Mirror Motor: Service and Repair Exterior Mirrors - Exploded View
EXTERIOR MIRRORS - EXPLODED VIEW
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Exterior Mirror Motor Synchronization > Page 10164
Power Mirror Motor: Service and Repair Exterior Mirror Motor
EXTERIOR MIRROR MOTOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If equipped with power folding mirrors, they must be synchronized any time the mirrors
have been folded or unfolded without using the mirror control switch.
1. Remove the mirror glass.
2. Remove the 3 exterior mirror motor screws and exterior mirror motor.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- If equipped with power folding mirrors, must be synchronized.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
10168
Power Mirror Switch: Diagrams
C527
C577
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
10169
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
10170
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
10171
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the driver front door trim panel.
Navigator
2. Depress the locking tabs and remove the exterior mirror control switch.
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
10172
3. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
1 Depress the locking tabs.
2 Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Paint: > 07-2-9 > Feb > 07 > Body - Paint Bubbles Around Liftgate Trim
Paint: Customer Interest Body - Paint Bubbles Around Liftgate Trim
TSB 07-2-9
02/05/07
PAINT BUBBLES AROUND LIFTGATE TRIM
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may experience paint bubbling or lifting
around the trim area on the liftgate. This can occur when the trim part moves on the paint surface
because of climate temp changes and/or owner operation. Overtime these trim parts can rub
through the paint surface and cause corrosion to start developing between the aluminum gate and
paint.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Paint resurfacing will be necessary to correct the paint bubbling concern.
2. Add Mylar tape to the backside edge of the following liftgate trim parts, the license plate bucket
for Navigator (Figure 1) and the license lamp applique for Expedition (Figure 2). The Mylar tape will
act as a friction barrier between the paint surface and the trim components.
3. Make sure that the backside of the trim pieces listed in Step 2 are clean of any contaminates.
This can be done by wiping the surface with a 50% solution of isopropyl alcohol and water.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Paint: > 07-2-9 > Feb > 07 > Body - Paint Bubbles Around Liftgate Trim > Page 10182
4. Apply the Mylar tape to the backside edge of the trim component. It may be necessary to trim the
tape after its been applied for a clean fit.
5. After applying the Mylar tape, follow installation procedure for each part as listed in the
appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 501.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070209A 2003-2006 Expedition: 1.3 Hrs.
Install Mylar Tape To The Backside Edge Of The License Plate Applique, Include Time To Detrim
(Do Not Use With P42D)
070209B 2003-2006 Navigator: 1.1 Hrs.
Install Mylar Tape To The Backside Edge Of The License Plate Bucket, Include Time To Detrim
(Do Not Use With P42D)
070209C 2003-2006 Expedition: 2.4 Hrs.
Additional Time To Paint Liftgate. To Be Used With Operation A In This TSB (Includes Time For
P101 Basic Paint) (Do Not Use With P42)
070209C 2003-2006 Navigator: 2.2 Hrs.
Additional Time To Paint Liftgate. To Be Used With Operation B In This TSB (Includes Time For
P101 Basic Paint) (Do Not Use With P42)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78404C42 D7
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 07-2-9 > Feb > 07 > Body - Paint Bubbles Around Liftgate Trim
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Paint Bubbles Around Liftgate Trim
TSB 07-2-9
02/05/07
PAINT BUBBLES AROUND LIFTGATE TRIM
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may experience paint bubbling or lifting
around the trim area on the liftgate. This can occur when the trim part moves on the paint surface
because of climate temp changes and/or owner operation. Overtime these trim parts can rub
through the paint surface and cause corrosion to start developing between the aluminum gate and
paint.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Paint resurfacing will be necessary to correct the paint bubbling concern.
2. Add Mylar tape to the backside edge of the following liftgate trim parts, the license plate bucket
for Navigator (Figure 1) and the license lamp applique for Expedition (Figure 2). The Mylar tape will
act as a friction barrier between the paint surface and the trim components.
3. Make sure that the backside of the trim pieces listed in Step 2 are clean of any contaminates.
This can be done by wiping the surface with a 50% solution of isopropyl alcohol and water.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 07-2-9 > Feb > 07 > Body - Paint Bubbles Around Liftgate Trim >
Page 10188
4. Apply the Mylar tape to the backside edge of the trim component. It may be necessary to trim the
tape after its been applied for a clean fit.
5. After applying the Mylar tape, follow installation procedure for each part as listed in the
appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 501.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070209A 2003-2006 Expedition: 1.3 Hrs.
Install Mylar Tape To The Backside Edge Of The License Plate Applique, Include Time To Detrim
(Do Not Use With P42D)
070209B 2003-2006 Navigator: 1.1 Hrs.
Install Mylar Tape To The Backside Edge Of The License Plate Bucket, Include Time To Detrim
(Do Not Use With P42D)
070209C 2003-2006 Expedition: 2.4 Hrs.
Additional Time To Paint Liftgate. To Be Used With Operation A In This TSB (Includes Time For
P101 Basic Paint) (Do Not Use With P42)
070209C 2003-2006 Navigator: 2.2 Hrs.
Additional Time To Paint Liftgate. To Be Used With Operation B In This TSB (Includes Time For
P101 Basic Paint) (Do Not Use With P42)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78404C42 D7
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 10189
Paint: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-2-9 Date: 070205
Body - Paint Bubbles Around Liftgate Trim
TSB 07-2-9
02/05/07
PAINT BUBBLES AROUND LIFTGATE TRIM
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may experience paint bubbling or lifting
around the trim area on the liftgate. This can occur when the trim part moves on the paint surface
because of climate temp changes and/or owner operation. Overtime these trim parts can rub
through the paint surface and cause corrosion to start developing between the aluminum gate and
paint.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Paint resurfacing will be necessary to correct the paint bubbling concern.
2. Add Mylar tape to the backside edge of the following liftgate trim parts, the license plate bucket
for Navigator (Figure 1) and the license lamp applique for Expedition (Figure 2). The Mylar tape will
act as a friction barrier between the paint surface and the trim components.
3. Make sure that the backside of the trim pieces listed in Step 2 are clean of any contaminates.
This can be done by wiping the surface with a 50%
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 10190
solution of isopropyl alcohol and water.
4. Apply the Mylar tape to the backside edge of the trim component. It may be necessary to trim the
tape after its been applied for a clean fit.
5. After applying the Mylar tape, follow installation procedure for each part as listed in the
appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 501.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070209A 2003-2006 Expedition: 1.3 Hrs.
Install Mylar Tape To The Backside Edge Of The License Plate Applique, Include Time To Detrim
(Do Not Use With P42D)
070209B 2003-2006 Navigator: 1.1 Hrs.
Install Mylar Tape To The Backside Edge Of The License Plate Bucket, Include Time To Detrim
(Do Not Use With P42D)
070209C 2003-2006 Expedition: 2.4 Hrs.
Additional Time To Paint Liftgate. To Be Used With Operation A In This TSB (Includes Time For
P101 Basic Paint) (Do Not Use With P42)
070209C 2003-2006 Navigator: 2.2 Hrs.
Additional Time To Paint Liftgate. To Be Used With Operation B In This TSB (Includes Time For
P101 Basic Paint) (Do Not Use With P42)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78404C42 D7
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-2-9 Date: 070205
Body - Paint Bubbles Around Liftgate Trim
TSB 07-2-9
02/05/07
PAINT BUBBLES AROUND LIFTGATE TRIM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 10191
FORD: 2003-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2003-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may experience paint bubbling or lifting
around the trim area on the liftgate. This can occur when the trim part moves on the paint surface
because of climate temp changes and/or owner operation. Overtime these trim parts can rub
through the paint surface and cause corrosion to start developing between the aluminum gate and
paint.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Paint resurfacing will be necessary to correct the paint bubbling concern.
2. Add Mylar tape to the backside edge of the following liftgate trim parts, the license plate bucket
for Navigator (Figure 1) and the license lamp applique for Expedition (Figure 2). The Mylar tape will
act as a friction barrier between the paint surface and the trim components.
3. Make sure that the backside of the trim pieces listed in Step 2 are clean of any contaminates.
This can be done by wiping the surface with a 50% solution of isopropyl alcohol and water.
4. Apply the Mylar tape to the backside edge of the trim component. It may be necessary to trim the
tape after its been applied for a clean fit.
5. After applying the Mylar tape, follow installation procedure for each part as listed in the
appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 501.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 10192
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070209A 2003-2006 Expedition: 1.3 Hrs.
Install Mylar Tape To The Backside Edge Of The License Plate Applique, Include Time To Detrim
(Do Not Use With P42D)
070209B 2003-2006 Navigator: 1.1 Hrs.
Install Mylar Tape To The Backside Edge Of The License Plate Bucket, Include Time To Detrim
(Do Not Use With P42D)
070209C 2003-2006 Expedition: 2.4 Hrs.
Additional Time To Paint Liftgate. To Be Used With Operation A In This TSB (Includes Time For
P101 Basic Paint) (Do Not Use With P42)
070209C 2003-2006 Navigator: 2.2 Hrs.
Additional Time To Paint Liftgate. To Be Used With Operation B In This TSB (Includes Time For
P101 Basic Paint) (Do Not Use With P42)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78404C42 D7
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes
Paint: Application and ID Paint Codes
PAINT CODES
Vehicle Certification Label
Exterior Paint Code
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 10195
Exterior Paint Code
Paint codes may be listed as a 2-part code. The first set of characters listed indicate the vehicle
primary body color. The second set of characters listed (if applicable) indicate a 2-tone or accent
body color. All colors are base coat/clear coat. DV - Light Tundra/Titanium Green
- G2 - Redfire
- G3 - Pueblo Gold
- G4 - Cashmir (tri-coat)
- HJ - Pewter Metallic
- JP - Silver Birch Metallic
- LD - Medium Wedgewood Blue
- T5 - Dark Copper
- T7 - Charcoal Beige
- UA - Ebony
- YZ - Oxford White
Interior Trim
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 10196
Interior Trim
Interior trim codes are listed as a 2-part code. The first character identifies the trim type. The
second character identifies the interior trim color.
Trim Type 1 - Milled Pebble/Toscana leather captain's chairs
- 1 - Milled Pebble/Imola leather captain's chairs
- 1 - Aniline cloth captain's chairs
- 2 - Milled Pebble/Imola low-back bucket seats
- F - Port cloth captain's chairs
- K - Milled Pebble/Imola leather captain's chairs
- M - Cloth 60/40 front (split bench)
Interior Trim Color C - Camel Tan
- D - Dove Gray
- E - Medium Flint
- H - Medium Parchment
- W - Charcoal Black
Tape/Paint Stripe
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 10197
Tape/Paint Stripe
Tape and paint stripe codes do not app1y.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 10198
Paint: Application and ID Paint Code Sticker Location
PAINT CODE STICKER LOCATION
Vehicle Certification (VC) Label Locator
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 10199
Paint: Application and ID Paint Code Information
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 10200
Paint: Application and ID DSO Fleet Color Codes
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 10201
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 10202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10207
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C341a
C341b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10208
C341c
C341d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
C4183
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10214
C4184
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10217
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10218
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10219
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 10223
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
C4174a
C4174b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 10224
C4174c
C4174d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 10225
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair
POWER LIFTGATE MODULE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Prior to removal of the power liftgate module, it is necessary to upload module configuration
information to a diagnostic tool. This information needs to be downloaded into the new power
liftgate module once installed.
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the power liftgate module.
1 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2 Remove the nut. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: Once the new power liftgate module is installed, it is necessary to download the module
configuration information from the diagnostic
tool into the new power liftgate module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10234
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10235
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10236
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10237
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10238
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10239
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10240
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10241
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10242
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10243
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul >
06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10244
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10250
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10251
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10252
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10253
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10254
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10255
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10256
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10257
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10258
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10259
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10260
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10261
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10262
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams
C3265a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10263
C3265b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10264
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair
CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), it is necessary to carry out
programmable module installation (PMI).
1. Before removing the dual CCSM, carry out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure. 2.
Position the front passenger seat all the way back and up. 3. Depower the SRS. 4. Pull out and
remove the seat track front cover.
5. NOTE: The inset shows the dual climate control seat module (CCSM) retaining bracket.
Remove the dual CCSM. 1
Pull the back of the dual CCSM away from the seat and slide it off the mounting bracket.
2 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3 Remove the dual CCSM.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the SRS. 8. Install the CCSM software
data. Carry out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10273
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10274
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10275
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10276
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10277
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10278
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10279
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10280
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10281
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10282
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10283
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot
Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
Seat Belt Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder'
Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 > Restraints - Cannot
Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 10289
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10299
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10300
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10301
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10302
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10303
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10304
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10305
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10306
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10307
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10308
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Customer Interest for Seat Heater Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D >
Page 10309
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10315
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10316
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10317
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10318
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10319
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10320
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10321
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10322
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10323
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10324
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Relay > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10325
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10329
C921
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10333
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10334
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10335
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Removal And Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 10342
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Motor Initialization
ROOF OPENING PANEL MOTOR INITIALIZATION
CAUTION: Be sure there are no obstructions in the path of the roof opening panel glass before
attempting to initialize the roof opening panel motor.
NOTE:
- A new roof opening panel motor will only open and must be initialized.
- The roof opening panel motor initialization procedure must be done when repairs are carried out
on any part of the roof opening panel system, including: any time the roof opening panel motor has
been removed from the roof opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor has been
installed, or when a new roof opening panel assembly has been installed.
1. Turn the ignition to the RUN position. For an existing roof opening panel motor, proceed to Step
3.
2. NOTE: If the open switch is released before initialization movements are complete, turn the
ignition key to the OFF position, then back to the
RUN position, and repeat this step.
For a new roof opening panel motor/module: Press and hold the open switch until the roof opening panel moves past full OPEN, then back to full
OPEN. Quickly release the open switch.
- Press and hold the open switch. The roof opening panel glass will move to full TILT, then back to
CLOSED (initialization movements). The initialization movements will start within approximately 3
seconds after the switch is pressed. When the initialization movements are complete, go to Step 4.
3. NOTE:
- Some roof opening panel motor/module assemblies may have an electronically controlled comfort
STOP position, which is approximately 2 in. (50 mm) from the full OPEN position. When the roof
opening panel is opened on vehicles equipped with this type of motor/module, the open switch
must be released when the comfort STOP position has been reached, and then pressed again to
fully open the roof opening panel.
- If the open switch is released before initialization movements are complete, turn the ignition key to
the OFF position, then back to the RUN position, and repeat this step.
For an existing roof opening panel motor/module: Press and hold the open switch until the roof opening panel glass moves to the full OPEN position.
- Press and hold the open switch (for approximately 10 seconds) until the roof opening panel glass
moves past full OPEN, then back to full OPEN. Quickly release the switch.
- Press and hold the open switch. The roof opening panel glass will move to full TILT, then back to
CLOSED (initialization movements). The initialization movements will start within approximately 3
seconds after the switch is pressed.
4. Release the open switch and test the system for normal operation by carrying out one-touch
open to comfort STOP, full OPEN, close from full
OPEN to full CLOSE and TILT operations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 10343
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Motor
ROOF OPENING PANEL MOTOR
Removal
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed. Refer to Roof Opening Panel Motor
Initialization.
1. Remove the headliner.
2. Disconnect the roof opening panel motor electrical connector and cut the tie strap.
3. Remove the roof opening panel motor.
- Remove the 3 bolts.
Installation
1. Connect the roof opening panel motor electrical connector. Install a new tie wrap and trim off
excess.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 10344
2. NOTE: When installing the roof opening panel motor/module, align the 3 attach holes before
engaging the drive gear into the roof opening panel
drive cable. Do not rotate the motor assembly after the drive gear is engaged with the roof opening
panel drive cable. Otherwise, the cable can bind.
Install the roof opening panel motor. Align the attach holes, then install the 3 bolts and tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Connect the overhead console electrical connectors. 4. Initialize the roof opening panel
motor/module. 5. Disconnect the overhead console electrical connectors. 6. Install the headliner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 10348
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Diagrams
C912
C9001
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 10349
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 10350
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL REAR TROUGH GUIDE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed.
1. Remove the roof opening panel.
2. Remove the 2 trough guide retaining screws.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
3. Remove the trough from the trough guide assembly.
4. Disconnect the trough guide rods from the lifter arm assemblies.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10354
5. Slide the trough guide back to the slot (approximately 15 mm (0.6 in)) cut in track.
6. Carefully twist trough guide through the slot in the track to remove. 7. Inspect the trough guide
assembly for damage. If damage is found, inspect the track for broken pieces and remove them. 8.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Adjust roof opening panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Sunroof / Moonroof Windguard: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Removal And Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 10359
Sunroof / Moonroof Windguard: Service and Repair Air Deflector
AIR DEFLECTOR
Removal and Installation
1. Open the roof opening panel.
2. NOTE: RH side shown, LH similar.
Remove the 2 air deflector tether screws. To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
3. Raise the front of the air deflector.
4. Slide the air deflector toward the rear, then lift up to release it from the pivot shafts. 5. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Frame > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Sunroof / Moonroof Frame: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Removal And Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Frame > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 10364
Sunroof / Moonroof Frame: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Frame
ROOF OPENING PANEL FRAME
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed. Refer to Roof Opening Panel Motor
Initialization.
1. Remove the headliner.
2. Remove the overhead console bracket.
- Remove the screws.
3. Disconnect the electrical connector and cut the tie strap.
4. Remove the roof opening panel frame.
1 Disconnect the 4 roof opening panel drain hoses.
2 Remove the 11 bolts. To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
3 Remove the roof opening panel frame.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. If a new roof opening panel frame is being installed,
transfer the existing roof opening panel motor, air
deflector, rear trough, roof opening panel glass and roof opening panel shield onto the new frame
assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Frame > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 10365
- Check for correct alignment of the roof opening panel.
- Initialize the roof opening panel motor. Refer to Roof Opening Panel Motor Initialization.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 10369
C921
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed.
1. Position the roof opening panel in the VENT position.
2. Remove the 4 roof opening panel bolts.
- To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Remove the roof opening panel from the outside of the vehicle by lifting up and out. 4. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
- Adjust the roof opening panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High
Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 10381
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 10382
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Sunroof Water Leaks
During High Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page
10388
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page
10389
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10390
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL WEATHERSTRIP
Removal
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed.
1. Remove the roof opening panel. 2. Place roof opening panel, topside up, on a worktable. Take
care to support the glass assembly from below to prevent damaging the mounting tabs.
3. Remove the old roof opening panel weatherstrip by pulling up on the weatherstrip.
Installation
1. Place a new weatherstrip into position on the glass assembly, with the splice (seam) on the
passenger side. 2. Starting with the corners, push the weatherstrip into position. Continue pushing
the weatherstrip into position around the glass assembly until
complete. Use a plastic or rubber hammer if necessary.
3. Install the roof opening panel. 4. Adjust the roof panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10396
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C341a
C341b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10397
C341c
C341d
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10401
C503
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10402
Seat Memory Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH - MEMORY SET
Memory Set Switch
Remove the memory set switch.
Measure the resistance between the indicated terminals while pressing the requested switches.
The resistance should be less than 5 ohms for each switch position.
If the resistance is not less than 5 ohms for each switch, install a new switch; otherwise, return to
the calling pinpoint test.
NOTE: Refer to multimeter user's manual for testing diodes.
To check the memory set switch LED, connect the positive meter lead to terminal 7 and the
negative lead to terminal 1. The meter should indicate greater than 0.3 volts. Reversing the leads,
the meter should read OL.
If the meter readings are not as indicated above, install a new switch; otherwise, return to the
calling pinpoint test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10407
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10408
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10409
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10410
Power Seat Motor: Locations
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10411
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10412
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10413
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10414
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10415
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10416
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10417
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10418
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Motor, Left > Page 10419
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor
C332
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10422
C3074
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10423
C3075
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10424
C3187
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10425
Power Seat Motor: Diagrams
C332
C3074
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10426
C3075
C3187
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10427
C363
C382
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10428
C362
C3189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10429
C3215
C3216
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10430
C4181
C4182
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Track Motor
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair Front Seat Track Motor
FRONT SEAT TRACK MOTOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All motors
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners (if possible). 2. Depower the
SRS. 3. Remove the 40 percent seat.
Forward/reverse motor
4. NOTE: If equipped with memory seat, disconnect the memory seat position sensor electrical
connector and remove sensor from the motor.
Remove the forward/reverse motor. 1
Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Pull to release the power seat drive cables from the motor.
3 Remove the 4 screws (2 shown).
4 Remove the power seat motor.
Rear height motor
5. NOTE: If equipped with memory seat, disconnect the memory seat position sensor electrical
connector and remove sensor from the motor.
Remove the rear height motor. Disconnect the rear height motor electrical connector.
- Remove the roll pin.
- Remove the bolt and nut.
- Remove the rear height power seat motor.
Front height motor
6. If equipped, remove the temperature controlled seat fan motor.
7. NOTE: If equipped with memory seat, disconnect the memory seat position sensor electrical
connector and remove sensor from the motor.
Remove the front height motor. Disconnect the front height motor electrical connector.
- Remove the roll pin.
- Remove the roll pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Track Motor > Page 10433
- Remove the front height power seat motor.
All motors
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure 9. Install the 40 percent seat.
10. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Track Motor > Page 10434
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair Front Seat Recliner Motor
FRONT SEAT RECLINER MOTOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat.
4. Remove the lower backrest cover. 5. Remove the 2 screws and the securing strap.
6. Release the backrest trim cover hook-and-loop strip and J-clip. 7. Depress the head restraint
guide tab and remove the head restraint.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Track Motor > Page 10435
8. NOTE: The head restraint guides are not interchangeable. Note location for installation.
Reach up into backrest and squeeze the head restraint guide ends together to release and pull the
2 head restraint guides out.
9. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip,
or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat backrest foam.
Invert the backrest trim cover and remove.
10. CAUTION: Use care when removing the backrest foam pad from the frame. The foam pad has
hook and loop fasteners holding the
thermo-electric device to the backrest foam pad.
Separate the backrest foam pad from the backrest thermo-electric device and remove the backrest
foam pad.
11. Remove the backrest pivot rod retainer on the end of the backrest pivot rod. 12. Remove the
backrest pivot rod cover and slide the backrest pivot rod out from the power recline motor. 13.
Disconnect the electrical connector, remove the bolt and the power recline motor. 14. To install,
reverse the removal procedure. 15. Install the 40 percent seat. 16. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Track Motor > Page 10436
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair Lumbar Motor
LUMBAR MOTOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a seat mounted side air bag and/or a safety belt pretensioner (if equipped)
system is being serviced, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat.
4. Remove lower backrest cover. 5. Remove the 2 screws and the securing strap.
6. Release the backrest trim cover hook-and-loop strip and J-clip. 7. Depress the head restraint
guide tab and remove the head restraint.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Track Motor > Page 10437
8. NOTE: The head restraint guides are not interchangeable. Note location for Installation.
Reach up into backrest and squeeze the head restraint guide ends together to release and pull the
2 head restraint guides out.
9. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip,
or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat backrest foam.
Invert the backrest trim cover and remove.
10. CAUTION: Use care when removing the backrest foam pad from the frame. The foam pad has
hook and loop fasteners holding the
thermo-electric device to the backrest foam pad.
Separate the backrest foam pad from the thermo-electric device and remove the backrest foam
pad.
11. Remove the 2 inboard backrest support bracket screws and the inboard backrest support
bracket.
12. Remove the lumbar motor cable from the lumbar support.
1 Flex the lumbar support.
2 Separate the lumbar support adjusting cable from the positioning spring.
3 Unhook the lumbar support adjusting cable from the lumbar support.
13. Remove the staples and open dampening bag. 14. Remove the power lumbar support motor.
- Disconnect the power lumbar motor electrical connector.
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Remove the power lumbar motor.
15. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 16. Install the 40 percent seat. 17. Repower the
SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Track Motor > Page 10438
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair Power-Fold Seat Motor
POWER-FOLD SEAT MOTOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: A cable assembly service kit is available.
All vehicles
1. Remove the affected third row seat. 2. Lift the cushion up, remove the inboard slide bracket
cover-to-inboard slide bracket screw and slide the cover up and out of the way.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-ft).
3. Remove the safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Remove the inboard slide bracket-to-inboard latch nut and separate the inboard slide bracket
from the inboard latch.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
5. Remove the inboard latch-to-backrest frame bolts and remove the inboard latch.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
Cable repair
6. NOTE: The motor should only need to be removed when installing a cable assembly service kit.
If necessary, grind off the bottom of the rivets or drill and punch out the rivets. Remove the
power-fold seat motor.
All vehicles
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 10443
View 151-35 (Chassis, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 10444
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 10445
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 10446
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor
C372
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10449
C383
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10450
C373
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10451
C1151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10452
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Diagrams
C372
C383
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10453
C373
C1151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10454
C1153
C4084
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10455
C3244
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Third
Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
C4183
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Third
Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10461
C4184
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10464
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10465
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10466
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Switch, Left/Right
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Switch, Left/Right > Page 10471
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Switch, Left/Right > Page 10472
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Left
C352
C3016
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left >
Page 10475
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Right
C355
C3026
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left >
Page 10476
C4179
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left >
Page 10477
C4180
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10480
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10481
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10482
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Left-8-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10483
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10484
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10485
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10486
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Right-6-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10487
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10488
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10489
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Right-8-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10490
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10491
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10492
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10493
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10494
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10495
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10496
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10497
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10498
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10499
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10500
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10501
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10502
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10503
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10504
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10505
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10506
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10507
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10508
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10509
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10510
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Control Switch - 8-Way
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - 8-Way
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - 8-WAY
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Pry and remove the seat control switch and power recline knobs.
5. Access and remove the cushion side shield front screw.
6. Pull out from the bottom and rear side of the cushion side shield to release the 3 retainer clips. 7.
Disconnect the power lumbar and seat control switch electrical connectors and remove the cushion
side shield. 8. Remove the 3 screws and remove the 8-way seat control switch. 9. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
10. Install the 40 percent seat. 11. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Control Switch - 8-Way > Page 10513
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - 6-Way
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - 6-WAY
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat is shown, passenger is similar.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. From under the seat, disconnect the 6-way power seat switch
electrical connector. 5. Remove the recliner handle screw cover, screw and recliner handle.
6. CAUTION: Use care when removing the lumbar knob. Using both hands, pull with even pressure
on both sides of the knob to remove.
Pull out to remove the manual lumbar knob.
7. Remove the cushion side shield screw from under the manual lumbar knob.
8. CAUTION: Use care not to scratch the side shield when removing the power seat knob.
Pry the seat control switch knob off.
9. Access and remove the front cushion side shield screw.
10. Pull to release the center and rear retainers and remove the cushion side shield.
11. Remove the 2 seat control switch screws and remove the 6-way seat control switch from the
cushion side shield. 12. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 13. Install the 40 percent seat.
14. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Control Switch - 8-Way > Page 10514
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Third Row
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - THIRD ROW
Removal and Installation
1. Partially remove the RH quarter trim panel for access to the third row power seat switch(es.). 2.
Remove the one-way push nuts on the back side of the power seat switch bezel. 3. Disconnect the
RH and LH third row seat control switch electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Control Switch - 8-Way > Page 10515
4. Release the 4 locking tabs (2 shown) on the affected switch, and remove the switch. 5. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent
FRONT SEAT CUSHION - 40 PERCENT
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10520
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Remove the side shield.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10521
5. Release the J-clips on the pivot covers (inboard shown, outboard similar). 6. Release the
cushion trim cover J-clips.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover.
8. Remove the cushion foam pad.
Power seats
9. Remove the power seat motors.
10. Remove the power seat tracks.
Manual seats
11. Remove the manual seat track.
Manual lumbar seats
12. Remove the 2 screws and the manual lumbar actuator.
13. NOTE: The lumbar support assembly must be fully relaxed.
Separate the manual lumbar actuator from the adjuster cable.
Driver memory seats
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10522
14. NOTE: The inset shows the driver seat module (DSM) retaining bracket.
Remove the DSM. 1
Pull the back of the DSM away from the seat and slide it off the mounting bracket.
2 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3 Remove the DSM.
Climate controlled seats
15. Remove the seat fan motor. 16. Remove the climate controlled seat module. 17. Remove the
seat cushion thermo-electric device. 18. Remove the cushion supply duct. 19. Unclip and remove
the TED mounting bezel.
All seats
20. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure. 21. Install the 40 percent seat. 22. Repower
the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10523
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Front Seat Cushion - 60 Percent
FRONT SEAT CUSHION - 60 PERCENT
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10524
Part 2
Disassembly
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10525
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 60 percent seat. 4. Remove the 60 percent seat backrest. 5. Remove the armrest
bracket inner cover. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the armrest bracket outer cover. 7. Release the
cushion trim cover J-clips.
8. Remove the 2 bolts and the backrest recliner.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
9. Remove the 2 bolts and the armrest bracket.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
10. Remove the seat track.
11. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Invert the cushion trim cover and remove from the cushion foam pad.
12. Remove the cushion foam pad from the cushion frame. 13. To assemble, reverse the
disassembly procedure. 14. Install the 60 percent seat backrest. 15. Install the 60 percent seat. 16.
Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10526
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Rear Seat Cushion - Second Row, 40 Percent
REAR SEAT CUSHION - SECOND ROW, 40 PERCENT
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10527
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the 40 percent seat backrest. 3. Unsnap the pull strap
retainer. 4. Release the 4 cushion trim cover J-clips. 5. Remove the cushion trim cover and cushion
foam pad from the cushion frame.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover from the cushion foam pad.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10528
7. Remove the 3 pin-type retainers from the seat bottom cover (2 shown).
8. Release the 2 J-clips for the bottom cover.
9. Remove the 4 pin-type retainers from the sides of bottom cover (2 shown).
10. Remove the bottom cover. 11. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- To aid installation, note the location of locating tab. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
12. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10529
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Rear Seat Cushion - Second Row, 20 Percent
REAR SEAT CUSHION - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10530
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the 20 percent seat. 2. Remove the 20 percent seat backrest. 3. Release the cushion
trim cover front J-clip. 4. Remove the 2 riser-to-cushion frame bolts.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Release the remaining cushion trim cover J-clips. 6. Remove the cushion frame from the cushion
foam pad.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip,
or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat cushion foam.
Remove the seat cushion cover from the foam pad.
8. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10531
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent
FRONT SEAT CUSHION - 40 PERCENT
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10532
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Remove the side shield.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10533
5. Release the J-clips on the pivot covers (inboard shown, outboard similar). 6. Release the
cushion trim cover J-clips.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover.
8. Remove the cushion foam pad.
Power seats
9. Remove the power seat motors.
10. Remove the power seat tracks.
Manual seats
11. Remove the manual seat track.
Manual lumbar seats
12. Remove the 2 screws and the manual lumbar actuator.
13. NOTE: The lumbar support assembly must be fully relaxed.
Separate the manual lumbar actuator from the adjuster cable.
Driver memory seats
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10534
14. NOTE: The inset shows the driver seat module (DSM) retaining bracket.
Remove the DSM. 1
Pull the back of the DSM away from the seat and slide it off the mounting bracket.
2 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3 Remove the DSM.
Climate controlled seats
15. Remove the seat fan motor. 16. Remove the climate controlled seat module. 17. Remove the
seat cushion thermo-electric device. 18. Remove the cushion supply duct. 19. Unclip and remove
the TED mounting bezel.
All seats
20. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure. 21. Install the 40 percent seat. 22. Repower
the SRS.
Front Seat Cushion - 60 Percent
FRONT SEAT CUSHION - 60 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10535
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10536
Part 2
Disassembly
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10537
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 60 percent seat. 4. Remove the 60 percent seat backrest. 5. Remove the armrest
bracket inner cover. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the armrest bracket outer cover. 7. Release the
cushion trim cover J-clips.
8. Remove the 2 bolts and the backrest recliner.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
9. Remove the 2 bolts and the armrest bracket.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
10. Remove the seat track.
11. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Invert the cushion trim cover and remove from the cushion foam pad.
12. Remove the cushion foam pad from the cushion frame. 13. To assemble, reverse the
disassembly procedure. 14. Install the 60 percent seat backrest. 15. Install the 60 percent seat. 16.
Repower the SRS.
Rear Seat Cushion - Second Row, 40 Percent
REAR SEAT CUSHION - SECOND ROW, 40 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10538
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10539
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the 40 percent seat backrest. 3. Unsnap the pull strap
retainer. 4. Release the 4 cushion trim cover J-clips. 5. Remove the cushion trim cover and cushion
foam pad from the cushion frame.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover from the cushion foam pad.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10540
7. Remove the 3 pin-type retainers from the seat bottom cover (2 shown).
8. Release the 2 J-clips for the bottom cover.
9. Remove the 4 pin-type retainers from the sides of bottom cover (2 shown).
10. Remove the bottom cover. 11. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- To aid installation, note the location of locating tab. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
12. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Rear Seat Cushion - Second Row, 20 Percent
REAR SEAT CUSHION - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10541
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10542
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the 20 percent seat. 2. Remove the 20 percent seat backrest. 3. Release the cushion
trim cover front J-clip. 4. Remove the 2 riser-to-cushion frame bolts.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Release the remaining cushion trim cover J-clips. 6. Remove the cushion frame from the cushion
foam pad.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip,
or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat cushion foam.
Remove the seat cushion cover from the foam pad.
8. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Rear Seat Cushion - Third Row, 40 Percent
REAR SEAT CUSHION - THIRD ROW, 40 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10543
40 Perecent Cushion
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the third row 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the third row 40 percent seat backrest. 3.
Remove the inboard and outboard slide bracket-to-cushion frame nuts and remove the slide
bracket from both sides of the seat cushion.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 2 third row seat riser-to-cushion frame bolts and the riser.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Release the cushion trim cover J-clips and remove the cushion frame.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook and loop strip, or the
hook and loop strip can be torn from
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10544
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover from the cushion foam pad.
7. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Rear Seat Cushion - Third Row, 60 Percent
REAR SEAT CUSHION - THIRD ROW, 60 PERCENT
60 Perecent Cushion
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the third row 60 percent seat. 2. Remove the third row 60 percent seat backrest. 3.
Remove the inboard and outboard slide bracket-to-cushion frame nuts and remove the slide
bracket from both sides of the seat cushion.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seat Cushion - 40 Percent > Page 10545
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 2 seat riser-to-cushion frame bolts and the riser.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Release the cushion trim cover J-clips and remove the cushion frame.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook and loop strip, or the
hook and loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover from the cushion foam pad.
7. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10554
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10555
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10556
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10557
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10558
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10559
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10560
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10561
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10562
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10563
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page
10564
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10570
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10571
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10572
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10573
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10574
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10575
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10576
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10577
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10578
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10579
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10580
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Seat Heater: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10583
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10584
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10585
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10586
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10587
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10588
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10589
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10590
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10591
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10592
Seat Heater: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10593
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10594
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10595
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10596
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10597
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10598
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10599
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10600
Seat Heater: Connector Views
C3034
C3039
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10601
C3035
C3040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10602
C3033
C3038
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10603
Seat Heater: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
119-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10604
119-2
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Seat Backrest Thermo-Electric Device
SEAT BACKREST THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat.
4. From under the seat, disconnect the seat backrest thermo-electric device (TED) electrical
connector at the seat cushion frame.
5. Remove lower backrest cover. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the securing strap.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10607
7. Release the backrest trim cover hook-and-loop strip and J-clip. 8. Depress the head restraint
guide tab and remove the head restraint.
9. NOTE: The head restraint guides are not interchangeable. Note location for installation.
Reach up into backrest and squeeze the head restraint guide ends together to release and pull the
2 head restraint guides out.
10. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop
strip, or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat backrest foam.
Invert the backrest trim cover and remove.
11. CAUTION: Use care when removing the backrest foam pad from the frame. The foam pad has
hook and loop fasteners holding the
thermo-electric device to the backrest foam pad.
Separate the backrest foam pad from the backrest thermo-electric device and remove the backrest
foam pad.
12. Route the backrest TED wire harness back through the seat cushion and trim cover. 13.
Remove the backrest TED.
- Remove the backrest TED wire harness pin-type retainers.
- Cut the zip-ties and separate the ducts from the backrest TED.
- Remove the backrest TED.
14. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 15. Install the 40 percent seat. 16. Repower the
SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10608
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Thermo-Electric Device
SEAT CUSHION THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Remove the seat side shield. 5. Remove the seat fan motor. 6.
Remove the front height power seat motor.
7. Release the cushion trim cover J-clips (6 shown).
8. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip,
or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat cushion.
Remove the seat cushion trim cover.
9. Remove the seat cushion foam pad.
10. Remove the screw and separate the seat cushion thermo-electric device (TED) from the
mounting bezel. 11. Remove the cushion TED.
- Cut the zip-tie, separate and remove the supply duct.
- Disconnect the seat cushion TED electrical connector.
- Remove the seat cushion TED.
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 13. Install the front height power seat motor. 14.
Install the seat fan motor. 15. Install the seat side shield. 16. Install the 40 percent seat. 17.
Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10609
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Seat Fan Motor
SEAT FAN MOTOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a seat mounted side air bag and/or a safety belt pretensioner (if equipped)
system is being serviced, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Remove the seat fan motor.
- Cut the zip-tie and separate the duct from the seat fan motor.
- Cut the zip-tie and separate the duct from the seat fan motor.
- Disconnect the seat fan motor wire harness electrical connector.
- Remove the 4 screws.
- Remove the fan motor.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. Install the 40 percent seat. 7. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10618
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10619
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10620
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10621
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10622
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10623
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10624
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10625
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10626
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10627
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10628
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10634
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10635
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10636
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10637
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10638
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10639
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10640
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10641
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10642
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10643
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10644
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 10645
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 10646
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams
C3265a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 10647
C3265b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 10648
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair
CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), it is necessary to carry out
programmable module installation (PMI).
1. Before removing the dual CCSM, carry out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure. 2.
Position the front passenger seat all the way back and up. 3. Depower the SRS. 4. Pull out and
remove the seat track front cover.
5. NOTE: The inset shows the dual climate control seat module (CCSM) retaining bracket.
Remove the dual CCSM. 1
Pull the back of the dual CCSM away from the seat and slide it off the mounting bracket.
2 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3 Remove the dual CCSM.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the SRS. 8. Install the CCSM software
data. Carry out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10657
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10658
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10659
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10660
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10661
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10662
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10663
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10664
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10665
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10666
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10667
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
Compressor Clutch Hub: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air > Page 10673
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10683
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10684
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10685
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10686
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10687
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10688
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10689
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10690
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10691
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10692
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Relay: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Relay: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10693
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10699
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10700
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10701
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10702
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10703
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10704
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10705
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10706
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10707
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10708
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Clutch Hub: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10709
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10718
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10719
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10720
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10721
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10722
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10723
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10724
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10725
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10726
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10727
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or
B272D > Page 10728
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10734
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10735
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10736
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10737
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10738
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10739
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10740
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10741
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10742
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10743
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10744
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10753
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10754
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10755
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10756
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10757
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10758
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10759
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10760
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10761
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10762
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10763
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
Compressor Pulley: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air > Page 10769
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10779
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10780
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10781
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10782
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10783
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10784
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10785
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10786
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10787
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10788
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > Customer Interest for Seat Heater
Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10789
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10795
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10796
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10797
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10798
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10799
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10800
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10801
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10802
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10803
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10804
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compressor Pulley: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC
B272C or B272D > Page 10805
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10814
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10815
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10816
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10817
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10818
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10819
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10820
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10821
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10822
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10823
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats
DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10824
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10830
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10831
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10832
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10833
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10834
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10835
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10836
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10837
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10838
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10839
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Thermostat > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Thermostat: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10840
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Power
Seat Track: Service and Repair Seat Track - Power
SEAT TRACK - POWER
Removal
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
Inboard and outboard seat tracks 1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor
fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3. Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Remove the assist spring.
Driver seat
5. NOTE: The SRS seat position sensor is serviced with the driver inboard seat track.
Disconnect the SRS seat position sensor.
Inboard seat track
6. Pull to remove the forward/reverse power seat motor inboard drive cable from inboard seat track.
7. Disconnect the safety belt buckle pretensioner and usage detection electrical connectors. 8.
Remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
- Remove the nut.
- Remove the safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
9. Remove the 4 cushion frame-to-inboard seat track nuts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Power > Page 10845
10. Remove the cushion frame-to-inboard seat track bolt and the inboard seat track.
Outboard seat track
11. Pull to remove the forward/reverse power seat motor outboard drive cable from the outboard
seat track.
6-way power seat 12. Disconnect the seat control switch electrical connector. 13. Remove the
recliner handle screw cover, screw and recliner handle.
14. CAUTION: Use care when removing the lumbar knob. Using both hands, pull with even
pressure on both sides of the knob to remove.
Remove the manual lumbar knob.
15. Remove the cushion side shield screw from under the manual lumbar knob.
16. CAUTION: Use care not to scratch the side shield when removing the power seat knob.
Pry the seat control switch knob off.
17. Access and remove the front cushion side shield screw. 18. Pull to release the center and rear
retainers and remove the cushion side shield.
8-way power seat 19. Pry to remove the power recline and seat control switch knobs. 20. Access
and remove the cushion side shield front screw.
21. Pull out from the bottom and rear side of the cushion side shield to release the 3 retainer clips.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Power > Page 10846
22. Disconnect the power lumbar and seat control switch electrical connectors and remove the
cushion side shield.
Outboard seat track 23. Remove the 4 outboard seat track nuts and the outboard seat track.
Installation
Outboard seat track 1. Position the outboard seat track and install the 4 nuts.
- Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
8-way power seat 2. Position the cushion side shield and connect the power lumbar and seat
control switch electrical connectors. 3. Push to install the 3 cushion side shield retainers onto the
seat frame. 4. Access and install the cushion side shield front screw. 5. Install the power recline
and seat control switch knobs.
6-way power seat 6. Position the cushion side shield and install the center and rear retainers into
the seat frame. 7. Install the cushion side shield front screw. 8. Install the seat control switch knob.
9. Install the cushion side shield screw from under the manual lumbar knob.
10. Align and install the manual lumbar knob. 11. Position the recliner handle and install the screw
and cover. 12. Connect the seat control switch electrical connector.
Outboard seat track 13. Install the forward/reverse power seat motor outboard drive cable to the
outboard seat track.
Inboard seat track
14. Position the inboard seat track to the seat frame and install the cushion frame-to-inboard seat
track bolt.
- Tighten to 47 Nm (35 lb-ft).
15. Install the 4 cushion frame-to-inboard seat track nuts.
- Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
16. Position the safety belt buckle and pretensioner to the bracket and install the nut.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
17. Connect the safety belt buckle pretensioner and usage detection electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Power > Page 10847
18. Install the forward/reverse power seat motor inboard drive cable to seat track.
Driver seat
19. NOTE: The SRS seat position sensor is serviced with the driver inboard seat track.
Connect the SRS seat position sensor.
Inboard and outboard seat tracks 20. Install the assist spring. 21. Install the 40 percent seat. 22.
Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Power > Page 10848
Seat Track: Service and Repair Seat Track - Manual
SEAT TRACK - MANUAL
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS.
3. NOTE: 60 percent seat shown, the 40 percent seat similar.
Remove the affected seat.
4. Remove recliner handle screw cover. 5. Remove the recliner handle screw and recliner handle.
6. CAUTION: Use care when removing the lumbar knob. Using both hands, pull with even pressure
on both sides of the knob to remove.
Remove the manual lumbar knob.
7. Remove the screw from the cushion side shield under the lumbar knob. 8. Remove the screw
from the front of the cushion side shield. 9. Remove the screw from the back of the cushion side
shield.
10. Remove the manual seat track riser and adjust handle.
- Remove the 2 outer seat track riser-to-outer seat track nuts. To install, tighten to 43 Nm (32 lb-ft).
- Remove the outer seat track riser.
- Remove the 3 seat track adjust handle-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
- Remove the seat track adjust handle.
11. Remove the 4 manual seat track-to-cushion frame bolts and remove the manual seat tracks.
- To install, tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb-ft).
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 13. Install the affected seat. 14. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Locations > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Left Front
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Locations > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Left Front > Page 10854
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Right Front
C331
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Right Front > Page 10857
C361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10858
Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10859
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10860
Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch: Service and Repair
LUMBAR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Access and remove the cushion side shield front screw.
5. Pull out from the bottom and rear side of cushion side shield to release the 3 retainer clips. 6.
Disconnect the power lumbar switch and 8-way power seat switch electrical connectors.
7. Pinch retainer in and push from the rear of power lumbar switch to remove the switch from the
side shield. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Install the 40 percent seat.
10. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams
C2090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10868
Pedal Positioning Switch: Diagrams
C2089
C2235
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10869
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10870
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10871
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 10876
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
C505
C541
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side > Page 10879
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
C605
C632
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10880
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10881
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10885
Power Mirror Switch: Diagrams
C527
C577
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10886
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10887
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10888
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the driver front door trim panel.
Navigator
2. Depress the locking tabs and remove the exterior mirror control switch.
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10889
3. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
1 Depress the locking tabs.
2 Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 10894
View 151-35 (Chassis, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 10895
View 151-36 (Chassis, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 10896
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Recliner Sensor > Page 10897
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor
C372
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10900
C383
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10901
C373
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10902
C1151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10903
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Diagrams
C372
C383
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10904
C373
C1151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10905
C1153
C4084
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Sensor > Page 10906
C3244
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Folding Seat Switch, Left/Right
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Folding Seat Switch, Left/Right > Page 10911
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Folding Seat Switch, Left/Right > Page 10912
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Left
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Left
C352
C3016
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Left > Page 10915
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Right
C355
C3026
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Left > Page 10916
C4179
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Left > Page 10917
C4180
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10920
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10921
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10922
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Left-8-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10923
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10924
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10925
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10926
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Right-6-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10927
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10928
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10929
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, Right-8-Way Power Seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10930
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10931
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10932
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10933
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10934
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10935
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10936
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10937
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10938
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10939
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10940
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10941
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10942
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10943
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10944
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10945
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10946
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10947
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10948
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10949
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, Left-6-Way Power Seat > Page 10950
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - 8-Way
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - 8-Way
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - 8-WAY
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Pry and remove the seat control switch and power recline knobs.
5. Access and remove the cushion side shield front screw.
6. Pull out from the bottom and rear side of the cushion side shield to release the 3 retainer clips. 7.
Disconnect the power lumbar and seat control switch electrical connectors and remove the cushion
side shield. 8. Remove the 3 screws and remove the 8-way seat control switch. 9. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
10. Install the 40 percent seat. 11. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - 8-Way > Page 10953
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - 6-Way
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - 6-WAY
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat is shown, passenger is similar.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. From under the seat, disconnect the 6-way power seat switch
electrical connector. 5. Remove the recliner handle screw cover, screw and recliner handle.
6. CAUTION: Use care when removing the lumbar knob. Using both hands, pull with even pressure
on both sides of the knob to remove.
Pull out to remove the manual lumbar knob.
7. Remove the cushion side shield screw from under the manual lumbar knob.
8. CAUTION: Use care not to scratch the side shield when removing the power seat knob.
Pry the seat control switch knob off.
9. Access and remove the front cushion side shield screw.
10. Pull to release the center and rear retainers and remove the cushion side shield.
11. Remove the 2 seat control switch screws and remove the 6-way seat control switch from the
cushion side shield. 12. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 13. Install the 40 percent seat.
14. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - 8-Way > Page 10954
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Third Row
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - THIRD ROW
Removal and Installation
1. Partially remove the RH quarter trim panel for access to the third row power seat switch(es.). 2.
Remove the one-way push nuts on the back side of the power seat switch bezel. 3. Disconnect the
RH and LH third row seat control switch electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - 8-Way > Page 10955
4. Release the 4 locking tabs (2 shown) on the affected switch, and remove the switch. 5. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 10959
C4039
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10968
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10969
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10970
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10971
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10972
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10973
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10974
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10975
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10976
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10977
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10978
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10984
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10985
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10986
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10987
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10988
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10989
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10990
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10991
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10992
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10993
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Sensor: > 06-13-6 >
Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 10994
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11003
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11004
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11005
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11006
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11007
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11008
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11009
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11010
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11011
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11012
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Climate
Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11013
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-13-6 Date: 060710
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D
TSB 06-13-6
07/10/06
DTC B272-C/D FOR THE DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
FORD: 2005-2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2006 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 05-14-10 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built prior to 03/26/2006 may exhibit
concerns with the climate controlled seat (CCS) system with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
B272C (Driver Differential Temperature Fault) and/or DTC B272D (Passenger Differential
Temperature Fault), with or without additional DTCs. These two DTCs may be triggered by various
sources, making them difficult to diagnose.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure to isolate the cause of these DTCs. If DTC
B272C and/or B272D are not present, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT061306 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Disclaimer
Section 1
SECTION 1
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B, General
Procedures; Supplemental Restraint System Depowering and Repowering.
2. Check the connections along the CCS systems, passenger side: C3040, C3039, C3625a,
C3625b; driver side: C3034, C3035, C311, C316, C3625b, C3625a. Ensure connectors are fully
seated and secure. If the CCS is now operable, repower the SRS and return vehicle to the
customer. If CCS system is still inoperable leave SRS depowered, continue to Step 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11019
3. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a DTC of B272C/D code then note the time until the CCS
fails when activated in the heat mode.
a. If the time to failure is 5 seconds or less then, proceed to Section 2.
b. If the time to failure is greater than 5 seconds but less than 40 seconds then, proceed to Section
3.
c. If the time to failure is 40 seconds or greater, then, proceed to Section 4.
NOTE
THERE ARE 4 PIDS WHEN USING IDS THAT READ THE TEMPERATURE OF THE 4
THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICES (TEDS) IN THE VEHICLE. WHEN ASKED TO MONITOR THE
PIDS, THIS TSB IS REFERRING TO THE PID'S OF THE AFFECTED SEAT BEING DIAGNOSED.
THE PIDS ARE AS FOLLOWS: (CSHTEMP) DRIVER CUSHION, (BK_TEMP) DRIVER SEAT
BACK, (PCSHTMP) PASSENGER CUSHION, (PBK_TEMP) PASSENGER SEAT BACK.
Section 2
SECTION 2 (Seat Shuts Off In Less Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS is inoperable with a DTC B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is present
(B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B) only on the first heating cycle. If the over-temp code is present
after several heating cycles then allow the TED's to rest for 15 minutes before retesting the system.
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present then go to Step 3.
b. If no over-temp DTC is present then go to Step 6.
3. Are any of the TED PIDS reading between 200-400° F (93-204° C) at room temperature
conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading 10° higher than
the other TED?
a. If reading excessively hotter than room temperature, for example 200° F (93° C) or so, then go
to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back TED and Cushion TED are 10° different, go to Step 11.
c. If readings are correct, then check for blockage / obstruction of the cushion or the ducting. If
blockage is not found, then replace the module and proceed to Step 5. If blockage is found, repair
as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11020
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 - passenger back, or C3040 - passenger
cushion) Figure 1.)
a. Check harness side of TED Connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 - driver cushion, C3039 passenger back, or C3040 - passenger cushion) for voltage with IGN on; is approximately 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3. If voltage is present, proceed to Step 4b. If not, then unplug the dual climate
control seat module (DCCSM) located under the passenger seat, and check if harness side Pin 3 is
shorted to ground. If Pin 3 is shorted fix wiring, if not replace DCCSM.
b. Check TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 200 ohms?
(1) If no, then replace TED.
(2) If yes, go to Step 5.
5. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then go to Step 6.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
6. Are both ambient TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then the Connector C32656 on the DCCSM is not plugged in, or both TEDs (Driver C3034 and C3035, Passenger - C3039 and C3040) are not plugged in. Plug it in and proceed to
Step 12.
b. If not then proceed to Step 7.
7. Is one of the TED PID readings below 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, then proceed to Step 8.
b. If no, then go to Step 9 in Section 3.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11021
8. Verify the TED is plugged in. (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion)
a. If plugged in, then proceed to Step 9.
b. If not plugged in, then correct and proceed to Step 12.
9. Is the thermistor circuit in the TED open? (Check the connector (C3034 - Driver Back C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion, C3265A - DCCSM).
(Figure 2)
a. If it is open, then proceed to Step 10.
b. If it is not open, then proceed to Step 11.
10. Verify the wire harnesses to the thermistor are good (looking for shorts or opens in the
harnesses).
a. If the wire harnesses to the thermistor are not good, then repair as needed and proceed to Step
12.
b. If the wire harnesses are good, then proceed to Step 11.
11. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED Connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) (between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value at 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value at 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. No, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. Yes, then replace the DCCSM and proceed to Step 12.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1, otherwise repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return vehicle to
customer.
Section 3
SECTION 3 (Seat Shuts Off Less Than 40 Seconds, But More Than 5 Seconds)
1. Follow the spread terminal fix procedure listed in Section 5. If this has already been performed
and in Step 3 in Section 1 has lead you back to this procedure, proceed to Step 2.
2. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, determine if an over-temp DTC is
present (B2729, B2730, B272A, B272B).
a. If there is an over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 3.
b. If there is no over-temp DTC present, then continue to Step 5.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11022
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
3. Are any of the Temperature PIDS reading between 200° F (93° C) and 400° F (204° C) at room
temperature conditions (when heat mode has not been on for 5 minutes), or is one TED reading
10° higher than the other TED?
a. If readings are hotter than room temperature, go to Step 4.
b. If TED temperatures between Back and Cushion are 100 different, go to Step 12.
c. If reading correctly then, proceed to Step 5.
4. Check for short to ground or voltage in the thermistor circuit. (As shown on TED connector
(C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger
Cushion). (Figure 1)
a. Looking into the harness side of the TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver
Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should read 5v +/1.5v present at Pin 3 with the ignition on.
(1) If no, then unplug DCCSM and check if harness side Pin 3 is shorted to ground.
(2) If yes, fix the wiring, if no replace the DCCSM.
b. Checking TED assembly connector, is resistance across Pins 2 and 3 greater than 1000 ohms?
(1) If yes, go to Step 5.
(2) If no, then replace TED. (Figure 2)
5. Is one of the TED PID readings less than 0° F (-18° C) or greater than 400° F (204° C)?
a. If yes, go to Step 6.
b. If no, go to Step 7.
6. Ensure the module is producing voltage to the thermistor circuit of the TED, checking the
harness side of TED connector (C3034 - Driver Back, C3035 - Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger
Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) the voltage should be 5v +/- 1.5v present at Pin 3 with ref to
Pin 2.
a. If no voltage to thermistor is present at TED, then ensure the harness is not damaged by
checking the voltage at the module Connector C3265A-Pins 13, 14, 15, 16 (DCCSM Connector
C3265B must remain plugged in). If no voltage is present at DCCSM, then replace DCCSM,
otherwise replace the harness. Verify system now functions and return vehicle to customer.
b. If the correct voltage is present to the thermistor, then replace the TED assembly. Verify system
now functions and return vehicle to customer.
7. Cycle ignition and enter into high cool mode. Does failure still occur?
a. If no, proceed to Step 8.
b. If yes, proceed to Step 13.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11023
8. Ensure voltage is getting to the suspect TED. Enter heat mode and back probe Pin 6 of the TED
connector.
NOTE
DO NOT LEAVE IN HEAT MODE FOR OVER 1 MINUTE
a. If voltage is not getting to the suspect TED, proceed to Step 9.
b. If voltage is getting to the suspect TED, replace TED.
9. Ensure voltage is coming out of the module by back probing the suspect pin on C3265B of the
module. (Figure 3)
^ Driver Cushion - Pin 9
^ Driver Backrest - Pin 8
^ Passenger Cushion - Pin 11
^ Passenger Backrest - Pin 22
a. If no voltage is coming out of the module, then replace the module and continue to Step 13.
b. If the correct voltage is coming out of the module, then continue to Step 10.
10. Disconnect DCCSM C3265B. Check for an open circuit (resistance greater than 5 ohms) from
the TED that is reading the cold temperature to the CCSM (C3265B). If no open circuit is found,
then continue to Step 11. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11024
11. With DCCSM C3265B disconnected, check for a short circuit (short to voltage is less than 0.2
volts, short to ground is resistance less than 10,000 ohms) in the wiring from the TED that is not
reading the over-temp to the CCSM. If no short circuit is found, then replace the TED. (Figure 5)
12. Is the resistance on the thermistor circuit at the TED connector (C3034 - driver back, C3035 Driver Cushion, C3039 - Passenger Back, or C3040 - Passenger Cushion) between 2.7 K ohms
(proper value @ 65° F) (18° C) to 1.86 K ohms (proper value @ 80° F) (27° C) at ambient (room
temperature)?
a. If no, then replace the TED that is outside the resistance range specified above, assuming the
TED is at room temperature, and proceed to Step 12.
b. If yes, then proceed to Step 13.
13. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 4 Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 14.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11025
14. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED. (Figures 6 and 7)
a. If there is a kink or obstruction of the ducting, repair as needed and continue to Step 15.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11026
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting then, continue to Step 16.
15. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code and:
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 16.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and finish other repairs as needed and return
vehicle to customer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11027
16. Check if the seat back/cushions are damaged or the scrim (Figures 8 and 9) has been
obstructed or damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking air flow from the TED.
a. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 17.
b. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and is correct for a climate control seat, then
replace the TED and continue to Step 17.
17. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3
in Section 1 of this TSB. If CCS in now operable, repower the SRS, and return vehicle to customer.
Section 4
SECTION 4 (Seat Shuts Off After More Than 40 Seconds)
1. Check the temperature PIDS with a generic scan tool (GST) from the two TEDs on the affected
seat when a heating cycle is initiated.
a. If a TED does not increase more than 1 or 2 degrees, then proceed to Step 2.
b. If the TEDs both increase temperature, then proceed to Step 3.
2. Let the TEDs sit with no heating or cooling cycle for 5 minutes. Check the resistance of the TED
that does not increase temperature from Step 1.
a. If the resistance of the TED is around 2.5 ohms +/- 10 ohms at room temperature, then proceed
to Step 3.
b. If the resistance of the TED is 0 or hundreds of ohms at room temperature then replace the TED,
verify the fix and proceed to Step 6.
3. Check for any kinks or obstructions of the ducting from the fan to the TED.
a. If there are kinks, then replace the ducting, if there is an obstruction, then remove if possible
otherwise replace the ducting and continue to Step 4.
b. If there are no kinks or obstructions of the ducting, then continue to Step 5.
4. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D code and
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11028
a. Time to failure is different than before, then start new diagnosis from Step 3 in Section 1.
b. Time to failure is not different than before, then continue to Step 5.
c. If CCS is now operable, then repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
5. Check for seat back/cushions damage or if the scrim (Figures 9 and 10) has been obstructed or
damaged or bunched in the cushion blocking airflow from the TED, or the TED - CCS cushion
alignment is incorrect.
a. If the cushion is not a CCS cushion, then replace it with a CCS cushion and proceed to Step 6.
b. If the TED and cushion alignment are incorrect, then correct the alignment, proceed to Step 6.
c. If the cushion or scrim is damaged or bunched or is incorrect, then repair or replace the
damaged cushion/scrim and continue to Step 6.
d. If the cushion or scrim is not damaged or bunched and the cushion is a correct cushion for a
climate control seat, then replace the TED and continue to Step 6.
6. If CCS continues to be inoperable with a B272C/D code, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1 of this TSB; otherwise repower the SRS and return vehicle to customer.
Section 5
SECTION 5 (Spread Terminal Fix Procedure)
1. Position the front passenger seat fully rearward and up.
2. Pull out and remove the seat track front cover.
3. Disconnect Connector C3265B 24-pin gray. (Figure 3).
4. Remove the red secondary wedge inside the connector.
5. Using an appropriate pick, or equivalent, disengage the internal lock that holds the terminals in
cavities 8, 9, 10, 11, 21, 22, 23, 24 (Figure 3).
NOTE
DO NOT DISENGAGE MORE THAN ONE (1) CIRCUIT AT A TIME. ONLY DISENGAGE THE
NEXT CIRCUIT AFTER THE PREVIOUS ONE HAS BEEN REPAIRED AND REASSEMBLED
INTO THE CONNECTOR. THIS WILL PREVENT INSERTING CIRCUITS INTO THE WRONG
CAVITY.
6. Insert the dental pick into the back part of each terminal (inside the box-shaped portion of the
terminal) and bend the spring into the proper position (Figure 10).
7. After all eight (8) terminals have been repaired, reinsert the red secondary wedge into the
connector.
8. Reconnect C3265B to the dual climate control seat module.
9. Reinstall the seat track front cover.
10. Repower the SRS. Refer to WSM, Section 501-20B.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Switch: > 06-13-6 > Jul > 06 >
A/C - Climate Controlled Seats DTC B272C or B272D > Page 11029
11. Verify the climate control seat function, and recheck DTCs.
12. If CCS continues to be inoperable with DTC B272C/D, start a new diagnosis from Step 3 in
Section 1. If no DTCs are present, and system is operating correctly, repower the SRS, and return
vehicle to customer. If system is still not operating properly, follow normal diagnostics per WSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11033
C503
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11034
Seat Memory Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH - MEMORY SET
Memory Set Switch
Remove the memory set switch.
Measure the resistance between the indicated terminals while pressing the requested switches.
The resistance should be less than 5 ohms for each switch position.
If the resistance is not less than 5 ohms for each switch, install a new switch; otherwise, return to
the calling pinpoint test.
NOTE: Refer to multimeter user's manual for testing diodes.
To check the memory set switch LED, connect the positive meter lead to terminal 7 and the
negative lead to terminal 1. The meter should indicate greater than 0.3 volts. Reversing the leads,
the meter should read OL.
If the meter readings are not as indicated above, install a new switch; otherwise, return to the
calling pinpoint test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11038
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Diagrams
C912
C9001
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11039
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 11045
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 11046
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch
C4190
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 11049
C4187
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Fork Bolt/Detent Switch > Page 11050
C9000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Locations > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Left Front
View 151-26 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Locations > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Left Front > Page 11055
View 151-27 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Right Front
C331
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Lumbar Adjust Switch, Right Front > Page 11058
C361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 11059
Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 11060
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch,
Seats > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 11061
Vacuum/Pressure Pump Switch: Service and Repair
LUMBAR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat track-to-floor fasteners. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
Remove the 40 percent seat. 4. Access and remove the cushion side shield front screw.
5. Pull out from the bottom and rear side of cushion side shield to release the 3 retainer clips. 6.
Disconnect the power lumbar switch and 8-way power seat switch electrical connectors.
7. Pinch retainer in and push from the rear of power lumbar switch to remove the switch from the
side shield. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Install the 40 percent seat.
10. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sound Proofing / Insulation > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Sound Proofing / Insulation: Description and Operation
INSULATION
Insulation is installed:
- under the roof.
- above and below the instrument panel.
- at the cowl sides.
- over the transmission tunnel.
- over the floorpan areas.
- inside the quarter panels.
And has heat-bondable mastic deadeners for improved NVH characteristics (Navigator).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and
Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL PANEL GRILLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the windshield wipers. 2. Remove the cowl grille seal.
3. Remove the pin-type retainer and left side cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
4. Remove the right side cowl trim panel.
1 Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
2 Remove the pin-type retainer.
5. If necessary, adjust the windshield wiper arms. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High
Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 11079
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 11080
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 >
Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Sunroof Water Leaks
During High Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 >
Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 11086
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 >
Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 11087
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 11088
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL WEATHERSTRIP
Removal
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed.
1. Remove the roof opening panel. 2. Place roof opening panel, topside up, on a worktable. Take
care to support the glass assembly from below to prevent damaging the mounting tabs.
3. Remove the old roof opening panel weatherstrip by pulling up on the weatherstrip.
Installation
1. Place a new weatherstrip into position on the glass assembly, with the splice (seam) on the
passenger side. 2. Starting with the corners, push the weatherstrip into position. Continue pushing
the weatherstrip into position around the glass assembly until
complete. Use a plastic or rubber hammer if necessary.
3. Install the roof opening panel. 4. Adjust the roof panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations >
Deactivator Switch
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations >
Deactivator Switch > Page 11094
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Deactivator Switch
C277
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Deactivator Switch > Page 11097
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 11100
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake
Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS)/BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code is set by the PCM strategy.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 11101
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
Removal
1. NOTE: The speed control deactivator switch can only be adjusted once. If further adjusting is
necessary, install a new switch.
Remove the speed control deactivator switch. 1
Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Rotate the deactivator switch counterclockwise 45 degrees and remove the switch.
Installation
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 11102
1. Release the plunger lock (if equipped).
- Turn the lock knob counterclockwise until the first click is felt.
2. Fully apply the brake pedal
3. Install the speed control deactivator switch.
1 Position the deactivator switch in the bracket and rotate it clockwise 45 degrees.
2 Connect the electrical connector.
Vehicles equipped with a locking tab
4. NOTE: There should be an extra click heard when tugging on the brake pedal.
Slowly release the brake pedal and tug it moderately once the pedal reaches the rest position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the driver air bag module.
Expedition
2. Remove the 2 screws and the speed control switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
3. Remove the horn switch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
11109
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the 4 bolts.
4. Remove the speed control switch.
1 Disconnect the wiring harness locators.
2 Remove the 4 screws. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations > Deactivator Switch
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations > Deactivator Switch > Page 11115
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Deactivator Switch
C277
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Deactivator Switch > Page 11118
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 11121
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake
Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS)/BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code is set by the PCM strategy.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 11122
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
Removal
1. NOTE: The speed control deactivator switch can only be adjusted once. If further adjusting is
necessary, install a new switch.
Remove the speed control deactivator switch. 1
Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Rotate the deactivator switch counterclockwise 45 degrees and remove the switch.
Installation
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 11123
1. Release the plunger lock (if equipped).
- Turn the lock knob counterclockwise until the first click is felt.
2. Fully apply the brake pedal
3. Install the speed control deactivator switch.
1 Position the deactivator switch in the bracket and rotate it clockwise 45 degrees.
2 Connect the electrical connector.
Vehicles equipped with a locking tab
4. NOTE: There should be an extra click heard when tugging on the brake pedal.
Slowly release the brake pedal and tug it moderately once the pedal reaches the rest position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the driver air bag module.
Expedition
2. Remove the 2 screws and the speed control switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
3. Remove the horn switch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11130
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the 4 bolts.
4. Remove the speed control switch.
1 Disconnect the wiring harness locators.
2 Remove the 4 screws. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Audible Warning Device: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
Audible Warning Device: Customer Interest Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Audible Warning Device: > 05-22-17 > Nov > 05 >
Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 11140
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Audible Warning Device: > 05-22-17 > Nov >
05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime
Audible Warning Device: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder'
Chime
TSB 05-22-17
11/14/05
INABILITY TO DISABLE THE SUPPLEMENTAL SAFETY BELT WARNING CHIME
(BELTMINDER)
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition/Navigator vehicles may exhibit an inability to disable the Belt Minder
function following procedures listed in the Workshop Manual or the Owner Guide. The Belt Minder
function operates normally, but can not be turned off (if desired by the customer).
ACTION Replace the restraint control module (RCM), which includes software to disable the Belt
Minder. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-20B to replace the RCM. Then follow Workshop
Manual, Section 413-09 or the Owner Guide procedure to disable the Belt Minder function.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
052217A 2006 Expedition: Replace 1.0 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
052217A 2006 Navigator: Replace 1.2 Hrs.
The Restraints Control Module Includes Time To Depower And Repower The Supplemental
Restraints System And Disable The Beltminder (Do Not Use With 14056D, 14056D1B, 14056D1C,
14056D1XN, 14056DZR)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B321 42
OASIS CODES: 104000, 206000
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Audible Warning Device: > 05-22-17 > Nov >
05 > Restraints - Cannot Disable 'Belt Minder' Chime > Page 11146
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 11147
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 11148
C4186
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cigarette Lighter: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11153
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11154
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11155
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11156
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11157
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11158
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11159
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11160
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11161
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11162
Cigarette Lighter: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11163
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11164
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11165
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11166
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11167
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11168
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11169
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11170
C2031
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11171
Cigarette Lighter: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
44-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11172
44-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11173
44-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Diagrams
C2016
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 11177
Clock: Description and Operation
CLOCK
The stand-alone electric analog clock, available in the Navigator only, is centrally located on the
instrument panel and displays time in a 12 hour format. The clock is backlit when the headlamps
and parking lamps are on. The Expedition clock is integrated into the radio.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Clock: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step. 4. If the fault is not visually evident, verify the symptom and GO to Symptom Chart. See:
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11180
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11181
Clock: Pinpoint Tests
PINPOINT TEST A: THE CLOCK OPERATION IS ERRATIC/INOPERATIVE
A1
A1-A2
Normal Operation
The clock receives battery voltage from the central junction box (CJB) through circuit 729 (RD/WH).
Ground for the clock is supplied through circuit 57 (BK).
Possible Causes
- fuse
- clock
- circuit 57 (BK) open
- circuit 729 (RD/WH) open
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 11182
Clock: Service and Repair
CLOCK
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster center finish panel. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector. 3.
Release the retaining clips and remove the clock from the instrument cluster center finish panel. 4.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 11183
73III Automotive Meter
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Diagrams
C909
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Vehicle Demagnetizing
Compass: Service and Repair Vehicle Demagnetizing
VEHICLE DEMAGNETIZING
CAUTION: During demagnetizing, the demagnetizer coil is pulled toward the vehicle. Place a cloth
over the vehicle roof to protect the vehicle surface if contact occurs. Make sure the cloth covers the
front third and the entire width of the roof.
NOTE:
- The demagnetizing process requires the use of a demagnetizing coil commonly used by television
service technicians to demagnetize television tubes.
- To demagnetize, use a constant circular motion over the vehicle roof. Do not turn off the
demagnetizer while sweeping the vehicle roof to prevent remagnetizing ferrous materials contained
in the vehicle.
- During the demagnetizing process, make sure the phenolic surface of the tool (the side opposite
the handle) is closest to the vehicle surface.
1. Demagnetize the front third of the vehicle roof.
1 Turn on the demagnetizer at least 1 meter (3 ft) away from the vehicle.
2 Holding the demagnetizer no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) from the roof and starting on the passenger
side, demagnetize the front third of the roof closest to the windshield using a constant circular
motion. Keep the circle radius within 30 cm (12 in) while sweeping across the entire surface of the
roof closest to the windshield. Continue the circular motion 4 times.
3 After the fourth pass and without stopping, move the demagnetizer at least 1 meter (3 ft) away
from the vehicle.
4 Turn the demagnetizer off.
2. NOTE: The demagnetizer must be located over the outside of the windshield no greater than 2.5
cm (1 in).
Demagnetize the inside rear view mirror mounting pad. 1
Turn on the demagnetizer at least 1 meter (3 ft) away from the vehicle.
2 Using a circular motion, pass the demagnetizer over the outside of the windshield near the inside
rear view mirror mounting pad. Without stopping, move the demagnetizer at least 1 meter (3 ft)
away from the vehicle.
3 Turn the demagnetizer off.
3. Carry out the Compass Zone Adjustment procedure. Refer to Compass Zone Adjustment - With
Message Center or Compass Zone Adjustment Without Message Center. See: Compass Zone Adjustment/With Message Center See: Compass
Zone Adjustment/Without Message Center
4. Carry out the Calibration Adjustment procedure. Refer to Compass Calibration - With Message
Center or Compass Calibration - Without Message
Center. See: Compass Calibration/With Message Center See: Compass Calibration/Without
Message Center
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Vehicle Demagnetizing > Page 11189
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Zone Adjustment
With Message Center
COMPASS ZONE ADJUSTMENT - WITH MESSAGE CENTER
1. NOTE: The compass zone setting is preset from the factory to Zone 8.
Determine which magnetic zone you are in for your geographic location.
2. Start the engine. 3. Press the message center switch INFO button until the compass information
is displayed. 4. Press and hold the SETUP and RESET buttons until the message center display
changes to show the current zone setting. 5. Press the SETUP button repeatedly until the correct
zone setting is displayed in the message center. 6. To exit the zone steering mode, and lock in the
changes, press and release the RESET button.
Without Message Center
COMPASS ZONE ADJUSTMENT - WITHOUT MESSAGE CENTER
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Vehicle Demagnetizing > Page 11190
1. NOTE: The compass zone setting is preset from the factory to Zone 8.
Determine which magnetic zone you are in for your geographic location.
2. Start the engine. 3. Press the TRIP/RESET button, hold for 6 seconds and release. ZONE
appears in the instrument cluster display. 4. Press and release the TRIP/RESET button until the
desired zone number appears. 5. When the desired zone number appears in the instrument cluster
display, hold the TRIP/RESET button down to set the new zone number. The
instrument cluster display returns to the normal mode when the TRIP/RESET button is not pressed
for 6 seconds.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Vehicle Demagnetizing > Page 11191
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Calibration
With Message Center
COMPASS CALIBRATION - WITH MESSAGE CENTER
1. NOTE: For optimum calibration, drive to an open, level location away from large metallic objects
or structures. Switch off all non-essential
electrical accessories (heated rear window, heater A/C, map lamps, wiper, etc.) and make sure all
the doors are closed.
Start the vehicle.
2. Press the RESET control button to start the compass calibration function. 3. Slowly drive the
vehicle in a circle less than 5 km/h (3 mph) until the CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE display
changes to CALIBRATION
COMPLETE. It takes up to 5 circles to complete the compass calibration.
Without Message Center
COMPASS CALIBRATION - WITHOUT MESSAGE CENTER
1. NOTE: For optimum calibration, drive to an open, level location away from large metallic objects
or structures. Switch off all non-essential
electrical accessories (heated rear window, heater A/C, map lamps, wiper, etc.) and make sure all
the doors are closed.
Start the vehicle.
2. Enter the compass calibration mode by pressing and holding the TRIP/RESET button for 8
seconds. The instrument cluster then shows CAL. 3. Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle at no more
than 5 km/h (3 mph) until CAL turns off in the instrument cluster display (approximately 5 circles).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety
canopy deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a seat mounted side air bag and/or a safety belt pretensioner (if equipped)
system is being serviced, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central junction
box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover and
remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and close
the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11197
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety canopy
module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11198
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central
junction box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover
and remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Remove the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
8. Remove the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11199
9. Remove the driver air bag module.
1 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
2 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
3 Disconnect the horn switch electrical connector.
4 Remove the driver air bag module.
Navigator
10. Disconnect the driver air bag module.
- Release the 2 tabs on each driver air bag module electrical connector and disconnect them. Label each driver air bag module electrical connector before disconnecting.
11. Release the tab and disconnect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector at
the top of the clockspring and remove the driver air
bag module.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11200
12. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tools to the clockspring electrical connectors at the top of
the steering column.
13. While pushing in on the 2 glove compartment door tabs, position the glove compartment
downward.
14. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the tab and disconnect the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
15. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
Vehicles with safety canopies
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11201
16. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
17. Remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
18. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11202
19. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
20. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide.
21. Remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
22. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11203
23. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the driver side safety
canopy electrical connector.
All vehicles 24. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB. 25. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
Vehicles with safety canopies
3. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the driver side
safety canopy electrical connector.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11204
5. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the driver side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
6. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row driver side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
7. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11205
8. Connect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
9. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
10. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11206
11. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger air
bag module electrical connector.
12. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
13. Close the glove compartment.
14. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tools from the clockspring electrical connector at the
top of the steering column.
Navigator
15. Connect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector to the connector end at the
top of the clockspring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11207
16. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module.
Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the
electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
Expedition
17. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
1 Connect the horn switch electrical connector.
2 CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the
driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal.
3 Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
All vehicles
18. Install the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11208
19. Install the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
20. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
21. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 22. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and
close the cover.
23. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
24. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11209
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Prove Out Procedure
PROVE OUT PROCEDURE
Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the ON position and visually monitor the air bag indicator
with all SRS components connected or restraint system diagnostic tools installed. The air bag
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is
present, the air bag indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator will
need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch. 3. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
View 151-30 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11217
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11218
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11219
View 151-31 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11220
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch
C479
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11223
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11224
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11225
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11226
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 11227
Door Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door lock actuator. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11231
C253
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11232
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Description and Operation
INFORMATION AND MESSAGE CENTER
The message center display is a green vacuum fluorescent, fixed format display. The message
center is a 2-line display integrated into the center of the instrument cluster and is controlled by the
message center switches. Refer to the Owner's Literature for operating instructions.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
The message center is a vacuum fluorescent display, part of the instrument cluster. The message
center electronic functions use both hardwired, and controller area network (CAN) circuitry to
transmit and receive information. As a technician, it is very important to understand:
- where the input (command) originates.
- all the information (messages) necessary in order for a feature to operate.
- which module(s) receive(s) the input or command message.
- if the module that received the input (message) controls the output of the feature, or if it outputs a
message over the CAN to another module.
- which module controls the output of the feature.
The message center provides the following features:
- information displays
- setup displays
- warning messages
- system check messages
The message center information can be selected through a set of 3 buttons:
- INFO
- SETUP
- RESET
Information Displays The information displays are non-timed modes. The selected mode remains
on until the driver presses a message center button to change the mode or it is overridden by
another mode. The information display modes are: odometer
- trip odometer
- compass
- distance to empty (DTE)
- average fuel economy
Setup Displays The setup displays are timed modes and terminate after a finite interval. The setup
display modes are: system check
- English/metric units
- power liftgate on/off (if equipped)
- running board auto in/out (if equipped)
- easy exit seat (if equipped)
- autolamp delay
- language
Warning Messages The warning messages are single cycle, non-resettable and repetitive warning
messages. The single cycle warning messages are: CHECK SUSPENSION
- CHECK COMPASS MODULE
- NO RESPONSE COMPASS
- ENGINE TEMP DATA
- COMPASS DATA ERROR
- DOOR SENSOR DATA ERROR
- CHARGING SYSTEM DATA ERROR
- CHECK PARK ASSIST
- CHECK FUEL CAP
- LOW WASHER FLUID LEVEL
The single cycle warning messages display once whenever the ignition switch is turned to ON or a
fault occurs in a system and can be cleared by pressing the RESET button.
The repetitive warning messages are: LOW BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
- CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM
- LOW FUEL LEVEL
- LOW OIL PRESSURE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11235
- CHECK ENGINE TEMPERATURE
- TEMPORARY 4x4 HIGH
- CHECK ADV/TRAC
- CHECK TIRE PRESSURE
The repetitive warning messages are displayed at a fixed interval whenever the ignition switch is
turned ON or is in the ACC position. To remove a repetitive warning message, press the RESET
button. The message only reoccurs after 10 minutes or until the warning condition is corrected.
The non-resettable warning messages are: DOOR AJAR
- STOP ENGINE SAFELY
- REDUCED ENGINE POWER
- ENGINE FAILSAFE MODE
- PARK ASSIST ON/OFF
- TRAIN LF TIRE
- TRAIN LR TIRE
- TRAIN RF TIRE
- TRAIN RR TIRE
- TRAIN SPARE TIRE
- TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPLETE
- TIRES NOT TRAINED
- PARK BRAKE ENGAGED
The non-resettable warning messages display whenever the ignition switch is turned to ON and a
fault occurs in a system. The fault must be corrected to clear the non-resettable warning
messages.
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step. 4. If the cause is not visually evident, connect the diagnostic tool to the data link
connector and select the vehicle to be tested from the diagnostic tool
menu. If the diagnostic tool does not communicate with the vehicle: check that the program card is correctly installed.
- check the connections to the vehicle.
- check the ignition switch position.
5. If the diagnostic tool still does not communicate with the vehicle, refer to the diagnostic tool
operating manual. 6. Carry out the diagnostic tool data link test. If the diagnostic tool responds with:
- ISO, SCP or CAN circuit fault; all electronic control units no response/not equipped, refer to
Information Bus (Module Communications Network).
- No response/not equipped for the instrument cluster, refer to Instrument Cluster.
- System passed, retrieve and record the continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs), erase the
continuous DTCs, and carry out self-test diagnostics for the instrument cluster.
7. If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, refer to the Instrument Cluster Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) Index. See: Diagnostic Trouble
Code Descriptions
8. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11236
B1209-U2013
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11237
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11238
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11239
Symptom Chart (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11240
Symptom Chart (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11241
Symptom Chart (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11242
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Pinpoint Tests
Test A: The Message Center Is Not Operating Correctly
PINPOINT TEST A: THE MESSAGE CENTER IS NOT OPERATING CORRECTLY
A1
Normal Operation
The message center functionality is controlled through the message center switches, which are
hardwired to the instrument cluster through circuit 1396 (VT/WH) and circuit 1411 (GY/OG). Each
message center switch uses a different resistance value allowing the instrument cluster to
determine which switch is pressed.
Possible Causes
- message center switches
- instrument cluster
Test B: The Compass Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST B: THE COMPASS IS INOPERATIVE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11243
B1-B3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11244
B3 Continued
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module receives voltage from central junction box (CJB) fuse 27 (5A) through
circuit 1003 (GY/YE) and is grounded through circuit 875 (BK/LB). The compass sensor module
communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster, and the direction is displayed in the
message center. The compass sensor module uses circuit 702 (WH/BK) and circuit 703 (WH/OG)
to communicate to the instrument cluster.
Possible Causes
- fuse
- circuit 702 (WH/BK) open or short to ground
- circuit 703 (WH/OG) open or short to ground
- circuit 875 (BK/LB) open
- circuit 1003 (GY/YE) open
- compass sensor module
Test C: The Compass Is Inaccurate
PINPOINT TEST C: THE COMPASS IS INACCURATE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11245
C1-C3
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster to
display in the message center.
Possible Causes
- compass sensor module
- vehicle magnetization
- zone setting
- calibration
Test D: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST D: THE MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11246
D1-D3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11247
D4-D5
Normal Operation
The message center switch assembly uses circuits 1396 (VT/WH) and 1411 (GY/OG) to
communicate the requested switch function to the message center.
Possible Causes
- circuit 1396 (VT/WH) open or short to ground
- circuit 1411 (GY/OG) open or short to ground
- message center switch
- instrument cluster
Test E: The Power Liftgate Display Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST E: THE POWER LIFTGATE DISPLAY IS INOPERATIVE
E1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11248
E2-E3
Normal Operation
The vehicle security module (VSM) sends a voltage reference signal through circuit 700 (WH/VT)
to the power liftgate module. When the reference signal loses the ground signal by the opening of
the power liftgate, the VSM sends a signal over the communication network to the instrument
cluster, illuminating the power liftgate display.
Possible Causes
- instrument cluster
- power liftgate
Test F: The Power Running Boards Display Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST F: THE POWER RUNNING BOARDS DISPLAY IS INOPERATIVE
F1-F3
Normal Operation
The instrument cluster receives the running board status from the power liftgate module over the
communication network. The retractable running boards are controlled by the power liftgate module
over the control circuits 1944 (BN/PK) (left side), and 1945 (VT/WH) (right side). The running board
motors are grounded through circuit 57 (BK). The retractable running board motors receive a
ground signal from the power liftgate module to deploy and an open signal to retract.
Possible Causes
- instrument cluster
- power running boards
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11249
Test G: The Park Assist On/Off Display Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST G: THE PARK ASSIST ON/OFF DISPLAY IS INOPERATIVE
G1-G3
Normal Operation
The parking aid system is enabled when the ignition switch is in the RUN position and REVERSE is
selected. The system can be disabled through the message center RESET switch located in the
instrument cluster. The parking aid menu is displayed until the transmission is taken out of
REVERSE. While the menu is displayed, pressing the message center RESET switch changes the
parking aid system status to OFF. The parking aid system is disabled if a fault is detected in 1 of
the 4 sensors, the parking aid speaker, or the parking aid module. This is indicated by the parking
aid disabled warning CHECK BACKUP AID displayed in the message center. The parking aid
module communicates with the instrument cluster through the communication network.
Possible Causes
- instrument cluster
- parking aid system
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11250
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Service and Repair
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel.
2. NOTE: Navigator is shown, Expedition is similar.
Press the tabs and remove the message center switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11251
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
CHECK FUEL CAP INDICATOR
NOTE: The check fuel cap indicator on the Hanger is a dedicated output signal that is controlled by
the PCM.
The check fuel cap indicator is a communications network message sent by the PCM. The PCM
sends the message to illuminate the lamp when the strategy determines that there is a failure in the
vapor management system due to the fuel filler cap not being sealed correctly. This would be
detected by the inability to pull vacuum in the fuel tank, after a fueling event.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Gauge: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11259
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11260
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11261
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11262
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11263
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11264
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11265
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11266
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11267
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11268
Fuel Gauge: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11269
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11270
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11271
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11272
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11273
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11274
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11275
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump Module (FPM)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 11280
Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump Module (FPM)
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 11281
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module and Reservoir
FUEL PUMP MODULE AND RESERVOIR
Fuel Pump Module And Reservoir
The fuel pump module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge
check valve that maintains the system pressure after the ignition key has been turned off to
minimize starting concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle
maneuvers with low tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 11282
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 11283
Part 2
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 11284
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel and vapor tubes from the fuel pump module.
3. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
4. CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 11285
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming and Arming
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety
canopy deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a seat mounted side air bag and/or a safety belt pretensioner (if equipped)
system is being serviced, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central junction
box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover and
remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and close
the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11291
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety canopy
module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11292
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the RCM fuse is removed and the ignition switch is
ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the central
junction box (CJB), located below the RH side of the instrument panel, open the kick panel cover
and remove the restraints control
module (RCM) fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag indicator for at least 30 seconds. The air
bag indicator will remain lit continuously (no
flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag indicator does not remain lit
continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors or
RCM, such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located at the bottom of the hood latch support bracket.
The first row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The second row side impact sensors (if equipped) are located at or near the base of the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Remove the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
8. Remove the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11293
9. Remove the driver air bag module.
1 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
2 Release the 2 retaining tabs. Disconnect the driver air bag module electrical connector. Label the driver air bag module squib number on the driver air bag module electrical connector
before disconnecting.
3 Disconnect the horn switch electrical connector.
4 Remove the driver air bag module.
Navigator
10. Disconnect the driver air bag module.
- Release the 2 tabs on each driver air bag module electrical connector and disconnect them. Label each driver air bag module electrical connector before disconnecting.
11. Release the tab and disconnect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector at
the top of the clockspring and remove the driver air
bag module.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11294
12. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tools to the clockspring electrical connectors at the top of
the steering column.
13. While pushing in on the 2 glove compartment door tabs, position the glove compartment
downward.
14. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the tab and disconnect the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
15. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger air bag
module electrical connector.
Vehicles with safety canopies
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11295
16. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
17. Remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
18. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11296
19. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
20. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt
guide cover is damaged or if it does not remain closed,
install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Release the retaining tab at each side and open the safety belt guide cover.
2 Remove the nut.
3 Remove the second row driver side safety belt guide.
21. Remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
1 Separate the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
2 Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
3 Pull out to release the retainers and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
22. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11297
23. Attach the restraint system diagnostic tool to the vehicle harness side of the driver side safety
canopy electrical connector.
All vehicles 24. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB. 25. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 19 (10A) from the CJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
Vehicles with safety canopies
3. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the driver side
safety canopy electrical connector.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11298
5. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the driver side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
6. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row driver side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row driver side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
7. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger side
safety canopy electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11299
8. Connect the passenger side safety canopy electrical connector.
9. WARNING: Anytime the safety canopy module has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, and C
pillar upper trim panels and attaching
hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and hardware. Failure to
do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel. 1
Position the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and push in, engaging the retainers.
2 Install the bolt and bolt cover. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3 Install the weather-stripping along the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
10. NOTE:
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or if it does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Make sure the safety belt is not twisted prior to installation.
Install the second row passenger side safety belt guide. 1
Position the second row passenger side safety belt guide.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Close the safety belt guide cover. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11300
11. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tool from the vehicle harness side of the passenger air
bag module electrical connector.
12. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
13. Close the glove compartment.
14. Remove the restraint system diagnostic tools from the clockspring electrical connector at the
top of the steering column.
Navigator
15. Connect the driver air bag module accessories electrical connector to the connector end at the
top of the clockspring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11301
16. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module.
Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the
electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
Expedition
17. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
1 Connect the horn switch electrical connector.
2 CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the
driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the driver air bag module electrical connectors as noted during removal.
3 Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel.
All vehicles
18. Install the 2 driver air bag module bolts (1 shown).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11302
19. Install the 2 steering wheel back cover plugs (1 shown).
20. WARNING: The restraint system diagnostic tool is for restraint system service only. Remove
from vehicle prior to road use. Failure to
remove could result in injury and possible violation of vehicle safety standards.
Make sure all restraint system diagnostic tool(s) that may have been installed during the repair
have been removed from the vehicle and all SRS components are connected.
21. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 22. Install the RCM fuse 19 (10A) to the CJB and
close the cover.
23. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
24. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag indicator will light
continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a diagnostic tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming and Arming > Page 11303
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Prove Out Procedure
PROVE OUT PROCEDURE
Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the ON position and visually monitor the air bag indicator
with all SRS components connected or restraint system diagnostic tools installed. The air bag
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is
present, the air bag indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch has been
turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the restraints control module
(RCM) to complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag indicator will
need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Instrument
Panel Bulb > Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Cluster Bulb
Instrument Panel Bulb: Service and Repair Instrument Cluster Bulb
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER BULB
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster.
2. Remove the instrument cluster illumination bulbs. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Instrument
Panel Bulb > Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Cluster Bulb > Page 11308
Instrument Panel Bulb: Service and Repair Warning Indicator Bulb
WARNING INDICATOR BULB
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the instrument cluster.
Expedition
2. NOTE: To remove a warning indicator bulb, rotate the bulb one quarter turn counterclockwise
and lift it out from the instrument cluster.
Remove the warning indicator bulb(s) in question.
Navigator
3. Release the clips and remove the rear cover.
4. NOTE: To remove a warning indicator bulb, rotate the bulb one quarter turn counterclockwise
and lift it out from the instrument cluster.
Remove the warning indicator bulb(s) in question.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Tire Pressure Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Description and Operation
UNDERSTANDING YOUR TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System measures pressure in your four road tires and sends the tire
pressure readings to your vehicle every minute while you are driving and once every 6 hours when
your vehicle is parked. The Low Tire Warning Lamp will turn ON if the tire pressure is 25% below
the pressure listed on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (approximately 6 to 9 psi below the
manufacturers recommend tire pressure). If the tire pressure increases 2 psi above the Light ON
threshold, then the TPMS light will turn OFF. Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under
inflated and need to be inflated to the manufacturers recommended tire pressure. Even if the light
turns ON and a short time later turns OFF, your tire pressure still needs to be checked. In short,
once the light has turned ON, at least one tire may be under inflated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Tire Pressure Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 11312
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPM's Indicator and Vehicle Message Center Messages
The TPM's indicator and vehicle message center (if equipped) sometimes displays faults that
cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these messages as TPM's faults that must be serviced.
GO to Symptom Chart for the TPM's indicator operation and message center messages. See: Tire
Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
TPM's Indicator Illuminates Continuously
The TPM's indicator remains on continuously for the following condition:
1. NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPM's functionality
before carrying out any diagnosis.
Low Tire Pressure - The TPM's indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays LOW
TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low. Tire
pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold placard pressure. Adjust the air pressure in
tires. Refer to Information BUS for diagnosis of the CAN bus. The TPM's indicator flashes for 20
seconds after prove-out and for the following 3 reasons:
1 No communication with the TPM's Module (integral to VSM) - The TPM's indicator is illuminated
when the instrument cluster (IC) has received no signals from the VSM for more than 5 seconds. If
equipped, the message center displays TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom
Chart. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
2 Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
SENSOR FAULT when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
3 Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT when the tire pressure
monitoring system is malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing
and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Service and Repair
This vehicle is not equipped with a maintenance required lamp/indicator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (MIL)
MIL (applications With A Dedicated Hard Wire MIL Circuit)
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, Or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately 4 seconds.
- For applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit, the PCM illuminates the MIL until a profile
ignition pickup (PIP) signal is detected. The Ranger uses a hard wire circuit.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if: an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- no PIP signal is detected (applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit). The PIP signal is
generated in the PCM using the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor. For these applications, the MIL
can be helpful in diagnosing a no start.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the Hardware Limited Operation Strategy (HLOS).
- the MIL circuit is shorted to ground (applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if: an indicator or instrument cluster concern is present.
- the MIL circuit is open (applications with a dedicated hard wire MIL circuit).
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the diagnostic tool must be sent, or 3
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
This vehicle is not equipped with an oil change reminder lamp.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-4 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 11325
C103
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking Assist Warning Indicator: > 06-20-5 >
Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Warning Indicator: Customer Interest Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC
C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking Assist Warning Indicator: > 06-20-5 >
Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 > Page 11334
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Parking Assist Warning Indicator:
> 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
Parking Assist Warning Indicator: All Technical Service Bulletins Parking Assist System - Speaker
Inop./DTC C1742/C1743
TSB 06-20-5
10/16/06
PARKING AID SPEAKER INOPERATIVE - DTCS C1742 AND C1743
FORD: 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2004-2006 Escape, Expedition, Explorer, F-150
2004-2007 F-250, F-350
MERCURY: 2005-2007 Montego 2004-2006 Mountaineer 2005-2006 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2004-2007 vehicles equipped with the parking aid reverse sensing system (RSS)
may experience low or no audible sound due to speaker issues related to the RSS. The speaker is
attached to the module which may exhibit diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1742 (Rear Sounder
Circuit Fault) and/or C1743 (Rear Sounder Short).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify that DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present. Also, low audible or intermittent audible
warning condition may exist as well.
2. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 are present, replace parking aid speaker on module with speaker
in Speaker Kit. Follow instructions in Speaker Kit.
3. Clear DTCs and repeat check for DTCs C1742 and/or C1743.
4. If DTCs C1742 and/or C1743 go away and speaker sounds, the repair is complete.
5. If DTCs remain, follow normal diagnostics in the appropriate Workshop Manual, Section 413-13
Pinpoint Test F.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
062005A 2004-2006 Expedition: 1.2 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2007 Super Duty 0.6 Hr.
250/350: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With
31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Parking Assist Warning Indicator:
> 06-20-5 > Oct > 06 > Parking Assist System - Speaker Inop./DTC C1742/C1743 > Page 11340
062005A 2004-2005 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not
Use With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2006 Explorer/Mountaineer: 1.3 Hrs.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR,
31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 F-150: Replace 0.5 Hr.
Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR, 31012AL,
31012AT)
062005A 2004-2006 Escape, 0.8 Hr.
2005-2006 Mariner: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Five 1.3 Hrs.
Hundred/Montego: Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use
With 31012AR, 31012AL, 31012AT)
062005A 2005-2007 Freestyle: 0.7 Hr.
Replace Parking Aid Speaker, Includes Time To Access Module (Do Not Use With 31012AR
31012AL, 31012AT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
15K864 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 11341
C4015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11345
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Buzzer > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Reminder Buzzer: Description and Operation
Warning System - Driver Safety Belt
The driver safety belt incorporates a safety belt warning indicator switch, warning indicator and
chime. The warning indicator and chime are reminders to fasten the safety belt. If the driver safety belt is not buckled before the ignition key is turned to ON, the safety belt warning
light illuminates for 1 to 2 minutes and the warning chime sounds for 4 to 8 seconds.
- If the driver side safety belt is buckled while the indicator light is illuminated and the warning
chime is sounding, the safety belt warning light and warning chime turn OFF.
- If the safety belt is buckled before the key is turned to the ON position, the warning indicator will
come on for 4 to 8 seconds with no chime.
Belt Minder (if equipped)
The Belt Minder feature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt warning function. This feature
provides additional reminders to the driver that the driver's safety belt is unbuckled by intermittently
sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster.
To activate or deactivate the Belt Minder feature, refer to Seat Belt Systems or the owner's
literature.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Description and Operation
Warning System - Driver Safety Belt
The driver safety belt incorporates a safety belt warning indicator switch, warning indicator and
chime. The warning indicator and chime are reminders to fasten the safety belt. If the driver safety belt is not buckled before the ignition key is turned to ON, the safety belt warning
light illuminates for 1 to 2 minutes and the warning chime sounds for 4 to 8 seconds.
- If the driver side safety belt is buckled while the indicator light is illuminated and the warning
chime is sounding, the safety belt warning light and warning chime turn OFF.
- If the safety belt is buckled before the key is turned to the ON position, the warning indicator will
come on for 4 to 8 seconds with no chime.
Belt Minder (if equipped)
The Belt Minder feature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt warning function. This feature
provides additional reminders to the driver that the driver's safety belt is unbuckled by intermittently
sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster.
To activate or deactivate the Belt Minder feature, refer to Seat Belt Systems or the owner's
literature.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch. 3. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
View 151-30 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11360
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11361
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11362
View 151-31 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11363
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch
C479
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11366
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11367
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11368
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11369
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 11370
Door Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door lock actuator. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump Module (FPM)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 11375
Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump Module (FPM)
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 11376
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Module and Reservoir
FUEL PUMP MODULE AND RESERVOIR
Fuel Pump Module And Reservoir
The fuel pump module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge
check valve that maintains the system pressure after the ignition key has been turned off to
minimize starting concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle
maneuvers with low tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 11377
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 11378
Part 2
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 11379
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Disconnect the fuel and vapor tubes from the fuel pump module.
3. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
4. CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 11380
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (LH A-Pillar)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11384
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure
Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Description and Operation
UNDERSTANDING YOUR TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System measures pressure in your four road tires and sends the tire
pressure readings to your vehicle every minute while you are driving and once every 6 hours when
your vehicle is parked. The Low Tire Warning Lamp will turn ON if the tire pressure is 25% below
the pressure listed on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (approximately 6 to 9 psi below the
manufacturers recommend tire pressure). If the tire pressure increases 2 psi above the Light ON
threshold, then the TPMS light will turn OFF. Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under
inflated and need to be inflated to the manufacturers recommended tire pressure. Even if the light
turns ON and a short time later turns OFF, your tire pressure still needs to be checked. In short,
once the light has turned ON, at least one tire may be under inflated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure
Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 11389
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPM's Indicator and Vehicle Message Center Messages
The TPM's indicator and vehicle message center (if equipped) sometimes displays faults that
cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these messages as TPM's faults that must be serviced.
GO to Symptom Chart for the TPM's indicator operation and message center messages. See:
Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
TPM's Indicator Illuminates Continuously
The TPM's indicator remains on continuously for the following condition:
1. NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPM's functionality
before carrying out any diagnosis.
Low Tire Pressure - The TPM's indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays LOW
TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low. Tire
pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold placard pressure. Adjust the air pressure in
tires. Refer to Information BUS for diagnosis of the CAN bus. The TPM's indicator flashes for 20
seconds after prove-out and for the following 3 reasons:
1 No communication with the TPM's Module (integral to VSM) - The TPM's indicator is illuminated
when the instrument cluster (IC) has received no signals from the VSM for more than 5 seconds. If
equipped, the message center displays TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom
Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
2 Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
SENSOR FAULT when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
3 Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT when the tire pressure
monitoring system is malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Module: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Module Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage can result.
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) is integral to the vehicle security module
(VSM) and is not serviced separately.
NOTE: A new VSM module is delivered in manufacturing mode with pre-set diagnostic trouble
codes (DTC's). These DTC's require that a particular set of operations to be carried out in order to
clear them and enable the module for normal operations. The pre-set DTC's are as follows: ^
B2477 - Module Configuration Failure/Mismatch
^ B2868 - Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2869 - Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2870 - Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ B2871 - Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault
^ C2780 - ECU in Manufacturing Mode
NOTE: A re-configured VSM may also set the above codes and will need to go through the same
set of procedures as a new module to enable normal operation.
1. NOTE: The steps included in the VSM removal and installation process are critical to restoring
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring
system operations and will permit a new or reconfigured module to operate as intended. Each step
is designed to carry out a particular operation and clear the manufacturing mode DTC's. Once
these DTC's are cleared, the new or reconfigured module will enter into normal operating mode.
Remove the VSM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Sensor Training (Reset Procedure)
NOTE: The tire pressure monitoring system is not affected by wheel and tire rotation.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency (RF) noise.
RF noise is generated by electrical motor and appliance operation, cellular telephones and remote
transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 2. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to
the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
3. Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position. Do not wait more than 1 minute between
each key cycle.
6. The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if train mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center displays
"TRAIN LF TIRE", place the special tool on the valve stem of the LF tire pressure sensor. The horn
will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the TPMS
module.
7. Within 2 minutes after the horn sounds, place the special tool on the valve stem of the RF tire
pressure sensor.
NOTE: If the VSM (TPMS module integral to VSM) does not recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure
sensors during the tire training procedure, the horn will sound twice and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT" and the procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
When the tire training procedure is complete, the horn will sound once and the message center (if
equipped) will display "TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPLETE".
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11396
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
Tire Pressure Sensor
Special Tools
CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11397
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
Removal
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The tire pressure monitoring system (TPM's) will
not operate correctly if black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not remove the valve stem core to relieve the tire pressure.
CAUTION: If the valve stem core has been removed from the valve stem, reinstall the original valve
stem core. If the original valve stem core is damaged, a nickel-plated core must be installed.
Failure to use a nickel-plated core will result in corrosion and the possible loss of tire pressure.
NOTE: Release the tire pressure by removing the sensor valve stem nut.
With the valve stem at the 6 o'clock position, remove the sensor valve stem nut and push the
sensor by hand into the tire (with the cap on).
3. Using a suitable tire machine, separate both beads of the tire from the wheel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11398
4. CAUTION: Care should be taken not to damage the tire pressure sensor while separating the
outside bead of tire from the wheel.
Place the wheel and tire on the turntable of the tire machine, index-mark the valve stem and wheel
weight positions, lubricate the bead of the tire and dismount the outside bead of the tire from the
wheel.
5. Remove the tire pressure sensor from the tire. 6. Remove and discard the grommet from the tire
pressure sensor.
Installation
NOTE: The vehicle is equipped with a light blue-colored tire pressure sensor. When installing new
components, use only this tire pressure sensor. The TPM's will not operate correctly if
black-colored tire pressure sensors are installed.
1. NOTE: Install a new sensor grommet or an air leak can occur.
Install a new grommet on the tire pressure sensor.
2. NOTE: Do not allow the tire to rotate relative to the rim while mounting the tire.
Lubricate and mount the outside and inside bead of the tire to the rim.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11399
3. CAUTION: Overtightening the tire pressure sensor valve stem nut can damage the tire pressure
sensor, undertightening can cause air leaks.
NOTE: Sensor position is critical for correct sensor operation. The "flat" side of the sensor must be
facing the wheel and the "slanted" side of the sensor must be facing away from the wheel. When
properly installed, there will be a very small gap between the sensor and the wheel.
NOTE: Tightening the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs.) equals approximately 2 clockwise turns after the
nut has been tightened by hand.
Push the side wall of the tire and install the tire pressure sensor. Tighten the nut to 5 Nm (44 inch
lbs.).
4. CAUTION: Use only special tool 204-354 anytime tire pressures are measured to be sure that
accurate values are obtained.
CAUTION: Place the air chuck straight on the valve stem to inflate the tire. Do not cock the air
chuck during the inflation cycle. Doing so can damage the valve stem and cause air leaks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11400
CAUTION: Ford recommends using a round head air chuck on tire pressure sensors; it is not
recommended to use air chucks with long shanks. Doing so can cause tire pressure sensor valve
stem damage and loss of tire pressure.
CAUTION: Use only OEM valve caps (aluminum or plastic valve caps) with the tire pressure
sensors. Do not use brass-threaded valve caps with the tire pressure sensors.
Inflate the tire to the pressure specified on the safety certification sticker located on the driver or
door pillar.
5. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 6. Train the tire pressure sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
LIGHT SENSOR
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 11408
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Remove the light sensor and bezel as an assembly from the defroster grille.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 screws and the light sensor.
Navigator
3. Remove the defroster grille. 4. Remove the 2 screws and the light sensor.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 11413
C1474
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 11414
Backup Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 11415
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 11419
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 11420
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Brake Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11425
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11426
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11427
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11428
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11429
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11430
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11431
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11432
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11433
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11434
Brake Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11435
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11436
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11437
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11438
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11439
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11440
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11441
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11442
Brake Lamp: Connector Views
C4032
C4035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11443
Brake Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
90-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11444
90-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11445
90-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Brake Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step. 4. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom and GO to Symptom Chart.
See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11448
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11449
Brake Lamp: Pinpoint Tests
Test H: The Stoplamps Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST H: THE STOPLAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
H1-H2
Normal Operation
The stoplamp switch is supplied voltage from the central junction box (CJB) fuse 2 (20A) through
circuit 10 (LG/RD). When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the
stoplamps through circuit 511 (LG).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 10 (LG/RD) open
- Circuit 511 (LG) open
- Stoplamp switch
Test I: One Or More Stoplamps Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST I: ONE OR MORE STOPLAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11450
I1-I4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11451
I4-I5
Normal Operation
When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the high mounted stoplamp
and the multifunction switch through circuit 511 (LG). The multifunction switch then routes the
voltage to the central junction box (CJB) through circuit 9 (LG/OG) and circuit 5 (OG/LB). The CJB
then routes the voltage to the LH stoplamp and RH stoplamp through circuit 9 (LG/OG) and circuit
5 (OG/LB) respectively.
Possible Causes
- Circuit 5 (OG/LB) open
- Circuit 9 (LG/OG) open
- Circuit 511 (LG) open
- Multifunction switch
- CJB
Test J: The Stoplamps Are On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST J: THE STOPLAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11452
J1-J6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11453
J7
Normal Operation
The stoplamp switch is supplied voltage from the central junction box (CJB) fuse 2 (20A) through
circuit 10 (LG/RD). When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the high
mounted stoplamp and the multifunction switch through circuit 511 (LG). The multifunction switch
then routes the voltage to the CJB through circuit 9 (LG/OG) and circuit 5 (OG/LB). The CJB then
routes the voltage to the LH stoplamp and RH stoplamp through circuit 9 (LG/OG) and circuit 5
(OG/LB) respectively.
Possible Causes
- Circuit 5 (OG/LB) short to voltage
- Circuit 9 (LG/OG) short to voltage
- Circuit 52 (YE) short to voltage
- Circuit 64 (DG) short to voltage
- Circuit 511 (LG) short to voltage
- Stoplamp switch
- Multifunction switch
- Trailer tow electric brake controller
- CJB
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
11454
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11458
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11459
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11460
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
STOPLAMP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the self-locking pin. 3. Remove
the stoplamp switch from the brake booster push rod and the brake pedal assembly. 4. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
C926
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
C475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Ash Tray Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
Ash Tray Lamp: Diagrams
C2014
C2246
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Courtesy Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Courtesy Lamp Relay: Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
The interior lamp relay is located in the instrument cluster and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
C254
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Interior Light Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Interior Light Switch: Service and Repair
INTERIOR LAMP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. Remove the interior lamp switch.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Rotate the interior lamp switch one-quarter turn counterclockwise and remove.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Locations Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11485
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11486
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Locations Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Ignition Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11487
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
C1359
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11490
C1171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp
Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11493
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11494
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Ignition
Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11495
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch. 3. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Battery Discharge Protection Relay, Lighting > Component Information >
Locations
Battery Discharge Protection Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Battery Discharge Protection Relay, Lighting > Component Information >
Locations > Page 11502
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The battery savar relay is part of the central junction box (CJB) and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear
View 151-30 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 11507
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 11508
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 11509
View 151-31 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 11510
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch
C479
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch >
Page 11513
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch >
Page 11514
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch >
Page 11515
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch >
Page 11516
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 11517
Door Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door lock actuator. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair
FOG LAMP BULB
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 11522
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The halogen bulb contains gas under pressure. The bulb may shatter if the glass
envelope is scratched or if the bulb is dropped. Handle the bulb only by its base. Avoid touching the
glass envelope. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
NOTE: The fog lamp bulb should not be removed from the fog lamp until just before a new bulb is
installed. Removing the bulb for an extended period of time may affect headlamp bulb
performance. Contaminants may enter the headlamp where they can settle on the lens and
reflector. Never turn on the fog lamp with the bulb removed from the fog lamp.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Make sure the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the fog lamp bulb.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 11526
C2241
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 11527
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 11528
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Flasher Relay > Component Information
> Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Flasher Relay > Component Information
> Locations > Page 11533
C2047
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Flasher Relay > Component Information
> Locations > Page 11534
Hazard Flasher Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Flasher Relay > Component Information
> Locations > Page 11535
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11540
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Headlamp Bulb: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP BULB
Headlamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 11545
Standard Headlamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 11546
High Intensity Discharge (HID) Headlamp
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
CAUTION: The halogen bulb contains gas under pressure. The bulb may shatter if the glass
envelope is scratched or if the bulb is dropped. Handle the bulb only by its base. Avoid touching the
glass envelope. Failure to follow these instructions may result in damage to the headlamp bulb.
NOTE:
- The headlamp bulb should not be removed from the headlamp until just before a new bulb is
installed. Removing the bulb for an extended period of time may affect headlamp bulb
performance. Contaminants may enter the headlamp where they can settle on the lens and
reflector. Never turn on the headlamp with the bulb removed from the headlamp.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 11547
- Make sure that the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
1. Remove the headlamp assembly.
Expedition or Navigator halogen bulb
2. Remove the headlamp bulb access cover.
3. CAUTION: Bulbs 9006 and 9005 look similar, but are not interchangeable. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in damage to
the headlamp bulb.
Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the headlamp bulb.
Navigator HID headlamp
4. Remove the low beam bulb access cover.
5. Release the spring tabs and remove the HID low beam bulb.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 11551
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 11552
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 11553
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 11554
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11558
Headlamp Switch: Diagrams
C205a
C205b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11559
C205c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps > Page 11562
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps > Page 11563
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Main Light Switch, Interior Lamps
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps > Page 11564
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 11565
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP SWITCH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 11566
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. CAUTION: Cover the end of the tool with tape to prevent damage to the trim panel.
NOTE: Use a thin-bladed tool to remove the headlamp switch bezel assembly.
Remove the headlamp switch and bezel assembly. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
Navigator
2. Remove the instrument panel finish panel.
3. NOTE: Release the tabs to remove the headlamp switch.
Remove the 2 screws and the headlamp switch.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > High Beam Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > High Beam Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11570
C2242
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > High Beam Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11571
High Beam Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > High Beam Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11572
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations
Horn Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 11577
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The horn relay is part of the central junction box (CJB) and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations
Interior Lighting Relay: Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
The interior lamp relay is located in the instrument cluster and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
License Plate Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11585
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11586
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11587
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11588
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11589
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11590
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11591
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11592
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11593
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11594
License Plate Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11595
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11596
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11597
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11598
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11599
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11600
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11601
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11602
License Plate Lamp: Connector Views
C452
C462
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11603
License Plate Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11604
92-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11605
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Map Light > Component Information > Diagrams > Map Reading Lamp,
Left Front
C908
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Map Light > Component Information > Diagrams > Map Reading Lamp,
Left Front > Page 11610
C903
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Side Lamp, Left
Front
C151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Side Lamp, Left
Front > Page 11615
C161
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11621
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Diagrams
> Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
C2244
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Diagrams
> Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11624
C2245
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11627
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11628
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Reset Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11629
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11634
C1474
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11635
Backup Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11636
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Battery Discharge Protection
Relay, Lighting > Component Information > Locations
Battery Discharge Protection Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Battery Discharge Protection
Relay, Lighting > Component Information > Locations > Page 11640
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The battery savar relay is part of the central junction box (CJB) and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Courtesy Lamp Relay: Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
The interior lamp relay is located in the instrument cluster and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Locations Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11648
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11649
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Locations Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Ignition Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11650
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
C1359
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11653
C1171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp
Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11656
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11657
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Ignition
Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Headlamp Relay > Page 11658
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11662
C2241
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11663
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11664
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11668
C2047
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11669
Hazard Flasher Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11670
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11674
C2242
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11675
High Beam Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11676
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Horn Relay: Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 11680
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The horn relay is part of the central junction box (CJB) and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Interior Lighting Relay: Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
The interior lamp relay is located in the instrument cluster and is Not Serviceable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11688
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
C2244
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11691
C2245
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11694
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11695
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Reset Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11696
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11701
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
C2240
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 11704
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 11707
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 11708
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 11709
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11713
C2047
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11714
Turn Signal Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
LIGHT SENSOR
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 11720
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Remove the light sensor and bezel as an assembly from the defroster grille.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 screws and the light sensor.
Navigator
3. Remove the defroster grille. 4. Remove the 2 screws and the light sensor.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations
View 151-6 (Transmission - 4R75E Without Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11724
View 151-7 (Transmission - 4R75E With Four-wheel Drive)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11725
C167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-10 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11729
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11730
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted
on the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired
as follows:
- BPP switch is hardwired to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle
brake pedal is applied.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module, Lighting Control Module
(LCM), or Rear Electronic Module (REM), the BPP signal is then broadcast over the network to be
received by the PCM.
- BPP switch is hardwired to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) traction control/stability assist
module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch input along with other ABS inputs and
generates an output called the driver brake application (DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent
to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11731
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
STOPLAMP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the self-locking pin. 3. Remove
the stoplamp switch from the brake booster push rod and the brake pedal assembly. 4. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
View 151-30 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11736
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11737
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11738
View 151-31 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11739
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch
C479
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11742
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11743
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11744
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Ajar Switch > Page 11745
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 11746
Door Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door lock actuator. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11750
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11751
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11755
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11756
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11757
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11758
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11762
Headlamp Switch: Diagrams
C205a
C205b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11763
C205c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps > Page 11766
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps > Page 11767
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Main Light Switch, Interior Lamps
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Light Switch, Exterior Lamps > Page 11768
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11769
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP SWITCH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11770
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. CAUTION: Cover the end of the tool with tape to prevent damage to the trim panel.
NOTE: Use a thin-bladed tool to remove the headlamp switch bezel assembly.
Remove the headlamp switch and bezel assembly. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
Navigator
2. Remove the instrument panel finish panel.
3. NOTE: Release the tabs to remove the headlamp switch.
Remove the 2 screws and the headlamp switch.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Interior Light Switch: Service and Repair
INTERIOR LAMP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. Remove the interior lamp switch.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Rotate the interior lamp switch one-quarter turn counterclockwise and remove.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11777
Turn Signal Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11778
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 11781
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 11782
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Turn Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 11783
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 11784
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11785
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch Removal and Installation
Steering Column
Steering Column
1. Remove the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Lower tilt release handle to access the second screw.
Remove the lower steering column shroud. ^
Remove the screws.
3. NOTE: The screw is located behind the multi-function switch.
Remove the screw and the upper steering column shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11786
4. Remove the bolt, push the release and raise the switch.
5. NOTE: A small screwdriver will be required to depress the connector release tab on connector
number 2.
Remove the multi-function switch. ^
Disconnect the 3 multi-function switch electrical connectors.
^ Remove the switch.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Tail Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11791
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11792
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11793
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11794
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11795
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11796
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11797
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11798
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11799
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11800
Tail Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11801
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11802
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11803
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11804
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11805
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11806
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11807
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11808
Tail Lamp: Connector Views
C412
C415
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11809
Tail Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11810
92-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11811
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Trailer Lamps: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11816
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11817
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11818
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11819
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11820
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11821
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11822
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11823
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11824
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11825
Trailer Lamps: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11826
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11827
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11828
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11829
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11830
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11831
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11832
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11833
Trailer Lamps: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11834
95-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11835
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Trailer Lamps: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Verify the exterior lighting system of the vehicle is operating
correctly. If not, refer to the appropriate pinpoint test. See: Pinpoint Tests 3. Visually inspect the
following for obvious signs of electrical damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Central junction box (CJB) fuse(s): 10 (20A) (trailer tow parking lamps relay, trailer tow reversing lamps relay)
- 13 (10A) (trailer tow battery charge relay coil)
- 29 (30A) (trailer tow electric brake controller)
- 36 (10A) (trailer tow RH stop/turn lamp)
- 42 (10A) (trailer tow LH stop/turn lamp)
- 106 (30A) (trailer tow battery charge relay)
- Circuitry
- Trailer
- Trailer tow battery charge relay
- Trailer tow parking lamps relay
- Trailer tow reversing lamps relay
- Trailer tow electric brake controller
- CJB
4. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step. 5. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom and
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11838
Trailer Lamps: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11839
Trailer Lamps: Pinpoint Tests
Test V: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST V: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
V1
Normal Operation
Ground for the trailer tow lamps is provided through circuit 206 (WH).
Possible Causes
- Circuit 206 (WH) open
- Trailer
Test W: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - RH Trailer Turn/Stop Lamp
PINPOINT TEST W: THE INDIVIDUAL TRAILER LAMP IS INOPERATIVE - RH TRAILER
TURN/STOP LAMP
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11840
W1-W2
Normal Operation
Voltage for the trailer tow RH turn/stop lamp is provided by the central junction box (CJB) fuse 36
(10A) through circuit 64 (DG).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 64 (DG) open
- Trailer
- CJB
Test X: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - LH Trailer Turn/Stop Lamp
PINPOINT TEST X: THE INDIVIDUAL TRAILER LAMP IS INOPERATIVE - LH TRAILER
TURN/STOP LAMP
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11841
X1-X2
Normal Operation
Voltage for the trailer tow LH turn/stop lamp is provided by the central junction box (CJB) fuse 42
(10A) through circuit 52 (YE).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 52 (YE) open
- Trailer
- CJB
Test Y: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Parking Lamps
PINPOINT TEST Y: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER PARKING LAMPS
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11842
Y1-Y4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11843
Y4-Y6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11844
Y7
Normal Operation
Voltage for the trailer tow parking lamps relay coil is supplied through circuit 14 (BN) when the
vehicle parking lamps are on. Ground for the trailer tow parking lamps relay coil is supplied through
circuit 57 (BK). Voltage for the trailer tow parking lamps relay supply is sent by the central junction
box (CJB) fuse 10 (20A). When the trailer tow parking lamps relay is energized, voltage is routed to
the trailer through circuit 962 (BN/WH).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 14 (BN) open
- Circuit 57 (BK) open
- Circuit 962 (BN/WH) open
- Trailer
- Trailer tow parking lamps relay
- CJB
Test Z: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Reversing Lamps
PINPOINT TEST Z: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER REVERSING LAMPS
Z1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11845
Z1-Z3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11846
Z3-Z4
Normal Operation
The trailer tow reversing lamps relay is integral to the central junction box (CJB). Voltage for the
trailer tow reversing lamps relay coil is supplied through circuit 140 (BK/PK) when the vehicle
reversing lamps are on. Ground for the trailer tow reversing lamps relay coil is supplied through
circuit 57 (BK). Voltage for the trailer tow reversing lamps relay supply is sent by the CJB fuse 10
(20A). When the trailer tow reversing lamps relay is energized, voltage is routed to the trailer
through circuit 963 (BK/LG).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 140 (BK/PK) open
- Circuit 57 (BK) open
- Circuit 963 (BK/LG) open
- Trailer
- CJB
Tests AA: The Trailer Lamps Are On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST AA: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11847
AA1-AA4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11848
AA4 Continued
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Parking Lamps
When the trailer tow parking lamps relay is energized, the voltage is routed to the trailer through
circuit 962 (BN/WH).
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Reversing Lamps
The trailer tow reversing lamps relay is integral to the central junction box (CJB). When the trailer
tow reversing lamps relay is energized, voltage is routed to the trailer through circuit 963 (BK/LG).
Possible Causes
- Circuit 962 (BN/WH) short to voltage
- Circuit 963 (BK/LG) short to voltage
- Trailer tow parking lamps relay
- Trailer
- CJB
Tests AB: The Trailer Battery Charging Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST AB: THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGING IS INOPERATIVE
AB1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11849
AB1-AB2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11850
AB3-AB5
Normal Operation
Voltage for the trailer tow battery charge relay coil is supplied by the central junction box (CJB) fuse
13 (10A) when the ignition switch is in the RUN position. Ground for the trailer tow battery charge
relay coil is supplied through circuit 57 (BK). Voltage for the trailer tow battery charge relay supply
is supplied by the CJB fuse 106 (30A). When the trailer tow battery charge relay is energized,
voltage is routed to the trailer through circuit 49 (OG).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 49 (OG) open
- Circuit 57 (BK) open
- Trailer tow battery charge relay
- Trailer
- CJB
Tests AC: The Trailer Electric Brakes Do Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST AC: THE TRAILER ELECTRIC BRAKES DO NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11851
AC1-AC2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11852
AC2-AC4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11853
AC5-AC6
Normal Operation
Voltage for the trailer tow electric brake controller is supplied by the central junction box (CJB) fuse
29 (30A) through circuit 50 (RD). Ground for the trailer tow electric brake controller coil is supplied
through circuit 206 (WH). Voltage input from the stoplamp switch is supplied through circuit 511
(LG). When the parking lamps are on, voltage for the trailer tow electric brake controller illumination
is supplied through circuit 14 (BN). Voltage output from the trailer tow electric brake controller
voltage to the trailer is sent through circuit 43 (DB).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit 14 (BN) open
- Circuit 43 (DB) open or short to ground
- Circuit 50 (RD) open
- Circuit 206 (WH) open
- Circuit 511 (LG) open
- Trailer tow electric brake controller
- Trailer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
11854
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11859
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Trailer Tow
Relay, Parking Lamp
C2240
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Trailer Tow
Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 11862
C2110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 11865
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 11866
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 11867
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front
C1023
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11873
C4032
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11874
C1043
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11875
C4035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 11876
Turn Signal Lamp: Service and Repair
SIDE TURN SIGNAL LAMP - SIGNAL MIRROR
Removal and Installation
1. Release the 2 tabs and remove the mirror glass.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 11877
2. CAUTION: Take care not to break the tabs. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
damage to the mirror.
Slide the lamp assembly away from the vehicle, release the tabs and remove the signal mirror lamp
assembly. Separate the bulb holders from the lamp assembly.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11881
C2047
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11882
Turn Signal Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11883
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11887
Turn Signal Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11888
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 11891
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 11892
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Turn Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 11893
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 11894
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 11895
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch Removal and Installation
Steering Column
Steering Column
1. Remove the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Lower tilt release handle to access the second screw.
Remove the lower steering column shroud. ^
Remove the screws.
3. NOTE: The screw is located behind the multi-function switch.
Remove the screw and the upper steering column shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 11896
4. Remove the bolt, push the release and raise the switch.
5. NOTE: A small screwdriver will be required to depress the connector release tab on connector
number 2.
Remove the multi-function switch. ^
Disconnect the 3 multi-function switch electrical connectors.
^ Remove the switch.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Vanity Mirror Lamp,
Left
C907
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Vanity Mirror Lamp,
Left > Page 11901
C906
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 11907
C2021
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 11908
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 11909
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 11914
C2021
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 11915
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 11916
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay
Power Window Relay: Locations Accessory Delay Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay > Page 11921
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The accessory delay relay is located in the central junction box, in the engine compartment, RH
side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay > Page 11922
Power Window Relay: Locations Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay > Page 11923
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
The quarter window open relay is located in the auxiliary relay box 2, behind trim panel, in loading
space, RH side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay > Page 11924
Power Window Relay: Locations Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Delay Relay > Page 11925
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
The quarter window close relay is located in the auxiliary relay box 2, behind trim panel, in loading
space, RH side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Quarter Window Open Relay
C4175
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 11928
C4176
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 11931
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 11932
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 11933
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11939
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11940
View 151-30 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11941
View 151-31 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11942
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
C504a
C504b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11945
C3193a
C3193b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11946
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Window Adjust Switch, Left Rear
C701
C717
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11947
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Window Adjust Switch, Right Rear
C801
C819
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11948
C624
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11949
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Quarter Window Switch
C998
C999
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11952
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11953
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11954
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Quarter Window Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11955
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11956
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11957
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11958
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11959
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11960
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
WINDOW CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
Navigator front
1. Lift up on the center console armrest.
2. Remove the center console window control switch panel.
- Remove the pin-type retainer.
3. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the window control switch.
- Release the locking tabs.
Expedition front and Expedition passenger rear
NOTE: Driver side Expedition shown, all others similar.
4. Remove the window control switch panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11961
5. Disconnect the electrical connector(s) and remove the window control switch.
- Release the locking tabs.
Navigator passenger rear
6. Remove the rear door trim panel. 7. Remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
All vehicles
8. To install, reverse removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front > Page 11968
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
Front Door Window Motor: Diagrams Left Front
C518
C540
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 11971
C608
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Quarter Window Motor > Component
Information > Locations > LH Side Rear
View 151-19 (Left Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Quarter Window Motor > Component
Information > Locations > LH Side Rear > Page 11976
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Quarter Window Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > LH Side Rear
C4047
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Quarter Window Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams > LH Side Rear > Page 11979
C4090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Accessory Delay Relay
Power Window Relay: Locations Accessory Delay Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Accessory Delay Relay > Page 11984
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
The accessory delay relay is located in the central junction box, in the engine compartment, RH
side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Accessory Delay Relay > Page 11985
Power Window Relay: Locations Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Accessory Delay Relay > Page 11986
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
The quarter window open relay is located in the auxiliary relay box 2, behind trim panel, in loading
space, RH side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Accessory Delay Relay > Page 11987
Power Window Relay: Locations Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Accessory Delay Relay > Page 11988
View 151-21 (Right Rear)
The quarter window close relay is located in the auxiliary relay box 2, behind trim panel, in loading
space, RH side.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Diagrams >
Quarter Window Open Relay
C4175
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Diagrams >
Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 11991
C4176
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 11994
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 11995
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 11996
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch
View 151-28 (Driver Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12001
View 151-29 (Passenger Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12002
View 151-30 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12003
View 151-31 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12004
View 151-23 (Roof)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
C504a
C504b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12007
C3193a
C3193b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12008
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Window Adjust Switch, Left Rear
C701
C717
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12009
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Window Adjust Switch, Right Rear
C801
C819
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12010
C624
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12011
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Quarter Window Switch
C998
C999
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12014
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12016
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Quarter Window Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12017
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12018
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12019
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12020
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 12021
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 12022
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
WINDOW CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
Navigator front
1. Lift up on the center console armrest.
2. Remove the center console window control switch panel.
- Remove the pin-type retainer.
3. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the window control switch.
- Release the locking tabs.
Expedition front and Expedition passenger rear
NOTE: Driver side Expedition shown, all others similar.
4. Remove the window control switch panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 12023
5. Disconnect the electrical connector(s) and remove the window control switch.
- Release the locking tabs.
Navigator passenger rear
6. Remove the rear door trim panel. 7. Remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
All vehicles
8. To install, reverse removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Frame > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Door Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View
Window Frame: Service and Repair Front Door Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View
FRONT DOOR GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Frame > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Door Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View > Page 12028
Window Frame: Service and Repair Front Door Glass Top Run
FRONT DOOR GLASS TOP RUN
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door window glass.
2. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
3. Remove the front door glass channel bolt and front door glass top run.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Frame > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Door Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View > Page 12029
Window Frame: Service and Repair Rear Door Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View
REAR DOOR GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Frame > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Door Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View > Page 12030
Window Frame: Service and Repair Rear Door Glass Top Run
REAR DOOR GLASS TOP RUN
Removal and Installation
1. Lower the rear door window glass. 2. Remove the rear door trim panel.
3. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
4. Remove the rear door glass channel bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
5. Remove the rear door glass top run. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body Front Door Window Scratched
Front Door Window Glass: Customer Interest Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12040
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12041
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12042
Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass:
One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF,
17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: Both Front Doors (Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12043
Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May >
07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched
Front Door Window Glass: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May >
07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12049
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May >
07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12050
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May >
07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12051
Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass:
One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF,
17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: Both Front Doors (Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > 07-10-5 > May >
07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12052
Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page 12053
Front Door Window Glass: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-10-5 Date: 070528
Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page 12054
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page 12055
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page 12056
Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass:
One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF,
17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: Both Front Doors (Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page 12057
Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-10-5 Date: 070528
Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page 12058
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page 12059
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page 12060
The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And
Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Window Glass: > Page 12061
Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 12062
Front Door Window Glass: Service and Repair
FRONT DOOR WINDOW GLASS
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
2. Remove the front door weathershield.
Expedition
3. NOTE: Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
Connect the window control switch.
All vehicles
4. Lower the window glass to access the 2 window glass to regulator bolts.
5. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 12063
6. Remove the front door glass channel bolt and position aside the channel.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
7. Remove the window glass-to-regulator bolts and front door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair
LIFTGATE WINDOW GLASS
Removal and Installation
Window glass assembly
1. Remove the rear window wiper motor.
2. Disconnect the rear window defrost electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 12067
3. CAUTION:
- The liftgate glass must be supported when removing and installing the liftgate assist cylinders.
- Do not extend the socket clips more than 2.0 mm (0.08 in) or failure of the socket can occur.
Disconnect the 2 liftgate glass assist cylinders. 1
Insert a screwdriver blade under the socket clip and lift.
2 Gently pull the socket off the ball stud.
Window glass assembly or hinge assembly
4. Remove the liftgate glass hinge-to-body fasteners and remove the glass.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Window hinge assembly
5. Remove the liftgate glass to hinge fasteners and remove the glass.
- Apply Threadlock 262 to the liftgate glass to hinge fasteners during installation.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Window glass assembly or window hinge assembly
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Quarter Window Glass: Service and Repair
REAR QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
Removal
All vehicles 1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 12071
2. CAUTION: To prevent damage to the coat hanger retainer, use a 3/16-inch flat-blade
screwdriver for this step.
Remove the front and rear coat hooks and lower the headliner over the rear quarter window glass.
Open the access cover.
- Insert a screwdriver into the coat hook slot and turn the screwdriver 90 degrees so that it engages
in the plastic component slot. This will spread the steal attachment clip wings to allow the plastic
component to disengage.
Vehicles with power vent window
3. Remove the bolts and rear quarter window regulator motor.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the rear quarter window regulator.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the audio antenna.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 12072
6. If equipped, remove the air duct.
- Remove the pin-type retainer.
7. CAUTION: Have an assistant hold the rear quarter window glass.
Remove the rear quarter window glass. 1
Remove the nuts.
2 Remove the rear quarter window glass.
8. Remove the excess foam butyl from the window opening.
Installation
All vehicles 1. Apply 8 mm (0.32 in) Foam Butyl of equivalent meeting Ford specification
WSB-M4GB45-A to the rear quarter window glass frame.
- Start at the bottom middle and work around the frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 12073
2. Install the rear quarter window glass.
1 Position the rear quarter window glass.
2 Install the rear quarter window glass nuts.
- Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. If equipped, install the air duct.
- Install the pin-type retainer.
4. Connect the audio antenna.
Vehicles with power vent windows
5. Install the rear quarter window regulator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 12074
6. Install the bolts and rear quarter window regulator motor.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Connect the electrical connector.
All vehicles 7. Position the headliner and install the coat hooks. 8. Install the rear quarter trim
panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Window Glass
Rear Door Window Glass: Service and Repair Rear Door Window Glass
REAR DOOR WINDOW GLASS
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel.
2. Position back the rear door weathershield. 3. Connect the window control switch. 4. Lower the
window glass to access the 2 window glass to regulator bolts.
5. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
6. Remove the rear door glass channel bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Window Glass > Page 12079
7. Remove the window glass to regulator bolts and rear door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Door Window Glass > Page 12080
Rear Door Window Glass: Service and Repair Rear Door Window Glass - Stationary
REAR DOOR WINDOW GLASS - STATIONARY
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door window glass.
2. Remove the rear door exterior glass moulding. 3. Remove the rear door glass top run.
4. Remove the rear door stationary glass screw. 5. Remove the stationary rear door glass.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 12085
2. Remove the screws and the front door speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Remove the front door weathershield.
Expedition
4. NOTE: Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
Connect the window control switch.
All vehicles
5. Lower the window glass to access the 2 window glass-to-regulator bolts.
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 12086
6. NOTE: Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
Disconnect the window control switch.
All vehicles
7. Remove the window glass-to-regulator bolts and front door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: Secure the front window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the front window glass with tape to the front door frame.
9. Position the interior door handle aside.
1 Remove the cable conduit fitting from the carrier assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 12087
2 Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
3 Remove the cable from the door handle.
10. Release the crash sensor harness pin-type retainers.
11. Position the front door window regulator harness aside.
1 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2 Release the pin-type retainers.
12. Remove the front window regulator.
1 Loosen the 2 hanger bolts.
2 Remove the front window regulator bolts and front top run channel bolt. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR - REAR DOOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 12091
2. Remove the rear door speaker.
1 Remove the screws.
2 Disconnect the electrical connector.
3 Remove the speaker.
3. Remove the rear door weathershield. 4. Connect the window control switch. 5. Lower the
window glass to access the 2 window glass-to-regulator bolts. 6. Disconnect the window control
switch.
7. Remove the window glass-to-regulator bolts and rear door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: Secure the rear window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the rear window glass with tape to the front door frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 12092
9. Disconnect the rear door window regulator electrical connectors.
10. Position the interior door handle aside.
- Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
11. Remove the rear door window regulator assembly.
- Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched
Window Seal: Customer Interest Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12101
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12102
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12103
Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass:
One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF,
17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: Both Front Doors (Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12104
Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched
Window Seal: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12110
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12111
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12112
Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass:
One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF,
17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: Both Front Doors (Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 12113
Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
Compressor Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air
TSB 08-21-3
10/27/08
A/C SYSTEM BLOWS WARM/INOPERATIVE - HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES, EXTENDED
IDLE TIMES, TRAILER TOW, DUSTY CLIMATES OR OFF ROAD USE
FORD: 2006 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2006 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with A/C may become inoperative
or blow warm air due to an open electrical circuit of the A/C compressor field coil in high ambient
temperatures, extended idle times, trailer tow, dusty climates or off road use.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the A/C clutch disc, field coil and compressor pulley, using the part numbers below. The
replacing parts are larger in diameter. Failure to use the part numbers listed below together may
cause repeat failure.
1. Recover A/C refrigerant per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley per WSM, Section 412-01.
3. Recharge A/C system per WSM, Section 412-00.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X2, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator 4X2/4X4: Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To
Remove and Install Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
082103A 2006 Expedition 4X4: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace the A/C compressor clutch, field coil and pulley, Includes Time To Remove and Install
Compressor (Do Not Use With 19700A, 19700A4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19D798 28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air > Page
12119
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 08-21-3 > Oct > 08 > A/C - Inoperative/Blows Warm Air > Page
12125
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Reseal
Windshield: Service and Repair Windshield Reseal
WINDSHIELD RESEAL
1. Remove the cowl grille.
2. Remove the A-pillar trim panels.
- Remove the bolt covers and bolts.
3. If equipped, remove the overhead console. 4. If equipped, remove the roof opening panel trim. 5.
Remove the interior rear view mirror.
6. Remove the sun visors.
1 Remove the 4 screws.
2 Remove the 2 sun visor and visor arm clips. If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors.
7. Partially lower the front portion of the headliner near the windshield upper opening and block
with a suitable material. 8. Clean the edge formed by the existing urethane and the glass on the
inside at the top and sides, and outside on the bottom of the windshield with an
alcohol-free cleaner.
9. Cut the urethane applicator tip to specification.
10. NOTE: Use either a high-ratio electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the urethane
with less effort and a continuous bead.
Apply a bead of Urethane Adhesive to the cleaned area.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Reseal > Page 12130
11. NOTE: Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one continuous
bead.
Backfill the urethane application and clean the excess.
12. CAUTION: The urethane adhesive must cure for a minimum of one hour before testing for air or
water leaks.
After the urethane has cured, check the windshield seal for air or water leaks through the urethane
adhesive bead and add urethane adhesive as necessary.
13. Install the headliner.
14. Install the sun visors.
1 Position the sun visors.
2 Install the 4 screws. If equipped, connect the electrical connectors.
15. Install the interior rear view mirror. 16. If equipped, install the roof opening panel trim. 17. If
equipped, install the overhead console. 18. Install the A-pillar trim panels.
- Install the bolts and covers.
19. Install the cowl grille. 20. Clean the interior and exterior of the windshield glass with an
alcohol-free cleaner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Reseal > Page 12131
Windshield: Service and Repair Windshield Glass
WINDSHIELD GLASS
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Reseal > Page 12132
Removal
WARNING: To prevent glass splinters from entering eyes or cutting hands, wear safety glasses
and heavy gloves when cutting glass from the vehicle.
1. Remove the cowl grille.
2. Remove the A-pillar trim panels.
- Remove the bolt covers and bolts.
3. If equipped, remove the overhead console. 4. Remove the interior rear view mirror.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Reseal > Page 12133
5. Remove the sun visors.
1 Remove the 4 screws.
2 Remove the 2 sun visor and visor arm clips. If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors.
6. Lower the front portion of the headliner.
7. Remove the windshield side mouldings.
- Pull out starting at the top corner.
8. Remove the upper windshield weatherstrip.
- Pull out starting at the corner.
9. Mark the outside of the windshield glass with a wax pencil to avoid damaging the glass stops
when cutting the urethane.
10. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt and foreign material from the pinch weld.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Reseal > Page 12134
11. CAUTION: Care must be taken to avoid scratching the pinchweld.
NOTE: Lubricate the urethane adhesive with water to aid the special tool while cutting.
Using the special tool, cut the urethane adhesive from the windshield glass. Insert the blade into the urethane at the top middle of the glass and work toward the top corners.
- Insert the blade at the top corners and work down each side of the glass toward the bottom.
12. CAUTION: Pump special tool 164-R2459 or equivalent slowly as cowl adhesive is cut to avoid
breaking glass.
Using the special tool, distance the windshield from the body.
13. NOTE: Removing the windshield glass requires an assistant.
Using the special tool, cut the remaining urethane adhesive and remove the windshield glass.
14. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt and foreign material from the pinch weld.
Installation
CAUTION: Do not drive the vehicle after installing windshield glass until the urethane adhesive has
cured. Inadequate curing of the urethane adhesive adversely affects the strength of the urethane
adhesive bond.
1. Dry-fit the windshield glass by centering it side-to-side and by adjusting the setting blocks (if
equipped) to get the correct position of the part top
to bottom. Make the alignment marks with tape or non-staining grease pencil on both the glass and
the vehicle body.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Reseal > Page 12135
2. CAUTION: Care must be taken to avoid scratching the pinch weld.
Trim the remaining urethane adhesive on the pinch weld to within specification. The old urethane surface should be smooth and free of cuts and contamination.
3. If reinstalling the original windshield, remove excess urethane adhesive from the windshield
glass. 4. If installing a new windshield glass, clean the inside of the glass surface with an
alcohol-free cleaner to make sure the ceramic-coated area is clean.
5. CAUTION: Be sure to use the same brand and cure-rate products for the adhesive and primer.
Do not mix different brands of urethane
and primer. Refer to the Material Chart in this procedure.
NOTE: Sika uses the same black primer for the glass and pinch weld area.
If installing a new windshield glass, apply urethane glass primer according to manufacturer's
instructions. Allow at least 6 minutes to dry.
6. Install the upper windshield weatherstrip.
7. Cut the urethane applicator tip to specification.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Reseal > Page 12136
8. CAUTION: Do not drive the vehicle after installing windshield glass until the urethane adhesive
has cured. Inadequate curing of the
urethane adhesive adversely affects the strength of the urethane adhesive bond.
Apply a bead of Urethane Adhesive to the pinch weld just outside the foam butyl dam over the top
of the existing urethane bed.
9. CAUTION: Open the windows to prevent the windshield glass from being pushed out by air
pressure if a door is closed.
Using the alignment marks, install the windshield glass.
10. Install the windshield side mouldings.
NOTE: Be sure the moldings seat completely.
11. Install the headliner. 12. Install the interior rear view mirror. 13. Install the overhead console.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Reseal > Page 12137
14. Install the A-pillar trim panels.
- Install the bolts and covers.
15. Install the sun visors.
1 Position the sun visors.
2 Install the 4 screws. If equipped, connect the electrical connectors.
16. Install the cowl grille. 17. Run the blower motor on defrost HIGH to check for glass that may
have fallen into the defroster vents.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12143
C138
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12147
Windshield Washer Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12148
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12149
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Blade Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Climate Control System)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Blade Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12155
C2323
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12159
Wiper Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12160
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12161
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12162
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 12163
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 12167
C138
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 12171
C1357
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Pump: Service and Repair
WINDSHIELD WASHER PUMP AND RESERVOIR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Remove the windshield washer reservoir screws.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. NOTE: Windshield washer fluid should be collected in a container after the windshield washer
hoses are disconnected.
Disconnect the windshield washer hoses.
4. Remove the windshield washer reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 12175
5. Remove the windshield washer pump if necessary.
6. CAUTION: Do not operate the windshield washer pump prior to filling the windshield washer
reservoir.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Fill the windshield washer reservoir with windshield washer concentrate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Service and Repair
WINDSHIELD WASHER PUMP AND RESERVOIR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Remove the windshield washer reservoir screws.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. NOTE: Windshield washer fluid should be collected in a container after the windshield washer
hoses are disconnected.
Disconnect the windshield washer hoses.
4. Remove the windshield washer reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 12179
5. Remove the windshield washer pump if necessary.
6. CAUTION: Do not operate the windshield washer pump prior to filling the windshield washer
reservoir.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Fill the windshield washer reservoir with windshield washer concentrate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 12183
Windshield Washer Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 12184
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 12185
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 12186
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 12187
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments > Windshield
Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment
Wiper Arm: Adjustments Windshield Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADE AND PIVOT ARM ADJUSTMENT
1. Cycle and park the windshield wipers.
2. Verify the distance between the outer tip of the (1) RH windshield wiper blade and the (3) bottom
of the windshield glass and between the outer tip
of the (2) LH windshield wiper blade and the (3) bottom of the windshield glass are within
specifications.
3. If the distance is not within specification, remove the windshield wiper pivot arm and reposition to
specification.
1 Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
2 Remove the nut.
4. Tighten the windshield wiper pivot arm nuts to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments > Windshield
Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment > Page 12192
Wiper Arm: Adjustments Rear Window Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment
REAR WINDOW WIPER BLADE AND PIVOT ARM ADJUSTMENT
1. Cycle and park the rear window wiper pivot arm and blade.
2. Check the rear window wiper park measurement. If not within specification, the rear window
wiper pivot arm will need to be removed.
3. CAUTION: Use a shop towel or similar device to protect the vehicle finish when carrying out the
procedure.
Remove the rear window wiper pivot arm. 1
Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
2 Remove the nut.
4. NOTE: This step makes sure that the wiper motor is in the PARK position.
Turn the rear window wiper switch ON and allow the motor to operate for at least one cycle. Turn
the rear window wiper switch to OFF.
5. Install the rear window wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
1 Position the wiper pivot arm within specification.
2 Tighten the nut to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
3 Install the cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Windshield Wiper
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Pivot Arm - Windshield Wiper
WIPER PIVOT ARM - WINDSHIELD WIPER
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The windshield wiper pivot arms must be in the highest position to remove them.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. 2. Turn the windshield wiper on. 3. Stop the
windshield wiper pivot arms at the highest position by turning the ignition switch OFF.
4. Remove the windshield wiper pivot arm.
1 Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
2 Remove the nut.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Adjust the windshield wiper pivot arms.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Windshield Wiper > Page 12195
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear
WIPER PIVOT ARM - REAR
Removal
1. CAUTION: Use a shop towel or similar device to protect the vehicle finish when carrying out the
procedure.
Remove the rear window wiper pivot arm. 1
Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
2 Remove the nut.
Installation
1. NOTE: This step makes sure that the wiper motor is in the PARK position.
Turn the rear window wiper switch ON and allow the motor to operate for at least one cycle. Turn
the rear window wiper switch to OFF.
2. Install the rear window wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
1 Position the wiper pivot arm within specification.
2 Tighten the nut to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
3 Install the cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Windshield Wiper > Page 12196
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper and Washer System - Exploded View
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM - EXPLODED VIEW
Wiper And Washer System - Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Windshield Wiper > Page 12197
Wiper And Washer System - Rear
Removal And Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Adjustments >
Windshield Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment
Wiper Blade: Adjustments Windshield Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADE AND PIVOT ARM ADJUSTMENT
1. Cycle and park the windshield wipers.
2. Verify the distance between the outer tip of the (1) RH windshield wiper blade and the (3) bottom
of the windshield glass and between the outer tip
of the (2) LH windshield wiper blade and the (3) bottom of the windshield glass are within
specifications.
3. If the distance is not within specification, remove the windshield wiper pivot arm and reposition to
specification.
1 Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
2 Remove the nut.
4. Tighten the windshield wiper pivot arm nuts to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Adjustments >
Windshield Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment > Page 12202
Wiper Blade: Adjustments Rear Window Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment
REAR WINDOW WIPER BLADE AND PIVOT ARM ADJUSTMENT
1. Cycle and park the rear window wiper pivot arm and blade.
2. Check the rear window wiper park measurement. If not within specification, the rear window
wiper pivot arm will need to be removed.
3. CAUTION: Use a shop towel or similar device to protect the vehicle finish when carrying out the
procedure.
Remove the rear window wiper pivot arm. 1
Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
2 Remove the nut.
4. NOTE: This step makes sure that the wiper motor is in the PARK position.
Turn the rear window wiper switch ON and allow the motor to operate for at least one cycle. Turn
the rear window wiper switch to OFF.
5. Install the rear window wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
1 Position the wiper pivot arm within specification.
2 Tighten the nut to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
3 Install the cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Climate Control System)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 12206
C2323
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 05S40S2 Date: 061019
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12215
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12216
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED? Yes. OASIS was activated by November 9, 2005
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? Yes
Available through the website as of November 11, 2005. Owner names and addresses were made
available November 28, 2005.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
Related damage claims are not approved for this program.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
This repair will require no additional labor time to complete. Claims submitted with "MT" labor will
not be accepted for reimbursement.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ For Labor Operation 05S40C, claim grease as miscellaneous expense code "OTHER" - for the
amount of $0.10 per vehicle.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12217
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12218
LABOR ALLOWANCES (REMINDER: Only one labor operation will be accepted for each VIN.)
[NEW!] PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
[NEW!] PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Affected Wiper Motors that were replaced are subject to random return to the Ford Warranty Parts
Analysis Center (WPAC) for supplier analysis. Refer to your daily PEARS (Parts Entry and Return
System) register for part disposition and return instructions.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12219
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
EXCESS STOCK RETURN
Excess stock returned for credit must have been purchased from Ford Customer Service Division
in accordance with Policy Procedure Bulletin 4000.
DEALER SORT/INSPECTION OF PARTS INVENTORY
Dealers must inspect all wiper motor inventories with part numbers shown below. Wiper motors
with a package label date of 8/26/05 through 10/21/05 should be returned to Ford. Those with an
earlier or later packaging date are okay for use. For those found within the suspect date range, file
a DOES II defective parts claim and include the information shown below.
^ Shipper Number: FSA 05S40
^ Comments: Wiper Motor Return
^ Return Reason Code: CD
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves inspecting the wiper motor manufacture code, then it necessary, inspecting
for the presence of grease under the gear cover. Based on your inspection,
^ the vehicle may be reassembled and released, or
^ the wiper motor assembly will be replaced, or
^ [NEW] grease will be applied to the metal worm and plastic ring gears.
INSPECTION
The manufacture code is laser etched onto the cylindrical wiper motor housing. The code consists
of two (2) lines of numbers. One line shows the wiper motor assembly engineering part number.
The other line shows the date and time of manufacture, the assembly line it was built on (N for
north or S for south) then the voltage of the motor.
The wiper motor assemblies that require additional inspection for the presence of grease on the
gears were built from 8-26-05 through 10-10-05 on the south assembly line. Any motor built before
or after these dates, or built on the north assembly line, requires no additional inspection and the
vehicle can be immediately released. See Figure 1.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12220
In some instances, the laser etching will be difficult to read. For these instances, the wiper motor
gear cover must be removed to inspect for the presence of grease on the gear assemblies. The
amount of grease will vary from motor to motor. If ANY grease is present on the worm or ring gear
teeth, that wiper motor assembly requires no further service and the vehicle can be reassembled.
In most cases, the etching can be viewed with minimal removal of parts. Generally, the left wiper
arm and left cowl panel grille have to be removed to view the motor and manufacture code.
Refer to the appropriate disassembly procedure for the vehicle being inspected. Then after
accessing the manufacture code, refer to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
ESCAPE, MARINER, ESCAPE HYBRID, MARINER HYBRID
NOTE:
All Escape, Mariner, Escape Hybrid and Mariner Hybrid vehicles have wiper motor assemblies that
were built on the south assembly line. Therefore, it is only necessary to inspect the manufacture
date code.
1. Remove the left cowl panel grille plastic pin-type retainers from along the front of the panel.
2. Carefully lift the left cowl panel to enable viewing of the wiper motor assembly and note the
manufacture DATE code on the motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small label
affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
3. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
E-SERIES
1. Remove the left wiper arm by lifting the arm slightly and releasing the lock tab, then removing
the arm off of the shaft.
2. Remove the left cowl grille panel retainer screws, then remove the panel.
3.
Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
4. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
EXPEDITION, NAVIGATOR
1. Park the wipers in the highest position on the glass.
2. Lift the wiper arm nut cover. Remove the retaining nut and lift the arm off of the shaft.
3. Position aside the cowl grille panel seal.
4. Remove the pin-type retainer from the far left end of the panel, then lift the panel, disconnect the
washer hose and remove the panel from the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12221
vehicle.
5. Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
6. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
EXPLORER, MOUNTAINEER
1. Remove both wiper arms by lifting the arms slightly and releasing the lock tabs, then remove the
arms off of the shafts.
2. Remove the passenger side, then the driver side cowl grille panels.
3.
Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
4. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
F-150, MARK LT
1. Remove the wiper arms by releasing the lock tabs and lifting the arms off of the shafts.
2. Remove the cowl grille panel plastic pin-type retainers (one per panel located near the fenders).
3.
CAUTION: To avoid breaking the retainer hooks on the cowl grille panel, do not pull on the rear of
the panel.
A) Remove the left (driver side) cowl grille panel, then the right (passenger side) panel.
B) Release the FRONT EDGE of the panel as follows:
^ Starting at the center of the vehicle, depress the forward tab and press upward on the forward
edge of the panel to release it from the cowl.
^ Continuing outward from the center of the vehicle, depress the remaining forward tabs and
release the rest of the panel from the cowl.
C) Release the REAR EDGE of the panel as follows:
^ Starting at the left fender, press down on the rear edge of the panel to release the retaining hook,
then lightly pull the front edge of the panel forward.
^ Continuing toward the center of the vehicle, release the remaining hooks by pressing the panel
down while gently pulling the panel forward.
D) Disconnect the windshield washer hose and remove the cowl grille panel from the vehicle.
4. Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
5. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
RANGER
1. Open the hood and locate the wiper motor.
2. Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
3. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
TAURUS
1. Park the wipers in the highest position on the glass.
2. Remove the wiper arm nut covers.
3. Remove the nuts then pull the wiper arms up off of the shafts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12222
4. Remove the cowl grille panel clips.
5. Remove the passenger side cowl grille panel, then the driver side panel.
6. Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
7. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
INSPECTION RESULTS
1. If the manufacture code cannot be read (even after removing the label), refer to Gear Cover
Removal and Inspection in this Attachment III.
2. The wiper motor assembly does not require additional inspection if it was built:
a) anytime on the north assembly line, or
b) before 8-26-05 or after 10-10-05 on the south assembly line. Reassemble and release the
vehicle.
3. The wiper motor assembly should be inspected further only if it was built:
a) from 8-26-05 through 10-10-05 on the south assembly line.
Refer to Gear Cover Removal and Inspection in this Attachment III.
GEAR COVER REMOVAL AND INSPECTION
1.
CAUTION: Use extreme care when bending the locking tabs back to remove the gear cover from
the wiper motor. The cover is constructed with a glass reinforced resin which makes the tabs less
flexible. Bend the tabs only far enough to release them from the lugs. Bending the tabs an
excessive amount could cause them to break.
Using a small pocket screwdriver placed under the lock tab, rotate the screwdriver to disengage the
tab from the lug on the motor housing. Disengage all five (5) tabs in the order indicated in Figure 2.
2. CAUTION: On Taurus, Escape Mariner, Escape Hybrid, Mariner Hybrid and Ranger vehicles,
the gear cover perimeter is sealed with silicone. Pry up around the perimeter of the gear cover to
break the sealant from the cover.
CAUTION:
The gear cover must be squarely lifted oft of the motor housing. Any rocking or sideways motion
may bend the three (3) internal electrical connector clips.
Squarely lift the gear cover off of the motor housing. Discard the covers only on Taurus, Escape,
Mariner, Escape Hybrid, Mariner Hybrid and Ranger vehicles. Retain the cover for reinstallation on
all other affected models. If in the rare event a tab breaks off on of these covers, are a placement
cover, part number 2L2Z-17C476-A, must be ordered.*
[NEW]* Only order a new cover if grease is found and wiper motor assembly replacement is NOT
required. (See Step 3)
[NEW] 3. NOTE: QFP Grease can no longer be ordered. Dealers are to use their supply of grease
on wiper motors which require it. Once the supply
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12223
of grease is exhausted, wiper motors are to be replaced when no grease is found during wiper
motor inspection.
Inspect the worm and ring gears for presence of grease. Any amount of grease is acceptable as
long as there is some grease present on the worm and ring gears. See Figure 3.
^ If grease is present, no further service is required. Refer to Gear Cover Installation for specific
cover installation procedures.
^ If no grease is present, apply a bead of grease, part number QFP, approximately 2-3 mm (1/8 in)
wide and 20 mm (3/4 in) long, to the worm and ring gear mating area, beginning where the worm
gear exits the motor. See Figure 3. The first tube will be shipped to dealers free of charge. DO NOT
USE ANY OTHER GREASE. Then, refer to Gear Cover Installation for detailed gear cover
installation procedures.
^ Refer to Attachment V for OFP Grease MSDS.
^ If grease is unavailable, replace the wiper motor assembly following the procedures in Section
501-16 of the appropriate workshop manual.
GEAR COVER INSTALLATION
NOTE:
A new gear cover, part number 1F2Z-17D532-CA, must be installed on Taurus, Escape, Mariner,
Escape Hybrid, Mariner Hybrid and Ranger vehicles. On all others, reinstall the original cover
unless the locking tabs have been broken, bent or otherwise damaged, in which case, a new cover,
part number 2L2Z-17C476-A, must be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12224
1. Inspect the three (3) internal electrical connector clips. All three (3) clips MUST be aligned
against the plastic terminal holder. If any of the clips are misaligned or touching the motor housing,
they must be straightened and positioned as shown in the illustration. See Figure 4.
2.
NOTE: This step applies only to Taurus, Escape, Mariner, Escape Hybrid, Mariner Hybrid and
Ranger vehicles. For all others, proceed to Step 3.
CAUTION:
Do not use solvents or compressed air to remove the sealant from the motor gear housing. Any
solvent entering the gear cavity may damage the motor. Also, remove all large pieces of sealant
that enter the gear housing cavity during cleaning. Small particles of sealant left in the cavity are
acceptable.
NOTE:
It is not necessary to remove the existing sealant attached to the vertical surfaces inside the gear
housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12225
Remove the existing sealant from the top surface of the gear housing and around each of the five
(5) mounting lug areas. To avoid damaging the motor, extra care must be taken when removing
sealant from the area around the internal electrical connector clips. See Figure 5.
3. Verity that the three (3) electrical spade terminals are not bent. It necessary, straighten them so
that they are perpendicular to the cover as illustrated in Figure 6.
4. Make sure that the foam gasket is properly seated in the new cover as shown in Figure 6.
5. NOTE: This step applies only to Taurus, Escape, Mariner, Escape Hybrid, Mariner Hybrid and
Ranger vehicles. For all others, proceed to Step 6.
Make sure that the white cam follower arm is positioned as shown in Figure 6.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12226
6.
IMPORTANT: Position the cover on the gear housing so that each plastic locking tab is outside of
the gear housing cavity and is resting over the mounting lugs. Ensure that the electrical spade
terminals are lined up with the connector clips. See Figure 7.
7. Using two (2) hands, push the gear cover downward onto the gear housing uniformly, to ensure
that the electrical terminals remain in alignment. Push down firmly until all five (5) locking tabs are
latched correctly. See Figure 8.
8.
CAUTION: If any of the locking tabs cannot be correctly latched as shown in Figure 9, contact the
Special Service Support Center for further instructions. DO NOT attempt to remove the cover and
reinstall it.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12227
9. Reassemble the vehicle following the disassembly procedures in reverse order. On Taurus and
Expedition/Navigator vehicles, tighten the wiper arm attaching nuts to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
10.
IMPORTANT: Check for proper wiper motor operation in all speeds, intermittent and wash, then
release the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12228
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12229
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12230
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12231
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12232
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12233
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor Inspection/Replacement > Page 12234
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls for Wiper Motor: > NHTSA05V520000 > Nov > 05 > Recall 05V520000: Wiper Motor Inspection/Repair
Wiper Motor: Recalls Recall 05V520000: Wiper Motor Inspection/Repair
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/E-150 2006 Ford/E-250 2006 Ford/E-350 2006
Ford/E-450 2006 Ford/Escape 2006 Ford/Expedition 2006 Ford/Explorer 2006 Ford/F-150 2006
Ford/Ranger 2006 Ford/Taurus 2006 Lincoln/Mark LT 2006 Lincoln/Navigator 2006
Mercury/Mariner 2006 Mercury/Mountaineer 2006 MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V520000 MFG'S REPORT DATE: November 07, 2005
COMPONENT: Visibility: Windshield Wiper/Washer: Motor
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 199942
SUMMARY: On certain trucks, passenger cars and sport utility vehicles, the windshield wiper motor
may have been produced without grease being applied to the output shaft gear.
CONSEQUENCE: After a period of continuous use on the high speed setting, lack of grease on the
output shaft gear may cause the gear to distort or fracture during operation resulting in a loss of
wiper function. Inoperative wipers under inclement weather conditions could cause a crash due to
impaired visibility.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect the wiper motor for the presence of grease and grease the wiper
motor gears if necessary. The recall began on November 22, 2005. Owners should contact FORD
at 1-800-392-3673 or Lincoln/Mercury at 1-800-521-4140. NOTES: Ford recall No. 05S40.
Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety
Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 05S40S2 Date: 061019
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12244
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12245
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED? Yes. OASIS was activated by November 9, 2005
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? Yes
Available through the website as of November 11, 2005. Owner names and addresses were made
available November 28, 2005.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
Related damage claims are not approved for this program.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
This repair will require no additional labor time to complete. Claims submitted with "MT" labor will
not be accepted for reimbursement.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ For Labor Operation 05S40C, claim grease as miscellaneous expense code "OTHER" - for the
amount of $0.10 per vehicle.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12246
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12247
LABOR ALLOWANCES (REMINDER: Only one labor operation will be accepted for each VIN.)
[NEW!] PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
[NEW!] PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Affected Wiper Motors that were replaced are subject to random return to the Ford Warranty Parts
Analysis Center (WPAC) for supplier analysis. Refer to your daily PEARS (Parts Entry and Return
System) register for part disposition and return instructions.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12248
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
EXCESS STOCK RETURN
Excess stock returned for credit must have been purchased from Ford Customer Service Division
in accordance with Policy Procedure Bulletin 4000.
DEALER SORT/INSPECTION OF PARTS INVENTORY
Dealers must inspect all wiper motor inventories with part numbers shown below. Wiper motors
with a package label date of 8/26/05 through 10/21/05 should be returned to Ford. Those with an
earlier or later packaging date are okay for use. For those found within the suspect date range, file
a DOES II defective parts claim and include the information shown below.
^ Shipper Number: FSA 05S40
^ Comments: Wiper Motor Return
^ Return Reason Code: CD
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves inspecting the wiper motor manufacture code, then it necessary, inspecting
for the presence of grease under the gear cover. Based on your inspection,
^ the vehicle may be reassembled and released, or
^ the wiper motor assembly will be replaced, or
^ [NEW] grease will be applied to the metal worm and plastic ring gears.
INSPECTION
The manufacture code is laser etched onto the cylindrical wiper motor housing. The code consists
of two (2) lines of numbers. One line shows the wiper motor assembly engineering part number.
The other line shows the date and time of manufacture, the assembly line it was built on (N for
north or S for south) then the voltage of the motor.
The wiper motor assemblies that require additional inspection for the presence of grease on the
gears were built from 8-26-05 through 10-10-05 on the south assembly line. Any motor built before
or after these dates, or built on the north assembly line, requires no additional inspection and the
vehicle can be immediately released. See Figure 1.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12249
In some instances, the laser etching will be difficult to read. For these instances, the wiper motor
gear cover must be removed to inspect for the presence of grease on the gear assemblies. The
amount of grease will vary from motor to motor. If ANY grease is present on the worm or ring gear
teeth, that wiper motor assembly requires no further service and the vehicle can be reassembled.
In most cases, the etching can be viewed with minimal removal of parts. Generally, the left wiper
arm and left cowl panel grille have to be removed to view the motor and manufacture code.
Refer to the appropriate disassembly procedure for the vehicle being inspected. Then after
accessing the manufacture code, refer to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
ESCAPE, MARINER, ESCAPE HYBRID, MARINER HYBRID
NOTE:
All Escape, Mariner, Escape Hybrid and Mariner Hybrid vehicles have wiper motor assemblies that
were built on the south assembly line. Therefore, it is only necessary to inspect the manufacture
date code.
1. Remove the left cowl panel grille plastic pin-type retainers from along the front of the panel.
2. Carefully lift the left cowl panel to enable viewing of the wiper motor assembly and note the
manufacture DATE code on the motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small label
affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
3. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
E-SERIES
1. Remove the left wiper arm by lifting the arm slightly and releasing the lock tab, then removing
the arm off of the shaft.
2. Remove the left cowl grille panel retainer screws, then remove the panel.
3.
Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
4. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
EXPEDITION, NAVIGATOR
1. Park the wipers in the highest position on the glass.
2. Lift the wiper arm nut cover. Remove the retaining nut and lift the arm off of the shaft.
3. Position aside the cowl grille panel seal.
4. Remove the pin-type retainer from the far left end of the panel, then lift the panel, disconnect the
washer hose and remove the panel from the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12250
vehicle.
5. Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
6. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
EXPLORER, MOUNTAINEER
1. Remove both wiper arms by lifting the arms slightly and releasing the lock tabs, then remove the
arms off of the shafts.
2. Remove the passenger side, then the driver side cowl grille panels.
3.
Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
4. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
F-150, MARK LT
1. Remove the wiper arms by releasing the lock tabs and lifting the arms off of the shafts.
2. Remove the cowl grille panel plastic pin-type retainers (one per panel located near the fenders).
3.
CAUTION: To avoid breaking the retainer hooks on the cowl grille panel, do not pull on the rear of
the panel.
A) Remove the left (driver side) cowl grille panel, then the right (passenger side) panel.
B) Release the FRONT EDGE of the panel as follows:
^ Starting at the center of the vehicle, depress the forward tab and press upward on the forward
edge of the panel to release it from the cowl.
^ Continuing outward from the center of the vehicle, depress the remaining forward tabs and
release the rest of the panel from the cowl.
C) Release the REAR EDGE of the panel as follows:
^ Starting at the left fender, press down on the rear edge of the panel to release the retaining hook,
then lightly pull the front edge of the panel forward.
^ Continuing toward the center of the vehicle, release the remaining hooks by pressing the panel
down while gently pulling the panel forward.
D) Disconnect the windshield washer hose and remove the cowl grille panel from the vehicle.
4. Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
5. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
RANGER
1. Open the hood and locate the wiper motor.
2. Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
3. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
TAURUS
1. Park the wipers in the highest position on the glass.
2. Remove the wiper arm nut covers.
3. Remove the nuts then pull the wiper arms up off of the shafts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12251
4. Remove the cowl grille panel clips.
5. Remove the passenger side cowl grille panel, then the driver side panel.
6. Note the manufacture code on the wiper motor. If the code cannot be seen AND there is a small
label affixed to the wiper motor cylindrical housing, remove and discard the label. The code may be
under the label.
7. Proceed to Inspection Results in this Attachment III.
INSPECTION RESULTS
1. If the manufacture code cannot be read (even after removing the label), refer to Gear Cover
Removal and Inspection in this Attachment III.
2. The wiper motor assembly does not require additional inspection if it was built:
a) anytime on the north assembly line, or
b) before 8-26-05 or after 10-10-05 on the south assembly line. Reassemble and release the
vehicle.
3. The wiper motor assembly should be inspected further only if it was built:
a) from 8-26-05 through 10-10-05 on the south assembly line.
Refer to Gear Cover Removal and Inspection in this Attachment III.
GEAR COVER REMOVAL AND INSPECTION
1.
CAUTION: Use extreme care when bending the locking tabs back to remove the gear cover from
the wiper motor. The cover is constructed with a glass reinforced resin which makes the tabs less
flexible. Bend the tabs only far enough to release them from the lugs. Bending the tabs an
excessive amount could cause them to break.
Using a small pocket screwdriver placed under the lock tab, rotate the screwdriver to disengage the
tab from the lug on the motor housing. Disengage all five (5) tabs in the order indicated in Figure 2.
2. CAUTION: On Taurus, Escape Mariner, Escape Hybrid, Mariner Hybrid and Ranger vehicles,
the gear cover perimeter is sealed with silicone. Pry up around the perimeter of the gear cover to
break the sealant from the cover.
CAUTION:
The gear cover must be squarely lifted oft of the motor housing. Any rocking or sideways motion
may bend the three (3) internal electrical connector clips.
Squarely lift the gear cover off of the motor housing. Discard the covers only on Taurus, Escape,
Mariner, Escape Hybrid, Mariner Hybrid and Ranger vehicles. Retain the cover for reinstallation on
all other affected models. If in the rare event a tab breaks off on of these covers, are a placement
cover, part number 2L2Z-17C476-A, must be ordered.*
[NEW]* Only order a new cover if grease is found and wiper motor assembly replacement is NOT
required. (See Step 3)
[NEW] 3. NOTE: QFP Grease can no longer be ordered. Dealers are to use their supply of grease
on wiper motors which require it. Once the supply
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12252
of grease is exhausted, wiper motors are to be replaced when no grease is found during wiper
motor inspection.
Inspect the worm and ring gears for presence of grease. Any amount of grease is acceptable as
long as there is some grease present on the worm and ring gears. See Figure 3.
^ If grease is present, no further service is required. Refer to Gear Cover Installation for specific
cover installation procedures.
^ If no grease is present, apply a bead of grease, part number QFP, approximately 2-3 mm (1/8 in)
wide and 20 mm (3/4 in) long, to the worm and ring gear mating area, beginning where the worm
gear exits the motor. See Figure 3. The first tube will be shipped to dealers free of charge. DO NOT
USE ANY OTHER GREASE. Then, refer to Gear Cover Installation for detailed gear cover
installation procedures.
^ Refer to Attachment V for OFP Grease MSDS.
^ If grease is unavailable, replace the wiper motor assembly following the procedures in Section
501-16 of the appropriate workshop manual.
GEAR COVER INSTALLATION
NOTE:
A new gear cover, part number 1F2Z-17D532-CA, must be installed on Taurus, Escape, Mariner,
Escape Hybrid, Mariner Hybrid and Ranger vehicles. On all others, reinstall the original cover
unless the locking tabs have been broken, bent or otherwise damaged, in which case, a new cover,
part number 2L2Z-17C476-A, must be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12253
1. Inspect the three (3) internal electrical connector clips. All three (3) clips MUST be aligned
against the plastic terminal holder. If any of the clips are misaligned or touching the motor housing,
they must be straightened and positioned as shown in the illustration. See Figure 4.
2.
NOTE: This step applies only to Taurus, Escape, Mariner, Escape Hybrid, Mariner Hybrid and
Ranger vehicles. For all others, proceed to Step 3.
CAUTION:
Do not use solvents or compressed air to remove the sealant from the motor gear housing. Any
solvent entering the gear cavity may damage the motor. Also, remove all large pieces of sealant
that enter the gear housing cavity during cleaning. Small particles of sealant left in the cavity are
acceptable.
NOTE:
It is not necessary to remove the existing sealant attached to the vertical surfaces inside the gear
housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12254
Remove the existing sealant from the top surface of the gear housing and around each of the five
(5) mounting lug areas. To avoid damaging the motor, extra care must be taken when removing
sealant from the area around the internal electrical connector clips. See Figure 5.
3. Verity that the three (3) electrical spade terminals are not bent. It necessary, straighten them so
that they are perpendicular to the cover as illustrated in Figure 6.
4. Make sure that the foam gasket is properly seated in the new cover as shown in Figure 6.
5. NOTE: This step applies only to Taurus, Escape, Mariner, Escape Hybrid, Mariner Hybrid and
Ranger vehicles. For all others, proceed to Step 6.
Make sure that the white cam follower arm is positioned as shown in Figure 6.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12255
6.
IMPORTANT: Position the cover on the gear housing so that each plastic locking tab is outside of
the gear housing cavity and is resting over the mounting lugs. Ensure that the electrical spade
terminals are lined up with the connector clips. See Figure 7.
7. Using two (2) hands, push the gear cover downward onto the gear housing uniformly, to ensure
that the electrical terminals remain in alignment. Push down firmly until all five (5) locking tabs are
latched correctly. See Figure 8.
8.
CAUTION: If any of the locking tabs cannot be correctly latched as shown in Figure 9, contact the
Special Service Support Center for further instructions. DO NOT attempt to remove the cover and
reinstall it.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12256
9. Reassemble the vehicle following the disassembly procedures in reverse order. On Taurus and
Expedition/Navigator vehicles, tighten the wiper arm attaching nuts to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
10.
IMPORTANT: Check for proper wiper motor operation in all speeds, intermittent and wash, then
release the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12257
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12258
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12259
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12260
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12261
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12262
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > 05S40S2 > Oct > 06 > Recall - Wiper Motor
Inspection/Replacement > Page 12263
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor: > NHTSA05V520000 > Nov > 05 > Recall 05V520000: Wiper
Motor Inspection/Repair
Wiper Motor: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 05V520000: Wiper Motor Inspection/Repair
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/E-150 2006 Ford/E-250 2006 Ford/E-350 2006
Ford/E-450 2006 Ford/Escape 2006 Ford/Expedition 2006 Ford/Explorer 2006 Ford/F-150 2006
Ford/Ranger 2006 Ford/Taurus 2006 Lincoln/Mark LT 2006 Lincoln/Navigator 2006
Mercury/Mariner 2006 Mercury/Mountaineer 2006 MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V520000 MFG'S REPORT DATE: November 07, 2005
COMPONENT: Visibility: Windshield Wiper/Washer: Motor
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 199942
SUMMARY: On certain trucks, passenger cars and sport utility vehicles, the windshield wiper motor
may have been produced without grease being applied to the output shaft gear.
CONSEQUENCE: After a period of continuous use on the high speed setting, lack of grease on the
output shaft gear may cause the gear to distort or fracture during operation resulting in a loss of
wiper function. Inoperative wipers under inclement weather conditions could cause a crash due to
impaired visibility.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect the wiper motor for the presence of grease and grease the wiper
motor gears if necessary. The recall began on November 22, 2005. Owners should contact FORD
at 1-800-392-3673 or Lincoln/Mercury at 1-800-521-4140. NOTES: Ford recall No. 05S40.
Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety
Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Windshield
Wiper Motor
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Windshield
Wiper Motor > Page 12270
View 151-32 (Liftgate)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Wiper Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (as if the ignition switch were
OFF).
Splices (3)
A dashed line indicates that the splice is not shown completely. A referance is given to the page
where the splice appears in full. It is also listed in the index.
Component Referencing (4)
Each Component on a diagram has a reference to the component location view or the diagram
where it is shown completely. It is located to the right of each component.
Component Names,Notes and Base Part Numbers (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component. Any notes that describe
switch positions or operating conditions follow the name. Descriptions of the internals of the
component are also included here. The diagram where the component appears in full is listed in
the Index. The base part number for a component is listed in parentheses next to or under a
component. These part numbers will appear any place the component name appears in the
publication.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12273
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located to
the right. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Function Identifiers (7)
Some components without internal diagrams use symbols or text to describe the function of a
circuit in a system.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse-/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified.
Fuse and Relay Numbering and Naming
Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, a
prefix precedes the fuse number to facilitate finding the fuse in the Component Location Charts,
e.g. "F 1." precedes Battery Junction Box fuses, and "F2." precedes Central Junction Box fuses.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12274
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. There is also a description of the ground location of
the vehicle and the harness it resides on. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several
components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the components are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12275
C1033
Component and Connector Information
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will help the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the component name and below the connector number. The circuit function charts
are located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component
Location Charts.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing lose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12276
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12277
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12278
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12279
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12280
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12281
Symbols Part 6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12282
Wiper Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12283
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12284
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12285
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring Strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12286
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12287
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12288
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R59O1 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. Insert stripped wire
into the barrel. 8. Holding the wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases. 9.
Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
10. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12289
11. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 12. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 13. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 12290
Wiper Motor: Connector Views
C125
C476
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Windshield Wiper Motor
Wiper Motor: Testing and Inspection Windshield Wiper Motor
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR
CAUTION: Do not handle the windshield wiper motor abusively when diagnosing the wiper
operations. Failure to follow this caution may result in damage to the motor magnets and will make
the windshield wiper motor inoperative. Rough handling of new windshield wiper motors may also
damage the motor magnets.
NOTE:
- Windshield wiper motor component test is carried out to determine if windshield wiper motor and
module are functional and not in default mode. Refer to Principles of Operation. See: Testing and
Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Principles of Operation
- Battery voltage must remain within 10 to 15 VDC to carry out test and keep windshield wiper
motor from entering its software safe mode.
- When connecting the power and ground test leads to the windshield wiper motor terminals, care
must be taken to not short terminals between power and ground, as well as making sure the logic
ground, pin 3, is always securely connected to prevent permanent windshield wiper motor module
damage.
If the windshield wiper motor does not pass any of the following tests, install a new windshield
wiper motor.
Use SABRE Premium Battery and Electrical System Tester 010-00736 or equivalent to test the
windshield wiper motor.
To test the windshield wiper motor, remove the windshield wiper mounting arm and pivot shaft from
the windshield wiper motor.
Disconnect the wiper motor. Connect the (1) green lead from the (2) SABRE to the battery negative
(-) post. Connect the red lead (3) from the SABRE to the wiper motor (4) component side connector
ground and logic ground pins 6 and 3 (3). Connect battery positive cable (5) to windshield wiper
motor (4) component side connector battery and logic positive pins 5 and 8 (5).
Low Speed
Test the LOW SPEED mode by connecting a separate set of test leads from battery ground (-) post
to windshield wiper motor (4) component side pins 9 and 10 (6). When these pins are grounded,
the windshield wiper motor operation should now be in low speed mode.
High Speed
Test the HIGH SPEED mode by connecting a separate set of test leads from battery ground (-)
post to windshield wiper motor (4) component side pins 1, 9 and 10 (7). When these pins are
grounded, the windshield wiper motor operation should now be in high speed mode.
Washer Pump Relay (Integral)
Test the windshield wiper motor internal washer relay function by measuring the voltage between
windshield wiper motor (4) component side pin 7 (8) and ground while grounding the windshield
wiper motor (4) component side pin 12 (9). When wash command input pin 12 is grounded,
measured voltage should read 10 volts or greater.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Windshield Wiper Motor > Page 12293
Wiper Motor: Testing and Inspection Rear Window Wiper Motor
REAR WINDOW WIPER MOTOR
CAUTION: Do not handle the rear window wiper motor abusively when diagnosing the wiper
operations. Failure to follow this caution may result in damage to the motor magnets and will make
the rear window wiper motor inoperative. Rough handling of new rear window wiper motors may
also damage the motor magnets.
NOTE:
- The rear window wiper motor component test is carried out to determine if wiper motor and
module are functional.
- Battery voltage must remain within 10 to 15 VDC to carry out test and keep wiper motor from
entering its software safe mode.
- When connecting the power and ground test leads to the rear wiper motor terminals, care must be
taken to not short terminals between power and ground, as well as making sure the logic ground,
pin 3, is always securely connected to prevent permanent rear window wiper motor module
damage.
If the rear window wiper motor does not pass any of the following tests, install a new rear window
wiper motor.
Use the SABRE Premium Battery and Electrical System Tester 010-00736 or equivalent to test the
rear window wiper motor.
Disconnect the rear window wiper motor. Connect the (1) green lead from the (2) SABRE to the
battery negative (-) post. Connect the red lead (3) from the SABRE to the wiper motor (4)
component side connector ground pins 1 an 2 (3). Connect battery positive cable (5) to wiper motor
(4) component side connector battery and logic positive pins 3 and 4 (5).
On Mode
Test the ON mode by connecting a separate set of test leads from battery ground (-) post to
windshield wiper motor (4) component side pins 6 and 7 (6). When these pins are grounded, the
rear window wiper motor operation should now be in ON mode.
Washer Pump Relay (Integral)
Test the rear window wiper motor internal washer relay function by measuring the voltage between
wiper motor (4) component side pin 5 (7) and ground. When wash command input pin 6 (7) is
grounded, measured voltage should read 10 volts or greater.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper and Washer System - Exploded View
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper and Washer System - Exploded View
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM - EXPLODED VIEW
Wiper And Washer System - Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper and Washer System - Exploded View > Page 12296
Wiper And Washer System - Rear
Removal And Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper and Washer System - Exploded View > Page 12297
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Windshield Wiper Motor
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the mounting arm and pivot shaft.
2. NOTE: Mark the position of the windshield wiper motor crank before it is disconnected.
Disconnect the windshield wiper motor crank. Remove the bolt.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
3. Remove the bolts and the windshield wiper motor.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft-lb).
4. NOTE: The windshield wiper motor crank must be set to the same location for the windshield
wiper mounting arm and pivot shaft to be installed
properly. Refer to Component test.
To install reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper and Washer System - Exploded View > Page 12298
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Rear Window Wiper Motor
REAR WINDOW WIPER MOTOR
Removal
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm.
2. Remove the dust boot cover.
3. Remove the rear window wiper pivot shaft nut and handle.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
4. Open the liftgate glass.
5. Remove the nuts and the rear window striker and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 7. Close the liftgate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper and Washer System - Exploded View > Page 12299
8. If installing a new rear wiper motor, remove the liftgate window glass latch.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
9. Remove the rear window wiper motor.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
Installation
1. If installing a new rear wiper motor, install the liftgate window glass latch.
- Tighten bolts to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. NOTE: An audible click should be heard as the striker engages the latch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper and Washer System - Exploded View > Page 12300
Push the rear window wiper striker and pivot shaft assembly into the wiper motor. The pivot shaft
pin should be aligned with the hole in the motor disc.
3. Install the rear window wiper motor alignment tool. If installing a new rear wiper motor, one is
provided with the motor assembly.
1 Make sure the alignment tool fits over the motor disc and striker assembly.
2 Make sure the alignment tool clips are securely engaged.
4. Install the rear wiper motor.
1 Tighten the bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
2 Connect the electrical connectors.
5. Carefully close the liftgate glass.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper and Washer System - Exploded View > Page 12301
6. Open the liftgate. Install the rear window wiper striker and wiper pivot arm mounting assembly
nuts.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
7. Close the liftgate.
8. Install the rear window wiper pivot shaft nut and handle.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
9. Install the dust boot cover.
10. Install the rear wiper pivot arm. 11. Open the liftgate.
12. Remove the rear window wiper motor aligning tool. 13. Open the liftgate glass. 14. Install the
liftgate trim panel. 15. Test the liftgate and liftgate glass for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > NHTSA05V520000 > Nov > 05 > Recall 05V520000: Wiper Motor Inspection/Repair
Wiper Motor Linkage: Recalls Recall 05V520000: Wiper Motor Inspection/Repair
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/E-150 2006 Ford/E-250 2006 Ford/E-350 2006
Ford/E-450 2006 Ford/Escape 2006 Ford/Expedition 2006 Ford/Explorer 2006 Ford/F-150 2006
Ford/Ranger 2006 Ford/Taurus 2006 Lincoln/Mark LT 2006 Lincoln/Navigator 2006
Mercury/Mariner 2006 Mercury/Mountaineer 2006 MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V520000 MFG'S REPORT DATE: November 07, 2005
COMPONENT: Visibility: Windshield Wiper/Washer: Motor
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 199942
SUMMARY: On certain trucks, passenger cars and sport utility vehicles, the windshield wiper motor
may have been produced without grease being applied to the output shaft gear.
CONSEQUENCE: After a period of continuous use on the high speed setting, lack of grease on the
output shaft gear may cause the gear to distort or fracture during operation resulting in a loss of
wiper function. Inoperative wipers under inclement weather conditions could cause a crash due to
impaired visibility.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect the wiper motor for the presence of grease and grease the wiper
motor gears if necessary. The recall began on November 22, 2005. Owners should contact FORD
at 1-800-392-3673 or Lincoln/Mercury at 1-800-521-4140. NOTES: Ford recall No. 05S40.
Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety
Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > NHTSA05V520000 > Nov > 05 > Recall 05V520000: Wiper Motor
Inspection/Repair
Wiper Motor Linkage: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 05V520000: Wiper Motor
Inspection/Repair
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/E-150 2006 Ford/E-250 2006 Ford/E-350 2006
Ford/E-450 2006 Ford/Escape 2006 Ford/Expedition 2006 Ford/Explorer 2006 Ford/F-150 2006
Ford/Ranger 2006 Ford/Taurus 2006 Lincoln/Mark LT 2006 Lincoln/Navigator 2006
Mercury/Mariner 2006 Mercury/Mountaineer 2006 MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 05V520000 MFG'S REPORT DATE: November 07, 2005
COMPONENT: Visibility: Windshield Wiper/Washer: Motor
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 199942
SUMMARY: On certain trucks, passenger cars and sport utility vehicles, the windshield wiper motor
may have been produced without grease being applied to the output shaft gear.
CONSEQUENCE: After a period of continuous use on the high speed setting, lack of grease on the
output shaft gear may cause the gear to distort or fracture during operation resulting in a loss of
wiper function. Inoperative wipers under inclement weather conditions could cause a crash due to
impaired visibility.
REMEDY: Dealers will inspect the wiper motor for the presence of grease and grease the wiper
motor gears if necessary. The recall began on November 22, 2005. Owners should contact FORD
at 1-800-392-3673 or Lincoln/Mercury at 1-800-521-4140. NOTES: Ford recall No. 05S40.
Customers can also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety
Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor Linkage: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear
Wiper is Inoperative
Wiper Pivot: All Technical Service Bulletins Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative
TSB 07-10-13
05/28/07
REAR WIPER INOPERATIVE
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-10 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2003-2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles, the rear wiper may not return to park
position. In this case, the rear wiper system will attempt to park periodically causing a battery
drain.This concern may be caused by corrosion on the wiper pivot shaft assembly.
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to identify and replace the rear window striker/wiper
pivot shaft assembly.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disengage rear wiper mechanism by partially opening the rear liftgate glass. (Figure 1)
2. Access the rear wiper arm attaching nut. (Figure 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor Linkage: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear
Wiper is Inoperative > Page 12320
3. Use a torque wrench to measure the amount of torque necessary to rotate the wiper arm
throughout the entire travel of the wiper arm. (Figure 3)
a. This must be done while the glass is open so that the wiper mechanism is disengaged from the
motor drive plate.
b. The wiper blade should be in full contact with the glass throughout the entire stroke of the arm.
c. The measurement taken must not exceed 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m) of force when rotated in either
direction.
(1) If the force is greater than 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m), then replace the rear window striker / wiper pivot
shaft assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-16 - Wipers and Washers Removal and
Installation. (Figure 4)
(2) If the rear window striker/wiper pivot shaft assembly is within specification, then follow normal
Workshop Manual diagnostics.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor Linkage: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear
Wiper is Inoperative > Page 12321
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071013A 2003-2007 0.7 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Rear Window Striker/Wiper Pivot Shaft, Includes Time To
Verify Concern (Do Not Use With 40860B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17C426 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor Linkage: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear
Wiper is Inoperative > Page 12327
3. Use a torque wrench to measure the amount of torque necessary to rotate the wiper arm
throughout the entire travel of the wiper arm. (Figure 3)
a. This must be done while the glass is open so that the wiper mechanism is disengaged from the
motor drive plate.
b. The wiper blade should be in full contact with the glass throughout the entire stroke of the arm.
c. The measurement taken must not exceed 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m) of force when rotated in either
direction.
(1) If the force is greater than 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m), then replace the rear window striker / wiper pivot
shaft assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-16 - Wipers and Washers Removal and
Installation. (Figure 4)
(2) If the rear window striker/wiper pivot shaft assembly is within specification, then follow normal
Workshop Manual diagnostics.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiper Motor Linkage: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear
Wiper is Inoperative > Page 12328
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071013A 2003-2007 0.7 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Rear Window Striker/Wiper Pivot Shaft, Includes Time To
Verify Concern (Do Not Use With 40860B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17C426 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield
Wiper Motor Linkage: Service and Repair Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield
WIPER MOUNTING ARM AND PIVOT SHAFT - WINDSHIELD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the cowl grille panel. 2. Disconnect and position the hood light harness aside. 3.
Remove the hood struts.
- Using a suitable tool support the hood.
4. Remove the mounting arm and pivot shaft assembly.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector and position the wiring harness aside.
2 Remove the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield > Page 12331
Wiper Motor Linkage: Service and Repair Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Rear
WIPER MOUNTING ARM AND PIVOT SHAFT - REAR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm. 2. Remove the dust boot cover.
3. Remove the nut and the rear window glass handle.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
4. Remove the nuts and the rear window wiper striker and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
5. To install reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield > Page 12332
Wiper Motor Linkage: Service and Repair Wiper and Washer System - Exploded View
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM - EXPLODED VIEW
Wiper And Washer System - Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield > Page 12333
Wiper And Washer System - Rear
Removal And Installation
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative
Wiper Pivot: Customer Interest Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative
TSB 07-10-13
05/28/07
REAR WIPER INOPERATIVE
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-10 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2003-2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles, the rear wiper may not return to park
position. In this case, the rear wiper system will attempt to park periodically causing a battery
drain.This concern may be caused by corrosion on the wiper pivot shaft assembly.
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to identify and replace the rear window striker/wiper
pivot shaft assembly.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disengage rear wiper mechanism by partially opening the rear liftgate glass. (Figure 1)
2. Access the rear wiper arm attaching nut. (Figure 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative > Page
12342
3. Use a torque wrench to measure the amount of torque necessary to rotate the wiper arm
throughout the entire travel of the wiper arm. (Figure 3)
a. This must be done while the glass is open so that the wiper mechanism is disengaged from the
motor drive plate.
b. The wiper blade should be in full contact with the glass throughout the entire stroke of the arm.
c. The measurement taken must not exceed 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m) of force when rotated in either
direction.
(1) If the force is greater than 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m), then replace the rear window striker / wiper pivot
shaft assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-16 - Wipers and Washers Removal and
Installation. (Figure 4)
(2) If the rear window striker/wiper pivot shaft assembly is within specification, then follow normal
Workshop Manual diagnostics.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative > Page
12343
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071013A 2003-2007 0.7 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Rear Window Striker/Wiper Pivot Shaft, Includes Time To
Verify Concern (Do Not Use With 40860B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17C426 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is
Inoperative
Wiper Pivot: All Technical Service Bulletins Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative
TSB 07-10-13
05/28/07
REAR WIPER INOPERATIVE
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-10 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2003-2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles, the rear wiper may not return to park
position. In this case, the rear wiper system will attempt to park periodically causing a battery
drain.This concern may be caused by corrosion on the wiper pivot shaft assembly.
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to identify and replace the rear window striker/wiper
pivot shaft assembly.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disengage rear wiper mechanism by partially opening the rear liftgate glass. (Figure 1)
2. Access the rear wiper arm attaching nut. (Figure 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is
Inoperative > Page 12349
3. Use a torque wrench to measure the amount of torque necessary to rotate the wiper arm
throughout the entire travel of the wiper arm. (Figure 3)
a. This must be done while the glass is open so that the wiper mechanism is disengaged from the
motor drive plate.
b. The wiper blade should be in full contact with the glass throughout the entire stroke of the arm.
c. The measurement taken must not exceed 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m) of force when rotated in either
direction.
(1) If the force is greater than 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m), then replace the rear window striker / wiper pivot
shaft assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-16 - Wipers and Washers Removal and
Installation. (Figure 4)
(2) If the rear window striker/wiper pivot shaft assembly is within specification, then follow normal
Workshop Manual diagnostics.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is
Inoperative > Page 12350
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071013A 2003-2007 0.7 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Rear Window Striker/Wiper Pivot Shaft, Includes Time To
Verify Concern (Do Not Use With 40860B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17C426 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 12351
Wiper Pivot: Service and Repair
REAR WINDOW STRIKER AND WIPER PIVOT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
Removal
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm.
2. Remove the dust boot cover.
3. Remove the nut and the rear window glass handle.
4. Remove the nuts and the rear window striker and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. NOTE: An audible click should be heard as the striker engages the latch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 12352
Push the rear window wiper striker and pivot shaft assembly into the wiper motor. The pivot shaft
pin should be aligned with the hole in the motor disc.
3. Install the rear window wiper motor alignment tool. If installing a new rear wiper motor, one is
provided with the motor assembly.
1 Make sure the alignment tool fits over the motor disc and striker assembly.
2 Make sure the alignment tool clips are securely engaged.
4. Carefully close the liftgate glass.
5. Open the liftgate. Install the rear window wiper striker and wiper pivot arm mounting assembly
nuts. Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. Remove the rear window wiper motor alignment tool. 7. Close the liftgate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 12353
8. Install the rear window wiper pivot shaft nut and handle. Tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
9. Install the dust boot cover.
10. NOTE: This step makes sure that the wiper motor is in the PARK position.
Turn the rear window wiper switch ON and allow the motor to operate for at least one cycle. Turn
the rear window wiper switch to OFF.
11. Install the rear wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
1 Position the wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
2 Tighten the nut to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
3 Install the cover.
12. Open the liftgate. 13. Install the liftgate trim panel. 14. Test the liftgate and liftgate glass for
normal operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Steering Column)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
12357
Wiper Switch: Diagrams
C202a
C202b
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
12358
C202c
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
12359
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L VIN 5 (2006))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
12360